20-F
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 20-F

(Mark One)

 

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

¨ SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number 1-14642            

ING GROEP N.V.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

The Netherlands

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

ING Groep N.V.

Amstelveenseweg 500

1081 KL Amsterdam

P.O. Box 810, 1000 AV Amsterdam

The Netherlands

(Address of principal executive offices)

Hans van Barneveld

Telephone: +31 20 541 8510

E-mail: Hans.van.Barneveld@ing.com

Amstelveenseweg 500

1081KL Amsterdam

The Netherlands

(Name; Telephone, Email and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

American Depositary Shares, each representing one Ordinary Share Ordinary Shares, nominal value EUR 0.24 per Ordinary Share and Bearer

 

New York Stock Exchange

Depositary receipts in respect of Ordinary Shares*   New York Stock Exchange
  7.05% ING Perpetual Debt Securities   New York Stock Exchange

  7.20% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

  6.20% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

6.125% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

6.375% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

7.375% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

  8.50% ING Perpetual Debt Securities

  New York Stock Exchange

 

* Listed, not for trading or quotation purposes, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.

 

Ordinary Shares, nominal value EUR 0.24 per Ordinary Share

     3,831,560,513   

Bearer Depositary receipts in respect of Ordinary Shares

     3,830,278,454   

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  þ Yes   ¨ No

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.  ¨ Yes þ  No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days  .þ Yes  ¨ No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrants have submitted electronically and posted on their corporate Web sites, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).*  ¨ Yes  ¨ No

 

* This requirement does not currently apply to the registrant.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act (Check one).

Large accelerated filer  þ                 Accelerated filer  ¨                 Non-accelerated filer  ¨

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

U.S. GAAP  ¨

 

International Financial Reporting Standards as issued

by the International Accounting Standards Board þ

  Other   ¨

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.  ¨ Item 17  ¨ Item 18

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  ¨ Yes  þ No

 

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     PART I    PAGE  
Item      
1.    IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISORS      5   
2.    OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE      5   
3.    KEY INFORMATION      5   
4.    INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY      32   
4A.    UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS      61   
5.    OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS      62   
6.    DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES      103   
7.    MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS      119   
8.    FINANCIAL INFORMATION      123   
9.    THE OFFER AND LISTING      126   
10.    ADDITIONAL INFORMATION      127   
11.    QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURE ABOUT MARKET RISK      136   
12.    DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES      136   
   PART II   
13.    DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES      138   
14.    MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS      138   
15.    CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES      138   
16A.    AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT      140   
16B.    CODE OF ETHICS      140   
16C.    PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES      140   
16D.    EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES      142   
16E.    PURCHASES OF REGISTERED EQUITY SERVICES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS      142   
16F.    CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT      142   
16G.    CORPORATE GOVERNANCE      142   
   PART III   
18.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS      143   
19.    EXHIBITS      143   
   ADDITIONAL INFORMATION   
   SELECTED STATISTICAL INFORMATION ON BANKING OPERATIONS      146   

 

2


Table of Contents

PRESENTATION OF INFORMATION

In this Annual Report, and unless otherwise stated or the context otherwise dictates, references to “ING Groep N.V.”, “ING Groep” and “ING Group” refer to ING Groep N.V. and references to “ING”, the “Company”, the “Group”, “we” and “us” refer to ING Groep N.V. and its consolidated subsidiaries. ING Groep N.V.’s primary insurance and banking subsidiaries are ING Verzekeringen N.V. (together with its consolidated subsidiaries, “ING Insurance”) and ING Bank N.V. (together with its consolidated subsidiaries, “ING Bank”), respectively. References to “Executive Board” or “Supervisory Board” refer to the Executive Board or Supervisory Board of ING Groep N.V.

ING presents its consolidated financial statements in Euros, the currency of the European Economic and Monetary Union. Unless otherwise specified or the context otherwise requires, references to “US$” and “Dollars” are to the United States dollars and references to “EUR” are to euros.

Solely for the convenience of the reader, this Annual Report contains translations of certain euro amounts into U.S. dollars at specified rates. These translations should not be construed as representations that the translated amounts actually represent such dollar or euro amounts, as the case may be, or could be converted into U.S. dollars or euros, as the case may be, at the rates indicated or at any other rate. Therefore, unless otherwise stated, the translations of euros into U.S. dollars have been made at the rate of euro 1.00 = $ 1.3320, the noon buying rate in New York City for cable transfers in euros as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (the “Noon Buying Rate”) on March 1, 2012.

ING prepares financial information in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IFRS-IASB”) for purposes of reporting with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), including financial information contained in this Annual Report on Form 20-F. ING Group’s accounting policies and its use of various options under IFRS-IASB are described under ‘Principles of valuation and determination of results’ in the consolidated financial statements. In this document the term “IFRS-IASB” is used to refer to IFRS-IASB as applied by ING Group.

The published 2011 Annual Accounts of ING Group, however, are prepared in accordance with IFRS-EU. IFRS-EU refers to International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as adopted by the European Union (“EU”), including the decisions ING Group made with regard to the options available under IFRS as adopted by the EU. IFRS-EU differs from IFRS-IASB, in respect of certain paragraphs in IAS 39 ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’ regarding hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk. Furthermore, IFRS 9 “Financial Instruments” (issued in 2009) is not yet endorsed by the EU and, therefore, is not yet part of IFRS-EU. However, IFRS 9 is only effective as of 2015 and ING has not early adopted IFRS 9 under IFRS-IASB.

Under IFRS-EU, ING Group applies fair value hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk (fair value macro hedges) in accordance with the EU ‘carve out’ version of IAS 39. Under the EU ‘IAS 39 carve-out’, hedge accounting may be applied, in respect of fair value macro hedges, to core deposits and hedge ineffectiveness is only recognized when the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets falls below the original designated amount of that bucket, and is not recognized when the revised amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets is more than the original designated amount. Under IFRS-IASB, hedge accounting for fair value macro hedges cannot be applied to core deposits and ineffectiveness arises whenever the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets is either more or less than the original designated amount of that bucket.

This information is prepared by reversing the hedge accounting impacts that are applied under the EU ‘carve out’ version of IAS 39. Financial information under IFRS-IASB accordingly does not take account of the possibility that had ING Group applied IFRS-IASB as its primary accounting framework it might have applied alternative hedge strategies where those alternative hedge strategies could have qualified for IFRS-IASB compliant hedge accounting. These decisions could have resulted in different shareholders’ equity and net result amounts compared to those indicated in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

Other than for SEC reporting, ING Group intends to continue to prepare its Annual Accounts under IFRS-EU.

A reconciliation between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB is included in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements entitled Basis of preparation.

Effective March 4, 2008, amendments to Form 20-F permit Foreign Private Issuers to include financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS-IASB without reconciliation to US GAAP.

 

3


Table of Contents

Certain amounts set forth herein may not sum due to rounding.

Although certain references are made to information available on ING’s website, no materials from ING’s website or any other source are incorporated by reference into this Annual Report, except as specifically stated herein.

ING Group changed its accounting policy for the insurance provisions for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for Life (GMWBL) on the Insurance US Closed Block VA book as of January 1, 2011. This change represents a change in accounting policy under IFRS, with a transitional impact being reflected in shareholders’ equity. Comparative years’ results have been restated. Further details are provided in the section “Changes in accounting policies” in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

The Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations were disposed of in December 2011. (for more information, see “Item 4. Information on the Company – Changes in the Composition of the Group). This transaction qualifies under IFRS as a discontinued operation. The results of the discontinued operations for the year and for comparative years are presented separately from continuing operations in the profit and loss account.

CAUTIONARY STATEMENT WITH RESPECT TO FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

Certain of the statements contained in this Annual Report are not historical facts, including, without limitation, certain statements made in the sections hereof entitled “Information on the Company,” “Dividends,” “Operating and Financial Review and Prospects,” “Selected Statistical Information on Banking Operations” and “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risk” are statements of future expectations and other forward-looking statements that are based on management’s current views and assumptions and involve known and unknown risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results, performance or events to differ materially from those expressed or implied in such statements. Actual results, performance or events may differ materially from those expressed or implied in such statements due to, without limitation,

 

   

changes in general economic conditions, in particular economic conditions in ING’s core markets,

 

   

changes in performance of financial markets, including developing markets,

 

   

consequences of a potential (partial) break-up of the euro,

 

   

the implementation of ING’s restructuring plan to separate banking and insurance operations,

 

   

changes in the availability of, and costs associated with, sources of liquidity such as interbank funding, as well as conditions in the credit markets generally, including changes in borrower and counterparty creditworthiness,

 

   

the frequency and severity of insured loss events,

 

   

changes affecting mortality and morbidity levels and trends,

 

   

changes affecting persistency levels,

 

   

changes affecting interest rate levels,

 

   

changes affecting currency exchange rates,

 

   

changes in investor, customer and policyholder behaviour,

 

   

changes in general competitive factors,

 

   

changes in laws and regulations,

 

   

changes in the policies of governments and/or regulatory authorities,

 

   

conclusions with regard to purchase accounting assumptions and methodologies,

 

   

changes in ownership that could affect the future availability to us of net operating loss, net capital and built-in loss carry forwards,

 

   

changes in credit ratings,

 

   

ING’s ability to achieve projected operational synergies, and

 

   

the other risks and uncertainties detailed in “Item 3. Key Information – Risk Factors” in ING’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2011.

Any forward-looking statements made by or on behalf of ING speak only as of the date they are made, and ING assumes no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information or for any other reason. See “Item 3. Key Information—Risk Factors” and “Item 5. Operating and financial review and prospects – Factors Affecting Results of Operations.”

 

4


Table of Contents

PART I

 

Item 1. Identity of Directors, Senior Management And Advisors

Not Applicable.

 

Item 2. Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Not Applicable.

 

Item 3. Key Information

The selected consolidated financial information data is derived from the IFRS-IASB consolidated financial statements of ING Group.

The following information should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified by reference to the Group’s consolidated financial statements and other financial information included elsewhere herein.

 

 

5


Table of Contents
$000,000,00 $000,000,00 $000,000,00 $000,000,00 $000,000,00 $000,000,00
     Year ended December 31,  
     2011      2011      2010(7 )     2009(7)     2008(7)     2007(7)  
     USD(1 )      EUR      EUR     EUR     EUR     EUR  
     (in millions, except amounts per share and ratios)  

IFRS-IASB Consolidated Income Statement Data

              

Income from banking operations:

              

Interest income

     86,112         64,649         68,334        79,850        98,201        76,859   

Interest expense

     68,198         51,200         55,011        67,475        87,118        67,823   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest result

     17,914         13,449         13,323        12,375        11,082        9,036   

Commission income

     3,269         2,454         2,593        2,660        2,820        2,926   

Investment and Other income

     774         581         1,091        (3,546     (5,950     3,151   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income from banking operations

     21,957         16,484         17,007        11,489        7,952        15,113   

Income from insurance operations:

              

Premium income

     36,228         27,198         27,786        30,248        42,671        44,746   

Commission income

     2,109         1,583         1,555        1,580        1,766        1,710   

Investment and Other income

     12,182         9,146         7,162        2,955        8,440        12,836   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income from insurance operations

     50,519         37,927         36,503        34,783        52,877        59,293   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income (2)

     72,477         54,412         53,510        46,273        60.538        74,182   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure from banking operations

     15,824         11,880         11,914        13,134        11,556        10,092   

Total expenditure from insurance operations

     50,822         38,155         38,610        35,970        54,732        52,927   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure (2 ) (3

     66,180         49,685         50,177        48,765        65,997        62,795   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Result before tax from banking operations

     6,133         4,604         5,093        (1,645     (3,604     5,021   

Result before tax from insurance operations

     163         122         (1,760     (848     (1,855     6,366   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Result before tax

     6,296         4,727         3,333        (2,492     (5,459     11,387   

Taxation

     1,344         1,009         1,076        (780     (1,708     1,590   

Result from discontinued operatiions (8)

     1,477         1,109         216        100        82        89   

Minority interests

     116         87         106        (118     (37     267   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     6,314         4,740         2,367        (1,494     (3,632     9,619   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividend on Ordinary Shares

               1,500        3,180   

Addition to shareholders’ equity

     6,314         4,740         2,367        (1,755     (5,557     6,439   

Coupon payable on non-voting equity securities (6 )

             259        425     

Net result attributable to equity holders of the Company

             (935     (729     9,241   

Basic earnings per share (4 )

     1.13         0.85         0.51        (0.78     (1.36     3.45   

Diluted earnings per share (4 )

     1.13         0.85         0.51        (0.78     (1.36     3.43   

Dividend per Ordinary Share (4 )

               0.74        1.48   

Interim Dividend

               0.74        0.66   

Final Dividend

                 0.82   

Number of Ordinary Shares outstanding (in millions)

     3,782.3         3782.3         3,780.3        3,784.5        2,059.5        2,098.1   

Dividend pay-out ratio (5 )

     n.a         n.a         n.a        n.a        n.a.        34.3

 

6


Table of Contents
     Year ended December 31,  
     2011      2011      2010(7 )      2009(7 )      2008(7)      2007(7)  
     USD(1 )      EUR      EUR      EUR      EUR      EUR  
     (in billions, except amounts per share and ratios)  

IFRS-IASB Consolidated Balance Sheet Data

                 

Total assets

     1,696.4         1,273.6         1,242.7         1,159.8         1,328,6         1,313,2   

Investments:

                 

Banking

     111.6         83.8         110.9         105.5         148.8         160.4   

Insurance

     178.0         133.6         123.3         106.6         109.5         132.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     289.6         217.4         234.2         212.1         258.3         292.6   

Loans and advances to customers

     795.1         596.9         608.9         575.3         616.8         553.7   

Insurance and investment contracts:

                 

Life

     349.1         262.1         255.5         226.2         214.3         232.4   

Non-life

     4.7         3.5         3.6         3.5         6.8         9.6   

Investment contracts

     17.6         13.2         12.0         11.3         21.1         23.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     371.4         278.8         271.1         241.0         242.2         265.7   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit:

                 

Savings accounts of the banking operations

     388.3         291.5         324.6         304.1         274.3         275.1   

Other deposits and bank funds

     234.4         176.0         186.8         165.4         248.5         250.1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     622.7         467.5         511.4         469.5         522.8         525.2   

Amounts due to banks

     96.2         72.2         72.9         84.2         152.3         167.0   

Shareholders’ equity

     56.6         42.5         37.7         30.9         14.9         37.7   

Non-voting equity securities

     4.0         3.0         5.0         5.0         10.0      

Shareholders’ equity per Ordinary Share (4)

     14.95         11.22         9.98         8.17         7.37         17.98   

Share capital in number of shares (in millions)

     3,831.6         3,831.6         3,831.6         3,831.6         2,063.1         2,226.4   

 

(1)

Euro amounts have been translated into U.S. dollars at the exchange rate of $ 1.3320 to EUR 1.00, the noon buying rate in New York City on March 1, 2012 for cable transfers in euros as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

(2)

After elimination of certain intercompany transactions between the insurance operations and the banking operations. See Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

(3)

Includes all non-interest expenses, including additions to the provision for loan losses. See “Item 5 Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Liquidity and Capital Resources”.

(4)

Basic earnings per share amounts have been calculated based on the weighted average number of Ordinary Shares outstanding and Shareholders’ equity per share amounts have been calculated based on the number of Ordinary Shares outstanding at the end of the respective periods. For purposes of this calculation ING Groep N.V. shares held by Group companies are deducted from the total number of Ordinary Shares in issue. The rights issue, which was finalized on December 15, 2009 has an effect on the basic earnings per share and the diluted earnings per share, as defined in IFRS IASB. All weighted average number of shares outstanding before the rights issue are restated with an adjustment factor that reflects the fact that the exercise price of the rights issue was less than the fair value of the shares, see Note 49 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements. The effect of dilutive securities is adjusted as well.

(5)

The dividend pay-out ratio is based on net result attributed to equity holders of the Company.

(6)

For details of the agreements with the Dutch State, see Note 13 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

(7)

Restated to reflect the change in accounting policy i.e. move towards fair value accounting for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for life in the US Closed Block VA as of January 1, 2011, see Basis of Presentation of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

(8)

For details on Discontinued operations, see Note 25 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

7


Table of Contents

EXCHANGE RATES

Fluctuations in the exchange rate between the euro and the U.S. dollar will affect the U.S. dollar amounts received by owners of shares or ADSs on conversion of dividends, if any, paid in euros on the shares and will affect the U.S. dollar price of the ADSs on the New York Stock Exchange.

The following table sets forth, for the periods and dates indicated, certain information concerning the exchange rate for U.S. dollars into euros based on the Noon Buying Rate.

 

     U.S. dollars per euro  
Calendar Period    Period
End(1)
     Average
Rate(2)
     High      Low  

2007

     1.4603         1.3794         1.4862         1.2904   

2008

     1.3919         1.4695         1.6010         1.2446   

2009

     1.4332         1.3955         1.5100         1.2547   

2010

     1.3269         1.3218         1.4536         1.1959   

2011

     1.2973         1.4002         1.4875         1.2926   

 

(1)

The Noon Buying Rate at such dates differ from the rates used in the preparation of ING’s consolidated financial statements as of such date. See Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

(2)

The average of the Noon Buying Rates on the last business day of each full calendar month during the period.

The table below shows the high and low exchange rate of the U.S. dollar per euro for the last six months.

 

     High      Low  

September 2011

     1.4283         1.3446   

October 2011

     1.4164         1.3281   

November 2011

     1.3803         1.3244   

December 2011

     1.3487         1.2926   

January 2012

     1.3192         1.2686   

February 2012

     1.3464         1.3087   

The Noon Buying Rate for euros on December 31, 2011 was EUR 1.00 = $ 1.2973 and the Noon Buying Rate for euros on March 1, 2012 was EUR 1.00 = $ 1.3320.

 

8


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

Any of the risks described below could have a material adverse effect on the business activities, financial condition, results of operations and prospects of ING. The market price of ING shares could decline due to any of these risks, and investors could lose all or part of their investments. Additional risks of which the Company is not presently aware could also affect the business operations of ING and have a material adverse effect on ING’s business activities, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. In addition, the business of a multinational, broad-based financial services firm such as ING is inherently exposed to risks that only become apparent with the benefit of hindsight. The sequence in which the risk factors are presented below is not indicative of their likelihood of occurrence or the potential magnitude of their financial consequences.

Risks Related to Financial Conditions, Market Environment and General Economic Trends.

Because we are a financial services company conducting business on a global basis, our revenues and earnings are affected by the volatility and strength of the economic, business and capital markets environments specific to the geographic regions in which we conduct business. The ongoing turbulence and volatility of such factors have adversely affected, and may continue to adversely affect, the profitability and solvency of our insurance, banking and asset management business.

Factors such as interest rates, securities prices, credit spreads, liquidity spreads, exchange rates, consumer spending, changes in client behaviour, business investment, real estate and private equity valuations, government spending, inflation, the volatility and strength of the capital markets, political events and trends, and terrorism all impact the business and economic environment and, ultimately, our solvency and the amount and profitability of business we conduct in a specific geographic region. In an economic downturn characterized by higher unemployment, lower family income, lower corporate earnings, higher corporate and private debt defaults, lower business investments, and lower consumer spending, the demand for banking and insurance products is usually adversely affected and ING’s reserves and provisions typically would increase, resulting in overall lower earnings. Securities prices, real estate values and private equity valuations may also be adversely impacted, and any such losses would be realized through profit and loss and shareholders’ equity. Some insurance products contain minimum return or accumulation guarantees. If returns do not meet or exceed the guarantee levels we may need to set up additional reserves to fund these future guaranteed benefits. In addition, we may experience an elevated incidence of claims and lapses or surrenders of policies. Our policyholders may choose to defer paying insurance premiums or stop paying insurance premiums altogether. Similarly, a downturn in the equity markets causes a reduction in commission income we earn from managing portfolios for third parties, income generated from our own proprietary portfolios, asset-based fee income on certain insurance products, and our capital base. We also offer a number of insurance and financial products that expose us to risks associated with fluctuations in interest rates, securities prices, corporate and private default rates, the value of real estate assets, exchange rates and credit spreads. See also “— Interest rate volatility and other interest rate changes may adversely affect our profitability”, “—Turbulence and volatility in the financial markets have adversely affected us, and may continue to do so”, and “—Market conditions observed over the last year may increase the risk of loans being impaired. We are exposed to declining property values on the collateral supporting residential and commercial real estate lending” below.

In case one or more of the factors mentioned above adversely affects the profitability of our business this might also result, among other things, in the following:

 

   

the unlocking of deferred acquisition costs impacting earnings; and/or

 

   

reserve inadequacies which could ultimately be realized through profit and loss and shareholders’ equity; and/or

 

   

the write down of tax assets impacting net results; and/or

 

   

impairment expenses related to goodwill and other intangible assets, impacting net results; and/or

 

   

movements in Risk Weighted Assets for the determination of required capital.

Shareholders’ equity and our net result may be significantly impacted by turmoil and volatility in the worldwide financial markets. Negative developments in financial markets and/or economies may have a material adverse impact on shareholders’ equity and net result in future periods, including as a result of the potential consequences listed above. See “ — Turbulence and volatility in the financial markets have adversely affected us, and may continue to do so” below.

Adverse capital and credit market conditions may impact our ability to access liquidity and capital, as well as the cost of credit and capital.

The capital and credit markets have been experiencing extreme volatility and disruption since the second half of 2008. In some cases, market developments have resulted in restrictions on the availability of liquidity and credit capacity for certain issuers.

 

9


Table of Contents

We need liquidity in our day-to-day business activities to pay our operating expenses, interest on our debt and dividends on our capital stock; maintain our securities lending activities; and replace certain maturing liabilities. The principal sources of our funding are deposit funds, insurance premiums, annuity considerations, cash flow from our investment portfolio and assets, consisting mainly of cash or assets that are readily convertible into cash. Sources of liquidity in normal markets may also include a variety of short- and long-term instruments, including repurchase agreements, commercial paper, medium-and long-term debt, subordinated debt securities, capital securities and stockholders’ equity.

In the event current resources do not satisfy our needs, we may need to seek additional financing. The availability of additional financing will depend on a variety of factors such as market conditions, the general availability of credit, the volume of trading activities, the overall availability of credit to the financial services industry, our credit ratings and credit capacity, as well as the possibility that customers or lenders could develop a negative perception of our long- or short-term financial prospects. Similarly, our access to funds may be limited if regulatory authorities or rating agencies take negative actions against us. If our internal sources of liquidity prove to be insufficient, there is a risk that external funding sources might not be available, or available at unfavourable terms.

Disruptions, uncertainty or volatility in the capital and credit markets, such as that experienced over the past few years, including in relation to the ongoing European sovereign debt crisis, may also limit our access to capital required to operate our business. Such market conditions may in the future limit our ability to raise additional capital to support business growth, or to counter-balance the consequences of losses or increased regulatory capital requirements. This could force us to (1) delay raising capital, (2) reduce, cancel or postpone payment of dividends on our shares, (3) reduce, cancel or postpone interest payments on other securities, (4) issue capital of different types or under different terms than we would otherwise, or (5) incur a higher cost of capital than in a more stable market environment. This would have the potential to decrease both our profitability and our financial flexibility. Our results of operations, financial condition, cash flows and regulatory capital position could be materially adversely affected by disruptions in the financial markets.

In the course of 2008 and 2009, governments around the world, including the Dutch government, implemented unprecedented measures to provide assistance to financial institutions, in certain cases requiring (indirect) influence on or changes to governance and remuneration practices. In certain cases governments nationalized companies or parts thereof. The measures adopted in the Netherlands include both liquidity provision and capital reinforcement, and a Dutch Credit Guarantee Scheme. The liquidity and capital reinforcement measures expired on October 10, 2009, and the Credit Guarantee Scheme of the Netherlands expired on December 31, 2010. Our participation in these measures has resulted in certain material restrictions on us, including those required by the European Commission (“EC”) as part of our Restructuring Plan. See “Risks Related to the Restructuring Plan — Our agreements with the Dutch State impose certain restrictions regarding the issuance or repurchase of our shares and the compensation of certain senior management positions”, “Risks Related to the Restructuring Plan — The implementation of the Restructuring Plan and the divestments anticipated in connection with that plan will significantly alter the size and structure of the Group and involve significant costs and uncertainties that could materially impact the Group”. The Restructuring Plan as well as any potential future transactions with the Dutch State or any other government, if any, or actions by such government regarding ING could adversely impact the position or rights of shareholders, bondholders, customers or creditors and our results, operations, solvency, liquidity and governance.

We are subject to the jurisdiction of a variety of banking and insurance regulatory bodies, some of which have proposed regulatory changes that, if implemented, would hinder our ability to manage our liquidity in a centralized manner. Furthermore, regulatory liquidity requirements in certain jurisdictions in which we operate are generally becoming more stringent, including those forming part of the “Basel III” requirements discussed further below under “—We operate in highly regulated industries. There could be an adverse change or increase in the financial services laws and/or regulations governing our business”, undermining our efforts to maintain this centralized management of our liquidity. These developments may cause trapped pools of liquidity, resulting in inefficiencies in the cost of managing our liquidity, and hinder our efforts to integrate our balance sheet, which is an essential element of our Restructuring Plan.

 

10


Table of Contents

The default of a major market participant could disrupt the markets.

Within the financial services industry the severe distress or default of any one institution (including sovereigns) could lead to defaults or severe distress by other institutions. Such distress or defaults could disrupt securities markets or clearance and settlement systems in our markets. This could cause market declines or volatility. Such a failure could lead to a chain of defaults that could adversely affect us and our contract counterparties. Concerns about the credit worthiness of a sovereign or financial institution (or a default by any such entity) could lead to significant liquidity and/or solvency problems, losses or defaults by other institutions, because the commercial and financial soundness of many financial institutions may be closely related as a result of their credit, trading, clearing or other relationships. Even the perceived lack of creditworthiness of, or questions about, a sovereign or a counterparty may lead to market-wide liquidity problems and losses or defaults by us or by other institutions. This risk is sometimes referred to as “systemic risk” and may adversely affect financial intermediaries, such as clearing agencies, clearing houses, banks, securities firms and exchanges with whom we interact on a daily basis and financial instruments of sovereigns in which we invest. Systemic risk could have a material adverse effect on our ability to raise new funding and on our business, financial condition, results of operations, liquidity and/or prospects. In addition, such a failure could impact future product sales as a potential result of reduced confidence in the financial services industry.

Management believes that despite increased attention recently, systemic risk to the markets in which we operate continues to exist, and dislocations caused by the interdependency of financial market participants continues to be a potential source of material adverse changes to our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Because our life and non-life insurance and reinsurance businesses are subject to losses from unforeseeable and/or catastrophic events, which are inherently unpredictable, our actual claims amount may exceed our established reserves or we may experience an abrupt interruption of activities, each of which could result in lower net results and have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

In our life and non-life insurance and reinsurance businesses, we are subject to losses from natural and man-made catastrophic events. Such events include, without limitation, weather and other natural catastrophes such as hurricanes, floods, earthquakes and epidemics that may be more severe or difficult to predict as a result of variable climate conditions, as well as events such as terrorist attacks and political and social unrest.

The frequency and severity of such events, and the losses associated with them, are inherently unpredictable and cannot always be adequately reserved for. Furthermore, we are subject to actuarial and underwriting risks such as, for instance, mortality, longevity, morbidity, and adverse claims development which result from the pricing and acceptance of insurance contracts. In accordance with industry practices, modelling of natural catastrophes is performed and risk mitigation measures are taken. In case claims occur, reserves are established based on estimates using actuarial projection techniques. The process of estimating is based on information available at the time the reserves are originally established and includes updates when more information becomes available. Although we continually review the adequacy of the established claim reserves, there can be no assurances that our actual claims experience will not exceed our estimated claim reserves. If actual claim amounts exceed the estimated claim reserves, our earnings may be reduced and our net results may be adversely affected.

In addition, and as discussed further below under “Risks Related to the Group’s Business, Operations, and Regulatory Environment—Operational risks are inherent in our business”, because unforeseeable and/or catastrophic events can lead to an abrupt interruption of activities, our banking and insurance operations may be subject to losses resulting from such disruptions. Losses can relate to property, financial assets, trading positions, insurance and pension benefits to employees and also to key personnel. If our business continuity plans are not able to be put into action or do not take such events into account, our financial condition could be adversely affected.

We operate in highly regulated industries. There could be an adverse change or increase in the financial services laws and/or regulations governing our business.

We are subject to detailed banking, insurance, asset management and other financial services laws and government regulation in each of the jurisdictions in which we conduct business. Regulatory agencies have broad administrative power over many aspects of the financial services business, which may include liquidity, capital adequacy and permitted investments, ethical issues, anti-money laundering, anti-terrorism measures, privacy, record keeping, product and sale suitability, and marketing and sales practices, and our own internal governance practices. Banking, insurance and other financial services laws, regulations and policies currently governing us and our subsidiaries may also change at any time and in ways which have an adverse effect on

 

11


Table of Contents

our business, and it is difficult to predict the timing or form of any future regulatory or enforcement initiatives in respect thereof. Also, regulators and other supervisory authorities in the EU, the US and elsewhere continue to scrutinize the financial services industry and its activities under regulations governing such matters as money-laundering, prohibited transactions with countries subject to sanctions, and bribery or other anti-corruption measures. Regulation is becoming increasingly more extensive and complex and regulators are focusing increased scrutiny on the industries in which we operate, often requiring additional Company resources. These regulations can serve to limit our activities, including through our net capital, customer protection and market conduct requirements, and restrictions on businesses in which we can operate or invest. If we fail to address, or appear to fail to address, appropriately any of these matters, our reputation could be harmed and we could be subject to additional legal risk, which could, in turn, increase the size and number of claims and damages asserted against us or subject us to enforcement actions, fines and penalties.

In light of current conditions in the global financial markets and the global economy, regulators have increased their focus on the regulation of the financial services industry. Most of the principal markets where we conduct our business have adopted, or are currently considering, major legislative and/or regulatory initiatives in response to the financial crisis. Governmental and regulatory authorities in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, the United States and elsewhere are implementing measures to increase regulatory control in their respective financial markets and financial services sectors, including in the areas of prudential rules, capital requirements, executive compensation, crisis and contingency management, bank levies and financial reporting, among others. Additionally, governmental and regulatory authorities in the Netherlands as well as in a multitude of jurisdictions continue to consider new mechanisms to limit the occurrence and/or severity of future economic crises (including proposals to restrict the size of financial institutions operating in their jurisdictions and/or the scope of operations of such institutions).

We cannot predict whether or when future legislative or regulatory actions may be taken, or what impact, if any, actions taken to date or in the future could have on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Despite our efforts to maintain effective compliance procedures and to comply with applicable laws and regulations, there are a number of risks in areas where applicable regulations may be unclear, subject to multiple interpretation or under development or may conflict with one another, where regulators revise their previous guidance or courts overturn previous rulings, or we fail to meet applicable standards. Regulators and other authorities have the power to bring administrative or judicial proceedings against us, which could result, amongst other things, in suspension or revocation of our licenses, cease and desist orders, fines, civil penalties, criminal penalties or other disciplinary action which could materially harm our results of operations and financial condition.

Basel III

In addition, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision has announced higher global minimum capital standards for banks, and has introduced a new global liquidity standard and a new leverage ratio. The Committee’s package of reforms, collectively referred to as the “Basel III” rules, will, among other requirements, increase the amount of common equity required to be held by subject banking institutions, prescribe the amount of liquid assets and the long term funding a subject banking institution must hold at any given moment, and limit leverage . Banks will be required to hold a “capital conservation buffer” to withstand future periods of stress such that the total Tier 1 common equity ratio, when fully phased in on January 1, 2019, will rise to 7%. Basel III also introduces a “countercyclical buffer” as an extension of the capital conservation buffer, which permits national regulators to require banks to hold more capital during periods of high credit growth (to strengthen capital reserves and moderate the debt markets). Further, Basel III calls for stricter definitions of capital that will have the effect of disqualifying many hybrid securities, potentially including those issued by the Group, from inclusion in regulatory capital, as well as the higher capital requirements for trading, derivative and securitization activities to be introduced at the end of 2011 as part of a number of reforms to the Basel II framework. In addition, the Basel Committee and Financial Stability Board (FSB) are currently considering measures that may have the effect of requiring higher loss absorbency capacity, liquidity surcharges, exposure limits and special resolution regimes for “systemically important financial institutions” (SIFIs) and so-called “Global” SIFIs (G-SIFI), in addition to the Basel III requirements otherwise applicable to most financial institutions. ING has been designated as a G-SIFI.

For European banks these requirements will be implemented through the Capital Requirement Directive (CRD) IV, which might deviate in its final state from the original Basel III requirements. While the full impact of the new Basel III rules, and any additional requirements for SIFIs or G-SIFIs if and as applicable to the Group, will depend on how they are implemented by national regulators, including the extent to which regulators and supervisors can set more stringent limits and additional capital requirements or surcharges, as well as on the economic and financial environment at the time of implementation and beyond, we expect these rules can have

 

12


Table of Contents

a material impact on ING’s operations and financial condition and may require the Group to seek additional capital. Further, the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) is considering changes to several IFRS standards, which changes could also have a material impact on our reported results and financial condition.

Solvency II

The European Council has agreed upon a full scale revision of the solvency framework and prudential regime applicable to insurance and reinsurance companies known as “Solvency II”, which was adopted on November 25, 2009 (Directive 2009/138/EG). A key aspect of Solvency II is the closer alignment of the assessment of risks and capital requirements with economic capital methodologies. Under the Solvency II regime, insurance companies may be permitted to make use of an internal economic capital model as a basis for calculation of their capital needs and solvency position (in the Netherlands, such a model (including ING’s model) has to be approved by the Dutch Central Bank).

The final text of the Level I Framework Directive includes rules regarding, among other things, own funds, capital requirements, investments and group supervision. Following adoption of this Level I Framework Directive, the European Commission and European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority (“EIOPA”), formerly CEIOPS, have initiated the development of detailed rules following the Lamfalussy process. Under this process, Directives related to financial institutions are developed on the basis of a four level approach intended to complement the principles of the Directive Level 2 measures will be issued by the European Commission (delegated acts and/or implementing technical standards proposed by EIOPA) and Level 3 guidance will be issued by EIOPA.

Solvency II, if implemented, will effect a full revision of the insurance industry’s solvency framework and prudential regime and will impose group level supervision mechanisms. We are unable to predict precisely how any regulations resulting from such initiatives and proposals could affect our results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.

Formally, each member state of the European Economic Area (“EEA”), including the Netherlands, is currently required to begin implementing Solvency II by October 31, 2012. Discussions are ongoing to postpone the Solvency II implementation date (likely until 2014 or 2015), and a European Parliament vote on this matter is currently expected in the spring of 2012. In case such voting is further delayed and the European Parliament does not approve a postponement of the implementation of Solvency II well in advance of October 31, 2012, the current Solvency II framework may need to be applied effective as of October 31, 2012. Implementation of Solvency II by October 31, 2012 may be further complicated by the fact that Level 2 measures and Level 3 guidance is not expected to be finalized by such date and the fact that it is unlikely that all member states will have their regulatory framework in place at that time. We cannot currently predict how these uncertainties at the EU and national levels, if not resolved in a timely fashion, will impact the insurance industry generally or our business and operations in particular.

Significant efforts towards establishing a more cohesive and streamlined European supervisory framework, including the establishment of the European Systemic Risk Board and a European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority, may also affect the Group’s operations.

EU Insurance Guarantee Scheme

In July 2010, the European Commission released a white paper detailing the need to establish minimum levels of protection for consumers of life and non-life insurance products in the event that insurance companies in the European Union with which they do business were to become insolvent. Though the mechanisms for providing any such protections remain under review by the European Commission, the European Parliament and the member states, the European Commission may currently be considering providing this protection by (i) mandating the creation of (or harmonization of existing) national level insurance guarantee schemes and/or (ii) implementing an EU-wide insurance guarantee scheme, which such scheme(s) may require significant prefunding by insurance companies. The implementation of an insurance guarantee scheme requiring significant levels of prefunding (or, in the event that prefunding is not required, the occurrence of circumstances requiring the commencement of event-driven contributions) may have a material and adverse impact on the liquidity, financial condition and operations of companies engaged in the insurance business, including us.

Dodd-Frank Act

Furthermore, in the United States, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (“Dodd-Frank” or the “Dodd-Frank Act”) has imposed comprehensive changes to the regulation of financial services in the United States and has implications for non-US financial institutions with a US presence, such as ING. Dodd-Frank directs existing and newly-created government agencies and bodies to promulgate regulations implementing the law, a process that is underway and is expected to continue over the next few years. While

 

13


Table of Contents

some studies have already been completed and the rulemaking process has begun, there continues to be significant uncertainty regarding the results of ongoing studies and the ultimate requirements of regulations that have not yet been adopted. We cannot predict with any certainty how Dodd-Frank and such regulations will affect the financial markets generally, impact the Group’s business, credit or financial strength ratings, results of operations, cash flows or financial condition or advise or require the Group to raise additional capital. Key aspects of Dodd-Frank that we have identified to date as possibly having an impact on the Group include:

 

   

The newly established risk regulator — the Financial Stability Oversight Council (the “FSOC”) — may designate the Group as a company whose material financial distress, or whose nature, scope, size, scale, concentration, interconnectedness or mix of activities, could pose a threat to the financial stability of the United States. In such an instance, the Group would become subject to the oversight of the Federal Reserve. If the Group becomes subject to the examination, enforcement and supervisory authority of the Federal Reserve, the Federal Reserve would have authority to impose capital requirements on the Group and its subsidiaries. The Group cannot predict what capital regulations the Federal Reserve will promulgate under these authorizations, either generally or as applicable to organizations with the Group’s operations, nor can management predict how the Federal Reserve will exercise potential general supervisory authority over the Group as to its business practices or those of its subsidiaries. If designated as systemically important by the FSOC, the Group would become subject to unspecified stricter prudential standards, including stricter requirements and limitations relating to risk-based capital, leverage, liquidity and credit exposure, as well as overall risk management requirements, management interlock prohibitions and a requirement to maintain a plan for rapid and orderly dissolution in the event of severe financial distress. The Group may become subject to stress tests to be promulgated by the Federal Reserve in consultation with the newly created Federal Insurance Office (discussed below) to determine whether, on a consolidated basis, the Group has the capital necessary to absorb losses as a result of adverse economic conditions. We cannot predict how the stress tests will be designed or conducted or whether the results thereof will cause the Group to alter its business practices or affect the perceptions of regulators, rating agencies, customers, counterparties or investors about the Group’s financial strength. The FSOC may also recommend that state insurance regulators or other regulators apply new or heightened standards and safeguards for activities or practices that the Group and other insurers or other financial services companies engage in.

 

   

Title II of Dodd-Frank provides that a financial company may be subject to a special orderly liquidation process outside the federal bankruptcy code, administered by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation as receiver, upon a determination that the company is in default or in danger of default and presents a systemic risk to US financial stability. We cannot predict how ratings agencies or creditors of us or our subsidiaries will evaluate this potential risk or whether it will impact our financing or hedging costs

 

   

Title VII Dodd-Frank creates a new framework for regulation of the over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives markets and certain market participants which could affect various activities of the Group and its subsidiaries. New margin and capital requirements on market participants contained in final regulations adopted by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) (and in regulations that may be adopted by the SEC) could substantially increase the cost of hedging and related operations, affect the profitability of our products or their attractiveness to our customers, or cause us to alter our hedging strategy or change the composition of risks we do not hedge

 

   

Dodd-Frank establishes a Federal Insurance Office (“FIO”) within the Department of the Treasury to be headed by a director appointed by the Secretary of the Treasury. While not having a general supervisory or regulatory authority over the business of insurance, the director of this office would perform various functions with respect to insurance (other than health insurance), including participating in the FSOC’s decisions regarding insurers (potentially including the Group and its subsidiaries), to be designated for stricter regulation. The FIO may recommend enhanced regulations to the states.

 

   

Dodd-Frank establishes the Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection (“BCFP”) as an independent agency within the Federal Reserve to regulate consumer financial products and services offered primarily for personal, family or household purposes. The BCFP will have significant authority to implement and enforce federal consumer financial laws, including the new protections established under Dodd-Frank, as well as the authority to identify and prohibit unfair and deceptive acts and practices. In addition, the BCFP will have broad supervisory, examination and enforcement authority over certain consumer products, such as mortgage lending. Insurance products and services are not within the BCFP’s general jurisdiction, and broker-dealers and investment advisers are not subject to the BCFP’s jurisdiction when acting in their registered capacity.

 

14


Table of Contents
   

Dodd—Frank also includes various securities law reforms that may affect the Group’s business practices and the liabilities and/or exposures associated therewith, including a provision intended to authorize the SEC to impose on broker-dealers fiduciary duties to their customers, as applies to investment advisers under existing law, which new standard could potentially expose certain of ING’s US broker-dealers to increased risk of SEC enforcement actions and liability. The SEC staff released a study on this issue.

Although the full impact of Dodd-Frank cannot be determined until the various studies mandated by the law are conducted and implementing regulations are adopted, many of the legislation’s requirements could have profound and/or adverse consequences for the financial services industry, including for us. Dodd-Frank could make it more expensive for us to conduct business, require us to make changes to our business model or satisfy increased capital requirements, subject us to greater regulatory scrutiny or to potential increases in whistleblower claims in light of the increased awards available to whistleblowers under Dodd-Frank and have a material effect on our results of operations or financial condition.

Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act

Under US federal tax legislation passed in 2010, a 30% withholding tax will be imposed on “withholdable payments” made to non-US financial institutions (including non-US investment funds and certain other non-US financial entities) that fail (or that have 50% affiliates which are also non-US financial institutions that fail) to provide certain information regarding their US accountholders and/or certain US investors (such US accountholders and US investors, “US accountholders”) to the US Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”). For non-US financial institutions that fail to comply, this withholding will generally apply without regard to whether the beneficial owner of a withholdable payment is a US person or would otherwise be entitled to an exemption from US federal withholding tax. “Withholdable payments” generally include, among other items, payments of US-source interest and dividends and the gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of property that may produce US-source interest and dividends. The US Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) has issued guidance stating that this withholding tax is expected to take effect on a “phased” schedule, starting in January 2014.

In general, non-publicly traded debt and equity interests in investment vehicles will be treated as “accounts” and subject to these reporting requirements. In addition, the IRS has stated that certain insurance policies and annuities may be considered accounts for these purposes.

The Group closely monitors all present and new legislation that is or will be applicable for its organisation, and is currently investigating all implications of this legislation. While investigating these implications, the Group is and will be in close contact with all of its stakeholders, including its peers and financial industry representative organisations.

The Group intends to take all necessary steps to comply with this legislation (including entering into such agreements with the US tax authorities as may be required), in accordance with the timeframe set by the US tax authorities. However, if the Group cannot enter into such agreements or satisfy the requirements thereunder (including as a result of local laws prohibiting information sharing with the IRS, as a result of contracts or local laws prohibiting withholding on certain payments to accountholders, policyholders, annuitants or other investors, or as a result of the failure of accountholders, policyholders, annuitants or other investors to provide requested information), certain payments to the Group may be subject to US withholding tax under this legislation. The possibility of such withholding tax and the need for accountholders, policyholders, annuitants and investors to provide certain information may adversely affect the sales of certain of the Group’s products. In addition, entering into agreements with the IRS and compliance with the terms of such agreements and with this legislation and any regulations or other guidance promulgated thereunder may substantially increase the Group’s compliance costs. Because regulatory guidance implementing this legislation remains under development, the future impact of this law on the Group is uncertain.

Dutch Intervention Act

In October 2011 the Ministry of Finance submitted a bill to the Dutch Parliament called the “Intervention Act”. The Intervention Act would amend the Dutch Financial Supervision Act and the Dutch Insolvency Act and set out what actions can be taken by Dutch authorities when banks and insurers fail and cannot be wound up under ordinary insolvency rules due to concerns regarding the stability of overall financial system. The proposal provides for two categories of measures. The first category includes measures related to the timely and efficient liquidation of failing banks and insurers and would give the Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank N.V., “DNB”) the power to transfer customer deposits, assets and/or liabilities other than deposits and shares of an entity to third parties or to a bridge bank. The DNB would also be granted the power to influence the internal decision making of failing institutions. The second category includes measures intended to safeguard the stability of the financial system as a whole and grants special powers to the Minister of Finance,

 

15


Table of Contents

including the power to take ownership of failing financial institutions. The Intervention Act also includes proposals to limit the ability of counterparties to exercise their rights after any of the measures mentioned above has been put into place. The Intervention Act has not been approved by the Dutch Parliament as of this writing (and remains subject to change). If approved, the Intervention Act is not expected to enter into force until July 1, 2012 at the earliest. We are unable to predict what effects, if any, the Intervention Act (if passed) may have on the financial system generally, our counterparties, or on us, our operations or our financial position.

The Financial Stability Board

In addition to the adoption of these measures, regulators and lawmakers around the world are actively reviewing the causes of the financial crisis and exploring steps to avoid similar problems in the future. In many respects, this work is being led by the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”), consisting of representatives of national financial authorities of the G20 nations. The G20 and the FSB have issued a series of papers and recommendations intended to produce significant changes in how financial companies, particularly companies that are members of large and complex financial groups, should be regulated. These proposals address such issues as financial group supervision, capital and solvency standards, systemic economic risk, corporate governance including executive compensation, and a host of related issues associated with responses to the financial crisis. The lawmakers and regulatory authorities in a number of jurisdictions in which the Group’s subsidiaries conduct business have already begun introducing legislative and regulatory changes consistent with G20 and FSB recommendations, including proposals governing consolidated regulation of insurance holdings companies by the Financial Services Agency in Japan, proposals governing executive compensation by the financial regulators in the Netherlands (DNB), Germany (BaFIN) and the United Kingdom (FSA).

Additional Governmental Measures

Governments in the Netherlands and abroad have also intervened over the past few years on an unprecedented scale, responding to stresses experienced in the global financial markets. Some of the measures adopted subject us and other institutions for which they were designed to additional restrictions, oversight or costs. For restrictions related to the Core Tier 1 Securities and the IABF, as further described in “Item 4. Information on the Company—Recent Developments” (together, the “Dutch State Transactions”), see “Risks related to the Restructuring Plan —Our agreements with the Dutch State impose certain restrictions regarding the issuance or repurchase of our shares and the compensation of certain senior management positions”. As a result of having received state aid through the Dutch State Transactions, we were required to submit our Restructuring Plan to the EC in connection with obtaining final approval for the Dutch State Transactions. See “Risks related to the Restructuring Plan — The implementation of the Restructuring Plan and the divestments anticipated in connection with that plan will significantly alter the size and structure of the Group and involve significant costs and uncertainties that could materially impact the Group”.

Sections 382 and 383 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code contain tax attribute limitation rules, the general purpose of which is to prevent trafficking in tax losses and credits (i.e. they are anti-abuse rules), but which can apply without regard to whether a “loss trafficking” transaction occurs or is intended. These rules are triggered when an “ownership change” (as specially defined for U.S. federal income tax purposes) occurs. As of December 31, 2011, we believe that our U.S. subsidiaries have not had an “ownership change” for purposes of Sections 382 and 383. However, this determination is subject to uncertainties and is based on various assumptions. Future increases of capital or other changes in ownership may adversely affect our cumulative ownership, and could trigger an “ownership change”, which could limit the ability of our U.S. subsidiaries to use tax attributes, and could correspondingly decrease the value of these attributes.

On September 28, 2011, the European Commission published a proposal for a financial transaction tax that would be levied on transactions in financial instruments by financial institutions if at least one of the parties to the transaction is located in the European Union. If not adopted by the European Union as a whole, such a tax might nonetheless be adopted by one or more European Union member states (as has recently been proposed in the Netherlands and approved in France by the French Parliament on certain financial instruments). As proposed, this tax could require us to pay a tax on transactions in financial instruments with parties (including, with respect to the EU-wide proposal, Group affiliates) located in the European Union. The Ministry of Finance in the Netherlands has put forward a proposal to introduce a banking tax in the Netherlands. That proposal, if approved by the Dutch Parliament, will likely result in increased taxes on ING’s Banking operations, which could negatively impact our operations, financial condition and liquidity. In addition, it is possible that the United States Congress may adopt a form of “financial crisis responsibility” fee and tax on banks and other financial firms to mitigate costs to taxpayers of various government programs established to address the financial crisis and to offset the costs of potential future crises. The Obama Administration’s 2013 revenue proposals include

 

16


Table of Contents

such a fee. Any regulations resulting from these financial transaction tax initiatives and proposals could affect our operational results, financial condition and liquidity, and could negatively impact the costs and scope of our transactions, including transactions with other financial institutions.

Test Achats Decision

On March 1, 2011, the European Court of Justice issued its judgment in the widely-followed Test Achats case. The Test Achats decision, in effect, provides that the use of gender as a factor in the pricing of or benefits under life and non-life insurance coverage is incompatible with the principles of equal treatment of men and women under the EU Charter. The Test Achat decision provides for a transition period, however, until December 21, 2012, after which the use of such gender-based factors will no longer be permissible. It is unclear whether this prohibition also applies to existing insurance contracts. While it is too early to assess the impacts of the Test Achats case on ING’s insurance business, it is expected that the industry generally will incur potentially significant compliance-related costs as policy forms, underwriting and pricing criteria, and related systems undergo required modifications. On December 22, 2011, the European Commission issued

guidelines to assist the insurance industry in implementing unisex pricing by December 21, 2012 (i.e., the end of the transition period specified in the Test Achats decision). ING is unable at this stage to quantify the extent of any such costs or other impacts on its business, and intends to follow closely the implementation of the Test Achats decision and the guidelines published by the European Commission.

Turbulence and volatility in the financial markets have adversely affected us, and may continue to do so.

General

Our results of operations are materially impacted by conditions in the global capital markets and the economy generally. Concerns over the slow economic recovery, the European sovereign debt crisis, unemployment, the availability and cost of credit, the level of U.S. national debt and the U.S. mortgage market, inflation levels, energy costs and geopolitical issues all have contributed to increased volatility and diminished expectations for the economy and the markets in recent years

While certain of such conditions have improved over 2009 and 2010, these conditions have generally resulted in greater volatility, widening of credit spreads and overall shortage of liquidity and tightening of financial markets throughout the world. In addition, prices for many types of asset-backed securities (“ABS”) and other structured products have significantly deteriorated. These concerns have since expanded to include a broad range of fixed income securities, including those rated investment grade and especially the sovereign debt of some EEA countries and the United States, the international credit and interbank money markets generally, and a wide range of financial institutions and markets, asset classes, such as public and private equity, and real estate sectors. As a result of these and other factors, sovereign governments across the globe, including in regions where the Group operates, have also experienced budgetary and other financial difficulties, which have resulted in austerity measures, downgrades in credit rating by credit agencies, planned or implemented bail-out measures and, on occasion, civil unrest (for further details regarding sovereign debt concerns, see “ – U.S. Sovereign Credit Rating” and “ – European Sovereign Debt Crisis” below). As a result, the market for fixed income instruments has experienced decreased liquidity, increased price volatility, credit downgrade events, and increased probability of default. In addition, the confluence of these and other factors has resulted in volatile foreign exchange markets. Securities that are less liquid are more difficult to value and may be hard to dispose of. International equity markets have also been experiencing heightened volatility and turmoil, with issuers, including ourselves, that have exposure to the real estate, mortgage, private equity and credit markets particularly affected. These events and market upheavals, including extreme levels of volatility, have had and may continue to have an adverse effect on our revenues and results of operations, in part because we have a large investment portfolio and extensive real estate activities around the world. In addition, the confidence of customers in financial institutions is being tested. Consumer confidence in financial institutions may, for example, decrease due to our or our competitors’ failure to communicate to customers the terms of, and the benefits to customers of, complex or high-fee financial products. Reduced confidence could have an adverse effect on our revenues and results of operations, including through an increase of lapses or surrenders of policies and withdrawal of deposits. Because a significant percentage of our customer deposit base is originated via Internet banking, a loss of customer confidence may result in a rapid withdrawal of deposits over the Internet.

As a result of the ongoing and unprecedented volatility in the global financial markets since 2007, we have incurred substantial negative revaluations and impairments on our investment portfolio, which have impacted our shareholders’ equity and earnings. During 2009, 2010 and 2011 the revaluation reserve position improved

substantially, positively impacting shareholders’ equity. Although we believe that reserves for insurance liabilities are generally adequate at the Group, inadequacies in certain product areas have developed.

 

17


Table of Contents

The aforementioned impacts have arisen primarily as a result of valuation and impairment issues arising in connection with our investments in real estate (both in and outside the US) and private equity, exposures to European sovereign debt and to US mortgage-related structured investment products, including sub-prime and Alt-A Residential and Commercial Mortgage-Backed Securities (“RMBS” and “CMBS”, respectively), Collateralized Debt Obligations (“CDOs”) and Collateralized Loan Obligations (“CLOs”), monoline insurer guarantees, private equity and other investments. In many cases, the markets for investments and instruments have been and remain highly illiquid, and issues relating to counterparty credit ratings and other factors have exacerbated pricing and valuation uncertainties. Valuation of such investments and instruments is a complex process involving the consideration of market transactions, pricing models, management judgment and other factors, and is also impacted by external factors such as underlying mortgage default rates, interest rates, rating agency actions and property valuations. We continue to monitor our exposures, however there can be no assurances that we will not experience further negative impacts to our shareholders’ equity or profit and loss accounts in future periods.

U.S. Sovereign Credit Rating

After a period of uncertainty as to whether U.S. lawmakers would be able to reach the political consensus needed to raise the federal debt ceiling, and notwithstanding that U.S. lawmakers passed legislation to raise the federal debt ceiling before the U.S. actually defaulted on any of its obligations, on August 5, 2011, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Group, Inc. lowered its long term sovereign credit rating on the United States of America from AAA to AA+. Although other ratings agencies have not similarly lowered the long term sovereign credit rating of the United States of America, they have put that credit rating on review. There continues to be a perceived risk of a future sovereign credit ratings downgrade of the U.S. government, including the rating of U.S. Treasury securities. It is foreseeable that the ratings and perceived creditworthiness of instruments issued, insured or guaranteed by institutions, agencies or instrumentalities directly linked to the U.S. government could also be correspondingly affected by any such downgrade. Instruments of this nature are key assets on the balance sheets of financial institutions and are widely used as collateral by financial institutions to meet their day-to-day cash flows in the short-term debt market. A downgrade of the sovereign credit ratings of the U.S. government and the perceived creditworthiness of U.S. government-related obligations could impact our ability to obtain funding that is collateralized by affected instruments, as well as affecting the pricing of that funding when it is available. A downgrade may also adversely affect the market value of such instruments. We cannot predict if, when or how any changes to the credit ratings or perceived creditworthiness of these organizations will affect economic conditions. Such ratings actions could result in a significant adverse impact to the Group.

European Sovereign Debt Crisis

In 2010, a financial crisis emerged in Europe, triggered by high budget deficits and rising direct and contingent sovereign debt in Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain, which created concerns about the ability of these EU “peripheral” states to continue to service their sovereign debt obligations. These concerns impacted financial markets and resulted in high and volatile bond yields on the sovereign debt of many EU nations. Despite assistance packages to Greece, Ireland and Portugal, the creation of a joint EU-IMF European Financial Stability Facility in May 2010, and announced plans in the summer of 2011 to expand financial assistance to Greece, uncertainty over the outcome of the EU governments’ financial support programs and worries about sovereign finances persisted and, notwithstanding increased purchases of sovereign bonds by the European Central Bank and measures taken by other central banks to enhance global liquidity, ultimately spread from “peripheral” to “core” European Union member states in the fall of 2011. Market concerns over the direct and indirect exposure of European banks and insurers to the EU sovereign debt further resulted in a widening of credit spreads and increased costs of funding for some European financial institutions. In December, 2011, European leaders agreed to implement steps (and continue to meet regularly to review, amend and supplement such steps) to encourage greater long term fiscal responsibility on the part of the individual member states and bolster market confidence in the Euro and European sovereign debt; however, such proposed steps are subject to final agreement (and in some cases, ratification and/or other approvals) by the European Union member states that are party to such arrangements and thus the implementation of such steps in their currently-contemplated form remains uncertain, and even if such steps are implemented, there is no guarantee that they will ultimately and finally resolve uncertainties regarding the ability of Eurozone states to continue to service their sovereign debt obligations. Further, even if such long term structural adjustments are ultimately implemented, the future of the Euro in its current form, and with its current membership, remains uncertain.

 

18


Table of Contents

Risks and ongoing concerns about the debt crisis in Europe, as well as the possible default by, or exit from the Eurozone of one or more European states and/or the replacement of the Euro by one or more successor currencies, could have a detrimental impact on the global economic recovery, sovereign and non-sovereign debt in these European countries and the financial condition of European and other financial institutions, including us. In the event of any default or similar event with respect to a sovereign issuer, some financial institutions may suffer significant losses for which they would require additional capital, which may not be available. Market and economic disruptions stemming from the crisis in Europe have affected, and may continue to affect, consumer confidence levels and spending, bankruptcy rates, levels of incurrence of and default on consumer debt and home prices, among other factors. There can be no assurance that the market disruptions in Europe, including the increased cost of funding for certain government and financial institutions, will not spread, nor can there be any assurance that future assistance packages will be available or, even if provided, will be sufficient to stabilize the affected countries and markets in Europe or elsewhere. To the extent uncertainty regarding the economic recovery continues to negatively impact consumer confidence and consumer credit factors, our business and results of operations could be significantly and adversely impacted. In addition, the possible exit from the Eurozone of one or more European states and/or the replacement of the Euro by one or more successor currencies could create significant uncertainties regarding the enforceability and valuation of Euro denominated contracts to which we (or our counterparties) are a party and thereby materially and adversely affect our and/or our counterparties’ liquidity, financial condition and operations. Such uncertainties may include the risk that (i) an obligation that was expected to be paid in Euros is redenominated into a new currency (which may not be easily converted into other currencies without significant cost), (ii) currencies in some European Union member states may devalue relative to others, (iii) former Eurozone member states may impose capital controls that would make it complicated or illegal to move capital out of such countries, and/or (iv) some courts (in particular, courts in countries that have left the Eurozone) may not recognize and/or enforce claims denominated in Euros (and/or in any replacement currency). The possible exit from the Eurozone of one or more European states and/or the replacement of the Euro by one or more successor currencies could also cause other significant market dislocations and lead to other adverse economic and operational impacts that are inherently difficult to predict or evaluate, and otherwise have potentially materially adverse impacts on us and our counterparties, including our depositors, lenders, borrowers and other customers.

During the week of December 5, 2011, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Group, Inc., citing ongoing political and economic uncertainties related to the European sovereign debt crisis, placed the credit ratings of the European Union, its member states included in the Eurozone (other than Cyprus and Greece) and several European banks on “credit watch negative”, indicating that Standard & Poor’s Ratings Group, Inc. might reduce the credit ratings of one or more such entities in the near term. On January 13, 2012, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Group, Inc. proceeded to downgrade the credit ratings of France, Austria, Italy, Spain, Portugal and a handful of other EEA states (while reaffirming the credit ratings of Germany, the Netherlands, Ireland and other EEA states). Further related downgrades of European sovereign ratings and of corporate ratings have occurred since that date, including the downgrade of Greece’s sovereign credit rating to “selective default’ by Standard & Poor’s Ratings Group, Inc. on February 27, 2012 as a result of a debt restructuring that is expected to impose significant losses on private creditors (including ING). These announcements, as well as any further future downgrades, could negatively affect borrowing costs of the affected entities, increase overall economic volatility, and affect the operation of our businesses.

Because we operate in highly competitive markets, including our home market, we may not be able to increase or maintain our market share, which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

There is substantial competition in the Netherlands and the other countries in which we do business for the types of insurance, commercial banking, investment banking, asset management and other products and services we provide. Customer loyalty and retention can be influenced by a number of factors, including relative service levels, the prices and attributes of products and services, and actions taken by competitors. If we are not able to match or compete with the products and services offered by our competitors, it could adversely impact our ability to maintain or further increase our market share, which would adversely affect our results of operations. Such competition is most pronounced in our more mature markets of the Netherlands, Belgium, the Rest of Western Europe, the United States, Canada and Australia. In recent years, however, competition in emerging markets, such as Latin America, Asia and Central and Eastern Europe, has also increased as large financial services companies from more developed countries have sought to establish themselves in markets which are perceived to offer higher growth potential, and as local institutions have become more sophisticated and competitive and have sought alliances, mergers or strategic relationships with our competitors. The Netherlands and the United States are our largest markets for both our banking and insurance operations. Our main competitors in the banking sector in the Netherlands are ABN AMRO Bank and Rabobank. Our main competitors in the insurance sector in the Netherlands are Achmea, ASR, Delta Lloyd and Aegon. Our main competitors in the United States are insurance companies such as Lincoln National, Hartford,

 

19


Table of Contents

Aegon Americas, AXA, Met Life, Prudential, Nationwide and Principal Financial. Competition could also increase due to new entrants in the markets that may have new operating models that are not burdened by potentially costly legacy operations. Increasing competition in these or any of our other markets may significantly impact our results if we are unable to match the products and services offered by our competitors. Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become more concentrated, as institutions involved in a broad range of financial services have been acquired by or merged into other firms or have declared bankruptcy. These developments could result in our competitors gaining greater access to capital and liquidity, expanding their ranges of products and services, or gaining geographic diversity. We may experience pricing pressures as a result of these factors in the event that some of our competitors seek to increase market share by reducing prices. In addition, under the Restructuring Plan we were required to agree to certain restrictions imposed by the EC, including with respect to our price leadership in EU banking markets and our ability to make acquisitions of financial institutions and other businesses. See “ Risks related to the Restructuring Plan — The limitations required by the EC on our ability to compete and to make acquisitions or call certain debt instruments could materially impact the Group”.

Because we do business with many counterparties, the inability of these counterparties to meet their financial obligations could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

General

Third-parties that owe us money, securities or other assets may not pay or perform under their obligations. These parties include the issuers and guarantors (including sovereigns) of securities we hold, borrowers under loans originated, customers, trading counterparties, counterparties under swaps, credit default and other derivative contracts, clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses and other financial intermediaries. Severe distress or defaults by one or more of these parties on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, lack of liquidity, downturns in the economy or real estate values, operational failure, etc., or even rumours about potential severe distress or defaults by one or more of these parties or regarding the financial services industry generally, could lead to losses for us, and defaults by other institutions. In light of experiences with significant constraints on liquidity and high cost of funds in the interbank lending market, and given the high level of interdependence between financial institutions, we are and will continue to be subject to the risk of deterioration of the commercial and financial soundness, or perceived soundness, of sovereigns and other financial services institutions. This is particularly relevant to our franchise as an important and large counterparty in equity, fixed-income and foreign exchange markets, including related derivatives, which exposes it to concentration risk.

We routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, mutual and hedge funds, insurance companies and other institutional clients, resulting in large daily settlement amounts and significant credit exposure. As a result, we face concentration risk with respect to specific counterparties and customers. We are exposed to increased counterparty risk as a result of recent financial institution failures and weakness and will continue to be exposed to the risk of loss if counterparty financial institutions fail or are otherwise unable to meet their obligations. A default by, or even concerns about the creditworthiness of, one or more financial services institutions could therefore lead to further significant systemic liquidity problems, or losses or defaults by other financial institutions.

With respect to secured transactions, our credit risk may be exacerbated when the collateral held by us cannot be realized, or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or derivative exposure due us. We also have exposure to a number of financial institutions in the form of unsecured debt instruments, derivative transactions and equity investments. For example, we hold certain hybrid regulatory capital instruments issued by financial institutions which permit the issuer to defer coupon payments on the occurrence of certain events or at their option. The EC has indicated that, in certain circumstances, it may require these financial institutions to defer payment. If this were to happen, we expect that such instruments may experience ratings downgrades and/or a drop in value and we may have to treat them as impaired, which could result in significant losses. There is no assurance that losses on, or impairments to the carrying value of, these assets would not materially and adversely affect our business or results of operations.

In addition, we are subject to the risk that our rights against third parties may not be enforceable in all circumstances. The deterioration or perceived deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or obligations we hold could result in losses and/or adversely affect our ability to rehypothecate or otherwise use those securities or obligations for liquidity purposes. A significant downgrade in the credit ratings of our counterparties could also have a negative impact on our income and risk weighting, leading to increased capital requirements. While in many cases we are permitted to require additional collateral from counterparties that experience financial difficulty, disputes may arise as to the amount of collateral we are entitled to receive and the value of pledged assets. Our credit risk may also be exacerbated when the collateral we hold cannot

 

20


Table of Contents

be realized or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or derivative exposure that is due to us, which is most likely to occur during periods of illiquidity and depressed asset valuations, such as those currently experienced. The termination of contracts and the foreclosure on collateral may subject us to claims for the improper exercise of our rights under such contracts. Bankruptcies, downgrades and disputes with counterparties as to the valuation of collateral tend to increase in times of market stress and illiquidity.

Any of these developments or losses could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, liquidity and/or prospects.

Reinsurers

Our insurance operations have bought protection for risks that exceed certain risk tolerance levels set for both our life and non-life businesses. This protection is bought through reinsurance arrangements in order to reduce possible losses. Because in most cases we must pay the policyholders first, and then collect from the reinsurer, we are subject to credit risk with respect to each reinsurer for all such amounts. As a percentage of our net reinsurance exposure as of December 31, 2011, the greatest exposure after collateral to an individual external reinsurer was approximately 21%, approximately 47% related to four other external reinsurers and the remainder of the reinsurance exposure related to various other reinsurers. The inability or unwillingness of any one of these reinsurers to meet its financial obligations to us, or the insolvency of our reinsurers, could have a material adverse effect on our net results and our financial results.

Market conditions observed over the last year may increase the risk of loans being impaired. We are exposed to declining property values on the collateral supporting residential and commercial real estate lending.

We are exposed to the risk that our borrowers (including sovereigns) may not repay their loans according to their contractual terms and that the collateral securing the payment of these loans may be insufficient. We may continue to see adverse changes in the credit quality of our borrowers and counterparties, for example as a result of their inability to refinance their indebtedness, with increasing delinquencies, defaults and insolvencies across a range of sectors. This may lead to impairment charges on loans and other assets, higher costs and additions to loan loss provisions. A significant increase in the size of our provision for loan losses could have a material adverse effect on our financial position and results of operations.

Economic and other factors could lead to further contraction in the residential mortgage and commercial lending market and to further decreases in residential and commercial property prices which could generate substantial increases in impairment losses.

Interest rate volatility and other interest rate changes may adversely affect our profitability.

Changes in prevailing

interest rates may negatively affect our business including the level of net interest revenue we earn, and for our banking business the levels of deposits and the demand for loans. In a period of changing interest rates, interest expense may increase at different rates than the interest earned on assets. Accordingly, changes in interest rates could decrease net interest revenue. Changes in the interest rates may negatively affect the value of our assets and our ability to realize gains or avoid losses from the sale of those assets, all of which also ultimately affect earnings.

Declining interest rates may result in:

 

   

life insurance and annuity products being relatively more attractive to consumers due to minimum guarantees with respect to such products that are frequently mandated by regulators

 

   

increased premium payments on products with flexible premium features

 

   

a higher percentage of insurance and annuity contracts remaining in force from year-to-year, potentially resulting in greater claims costs than we expected and creating asset liability duration mismatches

 

   

addition to provisions for guarantees included in life insurance and annuity contracts, as the guarantees become more valuable to policy holders

 

   

lower investment earnings because the interest earnings on our fixed income investments will likely have declined in parallel with market interest rates on our assets recorded at fair value

 

   

reserve strengthening by affecting the results of our reserve adequacy testing

 

   

higher prepayment or redemption of mortgages and fixed maturity securities in our investment portfolios as borrowers seek to borrow at lower interest rates. Consequently, we may be required to reinvest the proceeds in securities bearing lower interest rates

 

   

lower profitability as the result of a decrease in the spread between interest rates charged to policyholders and returns on our investment portfolios.

 

   

lower profitability since we may not be able to fully track the decline in interest rates in our savings rate.

 

21


Table of Contents

In addition, certain statutory capital and reserve requirements are based on formulas and models that consider interest rates, and an extended period of low interest rates may increase the statutory capital we are required to hold and the amount of assets we must maintain to support statutory reserves.

Rapidly increasing interest rates may result in:

 

   

decrease the demand for loans

 

   

increase in policy loans, and withdrawals and surrenders of life insurance policies and fixed annuity contracts as policyholders choose to forego insurance protection and seek higher investment returns. Obtaining cash to satisfy these obligations may require us to liquidate fixed maturity investments at a time when market prices for those assets are depressed because of increases in interest rates. This may result in realized investment losses. Regardless of whether we realize an investment loss, these cash payments would result in a decrease in total invested assets, and may decrease our net income. Premature withdrawals may also cause us to accelerate amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs, which would also reduce our net income.

 

   

prepayment losses if prepayment rates are lower than expected or if interest rates increase to rapidly to adjust the accompanying hedges.

We may incur losses due to failures of banks falling under the scope of state compensation schemes.

In the Netherlands and other jurisdictions deposit guarantee schemes and similar funds (“Compensation Schemes”) have been implemented from which compensation may become payable to customers of financial services firms in the event the financial service firm is unable to pay, or unlikely to pay, claims against it. In many jurisdictions in which we operate, these Compensation Schemes are funded, directly or indirectly, by financial services firms which operate and/or are licensed in the relevant jurisdiction. As a result of the increased number of bank failures, in particular since the fall of 2008, we expect that levies in the industry will continue to rise as a result of the Compensation Schemes. In particular, we are a participant in the Dutch Deposit Guarantee Scheme, which guarantees an amount of EUR 100,000 per person per bank (regardless of the number of accounts held). The costs involved with making compensation payments under the Dutch Deposit Guarantee Scheme are allocated among the participating banks by the Dutch Central Bank, De Nederlandsche Bank N.V. (“DNB”), based on an allocation key related to their market shares with respect to the deposits protected by the Dutch Deposit Guarantee Schemes. Given our size we may incur significant compensation payments to be made under the Dutch Deposit Guarantee Scheme, which we may be unable to recover from the bankrupt estate. The ultimate costs to the industry of payments which may become due under the Compensation Schemes, remains uncertain although they may be significant and these and the associated costs to us may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. Going forward the Dutch Deposit Guarantee Scheme will change from an ex-post scheme, where we contribute after the failure of a firm, to an ex-ante scheme where we pay yearly contributions to ensure the scheme holds a target level of fund regardless of whether any failures occur. The costs associated with potential future yearly contributions are today unknown, but given our size may be significant.

Risks Related to the Group’s Business, Operations, and Regulatory Environment

We may be unable to manage our risks successfully through derivatives.

We employ various economic hedging strategies with the objective of mitigating the market risks that are inherent in our business and operations. These risks include currency fluctuations, changes in the fair value of our investments, the impact of interest rate, equity markets and credit spread changes and changes in mortality and longevity. We seek to control these risks by, among other things, entering into a number of derivative instruments, such as swaps, options, futures and forward contracts including from time to time macro hedges for parts of our business, either directly as a counterparty or as a credit support provider to affiliate counterparties.

Developing an effective strategy for dealing with these risks is complex, and no strategy can completely insulate us from risks associated with those fluctuations. Our hedging strategies also rely on assumptions and projections regarding our assets, liabilities, general market factors and the credit worthiness of our counterparties that may prove to be incorrect or prove to be inadequate. Accordingly, our hedging activities may not have the desired beneficial impact on our results of operations or financial condition. Poorly designed strategies or improperly executed transactions could actually increase our risks and losses. Hedging strategies involve transaction costs and other costs, and if we terminate a hedging arrangement, we may also be required to pay additional costs, such as transaction fees or breakage costs. There have been periods in the past, and it is likely that there will be periods in the future, during which we have incurred or may incur losses on

 

22


Table of Contents

transactions, perhaps significant, after taking into account our hedging strategies. Further, the nature and timing of our hedging transactions could actually increase our risk and losses. In addition, hedging strategies involve transaction costs and other costs. Our hedging strategies and the derivatives that we use and may use may not adequately mitigate or offset the risk of interest rate volatility, and our hedging transactions may result in losses.

Our hedging strategy additionally relies on the assumption that hedging counterparties remain able and willing to provide the hedges required by our strategy. Increased regulation, market shocks, worsening market conditions (whether due to the ongoing Euro crisis or otherwise), and/or other factors that affect or are perceived to affect the financial condition, liquidity and creditworthiness of ING may reduce the ability and/or willingness of such counterparties to engage in hedging contracts with us and/or other parties, affecting our overall ability to hedge our risks and adversely affecting our business, operations, financial condition and liquidity.

ING Group may be unable to retain key personnel.

As a financial services enterprise with a decentralised management structure, ING Group relies to a considerable extent on the quality of local management in the various countries in which ING Group operates. The success of ING Group’s operations is dependent, among other things, on ING Group’s ability to attract and retain highly qualified professional personnel. Competition for key personnel in most countries in which ING Group operates is intense. ING Group’s ability to attract and retain key personnel, in particular senior officers, experienced portfolio managers, mutual fund managers and sales executives, is dependent on a number of factors, including prevailing market conditions and compensation packages offered by companies competing for the same talent.

As a part of the responses of the European Commission and governments throughout Europe to the financial crisis in 2008, there have been various legislative initiatives, including those set out in Directive 2010/76/EU (CRD III), the Guidelines on Remuneration Policies and Practices published by (the predecessor of) the European Banking Authority (EBA) and the Regulation of the Dutch Central Bank on Sound Remuneration Policies (Regeling beheerst beloningsbeleid Wft 2011) and the Dutch legislative proposal to prohibit the payment of variable remuneration to board members and day-to-day policy makers of financial institutions that receive state aid in the future, to ensure that financial institutions’ remuneration policies and practices are consistent with and promote sound and effective risk management, and that impose restrictions on the remuneration of personnel, in particular senior management, with a focus on risk alignment of performance-related remuneration. These restrictions have had and will have an impact on existing ING Group’s remuneration policies and individual remuneration packages of personnel.

These restrictions, alone or in combination with the other factors described above, could adversely affect ING Group’s ability to retain or attract qualified employees.

Because we use assumptions about factors, the use of different assumptions about these factors may have an adverse impact on our results of operations.

The establishment of insurance provisions, including the impact of minimum guarantees which are contained within certain variable annuity products, the adequacy test performed on the provisions for life policies and the establishment of Deferred Acquisition Costs (DAC) and Value of Business Acquired (VOBA) are inherently uncertain processes involving assumptions about factors such as court decisions, changes in laws, social, economic and demographic trends, inflation, investment returns, policyholder behaviour (e.g., lapses, persistency, etc.) and other factors, and, in the life insurance business, assumptions concerning mortality, longevity and morbidity trends. The use of different assumptions about these factors could have a material effect on insurance provisions and underwriting expense. Changes in assumptions may lead to changes in the insurance provisions over time. Furthermore, some of these assumptions can be volatile.

Because we use assumptions to model client behaviour for the purpose of our market risk calculations, the difference between the realization and the assumptions may have an adverse impact on the risk figures and future results.

We use assumptions in order to model client behaviour for the risk calculations in our banking and insurance books. Assumptions are used to determine insurance liabilities, the price sensitivity of savings and current accounts and to estimate the embedded optional risk in the mortgage and investment portfolios. The realization or use of different assumptions to determine the client behaviour could have material adverse effect on the calculated risk figures and ultimately future results.

 

23


Table of Contents

ING Insurance has a significant exposure to the take up of policy options by policyholders. The exposure is greatest for variable annuity business with guarantees deeply in-the-money, policyholder behaviour is difficult to predict and small changes in the proportion of policyholders taking up an option can have a significant financial impact. Furthermore, assumptions about policyholder behaviour are sometimes made for new insurance business without a substantial amount of experiential data. These assumptions may prove imperfect, which can have a material impact on results. See- “Because we use assumptions about factors, the use of different assumptions about these factors may have an adverse impact on our results of operations” –for a discussion of US variable annuity-related charges taken in the fourth quarter of 2011

We may incur further liabilities in respect of our defined benefit retirement plans if the value of plan assets is not sufficient to cover potential obligations, including as a result of differences between results and underlying actuarial assumptions and models.

ING Group companies operate various defined benefit retirement plans covering a significant number of our employees. The liability recognized in our consolidated balance sheet in respect of our defined benefit plans is the present value of the defined benefit obligations at the balance sheet date, less the fair value of each plan’s assets, together with adjustments for unrecognized actuarial gains and losses and unrecognized past service costs. We determine our defined benefit plan obligations based on internal and external actuarial models and calculations using the projected unit credit method. Inherent in these actuarial models are assumptions including discount rates, rates of increase in future salary and benefit levels, mortality rates, trend rates in health care costs, consumer price index, and the expected return on plan assets. These assumptions are based on available market data and the historical performance of plan assets, and are updated annually. Nevertheless, the actuarial assumptions may differ significantly from actual results due to changes in market conditions, economic and mortality trends and other assumptions. Any changes in these assumptions could have a significant impact on our present and future liabilities to and costs associated with our defined benefit retirement plans.

Our risk management policies and guidelines may prove inadequate for the risks we face.

The methods we use to manage, estimate and measure risk are partly based on historic market behaviour. The methods may, therefore, prove to be inadequate for predicting future risk exposure, which may be significantly greater than what is suggested by historic experience. For instance, these methods may not predict the losses seen in the stressed conditions in recent periods, and may also not adequately allow prediction of circumstances arising due to the government interventions and stimulus packages, which increase the difficulty of evaluating risks. Other methods for risk management are based on evaluation of information regarding markets, customers or other information that is publicly known or otherwise available to us. Such information may not always be correct, updated or correctly evaluated.

We are subject to a variety of regulatory risks as a result of our operations in certain countries.

In certain countries in which we operate, judiciary and dispute resolution systems may be less developed. As a result in case of a breach of contract we may have difficulties in making and enforcing claims against contractual counterparties and, if claims are made against us, we might encounter difficulties in mounting a defence against such allegations. If we become party to legal proceedings in a market with an insufficiently developed judiciary system, it could have an adverse effect on our operations and net result.

In addition, as a result of our operations in certain countries, we are subject to risks of possible nationalization, expropriation, price controls, exchange controls and other restrictive government actions, as well as the outbreak of hostilities, in these markets. In addition, the current economic environment in certain of these countries in which we operate may increase the likelihood for regulatory initiatives to enhance consumer protection or to protect homeowners from foreclosures. Any such regulatory initiative could have an adverse impact on our ability to protect our economic interest in the event of defaults on residential mortgages.

Because we are continually developing new financial products, we might be faced with claims that could have an adverse effect on our operations and net result if clients’ expectations are not met.

When new financial products are brought to the market, communication and marketing aims to present a balanced view of the product (however there is a focus on potential advantages for the customers). Whilst we engage in a due diligence process when we develop products, if the products do not generate the expected profit, or result in a loss, or otherwise do not meet expectations, customers may file mis-selling claims against us. Mis-selling claims are claims from customers who allege that they have received misleading advice or other information from either ING internal or external advisors (even though ING does not always have full control over the external advisors). Complaints may also arise if customers feel that they have not been treated

 

24


Table of Contents

reasonably or fairly, or that the duty of care has not been complied with. While a considerable amount of time and money has been invested in reviewing and assessing historic sales practices, and in the maintenance of risk management, legal and compliance procedures to monitor current sales practices, there can be no assurance that all of the issues associated with current and historic sales practices have been or will be identified, nor that any issues already identified will not be more widespread than presently estimated. The negative publicity associated with any sales practices, any compensation payable in respect of any such issues and/or regulatory changes resulting from such issues could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, operations and net result.

Customer protection regulations as well as changes in interpretation and perception by both the public at large and governmental authorities of acceptable market practices might influence client expectations.

Ratings are important to our business for a number of reasons. Downgrades could have an adverse impact on our operations and net results.

We have credit ratings from Standard & Poor’s Ratings Service, Moody’s Investor Service and Fitch Ratings. Each of the rating agencies reviews its ratings and rating methodologies on a recurring basis and may decide on a downgrade at any time. In the event of a downgrade the cost of issuing debt will increase, having an adverse effect on net results. Certain institutional investors may also be obliged to withdraw their deposits from ING following a downgrade, which could have an adverse effect on our liquidity.

Claims paying ability, at the Group or subsidiary level, and financial strength ratings are factors in establishing the competitive position of insurers. A rating downgrade could elevate lapses or surrenders of policies requiring cash payments, which might force us to sell assets at a price that may result in realized investment losses. Among others, total invested assets decreases and deferred acquisition costs might need to be accelerated, adversely impacting earnings. A downgrade may adversely impact relationships with distributors of our products and services and customers, which may affect new sales and our competitive position.

Furthermore, ING Bank’s assets are risk weighted. Downgrades of these assets could result in a higher risk weighting which may result in higher capital requirements. This may impact net earnings and the return on capital, and may have an adverse impact on our competitive position. For ING’s insurance businesses in a number of jurisdictions, such as the US and the EU, downgrades of assets will similarly affect the capital requirements for ING Insurance in those jurisdictions.

Our business may be negatively affected by a sustained increase in inflation.

A sustained increase in the inflation rate in our principal markets would have multiple impacts on us and may negatively affect our business, solvency position and results of operations. For example, a sustained increase in the inflation rate may result in an increase in market interest rates which may

(1) decrease the estimated fair value of certain fixed income securities we hold in our investment portfolios resulting in

 

   

reduced levels of unrealized capital gains available to us which could negatively impact our solvency position and net income,

 

   

a decrease of collateral values,

(2) result in increased surrenders of certain life & savings products, particularly, those with fixed rates below market rates,

(3) require us, as an issuer of securities, to pay higher interest rates on debt securities we issue in the financial markets from time to time to finance our operations which would increase our interest expenses and reduce our results of operations, and/or

(4) result in decreased fee income associated with a decline in the variable annuity balances invested in fixed income funds.

A significant and sustained increase in inflation has historically also been associated with decreased prices for equity securities and sluggish performance of equity markets generally. A sustained decline in equity markets may

(1) result in impairment charges to equity securities that we hold in our investment portfolios and reduced levels of unrealized capital gains available to us which would reduce our net income and negatively impact our solvency position

(2) negatively impact performance, future sales and surrenders of certain products where underlying investments are often allocated to equity funds, and/or

(3) negatively impact the ability of our asset management subsidiaries to retain and attract assets under management, as well as the value of assets they do manage, which may negatively impact their results of operations, and/or

(4) result in decreased fee income associated with a decline in the variable annuity balances invested in fixed income funds.

 

25


Table of Contents

In addition, in the context of certain property & casualty risks underwritten by our insurance subsidiaries (particularly “long-tail” risks), a sustained increase in inflation with a resulting increase in market interest rates may result in (1) claims inflation (i.e., an increase in the amount ultimately paid to settle claims several years after the policy coverage period or event giving rise to the claim), coupled with (2) an underestimation of corresponding claims reserves at the time of establishment due to a failure to fully anticipate increased inflation and its effect on the amounts ultimately payable to policyholders, and, consequently, (3) actual claims payments significantly exceeding associated insurance reserves which would negatively impact our results of operations. In addition, a failure to accurately anticipate higher inflation and factor it into our product pricing assumptions may result in a systemic mispricing of our products resulting in underwriting losses which would negatively impact our results of operations.

Operational risks are inherent in our business.

Our businesses depend on the ability to process a large number of transactions efficiently and accurately. Losses can result from inadequate trained or skilled personnel, IT failures, inadequate or failed internal control processes and systems, regulatory breaches, human errors, employee misconduct including fraud, or from external events that interrupt normal business operations. We depend on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. The equipment and software used in our computer systems and networks may be at or near the end of their useful lives or may not be capable of processing, storing or transmitting information as expected. Certain of our computer systems and networks may also have insufficient recovery capabilities in the event of a malfunction or loss of data. In addition, such systems and networks may be vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses or other malicious code and other external attacks or internal breaches that could have a security impact and jeopardize our confidential information or that of our clients or our counterparts. These events can potentially result in financial loss, harm to our reputation and hinder our operational effectiveness. We also face the risk that the design and operating effectiveness of our controls and procedures prove to be inadequate or are circumvented. Furthermore, widespread outbreaks of communicable diseases, such as the outbreak of the H1N1 influenza virus, may impact the health of our employees, increasing absenteeism, or may cause a significant increase in the utilization of health benefits offered to our employees, either or both of which could adversely impact our business. Unforeseeable and/or catastrophic events can lead to an abrupt interruption of activities, and our operations may be subject to losses resulting from such disruptions. Losses can result from destruction or impairment of property, financial assets, trading positions, the payment of insurance and pension benefits to employees and the loss of key personnel. If our business continuity plans are not able to be implemented or do not take such events into account, losses may increase further.

We have suffered losses from operational risk in the past and there can be no assurance that we will not suffer material losses from operational risk in the future.

Reinsurance may not be available, affordable or adequate to protect us against losses. We may also decide to reduce, eliminate or decline primary insurance or reinsurance coverage.

As part of our overall risk and capacity management strategy we purchase reinsurance for certain risks underwritten by our various insurance business segments. Market conditions beyond our control determine the availability and cost of the reinsurance protection we purchase. Accordingly, we may be forced to incur additional expenses for reinsurance or may not be able to obtain sufficient reinsurance on acceptable terms, which could adversely affect our ability to write future business.

In addition, we determine the appropriate level of primary insurance and reinsurance coverage based on a number of factors and from time to time decide to reduce, eliminate or decline coverage based on our assessment of the costs and benefits involved. In such cases, the uninsured risk remains with us.

Our business may be negatively affected by adverse publicity, regulatory actions or litigation with respect to us, other well-known companies or the financial services industry in general.

Adverse publicity and damage to our reputation arising from our failure or perceived failure to comply with legal and regulatory requirements, financial reporting irregularities involving other large and well known companies, increasing regulatory and law enforcement scrutiny of “know your customer” anti-money laundering, prohibited transactions with countries subject to sanctions, and bribery or other anti-corruption measures and anti-terrorist-financing procedures and their effectiveness, regulatory investigations of the mutual fund, banking and insurance industries, and litigation that arises from the failure or perceived failure by us to comply with legal, regulatory and compliance requirements, could result in adverse publicity and reputation harm, lead to increased regulatory supervision, affect our ability to attract and retain customers, maintain access to the capital markets, result in cease and desist orders, suits, enforcement actions, fines and civil and criminal penalties, other disciplinary action or have other material adverse effects on us in ways that are not predictable.

 

26


Table of Contents

Risks related to the Restructuring Plan

The implementation of the Restructuring Plan and the divestments anticipated in connection with that plan will significantly alter the size and structure of the Group and involve significant costs and uncertainties that could materially impact the Group.

In November 2008 the Dutch State purchased the Core Tier 1 Securities, and in the first quarter of 2009 we entered into the Illiquid Asset Back-up Facility (IABF) with the Dutch State. As a result of having received state aid through the Dutch State Transactions, we were required to submit a restructuring plan (the “Restructuring Plan”) to the EC in connection with obtaining final approval for the Dutch State Transactions under the EC state aid rules. On October 26, 2009, we announced our Restructuring Plan, pursuant to which we are required to divest by the end of 2013 all of our insurance business, including the investment management business, as well as ING Direct US, which operates our direct banking business in the United States, and certain portions of our retail banking business in the Netherlands. The EC’s approval of the Restructuring Plan was issued on November 18, 2009. On January 28, 2010 ING lodged an appeal with the General Court of the European Union (the “General Court”) against specific elements of the EC’s decision regarding the Restructuring Plan. On March 2, 2012, the Court partially annulled the Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009 and as a result a new decision must be issued by the Commission. Interested parties can file an appeal against the General Court’s judgment before the Court of Justice of the European Union within two months and ten days after the date of the General Court’s judgment.

In connection with the Restructuring Plan, we were required to agree to not be a price leader in certain EU markets with respect to certain retail, private and direct banking products and to refrain from (i) acquisitions of financial institutions and (ii) acquisitions of other businesses if this would delay our repayment of the remaining Core Tier 1 Securities. Those limitations may last until at least November 18, 2012 and could adversely affect our ability to maintain or grow market share in key markets as well as our results of operations. See “Risks Related to the Group — The limitations required by the EC on our ability to compete and to make acquisitions or call certain debt instruments could materially impact the Group”.

There can be no assurance that we will be able to implement the Restructuring Plan successfully or complete the announced divestments on favorable terms or at all, particularly in light of both the plan’s 2013 deadline and expected challenging market conditions in which other financial institutions may place similar assets for sale during the same time period and may seek to dispose of assets in the same manner. Any failure to successfully implement the Restructuring Plan may result in EC enforcement actions and may have a material adverse impact on the assets, profitability, capital adequacy and business operations of the Group. Moreover, in connection with the implementation of the Restructuring Plan, including any proposed divestments, we or potential buyers may need to obtain various approvals, including of shareholders, works councils and regulatory and competition authorities, and we and potential buyers may face difficulties in obtaining these approvals in a timely manner or at all. In addition, the implementation of the Restructuring Plan may strain relations with our employees, and specific proposals in connection with the implementation may be opposed by labor unions or works councils. Furthermore, following the announcement of the Restructuring Plan, several of our subsidiaries have been downgraded or put on credit watch by rating agencies. See “Risks Related to the Group — Ratings are important to our business for a number of reasons. Downgrades could have an adverse impact on our operations and net results”.

Other factors that may impede our ability to implement the Restructuring Plan successfully include an inability of prospective purchasers to obtain funding due to the deterioration of the credit markets, insufficient access to equity capital markets, a general unwillingness of prospective purchasers to commit capital in the current market environment, antitrust concerns, any adverse changes in market interest rates or other borrowing costs and any declines in the value of the assets to be divested. Similarly, it may also be difficult to divest all or part of our insurance or investment management business through one or more initial public offerings. There can also be no assurance that we could obtain favorable pricing for a sale of all or part of our insurance or investment management business in the public markets or succeed in turning the relevant subsidiaries into viable stand-alone businesses. A divestment may also release less regulatory capital than we would otherwise expect.

Any failure to complete the divestments on favorable terms, could have a material adverse impact on our assets, profitability, capital adequacy and business operations. If we are unable to complete the announced divestments in a timely manner, we would be required to find alternative ways to reduce our leverage, and we could be subject to enforcement actions or proceedings by the EC. In particular, if we do not succeed in completing divestitures as described in the Restructuring Plan within the timelines set out therein, the EC may request the Dutch State to appoint a divestiture trustee with a mandate to complete the relevant divestiture with no minimum price.

 

27


Table of Contents

The implementation of the divestments announced in connection with the Restructuring Plan, including the separation of the insurance and most of the investment management operations from the banking operations, will also give rise to additional costs related to the legal and financial assessment of potential transactions. The implementation may also result in increased operating and administrative costs. The process of completing the steps contemplated by the Restructuring Plan may be disruptive to our business and the businesses we are trying to sell and may cause an interruption or reduction of our business and the businesses to be sold as a result of, among other factors, the loss of key employees or customers and the diversion of management’s attention from our day-to-day business as a result of the need to manage the divestment process as well as any disruptions or difficulties that arise during the course of the divestment process. We may face other difficulties in implementing the Restructuring Plan and completing the planned divestments. For instance, the divestments, individually or in the aggregate, may trigger provisions in various contractual obligations, including debt and capital instruments, which could require us to modify, restructure or refinance those or other related obligations. We may not be able to effect any such restructuring or refinancing on similar terms as the current contractual obligations or at all. In addition, the announced divestments could be the subject of challenges or litigation, and a court could delay any of the divestment transactions or prohibit them from occurring on their proposed terms, or from occurring at all, which could adversely affect our ability to use the funds of the divestments to repay the Core Tier 1 Securities, reduce or eliminate our double leverage and strengthen our capital ratios as anticipated and eliminate the constraints on competition imposed by the EC.

The limitations required by the EC on our ability to compete and to make acquisitions or call certain debt instruments could materially impact the Group.

As part of our Restructuring Plan, we have undertaken with the EC to accept certain limitations on our ability to compete in certain retail, private and direct banking markets in the European Union and on our ability to acquire (i) financial institutions and (ii) businesses insofar this would delay our repayment of the remaining Core Tier 1 Securities held by the Dutch State. These restrictions in principle apply until the earlier of (1) November 18, 2012, and (2) the date upon which we repay all remaining Core Tier 1 Securities held by the Dutch State. We were also required to agree to limitations on our ability to call Tier-2 capital and Tier 1 hybrid debt instruments. If the EC does not approve the calling of Tier-2 capital and Tier 1 hybrid debt instruments in the future, this may have adverse consequences for us, result in additional payments on these instruments and limit our ability to seek refinancing on more favorable terms. The limitations described above will impose significant restrictions on our banking business operations and on our ability to take advantage of market conditions and growth opportunities. Such restrictions could adversely affect our ability to maintain or grow market share in key markets, as well as our results of operations.

Upon the implementation of the Restructuring Plan, we will be less diversified and may experience competitive and other disadvantages.

Following completion of the planned divestments under the Restructuring Plan, we expect to become a significantly smaller, regional financial institution focused on retail, direct and commercial banking in the Benelux region and certain other parts of Europe, as well as selected markets outside Europe. Although we will remain focused on banking operations, we may become a smaller bank than that represented by our current banking operations. In the highly competitive Benelux market and the other markets in which we operate, our competitors may be larger, more diversified and better capitalized and have greater geographical reach than us, which could have a material adverse effect on our ability to compete, as well as on our profitability. The divested businesses may also compete with the retained businesses, on their own or as part of the purchasers’ enlarged businesses. In addition, the restrictions on our ability to be a price leader and make acquisitions and on our compensation policies could further hinder our capacity to compete with competitors not burdened with such restrictions, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations. There can be no assurance that the implementation of the Restructuring Plan will not have a material adverse effect on the market share, business and growth opportunities and results of operations for our remaining core banking businesses.

Our Restructuring Programs may not yield intended reductions in costs, risk and leverage.

On October 26, 2009, we announced that we had reached an agreement with the EC on the Restructuring Plan. Projected cost savings and impact on our risk profile and capital associated with these initiatives are subject to a variety of risks, including:

 

   

contemplated costs to effect these initiatives may exceed estimates;

 

   

divestments planned in connection with the Restructuring Plan may not yield the level of net proceeds expected, as described under “Risks Related to the Group — The implementation of the Restructuring Plan and the divestments anticipated in connection with that plan will significantly alter the size and structure of the Group and involve significant costs and uncertainties that could materially impact the Group”;

 

28


Table of Contents
   

initiatives we are contemplating may require consultation with various regulators as well as employees and labor representatives, and such consultations may influence the timing, costs and extent of expected savings;

 

   

the loss of skilled employees in connection with the initiatives; and

 

   

projected savings may fall short of targets.

While we have begun and expect to continue to implement these strategies, there can be no assurance that we will be able to do so successfully or that we will realize the projected benefits of these and other restructuring and cost saving initiatives. If we are unable to realize these anticipated cost reductions, our business may be adversely affected. Moreover, our continued implementation of restructuring and cost saving initiatives may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Our agreements with the Dutch State impose certain restrictions regarding the issuance or repurchase of our shares and the compensation of certain senior management positions.

For so long as the Dutch State holds at least 25% of the Core Tier 1 Securities, for so long as the IABF is in place or for so long as any of the government guaranteed senior unsecured bonds issued by ING Bank N.V. under the Credit Guarantee Scheme of the Netherlands (the “Government Guaranteed Bonds”) are outstanding we are prohibited from issuing or repurchasing any of our own shares (other than as part of regular hedging operations and the issuance of shares according to employment schemes) without the consent of the Dutch State’s nominees on the Supervisory Board. In addition, under the terms of the Core Tier 1 Securities and IABF, we have agreed to institute certain restrictions on the compensation of the members of the Executive Board and senior management, including incentives or performance-based compensation. These restrictions could hinder or prevent us from attracting or retaining the most qualified management with the talent and experience to manage our business effectively. In connection with these transactions, the Dutch State was granted the right to nominate two candidates for appointment to the Supervisory Board. The Dutch State’s nominees have veto rights over certain material transactions. Our agreements with the Dutch State have also led to certain restrictions imposed by the EC as part of the Restructuring Plan, including with respect to our price leadership in EU banking markets and our ability to make acquisitions of financial institutions and other businesses. See “ — The limitations required by the EC on our ability to compete and to make acquisitions or call certain debt instruments could materially impact the Group” above.

Whenever the overall return on the (remaining) Core Tier 1 securities issued to the Dutch State is expected to be lower than 10% p.a., the European Commission may consider the imposition of additional behavioural constraints.

As stated in the decision of the European Commission of 12 November 2008 (in State aid N 528/2008 – The Netherlands), the core Tier 1 state-aid measure must be (re)notified to the European Commission by the Dutch authorities if the overall return on the Core Tier 1 Securities of at least 10% p.a. is not expected to be achieved. Such (re)notification by the Dutch authorities is particularly required (i) if ING abstains from paying dividend on its shares for a period of two consecutive years or for three years in the five years following the date of the aforementioned decision or (ii) if after a transition period of one year following the date of the aforementioned decision, the share price over a period of two consecutive years remains on average below EUR 13. In such cases, the European Commission may require additional (behavioural) constraints as a condition of the compatibility of the measure.

In 2011, ING reported to the Dutch authorities that ING has abstained from paying dividends on its shares for a period of two consecutive years (i.e. 2009 and 2010). ING (publicly) indicated in 2011 that provided that the strong capital generation continues, it intends to repurchase the remaining EUR 3 billion Core Tier 1 Securities from retained earnings ultimately by May 2012 on terms that are acceptable to all stakeholders. In this context, ING also indicated that this repurchase is conditional upon there having been no material changes regarding ING’s capital requirements and/or (ING’s outlook on) external market circumstances. Any repayment of the remaining Core Tier Securities is furthermore conditional on approval from the Dutch Central Bank (‘De Nederlandsche Bank’)

Early 2012, ING indicated that it aims to repay the remaining Core Tier 1 Securities as soon as possible—ideally a (part) in 2012 -,but that given the ongoing crisis in the eurozone and increasing regulatory capital requirements, it needs to take a cautious approach and pay special attention to liquidity, funding and capital. Against this background, ING is discussing the (terms and timing of the) repayment of the remaining EUR 3 billion Core Tier 1 Securities with the Dutch Authorities and the European Commission.

 

29


Table of Contents

Any of the fact that ING has not paid a dividend for (at least) two consecutive years, the status and outcome of discussions with the Dutch State and the European Commission on the terms of the repayment of the Core Tier 1 Securities and/or a change in ING’s repayment schedule due to market circumstances, increased capital requirements and/or other relevant factors, could result in the European Commission imposing additional (behavioural) constraints on us as a condition of the compatibility of the measure of and/or requiring a higher minimum overall return on the Securities than 10% p.a.

Additional risks relating to ownership of ING shares

Because we are a Dutch company and because the Stichting ING Aandelen holds more than 99.9% of our Ordinary Shares, the rights of our depositary receiptholders may differ from the rights of shareholders in other jurisdictions or companies that do not use a similar trust structure, which could affect your rights as an equity investor.

While holders of our bearer depositary receipts are entitled to attend and speak at our General Meeting of Shareholders (“General Meeting”), voting rights are not attached to the bearer depositary receipts. Stichting ING Aandelen (the “Trust”) holds more than 99.9% of our Ordinary Shares, and exercises the voting rights attached to the Ordinary Shares (for which bearer depositary receipts have been issued). Holders of bearer depositary receipts who attend — in person or by proxy — the General Meeting must obtain and are entitled to voting rights by proxy from the Trust. Holders of bearer depositary receipts and holders of the ADSs (American depositary shares) representing the bearer depositary receipts who do not attend the General Meeting may give binding voting instructions to the Trust. The Trust is entitled to vote on any Ordinary Shares underlying the bearer depositary receipts for which the Trust has not granted voting proxies, or voting instructions have not been given to the Trust. In exercising its voting discretion, the Trust is required to be guided primarily by the interests of the holders of bearer depositary receipts, while also taking into account:

 

   

our interests, and

 

   

the interests of our affiliates

The Trust may, but has no obligation to, consult with the holders of bearer depositary receipts in exercising its voting rights in respect of any Ordinary Shares for which it is entitled to vote. These arrangements differ from practices in other jurisdictions, and accordingly may affect the rights of the holders of bearer depositary receipts and their power to affect ING’s business and operations.

The share price of ING shares has been, and may continue to be, volatile.

The share price of our bearer depositary receipts has been volatile in the past, and the share price and trading volume of our bearer depositary receipts may continue to be subject to significant fluctuations due, in part, to changes in our actual or forecast operating results and the inability to fulfil the profit expectations of securities analysts, as well as to the high volatility in the securities markets generally and more particularly in shares of financial institutions. Other factors, besides our financial results, that may impact our share price include, but are not limited to:

 

   

market expectations of the performance and capital adequacy of financial institutions in general;

 

   

investor perception of the success and impact of our strategies;

 

   

investor perception of our positions and risks

 

   

a downgrade or review of our credit ratings;

 

   

the implementation and outcome of our Restructuring Plan;

 

   

potential litigation or regulatory action involving ING or sectors we have exposure to through our insurance and banking activities;

 

   

announcements concerning financial problems or any investigations into the accounting practices of other financial institutions; and

 

   

general market circumstances.

There can be no assurance that we will pay dividends on our Ordinary Shares in the future.

It is ING’s policy to pay dividends in relation to the long-term underlying development of cash earnings. Dividends can only be declared by shareholders when the Executive Board considers such dividends appropriate, taking into consideration the financial conditions then prevailing and the longer-term outlook. See “Item 8. Financial Information – Dividends”. Given the uncertain financial environment, ING will not pay a dividend over 2011 and there can be no assurance that we will pay dividends in the future.

 

30


Table of Contents

The remaining Core Tier 1 Securities issued to the Dutch State may be converted into Ordinary Shares or bearer depositary receipts and dilute existing shareholders.

The terms of the Core Tier 1 Securities permit us, on or after November 12, 2011, to convert any or all of the remaining Core Tier 1 Securities (EUR 3 billion per May 11, 2011) into Ordinary Shares or bearer depositary receipts on the basis of one Core Tier-1 security for 1,335 Ordinary Shares or bearer depositary receipts. Any such conversion would dilute existing shareholders. If we exercise our conversion right, the Dutch State may opt to require us to redeem the Core Tier 1 Securities on the conversion date at the original issue price of EUR 10 per Core Tier 1 Security, together with the pro rata coupon, if due, accrued to such date.

Certain holders of ING shares may not be able to participate in future equity offerings with subscription rights.

We may undertake future equity offerings with or without subscription rights. In case of equity offerings with subscription rights, holders of ING shares in certain jurisdictions, however, may not be entitled to exercise such rights unless the rights and the related shares are registered or qualified for sale under the relevant legislation or regulatory framework. Holders of ING shares in these jurisdictions may suffer dilution of their shareholding should they not be permitted to participate in future equity offerings with subscription rights.

 

31


Table of Contents
Item 4. Information on the Company

GENERAL

ING was established as a Naamloze Vennootschap (a Dutch public limited liability company) on March 4, 1991, through the merger of Nationale-Nederlanden, which was the largest insurer in the Netherlands, and NMB Postbank Group, which was one of the largest banks in the Netherlands. ING Groep N.V. is incorporated under the laws of the Netherlands.

 

The official address of ING Group is:

  

The name and address of ING Groep N.V.’s

agent in the United States is:

ING Groep N.V.

Amstelveenseweg 500

1081 KL Amsterdam

P.O. Box 810, 1000 AV Amsterdam

The Netherlands

Telephone +31 20 541 5411

  

ING Financial Holdings Corporation

1325 Avenue of the Americas

New York, NY 10019

 

United States of America

Telephone +1 646 424 6000

Our mission

ING’s mission is to set the standard in helping our customers manage their financial future. We aim to deliver financial products and services in the way our customers want them delivered: with exemplary service, convenience and at competitive prices.

Our profile

ING is a global financial institution of Dutch origin, currently offering banking, investments, life insurance and retirement services to meet the needs of a broad customer base. Going forward, we will concentrate on our position as a strong European bank with attractive home market positions in Northern Europe and growth options in Central and Eastern Europe and Asia, while creating an optimal base for independent futures for our insurance operations (including investment management).

Our strategy

To serve the interests of our stakeholders, increase management focus and create value for our shareholders. ING is moving towards separation of its banking and insurance operations. We believe the widespread demand for greater simplicity, reliability and transparency makes the best course of action. The separation is also part of the restructuring plan submitted to the European Commission in order to get approval for the Dutch state aid received during the financial crisis. In the future, ING Bank intends to be a strong European bank, with leading domestic banking positions in attractive, stable home markets, as well as a leading commercial bank in the Benelux and Central and Eastern Europe (“CEE”). We will also intend to continue to selectively evolve our various ING Direct units into more mature full-service banking models. These initiatives in Europe, coupled with our positions outside of Europe, should give the Bank attractive growth potential in the long term. ING will build on its global presence and international network and capitalise on its leadership position in gathering savings, multichannel distribution, simple propositions and marketing. On the insurance side, the focus will be on continuing to improve performance in order to optimise returns and value for the business as we prepare for separation. We will focus on earning our customers’ trust through transparent products, value for money and superior service. This reflects our universal customer ideal: saving and investing for the future should be easier.

Our customers

ING serves a broad customer base, comprising individuals, families, small businesses, large corporations, institutions and governments.

Our stakeholders

ING conducts business on the basis of clearly defined business principles. In all our activities, we carefully weigh the interests of our various stakeholders: customers, employees, business relations and suppliers, society at large and shareholders.

 

32


Table of Contents

Our corporate responsibility

ING wants to build its future on sustainable profit based on sound business ethics and respect for its stakeholders and to be a good corporate citizen. It is only by acting with professionalism and integrity that we will maintain our stakeholders’ trust and preserve our reputation. Our Business Principles prescribe the corporate values we pursue and the responsibilities we have towards society and the environment: we act with integrity, we are open and clear, we respect each other and we are socially and environmentally responsible.

CHANGES IN THE COMPOSITION OF THE GROUP

Acquisitions effective in 2011

There were no significant acquisitions in 2011.

Disposals effective in 2011

Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd.

In June 2011 ING had completed the sale of its entire stake in China’s Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd. (PALIC) to China Construction Bank for a consideration of EUR 82 million, and a net profit of EUR 28 million. This is the outcome of a strategic review announced in April 2009 as part of ING’s Back to Basics program. The stake in PALIC was previously included in the segment Insurance Asia/Pacific. The deal had been announced in 2009 and was presented as held for sale since 2009 until the sale was completed.

ING REIM Europe, ING REIM Asia and Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES)

ING announced in February 2011 that it has reached agreement with CB Richard Ellis Group, Inc., to sell ING REIM Europe, ING REIM Asia and Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES), ING REIM’s US-based manager of listed real estate securities, as well as part of ING’s equity interests in funds managed by these businesses.

In July 2011 ING announced the completion of the sale of Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES) to CB Richard Ellis. The sale resulted in a net gain on divestment of EUR 182 million. CRES was previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

In October 2011 ING announced that it had completed the sale of REIM’s Asian and European operations to US-based CBRE Group Inc., thereby completing the divestment of ING REIM. The divestment of ING REIM has resulted in an after-tax gain on disposal of approximately EUR 245 million. As a result of the agreement at closing ING continues to have certain contingent income and expenses, however no significant impact on the result on divestment is expected. REIM’s Asian and European operations were previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

Clarion Partners

In June 2011 ING announced the completion of the sale of the private market real estate investment manager of its US operations, Clarion Partners, to Clarion Partners management in partnership with Lightyear Capital LLC for USD 100 million. The sale resulted in a net gain on divestment of EUR 39 million. Clarion Partners was previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

ING Investment Management Australia

In October 2011 ING completed the sale of ING Investment Management (ING IM) Australia to UBS AG. ING IM Australia’s business provided a number of investment strategies and products directly to the Australian institutional and wholesale markets. This transaction supports ING’s objective to actively manage its capital and portfolio of businesses to ensure an attractive and coherent combination for the announced divestment of its insurance and investment management activities. ING IM Australia was previously included in the segment ING Investment Management.

Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations

In December 2011 ING completed the sale of its Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations for a total consideration of EUR 2,637 million to Grupo de Inversiones Suramericana (‘GRUPOSURA’). The sale is the first major step in the divestment of ING’s insurance and investment management activities. Under the terms of the agreement, ING received EUR 2,572 million in cash and GRUPOSURA will assume EUR 65 million in debt. The sale resulted in a net profit of EUR 995 million. Included in the transaction are the mandatory pension and voluntary savings businesses in Chile, Colombia, Mexico, Uruguay and ING’s 80% stake in AFP Integra S.A. in Peru; the life insurance businesses in Chile and Peru; As part of this transaction ING sold its 33.7% stake in Peruvian InVita Seguros de Vida S.A. to the Wiese Family,

 

33


Table of Contents

ING’s joint venture partner in InVita. The transaction also includes the local investment management capabilities in these five countries. Not included in the transaction is ING’s 36% stake in the leading Brazilian insurer Sul America SA. ING’s Commercial Banking activities in Mexico, Brazil and Argentina are not affected by the announcement. ING’s Mortgage and ING’s Leasing businesses in Mexico are also not part of the transaction.

The Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations were previously included in the segments Insurance Latin America and ING Investment Management before they were classified as discontinued operations. The segment Insurance Latin America has ceased to exist following this transaction as the majority of assets and liabilities have been sold. The net result from discontinued operations is presented separately in the consolidated profit and loss account. Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’ for more detailed disclosures.

ING Car Lease

In September 2011 ING completed the sale of ING Car Lease to BMW Group fleet management division Alphabet for total proceeds of EUR 696 million and a net transaction result of EUR 347 million. ING Car Lease was previously partly included in both the Commercial and Retail Banking segment.

Disposals occured in 2012

ING Direct USA

In June 2011 ING announced that it reached an agreement to sell ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation, a leading US-based financial holding company. In February 2012 ING announced that the transaction closed. Total proceeds of the transaction are approximately USD 9.0 billion (or approximately EUR 6.9 billion), including USD 6.3 billion in cash and USD 2.7 billion in the form of 54.0 million shares in Capital One, based on the share price of USD 49.29 at closing on February 16, 2012. These shares represented a 9.7% stake in Capital One at closing. The transaction has resulted in a positive result after tax of approximately EUR 0.5 billion.

In 2011 ING Direct USA is still included in the segment ING Direct. After this sale ING Direct USA will no longer be consolidated.

In connection with the divestment of ING Direct USA, ING also completed the adjustment of the agreement with the Dutch State concerning the structure of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (IABF) which was also announced on June 16, 2011. The amendment serves to de-link the IABF from ING Direct USA by putting ING Bank in its place as counterparty for the Dutch State. The IABF is further amended to ensure a continued alignment between ING and the State regarding exposure to the Alt-A portfolio. Only the part of the IABF covering ING Direct USA, currently approximately 85% of the total IABF-portfolio, is adjusted in the amendment. The ING Insurance part of the IABF remains unaltered. Reference is made to Note 33 ‘Related parties’ for details on the original agreement and the amendments made.

For the years 2010 and 2009, see Note 30 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

Major changes in the external environment had an impact on ING in 2011, the most significant being the deepening of the sovereign debt crisis in the eurozone which created an extremely challenging economic and financial market environment in the second half of 2011. Consequently international capital and money markets were not functioning as normal. This had repercussions, especially in Europe where funding for governments and financial institutions dried up in certain markets.

The financial sector was also subjected to further regulatory reform during the year. Although we support in principle the regulatory reforms, we have concerns with both the massive volume of new regulation and the lack of coordination throughout the European Union (EU) and at the international level. ING favours a harmonised approach to new financial regulation in the EU, both with regard to drafting and transposition into national laws. This would minimise interference with the vital role banks have in supporting the real economy. One of our primary concerns, therefore, is the increasing number of national initiatives being taken by different member states on matters that should, for reasons of maintaining a level playing field and enhancing the Single Market, be dealt with at the European level. Examples are the introduction of national bank levies, different interpretations and timing of Basel III rules and liquidity standards. Banks based in countries moving ahead of international regulation could be placed at a competitive disadvantage.

We made good progress in 2011 with the European Commission’s restructuring requirements for ING Group, and with the strengthening and streamlining of our banking and insurance businesses. The result is that ING is now in a relatively good position to navigate successfully through the challenges that will undoubtedly come from further changes in the financial and regulatory environment.

 

34


Table of Contents

European sovereign debt crisis affected credit and equity markets in 2011

For the eurozone countries in particular, 2011 was a year of two very different halves. In the first half there were still signs of continuing economic recovery; but in the second half the eurozone’s sovereign debt crisis which had slowly emerged in 2010, deepened and had a negative knock-on effect on the economy. 2011 was for a large part marked by the inability of public authorities and institutions to solve the crisis.

In the eurozone, credit spreads only slightly increased in the first half of 2011, but moved up in the third quarter of 2011 towards levels not seen since the direct aftermath of the fall of Lehman Brothers in September 2008. In the US, credit spreads followed a similar pattern, but rose less sharply than in the eurozone.

Equity indices in the US and the eurozone decreased in the second and third quarter of 2011 and increased somewhat in the last quarter, but not enough to make up for the earlier downturn. In the eurozone, the FTS Eurofirst 300 Index declined to levels last seen in the second quarter of 2009. The share prices of financial companies were particularly adversely affected. In these difficult market circumstances the performance of the ING share price was better than the FTS E300 Banks Index but somewhat worse than the FTS E300 Life Insurance Index over 2011.

Economies in Europe and beyond suffered a negative turnaround

As a result of the European debt crisis, macroeconomic conditions started to deteriorate in the second half of 2011. Eurozone consumer and producer confidence declined sharply, international trade stopped growing, companies’ willingness to invest fell and employment perspectives started to deteriorate markedly.

Whilst Europe seemed to be sliding into recession in 2011, the US economy showed signs of resilience in the second half of the year. Jobs data and unemployment rates gave grounds for market confidence and even some of the housing data was less negative than anticipated. However, the rate of growth of the US economy was still low in 2011.

By contrast, in many emerging economies like China, India and Brazil, household spending and corporate investment stayed at elevated levels and thus fuelled job creation, but this was not enough to quell fears of a further widening of global imbalances. Major imbalances between Asia and the Western world and between North and South in Europe continue to exist and threaten economic growth, and the stability of the global financial system. Looking ahead, underlying sovereign and financial system vulnerabilities remain a significant concern. The outlook for a large part of the global economy in 2012 therefore seems to be somewhat gloomy.

The uncertain economic outlook, the turbulence on financial markets, and other factors related to developing market conditions have had implications for ING’s strategy. On January 12, 2012 we announced that the base case of two IPOs is replaced by one in which ING will explore other options for its Asian insurance and investment management businesses.

Important changes in regulation and supervision

During 2011 important steps were taken in the European and international regulatory reform programmes that had been set up in the wake of the 2008/2009 financial crisis.

Reforms in the financial sector are of particular interest to ING as a cross-border financial institution with operations all over Europe and in other parts of the world. Although we actively support many of the new regulatory proposals and are implementing them to a large extent already, we have strong concerns that the ultimate and aggregated consequences of all reforms are still not fully clear. We fear that there are too many uncoordinated additions to regulation; that there is too much focus on short-term measures, and too little a focus on how the financial sector can contribute to achieving sustainable economic growth. This has a number of potential effects which should be taken into serious consideration.

First, we are concerned that too much regulation will unnecessarily restrict banking activities needed to support the economy and will make our services more expensive. Second, because of the aggregate impact of various new rules a tendency may emerge in which risks that are normally taken by financial institutions are shifted to customers.

 

35


Table of Contents

Third, as many new rules are still in development, we have some concerns about the actual implementation. There is a clear tendency for national authorities to have different and fragmented approaches to implementation, which is reflected both in the speed of introduction of new measures and the content of measures. This applies to the new capital and liquidity standards in Basel III/CRD IV, where regulators in some countries are implementing ahead of the timeframes set by the Basel Committee or are setting additional requirements at the national level. It also holds for crisis management regulation (insolvency laws). While an EU framework is under discussion, several countries are considering or have already announced they will adopt their own specific measures. This is leading to a lot of uncertainty, not only for financial companies, but also for equity investors and bond investors.

EBA stress test and capital exercise

In July 2011, the European Banking Authority (EBA) published the results of the second round of stress tests. The first round was conducted in 2010 by the EBA’s predecessor, the Committee of European Banking Supervisors (CEBS). The tests assessed the resilience of European banks to adverse market developments and tested their solvency levels under hypothetical stress events. The test in July 2011 again confirmed the strong capital position of ING Bank which makes us better equipped to absorb adverse shocks.

In addition to the EU-wide stress test in summer 2011, the EBA performed an additional capital exercise in December 2011. The objective of the capital exercise was to create an exceptional and temporary capital buffer to address current market concerns over sovereign risk and other residual credit risks related to the current difficult market environment. Following the completion of the capital exercise, which the EBA conducted in close cooperation with the Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank, DNB), it was determined that ING Bank met the 9% core Tier 1 ratio.

Additional measures for systemically important financial institutions

In 2011 the Basel Committee issued a consultative document on Global Systemically Important Banks (G-SIBs) as part of a broader package of policy measures to address Systemically Important Financial Institutions (SIFIs). The Financial Stability Board (FSB) reviewed and approved the package and submitted it for approval to the G20 in November 2011. As ING has been earmarked as a Global Systemically Important Financial Institution (G-SIFI), we could be subject to an additional capital surcharge. In November 2011, the Dutch Central Bank (DNB) and the Dutch government announced additional capital buffers for domestic systemically relevant banks. Depending on the degree of systemic relevance, the additional requirement amounts to 1 to 3 percent of Risk-weighted assets, and this includes the internationally agreed (FSB) buffer. The aim is to introduce the buffer gradually from 2016 to 2019, thereby allowing banks to generate capital from retained earnings.

Another important element of internationally agreed policy measures is the obligation for banks to set up recovery and resolution plans. In the recovery plans, which are drafted in close coordination with the main supervisor, banks have to draw up plans for the restoration of their financial situation in the event of a significant deterioration. An important element of these plans is risk mitigating measures with respect to capital and liquidity. In addition, clear governance principles have to be established. ING is in the process of finalising its recovery plan, which it currently plans to update annually.

Dutch legislative measures

In anticipation of related EU regulation the Dutch authorities have already announced a number of measures.

Dutch intervention law

A new draft legislative proposal on crisis management would if enacted grant new powers to the DNB and the Minister of Finance to intervene in situations where an institution faces financial difficulties or where there is a serious and immediate risk to the stability of the financial system caused by an institution in difficulty.

Bank levy

On July 1, 2011, the Dutch Ministry of Finance announced a temporary reduction of the real estate transfer tax, from 6% to 2%. In the announcement several ways of funding the reduction were identified, the introduction of a bank tax being one of them. The levy may enter into force in 2012. Dutch and non-Dutch entities with banking activities in the Netherlands will be included in its scope. The taxable base of the levy is the liability side of the (global consolidated) balance sheet with an exemption for equity, for deposits that are covered by a deposit guarantee scheme and for certain liabilities that relate to insurance business. The rate of short-term funding (less than one year) will be twice the rate of long-term funding (more than one year). Currently, total yearly tax proceeds of EUR 300 million are expected. We believe the timing and motivation for such a tax to be less opportune given the economic climate and conditions in financial markets.

 

36


Table of Contents

Deposit Guarantee Scheme

In August 2011, the Ministry of Finance and the DNB published their proposal to establish an ex-ante funded Deposit Guarantee Scheme (DGS) in the Netherlands. As was announced at an earlier stage by the minister, the target level of the fund will be 1% of total guaranteed deposits in the Netherlands. This equals about EUR 4 billion, to be built up, in principle, within 15 years. The main element of the proposal is that for each bank the individual target amount is defined as 1% of its guaranteed deposit base. To reach this individual target amount, every bank pays a base premium of 0.025% per quarter of the guaranteed deposits. Additionally a risk add-on of 0%, 25%, 50% or 100% of the base premium has to be paid by every bank, depending on its risk weighting.

Executive compensation legislation

Currently a legislative proposal is under discussion in the Dutch Parliament relating to variable remuneration at financial institutions that have received state support for reasons of financial stability,such as ING. If and when entered into force, the legislation would prevent these financial institutions from granting variable remuneration (in cash or otherwise) to their Executive Board members. In addition, the legislation contains certain restrictions with respect to the possibility of increasing the fixed salary of Executive Board members.

Solvency II

The most important regulatory issue for the insurance industry in Europe is the continued development by the European Union of the Solvency II capital adequacy framework. Solvency II is intended to be based on economic, risk-based and market-consistent principles whereby capital requirements across Europe are directly dependent on an insurer’s assets and liabilities.

Such a framework should enable insurance companies to play their fundamental role in society for consumers, corporates and the economy. Insurance companies take the risks off the shoulders of consumers by pooling their long-term risks and providing guarantees at affordable prices. Through the accumulation of premiums, insurance companies are also major institutional investors that provide long-term funding to companies and institutions via the capital markets. By spreading risks and extending long-term funding, the insurance industry thereby also plays an invaluable role for society as a whole in dampening volatility through economic cycles

In order to achieve these goals it is very important that the Solvency II framework, as originally envisaged, will become market-based, avoids pro-cyclicality and should be able to withstand market volatility. The framework should therefore ensure that the measures to be implemented are robust enough throughout market cycles.

Moreover, there needs to be a balance between on the one hand pricing that is affordable and on the other hand meeting capital objectives with which the industry can fulfil its long-term obligations. Such a balanced market-based framework should be designed to last for a long time to come and maintain the ongoing trust from consumers, thereby positioning the European insurance industry for the future.

ING wants to work constructively with its colleagues in the insurance industry to advise EU policy makers and regulators to come up with concrete proposals to meet these objectives. It is important that the framework is built to last and will service society as a whole for a long time to come.

In March 2011, the European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority (EIOPA) published the results of its Fifth Quantitative Impact Study (QIS5) on Solvency II. ING participated in QIS5 independently as ING Insurance, and also as ING Group, which is in line with our internal preparations to become fully Solvency II-ready. Based on the results, EIOPA and the Dutch Central Bank confirmed that the financial positions of European and Dutch insurers remained sound. Individual results were not disclosed. The results have been fed into the European Commission’s process for fine-tuning the Solvency II framework and implementation.

Alignment of remuneration policies with CRD III

Since the start of the crisis in 2008, ING has been continually reviewing and amending its remuneration policies in response to the ongoing review of the financial system and related public debate, as well as in line with applicable regulatory developments. In 2010 the European Commission issued the Capital Requirements Directive III (CRD III), which contained specific requirements in relation to the remuneration of those who have a material impact on the company’s risk profile, the so-called Identified Staff. From January 1, 2011 the directive had to be implemented into national law.

 

37


Table of Contents

In 2011, ING’s remuneration policies for the Executive Board and Identified Staff were amended in line with the CRD III requirements. The amended policy for the Executive Board was adopted by the annual General Meeting of Shareholders in May 2011. Our remuneration policies continue to have an increased focus on long-term value creation, risk and non-financial performance measures to improve sustainable business practices.

ING’s appeal against the EC decision

In January 2010, ING filed an appeal with the General Court of the European Union against specific elements of the European Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009 which approved the state aid received and ING’s Restructuring Plan. ING requested the Court to annul the decision of the European Commission insofar:

 

 

as it states that the agreement between ING and the Dutch State concerning a reduction of the repayment premium for the first EUR 5 billion tranche of Core Tier 1 Securities leads to additional state aid of EUR 2 billion;

 

 

as the Commission has subjected the approval of the state aid to the acceptance of price leadership bans; and

 

 

as the Commission has subjected the approval of the state aid to restructuring requirements that go beyond what is proportionate.

The Dutch State joined ING in 2010 in its appeal with the General Court to contest the EC decision insofar as it qualifies the core Tier 1 amendment as additional state aid. The Dutch Central Bank joined in the proceedings in support of ING’s appeal. In July 2011, oral arguments of the appeal case were heard by the Court. The ruling of the Court was issued on March 2, 2012. ING welcomes the judgment to partially annul the EC decision. From March 2, ING has been in the process of carefully assessing the full judgment as well as its consequences.

GROUP STRATEGY

2011 saw a marked deterioration in the debt and equity markets amid a slowdown of the macroeconomic environment and a deepening of the sovereign debt crisis in Europe. ING Group continued to take a prudent approach to risk, increasing hedging to preserve capital and selectively reducing exposure to southern Europe. In this challenging environment ING’s earnings remained resilient, and our strong funding position enabled us to continue to increase lending to support our customers in these uncertain times.

We were also able to make good progress on the strategic priorities of ING Group, which are strengthening the financial position, restructuring, streamlining the portfolio, repayment of state aid and building stronger banking and insurance/investment management businesses. Apart from these measures, earning trust remained at the top of our strategic agenda. The past few years have made it clear that it is of crucial importance for financial institutions such as ING to rebuild the trust and confidence of all their stakeholders, first and foremost those of their customers. We believe that trust is and remains the most important license to operate for every financial institution.

Strengthening the financial position

ING Group’s underlying net profit was EUR 2,649 million in 2011. This result was reached despite the impact of volatile financial markets, a weakening of the macroeconomic environment, a charge for the Insurance US Closed Block Variable Annuity and impairments on Greek sovereign debt.

Both ING Bank and ING Insurance/Investment Management (“ING Insurance/IM”) showed clear progress on their respective performance improvement programmes. Despite the far-reaching restructuring that ING Group is undergoing through, we have continued to show solid commercial growth across our franchises, which is a testimony to the dedication and professionalism of our staff as we endeavour to maintain the loyalty of our customers.

ING Bank’s results benefited from a healthy interest margin, higher client balances, lower risk costs and focus on cost control. The capital position of the Bank remained strong, with the core Tier 1 ratio stable at 9.6% after absorbing the impact of higher capital requirements under the Capital Requirements Directive III (CRD III) which came into effect at year-end, and despite repaying EUR 3 billion to the Dutch State in 2011.

ING Insurance/Investment Management’s operating results mostly showed improvement throughout 2011, reflecting higher fees and premium-based revenues, robust sales growth, an improvement in the investment margin and cost control. A significant earnings charge was taken of EUR 1.1 billion against fourth-quarter results for the Insurance US Closed Block Variable Annuity (VA), a legacy business that was closed in 2009 – primarily on revised assumptions for policyholder behaviour.

 

38


Table of Contents

Going forward, ING Group will strive to further strengthen its financial position by improving operating performance, boosting income and lowering risk and overall costs.

Restructuring and streamlining the portfolio

The restructuring of the Group is on track based on our work towards the separation of the banking and insurance/investment management activities and the execution of divestments.

Separation process on schedule

We continued to work towards the full physical and organisational separation of the banking and insurance/investment management activities. In 2011 we laid the groundwork for the original base case of two IPOs (initial public offerings) of our insurance and investment management activities: one for our US operations and one for our European and Asian activities. However, on January 12, 2012 we announced an update on the restructuring of the insurance and investment management businesses. Due to the uncertain economic outlook and volatile markets, especially in Europe, ING has decided to review other strategic options for its Asian insurance and investment management businesses. For the European insurance/investment management businesses, ING is continuing preparations for a stand-alone future, including the possibility of an IPO. And we are continuing to prepare for the base case of an IPO for the US insurance/ investment management businesses. ING is committed to conducting these processes with the utmost diligence in the interests of all stakeholders, including customers, employees, distribution partners and shareholders.

The separation process of ING Bank and ING Insurance/Investment Management (IM) has been a massive undertaking entailing more than 1,100 projects. It was set up as a four-year programme, running from early 2010 through to the end of 2013. Operational separation was achieved as of January 1, 2011; since then, approximately 90% of the planned full separation projects have been completed. The full separation of ING Insurance US and ING Insurance Eurasia was well underway in 2011. Separation costs for 2011 were about EUR 200 million, well within the budgeted amount of EUR 250 million after tax. This reflects the cost-efficient way in which the separation was handled. Only a small number of projects were carried over from 2011 to 2012 and are expected to be resolved in the first quarter of 2012. In addition, ING will finalise a couple of large longer- term IT projects.

As ING continued to prepare for the restructuring of its insurance/investment management businesses, important steps were made in 2011 to realign the legal structure and governance of the insurance/ investment management operations. Regulatory approvals were nearing completion at the end of 2011 to create one new holding company for the European and Asian insurance and investment management activities, called ING Insurance Eurasia, under ING Verzekeringen N.V. We also created a management board for ING Insurance Eurasia. These represent ‘no regrets’ steps to allow for strategic flexibility on execution of the divestments of the European and the Asian insurance and investment management businesses. The announcement of a stand-alone future for the European insurance/investment management businesses does not affect governance. The US insurance and investment management operations are expected to continue to be part of a separate, already existing legal entity (ING America Insurance Holdings). We believe that this change in the legal structure will allow ING Group to optimise the capital structure of the separate entities and go further with the disentanglement process in order to be able to move quickly towards the IPO(s) or other options when market conditions become favourable.

ING America Insurance Holdings Inc. is reviewing options to optimise its funding structure independent from the Group and to repay its remaining inter-company debt. After the divestments, ING Verzekeringen N.V. will become a legacy entity and will be wound down over time in an orderly manner, using the cash proceeds from the sale of the Latin American insurance and investment management business that was completed in the fourth quarter of 2011, and other divestments.

Decisive execution of divestments

We took decisive steps to meet the other restructuring demands which are part of the Restructuring Plan, which we submitted to the European Commission (EC) in late 2009 in order to obtain retroactive EC approval of state aid received. In June 2011 we reached an agreement to sell ING Direct USA, meeting one of the principal restructuring requirements. In February 2012 the regulatory approval process was concluded and the sale was closed. ING Direct USA was sold for approximately USD 9 billion (consisting of a combination of cash and shares) to Capital One Financial Corporation (Capital One), a leading US-based financial holding company. In connection with this sale, ING reached an agreement with the Dutch State to adjust the structure of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (IABF).

 

39


Table of Contents

Furthermore, we reached an agreement in 2011 to sell our Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations to Grupo de Inversiones Suramericana (“GrupoSura”) and in Peru to the Wiese Family for approximately EUR 2.6 billion, thereby marking the first major step in the divestment of the insurance and investment management activities.

Westland/Utrecht Bank (“WUB”) became commercially independent of ING in November 2010 after which options were further explored in 2011 to divest WUB.

In the course of the continued streamlining of our business portfolio we also announced other major divestments. ING Real Estate Investment Management was sold to the US-based CBRE Group and to Clarion Partners management in partnership with Lightyear Capital LLC in two separate transactions for a combined price of approximately USD 1 billion. These transactions fit our strategic objectives of reducing exposure to real estate, simplifying the structure of the company and further strengthening our capital base.

Furthermore, ING Car Lease was sold to BMW’s fleet management division Alphabet for approximately EUR 696 million. Going forward ING plans to continue building on its leading position as a predominantly European bank with a strong international network focused on providing customers with consistently high-quality services.

For further details on divestments, please see “Item 4. Information on the Company – Changes in the Composition of the Group”.

Repaying state aid as soon as possible but with prudence

The total amount repaid on the Core Tier 1 Scurities to the Dutch State by the end of 2011 was EUR 7 billion in principal, out of the total capital support provided of EUR 10 billion. Including interest and premium, the payments made to the Dutch State by the end of 2011 reached a total of EUR 9 billion. We have improved efficiency and built up strong capital buffers in the Bank to withstand potential shocks given the uncertain economic environment, while continuing to increase our lending to customers as much as possible to facilitate economic growth as much as possible. As a result, ING was in a position to repurchase a second tranche of support from the Dutch State out of retained earnings in May 2011. This latest repayment of EUR 3 billion (including a EUR 1 billion premium) of capital support to the Dutch State was an important milestone in ING Group’s efforts to do business successfully without the financial aid of the Dutch State.

We aim to repay the remaining EUR 3 billion principal of capital support to the Dutch State as soon as possible on terms acceptable to all stakeholders. Ideally we would like to complete the state repayment as soon as possible, however given the current challenging financial environment in the eurozone and increasing regulatory capital requirements we intend to take a cautious approach and maintain strong capital ratios as we build towards Basel III and satisfy other regulatory requirements.

Building stronger Banking and Insurance/Investment Management businesses

Bank

ING Bank has delivered on its priorities to strengthen its financial position, reduce risks, meet the restructuring requirements imposed by the European Commission and to build a stronger bank. The Bank continued to make progress on meeting its Ambition 2013 targets, which are business improvement programme targets, mostly established in October 2009. These targets included boosting underlying income, lowering risk and overall costs, and lifting return on equity. Due to the changing market circumstances and new regulatory requirements as well as the fact that ING has realised to a large extent its Ambition 2013 goals, ING set itself new performance targets as from 2012.

A key factor in developing the updated banking strategy which was presented in January 2012 has been the changing regulatory environment. In the short term the Bank’s priorities are to generate capital and reach a core Tier 1 ratio of at least 10% by 2013. With respect to Basel III our focus is also on the liquidity requirements to be met from 2013. After this transition period, ING Bank aims for moderate balance sheet growth in line with GDP growth and a strong focus on deposits generation. It wants to evolve ING Direct units into full banks and develop selected growth markets.

Our long-term ambition is to be a strong Northern European Bank with a low-risk balance sheet producing a competitive Return on (IFRS-EU) Equity of 10% to 13% through low costs and low risk. ING Bank has a good starting position with a competitive edge, with leading banking positions in its home markets of the Netherlands, Belgium, Luxemburg, Germany and Poland. Furthermore, ING has key positions in other western, central and eastern European countries. This is coupled with options outside of Europe which will give ING Bank interesting growth potential in the long term. It has strong deposit gathering capabilities and a strong funding mix. It has a

 

40


Table of Contents

well-known brand and it uses the Net Promoter Score (NPS) methodology as a tool to increase customer centricity. The Bank is used to operating in lean, competitive markets which has made us leaders in innovative distribution. It has a leading position in internet banking with a ‘direct first, advice when needed’ model and a relationship-driven commercial bank offering competitive products in terms of price, efficiency and effectiveness. Going forward, the Bank will focus on restoring trust and customer centricity, on operational excellence and optimising its balance sheet to meet its strategic goals.

Insurance/Investment Management

The main priorities for the insurance and investment management businesses are improving performance and optimising returns and value. In 2011 the businesses made good progress on these priorities. Going forward, ING Insurance/IM will continue to focus on its customers and distributors by providing exemplary products and service, as it restructures in preparation for a stand-alone future.

The operating profit for the insurance/investment management businesses increased compared with the previous year, as measures taken to improve returns continued to gain momentum. An NPS program used in the insurance/investment management businesses has improved customer service levels in the Benelux, Central and Rest of Europe, and Asia/Pacific as well as in the sold Latin American businesses. For more information on NPS, see—‘Earning, Trust’ below.

Earning trust

Building stronger banking and insurance/investment management businesses is also about earning trust and increasing customer centricity in both banking and insurance/investment management.

ING’s approach in both its banking and its insurance/investment management businesses is built on sound business ethics and good corporate citizenship in order to ensure customer loyalty, employee engagement, and ultimately to deliver satisfactory returns for our shareholders. As part of this approach, we have embedded social, ethical and environmental criteria into our financing and investment policies and business ambitions. We aim to ensure that our strategic decision-making is always based on financial as well as nonfinancial performance objectives.

The customer is at the centre of all our activities. We strive to meet our customers’ expectations by providing the right products and services to the right customers, for the right reasons, the right price and in the right way. ING also consistantly monitors market and regulatory developments, engages with customer representative groups, and tests its products to ensure their suitability for customer needs.

With a clearer focus on customer needs as the anchor of our business operations, ING is not only building businesses that are financially sound and viable, but ones that have the potential to become the supplier of choice for our customers. To monitor progress on customer loyalty we introduced the NPS methodology in 2009 and fully implemented it throughout ING in 2011. It is based on surveys sent to clients, and gauges customer feedback. NPS goes beyond being a measurement tool and is also used as a means of driving growth and changing local business culture. Customers feedback is used to improve ways of doing business.

ING believes that customers, employees, shareholders and the rest of society no longer live in separate worlds that meet intermittently, but have become more integrated. This mutual interdependence of business and society means that organisations must follow the principle of shared value – the actions they take must benefit everyone.

The financial crisis of 2008/2009 and its impact on ING made it necessary for us to intensify the dialogue with and rebuild trust among all our stakeholders and society as a whole. Although this need is recognised internationally, it was, and in fact still is, especially urgent in ING’s Dutch home market. Deepening relationships with all stakeholders continued to be a key priority in 2011.

ING is convinced that the changes set in motion will make it a stronger company and partner for stakeholders, one that is better able to anticipate and address emerging issues. To underline the increasing importance of ethical, environmental and social considerations in our business strategy, the Sustainability department began to report directly to ING Group’s chief executive officer from July 1, 2011.

Conclusions and ambitions

In a challenging environment ING’s earnings remained resilient in 2011, and our strong funding position enabled us to continue to increase lending to support our customers in these uncertain times. We were also able to make good progress on our strategic priorities, which are strengthening the financial position, restructuring,

 

41


Table of Contents

streamlining the portfolio, repayment of state aid and building stronger banking and insurance/investment management businesses. We continued to build our banking and our insurance businesses based on sound business ethics and good corporate citizenship.

As maintaining income levels comes under more pressure we must renew efforts to reduce expenses across the Group to adapt to the leaner financial environment and maintain our competitive position. Despite volatile markets we continue to work towards the separation of our insurance/investment management companies so we will be ready to move ahead with the IPO(s) or other options when markets are favourable. We maintain an open mind on how the future of the insurance/investment management businesses will be shaped. The fact that market values for activities to be divested are very low, requires that we review all options available to us.

ING will make further efforts to divest of businesses to meet the restructuring demands imposed by the European Commission, to simplify the company, to focus on core activities, to further improve our risk profile and to bolster the capital base. It is one of ING’s priorities to repay the remaining EUR 3 billion of capital support to the Dutch State as soon as possible, but as discussed above, ING recognises the need to proceed in a prudent manner in light of the current challenging and changing financial and regulatory environment.

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Legislative and regulatory developments

On June 6, 2011, the bill on management and supervision was enacted. In anticipation of that bill coming into force, a proposal to align the articles of association of ING Group will be submitted to the 2012 annual General Meeting. Also, the Governance Principles (Insurers’ Code), adopted by the Dutch Association of Insurers became effective on January 1, 2011. For more information, please refer to the paragraph ‘Corporate Governance Codes’ below. In addition, several legislative proposals with corporate governance implications were under discussion, or were adopted, in 2011 by the Lower House of the Dutch Parliament, or were under discussion in the Upper House of the Dutch Parliament. These proposals concern, among other things, the bill on revision and claw back of executive bonuses and profit-sharing of directors, the bill on the limitation of liability of supervisors of financial markets and the rules on executive bonuses of directors of financial institutions receiving financial assistance by the Dutch government and the bill on corporate investigation proceedings.

Transactions with the Dutch State

On November 12, 2008, ING Group issued one billion Core Tier 1 Securities (“Securities”) for a total consideration of EUR 10 billion to the Dutch State. Following the repurchase of 500 million Securities (representing approximately EUR 5 billion) on December 21, 2009 and the repurchase of 200 million Securities (representing approximately EUR 2 billion) on May 13, 2011, another 300 million of Securities representing EUR 3 billion remain outstanding. The Securities do not form part of ING Group’s share capital; accordingly they do not carry voting rights in the General Meeting. The financial entitlements of the Securities are described in Note 33 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements. On January 26, 2009, ING Group reached an agreement with the Dutch State regarding the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (‘IABF’), as further described in Note 33 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements. During 2009, ING Bank N.V. issued various series of debt instruments under the 2008 credit Guarantee Scheme of the Dutch State (“Bonds”), for the first time on January 30, 2009. As part of these transactions, certain arrangements with respect to corporate governance and remuneration were agreed with the Dutch State which will remain in place as long as the Dutch State owns at least 250 million Securities, or as long as the IABF remains in place (whichever expires last). These arrangements, among other things, allow the Dutch State to recommend two candidates (‘State Nominees’) for appointment to the Supervisory Board. Certain decisions of the Supervisory Board require approval of the State Nominees (these decisions are specified in “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees”). Furthermore, in line with these arrangements a sustainable remuneration policy for the Executive Board and Senior Management was introduced in 2010, which contains certain specific arrangements in relation to the remuneration of members of the Executive Board. For more information on the State Nominees and on ING’s remuneration policy, please refer to “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees”.

Shareholder participation and position of ING Trust Office

During the years 2008–2011, participation of shareholders, excluding the ING Trust Office, and depositary-receipt holders in annual General Meetings consistently increased from 38.7% to 47.1%. Only the extraordinary General Meeting of November 25, 2009 showed a deviation from this trend with a markedly lower turnout of 31.1%. The position of the ING Trust Office and ING Group’s depositary receipts structure was evaluated by the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board in 2010. On the basis of this evaluation, the Executive Board and

 

42


Table of Contents

the Supervisory Board concluded that it would be premature to change or abolish ING Group’s depositary-receipts structure in 2010 and that it would be more appropriate to reconsider this as part of a re-evaluation of ING Group’s entire governance structure following the current restructuring of ING Group and the completion of the divestments approved in the 2009 extraordinary General Meeting. The outcome of the aforementioned evaluation was discussed in the 2010 annual General Meeting.

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE CODES

Compliance with the Corporate Governance Code

For its corporate governance structure and practices, ING Group uses the Corporate Governance Code as reference. The Corporate Governance Code can be downloaded from the website of the Monitoring Commission Dutch Corporate Governance Code (www.commissiecorporategovernance.nl/Corporate Governance Code). The application of the Corporate Governance Code by ING is described in the publication ‘ING’s implementation of the Dutch Corporate Governance Code’, dated April 2010, on the website of the Company (www.ing.com), which is to be read in conjunction with this section and is deemed to be incorporated by reference into this section.

Dutch Banking Code

The Banking Code is applicable to ING Bank N.V. and not to ING Group. The Banking Code can be downloaded from the website of the Dutch Banking Association (www.nvb.nl). The principles of the Banking Code as a whole are considered as a reference by ING Bank N.V. and their application is described in the publication ‘Application of the Dutch Banking Code by ING Bank N.V.’ available on the website of the Company (www.ing.com). ING Group voluntarily applies the principles of the Banking Code regarding remuneration with respect to the members of its Executive Board, and considers these principles as a reference for its own corporate governance. ING Group’s remuneration policy for the Executive Board and Senior Management is in agreement with these principles.

Dutch Insurers’ Code

The Dutch Insurers’ Code (“Insurer’s Code) is applicable to the Dutch subsidiaries of ING Insurance Eurasia N.V. pursuing insurance business and not to ING Group, ING Verzekeringen N.V. or ING Insurance Eurasia N.V. The Insurers’ Code can be downloaded from the website of the Dutch Association of Insurers (www.verzekeraars.nl). However, insurance companies that are part of a group (‘concern’) can decide to apply all or parts of the Insurers’ Code at group level. ING Insurance Eurasia N.V. voluntarily adheres to the corporate governance related principles of the Insurers’ Code. ING Insurance Eurasia N.V.’s remuneration policy for its Management Board and Senior Management is in agreement with these principles. The remaining principles of the Insurers’ Code are applied by the subsidiaries of ING Insurance Eurasia N.V. The application of the Insurers’ Code principles is described in the publication ‘Application of the Insurers’ Code by ING Insurance Eurasia’ available on the website of the Company (www.ing.com).

NYSE Requirements

For an overview of what we believe to be the significant differences between our corporate governance practices and NYSE corporate governance rules applicable to US companies, see “Item 16G. Corporate Governance”. The summary of such significant differences is also available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com).

CORPORATE ORGANIZATION

ING Groep N.V. has a Supervisory Board and an Executive Board. The Executive Board of ING Group, the Management Board Banking and the Management Board Insurance are responsible for the day-to-day management of the Group and its business lines (Retail Netherlands, Retail Belgium, ING Direct, Retail Central Europe, Retail Asia, Commercial Banking, Real Estate, Insurance Benelux, Insurance Central and Rest of Europe, Insurance US, Insurance US Closed Block VA, Insurance Asia/Pacific and ING Investment Management). For more information about the Supervisory and Executive Boards, see “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees”.

Business Lines

The Executive Board of ING Group, the Management Board Banking and the Management Board Insurance set the performance targets and approve and monitor the budgets prepared by the business lines. Business lines

 

43


Table of Contents

formulate strategic, commercial, and financial policy in conformity with the strategy and performance targets set by the Executive Board, the Management Board Banking and the Management Board Insurance. Please see “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects”, Segment Reporting” for the total income and result before tax by business line for the years ended 2011, 2010 and 2009.

RETAIL NETHERLANDS

ING in the Netherlands services over 8.9 million retail clients and approximately 600,000 SME and Mid Corporate clients. The bank has improved customer service by combining the direct banking model of the former Postbank with the professional advice capabilities of ING Bank.

Retail Banking reaches its individual customers through internet banking, telephone, call centers, mailings and branches. Using direct marketing methods, it leverages its position as a leading provider of current account services and payments systems to provide other financial services such as savings accounts, mortgage loans, consumer loans, credit card services, investment and insurance products. Mortgages are offered through a tied agents sale force and direct and intermediary channels.

ING Bank Netherlands operates through a branch network of approximately 280 branches. It offers a full range of commercial banking activities and also life and non-life insurance products. It also sells mortgages through the intermediary channel.

As part of the Restructuring Plan and the EC Decision of November 18, 2009, ING has committed to carve out part of its retail banking business: WUH/Interadvies (“WUB”). WUB commercially and operationally separated from ING Bank on November 18, 2010. WUB is active in mortgages, consumer lending and consumer savings products.

RETAIL BELGIUM

ING Belgium provides banking, insurance (life, non-life) and asset management products and services to meet the needs of individuals, families, companies and institutions through a network of local head offices, 773 branches and direct banking channels (fully automated branches, home banking services and call centres). ING Belgium also operates a second network, Record Bank, which provides a full range of banking products through independent banking agents and credit products through a multitude of channels (agents, brokers, vendors).

ING DIRECT

ING Direct offers a range of easy-to-understand financial products – savings, mortgages, retail investment products, payment accounts and consumer lending products – primarily through direct channels. Its business model is based on low-cost, simplicity, transparency and offering a superior customer service. It has 24.5 million customers, and leading market positions in most markets in which it operates – Canada, Spain, Australia, France, Italy, Germany, Austria and the United Kingdom. In mid-June 2011, ING Group announced the sale of ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation. The sale (which closed on February 17, 2012) was part of ING’s Restructuring Plan filed with the European Commission in 2009 in order for the European Commission to ratify Dutch state aid given to ING. See “Item 4. “Information on the Company – Changes in the Composition of the Group – Acquisitions and Disposals Expected and Occurring or Expected To Occur in 2012 – ING Direct USA” for more information regarding this transaction.

ING Direct showed resilient commercial growth in 2011 bringing the total client balances (includes funds entrusted, retail lending and asset management/mutual funds) to EUR 432.7 billion at the end of December. ING Direct is focusing on maintaining an attractive customer offering in savings and term deposits while continuing to balance its mortgage portfolio growth. At year-end 2011 total funds entrusted to ING Direct worldwide (including ING Direct USA) amounted to EUR 255.4 billion and total lending amounted to EUR 166.4 billion, mainly consisting out of residential mortgages. After the sale of ING Direct USA, the total number of ING Direct worldwide 2011 clients amounts to 16.7 million, client balances amount to EUR 336.2 billion, funds entrusted amount to EUR 191.3 billion and lending amounts to EUR 134.3 billion.

In 2011 ING Direct continued to work towards becoming a complete retail bank, but one which continues to maintain a different approach from its competitors. The bank remained at the cutting edge of internet and mobile banking in 2011, while broadening its product base to achieve greater income diversification. It took further initiatives to optimise its distribution mix, introduced more branches and invested more in cross-selling.

 

44


Table of Contents

RETAIL CENTRAL EUROPE

Retail Central Europe has a leading presence in Poland and strong positions in Romania and Turkey. In all three countries, retail banking services are an integrated part of the domestic bank, and serve retail and commercial banking customers, offering a wide range of services. All business units are rapidly expanding into direct distribution, illustrating the convergence of the retail and direct business models.

ING in Poland aims to be ‘the most internet bank’. In 2011, its website www.ingbank.pl, was ranked the most user-friendly bank website in Poland by experts from banking website Money.pl. In 2011, ING Bank Turkey launched the Orange account, the country’s first variable savings product, developed using ING’s extensive savings know-how. The Orange account accelerated an operational transformation and simplification of the business and enhanced ING’s image in the Turkish market. It helped double the level of deposits in ING Bank Turkey in 2011 with 44% of all Orange accounts opened coming from new customers. The Orange account positioned ING Bank Turkey as an innovative, customer-savvy savings bank. It also showed how ING could bring its global experience to help local operations in emerging markets best meet the financial needs of their customers. ING in Turkey also launched a mobile phone banking application, which took first prize in the ‘Best Mobile Application’ category in one of the country’s largest award ceremonies. ING Bank Romania carried out an upgrade of its internet banking site, Home’Bank. A new interface and improvements in usability resulted in a 39% growth in transactions. In September a mobile version of the Home’Bank website was introduced and led to a threefold increase in site visits from smart phones.

RETAIL ASIA

Retail Banking has a leading presence in the important Asian markets of India, China and Thailand. ING Vysya, in which ING has a 44% stake, serves over two million customers and has grown in line with the rapidly growing Indian banking market. The business transformation programme in TMB Bank in Thailand, in which ING has a 30% stake, is yielding results with many operational efficiencies achieved and increased profitability for the third year in row. Bank of Beijing (BoB) – in which ING has the largest single shareholding (16.07%) – is the largest city commercial bank in China. ING provides principally risk management and retail banking expertise to BoB. The Beijing municipal government recognised ING’s work in assisting the bank with its risk management by awarding the company ‘The Great Wall Friendship’ award. This award is the highest honour for foreign companies that provide expertise which contributes to the development of Chinese capital. As with all other banking business units, Retail Asia’s core focus is to become the customer’s preferred bank by focusing on operational excellence, customer centricity and being a top employer.

COMMERCIAL BANKING

ING Commercial Banking supports the banking needs of our corporate and institutional clients and is an integral part of ING’s One Bank ambition and strategy, originating high-quality assets that earn attractive returns in which to invest both Retail and Commercial Bank customer deposits.

We are a full-service commercial bank in our home markets in the Benelux, as well as in Germany, Central and Eastern Europe and beyond. In addition to the basic banking services of lending, payments and cash management and treasury, we provide tailored solutions in other areas, including specialised and trade finance, derivatives, corporate finance, debt and equity capital markets, leasing, factoring and supply chain finance.

Our clients include mid-sized enterprises, large corporations, major multinationals, financial institutions, governments and supranational organisations. We assist them by financing their growth, managing their day-to-day banking needs and by providing a full range of banking solutions to help them manage their risks and achieve their business goals.

Lending is a core element of our business and an anchor product in building and supporting client relationships in our target markets creating a position from which we are able to provide other services.

Payments and Cash Management (PCM) is also one of our most important product lines. Alongside General Lending, we consider it a pre-requisite for customer acquisition and retention. During 2011, ING re-defined its PCM strategy. Our ambition is to gain a leading position in the European market and we have launched a multi-year investment programme to this end. In the coming years, we will significantly improve our payments offering to support these goals.

 

45


Table of Contents

Structured Finance (SF) is a specialist commercial lending business, providing loans to support capital intensive investments and working capital. It is managed in three groups: the Energy, Transport and Infrastructure Group; the Specialised Financing Group; and International Trade and Export Finance.

Leasing and Factoring (L&F) provides financial and operating leasing services for a wide range of equipment as well as receivables financing and other factoring solutions for Commercial Banking clients. The key development during 2011 has been the transformation of the former independent corporate structure of the L&F product lines into two separate product businesses integrated within the Transaction Services division of Commercial Banking.

The Financial Markets (FM) is the global business unit that manages ING’s financial markets trading and non-trading activities. FM is managed along three business lines: ALCO manages the interest rates exposures arising from the traditional banking activities, Strategic Trading Platform incorporates the primary proprietary risk taking units; and Clients and Products is the primary customer trading facilitation business line.

REAL ESTATE

During 2011 Real Estate Finance (REF) maintained the quality of its credit portfolio at a satisfying level, despite the challenging market circumstances. The volume of new transactions fell in 2011 in Europe as part of our strategy to reduce exposure to real estate in general, while investors continued their focus on core assets. The US businesses closed numerous restructurings, thereby optimising the portfolio, while the Asian and Australian businesses faced increased competition from regional players. Real Estate Development (ING RED) and Real Estate Investment Management (ING REIM) continued with a controlled wind down of activities

INSURANCE BENELUX

Insurance Benelux completed the integration of the Dutch insurance operations under the Nationale-Nederlanden banner, one year ahead of schedule. The two-year programme has led to major cost savings and increasing efficiency for the business in the Benelux. Including the rise of NN Services that manages all Retail Life Closed Book business.

In 2011, in response to the changing regulatory and economic environment and changing customer demands, Nationale-Nederlanden introduced new low-cost bank pension savings products and annuities. ING Life Belgium introduced a new Universal Life product.

Nationale-Nederlanden also received a licence from the Dutch Central Bank to launch a defined contribution “DC” company pension product “PPI”, an important development in expanding the company’s presence in the growing DC market in Europe.

The business revealed a client driven strategy late in 2011 which has a sharper focus on producing a flexible, transparent and low cost product range, available through the customer channel of choice. It also has investment in new and improved systems as one of the core pillars of the strategy. While intermediaries such as brokers and financial advisers remain very important, there will be an increased focus on the customer through the introduction of simpler products. ING Life Luxembourg expanded their distribution network with new partners.

In the Closed Book business, NN Services introduced a standardised processing and IT system (business process management layer) for several legacy lines of retail Life businesses. The business focus is on process rationalisation, excellent customer service and lower policy costs. NN Services IT plans to manage all the Closed Book business of Nationale-Nederlanden.

ING’s life insurance products in the Benelux consist of a broad range of traditional, unit-linked and variable annuity policies written for both individual and group customers. ING is also a prominent provider of (re-insured) company pension plans in the Netherlands. ING has a dedicated team to develop and grow its variable annuity business across Europe, servicing own and third party distributors in Luxembourg, Spain, Hungary, the Netherlands, Italy, Belgium and Luxembourg.

ING Benelux’ non-life products, mainly in the Netherlands, include coverage for both individual and commercial/group clients for fire, motor, disability, transport and third party liability. Nationale-Nederlanden has also a central product manufacturing service for property & casualty insurance, which has developed products for ING Bank in Belgium and ING Bank in the Netherlands. ING offers a broad range of disability insurance products and complementary services for employers and self-employed professionals (such as dentists and general practitioners

 

46


Table of Contents

INSURANCE CENTRAL AND REST OF EUROPE

Insurance Central and Rest of Europe has life insurance companies in Hungary, Poland, the Czech and Slovak Republics, Romania, Bulgaria, Greece, Spain and Turkey. It has pension funds in Poland, Hungary, the Czech and Slovak Republics, Bulgaria, Romania and in Turkey. Together these operations have about 3,500 employees who serve over 9 million clients throughout the region.

ING offers a wide array of individual endowment, unit linked, term and whole life insurance policies designed to meet specific customer needs. It also has employee benefits products as well as pension funds, that manage individual retirement accounts for individuals. The latter comprise both mandatory and voluntary retirement savings.

Insurance Central and Rest of Europe’s distribution is becoming more multichannelled, especially due to increased distribution by banks and brokers, however tied agents are still the main distribution channel. It continues to enhance the effectiveness of its tied agents’ sales: giving customers professional advice and service.

Remaining the region’s market leading life insurer and pension provider is an important goal towards building a sustainable growth engine, which means an engine geared for long-term success in the market. This motivates Insurance Central and Rest of Europe to further improve the customer experience, deliver good value-for-money to customers as well as meet today’s and tomorrow’s compliance and risk requirements.

INSURANCE UNITED STATES (EXCLUDING US CLOSED BLOCK VA)

ING Insurance US offers retirement services (primarily defined contribution plans), life insurance, fixed annuities, employee benefits, mutual funds, and broker-dealer services in the United States. ING Insurance US currently operates four core businesses: Retirement Plans, Individual Retirement, Individual Life and Employee Benefits.

In 2011, ING Insurance US continued its focus on preparing the organization for its anticipated separation, together with ING IM US, from the rest of ING’s global operations, to constitute an independent US-based insurance, annuities, retirement services and investment management company. The base case for this separation currently involves an initial public offering, or IPO, of ING Insurance US and ING IM US. In 2011, ING Insurance US’s efforts were directed at strengthening its management team, improving operational results, maintaining a strong balance sheet, managing administrative expenses and bolstering its leadership positions in its retirement services and life insurance businesses. In 2012, ING Insurance US anticipates that it will focus on three key priorities: margin improvement, expense management and disciplined growth.

ING Insurance US’s Retirement Plans business is one of only a few defined contribution providers that offer a broad range of retirement solutions to all sizes and types of employers, including businesses for-profit ranging from start-ups to large corporations, public and private school systems, higher education institutions, state and local governments, hospitals and healthcare facilities, and not-for-profit organizations. It serves the full spectrum of the US market from pure recordkeeping services to fully bundled plan management and investment offerings. ING Insurance US’s Retirement Plans business is the third largest provider of defined contribution (DC) retirement plans in the US based on assets under management and administration, the second largest based on the number of plan participants and the second largest based on the number of sponsors. In addition to its leadership position, Retirement Plans has over 40 years tenure in delivering high-quality service and developing long-lasting, trusted relationships with participants, plan sponsors, and distribution partners.

The vision of ING Insurance US is to be the leader in helping individuals and institutions save, grow, protect and enjoy their wealth. As part of that strategy, ING Insurance US’s Individual Retirement business has a renewed strategic focus on offering products and services that are specifically focused on meeting the financial and retirement income needs of individuals who may or may not be participating in one of our defined contributions plans. Products offered for these individuals include rollover IRAs (individual retirement account, essentially an individually established defined contribution retirement fund), which is expected to be the fastest growing segment of the US retirement market as baby boomers retire over the next two decades. ING Insurance US’s Individual Retirement business also leverages the capabilities of its affiliated broker-dealer, ING Financial Partners, to provide holistic advice and guidance to individuals by phone or via face-to-face interaction. These products and services are aimed at capturing the growth opportunity that lies within the rapidly expanding market for retirees and people changing jobs.

 

47


Table of Contents

ING Insurance US’s Individual Life business manufactures a range of products from low-cost term in the middle market to high-end universal life sales in the affluent market. The business has a strong multi-channel sales team with the breadth to touch every licensed life insurance agent in the US. It has over 80,000 independent producers and 1,500 intermediaries under contract or appointment. Its distribution organization boasts a best-in-class sales support and illustration system. The business also provides one of the broadest competitive product portfolios in the industry and is supported by a best-in-class operational model with leading industry cycle times. This model has allowed the Individual Life business to attract significant independent distribution, create significant scale, become a top five writer of individual term life insurance and develop into a major writer of universal life insurance. Overall, ING Insurance US is a top ten writer of Individual Life Insurance. Individual Life also distributes fixed index annuities as a key product offering and we rank in the top ten.

ING Insurance US’s Employee Benefits business provides group insurance products to medium and large corporate employers and affinity groups. These products include group life, medical stop loss, and disability insurance. Of all the carriers competing outside of the Managed Care market, ING Insurance US is the fifth largest provider of medical stop loss based on in-force premiums. In addition, the Employee Benefits business serves the voluntary worksite market by providing individual and payroll-deduction products, such as life, critical illness, accident and short-term disability insurance.

INSURANCE US CLOSED BLOCK VA

Since taking the decision to terminate sales of this product in early 2009, ING has implemented a number of key changes with regard to the US Closed Block VA business to increase transparency, improve reserve adequacy, reduce earnings volatility and to bring accounting and hedging more into line with US peers. As part of these changes, ING began to report the US Closed Block VA business as a separate business line within ING Insurance/IM to improve transparency for both the Closed Block and ongoing businesses.

ING US Closed Block VA consists of variable annuities issued in the US that are primarily owned by individuals and were designed to address the demand for tax-advantaged savings, retirement planning, and wealth-protection. These annuity contracts were sold in the US, primarily through independent third party distributors, including wirehouses and securities firms, independent planners and agents and banks. The Management of the US Closed Block VA continues to help existing individual annuity contract-owners invest their savings, manage their investments, and plan their financial future through asset accumulation and annuity payout options. With over 500,000 contract-owners and over USD 46 billion in assets under management, US Closed Block VA seeks to assist clients in meeting their retirement planning needs.

US Closed Block VA continues to share resources with ING Insurance US to leverage scale and capacity of administrative systems and product competencies.

INSURANCE ASIA/PACIFIC

ING Insurance Asia/Pacific (“IAP”) is a leading provider of life insurance products and services. It is a leading international life insurer in the region, with nine life operations in eight markets. IAP has flagship operations in the mature and larger markets of Japan and South Korea, operates a dominant business in Malaysia, and is well positioned to secure an increasing share of future growth in the emerging markets of China, Hong Kong, Macau, India and Thailand.

In April 2011, IAP, together with its strategic partners, Public Bank Berhad and Public Islamic Bank Berhad, launched a new joint venture in Malaysia called ING PUBLIC Takaful Ehsan Berhad, which will develop Takaful insurance products.

IAP completed the sale of its 50% stake in Pacific-Antai Life Insurance Company Limited (“PALIC”) in June 2011 with a net disposal gain of EUR 27 million in order to further focus on strengthening its continuing partnership with Bank of Beijing in China.

The IAP regional office in Hong Kong leads, controls and supports all IAP business units in the region, ensures implementation of strategy and standards and facilitates regional and global synergies.

The business units of IAP offer select types of life insurance, wealth management, and retail products and services. These include annuities, endowment, disability/morbidity insurance, unit linked/universal life, whole

 

48


Table of Contents

life, participating life, group life, accident and health, term life and employee benefits. In Hong Kong non-life insurance products (including medical, motor, fire, marine, personal accident and general liability) are also offered.

Product innovations continued to be introduced to capture new market opportunities, differentiate its product line and meet evolving customer demands. In Hong Kong, a life insurance product tailored for high net worth customers was successfully launched. In India, a new cross-generational joint life product was launched to meet the savings and protection needs of two generations. Across the region, there is an increasing focus on protection products that meet emerging customer needs and enhance value for customers.

IAP has a multi-distribution platform. In 2011, IAP continued its efforts to further strengthen distribution. In tied agency, regional initiatives around the theme of ‘quality’, designed to lift the standard of professionalism, were instituted. IAP is also making solid progress in strengthening bancassurance. In the first half of 2011, IAP broadened its reach in China with the opening of a branch in Tianjin, the first since the Bank of Beijing replaced Beijing Capital Group as a joint venture partner last year. ING Life Hong Kong renewed a distribution agreement with China Construction Bank for another ten years.

IAP is on-track with its business ambitions and is making good progress on performance improvement initiatives. The business is pursuing its vision of creating a best-in-class company for its customers, employees and investors through customer-focused product innovation, expanding and improving distribution and improving operational efficiency.

INSURANCE LATIN AMERICA

ING completed the sale of its pensions, life insurance and investment management operations in Chile, Colombia, Mexico, Peru and Uruguay on December 29, 2011, as further detailed in “Item 4—Information on the Company—Changes in the Composition of the Group—Disposals effective in 2011—Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations”.

ING INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT

ING IM is the principal investment manager of ING Group with activities in Europe, the Americas, Asia-Pacific and the Middle East.

In preparation for the divestment of ING Insurance/IM, ING IM Europe & Asia and ING IM US are now operating on an arm’s length basis as of 2011, sharing fees and leveraging global client relationships. These cross-selling relationships will continue and develop into preferred provider relationships, to service clients with a full range of global solutions.

ING IM announced the divestments of ING IM Philippines at the end of 2010, and ING IM Australia in June 2011. The sale of ING IM Philippines was closed in March 2011 and the sale of ING IM Australia was completed in October 2011. These transactions were in support of ING’s objective to manage its capital and portfolio of businesses in preparation for the divestment of the insurance and investment management business.

ING IM provides a wide variety of actively-managed strategies, investment vehicles and advisory services in all major asset classes and investment styles. It delivers a wide range of investment strategies and services to ING’s global network of businesses and third-party clients.

On January 12, 2012, ING announced an update on the restructuring of the insurance and investment management businesses. Due to the uncertain economic outlook and volatile markets, especially in Europe, ING is currently reviewing other strategic options for its Asian Insurance and Investment Management businesses. Within ING IM, ING IM Europe, ING IM Asia/Pacific and ING IM US intend to continue to operate in partnership to ensure continued commercial collaboration and cross-selling arrangements among the regional ING IM businesses.

During this period of change, ING’s investment management business will remain focused on delivering excellent service, generating superior returns and providing a broad range of products and investment solutions in a wide variety of asset classes for its clients.

PRINCIPAL GROUP COMPANIES

Reference is made to Exhibit 8 “ List of subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V.”

 

49


Table of Contents

REGULATION AND SUPERVISION

The banking, insurance, asset management and broker-dealer businesses of ING are subject to detailed and comprehensive supervision in substantially all of the jurisdictions in which ING conducts business. As discussed under “Item 3. Key Information — Risk Factors”, as a large multinational financial institution we are subject to reputational and other risks in connection with regulatory and compliance matters involving such countries.

Dutch Regulatory Framework

The Dutch regulatory system for financial supervision consists of prudential supervision – monitoring the soundness of financial institutions and the financial sector, and conduct-of-business supervision – regulating institutions’ conduct in the markets. Prudential supervision is exercised by De Nederlandsche Bank (“DNB”), while conduct-of-business supervision is performed by the Netherlands Authority for the Financial Markets, Autoriteit Financiële Markten (“AFM”).

Global Regulatory Environment

There are a variety of proposals that could impact ING globally, in particular those made by the Financial Stability Board and the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision at the transnational level, Dodd-Frank in the United States and an expanding series of supranational directives and national legislation in the European Union (see “Item 3. Key Information — Risk Factors — We operate in highly regulated industries. There could be an adverse change or increase in the financial services laws and/or regulations governing our business” for details regarding some of these proposals). The aggregated impact and possible interaction of all of these proposals is hard to determine, and it may be difficult to reconcile them where they are not aligned. The financial industry has also taken initiatives by means of guidelines and self-regulatory initiatives. Examples of these initiatives are the Dutch Banking Code as established by the Dutch Bankers’ Association and the Dutch Insurers Code established by the Association of Dutch Insurers, which detail a set of principles on corporate governance, risk management, audit and remuneration that Dutch banks and insurers have to apply on a comply-or-explain basis. Work has also been done on many other topics including deposit guarantee schemes and cross border crisis and resolution management. The latter discussion could have a significant impact on business models and capital structure of financial groups.

A large number of national, regional and global bodies have presented in 2011 views and proposals of possible legislative and regulatory changes for the banking, insurance and investment industry, building on proposals in the previous years such as the 2009 Report by the High-Level Group on Financial Supervision in the EU chaired by Mr Jacques de Larosière. On the issue of supervisory architecture we saw in 2010 the agreement on the establishment of three European supervisory agencies for each of the financial sectors and one Systemic Risk Board. These new European bodies have been established and started their mandate on January 1, 2011. The European Systemic Risk Board started working on detecting risks building up in the financial sector and the economy as a whole. In addition to changes to the regulatory architecture, significant changes to capital and liquidity standards were agreed and also on topics such as remuneration various national and international bodies have issued guidelines that need implementation.

Financial institutions continue to be closely scrutinized by regulatory authorities, governmental bodies, shareholders, rating agencies, customers and others to ensure they comply with the relevant laws, regulations, standards and expectations. Bank and insurance regulators and other supervisory authorities in Europe, the US and elsewhere continue to oversee the activities of financial institutions to ensure that they operate with integrity and conduct business in an efficient, orderly and transparent manner. ING seeks to meet the standards and expectations of regulatory authorities and other interested parties through a number of initiatives and activities, including scrutinizing account holder information, payment processing and other transactions to support compliance with regulations governing money laundering, economic and trade sanctions, bribery and other corrupt practices. The failure or alleged failure by ING to meet applicable standards in these areas could result in, among other things, suspension or revocation of ING’s licenses, cease and desist orders, fines, civil or criminal penalties and other disciplinary action which could materially damage ING’s reputation and financial condition, and accordingly ING’s primary focus is to support good business practice through its Business Principles and group policies. Over the past years ING has significantly increased its Compliance efforts, including a major staff increase, amendment of key policies and guidelines and the international rollout of several programmes for education, awareness and monitoring of compliance issues.

As a result of our frequent evaluation of all businesses from economic, strategic and risk perspectives ING continues to believe that for business reasons doing business involving certain specified countries should be

 

50


Table of Contents

discontinued, which includes that ING has a policy not to enter into new relationships with clients from these countries and processes remain in place to discontinue existing relationships involving these countries. At present, these countries include Myanmar, North Korea, Sudan, Syria, Iran and Cuba. Each of these countries is subject to a variety of EU, US and other sanctions regimes. Cuba, Iran, Sudan, and Syria are identified by the US as state sponsors of terrorism and are subject to US economic sanctions and export controls.

ING Bank N.V. has continued discussions with its Dutch bank regulator De Nederlandsche Bank (DNB) related to transactions involving persons in countries subject to sanctions by the EU, the US and other authorities and its earlier review of transactions involving sanctioned parties. ING Bank completed the global implementation of enhanced compliance and risk management procedures, and continues working to further strengthen the Financial Economic Crime controls as agreed with DNB.

ING Bank remains in discussions with authorities in the US concerning these matters, including ING Bank’s compliance with Office of Foreign Asset Control requirements. ING Bank has received requests for information from US Government agencies including the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office. ING Bank is cooperating fully with the ongoing investigations and is engaged in discussions to resolve these matters with the US authorities; however, it is not yet possible to reliably estimate the timing or amount of any potential settlement, which could be significant.

Dodd-Frank Act

The US Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which became law on July 21, 2010, represents an effort to comprehensively overhaul the regulation of US financial institutions, and the structure certain US financial markets, in response to the financial market crisis of 2008 and 2009. The Dodd-Frank Act includes a broad range of provisions with varying degrees of potential impact on ING’s US and non-US operations. Many key details of these provisions were left to rulemaking by US financial regulators. Those rules are still in the process of being promulgated, and the final shape of the rules – and thus the ultimate impact on ING’s US and non-US operations – therefore cannot currently be predicted.

The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act created a new agency, the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”), an inter-agency body that is responsible for monitoring the activities of the US financial system, designating systemically significant financial services firms and recommending a framework for substantially increased regulation of such firms, including systemically important nonbank financial companies that could consist of securities firms, insurance companies and other providers of financial services, including non-US companies. If ING or its US operations, or any part thereof, were designated as a systemically significant non-bank financial company by FSOC , then ING and its subsidiaries would be supervised by the Federal Reserve Board and would be subject to heightened prudential standards, including minimum capital requirements, liquidity standards, short-term debt limits, credit exposure requirements, management interlock prohibitions, maintenance of resolution plans, stress testing, and restrictions on proprietary trading. Failure to meet the requisite measures of financial condition applicable to an entity designated by FSOC as a systemically significant non-bank financial company could result in requirements for a capital restoration plan or capital raising; management changes; asset sales; and limitations and restrictions on capital distributions, acquisitions, affiliate transactions and/or product offerings. As we have previously announced, we anticipate divesting ING US (which comprises US Insurance and IM US) through a base case of an IPO. This divestiture, when completed, will substantially reduce the level of activity conducted in the US by ING and its controlled subsidiaries, and, as a result, we believe will substantially reduce the likelihood that ING or any of its US operations, or any part thereof, being designated as a nonbank financial company subject to regulation by the Federal Reserve Board. The designation by FSOC of ING or any part thereof (such as its US operations) as a systemically significant non-bank financial company could materially and adversely impact ING as a whole and/or the parts of ING so designated. We cannot currently predict whether ING or its US operations will be designated as a systemically significant non-bank financial company by FSOC.

Dodd-Frank also imposes a number of other requirements, some of which may have a material impact on our operations and results, as discussed further under “Item 3. Key Information — Risk Factors — We operate in highly regulated industries. There could be an adverse change or increase in the financial services laws and/or regulations governing our business”.

BANKING

Basel II and European Union Standards as currently applied by ING Bank and the introduction of Basel III

DNB, our home supervisor, has given ING permission to use the most sophisticated approaches for solvency reporting under the Financial Supervision Act, the Dutch legislation reflecting the Basel II Framework. DNB has shared information with host regulators of relevant jurisdictions to come to a joint decision. In all jurisdictions where the bank operates through a separate legal entity, ING must meet local Basel requirements as well.

 

51


Table of Contents

ING uses the Advanced IRB Approach for credit risk, an internal VaR model for its trading book exposures and the Advanced Measurement Approach for operational risk. During 2008 a Basel I regulatory floor of 90%, in 2009, 2010 and 2011 a floor of 80%, still applied. (A small number of portfolios are still reported under the Standardized Approach.

The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision has announced higher global minimum capital standards for banks, and has introduced a new global liquidity standard and a new leverage ratio. The Committee’s package of reforms, collectively referred to as the “Basel III” rules, will, among other requirements, increase the amount of common equity required to be held by subject banking institutions, prescribe the amount of liquid assets and the long term funding a subject banking institution must hold at any given moment, and limit leverage . Banks will be required to hold a “capital conservation buffer” to withstand future periods of stress such that the total Tier 1 common equity ratio, when fully phased in on January 1, 2019, will rise to 7%. Basel III also introduces a “countercyclical buffer” as an extension of the capital conservation buffer, which permits national regulators to require banks to hold more capital during periods of high credit growth (to strengthen capital reserves and moderate the debt markets). Further, Basel III calls for stricter definitions of capital that will have the effect of disqualifying many hybrid securities, potentially including those issued by the Group, from inclusion in regulatory capital, as well as the higher capital requirements for trading, derivative and securitization activities to be introduced at the end of 2011 as part of a number of reforms to the Basel II framework. In addition, the Basel Committee and Financial Stability Board (FSB) are currently considering measures that may have the effect of requiring higher loss absorbency capacity, liquidity surcharges, exposure limits and special resolution regimes for “systemically important financial institutions” (SIFIs) and so-called “Global” SIFIs (G-SIFIs), in addition to the Basel III requirements otherwise applicable to most financial institutions. ING has been designated as a G-SIFI.

For European banks these Basel III requirements will be implemented through the Capital Requirement Directive (CRD) IV, which might deviate in its final state from the original Basel III requirements. While the full impact of the new Basel III rules, and any additional requirements for SIFIs or G-SIFIs if and as applicable to the Group, will depend on how they are implemented by national regulators, including the extent to which regulators and supervisors can set more stringent limits and additional capital requirements or surcharges, as well as on the economic and financial environment at the time of implementation and beyond, we expect these rules can have a material impact on ING’s operations and financial condition and may require the Group to seek additional capital

ING Bank files consolidated quarterly and annual reports of its financial position and results with DNB in the Netherlands. ING Bank’s independent auditors audit these reports on an annual basis

Americas

United States

ING Bank has a limited direct presence in the United States through the facility of the ING Bank Representative Office in New York. Although the office’s activities are strictly limited to essentially that of a marketing agent of bank products and services and a facilitator (i.e. the office may not take deposits or execute any transactions), the office is subject to the regulation of the State of New York Banking Department and the Federal Reserve. ING Bank also has a subsidiary in the United States, ING Financial Holdings Corporation, which through several operating subsidiaries offers various financial products, including lending, and financial markets products. These entities do not accept deposits in the United States on their own behalf or on behalf of ING Bank N.V.

ING sold ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation, as further detailed in “Item 4—Information on the Company—Changes in the Composition of the Group — Disposals occurred in 2012”. The transaction closed on February 17, 2012. ING no longer conducts retail banking in the United States.

Anti-Money Laundering Initiatives and countries subject to sanctions

A major focus of governmental policy on financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”) substantially broadened the scope of U.S. anti-money laundering laws and regulations by imposing significant new compliance and due diligence obligations, creating new crimes and penalties and expanding the extra-territorial jurisdiction of the United States. The U.S. Treasury Department has issued a number of implementing regulations, which apply various requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act to financial institutions such as our

 

52


Table of Contents

bank, insurance, broker-dealer and investment adviser subsidiaries and mutual funds advised or sponsored by our subsidiaries. Those regulations impose obligations on financial institutions to maintain appropriate policies, procedures and controls to detect, prevent and report money laundering and terrorist financing and to verify the identity of their customers. In addition, the bank regulatory agencies are imposing heightened standards, and law enforcement authorities have been taking a more active role. Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could have serious legal and reputation consequences for the institution.

Financial institutions continue to be closely scrutinized by regulatory authorities, governmental bodies, shareholders, rating agencies, customers and others to ensure they comply with the relevant laws, regulations, standards and expectations. Bank and insurance regulators and other supervisory authorities in Europe, the US and elsewhere continue to oversee the activities of financial institutions to ensure that they operate with integrity and conduct business in an efficient, orderly and transparent manner. ING seeks to meet the standards and expectations of regulatory authorities and other interested parties through a number of initiatives and activities, including scrutinizing account holder information, payment processing and other transactions to support compliance with regulations governing money laundering, economic and trade sanctions, bribery and other corrupt practices. The failure or alleged failure by ING to meet applicable standards in these areas could result in, among other things, suspension or revocation of ING’s licenses, cease and desist orders, fines, civil or criminal penalties and other disciplinary action which could materially damage ING’s reputation and financial condition, and accordingly ING’s primary focus is to support good business practice through its Business Principles and group policies. Over the past years ING has significantly increased its Compliance efforts, including a major staff increase, amendment of key policies and guidelines and the international rollout of several programmes for education, awareness and monitoring of compliance issues.

As a result of our frequent evaluation of all businesses from economic, strategic and risk perspectives ING continues to believe that for business reasons doing business involving certain specified countries should be discontinued, which includes that ING has a policy not to enter into new relationships with clients from these countries and processes remain in place to discontinue existing relationships involving these countries. At present, these countries include Myanmar, North Korea, Sudan, Syria, Iran and Cuba. Each of these countries is subject to a variety of EU, US and other sanctions regimes. Cuba, Iran, Sudan, and Syria are identified by the US as state sponsors of terrorism and are subject to US economic sanctions and export controls.

Regulatory measures and law enforcement agencies investigations

ING Bank N.V. has continued discussions with its Dutch bank regulator De Nederlandsche Bank (DNB) related to transactions involving persons in countries subject to sanctions by the EU, the US and other authorities and its earlier review of transactions involving sanctioned parties. ING Bank completed the global implementation of enhanced compliance and risk management procedures, and continues working to further strengthen the Financial Economic Crime controls as agreed with DNB.

ING Bank remains in discussions with authorities in the US concerning these matters, including ING Bank’s compliance with Office of Foreign Asset Control requirements. ING Bank has received requests for information from US Government agencies including the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office. ING Bank is cooperating fully with the ongoing investigations and is engaged in discussions to resolve these matters with the US authorities; however, it is not yet possible to reliably estimate the timing or amount of any potential settlement, which could be significant.

Canada

ING Bank of Canada (“ING Direct Canada”) is a federally regulated financial institution that is subject to the supervision of the Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions (“OSFI”), which is the primary supervisor of federally chartered financial institutions (including banks and insurance companies) and federally administered pension plans. Our regulators are closely monitoring the activities of financial institutions with a focus on ensuring the stability and integrity of the banking system, including issues such as: capital adequacy, consumer protection and transparency. In particular, legislation has been introduced to ensure plain language is used in disclosure for deposit and lending products. OSFI has communicated its expectations regarding capital management and planning for banks. In addition, Canada maintains a robust anti-money laundering regime where financial institutions are required to know and monitor their customers and their transactions.

ING Direct Canada manufactures and sells mutual funds through its wholly-owned subsidiaries. ING Direct Asset Management Limited manages four index-based mutual funds exclusively sold by ING Direct Funds Limited, a registered mutual fund dealer. Both entities are principally regulated by the Ontario Securities Commission. The dealership is also a member of the Mutual Fund Dealers Association, a mandatory self-regulatory body, which governs and oversees the conduct of mutual fund dealers in Canada.

 

53


Table of Contents

Asia/Pacific

Australia

ING’s banking activities are undertaken in Australia by ING Bank (Australia) Limited (“ING Direct”) and ING Bank NV Sydney Branch. Banking activities in Australia are subject to licensing and regulation by the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority (“APRA”) and the Australian Securities and Investments Commission (“ASIC”). In addition ING entities are required to comply with the requirements under the Anti Money Laundering and Counter Terrorism Financing Act that is subject to regulatory compliance oversight by the Australian Transaction Reports and Analysis Centre (“AUSTRAC”).

APRA is responsible for the prudential regulation of banks and other deposit taking institutions, life and general insurance companies, superannuation funds and Retirement Savings Account Providers. ASIC regulates corporate entities, markets, financial services and consumer credit activities. ASIC’s aim is to protect markets and consumers from manipulation, deception and unfair practices and also promote confident participation in the financial system.

ING Direct is an Australian incorporated subsidiary which holds a Banking Licence, an Australian Financial Services licence (“AFSL”) and Australian Credit License (“ACL”). As ING Direct provides banking products and services to retail customers it is subject to stringent legislative and regulatory disclosure and conduct requirements. ING Direct must demonstrate compliance as a condition to maintaining its AFSL and ACL. As an Australian incorporated subsidiary, ING Direct is also required to comply with corporate disclosure requirements and securities exchange listing requirements.

ING Bank N.V., Sydney Branch is not an Australian incorporated legal entity. ING Bank N.V., Sydney Branch holds its own AFSL which is limited to the provision of financial services to wholesale clients.

INSURANCE

Europe

Insurance companies in the EU are subject to supervision by insurance supervisory authorities in their home country. This principle of “home country control” was established in a series of directives adopted by the EU, which we refer to as the “1992 Insurance Directives”. In the Netherlands, DNB monitors compliance with applicable regulations, the capital base of the insurer and its actuarial reserves, as well as the assets of the insurer, which support such reserves. Pursuant to the 1992 EU Directives, ING may also conduct business directly, or through foreign branches, in all the other jurisdictions of the EU, without being subject to licensing requirements under the laws of the other EU member-states, though it has to deal with local legislation and regulation in all the European countries where it is active.

ING Insurance’s life and non-life subsidiaries in the EU are required to file detailed audited annual reports with their home country insurance supervisory authority. These reports are audited by ING Insurance’s independent auditors and include balance sheets, profit and loss statements, actuarial statements and other financial information. The authorizations granted by the insurance supervisory authorities stipulate the classes of business that an insurer may write an insurance policy for, and is required for every proposed new class of business. In addition, the home country insurance supervisory authority may require an insurer to submit any other information it requests and may conduct an audit at any time.

On the basis of the EU directives, European life insurance companies are required to maintain at least a shareholders’ equity level of generally 4% of insurance reserves (1% of separate account reserves), plus 0.3% of the amount at risk under insurance policies. The required shareholders’ equity level for Dutch non-life insurers is the greater of two calculations: one based on premiums and the other on claims.

The European Commission, jointly with Member States and EIOPA (European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority), is carrying out a fundamental review of the regulatory regime of the insurance industry; the Solvency II project. Solvency II will introduce economic risk-based solvency requirements across all EU Member States. These new solvency requirements will be more risk-sensitive and more sophisticated than in the past, thus enabling a better coverage of the real risks run by any particular insurer. Also, Solvency II will introduce new governance requirements and requirements relating to supervisory reporting and disclosure. The directive

 

54


Table of Contents

(level 1 text) was approved of by the Council on November 25, 2009. As regards the level 2 text (delegated acts by the European Commission and/or implementing technical standards by EIOPA and the European Commission) and level 3 text (guidance by EIOPA), the work is steadily advancing. Formally, Member States are still required to apply Solvency II as from October 31, 2012. Due to the complexity of the requirements, differences of opinion between insurers, regulators and other stakeholders and the sovereign debt crisis, the Solvency II process moved along more slowly than the insurance industry had hoped for. As a result, the (full) implementation date of Solvency II is likely to be delayed to January 1, 2014 or later. The European Parliament is expected to vote in the spring of 2012 on a proposal to postpone the implementation of Solvency II as well as other issues. For more information, see “Item 3. Key Information-Risk Factors-We operate in highly regulated industries. There could be an adverse change or increase in the financial services laws and/or regulations governing our business-Solvency II”.

Americas

United States

ING Group’s United States insurance subsidiaries are subject to comprehensive and detailed regulation of their activities under U.S. state and federal laws. Supervisory agencies in various states have broad powers to grant or revoke licenses to conduct business, regulate trade practices, license agents, approve policy forms and certain premium rates, set standards for capital and reserve requirements, determine the form and content of required financial reports, examine insurance companies, require investment portfolio diversification and prescribe the type and amount of permitted investments. Insurance companies are subject to a mandatory annual audit of their statutory basis financial statements by an independent certified public accountant, and in addition, are subject to an insurance department financial condition examination by their state of domicile approximately every three to five years.

ING Insurance’s U.S. operations are subject to Risk Based Capital (“RBC”) guidelines which provide a method to measure the adjusted capital (statutory capital and surplus plus other adjustments) that insurance companies should maintain, taking into account the risk characteristics of the company’s investments and products. The RBC guidelines are used by state insurance regulators as an early warning regulatory tool to identify possibly inadequately capitalized insurers which may need additional regulatory oversight. Each of the companies comprising ING Insurance’s U.S. operations was above its target and statutory minimum RBC ratios at year-end 2011.

Insurance holding company statutes and regulations of each insurer’s state of domicile require periodic disclosure concerning the ultimate controlling person (i.e. the corporation or individual that controls the insurer). Such statutes also impose various limitations on investments in, or transactions with, affiliates and may require prior approval of the payment of certain dividends by the domestic insurer to its immediate parent company. ING is subject, by virtue of its ownership of U.S. insurance companies, to certain of these statutes and regulations.

Although the U.S. federal government generally does not directly regulate the insurance business, many federal laws affect the insurance business in a variety of ways, including federal privacy legislation which requires safeguarding and maintaining the confidentiality of customer information, federal tax laws relating to insurance and annuity product taxation, and the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 requiring, among other things, the establishment of anti-money laundering monitoring programs. In addition, a number of the products issued by ING Group’s U.S. insurance companies are regulated as securities under state and federal law. Finally, a variety of U.S. retirement savings products and services may be subject to Department of Labor regulation under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”). Finally, the Dodd Frank Act (described above) and the regulations that are promulgated to implement it could have an impact on ING’s US insurance operations if they are deemed “systematically significant”. The newly created Federal Insurance Office within the Treasury Department is not expected to act as a federal domestic insurance regulator, but it could nonetheless impact ING’s US insurance operations if it negotiates binding international insurance agreements affecting US carriers.

Canada

Our U.S. insurance businesses that are licensed in Canada are subject to regulation by the Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions (“OSFI”).

Mexico

ING’s mortgage business in Mexico is subject to general rules and detailed regulations under federal law and is supervised by the National Banking and Securities Commission (“CNBV”). The main legal framework applicable to the mortgage business in Mexico are regulations issued by the CNBV.

 

55


Table of Contents

The Commerce Code, the Mercantile Companies Law, the Foreign Investment Law, Income Tax Laws and regulations issued by the Ministry of Finance are also applicable to these entities.

The Ministry of Finance has authority to grant or revoke licenses to conduct mortgage businesses in Mexico and to prescribe rules on anti-money laundering. The CNBV regulates ING business activities through inspection and ongoing supervision, and have issued regulations that provide specific rules for its operations, including capital requirements and reserves, financial information standards and reporting, corporate governance guidelines, investment rules, risk management and related party transactions. Mortgage companies are also subject to a mandatory annual audit of their financial statements and tax reports by independent auditors.

Argentina

In May 2009, ING sold 100% of its stake in the insurance annuities business in Argentina.

ING is in the process of liquidating Nationale-Nederlanden Cía de Seguros de Vida (INGIA) a legacy company which is a branch of the Nationale-Nederlanden Life in Holland. In late 2004, ING sold the insurance portfolio of this company. Currently INGIA is winding down the entire business which is in the final stage of liquidation process.

Private pension fund businesses in Argentina were nationalized on December 9, 2008, pursuant to law 26.425. This law ordered all Private Pension Fund Managers (“AFJP”) to transfer the pension funds they then held to the ANSES (“Administración Nacional de la Seguridad Social”), the Argentine State social security system. As a result of the nationalization of the Argentine pension fund system, ANSES has taken over control of the private pension funds and ING’s Argentine AFJP will ultimately be liquidated. During this liquidation process, the AFJP is regulated by the General Inspection of Justice (“Inspección General de Justicia”).

Peru, Chile, Colombia, Uruguay

ING completed the sale of its pensions, life insurance and investment management operations in Peru, Chile, Colombia and Uruguay (and in Mexico) on December 29, 2011, as further detailed in “Item 4—Information on the Company—Changes in the Composition of the Group — Disposals effective in 2011 — Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations”.

Asia/Pacific

While the insurance regulations in Asia Pacific vary from country to country, these regulations are designed to protect the interests of policyholders. Most jurisdictions in which ING operate have regulations governing solvency standards, capital and reserves level, permitted investments, business conduct, sales intermediaries licensing and sales practices, policy forms and, for certain lines of insurance, approval or filing of rates. In certain jurisdictions, regulations limit sales commissions and certain marketing expenses. In general, insurers are required to file detailed financial statements with their regulators. Regulators have power to conduct regular or specific examinations of the insurers’ operations and accounts and request for information from the insurers.

Japan

ING Group’s life insurance subsidiary in Japan is subject to the supervision of the Financial Services Agency, the chief regulator in Japan, the rules and regulations as stipulated by the Insurance Law, Insurance Business Law and ordinances of the Cabinet Office. The affairs handled by the Financial Services Agency include, among others, planning and policymaking concerning financial systems and the inspection and supervision of private sector financial institutions including insurance companies.

New products, revision of existing products, etc. require approval by the Financial Services Agency. The Cabinet Office ordinances stipulate the types and proportions of assets in which an insurance company can invest. The Insurance Business Law further requires that an insurance company set aside a liability reserve to provide for the fulfillment of the level of expected mortality and other assumptions that are applied in calculating liability reserves for long-term contracts. In addition to the required audit by external auditors, insurance companies are required to appoint a corporate actuary and have such corporate actuary be involved in the method of calculating premiums and other actuarial, accounting and compliance matters.

 

56


Table of Contents

South Korea

ING Group’s South Korean insurance companies are subject to supervision by the Financial Services Commission (“FSC”) and its executive arm, the Financial Supervisory Service (“FSS”), the main financial regulator in Korea. In addition, insurance companies are - as all companies doing business in Korea—subject to the Korea Fair Trade Commission (“KFTC”)’s authority on antitrust and unfair trade matters. Another body, the Korean Insurance Development Institute (“KIDI”) established under the Insurance Business Law (“IBL”), calculates net insurance premium rates that insurance companies can apply and reports such premium rates to the FSC. The KIDI also confirms insurance companies’ methods of calculating insurance premiums and the liability reserve in relation to new products and revisions of existing products. Since April 2007, the FSS adopted the Risk Assessment and Application System to strengthen insurance risk management system of insurance companies. The IBL has been amended comprehensively as of January 2011, to strengthen consumer protection while liberalizing regulation on asset management and product development process, among others.

Malaysia

ING Group’s Malaysian insurance subsidiary is subject to the supervision of the Central Bank of Malaysia (“BNM”). Regulation of the Malaysian insurance industry covers licensing, policy development, administration and enforcement of the industry, actuarial function and consumer education and complaints handling. In addition, BNM introduced the Risk-Based Capital Framework for insurers with effect from January 1, 2009 to better align the regulatory capital requirements with the underlying risk exposure of each individual insurer.

BROKER-DEALER AND INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT ACTIVITIES

Americas

United States

ING’s broker-dealer entities in the United States are regulated by the Securities and Exchange Commission, the states in which they operate, and the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”), the self-regulatory organization that succeeded to the securities industry self-regulatory functions of the National Association of Securities Dealers and the New York Stock Exchange. The primary governing statutes for such entities are the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and state statutes and regulations, as applicable. These and other laws, and the regulations promulgated thereunder, impose requirements (among others) regarding minimum net capital, safeguarding of customer assets, protection and use of material, non-public (inside) information, record-keeping requirements, supervision of employee activities, credit to customers, suitability determinations in the context of recommending transactions to customers, clearance and settlement procedures and anti-money laundering standards and procedures. The rules of FINRA in some respects duplicate the above-mentioned legal requirements, but also impose requirements specific to the marketplaces that FINRA oversees. For example, FINRA imposes requirements relating to activities by market-makers in the over-the-counter market in equity securities and requirements regarding transactions effected in its listed securities market.

Certain ING entities in the United States (including certain of its broker-dealers) also act in the capacity of a federally registered investment advisor (i.e., providing investment advice to customers for a fee), and are governed in such activities by the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended. Moreover, certain ING entities manage registered investment companies (such as mutual funds) and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, regulates the governance and activities of those funds. These laws impose, among other things, record-keeping and disclosure requirements on ING in the context of such activities. Moreover, the laws impose restrictions on transactions or require disclosure of transactions involving advisory clients and the advisor or the advisors’ affiliates, as well as transactions between advisory clients. In addition, ERISA imposes certain obligations on investment advisors managing employee plan assets as defined in the Act.

Other federal laws affect ING’s US financial services businesses in a variety of ways, including federal and state privacy legislation that requires safeguarding and confidentiality of customer information, federal tax laws, and the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 requiring, among other things, the establishment of anti-money laundering monitoring programs. Certain sales and solicitation practices are also subject to US Department of Labor and state regulation and disclosure obligations as well.

The failure of ING to comply with these various requirements could result in civil and criminal sanctions and administrative penalties imposed by the US federal or state governments or agencies, or civil sanctions and administrative penalties imposed by the Securities and Exchange Commission, the state securities regulators, or FINRA. Moreover, employees who are found to have participated in the violations, and the managers of these employees, also may be subject to penalties by governmental and self-regulatory agencies.

 

57


Table of Contents

ING DIRECT Investing, Inc., a US retail broker, was indirectly sold to Capital One Financial Corporation as part of the ING Direct USA transaction, which closed on February 17, 2012, as further detailed in “Item 4—Information on the Company—Changes in the Composition of the Group — Disposals occurred in 2012”.

 

58


Table of Contents

COMPETITION

ING is a global financial institution of Dutch origin with presence in more than 40 countries, currently offering banking, investments, life insurance and retirement services to meet the needs of a broad customer base. Going forward, we will concentrate on our position as a strong European bank with attractive home market positions in Northern Europe and growth options in Central and Eastern Europe and Asia, while creating an optimal base for independent futures for our insurance operations (including investment management). We strive to meet our customers’ expectations by providing the right products and services to the right customers, for the right reasons and for the right price.

The mature markets of the Netherlands, Belgium, the Rest of Europe, North America and Australia are characterised by a high degree of competition. In emerging markets the degree of competition between companies from mature markets and local players has risen rapidly in the past few years In both mature and emerging markets ING and its competitors have sought to form alliances, mergers or strategic relationships with local institutions, which are becoming more and more sophisticated and competitive.

During the financial crisis of 2008/2009, governments around the globe undertook exceptional measures to support financial institutions. ING’s management feels that these measures were important and necessary steps to restore confidence and bring stability and certainty to the financial system. ING itself entered into two transactions with the Dutch State: on the issuance of EUR 10 billion of Core Tier 1 Securities to the Dutch State (October 2008) and an Illiquid-Assets Back-up Facility (January 2009) with respect to 80% of ING’s Alt-A residential mortgage backed securities.

Under European state-aid rules, all state-supported financial institutions need to demonstrate their long-term viability and take actions to prevent undue distortions of competition. As a result, and parallel to the introduction and implementation of the ‘Back to Basics’ programme, ING was also required to develop and submit a restructuring plan to the European Commission (EC). The negotiations with the EC on the Restructuring Plan have acted as a catalyst to accelerate the separation of our banking and insurance operations.

However, ING has had to accept a number of commitments to obtain the EC’s approval for the transactions with the Dutch State. One of these involved the divestment of ING Direct USA. Also as part of the Restructuring Plan, a new company named WestlandUtrecht Bank (WUB) was created in the Dutch retail market, by combining the Interadvies banking division (including Westland Utrecht and the mortgage activities of Nationale-Nederlanden) and the consumer lending portfolio of ING Retail. WUB became commercially independent of ING in November 2010 after which options were further explored in 2011 to divest the business. Furthermore, ING has had to refrain from being a price leader within the European Union for certain retail and small and medium-sized enterprise banking products, and has been obliged to refrain from acquisitions of financial institutions and acquisitions that would slow down the repayment of the Core Tier 1 Securities.

In January 2010, ING filed an appeal with the General Court of the European Union against specific elements of the European Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009 which approved the state aid received and ING’s Restructuring Plan. ING requested the Court to annul the decision of the European Commission insofar:

 

 

as it states that the agreement between ING and the Dutch State concerning a reduction of the repayment premium for the first EUR 5 billion tranche of Core Tier 1 Securities leads to additional state aid of EUR 2 billion;

 

 

as the Commission has subjected the approval of the state aid to the acceptance of price leadership bans;

 

 

as the Commission has subjected the approval of the state aid to restructuring requirements that go beyond what is proportionate.

The Dutch State joined ING in 2010 in its appeal with the General Court to contest the EC decision insofar as it qualifies the core Tier 1 amendment as additional state aid. The Dutch Central Bank intervened in the proceedings in support of ING’s appeal. In July 2011, oral arguments of the appeal case were heard by the Court. The ruling of the Court was on March 2, 2012. ING welcomes the judgment to partially annul the EC decision. From March 2, ING has been in the process of carefully assessing the full judgment as well as its consequences.

Nevertheless, we took decisive steps to meet the restructuring demands which are part of the Restructuring Plan which we submitted to the EC in late 2009 in order to obtain approval of state aid received. In June 2011, we reached an agreement to sell ING Direct USA, meeting one of the principal restructuring requirements. The sale of ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation (“Capital One”), a leading US-based financial holding company was completed in February 2012. In connection with this sale, ING reached an agreement with the Dutch State to amend the structure of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (“IABF”) in June 2011. The amendment serves to delink the IABF from ING Direct USA by interposing ING Bank as a counterparty for the

 

59


Table of Contents

Dutch State. The 20% of the Alt-A portfolio not covered by the IABF remained on the balance sheet of ING Direct USA and was transferred to Capital One as part of the sale of ING Direct USA. In order to ensure continued alignment between the interests of ING and the Dutch State with regard to the Alt-A portfolio, ING will provide a counter guarantee to the Dutch State covering 25% of the 80%exposure of the Dutch State. This guarantee will cover realised cash losses if these exceed the 35.5% that is implied by the market value of the portfolio at the time the divestment of ING Direct USA was announced. This adjustment will therefore lower the risk exposure for the Dutch State. The potential capital and P&L impact of the alignment for ING Bank is expected to be limited. ING’s commercial finance activities and ING’s insurance/investment management operations in the United States have not been materially affected by this transaction.

The total amount repaid on the Core Tier 1 Securities to the Dutch State by the end of 2011 was EUR 7 billion in principal, out of a total capital support of EUR 10 billion. Including interest and premium, the payments made to the Dutch State by the end of 2011 reached a total of EUR 9 billion. Ideally we would like to complete the state repayment in 2012, however given the current challenging financial environment in the eurozone and increasing regulatory capital requirements we currently intend to take a cautious approach and maintain strong capital ratios as we build towards Basel III and satisfy other regulatory requirements.

The financial sector faced many challenges in 2011. These include the many regulatory changes for the banking and insurance sectors. A massive volume of new regulations needs to be implemented within a short period of time. ING recognises and endorses the importance of bolstering the stability of the financial system but we are concerned that there is no universal international application because national interests all too often prevail. Furthermore, it is essential that the impact on the economy and on customers is assessed very carefully when new regulations are introduced. It is important that financial institutions can continue to carry out their fundamental role in the economy effectively. One of our primary concerns, therefore, is the increasing number of national initiatives being taken by different member states on matters that should, for reasons of maintaining a level playing field and enhancing of the European Single Market, be dealt with at the European level. Clear examples of such steps being taken by some states but not others are the introduction of national bank levies, additional capital buffers for domestic SIFIs (Systemically Important Financial Institutions) and the ring-fencing of retail-deposit-taking banks. Banks based in those countries moving ahead of international regulation can be placed at a competitive disadvantage.

Against a backdrop of a deteriorating economy and increasing turmoil in the financial markets, we reported good performance in 2011. Thanks to a number of strategic measures, our capital position is strong. We have sold a number of operations to simplify our portfolio. We divested ING Direct USA and the Latin American insurance and investment management operations as is required by the European Commission. We have boosted our efficiency and kept our costs in check. With income under pressure, it is important that we maintain our competitive position by further driving down our costs and adapting to market conditions.

In the long run, competition in the financial services industry in both mature and emerging markets will continue to be based on factors like customer service, price, products offered, financial strength, brand recognition, scope of distribution systems and, in the case of investment-linked insurance products and asset management services, investment performance,. Management believes that over the coming years ING’s major competitors will be the leading global European, American and Asian commercial banks, insurance companies, asset management and other financial-services companies. However, competition has become less global and more regional. In the last few years financial services providers around the world have increasingly focused their efforts on certain home markets. ING is no exception to this.

ING maintains leading banking positions in its home markets of the Netherlands, Belgium, Luxemburg, Germany and Poland. Furthermore, ING has key positions in other Western, Central and Eastern Europe and Turkey. This is coupled with options outside of Europe which should give ING Bank interesting growth potential in the long term. The long term ambition is to be a strong Northern European Bank with a low-risk balance sheet producing a competitive Return on (IFRS) Equity of 10 to 13% through low costs and low risk. ING Bank has a well-known brand and it uses the NPS (Net Promoter Score) methodology as a tool to increase customer centricity and to improve ways of doing business. The bank is used to operating in lean, competitive markets which has made us leaders in innovative distribution. It has a leading position in internet banking with a ‘direct first, advice when needed’ model and a relationship-driven commercial bank offering competitive products in terms of price, efficiency and effectiveness. Retail Banking has strong positions in the mature markets of the Benelux, Western Europe, Canada and Australia. It is well placed to capture opportunities in the high-growth markets of Central Europe and Asia. Our commercial bank has strengthened its position substantially in the Benelux in recent years, and we are now the leading commercial bank in the Benelux, as well as a leading player in CEE and a top-10 global player in Structured Finance. Going forward, the bank currently intends to focus on restoring trust and customer centricity, on operational excellence and optimising its balance sheet to meet its strategic goals.

 

60


Table of Contents

The main priorities for the insurance and investment management businesses are improving performance and optimising returns and value. In 2011 the businesses made good progress on these priorities. Going forward, ING Insurance/Investment Management will continue to focus on its customers and distributors by providing exemplary products and service, as it restructures in preparation for a stand-alone future. We continued to work towards the full physical and organisational separation of the banking and insurance/investment management activities for increased transparency and simplicity. In 2011 we have been laying the groundwork for the original base case of two IPOs (initial public offerings) of our insurance and investment management activities: one for our US operations and one for our European and Asian activities. However, on January 12, 2012 we announced an update on the restructuring of the insurance and investment management businesses. Due to the uncertain economic outlook and volatile markets, especially in Europe, ING is currently reviewing other strategic options for its Asian insurance and investment management businesses. For the European insurance/investment management businesses, ING is currently reviewing preparations for a stand-alone future, including the possibility of an IPO. We are also continuing to prepare for the base case of an IPO for the US insurance/ investment management businesses. ING is committed to conducting these processes with the utmost diligence in the interests of all stakeholders, including customers, employees, distribution partners and shareholders.

RATINGS

We rely upon the short-term and long-term debt capital markets for funding, and the cost and availability of debt financing is significantly influenced by our credit ratings. Credit ratings may also be important to customers and counterparties when we are competing in certain markets.

ING Groep N.V.’s long-term senior debt is rated “A” (with a stable outlook) by Standard & Poor’s Ratings Service (“Standard & Poor’s”), a division of the McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. ING Groep N.V.’s long-term senior debt is rated “A1” (under review) by Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”). ING Groep N.V.’s long term senior debt is rated “A” (with a stable outlook) by Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”).

ING Verzekeringen N.V.’s long-term senior debt is rated “A-” (with a negative outlook) by Standard & Poor’s and “Baa2” (with a developing outlook) by Moody’s. Fitch rated ING Verzekeringen N.V.’s long-term senior debt “A-” (with a negative outlook).

ING Bank N.V.’s long-term senior debt held a “A+” (with a stable outlook) rating by Standard & Poor’s. Moody’s rated ING Bank N.V.’s long-term senior debt at “Aa3” (under review). Finally, ING Bank N.V.’s long-term senior debt was rated “A+” (with a stable outlook) by Fitch Ratings, Ltd.

ING Verzekeringen N.V.’s short-term senior debt is rated “A-2” by Standard & Poor’s and Prime-2 (P-2) by Moody’s. ING Verzekeringen held a F2 rating by Fitch.

ING Bank N.V.’s short-term senior debt held a rating of “A-1” by Standard & Poor’s and Prime-1 (P-1) by Moody’s. Fitch rated ING Bank N.V.’s short-term senior debt “F1+”.

All ratings are provided as of March 12, 2012, and are still current at date of filing.

DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTY

ING predominantly leases the land and buildings used in the normal course of its business. In addition, ING has part of its investment portfolio invested in land and buildings. Management believes that ING’s facilities are adequate for its present needs in all material respects.

 

Item 4A. Unresolved Staff comments

None.

 

61


Table of Contents
Item 5. Operating and financial review and prospects

The following review and prospects should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the related Notes thereto included elsewhere herein. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS-IASB. Unless otherwise indicated, financial information for ING Group included herein is presented on a consolidated basis under IFRS-IASB.

FACTORS AFFECTING RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

ING Group’s results of operations are affected by demographics (particularly with respect to life insurance) and by a variety of market conditions, including economic cycles, banking industry cycles and fluctuations in stock markets, interest and foreign exchange rates. See “Item 3. Key information—Risk Factors” for more factors that can impact ING Group’s results of operations.

Financial environment

Major changes in the external environment had an impact on ING in 2011, the most significant being the deepening of the euro sovereign debt crisis in the eurozone which created an extremely challenging economic and financial market environment in the second half of the year. Consequently international capital and money markets were not functioning in the manner they would in more normal circumstances. This had repercussions (for us, our industry and the broader economy) especially in Europe where funding for governments and financial institutions dried up in certain markets. For details regarding the impact of the credit and liquidity crisis on ING’s assets and results reference is made to the section “Risk Management” and Note 4 in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements, which also includes details on the sovereign debt crisis.

General market conditions

Demographic studies suggest that over the next decade there will be growth in the number of individuals who enter the age group that management believes is most likely to purchase retirement-oriented life insurance products in ING’s principal life insurance markets in the Netherlands, the Rest of Europe, the United States, Asia and Australia. In addition, in a number of its European markets, including the Netherlands, retirement, medical and other social benefits previously provided by the government have been, or in the coming years are expected to be, curtailed. Management believes this will increase opportunities for private sector providers of life insurance, health, pension and other social benefits-related insurance products. Management believes that ING Insurance’s distribution networks, the quality and diversity of its products and its investment management expertise in each of these markets, position ING Insurance to benefit from these developments. In addition, the emerging markets in Central and Eastern Europe and Asia, in which ING Insurance has insurance operations, generally have lower gross domestic products per capita and gross insurance premiums per capita than the countries in Western Europe and North America in which ING Insurance has insurance operations. Management believes that insurance operations in these emerging markets provide ING Insurance with the market presence which will allow it to take advantage of anticipated growth in these regions. In addition, conditions in the non-life insurance markets in which ING Insurance operates are cyclical, and characterized by periods of price competition, fluctuations in underwriting results, and the occurrence of unpredictable weather-related and other losses.

Fluctuations in equity markets

Our insurance and asset management operations are exposed to fluctuations in equity markets. Our overall investment return and fee income from equity-linked products are influenced by equity markets. The fees we charge for managing portfolios are often based on performance and value of the portfolio. In addition, fluctuations in equity markets may affect sales of life and pension products, unit-linked products, including variable business and may increase the amount of withdrawals which will reduce related management fees. In addition, our direct shareholdings that are classified as investments are exposed to fluctuations in equity markets. The securities we hold may become impaired in the case of a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost. Our banking operations are exposed to fluctuations in equity markets. ING Bank maintains an internationally diversified and mainly client-related trading portfolio. Accordingly, market downturns are likely to lead to declines in securities trading and brokerage activities which we execute for customers and therefore to a decline in related commissions and trading results. In addition to this, ING Bank also maintains equity investments in its own non-trading books. Fluctuations in equity markets may affect the value of these investments.

Fluctuations in interest rates

Our insurance operations are exposed to fluctuations in interest rates through impacts on sales and surrenders of life insurance and annuity products. Declining interest rates may impact profitability as a result of a reduced spread between the guaranteed interest rates to policyholders and the investment returns on fixed interest

 

62


Table of Contents

investments. Declining interest rates may also affect the results of our reserve adequacy testing which may in turn result in reserve strengthening. Rising interest rates may increase the surrender of policies which may require liquidation of fixed interest investments at unfavorable market prices. This could result in realized investment losses. Our banking operations are exposed to fluctuations in interest rates. Our management of interest rate sensitivity affects the results of our banking operations. Interest rate sensitivity refers to the relationship between changes in market interest rates on the one hand and on the other hand to changes in both net interest income and the results of our trading activities for our own account. Both the composition of our banking assets and liabilities and the fact that interest rate changes may affect client behavior in a different way than assumed in our internal models result in a mismatch which causes the banking operations’ net interest income and trading results to be affected by changes in interest rates.

Fluctuations in exchange rates

ING Group is exposed to fluctuations in exchange rates. Our management of exchange rate sensitivity affects the results of our operations both through the trading activities for our own account and because that we prepare and publish our consolidated financial statements in euros. Because a substantial portion of our income and expenses are denominated in currencies other than euros, fluctuations in the exchange rates used to translate foreign currencies, particularly the U.S. dollar,the Canadian dollar, the Pound sterling, the Polish zloty, the Australian dollar, the Japanese yen, the Korean won and the Turkish lira into euros will impact our reported results of operations and cash flows from year to year. This exposure is mitigated by the fact that realized results in non-Euro currencies are translated into euro by monthly hedging. See Note 24 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements for a description of our hedging activities with respect to foreign currencies. Fluctuations in exchange rates will also impact the value (denominated in euro) of our investments in our non-Euro reporting subsidiaries. The impact of these fluctuations in exchange rates is mitigated to some extent by the fact that income and related expenses, as well as assets and liabilities, of each of our non-euro reporting subsidiaries are generally denominated in the same currencies. The translation risk is managed by taking into account the effect of translation results on the core Tier-1 ratio.

The weakening of the euro against most currencies during 2011 had a negative impact of EUR 35 million on (underlying) net result. In 2010 and 2009 exchange rates influenced net result, respectively, by EUR 88 million and EUR 184 million positively.

For the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, the year-end exchange rates (which are the rates ING uses in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements for balance sheet items not denominated in euros) and the average quarterly exchange rates (which are the rates ING uses in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements for income statement items and cash flows not denominated in euros) were as follows for the currencies specified below:

 

Average  
     4Q 2011      3Q 2011      2Q 2011      1Q 2011  

U.S. dollar

     1.343         1.417         1.449         1.378   

Australian dollar

     1.327         1.349         1.359         1.357   

Canadian dollar

     1.372         1.395         1.397         1.358   

Pound sterling

     0.857         0.883         0.888         0.865   

Japanese yen

     104.222         110.315         118.177         113.084   

South Korean won

     1,540.686         1,544.925         1,561.218         1,538.012   

Turkish lira

     2,464         2.437         2.275         2.168   

Polish zloty

     4.440         4.141         3.973         3.966   

 

     4Q 2010      3Q 2010      2Q 2010      1Q 2010  

U.S. dollar

     1.347         1.290         1.285         1.386   

Australian dollar

     1.376         1.431         1.450         1.541   

Canadian dollar

     1.371         1.347         1.322         1.452   

Pound sterling

     0.857         0.834         0.856         0.884   

Japanese yen

     110.883         110.502         118.316         126.568   

South Korean won

     1,531.253         1,530.355         1,495.789         1,600.933   

Turkish lira

     2.000         1.957         1.976         2.097   

Polish zloty

     3.999         4.034         3.996         3.997   

 

63


Table of Contents
     4Q 2009      3Q 2009      2Q 2009      1Q 2009  

U.S. dollar

     1.473         1.431         1.371         1.319   

Australian dollar

     1.634         1.702         1.810         1.985   

Canadian dollar

     1.567         1.575         1.608         1.641   

Pound sterling

     0.902         0.874         0.888         0.919   

Japanese yen

     132.199         133.816         133.099         124.067   

South Korean won

     1,723.971         1,761.229         1,775.507         1,829.427   

Turkish lira

     2.210         2.144         2.169         2.160   

Polish zloty

     4.179         4.235         4.506         4.509   

 

     Year-end  
     2011      2010      2009  

U.S. dollar

     1.295         1.338         1.440   

Australian dollar

     1.273         1.314         1.602   

Canadian dollar

     1.320         1.334         1.514   

Pound sterling

     0.836         0.862         0.889   

Japanese yen

     100.196         108.745         133.057   

South Korean won

     1,500.636         1,500.388         1,679.614   

Turkish lira

     2.436         2.067         2.157   

Polish zloty

     4.468         3.959         4.106   

Sovereign Debt Exposures

For information regarding certain sovereign debt exposures, see Note 4 “Investments” of Note 2.1.2 and Note 2.2.1 “Risk Management” to the consolidated annual accounts.

Critical Accounting Policies

See Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

64


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following information should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified by reference to the Group’s consolidated financial statements and other financial information included elsewhere herein. ING Group’s operating segments are based on the management structure of the Group, which is different from its legal structure. ING Group evaluates the results of its operating segments using the financial performance measure called underlying result. Underlying result is defined as result under IFRS-IASB excluding the impact of divestments and special items.

While these excluded items are significant components in understanding and assessing the Group’s consolidated financial performance, ING Group believes that the presentation of underlying result before tax enhances the understanding and comparability of its segment performance by highlighting result before tax attributable to ongoing operations and the underlying profitability of the segment businesses. For example, we believe that trends in the underlying profitability of our segments can be more clearly identified without the effects of the realized gains/losses on divestitures as the timing is largely subject to the Company’s discretion, influenced by market opportunities and ING Group does not believe that they are indicative of future results. Underlying result before tax is not a substitute for result before tax as determined in accordance with IFRS-IASB. ING Group’s definition of underlying result before tax may differ from those used by other companies and may change over time.

For the banking activities underlying result is analysed in a format that is similar to the IFRS profit and loss account.

With regard to insurance activities, ING Group analyses, as of 2011, the underlying result through a margin analysis, which includes the following components:

 

Operating result

 

Non-operating items

Both are analysed into various sub-components. The total of operating result and non-operating items (gains/ losses and impairments, revaluations and market & other impacts) equals underlying result before tax.

To determine the operating result the following non-operating items are adjusted in the reported underlying result before tax:

 

Realised capital gains/losses and impairments on debt and equity securities;

 

Revaluations on assets marked to market through the P&L; and

 

Other non-operating impacts, e.g. provision for guarantees on separate account pension contracts, equity related and other DAC unlocking,Variable Annuities/Fixed Indexed Annuities (“VA/FIA”) Guaranteed benefit Reserve Unlocking and DAC offset on gains/losses on debt securities.

The operating result for the life insurance business is also broken down in expenses and the following sources of income:

 

Investment margin which includes the spread between investment income earned and interest credited to insurance liabilities (excluding market impacts, but including dividends and coupons);

 

Fees and premium-based revenues which includes the portion of life insurance premiums available to cover expenses and profit, fees on deposits and fee income on assets under management (net of guaranteed benefit costs in the United States);

 

Technical margin which includes the margin between costs charged for benefits and incurred benefit costs- it includes mortality, morbidity and surrender results; and

 

Non-modeled which is immaterial and includes parts of the business for which no margins are provided.

As of the fourth quarter of 2010, the Legacy Variable Annuity business in the US has been reported and analysed separately from the other US business in the internal management reporting. Therefore as of October 1, 2010 ING has reported the Insurance US Legacy VA business as a separate business line to improve the transparency of the ongoing business. ING Group’s accounting policy for reserve adequacy as set out in the Accounting policies for the consolidated annual accounts of ING Group requires each segment to be adequate at the 50% confidence level. The separation of the Legacy VA business into a separate segment triggered a charge in the fourth quarter of 2010 to bring reserve adequacy on the new Insurance US Closed Block VA business line to the 50% level. This charge is reflected as a DAC write-down of EUR 975 million before tax. For 2011 the impact of the assumption adjustments includes a charge of EUR 177 million to restore the reserve adequacy of the Insurance US Closed Block VA business line to the 50% level at December 31, 2011. Reference is made to Note 43 and Note 51 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

65


Table of Contents

For further information on underlying result for the banking and insurance activities, as well as the reconciliation of our segment underlying result before tax to our net result, see Note 51 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

GROUP OVERVIEW

The following table sets forth the consolidated underlying results of the operations of ING Group and its banking and insurance operations for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010:

 

     Banking     Insurance     Eliminations 1)      Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011      2010      2011      2010  
     (EUR millions)  

Underlying income:

                   

Gross premium income

         27,198        27,786              27,198         27,786   

Net interest result banking operations

     13,562        13,555            60         93         13,502         13,462   

Commission income

     2,255        2,253        1,515        1,472              3,770         3,725   

Total investment and other income

     (1,345     413        9,352        7,388        291         243         7,716         7,558   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     14,472        16,221        38,066        36,646        350         336         52,187         52,533   

Underlying expenditure:

                   

Underwriting expenditure

         33,087        32,802              33,087         32,802   

Other interest expenses

         910        1,122        350         336         560         786   

Operating expenses (2)

     9,447        9,336        3,731        3,766              13,178         13,102   

Additions to loan loss provision

     1,667        1,742                  1,667         1,742   
  

 

 

   

 

 

                

Other impairments

         24        29              24         29   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total underlying expenditure

     11,114        11,078        37,752        37,719        350         336         48,516         48,461   

Underlying result before tax

     3,358        5,143        314        (1,072           3,671         4,072   

Taxation

     921        1,275        19        (40           940         1,235   

Minority interests

     79        69        4        18              83         87   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     2,358        3,799        291        (1,050           2,649         2,749   

Divestments (3)

     887        481        46        (6           933         474   

Discontinued operations (4)

         1,104        209              1,104         209   

Special items (5)

     281        (340     (228     (725           53         (1,065
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net result

     3,526        3,940        1,212        (1,572           4,740         2,367   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1)

After elimination of certain intercompany transactions between the banking operations and the insurance operations

2)

Including Intangibles amortisation and impairments in banking operations

3)

Divestments Bank: sale REIM (EUR 453 million, 2011, EUR 23 million, 2010), sale Car Lease (EUR 405 million, 2011, EUR 57 million, 2010), sale Philippines (EUR 29 million, 2011) sale Private Banking Swiss (EUR 73 million, 2010), sale Private Banking Asia (EUR 334 million, 2010), sale Summit Canada (EUR (6) million, 2010). Divestments Insurance: sale Latin America (EUR 995 million, 2011), sale IM Australia (EUR 26 million, 2011), Sale PALIC China (EUR 29 million, 2011), Other (sale EUR (5) million, 2011), sale joint-venture Brasil (EUR 22 million, 2010) sale Industry Pension Funds (EUR 4 million, 2010), sale Greece Non-life (EUR (4) million, 2010), sale US (EUR (12) million, 2010), sale Argentina (EUR 4 million, 2011, EUR (17) million, 2010.

4)

Reference is made to Note 25 “Discontinued operations” for more information on discontinued business.

5)

Special items Bank: Liability Management transaction (EUR 647 million, 2011), separation costs ING (EUR (48) million, 2011, EUR (43) million, 2010), Retail Netherlands strategy (EUR (105) million, 2011, EUR (180) million, 2010), restructuring provisions (EUR (209) million, 2011), EUR (115) million, 2010), Other (EUR (4) million, 2011, EUR (2) million, 2010). Special items Insurance: Liability Management transaction (EUR 71 million, 2011), restructuring provisions (EUR (320) million, 2011, EUR (218) million, 2010), goodwill impairment US (EUR (510) million, 2010), Other (EUR 22 million, 2011).

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Operating conditions were challenging in 2011, as financial markets continued to be volatile and the macroeconomic environment deteriorated further in the second half of the year. The prolonged weakness of the economic recovery and its impact on local and capital markets were especially prominent in the fourth quarter. Despite this difficult context, ING Group’s full-year results improved compared with 2010. The full-year 2011 net result was EUR 4,740 million compared with a net result of EUR 2,367 million in 2010. The 2011 net result includes EUR 1,928 million gains on divestments, of which EUR 995 million was attributable to the sale of our Latin American insurance, pension and investment management business, EUR 405 million to the sale of ING Car Lease, and EUR 453 million to the sale of Real Estate Investment Management. Special items were EUR 53 million in 2011 compared with EUR (1,065) million in 2010. The 2011 special items include a EUR 718 million net gain from the Liability Management transaction, i.e., the exchange or tender offers for seven tranches of subordinated debt securities totalling approximately EUR 5.8 billion, offset by costs for various restructuring programmes and separation costs. After-tax separation and initial public offering (IPO) preparation costs were EUR 202 million for the full-year 2011. Result on divestments and discontinued operations recorded in 2010 were EUR 683 million. Net gains on divestments were EUR 474 million, mainly reflecting the result on the sale of Private Banking Switzerland and Asia. The 2010 net results from discontinued operations amounted to EUR

 

66


Table of Contents

209 million and relate to the Insurance Latin America operations. Special items in 2010 were EUR (1,065) million, reflecting expenses for various restructuring programmes, separation costs and the goodwill write-down in the US. The after-tax separation costs were EUR 85 million for the full-year 2010.

Underlying net result for 2011 was EUR 2,649 million, down 3.6% from EUR 2,749 million a year earlier. Underlying net result is derived from total net result by excluding the impact from divestments and special items.

 

67


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the consolidated underlying results of the operations of ING Group and its banking and insurance operations for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009:

 

     Banking     Insurance     Eliminations 1)      Total  
     2010     2009     2010     2009     2010      2009      2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Underlying income:

                  

Gross premium income

         27,786        30,009              27,786        30,009   

Net interest result banking operations

     13,555        12,628            93         164         13,462        12,464   

Commission income

     2,253        2,149        1,472        1,359              3,725        3,508   

Total investment and other income

     413        (2,396     7,388        3,061        243         172         7,558        492   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     16,221        12,381        36,646        34,429        336         336         52,533        46,473   

Underlying expenditure:

                  

Underwriting expenditure

         32,802        30,274              32,802        30,274   

Interest expenses

         1,122        1,047        336         336         786        711   

Operating expenses (2)

     9,336        8,913        3,766        3,593              13,102        12,506   

Addition to loan loss provision

     1,742        2,854                  1,742        2,854   

Other

         29        25              29        25   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenditure

     11,078        11,767        37,719        34,939        336         336         48,461        46,370   

Underlying result before tax

     5,143        614        (1,072     (510           4,072        103   

Taxation

     1,275        (102     (40     (95           1,235        (197

Minority interests

     69        76        18        17              87        93   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     3,799        640        (1,050     (431           2,749        209   

Divestments (3)

     481        (176     (6     136              474        (40

Discontinued operations (4)

         209        94              209        94   

Special items (5)

     (340     (1,261     (725     (497           (1,065     (1,758
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     3,940        (797     (1,572     (698           2,367        (1,494
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1)

After elimination of certain intercompany transactions between the banking operations and the insurance operations

2)

Including Intangibles amortisation and impairments banking operations

3)

Divestments Bank: sale Private Banking Swiss (EUR 73 million, 2010, EUR 17 million, 2009), sale Private Banking Asia (EUR 334 million, 2010, EUR (63) million, 2009), sale Summit Canada (EUR (6) million, 2010, EUR (195) million, 2009), sale REIM (EUR 23 million, 2010 EUR 45 million, 2009), Sale Car Lease (EUR 57 million, 2010, EUR 20 million in 2009). Divestments Insurance: sale joint-venture Brasil (EUR 22 million, 2010) sale Industry Pension Funds (EUR 4 million, 2010, EUR (119) million, 2009), sale Greece Non-life (EUR (4) million, 2010, EUR (7) million, 2009), sale Canada (EUR (43) million, 2009), sale Argentina (EUR (17) million, 2010, EUR (19) million, 2009), sale Australia (EUR 361 million, 2009), sale US (EUR (12) million, 2010, EUR (21) million, 2009), sale Russia (EUR (6) million, 2009), sale Chile Health/Annuities (EUR (59) million, 2009), sale Mexico (EUR 3 million, 2009), sale Taiwan (EUR 1 million, 2009), sale LA (EUR 38 million, 2009).

4)

Reference is made to Note 25 “Discontinued operations” for more information on discontinued business.

5)

Special items Bank: separation costs ING (EUR (43) million, 2010), Retail Netherlands strategy (EUR (180) million, 2010, EUR (166) million, 2009), not launching ING Direct Japan (EUR (5) million, 2009), transaction result on Alt-A portfolio (EUR 44 million, 2009), additional IABF payments (EUR (822) million, 2009), restructuring provisions (EUR (115) million, 2010, EUR (312) million, 2009), Other (EUR (2) million, 2010). Special items Insurance: goodwill impairment US (EUR (510) million, 2010), restructuring provisions (EUR (218) million, 2010, EUR (235) million, 2009), transaction result on Alt-A portfolio (EUR (154) million, 2009), additional IABF payments (EUR (108) million, 2009).

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The operating environment continued to improve gradually during the year, although the global economic recovery remained fragile and market volatility persisted. Nevertheless, ING Group’s results showed a strong improvement compared with the previous year. ING Group’s net result for the full-year 2010 was EUR 2,367 million compared to a net loss in 2009 of EUR (1,495) million. The 2010 net result includes a EUR 513 million goodwill write-down in the US in the third quarter of 2010 and a EUR 634 million write-down of DAC in the fourth quarter as part of the measures to improve transparency and address the reserve adequacy of the US Closed Block Variable Annuity (VA) business in the US.

Divestments recorded in 2010 totalled EUR 474 million, mainly reflecting the EUR 405 million profit on the sale of Private Banking Switzerland and Asia. Special items in 2010 were EUR (1,065) million, reflecting expenses for various restructuring programmes, separation costs and the aforementioned EUR 513 million goodwill write-down in the US. The separation costs were EUR 85 million for the full-year 2010. In 2009 divestments totalled EUR (40) million. Special items were EUR (1,758) million and included a one-time charge due to an accrual for additional future payments to the Dutch State of EUR 930 million and a EUR 554 million restructuring provision, which was predominantly related to the headcount reduction for ING’s Back to Basics programme.

 

68


Table of Contents

Underlying net result was EUR 2,749 million for the full-year 2010, compared to EUR 209 million a year earlier. Underlying net result is derived from total net result by excluding the impact from divestments and special items.

 

69


Table of Contents

SEGMENT REPORTING

ING Group segments are based on the management structure of the Group, which is different from its legal structure. Reference is made to Note 51 Operating Segments of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements. The financial information for each business segment is reported on the same basis as used internally by the Executive and Management Boards in assessing segment performance and the allocation of segment resources. The business segment results (underlying net result and underlying result before tax) are therefore measures of segment profitability.

BANKING OPERATIONS

The following table sets forth the contribution of ING’s banking business lines and the corporate line banking (CL) to the underlying net result for each of the years 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 

(EUR millions)

2011

  

Retail
Netherlands

   

Retail
Belgium

   

ING

Direct

   

Retail CE

    

Retail
Asia

    

Commercial

Banking

   

ING Real
Estate

   

Corporate
line

   

Total
Banking

 

Underlying income

                    

•   Net interest result

     3,613        1,606        3,865        705         143         3,257        482        (109     13,562   

•   Commission income

     481        336        166        249         59         933        44        (13     2,255   

•   Total investment and other income

     52        89        (608     74         73         (1,078     3        50        (1,345
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     4,146        2,031        3,423        1,028         275         3,112        529        (72     14,472   

Underlying expenditure

                    

•   Operating expenses*

     2,428        1,432        1,962        773         173         2,178        349        152        9,447   

•   Additions to loan loss provision

     457        145        462        97         30         330        146          1,667   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenditure

     2,885        1,577        2,424        870         203         2,508        495        152        11,114   

Underlying result before taxation

     1,261        454        999        158         72         604        34        (224     3,358   

Taxation

     316        108        349        30         14         42        87        (25     921   

Minority interests

         1        29         30         26        (7       79   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     945        346        649        99         28         536        (46     (199     2,358   

Divestments

     12        2                420        453          887   

Special items

     (246     (12             (68     (12     619        281   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     711        336        649        99         28         888        395        420        3,526   
*

including intangibles amortization and other impairments

 

(EUR millions)

2010

  

Retail
Netherlands

   

Retail
Belgium

   

ING

Direct

   

Retail CE

    

Retail
Asia

    

Commercial

Banking

   

ING Real
Estate

   

Corporate
line

   

Total
Banking

 

Underlying income

                    

•   Net interest result

     3,816        1,608        3,774        670         169         3,233        439        (154     13,555   

•   Commission income

     498        345        152        278         55         910        28        (13     2,253   

•   Total investment and other income

     (4     95        (144     28         62         82        62        232        413   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     4,310        2,048        3,782        976         286         4,225        529        65        16,221   

Underlying expenditure

                    

•   Operating expenses*

     2,376        1,345        1,886        761         180         2,107        536        145        9,336   

•   Additions to loan loss provision

     560        160        446        61         26         387        102          1,742   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenditure

     2,936        1,505        2,332        822         206         2,494        638        145        11,078   

Underlying result before taxation

     1,374        543        1,450        154         80         1,731        (109     (80     5,143   

Taxation

     361        91        463        31         15         332        27        (45     1,275   

Minority interests

       (6     1        20         22         28        4          69   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     1,013        458        986        103         43         1,371        (140     (35     3,799   

Divestments

     16        75             334         39        17          481   

Special items

     (232     (13             (31     (34     (30     (340
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     797        520        986        103         377         1,379        (157     (65     3,940   

 

*

including intangibles amortization and other impairments

 

70


Table of Contents

(EUR millions)

2009

  

Retail
Netherlands

   

Retail
Belgium

   

ING

Direct

   

Retail CE

   

Retail
Asia

   

Commercial

Banking

   

ING Real Estate

   

Corporate
line

   

Total
Banking

 

Underlying income

                  

•    Net interest result

     3,303        1,619        3,136        675        110        3,513        428        (156     12,628   

•    Commission income

     528        339        167        261        43        811        6        (6     2,149   

•    Total investment and other income

     39        100        (1,541     (76     43        (101     (654     (206     (2,396
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     3,870        2,058        1,762        860        196        4,223        (220     (368     12,381   

Underlying expenditure

                  

•    Operating expenses*

     2,475        1,280        1,663        660        132        1,817        591        295        8,913   

•    Additions to loan loss provision

     527        200        765        116        39        968        239          2,854   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenditure

     3,002        1,480        2,428        776        171        2,785        830        295        11,767   

Underlying result before taxation

     868        578        (666     84        25        1,438        (1,050     (663     614   

Taxation

     229        79        (252     29        5        206        (216     (182     (102

Minority interests

       2          5        10        30        29          76   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     639        497        (414     50        10        1,202        (863     (481     640   

Divestments

     11        17            (63     9        (150       (176

Special items

     (225     (39     36        (6     (2     (169     (29     (827     (1,261
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     425        475        (378     44        (55     1,042        (1,042     (1,308     (797

 

*

including intangibles amortization and other impairments

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Underlying result before tax declined to EUR 3,358 million in 2011 from EUR 5,143 million in 2010. This decline was partially caused by the higher negative fair value changes on derivatives related to asset-liability-management activities for the mortgage and savings portfolios in the Netherlands and Belgium of EUR 787 million. These fair value changes are mainly a result of changes in market interest rates. As explained on page 5, no hedge accounting is applied to these derivatives under IFRS-IASB. Excluding these fair value changes, underlying result before tax dropped 17.4% to EUR 4,740 million from EUR 5,738 million in 2010, mainly reflecting the impact of the sovereign debt crisis in Europe. The decline was mainly due to EUR 588 million of impairments on Greek government bonds and EUR 181 million of losses on selective de-risking at ING Direct, while the previous year included EUR 275 million of capital gains on the sale of two Asian equity stakes. Also excluding these items, underlying result before tax slightly rose by 0.8%.

Net result from banking operations declined to EUR 3,526 million in 2011 from EUR 3,940 million in 2010. In 2011, divestments of ING Real Estate Investment Management, ING Car Lease and ING IM Philippines have resulted in a net gain of EUR 821 million, while the operating net results from these units amounted to EUR 66 million. In 2011, special items after tax were EUR 281 million positive, driven by the EUR 647 million net gain on the liability management transaction that was completed in December 2011. The gain was partly offset by special items from various restructuring programs, including the strategic measures taken in Retail Netherlands and Commercial Banking as well as additional costs for the merger of the Dutch retail banking activities, and costs related to the separation of Banking and Insurance. In 2010, divestments included the gains on the sale of the Swiss and Asian Private Banking activities and the sale of Summit in Canada as well as the operating net results from divested units, while special items were related to the Bank’s previous restructuring programs.

Total underlying income declined 10.8% to EUR 14,472 million in 2011 from EUR 16,221 million in 2010. The underlying net interest result was practically stable at EUR 13,562 million, despite a small increase in volumes. The total interest margin however declined slightly to 1.41% from 1.42% in 2010. Commission income remained flat on 2010, as increases in Commercial Banking (mainly Structured Finance) were offset by declines in Retail Banking. Total investment and other income was EUR (1,345) million compared with EUR 413 million in 2010, whereas EUR 787 million of the decline was caused by higher negative fair value changes on derivatives related to asset-liability-management activities as mentioned above. The remaining decline was entirely due to the above-mentioned impairments on Greek government bonds and losses on selective de-risking at ING Direct taken in 2011, while 2010 included the capital gains on the sale of two Asian equity stakes.

Underlying operating expenses, which includes intangibles amortization and other impairments, increased by 1.2% to EUR 9,447 million, mainly due to specific investments in the business and a modest year-on-year increase in staff costs. This was largely offset by stringent cost control and lower impairments on real estate development projects, The underlying net addition to the provision for loan losses declined 4.3% to EUR 1,667 million from EUR 1,742 million in 2010. Risk costs in 2011 were 52 basis points of average risk-weighted assets compared with 53 basis points in 2010.

 

71


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Underlying result before tax increased to EUR 5,143 million in 2010 from EUR 614 million in 2009. The strong improvement was principally driven by volume growth, strengthening of the interest margin, lower negative market-related impacts and a more normalized level of risk costs. Almost all business segments contributed to the increase. ING Direct and ING Real Estate benefited from the signs of stabilization in the property markets: ING Direct posted an underlying result before tax of EUR 1,450 million after a loss of EUR 666 million in 2009, while ING Real Estate reduced the amount of its loss from EUR 1,050 million in 2009 to EUR 109 million in 2010.

Net result from banking operations rose to EUR 3,940 million in 2010 compared with a loss of EUR (797) million in 2009. In 2010, the divestment of the Swiss and Asian Private Banking activities and the sale of Summit in Canada resulted in a net gain of EUR 379 million, while the operating net results from divested units amounted to EUR 102 million. Special items in 2010 were EUR (340) million, mainly related to various restructuring programs, including the merger of the Dutch retail banking activities, and costs related to the separation of Banking and Insurance. The loss in 2009 included EUR (1,261) million of special items, mainly related to additional payments on the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility and charges for the merger of the retail banking activities in the Netherlands, and EUR (176) million of operating net results from divested units.

Total underlying income rose 31.0% to EUR 16,221 million. The net interest result increased 7.3%, driven by higher volumes and margins. The total interest margin improved to 1.42% from 1.32% in 2009, mainly in Retail Banking. Commission income increased 4.8% driven by higher Structured Finance fees. Total investment and other income was EUR 413 million compared with EUR (2,396) million in 2009, principally driven by a diminution of impairments on debt securities and negative revaluations on real estate combined with higher capital gains, whereas EUR 61 million of the increase was caused by lower negative fair value changes on derivatives related to asset-liability-management activities for the mortgage and savings portfolios in the Netherlands, for which as explained on page 5, no hedge accounting is applied under IFRS-IASB .

Underlying operating expenses, which includes intangibles amortization and other impairments, increased by 4.7% to EUR 9,336 million, reflecting higher staff costs, increased marketing expenses and deposit guarantee scheme costs as well as higher IT project costs. The underlying net addition to the provision for loan losses declined to EUR 1,742 million from EUR 2,854 million in 2009. The additions to the provision for loan losses in 2010 were 53 basis points of average risk-weighted assets compared with 85 basis points in 2009.

The Banking business lines are analyzed using underlying result before tax in a format that is similar to the IFRS-IASB profit and loss account.

RETAIL NETHERLANDS

 

     Retail Netherlands  
(EUR millions)    2011     2010     2009  

Underlying income:

      

Interest result

     3,613        3,816        3,303   

Commission income

     481        498        528   

Investment income and other income

     52        (4     39   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     4,146        4,310        3,870   

Underlying expenditure:

      

Operating expenses

     2,428        2,376        2,475   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     457        560        527   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     2,885        2,936        3,002   

Underlying result before tax

     1,261        1,374        868   

Taxation

     316        361        229   

Minority interests

      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     945        1,013        639   

Divestments

     12        16        11   

Special items

     (246     (232     (225
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     711        797        425   

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Retail Netherlands decreased 8.2% to EUR 1,261 million in 2011 from EUR 1,374 million in 2010, principally driven by lower income and higher expenses, partly offset by a decrease in risk

 

72


Table of Contents

costs. Total underlying income decreased 3.8% to EUR 4,146 million in 2011. This decrease was mainly the result of a 5.3% decline in interest result, due to increased competition for savings putting pressure on margins. Net production in residential mortgages was EUR 3.6 billion, while volumes in other lending decreased EUR 0.2 billion and margins declined. Funds entrusted increased EUR 3.1 billion, mainly driven by a successful marketing campaign for a one-year deposit in the fourth quarter. Operating expenses rose 2.2% to EUR 2,428 million in 2011, mainly as a consequence of higher pension costs following updated mortality tables and an impairment on software in WestlandUtrecht Bank. The addition to loan loss provisions decreased 18.4% to EUR 457 million, or 93 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, mainly due to lower additions for specific files in the mid-corporate and SME segments, although the level started to increase again in the last quarter of 2011.

Underlying net result decreased to EUR 945 million in 2011 from EUR 1,013 million in 2010. The net result declined to EUR 711 million in 2011 compared with EUR 797 million in 2010. In 2011, special items after tax amounted to EUR (246) million, mainly related to the Case for Change initiative as well as additional costs for the combining of ING Bank and Postbank and the operational and legal separation of WestlandUtrecht Bank. Special items in 2010 were EUR (232) million, mainly related to the Retail Netherlands Strategy (combining ING Bank and Postbank), other restructuring expenses and separation costs related to WestlandUtrecht Bank. Divestments in both years related to the operating net results of the in 2011 divested ING Car Lease activities.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Retail Netherlands increased 58.3% to EUR 1,374 million in 2010 from EUR 868 million in 2009, principally driven by higher income and lower expenses, despite an increase in risk costs. Total underlying income rose 11.4% to EUR 4,310 million in 2010. This increase was fully attributable to a 15.5% higher interest result, mainly driven by higher interest margins on savings and mortgages. Net production in residential mortgages was EUR 5.5 billion, while volumes in other lending decreased by EUR 1.1 billion due to low demand. Funds entrusted increased by a modest EUR 0.4 billion. Operating expenses declined 4.0% to EUR 2,376 million in 2010, principally driven by the cost containment program started in 2009 and efficiency improvements related to the merger of ING Bank and Postbank. The addition to the provision for loan losses increased 6.3% to EUR 560 million, or 108 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, as economic recovery in the Netherlands remained fragile.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 1,013 million in 2010 from EUR 639 million in 2009. The net result rose to EUR 797 million in 2010 compared with EUR 425 million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (232) million, mainly provisions and costs related to the Retail Netherlands Strategy (combining ING Bank and Postbank), other restructuring expenses and separation costs related to WestlandUtrecht Bank. The net result in 2009 included EUR (225) million of special items, mainly related to the Retail Netherlands Strategy and the Group initiative to reduce operating expenses. Divestments in both years included the operating net results of ING Car Lease, divested in 2011.

RETAIL BELGIUM

 

     Retail Belgium  
     2011     2010     2009  

Underlying income:

      

Interest result

     1,606        1,608        1,619   

Commission income

     336        345        339   

Investment income and other income

     89        95        100   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     2,031        2,048        2,058   

Underlying expenditure:

      

Operating expenses

     1,432        1,345        1,280   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     145        160        200   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     1,577        1,505        1,480   

Underlying result before tax

     454        543        578   

Taxation

     108        91        79   

Minority interests

       (6     2   
    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     346        458        497   

Divestments

     2        75        17   

Special items

     (12     (13     (39
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     336        520        475   

 

73


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Retail Belgium fell 16.4% on 2010, as a slight decline in income was accompanied by higher operating expenses. Income decreased 0.8% compared to 2010, mainly due to EUR 17 million of impairments on Greek government bonds. Interest result remained flat, as decline in margins was compensated by higher volumes, particularly in savings and lending. Net production in mortgages totaled EUR 3.0 billion in 2011, while production in other lending was EUR 3.2 billion. The net production in funds entrusted was EUR 3.0 billion, mainly driven by the success of the Orange Book savings product in the beginning of the year. Operating expenses increased 6.5% on 2010 to EUR 1,432 million, mainly reflecting higher staff expenses, increased contribution to the deposit guarantee scheme and higher marketing expenses. The addition to the provision for loan losses declined 9.4%, to EUR 145 million, or 77 basis points of average risk weighted assets, mainly attributable to releases in the mid-corporate segment.

Underlying net result decreased to EUR 346 million in 2011 from EUR 458 million in 2010. The net result declined to EUR 336 million from EUR 520 million. In 2011, the impact of divestments was EUR 2 million, fully related to operating results of ING Car Lease sold in 2011. In 2010, divestments added EUR 75 million, and included next to the operating results of ING Car Lease, the gain on the sale of Swiss Private Banking activities. Special items after tax decreased in both 2010 and 2011, mainly related to the domestic transformation program.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Retail Belgium declined 6.1% compared to 2009, mainly due to increased expenses. Underlying income slipped 0.5% to EUR 2,048 million. The interest result decreased slightly, following lower margins on savings and current accounts, which were largely offset by higher margins on mortgages and other lending. Net production in mortgages totaled EUR 2.8 billion in 2010, while net production in other lending was EUR 1.3 billion. The net production in funds entrusted was EUR 2.2 billion, mainly driven by the success of the Orange Book savings product, which compensated for outflows in current accounts. Operating expenses increased 5.1% to EUR 1,345 million, mainly driven by additional costs for the national deposit guarantee scheme in 2010. The addition to the provision for loan losses declined 20.0% to EUR 160 million, or 84 basis points of average risk-weighted assets.

Underlying net result decreased 7.8% to EUR 458 million in 2010 from EUR 497 million in 2009. The net result rose to EUR 520 million in 2010 compared with EUR 475 million in 2009. In 2010, the impact of divestments was EUR 75 million, including the gain on the sale of the Swiss Private Banking activities and operating results of ING Car Lease, sold in 2011. In 2009, divestments were EUR 17 million, entirely related to the net result from divested units. Special items in 2010 were EUR (13) million, mainly related to the domestic transformation program. The net result in 2009 included EUR (39) million of special items, mainly restructuring provisions as part of the Group initiative to reduce operating expenses.

ING DIRECT

 

     ING Direct  
(EUR millions)    2011     2010     2009  

Underlying income:

      

Interest result

     3,865        3,774        3,136   

Commission income

     166        152        167   

Investment income and other income

     (608     (144     (1,541
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     3,423        3,782        1,762   

Underlying expenditure:

      

Operating expenses

     1,962        1,886        1,663   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     462        446        765   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     2,424        2,332        2,428   

Underlying result before tax

     999        1,450        (666

Taxation

     349        463        (252

Minority interests

     1        1     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     649        986        (414

Special items

         36   
      

 

 

 

Net result

     649        986        (378

 

74


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of ING Direct declined 31.1% to EUR 999 million compared to EUR 1,450 million in 2010. The decrease was due to EUR 326 million higher impairments on debt securities (including EUR 346 million of impairments on Greek government bonds) and EUR 181 million of losses from the selective sale of mainly unsecured and ABS exposures in the investment portfolio. Underlying income decreased to EUR 3,423 million from EUR 3,782 million last year, fully due to abovementioned impairments and losses. The interest result increased by 2.4%, or EUR 91 million, driven by higher volumes while the interest margin remained stable at 1.24%. The interest result in the US continued to benefit from the IFRS treatment on previously impaired bonds, which had a positive impact of EUR 168 million in 2011, down from EUR 230 million in 2010. The total net production in mortgages was EUR 12.4 billion while funds entrusted reported a net inflow of EUR 13.7 billion. Operating expenses increased by 4.0%, reflecting higher marketing expenses (particularly in Germany, Italy, France and Spain) and higher costs to set up a limited number of branches in Spain and further roll out of payment accounts in France, Italy and Canada. The addition to loan loss provisions increased to EUR 462 million, or 61 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, from EUR 446 million in 2010 (or 59 basis points of average risk-weighted assets). The increase was driven by the lower anticipated recovery rates in the US, partially offset by lower risk costs in Germany.

Both underlying net result and net result decreased to EUR 649 million in 2011 compared to EUR 986 million in 2010.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

ING Direct delivered strong results in 2010 with a positive underlying result before tax of EUR 1,450 million, compared with a loss of EUR 666 million in 2009. This major improvement was driven by lower impairments on the investment portfolio, a higher interest result and lower additions to the loan loss provisions. Underlying income more than doubled, as impairments (mainly on the Alt-A RMBS portfolio in the US) declined to EUR 107 million compared to EUR 1,394 million in 2009. The interest result increased by 20.3%, or EUR 638 million, driven by higher volumes and increased margins on savings and mortgages. The interest result in the US benefited from the IFRS treatment on previously impaired bonds, which had a positive impact of EUR 230 million in 2010 up from EUR 99 million in 2009. Operating expenses increased by 13.4%, primarily reflecting higher marketing costs, the roll-out of payment accounts and increased staff costs. The addition to the provision for loan losses decreased to EUR 446 million, or 59 basis points of average risk-weighted assets from EUR 765 million in 2009 (or 112 basis points of average risk-weighted assets), supported by signs of stabilization in the US housing market and US unemployment rate as well as diminishing delinquencies.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 986 million in 2010 from a loss of EUR (414) million in 2009. Net result rose to EUR 986 million in 2010 compared with a loss of EUR (378) million in 2009. The net result in 2009 included EUR 36 million of special items related to a one-off gain on the transfer of 80% economic ownership of ING Direct’s Alt-A RMBS portfolio to the Dutch State, partially offset by costs for not launching ING Direct Japan and other restructuring expenses.

RETAIL CENTRAL EUROPE

 

     Retail Central Europe  
(EUR millions)    2011      2010      2009  

Underlying income:

        

Interest result

     705         670         675   

Commission income

     249         278         261   

Investment income and other income

     74         28         (76
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     1,028         976         860   

Underlying expenditure:

        

Operating expenses

     773         761         660   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     97         61         116   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     870         822         776   

Underlying result before tax

     158         154         84   

Taxation

     30         31         29   

Minority interests

     29         20         5   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     99         103         50   

Special items

           (6
        

 

 

 

Net result

     99         103         44   

 

75


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Retail Central Europe rose 2.6% to EUR 158 million, driven by higher results in Poland, partly offset by lower results in Turkey due to increased risk costs. Underlying income in Central Europe increased 5.2% as higher income in Poland and Romania was partly offset by lower income in Turkey, mainly due to negative currency effects. Overall volumes in Poland remained relatively stable, while margins increased, particularly in savings and current accounts. In Turkey, a variable savings product was launched which led to a slight decrease in margin and an increase in volumes. Both volumes and margins remained largely stable in Romania. Net production of lending in Central Europe was EUR 3.5 billion, while the net inflow of funds entrusted was EUR 2.2 billion. Operating expenses were up 1.6% driven by the increased client activity. The addition to loan loss provisions rose to EUR 97 million, or 42 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, compared with EUR 61 million, or 28 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, in 2010. Risk costs increased mainly in Turkey due to business growth, while the level in 2010 was low due to releases of specific provisions and improved data quality.

Both underlying net result and net result decreased to EUR 99 million in 2011 compared to EUR 103 million last year.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Retail Central Europe rose 83.3% to EUR 154 million, driven by higher results in Poland and Romania, while results in Turkey declined compared with the strong performance in 2009. Underlying income in Central Europe rose 13.5% supported by higher volumes in all countries and improved interest margins in Poland and Romania. In Turkey, margins declined due to increased competition, while income was impacted by negative fair value changes on derivatives (not eligible for hedge accounting). Net lending production was EUR 2.2 billion, and inflow of funds entrusted amounted to EUR 0.3 billion. Operating expenses were up 15.3% reflecting business growth and increased staff costs. Risk costs declined to EUR 61 million, or 28 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, from EUR 116 million (or 61 basis points of average risk-weighted assets) in 2009. The decline in the addition to the provision for loan losses occurred mainly in Turkey and Romania supported by the release of specific provisions and improved data quality.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 103 million in 2010 from EUR 50 million in 2009. Net result rose to EUR 103 million in 2010 compared with EUR 44 million in 2009. Net result in 2009 included EUR (6) million of special items, mainly related to the closure of the Ukraine retail activities.

RETAIL ASIA

 

     Retail Asia  
(EUR millions)    2011      2010      2009  

Underlying income:

        

Interest result

     143         169         110   

Commission income

     59         55         43   

Investment income and other income

     73         62         43   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     275         286         196   

Underlying expenditure:

        

Operating expenses

     173         180         132   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     30         26         39   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     203         206         171   

Underlying result before tax

     72         80         25   

Taxation

     14         15         5   

Minority interests

     30         22         10   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     28         43         10   

Divestments

        334         (63

Special items

           (2
        

 

 

 

Net result

     28         377         (55

 

76


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Retail Asia’s underlying result before tax declined to EUR 72 million in 2011 from EUR 80 million in 2010. This decline was mainly the result of lower income, primarily as a result of unfavorable currency movements. Excluding currency impacts, underlying income was up 3%, driven by ING Vysya Bank, where higher interest results were coupled with increased fee income and higher other income. Net production in lending was EUR 1.2 billion in 2011, while the net inflow of funds entrusted was EUR 0.5 billion. The increased profit contribution from ING Bank’s share in the result of TMB in Thailand and higher dividends from Bank of Beijing were offset by higher funding costs resulting in an overall decline of the interest result. Operating expenses were down 3.9% to EUR 173 million, but increased adjusted for currency effects, mainly as a result of business expansion in India. The addition to loan loss provisions rose by EUR 4 million to EUR 30 million, or 32 basis points of average risk-weighted assets in 2011, mainly as a result of higher non-performing loans at ING Vysya Bank.

Underlying net result decreased to EUR 28 million in 2011 from EUR 43 million in 2010. Net result was down to EUR 28 million from EUR 377 million in 2010, which included a net result of EUR 334 million related to the divestment of Private Banking Asia.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Retail Asia’s underlying result before tax more than tripled to EUR 80 million from EUR 25 million in 2009. The strong improvement was mainly attributable to higher results from ING Vysya Bank in India, driven by higher volumes and margins, a one-off gain on the sale of an investment and lower risk costs. This was partly offset by higher expenses due to further investments in business growth and increased staff costs, including additional pension provisions. The result in Asia was supported by the increased profit contribution from ING Bank’s share in the result of TMB in Thailand and higher dividends from Bank of Beijing and Kookmin Bank.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 43 million in 2010 from EUR 10 million in 2009. Net result rose to EUR 377 million in 2010 compared with a loss of EUR (55) million in 2009. The divestments in 2010 accounted for EUR 334 million related to the sale of Private Banking Asia at the beginning of 2010, compared to a loss of EUR (63) million in 2009 mainly related to the net result of the divested unit.

COMMERCIAL BANKING (excluding Real Estate)

 

     Commercial Banking
excluding Real Estate
 
(EUR millions)    2011     2010      2009  

Underlying income:

       

Interest result

     3,257        3,233         3,513   

Commission income

     933        910         811   

Investment income and other income

     (1,078     82         (101
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     3,112        4,225         4,223   

Underlying expenditure:

       

Operating expenses

     2,178        2,107         1,817   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     330        387         968   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     2,508        2,494         2,785   

Underlying result before tax

     604        1,731         1,438   

Taxation

     42        332         206   

Minority interests

     26        28         30   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     536        1,371         1,202   

Divestments

     420        39         9   

Special items

     (68     (31)         (169
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net result

     888        1,379         1,042   

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Commercial Banking excluding Real Estate dropped by 65.1% to EUR 604 million in 2011 compared to EUR 1,731 million in 2010.

The decline in the underlying result before tax of Commercial Banking excluding Real Estate was largely attributable to Financial Markets, whose result declined by EUR 1,208 million to EUR (884) million 2011 from EUR 324 million in 2010. This decline was partially caused by the higher negative fair value changes on derivatives related to asset-liability-management activities for the mortgage and savings portfolios in the Netherlands and Belgium of EUR 788 million. These fair value changes are mainly a result of changes in market

 

77


Table of Contents

interest rates. As explained on page 5, no hedge accounting is applied to these derivatives under IFRS-IASB. Furthermore, EUR 225 million was caused by impairments on Greek government bonds taken in 2011. Excluding these impacts, underlying result of Financial Markets declined by EUR 195 million (or -21.2%), following adverse market circumstances as well as the winding down of the proprietary trading book in the US. Underlying result of General Lending and Payments and Cash Management (PCM) declined by 9.9% to EUR 410 million in 2011 from EUR 455 million in 2010. This was mainly driven by impairments on the restructuring portfolio, as well as higher expenses due to selective IT investments in PCM. The result of Structured Finance rose by 21.4% to EUR 1,139 million in 2011, driven by strong volume growth in the first half of 2011 resulting in higher interest results and commission income, while risk costs were lower. The result of Leasing & Factoring declined EUR 5 million to EUR 75 million entirely due to higher risk costs.

Total underlying income of Commercial Banking excluding Real Estate was 26.3% lower than in 2010, declining to EUR 3,112 million, driven primarily by Financial Markets. Underlying operating expenses increased by 3.4% to EUR 2,178 million, mainly as a result of investments in PCM as well as higher costs in Structured Finance. Provisions for loan losses were EUR 57 million lower in 2011, reaching EUR 330 million or 27 basis points of average risk-weighted assets, compared to EUR 387 million in 2010.

Underlying net result declined to EUR 536 million in 2011 from EUR 1,371 million in 2010. Net result declined to EUR 888 million in 2011 from EUR 1,379 million in 2010. Divestments added EUR 420 million to the 2011 net result and included gains on the sale of ING Car Lease and IIM Philippines as well as operating results from the divested units. In 2010, divestments added EUR 39 million fully related to divested units. Special items, mainly restructuring provisions, were EUR (68) million in 2011 and EUR (31) million in 2010.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Commercial Banking excluding Real Estate increased 20.4% to EUR 1,731 million from EUR 1,438 million in 2009. The increased result of Commercial Banking excluding Real Estate was largely attributable to Structured Finance, the result of which increased threefold to EUR 938 million thanks to higher volumes and improved margins, combined with lower risk costs. Underlying result before tax from Financial Markets declined to EUR 324 million from EUR 633 million in 2009, mainly as a result of lower income in the client business following the normalization of the markets, as well as higher expenses partly caused by an accrual adjustment related to the deferral of incentive compensation in 2009. The results of General Lending & Payments and Cash Management (PCM) increased by 6.8%, as lower commission income and somewhat higher operating expenses were more than offset by significantly lower risk costs. Result before tax in Leasing & Factoring declined to EUR 80 million, driven by lower provisions for loan losses.

Total underlying income was stable at EUR 4,225 million. Higher income at Structured Finance was offset by declines at General Lending & PCM, Financial Markets, and Other Products. Underlying operating expenses increased 16.0% to EUR 2,107 million partly caused by an accrual adjustment related to the deferral of incentive compensation in 2009 and despite lower impairments on real estate development projects.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 1,371 million in 2010 from EUR 1,202 million in 2009. Net result rose to EUR 1,379 million in 2010 compared with EUR 1,042 million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (31) million, mainly restructuring provisions. Divestments were EUR 39 million in 2010, related to operating results of divested units. The net result in 2009 included EUR (169) million of special items, mainly related to restructuring provisions as part of the Group initiative to reduce operating expenses. In 2009, divestments were EUR 9 million relating to operating results of ING Car Lease.

 

78


Table of Contents

ING REAL ESTATE

 

     ING Real Estate              
(EUR millions)    2011     2010     2009  

Underlying income:

      

Interest result

     482        439        428   

Commission income

     44        28        6   

Investment income and other income

     3        62        (654
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     529        529        (220

Underlying expenditure:

      

Operating expenses

     349        536        591   

Additions to the provision for loan losses

     146        102        239   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenditure

     495        638        830   

Underlying result before tax

     34        (109     (1,050

Taxation

     87        27        (216

Minority interests

     (7     4        29   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     (46     (140     (863

Divestments

     453        17        (150

Special items

     (12     (34     (29
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     395        (157     (1,042

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

ING Real Estate reported an underlying profit before tax of EUR 34 million, compared with a loss of EUR (109) million in 2010. This improvement was mainly driven by decrease in operating expenses, following reduction in impairments on development projects. Negative fair value changes on the direct and indirect real estate investments as well as impairments on real estate development projects declined to EUR 273 million in 2011, compared with EUR 434 million in 2010. Excluding revaluations and impairments, underlying result before tax decreased by EUR 18 million to EUR 307 million in 2011 from EUR 325 million in 2010. This decline was primarily driven by EUR 44 million higher risk costs at Real Estate Finance, reaching EUR 146 million in 2011, or 116 basis points of average risk-weighted assets. Higher income within Real Estate Finance was offset by lower income from project sales in Real Estate Development. Operating expenses, excluding impairments on development projects, declined by EUR 12 million.

Underlying net result improved to EUR (46) million in 2011 from EUR (140) million in 2010. Net result in 2011 was EUR 395 million, significantly up from EUR (157) million in 2010. Divestments in 2011 were EUR 453 million, and included the gain on the divestment of ING Real Estate Investment Management as well as its operating results. Divestments in 2010 added EUR 17 million, related to the operating result of divested units as well as a loss on the divestment of ING’s 50% stake in ING Summit Industrial Fund and the manager of Summit, ING Real Estate Canada. Special items in 2011 were EUR (12) million, related to restructuring activities in Real Estate, while special items in 2010 were EUR (34) million.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

ING Real Estate reported an underlying loss before tax of EUR (109) million compared with a loss of EUR (1,050) million in 2009. This improvement was mainly due to the gradual stabilization of market conditions, which even led to ING Real Estate showing a profit in the last quarter of 2010. Negative fair value changes on the direct and indirect real estate investments as well as impairments on real estate development projects declined to EUR 434 million in 2010, compared with EUR 1,190 million in 2009. Excluding revaluations and impairments, underlying result before tax increased to EUR 324 million in 2010 from EUR 140 million in 2009, mainly driven by improved operational results within Real Estate Finance business due to lower addition to the provision for loan losses, which were EUR 102 million in 2010 (or 64 basis points of average risk-weighted assets).

Underlying net result improved to a loss of EUR (140) million in 2010 from a loss of EUR (863) million in 2009. Net result in 2010 was a loss of EUR (157) million compared with a loss of EUR (1,042) million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (34) million, mainly related to restructuring activities within the unit, compared with EUR

 

79


Table of Contents

(29) million of special items in 2009. Divestments in 2010 were EUR 17 million, related to the operating result of the Real Estate Investment Management business divested in 2011 and the divestment of ING’s 50% stake in ING Summit Industrial Fund and the manager of Summit, ING Real Estate Canada in 2010. Divestments in 2009 were EUR (150) million, fully related to the operating results of the Real Estate Investment Management business and Summit.

 

80


Table of Contents

INSURANCE OPERATIONS

The following table sets forth the contribution of ING’s insurance business lines and the corporate line Insurance (CL) to the net result for each of the years 2011, 2010, and 2009. With regard to insurance activities, ING Group analyses, as of 2011, the underlying result through a margin analysis, which includes the following components: Operating result and Non-operating items. Both are compsed of into various sub-components. The total of operating result and non-operating items (gains/ losses and impairments, revaluations and market & other impacts) equals underlying result before tax.

 

(EUR millions)

2011

   Insurance
Benelux
    Insurance
CRE
    Insurance
US
    Insurance
Closed
Block VA
    Insurance
Asia/Pacific
    ING IM     Corporate
line
    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     666        76        892        28        73        4          1,739   

Fees and premium based revenues

     585        458        1,064        168        1,442        868          4,585   

Technical margin

     315        169        72        28        178            762   

Income non-modeled business

     36        9            44            89   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,602        712        2,028        224        1,737        872          7,175   

Administrative expenses

     594        308        742        81        456        676          2,857   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     213        202        625        124        731        3          1,898   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     807        510        1,367        205        1,187        679          4,755   

Life & ING IM operating result

     795        202        661        19        550        193          2,420   

Non-life operating result

     179        5            4            188   

Corporate line operating result

                 (402     (402
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     974        207        661        19        554        193        (402     2,206   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (47     (404     (166     2        60        5          (550

Revaluations

     62        (1     159        1        (8     6        (14     205   

Market & other impacts

     (250       (36     (1,295     (18       52        (1,547
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     739        (198     618        (1,273     588        204        (364     314   

Taxation

     69        21        (22     (222     121        72        (20     19   

Minority interests

     4        10                (10     4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     666        (229     640        (1,051     467        132        (334     291   

Divestments

             29        26        (9     46   

Discontinued operations

                   1,104   

Special items

     (104     (77     (44       (2     (12     11        (228
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     562        (306     596        (1,051     494        146        (332     1,212   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(EUR millions)

2010

   Insurance
Benelux
    Insurance
CRE
    Insurance
US
    Insurance
Closed
Block VA
    Insurance
Asia/Pacific
    ING IM     Corporate
line
    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     457        77        827        (11     53        2          1,405   

Fees and premium based revenues

     578        501        1,060        121        1,329        826          4,415   

Technical margin

     243        149        195        9        157            753   

Income non-modeled business

     40        16            80            136   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,318        743        2,082        119        1,619        828          6,709   

Administrative expenses

     567        261        904        77        441        682          2,932   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     230        197        619        (7     710        3          1,752   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     797        458        1,523        70        1,151        685          4,684   

Life & ING IM operating result

     521        285        559        49        468        143          2,025   

Non-life operating result

     156        7            5            168   

Corporate line operating result

                 (633     (633
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     677        292        559        49        473        143        (633     1,560   

Gains/losses and impairments

     14        (29     (564     22        50        10        (15     (512

Revaluations

     60          490        3        (14     (3     (87     449   

Market & other impacts

     24        (10     (177     (2,149     8          (265     (2,569
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     775        253        308        (2,075     517        150        (1,000     (1,072

Taxation

     130        63        (155     (57     137        56        (214     (40

Minority interests

     15        10            1        1        (9     18   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     630        180        463        (2,018     379        93        (777     (1,050

Divestments

     4        (4     (12           6        (6

Discontinued operations

                   209   

Special items

     (33     (46     (66         (41     (539     (725
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     601        130        385        (2,018     379        52        (1,310     (1,572
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

81


Table of Contents

(EUR millions)

2009

   Insurance
Benelux
    Insurance
CRE
    Insurance
US
    Insurance
Closed
Block VA
    Insurance
Asia/Pacific
    ING IM     Corporate
line
    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     368        77        643        22        9        17          1,136   

Fees and premium based revenues

     569        522        967        167        1,083        704          4,012   

Technical margin

     286        175        238        25        163            887   

Income non-modeled business

     23        14            86            123   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,246        788        1,848        214        1,341        721          6,158   

Administrative expenses

     635        261        791        87        410        535          2,719   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     235        197        489        104        570        3          1,598   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     870        458        1,280        191        980        538          4,317   

Life & ING IM operating result

     376        330        568        23        361        183          1,841   

Non-life operating result

     248        6            4            258   

Corporate line operating result

                 (802     (802
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     624        336        568        23        365        183        (802     1,297   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (44     (44     (515     38        26          (7     (546

Revaluations

     (356       272        (4     (9     (33     (213     (343

Market & other impacts

     66        (1     31        (821     1          (194     (918
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     290        291        356        (764     383        150        (1,216     (510

Taxation

     58        57        138        (118     112        56        (398     (95

Minority interests

     15        12            1        1        (12     17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     217        222        218        (646     270        93        (806     (432

Divestments

     (119     (13     (62       363        7        (40     136   

Discontinued operations

                   94   

Special items

     (117        (14     (202       (26     (27     (110     (497
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     (19     195        (46     (646     606        73        (955     (698
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Operating conditions were challenging in 2011, as financial markets continued to be volatile and the macroeconomic environment deteriorated. The underlying result before tax of Insurance/IM was EUR 314 million, up from a loss of EUR (1,072) million in 2010. The increase was primarily driven by an improvement in market and other impacts as a result of lower DAC write downs in the US Closed Block VA business and in Japan’s Single Premium Variable Annuity (SPVA) business. This is however partially offset by a charge of EUR 1.1 billion due to the completion of a comprehensive policyholder behaviour assumption review for the US Closed Block VA. Capital losses, reflecting de-risking, and impairments were in line with the previous year. Further, revaluations were lower, largely related to Collateralised Mortgage Obligations (CMOs) in the US. Hence, underlying results per business line diverged, with strong recoveries in the US and Asia/Pacific (excluding Japan variable annuities), compared with lower underlying results in the Benelux and Central and Rest of Europe.

The operating result of Insurance/IM increased to EUR 2,206 million from EUR 1,560 million in 2010, mostly driven by higher investment margins and higher fees and premium-based revenues in the life and the investment management business. The investment spread on life general account assets increased 16 basis points to 106 basis points in 2011 following cautious re-risking of the investment portfolios in the first half of 2011, which was partially offset by de-risking in the second half. The increase in operating income was partly offset by higher expenses. Operating results improved in nearly every business line, with the exception of Central and Rest of Europe given the harsh economic conditions and in US Closed Block VA.

The Life/IM administrative expenses ratio improved from 43.7% in 2010 to 39.8% in 2011 as a result of 6.9% higher Life/IM income and 2.6% lower administrative expenses. Expenses especially in the US were lower as a result of cost savings and pension plan changes.

New life sales (Annual Premium Equivalent “APE”) amounted to EUR 4,200 million, an increase of EUR 31 million or 0.7% compared with last year. Higher sales, mainly in Asia/Pacific, were partly offset by lower sales in the US.

Underlying net result increased EUR 1,341 million from EUR (1,050) million in 2010 to EUR 291 million in 2011. Net result from insurance operations increased to EUR 1,212 million in 2011 compared with a loss of EUR (1,572) million in 2010. Net gains on divestments were realised mainly by the sale of the Latin American pension, life insurance and investment management operations. The discontinued Latin American operations

 

82


Table of Contents

added EUR 109 million to the net result compared to EUR 209 million in the previous year. Special items were EUR (228) million in 2011, mainly relating to restructuring costs and integration costs. In 2010 special items were EUR (725) million relating to EUR (513) million goodwill impairment in the Corporate Line, restructuring costs in the US of EUR (64) million, the integration of the Dutch insurance companies of EUR (29) million, a program to standardise regional IT, procurement and finance processes in Central and Rest of Europe of EUR (44) million and a programme to integrate investment management into one global organization of EUR (38) million.

In the US, the closed block variable annuity business was reported as a separate business line as of the fourth quarter of 2010. The split of the US insurance business into two business lines, triggered a EUR 975 million write-down of deferred acquisition costs related to the closed variable annuity business, bringing the reserve adequacy on this block to well above 50%. See Note 43 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Although business fundamentals improved, the underlying loss before tax of Insurance/IM was EUR (1,072) million compared with a loss of EUR (510) million in 2009. Market conditions continued to improve in 2010, although at a relatively slow pace given the depth of the financial crisis in 2008 and 2009. The operating result of Insurance/IM increased to EUR 1,560 million from EUR 1,297 million in 2009, mostly driven by higher investment margins and increased fees and premium-based revenues in life insurance and the investment management business. The 4-quarter rolling average investment spread on life general account assets increased 9 basis points to reach 90 basis points in 2010, after cautious re-risking of the investment portfolios.

The 8.9% increase in Life & ING IM operating income was partly offset by higher expenses. Operating results improved in the Benelux, Asia/Pacific and US Closed Block VA. Operating results were lower in Central and Rest of Europe given the harsh economic conditions in this region, US Investment Management following higher expenses related to the build-up of its global investment capabilities, and Insurance US due to higher administrative expenses and DAC amortisation and trail commissions.

Despite the 7.9% increase in Life administrative expenses, partly driven by the weakening of the euro against most major international currencies, the Life & IM administrative expense ratio improved to 43.7% for the full year. Especially in the Benelux, significant progress was made in containing expenses through the integration of the Dutch businesses.

The increase in the operating result and significantly higher revaluations of investments were more than cancelled out by higher negative market impacts, mostly related to the closed variable annuity blocks in the US and Japan. Hence, underlying results per business line diverged, with strong result recoveries in the Benelux and Asia/Pacific (excluding Japan variable annuities), compared with lower results in Central and Rest of Europe and the US.

Underlying net result decreased from EUR (432) million in 2009 to EUR (1,050) million in 2010. Net result from insurance operations decreased to EUR (1,572) million in 2010 compared with a loss of EUR (698) million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (725) million, mainly relating to a EUR (513) million goodwill impairment in the Corporate Line, restructuring costs in the US of EUR of (64) million, the integration of the Dutch insurance companies of EUR (29) million, a program to standardise regional IT, procurement and finance processes in Central and Rest of Europe of EUR (44) million and a programme to integrate investment management into one global organization of EUR (38) million. Discontinued operations (Latin American pension, life insurance and investment management operations) added EUR 209 million to net result in 2010 and EUR 94 million in 2009, respectively. The loss in 2009 included EUR (497) million of special items, mainly related to a transaction result and additional charge from the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility of EUR (262) million, restructuring provisions of EUR (151) million and the integration of the Dutch insurance companies of EUR (43) million, and a profit of EUR 136 million of results from divested units

 

83


Table of Contents

INSURANCE BENELUX

 

     Insurance Benelux  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     666        457        368   

Fees and premium based revenues

     585        578        569   

Technical margin

     315        243        286   

Income non-modeled life business

     36        40        23   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,602        1,318        1,246   

Administrative expenses

     594        567        635   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     213        230        235   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     807        797        870   

Life & ING IM operating result

     795        521        376   

Non-life operating result

     179        156        248   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     974        677        623   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (47     14        (44

Revaluations

     62        60        (356

Market & other impacts

     (250     24        66   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     739        775        290   

Taxation

     69        130        58   

Minority interests

     4        15        15   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     666        630        217   

Divestments

       4        (119

Special items

     (104     (33     (117
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     562        601        (19

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax in the Benelux decreased by 4.6%, despite a 43.8% higher operating result, reflecting the change in provision for guarantees on separate account pension contracts and capital losses and impairments on debt and public equity, mainly as a result of deteriorating financial markets and de-risking.

The operating result increased 43.7%, as a higher investment margin, higher technical margin and a higher non-life result more than offset higher administrative expenses. The 45.9% higher investment margin was mainly driven by lower interest rebates, lower profit sharing and higher non-recurring separate account pension contract results. In addition, the investment margin continued to benefit from the impact of reinvestments in the first half of 2011, higher dividends on public equity and real estate funds.

The technical margin increased by 29.3% to EUR 315 million from EUR 243 million in the previous year, mainly due to a EUR 70 million positive impact from an early surrender of a contract with a large pension fund. Life administrative expenses increased 4.4% as a result of releases of incidental expenses in the previous year, incidental expenses in 2011 and the impact of organisational changes which were only partially offset by recurring cost savings.

Non-Life results increased 14.7% due to lower claims and a non-recurring positive effect in the expense provisions, resulting from unifying provision methodologies in the Dutch non-life entities.

New sales (APE) increased by 6.8% in 2011, mainly driven by higher corporate pension sales and renewals.

Underlying net result increased EUR 36 million to EUR 666 million in 2011 from EUR 630 million in 2010. Net result decreased EUR 39 million to EUR 562 million from EUR 601 million in 2010. In 2010 divestments contributed EUR 4 million to the net profit due to the sale of Industry Pension Funds. Special items in 2011 were EUR (104) million, relating to the integration of the Dutch insurance companies and the disentanglement of ING Bank, compared to EUR (33) million in 2010 also relating to the integration of the Dutch insurance companies.

 

84


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax in the Benelux more than doubled in 2010 to EUR 775 million, compared to 2009, reflecting a higher operating result (increase of EUR 54 million), lower negative real estate revaluations (decrease of EUR 379 million) as well as lower negative realized gains on real estate (decrease of EUR 57 million). After a period of rapidly declining real estate values, the ING Insurance Real Estate Portfolio benefited from both the continuing recovery in the UK real estate market and stabilizing yields in Continental Europe. Operating result increased 8.7%, as a higher investment margin and lower expenses more than compensated for a lower technical margin as well as a lower non-life result. The higher investment margin (increase of EUR 88 million or 23.9% increase) reflected a higher fixed income result as cash balances were reinvested over the course of 2010.

The non-life operating result totaled EUR 156 million in 2010 compared to EUR 248 million in 2009. This decline was due to the inclusion of favorable one-off items in the 2009 result. Furthermore, adverse claims development in the disability business and a few large fire claims in 2010 contributed to the decline in the non-life result.

The technical margin decreased to EUR 243 million compared to EUR 286 million in 2009 as the second quarter of 2009 included a favorable one-off item, being the release of EUR 54 million in morbidity provisions. Life expenses declined by 8.4% because of lower administrative expenses mainly reflecting lower staff levels in the Benelux.

Underlying net result increased by EUR 413 million to EUR 630 million in 2010 from EUR 217 million in 2009. Net result increased EUR 620 million to EUR 601 million from a loss of EUR (19) million in 2009. In 2009 divestments contributed EUR (119) million to the loss due to the sale of Industry Pension Funds. Special items in 2010 were EUR (33) million, relating to the integration of the Dutch insurance companies, compared to EUR (117) million in 2009 related to restructuring provisions and other costs related to the integration of the Dutch insurance companies.

INSURANCE CENTRAL AND REST OF EUROPE

 

     Insurance CRE  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     76        77        77   

Fees and premium based revenues

     458        501        522   

Technical margin

     169        149        175   

Income non-modeled life business

     9        16        14   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     712        743        788   

Administrative expenses

     308        261        261   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     202        197        197   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     510        458        458   

Life & ING IM operating result

     202        285        330   

Non-life operating result

     5        7        6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     207        292        336   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (404     (29     (44

Revaluations

     (1    

Market & other impacts

       (10     (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     (198     253        291   

Taxation

     21        63        57   

Minority interests

     10        10        12   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     (229     180        222   

Divestments

       (4     (13

Special items

     (77     (46     (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     (306     130        195   

 

85


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Insurance Central and Rest of Europe was a loss of EUR (198) million compared to a EUR 253 million profit in 2010. In addition to a lower operating result, the gains/losses and impairments were EUR (404) million compared to EUR (29) million in 2010. This decrease was mainly caused by EUR 324 million impairments of Greek governments bonds, EUR 34 million capital losses on sales of Italian sovereign bonds and EUR 18 million capital losses on sales of Portuguese bonds of financial institutions.

The operating result declined 29.3% to EUR 207 million from EUR 292 million last year. The decline was mainly driven by lower fees reflecting regulatory changes in the region’s major pension markets (Poland, Hungary) and higher administrative expenses, mainly related to project costs.

The investment margin of EUR 76 million remained flat compared with EUR 77 million last year. Fees and premium-based revenues declined 8.6% compared with 2010. This decline was driven by regulatory changes affecting pension funds in Poland and Hungary. In addition the decline reflects a reallocation of health insurance premiums in Greece to the technical margin. The technical margin increased by 13.4% due to the reallocation of health insurance premiums in Greece from fees and premium-based revenues. Life administrative expenses rose by 17.7% compared with last year, mainly due to higher project-related costs as Solvency II and building a regional IT organisation. The increase also reflects non-recurring restructuring expenses in Spain, Hungary and Greece.

New sales (APE) increased 1.3% compared to the previous year. Life sales rose by EUR 23 million compared to 2010, due to successful new product launches. This increase was offset by EUR 18 million lower pension sales compared to 2010, reflecting the regulatory changes for pension funds in Poland and Hungary.

Underlying net result decreased EUR (409) million to EUR (229) million in 2011 from EUR 180 million in 2010. Net result decreased EUR (436) million to EUR (306) million from a EUR 130 million net result in 2010. In 2010 divestments contributed EUR (4) million to the net profit due to the sale of Greece non-life. Special items in 2011 were EUR (77) million, relating to disentanglement of ING Bank, and a program to standardise regional IT-, procurement and finance processes, compared to EUR (46) million in 2010 also related to the program to standardize regional IT-, procurement and finance processes .

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Insurance Central and Rest of Europe decreased by 12.7% to EUR 253 million from EUR 291 million in 2009. Gains and losses on sales of securities and impairments were EUR (29) million in 2010 compared to EUR (45) million in 2009, mainly as a result of EUR 10 million lower impairments in Spain. Market and other impacts were EUR (10) million as a result of a prepaid capitalized commission write-off in the pension fund in Hungary.

The operating result fell by 13.1% to EUR 292 million. This result was largely driven by a EUR 26 million lower technical margin and EUR 21 million lower fees and premium-based revenues. The EUR 26 million lower technical margin was largely driven by a release in the provision for rider reserves in Poland and Hungary in 2009 of EUR 23 million and to a lesser extent by a lower realized result on surrenders. The decrease in fees and premium-based revenues of EUR 21 million was largely driven by lower revenues in both the pension fund in Poland and the life company in the Czech Republic. Administrative expenses were stable at EUR 261 million in 2010 compared to EUR 261 million in 2009, despite a EUR 16 million tax on financial institutions in Hungary and a EUR 7 million currency impact. Excluding both items, administrative expenses were EUR 22 million lower on a comparable basis.

Underlying net result decreased to EUR 180 million in 2010 from EUR 222 million in 2009. Net result in 2010 decreased to EUR 130 million from EUR 195 million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (46) million, relating to a program to standardize regional IT-, procurement and finance processes, compared to EUR (14) million in 2009 related to restructuring provisions.

 

86


Table of Contents

INSURANCE UNITED STATES

 

     Insurance United States  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     892        827        643   

Fees and premium based revenues

     1,064        1,060        967   

Technical margin

     72        195        238   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     2,028        2,082        1,848   

Administrative expenses

     742        904        791   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     625        619        489   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     1,367        1,523        1,280   

Life & ING IM operating result

     661        559        568   

Operating result

     661        559        568   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (166     (564     (515

Revaluations

     159        490        272   

Market & other impacts

     (36     (177     31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     618        308        356   

Taxation

     (22     (155     138   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     640        463        218   

Divestments

       (12     (62

Special items

     (44     (66     (202
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     596        385        (46

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Insurance US more than doubled to EUR 618 million from EUR 308 million in 2010. The increase was driven by higher operating results, lower impairments, and favourable DAC unlocking, partially offset by lower revaluations and a non-recurring increase in reserves related to the company’s use of the U.S. Social Security Death Master File to identify potential claims.

The operating result for Insurance US increased 18.3% as a higher investment margin and lower operating expenses were partially offset by a lower technical margin. The investment margin increased by 7.8% primarily due to a reduction in average interest credited. The technical margin decreased by 63.1% compared with 2010, in part due to lower amortisation of a gain related to the transfer of the US group reinsurance business in the first quarter of 2010 as well as a non-recurring reserve reduction in the prior year. Administrative expenses were 17.9% lower than in 2010 due to changes in the company’s pension plan as well as cost savings.

New sales (APE) were 5.9% lower compared with 2010 due to lower Stable Value and Fixed Annuity sales.

Underlying net result increased by EUR 177 million to EUR 640 million in 2011 from EUR 463 million in 2010. Net result increased by EUR 212 million to EUR 596 million from a EUR 385 million net result in 2010. In 2010 divestments contributed EUR (12) million to the net profit due to the divestment of US Group Re, US Advisors Network and ING Canada. Special items in 2011 were EUR (44) million relating to separation of Insurance/IM US from ING Bank, the establishment of a new head office and the local activities for the IPO preparation, compared to EUR (66) million in 2010 relating to restructuring costs.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying result before tax of Insurance US in 2010 decreased to EUR 308 million from EUR 356 million in 2009. The impact of non-operating items in 2010 of EUR (251) million was greater than the impact in 2009 of EUR (212) million as the higher favorable result from revaluations was more than offset by lower results from deferred acquisition costs (“DAC”) and reserve adjustments, primarily related to fixed annuities. The operating result decreased slightly to EUR 559 million in 2010 from EUR 568 million in 2009. Higher operating income in 2010 was more than cancelled out by higher administrative expenses and DAC amortisation and trail commissions. The rise in operating income was driven by a higher investment margin mainly from lower interest rate swap expenses and reinvestments into (longer duration) fixed income securities, and also from higher fees and premium-based revenues, as a result of increased assets under management. Administrative expenses

 

87


Table of Contents

increased to EUR 904 million from EUR 791 million in 2009. The comparison with 2009 is impacted by accrual adjustments which lowered expenses in 2009 as well as currency effects. DAC amortisation and trail commissions increased to EUR 619 million from EUR 489 million in 2009 due to higher operating income and higher assets under management resulting in higher trail commissions.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 463 million in 2010 from EUR 218 million in 2009. Net result in 2010 increased to EUR 385 million from a loss of EUR (46) million in 2009. Divestments in 2010 were EUR (12) million compared to EUR (62) million in 2009 related to the divestment of US Group Re, US Advisors Network and ING Canada. Special items in 2010 were EUR (66) million, relating to restructuring costs, compared to EUR (202) million in 2009 mainly related to the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facilities.

INSURANCE US CLOSED BLOCK VA

 

     Insurance US Closed Block VA  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     28        (11     22   

Fees and premium based revenues

     168        121        167   

Technical margin

     28        9        25   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     224        119        214   

Administrative expenses

     81        77        87   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     124        (7     104   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     205        70        191   

Life & ING IM operating result

     19        49        23   

Operating result

     19        49        23   

Gains/losses and impairments

     2        22        38   

Revaluations

     1        3        (4

Market & other impacts

     (1,295     (2,149     (821
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     (1,273     (2,075     (764

Taxation

     (222     (57     (118
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     (1,051     (2,018     (646

Net result

     (1,051     (2,018     (646

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

As mentioned above, the completion of a comprehensive policyholder behaviour assumption review for the US Closed Block VA led to a charge of EUR 1.1 billion in the fourth quarter of 2011, which resulted in a loss of EUR (1,273) million on an underlying result before profit basis in the year 2011. The assumptions were updated for lapses, mortality, annuitisation, and utilisation rates, with the most significant revision coming from the adjustments of lapse assumptions. The impact of the assumption adjustments includes a charge to restore the reserve adequacy to the 50% confidence level for the US Closed Block VA. Since the decision to terminate sales of this product in early 2009, ING has taken actions to reduce risk for this legacy book. These actions include reducing deferred acquisition costs, strengthening reserves, expanding the hedging programmes and increasing transparency by reporting the US Closed Block VA as a separate business alongside the ongoing ING Insurance US businesses.

The operating result for the US Closed Block VA was EUR 19 million versus EUR 49 million in 2010.

The investment margin was EUR 28 million compared with EUR (11) million in 2010.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

The underlying loss before tax was EUR (2,075) million in 2010 compared with an underlying loss before tax of EUR (764) million in 2009. The negative underlying result before tax was driven by reductions in the DAC balance. In the second quarter of the year, the DAC balance was reduced as a result of an 11.9% decline in the S&P 500 during the quarter. In the fourth quarter, the DAC balance further decreased mainly due to a non-recurring DAC write down of EUR 975 million. This DAC write-down, triggered by making the VA business a

 

88


Table of Contents

separate business line, was implemented to improve the reserve adequacy to meet the 50% confidence level for the business on a stand-alone basis. Excluding these non-operating items, the operating result improved by EUR 26 million to EUR 49 million in 2010 from EUR 23 million in 2009, as lower expenses more than offset the decrease in operating income.

Life & ING IM operating income fell EUR 95 million to EUR 119 million from EUR 214 million in 2009, mainly due to lower investment margin and lower fees and premium based revenues. The investment margin decreased by EUR 33 million to EUR (11) million primarily reflecting higher balances in short-term investments and the impact of lower interest rates. Fees and premium-based revenues decreased by EUR 46 million to EUR 121 million as higher fee income was more than offset by higher hedging costs. The decrease in the technical margin of EUR 16 million was mainly attributable to non-recurring negative reserve developments in the fourth quarter 2010. Total life expenses decreased to EUR 70 million in 2010 from EUR 191 million in 2009 mainly due to lower DAC amortisation, resulting from lower operating income. Administrative expenses in 2010 were lower compared with 2009 as product distribution and support teams were reduced or redeployed following the strategic decision to cease sales of variable annuity products effective as of March 31, 2010. This decision was a part of the overall global strategy and risk reduction plan.

INSURANCE ASIA/PACIFIC

 

     Insurance Asia/Pacific  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     73        53        9   

Fees and premium based revenues

     1,442        1,329        1,083   

Technical margin

     178        157        163   

Income non-modeled life business

     44        80        86   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,737        1,619        1,341   

Administrative expenses

     456        441        410   

DAC amortization and trail commissions

     731        710        570   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     1,187        1,151        980   

Life & ING IM operating result

     550        468        361   

Non-life operating result

     4        5        4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     554        473        365   

Gains/losses and impairments

     60        50        26   

Revaluations

     (8     (14     (9

Market & other impacts

     (18     8        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     588        517        383   

Taxation

     121        137        112   

Minority interests

       1        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     467        379        270   

Divestments

     29          363   

Special items

     (2       (26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     494        379        606   

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

The underlying result before tax of Insurance Asia/Pacific increased by 14.0% to EUR 588 million compared with EUR 517 million in 2010. The operating result for Insurance Asia/Pacific increased by 17.4%, primarily driven by higher fees and premium-based revenue and a higher technical margin.

 

89


Table of Contents

The investment margin rose by 37.7%, supported by an improved spread between interest earned on general account assets and interest credited to reserves in Japan and Hong Kong. This was partly offset by lower dividend income. Fees and premium-based revenues increased by 8.5%, driven by growth in premium income, particularly in Japan’s COLI business as well as in Hong Kong and KB Life in South Korea. The inclusion of the Malaysian Employee Benefits business (modelled as of the first quarter of 2011), contributed an additional EUR 31 million, with a corresponding reduction in non-modelled income. The technical margin increased by 13.5% to EUR 178 million from EUR 157 million in the previous year, mainly driven by South Korea and Malaysia. Life administrative expenses increased 3.2% to support business growth. The ratio of administrative expenses to operating income fell from 27.3% in 2010 to 26.3% in 2011.

New sales (APE) increased by 11.8% driven by growth in Japan, Malaysia, Hong Kong and China.

Underlying net result increased EUR 88 million to EUR 467 million in 2011 from EUR 379 million in 2010. Net result increased by EUR 115 million to EUR 494 million from a EUR 379 million net result in 2010. In 2011 divestments contributed EUR 29 million to the net profit due to the sale of the share in the Pacific Antai Life Insurance Corporation. Special items in 2011 were EUR (2) million, relating to the separation of Insurance IM/Asia/Pacific from ING Bank.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Insurance Asia/Pacific posted an underlying result before tax of EUR 517 million in 2010, an increase of 34.7% compared to EUR 383 million in 2009. This was achieved by improved operating results in most countries in the region in 2010. Market-related items and other impacts contributed EUR 44 million to the result compared to EUR 18 million in 2009. The operating result of EUR 473 million in 2010 rose by 29.3% or 11.6% excluding currency effects from EUR 365 million in 2009, driven by higher operating income, partly offset by moderate growth in expenses.

The Life & ING IM operating income increased 20.6% to EUR 1,619 million in 2010 from EUR 1,342 million in 2009. The increase was attributable to higher fees and premium-based revenues driven by volume growth in most countries as well as an ongoing improvement in the investment margin reflecting increased investment income, growth in general account assets and reinvestment of cash in longer-duration assets. Administrative expenses increased by a modest 7.6%, but fell by 3.6% excluding currency effects as a result of focus on cost discipline throughout the region. DAC amortisation and trail commissions grew by 24.3% to EUR 710 million from the previous year reflecting currency impacts and business growth. Total Life & ING IM expenses increased by 17.3% to EUR 1,151 million compared to EUR 980 million in 2009.

Underlying net result increased to EUR 379 million in 2010 from EUR 270 million in 2009. Net result in 2010 decreased to EUR 379 million from EUR 606 million in 2009. Divestments in 2009 were EUR 363 million and related to Australia and Taiwan. Special items in 2009 were EUR (26) million, relating to a restructuring provision related to the Japan SPVA runoff.

 

90


Table of Contents

ING INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT

 

     ING Investment Management  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Investment margin

     4        2        17   

Fees and premium based revenues

     868        826        704   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     872        828        721   

Administrative expenses

     676        682        535   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     3        3        3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life& ING IM expenses

     679        685        538   

Life & ING IM operating result

     193        143        183   

Operating result

     193        143        183   

Gains/losses and impairments

     5        10     

Revaluations

     6        (3     (33
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     204        150        150   

Taxation

     72        56        56   

Minority interests

       1        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     132        93        93   

Divestments

     26          7   

Special items

     (12     (41     (27
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result

     146        52        73   

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Assets under management (AuM) at ING Investment Management (ING IM) increased 3.8% to EUR 321.7 billion from EUR 309.9 billion at year-end 2010. The AuM balance excluded assets managed by ING IM Australia (EUR 22.3 billion) which was sold on October 4, 2011. Inflows in the institutional and proprietary segments were partly offset by outflows in the retail segment.

The underlying result before tax increased 36.0% to EUR 204 million and the operating result increased 34.2% to EUR 193 million. Both increases were largely attributable to higher fee income in line with the increase in assets managed.

Fees and premium-based revenues increased 5.1% to EUR 868 million from EUR 826 million in 2010 supported by an increase in assets managed. The annualised fourth quarter ratio of fees to average AuM decreased to 27 basis points compared with the previous year at 29 basis points partly due to a change in the underlying asset mix. This ratio is calculated using an average of opening and closing AuM balances for the period. Administrative expenses were 0.8% lower than the previous year mainly due to staff reduction and a non-recurring expense reduction from a change to the IM US pension plan.

Underlying net result increased EUR 38 million to EUR 132 million in 2011 from EUR 93 million in 2010. Net result increased by EUR 93 million to EUR 146 million from a EUR 52 million net result in 2010. In 2011 divestments contributed EUR 26 million to the net profit due to the sale of IM Australia. Special items in 2011 and 2010 were EUR (12) million and EUR (41) million, respectively, relating to the integration into one global investment management organisation.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Underlying result before tax remained stable at EUR 150 million in 2010 as a result of a EUR 30 million reduction in negative revaluations in private equity investments and the reversal of an impairment on assets in India (EUR 8 million), which were almost cancelled out by a EUR 40 million lower operating result.

The operating result fell by 21.8% to EUR 143 million as a result of a EUR 146 million increase in administrative expenses and a EUR 15 million reduction in the investment margin, which was in total largely offset by EUR 122 million higher fees and premium-based revenues. Fees and premium-based revenues increased by 17.3% to EUR 826 million. The 9.2% increase in assets under management was the main driver for these higher revenues, further assisted by the introduction of a fixed service fee in the third quarter which related to the

 

91


Table of Contents

transfer of funds to the Luxembourg platform. As of the third quarter of 2010, expenses of these funds were no longer recorded as negative fee income. Administrative expenses grew by 27.3% to EUR 682 million in 2010 from EUR 535 million in the previous year. Comparisons with 2009 were impacted by accrual adjustments, which reduced the expense level in the fourth quarter of 2009 by EUR 33 million. This increase was mainly due to the introduction of a fixed service fee (EUR 17 million) and higher staff costs.

Underlying net result remained unchanged at EUR 93 million. Net result in 2010 decreased to EUR 52 million from EUR 73 million in 2009. Special items in 2010 were EUR (41) million, relating to the integration into one global investment management organisation and EUR (27) million in 2009 relating to restructuring provisions.

 

92


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

The following table sets forth ING Group’s condensed consolidated assets and liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, reference is made page F-3 for the complete consolidated balance sheet of ING Group.

 

     2011      2010      2009  
     (EUR billions, except amounts per share)  

Cash and balances with central banks

     31.2         13.1         15.4   

Amounts due to banks

     45.3         51.8         43.4   

Investments

     217.4         234.2         212.1   

Financial assets at fair value through the profit and loss account

     262.7         263.9         233.2   

Loans and advances to customers

     596.9         608.9         575.3   

Assets held for sale

     62.5         0.7         5.0   

Other assets

     31.0         36.5         39.2   

Total assets

     1,273.6         1,242.7         1,160.0   

Insurance and investment contracts:

        

Life

     262.1         255.5         226.7   

Non-life

     3.5         3.6         3.5   

Investment contracts

     13.2         12.0         11.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total insurance and investment contracts

     278.8         271.1         241.5   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposits (1)

     467.5         511.4         469.5   

Debt securities in issue/other borrowed funds

     159.5         157.9         143.1   

Liabilities held for sale

     64.3         0.4         4.9   

Other liabilities

     33.2         36.4         40.3   

Total liabilities (including minority interests)

     1,227.4         1,199.3         1,123.0   

Non-voting equity securities

     3.0         5.0         5.0   

Shareholders’ equity

     42.5         37.7         30.9   

Shareholders’ equity per Ordinary Share (in EUR)

     11.22         9.98         8.17   

 

(1)

Customer deposits and other funds on deposits consists of savings accounts, other deposits, bank funds and debt securities privately issued by the banking operations of ING.

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Total assets increased in 2011 by 2.5%, or EUR 30.9 billion, to EUR 1,273.6 billion. Cash and balances with central banks increased to EUR 31.2 billion from EUR 13.1 billion at year-end 2010. This was mainly due to a further increase of overnight deposits with central banks, while amounts due from banks declined by EUR 6.5 billion. Investments decreased by EUR 16.8 billion to EUR 217.4 billion, due to the transfer of EUR 21.1 billion of assets of ING Direct USA to assets held for sale. Loans and advances to customers decreased by EUR 12.0 billion to EUR 596.9 billion at year-end 2011 from EUR 608.9 billion at year-end 2010. Adjusted for the ING Direct USA sale, loans and advances to customers increased EUR 18 billion, due to positive currency effects, growth in short-term lending to ‘mid-corporates, SMEs and other’ and mortgage growth at the other ING Direct locations and Retail Benelux partly offset by repayments, run-off and selective de-risking. Assets held for sale increased by EUR 61.8 billion to EUR 62.5 billion. At year-end 2011, assets held for sale entirely relate to ING Direct USA. Other assets decreased by EUR 5.5 billion, almost half of this was caused by the transfer of ING Direct USA to Assets held for sale.

Shareholders’ equity increased EUR 4.8 billion from EUR 37.7 billion at the end of 2010 to EUR 42.5 billion at the end of 2011. This increase was caused by the EUR 4.7 billion net profit. Positive changes in reserves were offset by the EUR 1 billion repayment premium paid to the Dutch state in May 2011. This amount is the 50% premium paid on the repayment of EUR 2 billion Core Tier 1 Securities issued in November 2008. This was an important step towards full repayment of the support ING received from the Dutch State.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Total assets increased in 2010 by 7.1%, or EUR 82.7 billion, to EUR 1,242.7 billion, mainly due a EUR 22.1 billion increase of investments, increased financial assets at fair value through the profit and loss account of EUR 30.7 billion and loans and advances to customers which rose by EUR 33.6 billion. The increase in Investments was almost entirely caused by the insurance operations, which rose by EUR 17.8 billion due to

 

93


Table of Contents

positive revaluations and favourable currency effects. The financial assets at fair value through the profit and loss account of the banking operations increased by EUR 12.3 billion, due to positive currency effects and higher trading and non-trading derivatives. The insurance operations increased by EUR 17.4 billion, mainly due to increased investments for risk of policyholders. The increase in loans and advances to customers was almost completely caused by the banking operations, which increased by EUR 35.1 billion almost entirely in residential mortgages at ING Direct and in the Benelux.

Shareholders’ equity increased by 22.1% or EUR 6.8 billion to EUR 37.7 billion at December 31, 2010 compared to EUR 30.9 billion at December 31, 2009. The increase is mainly due the net profit of EUR 2.4 billion, unrealised revaluations debt securities of EUR 3.1 billion and exchange rate difference of EUR 2.9 billion, partly offset by deferred interest crediting to life policyholders of EUR (1.6) billion.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

ING Groep N.V. is a holding company whose principal assets are its investments in the capital stock of its primary insurance and banking subsidiaries. The liquidity and capital resource considerations for ING Groep N.V., ING Insurance and ING Bank vary in light of the business conducted by each, as well as the insurance and bank regulatory requirements applicable to the Group in the Netherlands and the other countries in which it does business. ING Groep N.V. has no employees and substantially all of ING Groep N.V.’s operating expenses are allocated to and paid by its operating companies.

As a holding company, ING Groep N.V.’s principal sources of funds are funds that may be raised from time to time from the issuance of debt or equity securities and bank or other borrowings, as well as cash dividends received from its subsidiaries. ING Groep N.V.’s total debt and capital securities outstanding to third parties at December 31, 2011 was EUR 15,517 million, at December 31, 2010, EUR 18,337 million and at December 31, 2009, EUR 17,684. The EUR 15,517 million of debt and capital securities outstanding at December 31, 2011, consisted of subordinated loans of EUR 10,017 million and debenture loans of EUR 5,500 million, both specified below :

 

Interest rate (%)

     Year of issue      Due date      Balance sheet
value
 
(EUR millions)  
  9.000         2008         Perpetual         10   
  8.500         2008         Perpetual         1,527   
  8.000         2008         Perpetual         1,500   
  7.375         2007         Perpetual         1,176   
  6.375         2007         Perpetual         804   
  5.140         2006         Perpetual         79   
  5.775         2005         Perpetual         292   
  6.125         2005         Perpetual         533   
  4.176         2005         Perpetual         168   
  Variable         2004         Perpetual         527   
  6.200         2003         Perpetual         376   
  Variable         2003         Perpetual         424   
  7.200         2002         Perpetual         839   
  7.050         2002         Perpetual         603   
  Variable         2000         December 31, 2030         1,159   
        

 

 

 
           10,017   
        

 

 

 

 

Interest rate (%)

   Year of issue      Due date      Balance sheet
value
 
(EUR millions)  
4.125      2011         March 23, 2015         653   
5.625      2008         September 3, 2013         1,053   
4.699      2007         June 1, 2035         117   
4.750      2007         May 31, 2017         1,932   
Variable      2006         April 11, 2016         998   
4.125      2006         April 11, 2016         747   
        

 

 

 
           5,500   
        

 

 

 

 

94


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, ING Groep N.V. also owed EUR 2,869 million, EUR 736 million and EUR 800 million, respectively, to ING Group companies pursuant to intercompany lending arrangements. Of the EUR 2,869 million owed by ING Groep N.V. to ING Group companies at December 31, 2011, EUR 0 million was owed to ING Insurance companies, EUR 2,869 million was owed to ING Bank companies and EUR 0 million was owed to direct subsidiaries of ING Group companies, as a result of normal intercompany transactions.

In October 2008 ING issued Core Tier 1 Securities to the Dutch State for a total consideration of EUR 10,000 million. This capital injection qualifies as core Tier 1 capital for regulatory purposes. Such securities were not issued in the years before. In December 2009 ING repurchased EUR 5,000 million of the non-voting equity securities from the Dutch State. On May 13, 2011 ING repurchased of EUR 2 billion in principal of the remaining non-voting equity securities, with the total payment in May 2011 amounting to EUR 3 billion (including a 50)% repayment premium).

At December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, ING Groep N.V. had EUR 1,400 million, EUR 72 million and EUR 183 million of cash, respectively. Dividends paid to the Company by its subsidiaries amounted to EUR 3,000 million, EUR 200 million and EUR 350 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively, in each case representing dividends declared and paid with respect to the reporting calendar year and the prior calendar year. Of the amounts paid to the Company, EUR 0 million, EUR 0 million and EUR 350 million were received from ING Insurance in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively; EUR 3,000 million, EUR 200 million and EUR 0 million were received from ING Bank in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. On the other hand, the Company injected EUR 0 million, EUR 1,500 million and EUR 700 million into its direct subsidiaries during the reporting year 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Of the amounts injected by the Company, EUR 0 million, EUR 1,500 million and EUR 550 million were injected into ING Insurance in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively; EUR 0 million, EUR 0 million and EUR 150 million were injected into ING Bank in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. ING and its Dutch subsidiaries are subject to legal restrictions on the amount of dividends they can pay to their shareholders. The Dutch Civil Code provides that dividends can only be paid by Dutch companies up to an amount equal to the excess of a company’s shareholders’ equity over the sum of (1) paid-up capital and (2) shareholders’ reserves required by law. Further, certain of the Group companies are subject to restrictions on the amount of funds they may transfer in the form of cash dividends or otherwise to ING Groep N.V.

In addition to the restrictions in respect of minimum capital and capital base requirements that are imposed by insurance, banking and other regulators in the countries in which the Group’s subsidiaries operate, other limitations exist in certain countries. For example, the operations of the Group’s insurance company subsidiaries located in the United States are subject to limitations on the payment of dividends to their parent company under applicable state insurance laws. Dividends paid in excess of these limitations generally require prior approval of the Insurance Commissioner of the state of domicile.

On December 12, 2011 ING announced the launch of three separate exchange offers in Europe and tender offers in the United States of America, on a total of seven series of outstanding subordinated securities of ING entities with a total nominal value of approximately EUR 5.8 billion. As of December 23, 2011, all tender and exchange offers announced on December 12, 2011 were successfully completed. For more information see Note 14 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

ING Group Consolidated Cash Flows

ING’s Risk Management, including liquidity, is discussed in Note 2.2.1 “Risk Management” of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

Net cash flow from operating activities amounted to EUR 9,187 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared with EUR (4,775) million for the year ended December 31, 2010. This increase was mainly due to amounts due to/from banks and trading assets/liabilities. The cash flow generated through the customer deposits and other funds on deposit and loans and advances was EUR 27,019 million and EUR 21,202 million respectively. The cash flow employed in lending increased from a cash outflow of EUR (16,331) million in 2010 to a cash outflow of EUR (23,713) million in 2011.

Net cash flow from investment activities in 2011 was EUR 6,504 million, compared to EUR (3,349) million in 2010. The increase was mainly caused by higher disposals and redemptions of group companies, available-for-sale investments and investments for risk of policyholders.

 

95


Table of Contents

Net cash flow from financing activities was EUR (6,931) million in 2011, compared to EUR 7,640 million in 2010. The decrease of EUR 14,571 million in net cash flow from financing activities is mainly due to repayment of non voting securities, repayment of subordinated loans and net repayment of other borrowed funds.

The operating, investing and financing activities described above resulted in net cash and cash equivalents at year-end 2011 of EUR 29,300 million, compared with EUR 20,740 million at year-end 2010, an increase of EUR 8,560 million from 2010 levels.

 

     2011     2010  
     (EUR millions)  

Treasury bills and other eligible bills

     2,611        4,441   

Amounts due from/to banks

     (4,505     3,227   

Cash and balances with central banks

     31,194        13,072   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     29,300        20,740   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

Net cash flow from operating activities amounted to EUR (4,775) million for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared with EUR (27,400) million for the year ended December 31, 2009. This increase was mainly due trading assets/trading liabilities and banks, loans and funds entrusted. The cash flow generated through the customer deposits and other funds on deposit and loans and advances was EUR 21,202 million and EUR 21,073 million respectively, offset by lower banks (amounts due from/to banks not available on demand). The cash flow employed in lending decreased from a cash inflow of EUR 12,208 million in 2009 to a cash outflow of EUR (16,331) million in 2010.

Net cash flow from investment activities in 2010 was EUR (3,349) million, compared to EUR 3,239 million in 2009. The decrease was mainly caused by higher disposals and redemptions of group companies, available-for-sale investments and investments for risk of policyholders.

Net cash flow from financing activities was EUR 7,640 million in 2010, compared to EUR 13,853 million in 2009. The decrease of EUR 6,213 million in net cash flow from financing activities is mainly due to lower repayments/proceeds of borrowed funds and debt securities.

The operating, investing and financing activities described above resulted in net cash and cash equivalents at year-end 2010 of EUR 20,740 million, compared with EUR 20,959 million at year-end 2009, a decrease of EUR 219 million from 2009 levels.

 

     2010      2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Treasury bills and other eligible bills

     4,441         3,182   

Amounts due from/to banks

     3,227         2,387   

Cash and balances with central banks

     13,072         15,390   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     20,740         20,959   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital Adequacy

The debt/equity ratio of ING Group as at year-end 2011 was 12.71% (2010: 13.44%).

ING Group reports to the Dutch Central Bank as required under the Dutch implementation of the financial conglomerates directive (FICO). The directive mainly covers risk concentrations in the group, intra-group transactions and an assessment of the capital adequacy of the Group.

In the following table, we show the Group’s FICO ratio on the following basis:

 

 

Insurance required capital from applying European Solvency I rules to all ING Insurance entities globally (regardless of local capital requirements);

 

 

Bank required capital based on applying Basel II with the Basel I floor (80% of Basel I Risk Weighted Assets);

 

 

Group FICO capital using an approach similar to that used for Bank BIS capital and Insurance IGD capital whereby Group leverage is deducted.

 

96


Table of Contents
     2011     2010  
     (EUR millions)  

BIS capital

     47,123        49,145   

IGD capital

     21,406        20,336   

Group leverage (core debt)

     (7,917     (8,462
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Regulatory capital

     60,611        61,019   

Required capital banking operations

     31,107        29,860   

Required capital insurance operations

     9,515        8,826   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total required capital

     40,621        38,686   

FICO ratio

     149     158

ING Bank Cash Flows

The principal sources of funds for ING Bank’s operations are growth of the retail funding, which mainly consists of current accounts, savings and retail deposits, repayments of loans, disposals and redemptions of investment securities (mainly bonds), sales of trading portfolio securities, interest income and commission income. The major uses of funds are advances of loans and other credits, investments, purchases of investment securities, funding of trading portfolios, interest expense and administrative expenses (see “Item 11 Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risk”).

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, ING Bank had EUR 26,217 million and EUR 17,188 million, respectively, of cash and cash equivalents. The increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents is mainly attributable to the cash and bank balance positions with Central banks.

Specification of cash position (EUR millions):

 

     2011     2010  
     (EUR millions)  

Cash

     28,112        9,519   

Short dated government paper

     2,611        4,442   

Banks on demand

     (4,506     3,227   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash balance and cash equivalents

     26,217        17,188   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The EUR 20,009 million increase in ING Bank’s operating activities, consist of EUR 8,923 million cash inflow for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared to EUR 11,086 million cash outflow for the year ended December 31, 2010.

The cash flow from operating activities was largely affected by cash inflows from Customer deposits and other funds on deposit (EUR 30,569 million compared to a cash inflow in 2010 of EUR 21,052 million), cash outflows from Amounts due to and from Banks (EUR 4,523 million compared to a cash outflow in 2010 of EUR 14,164 million) and a cash outflow of loans and advances to customers of EUR 26,392 million (compared to a cash outflow in 2010 of EUR 19,665).

Net cash inflow from investing activities was EUR 4,027 million (2010: EUR 1,303 million cash inflow). Investments in available-for-sale securities was EUR 155,004 million and EUR 89,614 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively. Disposals and redemptions of available-for-sale securities amounted to EUR 155,826 million and EUR 88,333 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Net cash flow from financing activities in 2011 amounted to a cash outflow of EUR 3,778 million compared to a cash inflow in 2010 of EUR 8,224 million, and is mainly attributable to less balance cash inflow from debt securities in issue and a dividend payment of EUR 3,000 million.

 

97


Table of Contents

The operating, investing and financing activities described above resulted in a positive cash flow of EUR 9,172 in 2011 compared to a negative net cash flow of EUR (1,559) million in 2010.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

At December 31, 2010 and 2009, ING Bank had EUR 17,188 million and EUR 18,170 million, respectively, of cash and cash equivalents. The decrease in Cash and Cash Equivalents is mainly attributable to the cash and bank balance positions with Central banks.

Specification of cash position (EUR millions):

 

     2010      2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Cash

     9,519         12,602   

Short dated government paper

     4,442         3,181   

Banks on demand

     3,227         2,387   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash balance and cash equivalents

     17,188         18,170   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The EUR 24,634 million increase in ING Bank’s operating activities, consist of EUR 11,086 million cash outflow for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared to EUR 35,720 million cash outflow for the year ended December 31, 2009.

The cash flow from operating activities was largely affected by cash flows from Amounts due to and from Banks (cash outflow of EUR 14,164 million compared to a cash outflow in 2009 of EUR 58,799 million) and a cash outflow of loans and advances to customers of EUR 19,665 million compared to a cash inflow in 2009 of EUR 9,489).

Net cash flow for investment activities was EUR 1.303 million cash inflow (2009: EUR 4,819 million cash inflow). Investment in interest-earning securities was EUR 89,614 million and EUR 58,424 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively. Disposals and redemptions of interest-earning securities was EUR 88,333 million and EUR 62,669 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Net cash inflow from financing activities in 2010 amounted to EUR 8,224 million compared to a cash inflow in 2009 of EUR 21,681 million, and is mainly attributable to less on balance cash inflow from debt securities in issue.

The operating, investment and financing activities described above resulted in a negative cash flow of EUR (1,559) in 2010 compared to a negative net cash flow of EUR (9,220) million in 2009.

Capital Adequacy

Capital adequacy and the use of capital are monitored by ING Bank and its subsidiaries, employing techniques based on the guidelines developed by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and implemented by the EU and the Dutch Central Bank for supervisory purposes. See “Item 4 Information on the Company”. Qualifying capital is based on IFRS-EU, as primary accounting basis, which is also the basis for statutory and regulatory reporting.

The following table sets forth the capital position of ING Bank N.V. as of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

 

98


Table of Contents

Capital position of ING Bank

 
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     30,156        31,267        27,480   

Difference IFRS-IASB and IFRS-EU

     4,211        3,185        2,742   

Minority interests

     817        748        960   

Subordinated loans qualifying as Tier 1 capital (2 )

     6,850        8,438        8,057   

Goodwill and intangibles deductible from Tier 1 (5)

     (1,390     (1,645     (1,636

Deductions Tier 1

     (1,014     (1,069     (1,073

Revaluation reserve (2)

     (1,008     (1,592     (2,516
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Available capital – Tier 1

     38,622        39,332        34,015   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplementary capital – Tier 2 (3)

     9,516        10,882        11,789   

Deductions

     (1,014     (1,069     (1,073
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

BIS capital

     47,124        49,145        44,731   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets

     330,421        321,103        332,375   

Tier 1 ratio

     11.69     12.25     10.23

BIS ratio

     14.26     15.30     13.46

Required capital based on Basel I floor (4)

     31,107        29,860        28,709   

BIS ratio based on Basel I floor (4)

     12.12     13.17     12.46

 

(1) 

Subordinated loans qualifying as Tier 1 capital have been placed by ING Groep N.V. with ING Bank N.V.

(2) 

Includes revaluation debt securities, revaluation reserve cash flow hedge and revaluation reserves equity and real estate

(3) 

Includes eligible lower Tier-2 loans and revaluation reserves equity and real estate revaluations removed from Tier 1 capital.

(4) 

Using 80% of Basel I Risk-Weighted Assets.

(5) 

According to the regulatory definition

Capital measures in the table exclude the difference between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB as capital measures are based on IFRS-EU as primary accounting basis for statutory and regulatory reporting.

ING Group’s management believes that working capital is sufficient to meet the current and reasonably foreseeable needs of the Company.

ING Insurance Cash Flows

The principal sources of funds for ING Insurance are premiums, net investment income and proceeds from sales or maturity of investments, while the major uses of these funds are to provide life policy benefits, pay surrenders and profit sharing for life policyholders, pay non-life claims and related claims expenses, and pay other operating costs. ING Insurance generates a substantial cash flow from operations as a result of most premiums being received in advance of the time when claim payments or policy benefits are required. These positive operating cash flows, along with that portion of the investment portfolio that is held in cash and highly liquid securities, have historically met the liquidity requirements of ING Insurance’s operations, as evidenced by the growth in investments. See Note 2.2.1 “Risk Management” to the consolidated financial statements.

Year ended December 31, 2011 compared to year ended December 31, 2010

ING Insurance’s liquidity requirements are met on both a short- and long-term basis by funds provided from insurance premiums collected, investment income and collected reinsurance receivables, and from the sale and maturity of investments. ING Insurance also has access to commercial paper, medium-term note and other credit facilities. ING Insurance’s balance of cash and cash equivalents was EUR 11,577 million at December 31, 2011 and EUR 8,646 million at December 31, 2010.

 

     2011      2010  
     (EUR millions)  

Cash and bank balances

     3,230         4,057   

Short term deposits

     8,347         4,589   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     11,577         8,646   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities was EUR 2,069 million in 2011 and EUR 2,857 million in 2010.

 

99


Table of Contents

Net cash used by ING Insurance in investment activities was EUR 2,477 million in 2011 and EUR (4,466) million in 2010. The increase was caused by group companies, available-for-sale- investments and investments for risk of policyholders.

Cash provided by ING Insurance’s financing activities amounted to EUR (1,558) million and EUR 1,140 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively. The decrease was due to Proceeds/repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities.

Year ended December 31, 2010 compared to year ended December 31, 2009

ING Insurance’s liquidity requirements are met on both a short- and long-term basis by funds provided from insurance premiums collected, investment income and collected reinsurance receivables, and from the sale and maturity of investments. ING Insurance also has access to commercial paper, medium-term note and other credit facilities. ING Insurance’s balance of cash and cash equivalents was EUR 8,646 million at December 31, 2010 and EUR 9,425 million at December 31, 2009.

 

     2010      2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Cash and bank balances

     4,057         3,752   

Short term deposits

     4,589         5,673   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     8,646         9,425   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities was EUR 2,857 million in 2010 and EUR 3,876 million in 2009.

Net cash used by ING Insurance in investment activities was EUR (4,466) million in 2010 and EUR (1,590) million in 2009.

Cash provided by ING Insurance’s financing activities amounted to EUR 1,140 million and EUR (7,303) million in 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase was due to Proceeds/repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities.

The table below shows the Insurance Group Directive which represent the consolidated regulatory Solvency I position of ING Insurance business. The Insurance companies complied with their respective local regulatory requirements.

 

     2011     2010 (1)  
     (EUR millions)  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     23,475        20,159   

Hybrids issued by ING Group (2)

     2,604        2,094   

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance (3)

     1,726        2,207   

Required regulatory adjustments

     (6,399     (4,125
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

IGD capital

     21,406        20,335   

EU required capital base (4)

     9,515        8,826   

IGD Solvency ratio (4)(5)

     225     230

 

(1)

In the first quarter of 2011 these numbers have been restated to reflect the move towards fair value accounting for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for life in the US closed block VA as of January 1, 2011. Further details on the restatement are available in the restated fourth quarter 2010 Historical Trend Document which is available on www.ing.com.

(2)

Hybrids issued by ING Group at notional value

(3)

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance at notional value capped at 25% of EU required capital

(4)

In the fourth quarter 2011, ING has reviewed the calculation of the IGD ratio to ensure consistent application throughout the Group. As a consequence, several changes have been made, mainly related to (i) certain provisions which are internally reinsured and for which required capitals were netted out in the past and (ii) changes in the allocation of policyholder liabilities to the relevant capital requirement categories. The numbers for 2010 have been adjusted for this change.

(5)

The actual required regulatory adjustments for IGD capital and the EU required capital may be different from the estimate since the statutory results are not final until filed with the regulators.

 

100


Table of Contents

Adjusted Equity

ING calculates certain capital ratios on the basis of “adjusted equity”. Adjusted equity differs from Shareholders’ equity in the consolidated balance sheet. The main differences are that adjusted equity excludes unrealized gains and losses on debt securities, goodwill and the cash flow hedge reserve and includes hybrid capital and the Core Tier 1 Securities. Adjusted equity also excludes the difference between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB, as capital ratios are based on IFRS-EU as primary accounting basis, which is also the basis for statutory and regulatory reporting. Adjusted equity for 2011, 2010 and 2009 is reconciled to shareholders’ equity as follows:

 

     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Shareholders’ equity

     42,452        37,719        30,901   

Difference between IFRS-IASB and IFRS-EU

     4,211        3,185        2,742   

Core Tier 1 Securities

     3,000        5,000        5,000   

Group hybrid capital

     9,332        12,039        11,478   

Revaluation reserves debt securities and other

     (4,626     (3,469     (1,291
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted equity

     54,369        54,474        48,831   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Group hybrid capital” comprises subordinated loans and preference shares issued by ING Group, which qualify as (Tier 1) capital for regulatory purposes, but are classified as liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet.

“Revaluation reserves debt securities and other” includes unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale debt securities and revaluation reserve crediting to policyholders of EUR (650) million in 2011, EUR 330 million in 2010 and EUR 2,325 million in 2009, the cash flow hedge reserve of EUR (1,970) million in 2011, EUR (847) million in 2010 and EUR (372) million in 2009 and capitalized goodwill of EUR (2,006) million in 2011, EUR (2,908) million in 2010 and EUR (3,244) million in 2009.

ING uses adjusted equity in calculating its debt/equity ratio, which is a key measure in ING’s Group capital management process. The debt/equity ratio based on adjusted equity is used to measure the leverage of ING Group The target and actual debt/equity ratio based on adjusted equity are communicated internally to key management and externally to investors, analysts and rating agencies on a quarterly basis. ING uses adjusted equity for these purposes instead of Shareholders’ equity presented in the balance sheet principally for the following reasons:

 

   

adjusted equity is calculated using criteria that are similar to the capital model that is used by Standard and Poor’s to measure, compare and analyze capital adequacy and leverage for insurance groups, and the level of our adjusted equity may thus have an impact on the S&P ratings for the Company and its operating insurance subsidiaries;

 

   

ING believes its Standard and Poor’s financial strength and other ratings are one of the most significant factors looked at by our clients and brokers, and accordingly are important to the operations and prospects of our insurance operating subsidiaries, and a major distinguishing factor vis-à-vis our competitors and peers.

To the extent our debt/equity ratio (based on adjusted equity) increases or the components thereof change significantly period over period, we believe that rating agencies and regulators would all view this as material information relevant to our financial health and solvency. On the basis of adjusted equity, the debt/equity ratio of ING increased to 12.7% in 2011 from 13.4% in 2010. The debt/equity ratio of ING Group between December 31, 2002 and December 31, 2011 has been in the range of 19.9% to 9.0%. Although rating agencies take many factors into account in the ratings process and any of those factors alone or together with other factors may affect our rating, we believe that an increase of our debt/equity ratio in a significant way, and for an extended period of time, could result in actions from rating agencies including a possible downgrade of the financial strength ratings of our operating subsidiaries. Similarly, although regulatory authorities do not currently set any explicit leverage requirements for ING Group, such an increase of our debt/equity ratio could also likely result in greater scrutiny by regulatory authorities. Over the last year, ING has targeted a 15% debt/equity ratio for ING Group currently, but management aims to reduce the Group debt/equity ratio to 10% in the near term. In addition, ING stated in its Restructuring Plan as presented on October 26, 2009 that in the coming years, as insurance units are divested, ING Groep N.V. wants to reduce its core Debt to zero, thereby eliminating the double leverage. These targets are reviewed at least once a year and approved by the Executive Board. During the yearly review, many factors are taken into account to establish this target, such as rating agency guidance, regulatory guidance, peer review, risk profile and strategic objectives. During the year, the ratio is managed by regular reporting, forecasting and capital management actions. Management has full discretion to change the target ratio if circumstances change.

 

101


Table of Contents

Off-Balance-Sheet-Arrangements

See Note 27 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

    

Total

2011

    

Less
than

one

year

    

More
than

one

year

    

Total

2010

    

Less
than

one year

    

More
than

one

year

 
     (EUR millions)  

Insurance operations

                 

Commitments concerning investments in land and buildings

     112         87         25         22         22      

Commitments concerning fixed-interest securities

     947         947            1,120         1,115         5   

Guarantees

     24            24         23            23   

Other commitments

     766         560         206         872         664         208   

Banking operations

                 

Contingent liabilities in respect of:

                 

Ÿ discounted bills

     2         2            3         3      

Ÿ guarantees

     25,617         20,301         5,316         21,711         17,159         4,552   

Ÿ irrevocable letters of credit

     17,206         16,996         210         15,540         15,317         223   

Ÿ other contingent liabilities

     570         562         8         428         419         9   

Irrevocable facilities

     86,188         56,041         30,147         90,027         59,885         30,142   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     131,432         95,496         35,935         129,746         94,584         35,162   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contractual obligations

The table below shows the cash payment requirements, due by period, from specified contractual obligations outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010. Reference is made to Note 21 Other liabilities in Note 2.1 for information about future payments in relation to pension benefit liabilities. Reference is made to Note 23 Liabilities by contractual maturity in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements for information about coupon interest due on financial liabilities by maturity bucket.

 

Payment due by period    Total      Less
than 1
year
     1-3
years
     3-5
years
    

More

than 5
years

 
     (EUR millions)  

2011

              

Operating lease obligations

     1,353         306         435         327         285   

Subordinated loans of Group companies

     12,148         2,907         1,262         3,227         4,752   

Preference shares of Group companies

     404                  404   

Debenture loans

     139,861         68,179         29,420         14,853         27,409   

Loans contracted

     2,287         428         76            1,783   

Loans from credit institutions

     4,845         4,052         57         56         680   

Insurance provisions (1)

     175,549         11,177         18,702         19,127         126,543   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     336,447         87,049         49,952         37,590         161,856   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2010

              

Operating lease obligations

     1,088         199         345         264         280   

Subordinated loans of Group companies

     13,780         2,647         2,357         1,167         7,609   

Preference shares of Group companies

     1,121                  1,121   

Debenture loans

     135,604         77,525         23,316         18,205         16,558   

Loans contracted

     3,740         2,055            73         1,612   

Loans from credit institutions

     3,650         2,677         59         188         726   

Insurance provisions (1)

     163,864         11,883         18,291         16,995         116,695   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     322,847         96,986         44,368         36,892         144,601   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Amounts included in the table reflect best estimates of cash payments to be made to policyholders. Such best estimate cash outflows reflect mortality, retirement, and other appropriate factors, but are undiscounted with respect to interest. As a result, the sum of the cash outflows shown for all years in the table differs from the corresponding liability included in our consolidated financial statements at December 31, 2011. Furthermore, the table does not include insurance or investment contracts for risk of policyholders, as these are products where the policyholder bears the investment risk.

 

102


Table of Contents
Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees

Appointment and dismissal Supervisory Board

Members of the Supervisory Board are appointed by the General Meeting from a binding list to be drawn up by the Supervisory Board. The list will be rendered non-binding if a resolution of the General Meeting to that effect is adopted by an absolute majority of the votes cast which majority represents more than one-third of the issued share capital. Candidates for appointment to the Supervisory Board must comply with the expertise and reliability requirements set out in the Dutch Financial Supervision Act. Pursuant to current Dutch law, this list is to contain at least two candidates for each vacancy, and if not, the list will be non-binding. With respect to the second candidate, ING Group’s policy is to propose (retired) senior managers or other high-ranking officers who, in view of the forthcoming abolition of this requirement, do not have to meet the independency requirements of the Corporate Governance Code or the requirements of the Supervisory Board Profile.

Members of the Supervisory Board may be suspended or dismissed at any time by a majority resolution of the General Meeting. A resolution to suspend or dismiss members of the Supervisory Board that has not been brought forward by the Supervisory Board may only be adopted by the General Meeting by an absolute majority of the votes cast which majority represents more than one-third of the issued share capital.

In connection with the issue of the Securities to the Dutch State, ING Group and the Dutch State agreed that the Dutch State may recommend candidates for appointment to the Supervisory Board in such a way that upon appointment of all recommended candidates by the General Meeting, the Supervisory Board would comprise two State Nominees among its members. The Dutch State may recommend a Supervisory Board member already in office. The recommendation right of the Dutch State is subject to applicable law and to corporate governance practices, generally accepted under stock exchange listing regimes applicable to ING Group and continues as long as the Dutch State holds at least 250 million Securities, or as long as the IABF continues (whichever occurs last). Should the holding of the Dutch State decrease below 250 million Securities and the IABF have expired, the State Nominees will remain in office and complete their term of appointment.

Candidates recommended by the Dutch State will be nominated for appointment by way of a binding nomination, unless one or more specified situations occur. These include that:

 

   

the candidate is not fit and proper to discharge his duties as a Supervisory Board member;

 

   

upon appointment the composition of the Supervisory Board would not be appropriate and/or not be in accordance with the Supervisory Board Profile;

 

   

appointment would be incompatible with any provision of the Articles of Association, the Supervisory Board Charter, any principle or best-practice provision of the Corporate Governance Code as applied by ING Group and/or any other generally accepted corporate governance practice or requirement which is applicable to ING Group as an internationally listed company;

 

   

the relevant candidate has a structural conflict of interest with ING Group; and

 

   

the Dutch Central Bank refuses to issue a statement of ‘no objection’ for the appointment of the relevant candidate.

The Dutch State recommended Lodewijk de Waal and Tineke Bahlmann for appointment to the Supervisory Board, who were both appointed by the General Meeting on April 27, 2009.

Function of the Supervisory Board

The function of the Supervisory Board is to supervise the policy of the Executive Board and the general course of events of ING Group and its business, as well as to provide advice to the Executive Board. In line with Dutch company law, the Corporate Governance Code and the Articles of Association, the Supervisory Board Charter requires all members of the Supervisory Board, including the State Nominees, to act in accordance with the interests of ING Group and the business connected with it, taking into account the relevant interests of all the stakeholders of ING Group, to perform their duties without mandate and independent of any interest in the business of ING Group, and to refrain from supporting one interest without regard to the other interests involved.

Certain resolutions of the Executive Board, specified in the Articles of Association of ING Group, the Executive Board Charter and in the Supervisory Board Charter, are subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board.

Pursuant to the agreements concerning the transactions with the Dutch State mentioned above, certain resolutions of the Supervisory Board are subject to the condition that no State Nominee voted against the proposal. These rights became effective as from the 2009 annual General Meeting. These resolutions relate to the following matters:

 

103


Table of Contents

a. the issue or acquisition of its own shares by ING Group, other than related to the Securities issue (including, for the avoidance of doubt, for the purpose of conversion or financing of a repurchase of Securities), as part of regular hedging operations or in connection with employment schemes;

b. the cooperation by ING Group in the issue of depositary receipts for shares;

c. the application for listing on or removal from the price list of any stock exchange of the securities referred to in a. or b.;

d. the entry into or termination of lasting cooperation between ING Group or a dependent company and another legal entity or partnership or as general partner in a limited partnership or general partnership where such cooperation or termination thereof has material significance for ING Group, i.e. amounting to one-quarter or more of ING Group’s issued capital and reserves as disclosed in its balance sheet and notes thereto;

e. the acquisition by ING Group or a dependent company of a participating interest in the capital of another company amounting to one-quarter or more of ING Group’s issued capital and reserves as disclosed in its balance sheet and notes thereto or a material increase or decrease in the magnitude of such a participating interest;

f. investments involving an amount equal to one-quarter or more of ING Group’s issued capital and reserves as disclosed in its balance sheet and notes thereto;

g. a proposal to wind up ING Group;

h. filing of a petition for bankruptcy or moratorium of ING Group;

i. a proposal to reduce the issued capital of ING Group (other than related to the Securities issue);

j. a proposal for merger, split-off or dissolution of ING Group;

k. a proposal to change ING Group’s remuneration policy; and

l. appointment of the chief executive officer of the Executive Board.

Profile of members of the Supervisory Board

The Supervisory Board has drawn up a profile to be used as a basis for its composition. It is available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com) and at the ING Group head office.

In view of their experience and the valuable contribution that former members of the Executive Board can make to the Supervisory Board, it has been decided, taking into account the size of the Supervisory Board and ING’s wide range of activities that such individuals may become members of the Supervisory Board of ING Group. There is, however, a restriction in that only one in every five other members of the Supervisory Board may be a former member of the Executive Board. In addition, this member must wait at least one year after resigning from the Executive Board before becoming eligible for appointment to the Supervisory Board. Former members of the Executive Board are not eligible for appointment to the position of chairman or vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board.

After being appointed to the Supervisory Board, a former member of the Executive Board may also be appointed to one of the Supervisory Board’s committees. However, appointment to the position of chairman of a committee is only possible if the individual in question resigned from the Executive Board at least four years prior to such appointment.

Term of appointment of members of the Supervisory Board

A member of the Supervisory Board retires no later than at the end of the first general meeting held four years after his or her last appointment or reappointment. In accordance with the Corporate Governance Code, members of the Supervisory Board may as a general rule be reappointed for two additional four-year terms. Under special circumstances however, the Supervisory Board may deviate from this general rule, among others in order to maintain a balanced composition of the Supervisory Board and/or to preserve valuable expertise and experience. As a general rule, members of the Supervisory Board shall also resign at the end of the annual general meeting in the year in which they attain the age of 70 and shall not be reappointed. The schedule for resignation by rotation is available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com).

Ancillary positions /Conflicting interests

Members of the Supervisory Board are asked to provide details on any other directorships, paid positions and ancillary positions they may hold. Such positions may not conflict with the interests of ING Group. It is the responsibility of the individual member of the Supervisory Board and the Corporate Governance Committee to ensure that the directorship duties are performed properly and are not affected by any other positions that the individual may hold outside the Group.

 

104


Table of Contents

In accordance with the Corporate Governance Code, members of the Supervisory Board are to disclose material conflicts of interest and potential conflicts of interest and to provide all information relevant thereto. Thereupon the Supervisory Board – without the member concerned taking part – decides whether a conflict of interest exists. In special circumstances, the Supervisory Board may deviate from this rule and decide that, notwithstanding the fact that the matter would entail a conflict of interest according to the Corporate Governance Code, a conflict of interest does not exist. This concerns in particular situations in which the conflict of interest is based on a marriage that exists no longer, to allow for situations where there is no material family relation. In case of a conflict of interest, the relevant member of the Supervisory Board, as the Corporate Governance Code recommends, abstains from discussions and decision-making on the topic or the transaction in relation to which he or she has a conflict of interest with ING Group.

Transactions involving actual or potential conflicts of interest

In accordance with the Corporate Governance Code, transactions with members of the Supervisory Board in which there are significant conflicting interests will be disclosed in the Annual Report. In deviation of the Corporate Governance Code however, this does not apply if (i) disclosure would be against the law; (ii) the confidential, share-price sensitive or competition-sensitive character of the transaction prevents disclosure; and/or (iii) the information is so competition-sensitive that disclosure could damage the competitive position of ING Group.

Significant conflicting interests are considered to be absent in case of a relationship that a member of the Supervisory Board may have with ING Group subsidiaries as an ordinary, private individual, with the exception of any loans that may have been granted.

Independence

Annually, the members of the Supervisory Board are requested to assess whether the criteria of dependence set out in the Corporate Governance Code do not apply to them and to confirm this in writing. On the basis of these criteria, all members of the Supervisory Board, with the exception of Luc Vandewalle, are to be regarded as independent on December 31, 2011. Luc Vandewalle is not to be regarded as independent because of his former position at ING Belgium. Members of the Supervisory Board to whom the independence criteria of the Corporate Governance Code do not apply, and members of the Supervisory Board to whom the criteria do apply but who can explain why this does not undermine their independence, are deemed to be independent.

Company secretary

ING Group’s company secretary is Jan-Willem Vink, general counsel of ING Group.

Committees of the Supervisory Board

On December 31, 2011, the Supervisory Board had five standing committees: the Audit Committee, the Risk Committee, the Remuneration Committee, the Nomination Committee and the Corporate Governance Committee.

The organization, powers and conduct of the Supervisory Board are detailed in the Supervisory Board Charter. Separate charters have been drawn up for the Audit Committee, the Risk Committee, the Remuneration Committee, the Nomination Committee and the Corporate Governance Committee. These charters are available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com). A short description of the duties for the five Committees follows below.

The Audit Committee assists the Supervisory Board in monitoring the integrity of the financial statements of ING Group, ING Verzekeringen N.V. and ING Bank N.V., in monitoring the compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and in monitoring the independence and performance of ING’s internal and external auditors. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Audit Committee were: Joost Kuiper (chairman), Tineke Bahlmann, Henk Breukink, Aman Mehta and Luc Vandewalle.

The Supervisory Board has determined that Sjoerd van Keulen, Joost Kuiper and Aman Mehta are financial experts as referred to in the Corporate Governance Code. Joost Kuiper and Aman Mehta were appointed to the Audit Committee per May 9, 2011 and February 14, 2011, respectively. Sjoerd van Keulen was appointed to the Risk Committee per May 9, 2011.

Sjoerd van Keulen and Joost Kuiper are considered by the Supervisory Board as financial experts due to their broad experience in the banking and insurance business and the Dutch financial sector while Aman Mehta has gathered his experience by serving as chief executive officer of Hong Kong & Shanghai Banking Corporation (HSBC) in Hong Kong.

 

105


Table of Contents

The Risk Committee assists and advises the Supervisory Board in monitoring the risk profile of ING as a whole as well as the structure and operation of the internal risk management and control systems. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Risk Committee were: Piet Klaver (chairman), Tineke Bahlmann, Sjoerd van Keulen, Joost Kuiper, Luc Vandewalle and Jeroen van der Veer.

The Remuneration Committee advises the Supervisory Board, among other things, on the terms and conditions of employment (including remuneration) of the members of the Executive Board and on the policies and general principles on which the terms and conditions of employment of the members of the Executive Board and of senior managers of ING and its subsidiaries are based. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Remuneration Committee were: Peter Elverding (chairman), Sjoerd van Keulen, Piet Klaver, Jeroen van der Veer and Lodewijk de Waal.

The Nomination Committee advises the Supervisory Board, among other things, on the composition of the Supervisory Board and Executive Board. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Nomination Committee were: Jeroen van der Veer (chairman), Peter Elverding, Sjoerd van Keulen, Piet Klaver and Lodewijk de Waal. The Corporate Governance Committee assists the Supervisory Board in monitoring and evaluating the corporate governance of ING as a whole and the reporting thereon in the Annual Report and to the General Meeting and advises the Supervisory Board on improvements. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Corporate Governance Committee were: Henk Breukink (chairman), Aman Mehta, Jeroen van der Veer and Lodewijk de Waal.

The current composition of the Supervisory Board Committees can be found on the Company’s website (www.ing.com), which is updated on a regular basis.

Remuneration and share ownership

The remuneration of the members of the Supervisory Board is determined by the General Meeting and is not dependent on the results of ING Group. Members of the Supervisory Board are permitted to hold shares and depositary receipts for shares in the share capital of ING Group for long-term investment purposes. Transactions by members of the Supervisory Board in these shares and these depositary receipts for shares are subject to the ING regulations for insiders. These regulations are available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com).

INFORMATION ON MEMBERS OF THE SUPERVISORY BOARD

Jeroen van der Veer (chairman)

(Born 1947, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2009, term expires in 2013)

Former chief executive officer of Royal Dutch Shell plc. Other business activities: non-executive director of Royal Dutch Shell plc and chairman of the Supervisory Board of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. (listed companies). Member of the Supervisory Board of Het Concertgebouw N.V. Chairman of Platform Bètatechniek. Chairman of the Supervisory Council of Nederlands Openluchtmuseum. Member of the Board of Nationale Toneel (theatre).

Peter A.F.W. Elverding (vice-chairman)

(Born 1948, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2007, term expires in 2015)

Former chairman of the Managing Board of Directors of Koninklijke DSM N.V. Former vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board of De Nederlandsche Bank N.V. (Dutch Central Bank). Other business activities: chairman of the Supervisory Board of Océ N.V. and chairman of the Supervisory Board of Koninklijke BAM Groep N.V. (listed companies). Vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board of SHV Holdings N.V. Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Q-Park N.V. Member of the Supervisory Board of Koninklijke FrieslandCampina N.V. Member of the Board of Stichting Instituut GAK.

J.P. (Tineke) Bahlmann

(Born 1950, Dutch nationality, female; appointed in 2009, term expires in 2013)

Professor in Business Administration, University of Utrecht. Chairman of the Dutch Media Authority. Other business activities: vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board of N.V. Nederlandsche Apparatenfabriek ‘Nedap’ (listed company). Member of the Board of Maatschappelijk Verantwoord Ondernemen Nederland (CSR). Chairman of Stichting Max Havelaar. Member of the Board of De Baak Management Centre VNO-NCW. Member of the Board of Toneelgroep Amsterdam (theatre).

 

106


Table of Contents

Henk W. Breukink

(Born 1950, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2007, term expires in 2015)

Former managing director of F&C and country head for F&C Netherlands (asset management firm). Other business activities: member of the Supervisory Board of NSI N.V. (real estate fund) and non-executive director of F&C Sapphire hedge fund, Ireland (listed companies). Non-executive director of Brink Groep BV. Non-executive chairman of Heembouw Holding B.V. Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Omring (health care institution). Member of the Supervisory Board of HaagWonen (housing corporation). Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Inholland University.

Sjoerd van Keulen

(Born 1946, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2011, term expires in 2015)

Former chairman of the Executive Board of SNS Reaal N.V. Chairman of Holland Financial Centre. Other business activities: member of the Supervisory Board of Heijmans N.V. and chairman of the Supervisory Board of Mediq N.V. (listed companies). Member of the Supervisory Board of APG Groep N.V. and Vado Beheer B.V. Member of the Supervisory Committee of World Wildlife Fund. Chairman of the Board of Investment Fund for Health in Africa. Member of the Supervisory Board of Stichting PharmAccess International. Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Access to Medicine Foundation. Board member of Stichting Health Insurance Fund.

Piet C. Klaver

(Born 1945, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2006, term expires in 2014)

Former chairman of the Executive Board of SHV Holdings N.V. Other business activities: chairman of the Supervisory Board of PostNL N.V. (listed company). Chairman of the Supervisory Board of each of Koninklijke Dekker B.V., Credit Yard Group B.V., Dura Vermeer Groep N.V. and Blokker Holding B.V. Vice-chairman of the

Supervisory Board of SHV Holdings N.V. Member of the Board of the African Parks Foundation.

Joost CH.L. Kuiper

(Born 1947, Dutch nationality; male; appointed in 2011, term expires in 2015)

Former member of the Executive Board of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. Other business activities: Chairman of the Supervisory Board of IMC B.V. Member of the Supervisory Board of each of Hespri Holding B.V., AutoBinck Holding N.V. and Nexus Institute. Board member of each of Stichting voor Ooglijders, Prins Bernhard Cultuurfonds and Stichting Democratie en Media. Treasurer of Mondriaan Stichting.

Aman Mehta

(Born 1946, Indian nationality, male; appointed in 2008, term expires in 2012)

Former chief executive officer of Hong Kong & Shanghai Banking Corporation (HSBC) in Hong Kong. Other business activities: non-executive director of each of Tata Consultancy Services, Jet Airways Ltd., PCCW Ltd., Vedanta Resources Plc, Wockhardt Ltd., Godrej Consumer Products Ltd., Cairn India Ltd. and Max India Ltd. Member of the governing board of Indian School of Business.

Luc A.C.P. Vandewalle

(Born 1944, Belgian nationality, male; appointed in 2011, term expires in 2014)

Former chairman and non-executive member of ING Belgium NV/SA. Other business activities: Chairman of the Supervisory Board of each of Bakker Hillegom B.V., Domo Real Estate, Matexi Groep, Plu Holding and Transics

International. Member of the Supervisory Board of each of Allia Insurance Brokers, Arseus, Besix Groep, Galloo, Masureel Veredeling, Sea-Invest, Sioen Industries, Vergroup, Veritas and Willy Naessens Industriebouw.

Lodewijk J. de Waal

(Born 1950, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2009, term expires in 2013)

Former general manager of Humanitas. Other business activities: member of the Supervisory Board of PGGM N.V. Member of the Advisory Board of Zorgverzekeraars Nederland. Chairman of the Advisory Board of Stichting Nationaal Fonds Kunstbezit. Member of the Netherlands’ National Contact Point (“NCP”) of the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (“OECD”). Chairman of the Supervisory Council of Museum Volkenkunde. Chairman of the Platform ‘Slim Werken Slim Reizen’. Member of the Toetsingscommissie Beloningen Woningcorporaties.

 

107


Table of Contents

Changes in the composition

Jackson Tai, Godfried van der Lugt and Joan Spero resigned from the Supervisory Board as of January 6, 2011, January 24, 2011 and June 1, 2011 respectively. Claus Dieter Hoffmann retired at the end of the 2011 annual General Meeting. The current term of appointment of Aman Mehta will expire at the end of the 2012 annual General Meeting. At this meeting, Aman Mehta will be nominated for reappointment. In addition, the Supervisory Board has nominated three candidates for appointment: Yvonne van Rooy (born 1951, Dutch nationality, female), Jan Holsboer (born 1946, Dutch nationality, male) and Robert Reibestein (born 1956, Dutch nationality, male). The proposed appointments have been approved by the Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank N.V., “DNB”). More information can be found in the convocation for the 2012 annual General Meeting, available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com).

EXECUTIVE BOARD

Appointment and dismissal

Members of the Executive Board are appointed by the General Meeting from a binding list to be drawn up by the Supervisory Board. The list will be rendered non-binding if a resolution of the General Meeting to that effect is adopted by an absolute majority of the votes cast which majority represents more than one-third of the issued share capital. Candidates for appointment to the Executive Board must comply with the expertise and reliability

requirements set out in the Dutch Financial Supervision Act. Pursuant to current Dutch law, this list is to mention at least two candidates for each vacancy, and if not, the list will be non-binding. With respect to the second candidate, ING Group’s policy is to propose (retired) senior managers or other high ranking officers who, in view of the forthcoming abolition of this requirement, do not have to meet the requirements of the Executive Board Profile. Members of the Executive Board may be suspended or dismissed at any time by a majority resolution of the General Meeting. A resolution to suspend or dismiss members of the Executive Board that has not been brought forward by the Supervisory Board may only be adopted by the General Meeting by an absolute majority of the votes cast, which majority represents more than one-third of the issued share capital.

Function of the Executive Board

The Executive Board is charged with the management of ING Group, which means, among other things, that it is responsible for the setting and achieving of the company’s objectives, strategy and policies, as well as the ensuing delivery of results. It also includes the day-to-day management of ING Group. The Executive Board is accountable for the performance of these duties to the Supervisory Board and the General Meeting. The responsibility for the management of ING Group is vested in the Executive Board collectively. The organisation, powers and modus operandi of the Executive Board are detailed in the Executive Board Charter, which was approved by the Supervisory Board. The Executive Board Charter is available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com).

Profile of members of the Executive Board

The Supervisory Board has drawn up a profile to be used as a basis for selecting members of the Executive Board. It is available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com) and at the ING Group head office.

Remuneration and share ownership

Members of the Executive Board are permitted to hold shares and depositary receipts for shares in the share capital of ING Group for long-term investment purposes. Transactions by members of the Executive Board in these shares and these depositary receipts for shares are subject to the ING regulations for insiders. These regulations are available on the website of ING Group (www.ing. com).

Ancillary positions/Conflicting interests

No member of the Executive Board has corporate directorships at listed companies outside ING. This is in accordance with ING Group’s policy to avoid conflicts of interest.

 

108


Table of Contents

Transactions involving actual or potential conflicts of interest

In accordance with the Corporate Governance Code, transactions with members of the Executive Board in which there are significant conflicting interests will be disclosed in the Annual Report. In deviation of the Corporate Governance Code however, this does not apply if (i) disclosure would be against the law; (ii) the confidential, share-price sensitive or competition-sensitive character of the transaction prevents disclosure; and/or (iii) the information is so competition-sensitive that the disclosure could damage the competitive position of ING Group. Significant conflicting interests are considered to be absent and are not reported if a member of the Executive Board obtains financial products and services, other than loans, which are provided by ING Group subsidiaries in the ordinary course of their business on terms that apply to all employees. In connection with the foregoing, ‘loans’ does not include financial products in which the granting of credit is of a subordinated nature, e.g. credit cards and overdrafts in current account, because of a lack of materiality.

INFORMATION ON MEMBERS OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD

Jan H.M. Hommen, chief executive officer

(Born 1943, Dutch nationality, male; appointed in 2009, term expires in 2013)

Jan Hommen graduated with a master’s degree in Business Economics from Tilburg University. He was appointed a member of the Executive Board on April 27, 2009. He is also CEO of ING Bank N.V. and CEO of ING Verzekeringen N.V. Jan Hommen was a member of the Supervisory Board of ING Group as of June 1, 2005 and became chairman of the Supervisory Board of ING Group in January 2008. Until May 1, 2005, he was vice-chairman and chief financial officer of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. From 1975 to 1997, he worked for Alcoa Inc. From 1978, he worked at the Alcoa head office in the US, becoming chief financial officer in 1991. Jan Hommen is a member of the board of Royal Concertgebouw Orchestra. Eight Group staff departments report directly to Jan Hommen: Investor Relations, Corporate Legal Department, Corporate Human Resources, Corporate Development, Corporate Communications & Affairs, Public & Government Affairs, Sustainability and Corporate Audit Services.

Patrick G. Flynn, chief financial officer

(Born 1960, Irish nationality, male; appointed in 2009, term expires in 2013)

Patrick Flynn is a Chartered Accountant and a member of the Association of Corporate Treasurers in the UK. He also holds a bachelor’s degree in Business Studies from Trinity College Dublin. He was appointed a member of the Executive Board of ING Group on April 27, 2009. From 2007 to 2009, he was the chief financial officer of HSBC Insurance Holdings Ltd. Patrick Flynn is responsible for ING’s finance departments.

Changes in the composition

Koos Timmermans was appointed vice-chairman of the Management Board Banking as of October 1, 2011. Considering his new role, he stepped down as chief risk officer and member of the Executive Board of ING Group as per the same date. The Supervisory Board intends to propose that Wilfred F. Nagel (born 1956, Dutch nationality, male) be appointed as a member of the Executive Board and chief risk officer of ING Group at the annual General Meeting on May 14, 2012. From October 1, 2011 until the appointment of Wilfred Nagel, Patrick Flynn has assumed the responsibility for Risk at ING Group level.

REMUNERATION REPORT

This section sets out the remuneration for the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board. The remuneration policy for the Executive Board was adopted by the annual General Meeting (AGM) on April 27, 2010; adjustments to the remuneration policy in line with new regulatory developments were adopted by the AGM on May 9, 2011. In addition, the Remuneration report provides information on the remuneration paid for 2011. Furthermore, information is included on loans and advances to the Executive Board and Supervisory Board members as well as ING depositary receipts for shares held by members of both Boards.

REMUNERATION POLICY

The primary objective of the remuneration structure is to enable ING to retain and recruit qualified and expert leaders, senior staff and other highly qualified employees, who have a drive for excellence in serving the interests of the Company’s various stakeholders. ING endeavours to match compensation of the Company’s leadership appropriately against a variety of factors, such as the complexity of functions, the scope of

 

109


Table of Contents

responsibilities, the alignment of risks and rewards, and the long-term objectives of the Company and its stakeholders, which is all the more important given the changing international standards regarding responsible remuneration. These factors differ for each role, line of business and country. This is especially the case for ING with its operations in over 40 countries and over 97,000 employees of whom around 71,000 are based outside the Netherlands (over 54% of senior management is non-Dutch). As much as possible for a global financial institution of this size, ING aims to take account of all these differences and also of the standards applied within similar financial institutions in the various countries in which it operates.

REMUNERATION POLICY FOR THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ADOPTED IN 2010

According to the remuneration policy of the Executive Board as adopted by the AGM on April 27, 2010 and amended by the AGM on May 9, 2011, remuneration of Executive Board members consists of a combination of fixed remuneration (base salary) and variable remuneration (together ‘total direct compensation’), pension arrangements and benefits as described below.

Total direct compensation: moderation and reduced emphasis on variable remuneration

Total direct compensation levels are based on market data that include peers both inside and outside the financial sector in the international context in which ING operates. Total direct compensation is benchmarked against a peer group of companies that, in the opinion of the Supervisory Board, are comparable with ING in terms of size and scope. In line with the foregoing, the Supervisory Board has determined that the peer group consists of the companies in the Dow Jones EURO STOXX 50 index. These are 50 companies, in a range of financial and non-financial industries, which are based in countries within the Economic and Monetary Union of the European Union. In accordance with the Dutch Banking Code, ING’s new remuneration policy for the Executive Board aims for total direct compensation levels slightly below market median levels for comparable positions in the relevant markets. In addition, the remuneration policy provides for a balanced mix between fixed and variable remuneration. Variable remuneration will not exceed 100% of fixed salary at the time of allocation. Fixed remuneration (i.e. the base salary levels) will be determined in line with the relevant market environment as an integral part of total direct compensation, and will be reviewed from time to time by the Supervisory Board. The policy provides for an at target variable remuneration of 40% in cash and 40% in stock (in total 80%) of base salary if performance criteria are met. If performance criteria (as predetermined by the Supervisory Board) are exceeded, the variable component can be increased from target to maximum, not exceeding 100% of base salary at the time of allocation.

Increased emphasis on long-term value creation

The remuneration policy for the Executive Board combines the short and long-term variable components into one structure. This structure intends to support both long-term value creation and short-term company objectives. The emphasis on long-term performance indicators within the variable component of the compensation package is increased by means of deferral, reasonableness test and claw back mechanisms. The allocation of variable remuneration is conditional on the achievement of a number of performance objectives. The short-term component, at maximum 40% of total variable remuneration, is equally divided between cash and stock and awarded in the year following the performance year. The other 60% of the total variable remuneration is deferred and also equally divided between cash and stock. This long-term component is intended to serve the objective of retaining the members of the Executive Board for a longer period of time. The value of the stock award is set such that total variable remuneration at the time that the maximum number of shares to be granted is determined stays within the 100% limit. The long-term component, consisting of two equal portions of cash and stock, will be subject to a tiered vesting on the first, second and third anniversary of the grant date (one-third per annum). The entire long-term component is subject to an ex-post assessment by the Supervisory Board. The ex-post assessment cannot lead to an upward adjustment of the value of the cash deferred portion or the number of deferred shares. Executive Board members are not allowed to sell depositary receipts obtained within a period of five years from the grant date. However, they are allowed to sell part of their depositary receipts at the date of vesting to pay tax over the vested share award.

Increased focus on risk and non-financial performance

Variable remuneration is linked to risk and non-financial performance and will take into consideration both individual and company performance criteria. Performance measurement will account for estimated risks and costs of capital. In addition to financial indicators, performance will also be assessed based on non-financial drivers, by means of a number of targets regarding economic, environmental, customer satisfaction and social criteria.

 

110


Table of Contents

Pensions Executive Board members

Members of the Executive Board, who are employed on the basis of a Dutch employment contract, will participate in the defined contribution pension plans introduced in 2010 as part of the remuneration policy. Individual Board members participating in the pension plan that existed before the introduction of the 2010 plans were given the choice to keep their existing pension arrangement. This existing pension arrangement, approved by the 2006 AGM, is based on a defined contribution plan. Alternatively, they can switch to the 2010 arrangements. Members of the Executive Board will be required to pay a contribution to their pension premium in line with the contributions under ING’s Collective Labour Agreement in the Netherlands. Members of the Executive Board working on a non-Dutch employment contract will be offered pensions in line with local practices.

Benefits

Executive Board members will continue to be eligible for a range of additional benefits (e.g. the use of company cars, contributions to company savings plans and, if applicable, expatriate allowances). Executive Board members may obtain banking and insurance services from ING Group subsidiaries in the ordinary course of their business and on terms that apply to most other comparable employees of ING. In addition, tax and financial planning services will be provided to ensure compliance with the relevant legislative requirements.

Tenure

The contract of employment for Executive Board members provides for an appointment for a period of four years and allows for reappointment by the General Meeting. In the case of an involuntary exit, Executive Board members are eligible for an exit-arrangement limited to one-year base salary.

OTHER ITEMS FOR SUPERVISORY BOARD DISCRETION

Claw back and adjustments

The Supervisory Board has the authority to reclaim variable remuneration allocated to a member of the Executive Board based on inaccurate data and/or behavior that led to significant harm to the company. The Supervisory Board also has the authority to adjust variable remuneration if application of the predetermined performance criteria results in undesired outcomes. Accordingly, the Supervisory Board has decision authority in situations not addressed in the policy.

Special employment conditions

Special employment conditions, such as commitments made to secure the recruitment of new executives, may be used in exceptional circumstances subject to strict control by the Supervisory Board.

Supervisory Board discretion to review the policy and the remuneration paid

ING as a company is expected to undergo significant changes during the coming years. Moreover, the relevant international employment market is very much in flux. In order to ensure that ING can adapt to these two uncertain factors, the Supervisory Board indicated in 2010 and 2011 that it may re-evaluate in 2012, whether the remuneration policy adopted in 2010 and amended on May 9, 2011, is in line with the long-term objectives of the Company, the relevant international context, as well as the societal perception of ING as a company. As the internal restructuring is ongoing and the regulatory environment continues to be in flux, the Supervisory Board may re-evaluate at a later stage. Should it become clear, after such evaluation, that the new remuneration policy has led to an unintended or inequitable outcome, the Supervisory Board will have the discretion to correct the previously allocated variable remuneration. However, it is understood that any such correction could not lead to a deviation from the requirement that variable remuneration cannot exceed 100% of base salary during any year, as required under the Dutch Banking Code or be in violation of the Capital Requirements Directive III. The remuneration policy is leading in the international financial markets in terms of moderation of pay. The Supervisory Board and the Executive Board also have an obligation to safeguard the continuity of the Company. The Supervisory Board will therefore evaluate from time to time how these two responsibilities relate to each other. If and when appropriate, it can make adjustments.

 

111


Table of Contents

2011 REMUNERATION

Ongoing public debate regarding remuneration

Remuneration at ING is a topic of heated debate, particularly in the Netherlands. In 2011, following public discussion in the Netherlands after the Remuneration Committee had awarded the Executive Board of ING Group variable remuneration in relation to their 2010 performance, the members of the Executive Board decided not to accept this variable portion of their total direct compensation. Furthermore, they announced not to accept the proposed 2011 salary increase and variable remuneration until the Core Tier 1 Securities that were issued to the Dutch State have been fully repaid even though the proposed salary increase and variable remuneration were in line with the remuneration policy as approved by the AGM in 2010. The Supervisory Board regrets that it underestimated the signal that was sent to Dutch society by awarding the Executive Board variable remuneration and is keen on ensuring that remuneration at ING does not become the subject of public debate again. However, while the gesture made by the Executive Board members was appreciated by the public and the Supervisory Board, this does not solve the ongoing dilemmas faced by the Supervisory Board in general and the Remuneration Committee in particular. It is the Remuneration Committee’s responsibility to take the interests of all stakeholders, including shareholders and the global employee population into account, as well as business continuity when overseeing a company-wide remuneration policy and executing the Executive Board remuneration policy.

2011 REMUNERATION EXECUTIVE BOARD

The Executive Board remuneration for 2011 is based on the remuneration policy approved by the 2010 AGM and amended by the 2011 AGM.

2011 base salary Executive Board

The base salary of all Executive Board members was set at the time of the introduction of the remuneration policy in 2010 and the Executive Board decided not to accept a base salary increase in 2011 as ING had not completely repaid all outstanding Core Tier 1 Securities that were issued to the Dutch State. As a consequence the base salary level remained at the 2010 level.

2011 variable remuneration Executive Board

In 2011 the Executive Board decided that it will not accept variable remuneration for as long as ING has not completely repaid all outstanding Core Tier 1 Securities that were issued to the Dutch State. As the repayment did not occur during 2011, the Executive Board did not receive any variable remuneration in relation to performance year 2011. It is noted that the total direct compensation levels of the Executive Board, even if variable remuneration had been accepted by the Executive Board, continue to be significantly below the market median. The fact that the Executive Board has only accepted base salary in 2011 (and not variable remuneration) makes the current gap between the market median and ING even more significant.

Compensation of the individual members of the Executive Board

 

(EUR thousands)           2011 (1)             2010             2009  
     amount      number of
shares
     amount      number of
options/shares
     amount      number of
options/shares
 

Jan Hommen

                 

Base salary (2)

     1,353            1,353            923      

Variable remuneration in cash

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

Variable remuneration in stock

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

Patrick Flynn (3)

                 

Base salary

     750            750            454      

Variable remuneration in cash

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

Variable remuneration in stock

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

Koos Timmermans (4)

                 

Base salary

     563            750            665      

Variable remuneration in cash

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

Variable remuneration in stock

     0         0         0         0         0         0   

 

112


Table of Contents
(1)

It is noted that while the 2010 Annual Report indicated that the Board members would receive a salary increase and variable remuneration, they decided to forego the proposed increase in 2011 as well as the variable remuneration in relation to performance year 2010. The above table outlines the actual situation.

(2)

Jan Hommen was appointed to the Executive Board on April 27, 2009. Jan Hommen has been remunerated as of April 27, 2009 in accordance with the ‘new’ remuneration policy adopted by the AGM in 2010. The figure for 2009 reflects a partial year as an Executive Board member and was paid in 2010 after the ‘new’ remuneration policy was adopted.

(3)

Patrick Flynn was appointed to the Executive Board on April 27, 2009. The figures for this member reflect remuneration earned in the capacity as Executive Board member. Thus, the figure for 2009 reflects a partial year as an Executive Board member.

(4)

Koos Timmermans stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011. The figures for this member reflect remuneration earned in the capacity as Executive Board member. Thus, the figure for 2011 reflects a partial year as an Executive Board member.

Remuneration of former members of the Executive Board amounted to nil for 2011, nil for 2010 and EUR 2,842,000 for 2009.

Pension costs

The table below shows the pension costs of the individual members of the Executive Board

 

(EUR thousands)    2011      2010      2009  

Jan Hommen (1)

     0         0         0   

Patrick Flynn (2)

     180         134         78   

Koos Timmermans (3)

     135         158         115   

 

(1)

Jan Hommen does not participate in the pension plan.

(2)

Patrick Flynn was appointed to the Executive Board on April 27, 2009. The 2009 pension costs for this member reflect the partial year as an Executive Board member.

(3)

Koos Timmermans stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011. The 2011 pension costs for this member reflect the partial year as an Executive Board member.

Pension costs of former members of the Executive Board amounted to nil for 2011, nil for 2010 and EUR 742,000 for 2009.

Long-term incentives awarded in previous years

The long-term incentive plan (LTIP) at ING in place until 2010 includes both stock options and performance shares. The ING stock options have a total term of ten years and a vesting period of three years after which they can be exercised for the remaining seven years.

Information on the options outstanding and the movements during the financial year of options held by the members of the Executive Board as at December 31 , 2011 (1)

 

number of options   

Outstanding

as at

December 31,

2010

    

Granted

in 2011

    

Exercised

in 2011

    

Waived or

expired in

2011(2)

    

Outstanding

as at

December 31,

2011

     Exercise
price in
euros
     Vesting date      Expiry date  

Jan Hommen

        0         0         0         0            

Patrick Flynn

        0         0         0         0            

Koos Timmermans (3)

     13,674         0         0         0         13,674         22.57         Mar 11, 2005         Mar 11, 2012   
     7,814         0         0         0         7,814         14.37         Mar 15, 2007         Mar 15, 2014   
     11,460         0         0         0         11,460         17.88         Mar 30, 2008         Mar 30, 2015   
     8,504         0         0         0         8,504         25.16         Mar 23, 2009         Mar 23, 2016   
     46,157         0         0         0         46,157         24.72         Mar 22, 2010         Mar 22, 2017   
     56,405         0         0         0         56,405         19.53         May 15, 2011         May 15, 2018   
     20,675         0         0         0         20,675         14.36         Sept. 17, 2011         Sept. 17, 2018   

 

(1)

The number of options and the strike prices of these options reflect the number and strike prices adjusted for the effects of the rights issue of December 2009.

(2)

Waived at vesting date or expired at expiry date.

(3)

Koos Timmermans stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011; the table above shows all options outstanding as at December 31, 2011.

Performance shares were conditionally granted. The number of ING depositary receipts that would ultimately be granted at the end of a three-year performance period depended on ING’s Total Shareholder Return (TSR)

performance over three years (return in the form of capital gains and reinvested dividends that shareholders received in that period) relative to the TSR performance of a predefined peer group.

 

113


Table of Contents

ING’s TSR ranking within this group of companies determines the final number of performance shares that vest at the end of the three year performance period. The performance shares granted in 2008 had a three-year performance period of 2008-2010 and vested in 2011. The actual results of 57% are based upon ING’s TSR ranking of 14th within the designated peer group. The results were determined by an independent third party. ING’s external auditor has reviewed the calculations performed.

For Koos Timmermans, a number of 10,411 performance shares vested in 2011 (57% of the 18,266 shares awarded). The value at vesting amounted to EUR 79,139. The number of performance shares reflects the number adjusted for the effects of the rights issue of December 2009.

Patrick Flynn received a conditional grant of restricted stock in 2009 to a maximum of 130,230 shares. The cumulative value of the conditional share award is capped at EUR 1.3 million. The first vesting in the amount of 39,069 shares occurred at the 2010 AGM. The value at vesting amounted to EUR 288,329. A second vesting of 39,069 shares occurred at the 2011 AGM, the value at vesting amounted to EUR 347,323, and the remaining 52,092 shares will vest at the 2012 AGM, subject to satisfactory performance and the aforementioned cumulative value cap of EUR 1.3 million. The number of shares reflects the number adjusted for the effects of the rights issue of December 2009.

The Executive Board members are not allowed to sell depositary receipts obtained within a period of five years from the grant date. They are only allowed to sell part of their depositary receipts at the date of vesting to pay tax over the vested performance-share award. Depositary receipts obtained from exercised stock options may only be sold within a period of five years from the grant date of the options to pay tax over the exercised award.

Loans and advances to Executive Board members

The table below presents the loans and advances provided to Executive Board members and outstanding on December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009. These loans were concluded in the normal course of business and on terms generally applicable to comparable Company personnel and were approved by the Supervisory Board.

 

    

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest

rate

   

Repay-

ments

  

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest

rate

   

Repay-

ments

  

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest
rate

   

Repay-

ments

(amounts in EUR thousands)

     December 31, 2011           December 31, 2010           December 31, 2009     

Jan Hommen

     1,588         3.4        1,588         3.4          

Koos Timmermans (1)

     380         4.6        380         4.6        380         4.6  

 

(1)

Koos Timmermans stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011; the table above shows all loans and advances outstanding at December 31, 2011.

ING depositary receipts for shares held by Executive Board members

Executive Board members are permitted to hold ING depositary receipts for shares as a long-term investment. The table below shows the holdings by members of the Executive Board.

 

    

Number of

(depositary receipts for) shares

 
     2011      2010      2009  

Jan Hommen

     76,426         76,426         46,426   

Patrick Flynn

     51,339         25,793      

Koos Timmermans (1)

     21,635         16,504         14,457   

 

(1)

Koos Timmermans stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011; the table above shows ING depositary receipts held by Koos Timmermans at December 31, 2011.

 

114


Table of Contents

2012 REMUNERATION STRUCTURE EXECUTIVE BOARD

2012 base salary Executive Board

In line with the Executive Board decision not to accept a base salary increase in 2011 as the repayment of Core Tier 1 Securities that were issued to the Dutch State has not been completed, the Supervisory Board does not propose a base salary increase with respect to the performance year 2012.

2012 variable remuneration Executive Board

The payment of variable remuneration to the Executive Board will be suspended for as long as the repayment of all outstanding Core Tier 1 Securities that were issued to the Dutch State has not been completed.

Executive compensation legislation

Currently a legislative proposal is under discussion in the Dutch Parliament relating to variable remuneration at financial institutions that have received state support for reasons of financial stability such as ING. If and when entered into force, the legislation is expected to prevent these financial institutions from granting variable remuneration (in cash or otherwise) to their Executive Board members. In addition, the legislation contains certain restrictions with respect to the possibility of increasing the fixed salaries of Executive Board members.

REMUNERATION POLICY FOR SENIOR MANAGEMENT

As much as possible for a global financial institution of this size, ING aims to take account of all the differences and standards applied within similar financial institutions in the various countries in which it operates. The remuneration of members of the Management Boards and senior management will be in line with the general principles of the amended remuneration structure for the Executive Board, taking into account international and local practices.

Total direct compensation

Total direct compensation levels will be based on benchmark data in the international context in which ING operates. ING aims for compensation levels to be set at market median levels. Total compensation levels will be determined in line with the relevant market.

Focus on long term value creation, risk and non-financial performance

Variable remuneration is linked to long-term value creation and risk. It is determined based on individual, business and company performance criteria. Performance measurement will increasingly account for estimated risks and costs of capital. There will be increased emphasis on long term value creation by means of long-term incentives, deferral and claw back mechanisms. Furthermore, and in addition to financial indicators, performance is also assessed based on non-financial drivers. The incorporation of non-financial indicators in the overall assessment is particularly aimed at further improving sustainable business practices within ING. Therefore, a number of action targets have been formulated regarding ING’s performance in the area of, for example, workforce diversity, customer satisfaction, stakeholder engagement and sustainable business practices.

2012 REMUNERATION STRUCTURE SENIOR MANAGEMENT

Given the differences in the regulatory requirements for banking and insurance and the separation of ING’s banking and insurance activities, the remuneration structures for senior management in ING’s banking and insurance operations were determined separately in 2011 based on internal strategy and external regulatory developments.

The remuneration policy for the Executive Board, which permits a combination of fixed remuneration (base salary) and variable remuneration (together “total direct compensation”) pension arrangements and benefits will apply in full to members of the Management Board Banking. For senior management in Banking, a gradual shift to a more balanced mix of fixed and variable remuneration, in line with the remuneration policy for the Executive Board, was initiated in 2010 and will continue during the coming year. Exceptions may exist for high value specialists and senior management working in certain divisions and/or geographical areas. In addition, the remuneration policy for senior management has been amended in line with the requirements as set out in the Capital Requirements Directive III.

 

115


Table of Contents

For the Management Board Eurasia and senior management in ING’s Eurasia insurance operations, remuneration is in line with the general principles of the new remuneration policy for the Executive Board and the requirements under the Capital Requirements Directive III.

The remuneration for a select group of Bank and Insurance Eurasia employees has been reviewed and amended as necessary in order to comply with the Capital Requirements Directive III. The amendments relate to the allocation of variable remuneration and the ratio between fixed and variable remuneration and are intended to mitigate risk relating to remuneration. Measures include an ex-ante and ex-post assessment of variable remuneration prior to awarding and vesting respectively, significant deferral of variable remuneration, an equal divide between variable remuneration in cash and in shares, as well as retention periods on all equity remuneration as soon as it becomes unconditional.

Moreover, in light of the Capital Requirements Directive III compensation packages related to control functions (such as risk management functions) are structured so that they provide for a reduced emphasis on variable remuneration. To ensure the autonomy of the individual, financial performance metrics are dependent on objectives determined at the divisional level (i.e. not at the level of the relevant business unit). In addition, performance assessments are not only determined by business unit management, but also by the functional line. By making the above changes, ING has taken an important step to further align its compensation philosophy and structure with its risk profile. The current structure will in most cases lead to a decrease in the cash component of variable remuneration and a decrease in the ratio between fixed and variable remuneration.

For the Insurance US operations the changes in the mix between fixed salary and variable remuneration as well as the allocation of variable remuneration will need to be weighted in light of the different regulatory requirements within the US insurance industry and the intended separation of these activities from ING.

The regulatory environment governing remuneration is still in development. The structure as set out above is based on information currently available. Should it become clear, after everything has been clarified, that adjustments are necessary, ING will amend the structure as deemed appropriate.

REMUNERATION SUPERVISORY BOARD

The annual remuneration of the Supervisory Board members as adopted by the General Meetings in 2006 and 2008 amounts to: chairman EUR 75,000, vice-chairman EUR 65,000, other members EUR 45,000. In addition to the remuneration each member receives an expense allowance. For the chairman and vice-chairman the annual amount is EUR 6,810. For the other members the amount is EUR 2,270.

The remuneration for the membership of committees is as follows: chairman of the Audit Committee EUR 8,000, members of the Audit Committee EUR 6,000, chairmen of other Supervisory Board committees EUR 7,500 and members of other Supervisory Board committees EUR 5,000. In addition to the fixed remuneration, committee members receive a fee for each meeting they attend. For the Audit Committee chairman this fee is EUR 2,000 per meeting and for its members EUR 1,500. For the chairman and members of other committees the attendance fee amounts to EUR 450 per meeting.

Supervisory Board members receive an additional fee of EUR 2,000 per attended Supervisory Board or Committee meeting in the event the meeting is held outside the country of residence of the Supervisory Board member, or an additional amount of EUR 7,500 per attended Supervisory Board or Committee meeting if intercontinental travel is required for attending the meeting.

2011 remuneration Supervisory Board

In 2009 and 2010 the chairman and vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board did not receive remuneration and attendance fees associated with committee membership. As announced in the 2010 Annual Report effective 2011, the chairman and vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board did receive compensation for committee attendance. In 2011 more meetings were called than scheduled. Jeroen van der Veer and Peter Elverding have voluntarily requested a lower level of compensation than the annual remuneration as adopted by the AGM and to cap the annual remuneration for Supervisory Board members relating to 2011 at EUR 100,000 and EUR 90,000 respectively (inclusive attendance fees). At their request, the excess amounts of EUR 14,000 and EUR 13,000 respectively will be deducted from their compensation relating to 2012. In 2012 their compensation will also be capped at the aforementioned levels.

The table below shows the remuneration, expense allowances and attendance fees per Supervisory Board member for 2011 and previous years.

 

116


Table of Contents
     2011 1)     2010 1)      2009 1)  
     (EUR thousands)  

Jeroen van der Veer 2)3)

     114  4)      74         35   

Peter Elverding 5)

     103  4)      84         79   

Tineke Bahlmann 6)

     70        69         46   

Henk Breukink

     71        69         61   

Claus Dieter Hoffmann 7)

     30        74         78   

Piet Klaver

     72        68         65   

Godfried van der Lugt 8)

     0        69         67   

Aman Mehta

     126        114         113   

Joan Spero 9)

     47        104         105   

Jackson Tai 10)

     0        139         152   

Lodewijk de Waal 11)

     71        66         50   

Sjoerd van Keulen 12)

     49        

Joost Kuiper 12)

     46        

Luc Vandewalle 12)

     58        

 

(1)

In 2010 and 2009 the remuneration and attendance fees for the membership of a committee have not been paid to the chairman and vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board. Effective 2011 remuneration and attendance fees for the membership of a committee are paid to the chairman and vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board.

(2)

Jeroen van der Veer has been chairman of the Supervisory Board since May 2011. From October 2009 until May 2011 he was vice-chairman of the Supervisory Board.

(3)

Jeroen van der Veer is a member of the Supervisory Board as of July 2009. The compensation figure for 2009 reflects the partial year as a member of the Supervisory Board.

(4)

In 2012, compensation will be capped at EUR 100,000 and EUR 90,000 for the chairman and vice-chairman, respectively. Please see paragraph above the table.

(5)

Peter Elverding was chairman of the Supervisory Board from April 2009 until May 2011. He has been vice-chairman since May 2011.

(6)

Tineke Bahlmann is a member of the Supervisory Board as of April 2009. The compensation figure for 2009 reflects the partial year as a member of the Supervisory Board.

(7)

Claus Dieter Hoffmann retired in June 2011. The compensation figure for 2011 reflects the partial year as a member of the Supervisory Board. He did not receive any compensation in relation to 2011.

(8)

Godfried van der Lugt retired in January 2011. He did not receive any compensation in relation to 2011.

(9)

Joan Spero retired in June 2011. The compensation figure for 2011 reflects the partial year as a member of the Supervisory Board.

(10)

Jackson Tai retired in January 2011. He did not receive any compensation in relation to 2011.

(11)

Lodewijk de Waal is a member of the Supervisory Board as of April 2009. He acted as an observer in the Supervisory Board as of November 2008 until his appointment to the Board in April 2009. The compensation figure for 2009 reflects the partial year as a member of the Supervisory Board. Up to the appointment date Lodewijk de Waal has received remuneration, expense allowances and attendance fees in line with the remuneration of the Supervisory Board.

(12)

Sjoerd van Keulen, Joost Kuiper and Luc Vandewalle are members of the Supervisory Board as of May 2011. The compensation figures for 2011 reflect the partial year as members of the Supervisory Board.

Compensation of former members of the Supervisory Board who are not included in the above table amounted to nil in 2011, EUR 80,000 in 2010 and EUR 277,000 in 2009.

Loans and advances to Supervisory Board members

Supervisory Board members may obtain banking and insurance services from ING Group subsidiaries in the ordinary course of their business and on terms that are customary in the sector. The table below presents the loans and advances to Supervisory Board members outstanding on December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

 

    

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest

rate

   

Repay-

ments

  

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest

rate

   

Repay-

ments

  

Amount

outstan-

ding

    

Average

Interest
rate

   

Repay-

ments

     (EUR thousands)
     December 31, 2011    December 31, 2010    December 31, 2009

Jeroen van der Veer (1)

     282         8.6        282         8.6        282         8.6  

 

(1)

The amount reflects a housing mortgage loan granted in 1992, well before Jeroen van der Veer’s appointment to the Supervisory Board (effective as of July 1, 2009).

 

117


Table of Contents

ING depositary receipts for shares and options held by Supervisory Board members

Supervisory Board members are permitted to hold ING depositary receipts for shares as a long-term investment. The table below shows the holdings by members of the Supervisory Board. Supervisory Board members did not hold ING options at year-end 2011.

 

    

Number of (depositary receipts for)

shares 1)

 
     2011      2010      2009  

Piet Klaver

     43,796         43,796         13,796   

Jeroen van der Veer

     119,469         99,469         99,469   

Sjoerd van Keulen 2)

     1,703         

Luc Vandewalle 2) 3)

     80,000         

 

1)

The numbers of depositary receipts for shares reflect the shares held by the member of the Supervisory Board and their partners.

2)

Sjoerd van Keulen and Luc Vandewalle were newly appointed in May 2011

3)

The ING depositary receipts held by Luc Vandewalle are currently being held in usufruct.

EMPLOYEES

The number of staff employed on a full time equivalent basis of ING Group averaged 104,419 in 2011, of which 26,332 or 25%, were employed in the Netherlands. The geographical distribution of employees with respect to the Group’s insurance operations and banking operations over 2011 was as follows (average full time equivalents):

 

     Insurance operations      Banking operations      Total (1)  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

The Netherlands

     7,305         8,335         8,234         19,027         19,415         19,678         26,332         27,750         27,912   

Belgium

     427         331         321         10,523         10,407         10,479         10,950         10,738         10,800   

Rest of Europe

     3,829         3,694         3,823         25,649         25,897         26,902         29,478         29,591         30,727   

North America

     8,483         9,039         10,322         4,001         4,112         4,125         12,484         13,151         14,447   

Latin America

     6,643         6,961         6,776         163         248         280         6,806         7,209         7,056   

Asia

     6,119         6,292         6,759         10,810         10,119         10,050         16,929         16,411         16,809   

Australia

     5         154         1,456         1,003         1,088         1,066         1,008         1,242         2,522   

Other

     434         47         7                  434         47         7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     33,244         34,853         37,700         71,175         71,286         72,580         104,419         106,140         110,277   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

The average number of employees includes, on an average basis, employees of entities that were sold during the year

The Group does not employ significant numbers of temporary workers. Substantially all of the Group’s Dutch employees are subject to collective labor agreements covering the banking and insurance industries. The Group believes that its employee relations are generally good.

Further information is provided in Note 45 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

118


Table of Contents
Item 7. Major shareholders and related party transactions

As of December 31, 2011, Stichting ING Aandelen (the “Trust”) held 3,830,278,454 Ordinary Shares of ING Groep N.V., which represents over 99.9% of the Ordinary Shares outstanding and ING Groep N.V. and its subsidiaries held 43,702,855. These holdings give the Trust voting control of ING Groep N.V. subject to the right of holders of bearer depositary receipts to vote according to their own discretion on the basis of a proxy as set out below under “Voting of the Ordinary Shares by holders of bearer receipts as a proxy of the Trust”. The following is a description of the material provisions of the Articles of Association (Statuten) and the related Trust Conditions (Administratievoorwaarden) (together the “Trust Agreement”), which governs the Trust, and the applicable provisions of Netherlands law. This description does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the Trust Agreement and the applicable provisions of Netherlands law referred to in such description.

As of December 31, 2011, there were 145,502,149 American Depositary Shares or ADSs outstanding, representing an equal number of bearer receipts. The ADSs were held by 808 record holders. Because certain of the ADSs were held by brokers or other nominees and the depositary receipts are held in bearer form and due to the impracticability of obtaining accurate residence information for all such holders, the number of holders of record or registered holders in the United States is not representative of the number of beneficial holders or of the residence of the beneficial holders.

Bearer depositary receipts, which are negotiable instruments under Netherlands law, are issuable by the Trust pursuant to the terms of the Trust Agreement. Each bearer depositary receipt represents financial interests in one Ordinary Share held by the Trust, as described herein. Holders of bearer depositary receipts (including those bearer depositary receipts for which ADSs have been issued) do not have any voting rights with respect to the Ordinary Shares underlying the bearer depositary receipts owned by the Trust. Such rights belong only to the Trust and will be exercised by the Trust pursuant to the terms of the Trust Agreement as described in more detail below.

All bearer depositary receipts are embodied in one or more global depositary receipts which are held in custody by Euroclear Nederland (the Central securities Depositary (CSD) of the Netherlands, formerly known as “NECIGEF”) in exchange for which every bearer depositary receipt holder is credited in the books of the participants of Euroclear Nederland pursuant to the Netherlands Act on Book-Entry Transactions (Wet giraal effectenverkeer). Each holder of bearer depositary receipts shall nominate a Euroclear Nederland participant, through which the global depositary receipts are to be held in custody on his behalf. Surrender of the global depositary receipts shall only be permitted in the cases prescribed in the Netherlands Act on Book-Entry Transactions. Administration of the global depositary receipts is assigned to Euroclear Nederland which is authorized to perform any necessary act on behalf of the holder(s) of bearer receipts in respect of the relevant depositary receipt, including acceptance and transfer, and to cooperate in making additions to and deletions from the relevant global depositary receipt in accordance with the provisions of the Act on Book Entry Transactions.

Transfer of title in the bearer depositary receipts is affected by book-entry through the facilities of Euroclear Nederland and its participants pursuant to the Netherlands Act on Book-Entry Transactions. Holders of bearer depositary receipts participate in the Euroclear Nederland system by maintaining accounts with Euroclear Nederland participants. There is no limitation under Netherlands law on the ability of non-Dutch citizens or residents to maintain such accounts that are obtainable through Dutch banks.

Voting of the Ordinary Shares by holders of bearer depositary receipts as a proxy of the Trust

Holders of bearer depositary receipts are entitled to attend and speak at general meetings of ING Groep N.V. but do not have any voting rights. However, the Trust will, subject to certain restrictions, grant a proxy to a holder of bearer depositary receipts to the effect that such holder may, in the name of the Trust, exercise the voting rights attached to the number of its Ordinary Shares that corresponds to the number of bearer depositary receipts held by such holder of bearer depositary receipts.

Based on such a proxy, the holder of bearer depositary receipts may vote according to his or her own discretion. The requirements with respect to the use of the voting rights on the Ordinary Shares that apply for the Trust (set out below) do not apply for the holder of bearer depositary receipts voting on the basis of such a proxy.

The restrictions under which the Trust will grant a voting proxy to holders of bearer depositary receipts are:

 

119


Table of Contents
   

the relevant holder of bearer depositary receipts must have announced his intention to attend the general meeting observing the provisions laid down in the Articles of Association of ING Groep N.V.;

 

   

the relevant holder of bearer depositary receipts may delegate the powers conferred upon him or her by means of the voting proxy, provided that the relevant holder of bearer depositary receipts has announced his or her intention to do so to the Trust observing a term before the commencement of the general meeting, which term will be determined by the Trust.

Voting instructions of holders of bearer depositary receipts of Ordinary Shares to the Trust

Holders of bearer depositary receipts are entitled to give binding instructions to the Trust, concerning the Trust’s exercise of the voting rights attached to the Ordinary Shares. The Trust will follow such instructions for a number of Ordinary Shares equal to the number of bearer depositary receipts held by the relevant holder of bearer depositary receipts.

Voting of the Ordinary Shares by the Trust

The Trust will only determine its vote with respect to the Ordinary Shares of ING Groep N.V., held by the Trust, that correspond with bearer depositary receipts:

 

   

the holder of which does not, either in person or by proxy, attend the general meeting;

 

   

the holder of which, did not give a voting instruction to the Trust.

The Trust has discretion to vote in respect of shares for which it has not issued voting proxies to holders of bearer depositary receipts and has not received any voting instructions. Under the Trust Agreement, the Trust is required to be guided primarily by the interests of all holders of bearer depositary receipts, irrespective of whether they attend the general meetings, also taking into account the interests of ING Groep N.V. and its affiliated enterprises.

Shareholder participation and position of the Trust

During the years 2008-2011, participation of shareholders, excluding the Trust, and depositary receipt holders in annual General Meetings consistently increased from 38.7% to 47.1%. Only the extraordinary General Meeting of November 25, 2009 showed a deviation from this trend with a markedly lower turnout of 31.1%. The position of the Trust and ING Group’s depositary-receipts structure was evaluated by the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board in 2010. On the basis of this evaluation, the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board concluded that it would be premature to change or abolish ING Group’s depositary-receipts structure in 2010 and that it would be more appropriate to reconsider this as part of a re-evaluation of ING Group’s entire governance structure following the current restructuring of ING Group and the completion of the divestments approved in the 2009 extraordinary General Meeting. The outcome of the aforementioned evaluation was discussed in the 2010 annual General Meeting.

Administration of the Trust

The Board of the Trust will determine the number of its members itself, subject to the restriction that there may be no more members than seven and no less than three. Members of the Board of the Trust will be appointed by the Board of the Trust itself without any approval from ING Groep N.V. or any of its corporate bodies being required. Members of any corporate body of ING Groep N.V. are not eligible for appointment as a member of the Board of the Trust. Members of the Board of the Trust are appointed for a term of maximum four years and may be re-appointed for two terms without any requirement for approval by ING Groep N.V.

Valid resolutions may be passed only if all members of the Board of the Trust have been duly notified, except that in a case where there is no such notification valid resolutions may nevertheless be passed by unanimous consent at a meeting at which all members of the Board of the Trust are present or represented. Only a fellow Board member who is authorized in writing may represent a member of the Board of the Trust in such meeting. All resolutions of the Board of the Trust shall be passed by an absolute majority of the votes.

The legal relationship between holders of bearer depositary receipts and the Trust is governed entirely by Netherlands law.

 

120


Table of Contents

Termination of the Trust

Should the Trust be dissolved or wish to terminate its function under the Trust Agreement, or should ING Groep N.V. wish to have such function terminated, ING Groep N.V. shall, in consultation with the Trust and with the approval of the meeting of holders of bearer depositary receipts, appoint a successor to whom the administration can be transferred. The successor shall have to take over all commitments under the Trust Agreement. Within two months of the decision to dissolve or terminate the Trust, the Trust shall have the shares, which it holds for administration transferred into its successor’s name. For a period of two months following notification of succession of the administration, holders of bearer depositary receipts may elect to obtain free of charge, shares. In no case shall the administration be terminated without ING Groep N.V.’s approval.

Holders of bearer depositary receipts with a stake of 5% or more

To the best of our knowledge, as of December 31, 2011, no holder of depositary receipts held more than 5% of all bearer depositary receipts outstanding.

On December 31, 2011, ING Groep N.V. and its subsidiaries held 49,305,917 bearer receipts, representing 1.29% of the bearer depositary receipts and underlying Ordinary Shares outstanding. These bearer depositary receipts were acquired, among others, pursuant to ING Groep N.V.’s delta hedging activities in respect of its employee options, which activities are now terminated. ING Groep N.V. does not have voting rights in respect of shares and bearer depositary receipts it holds or which are held by its subsidiaries.

The voting rights of the majority of Ordinary Shares are held by the Trust. Pursuant to section 5.3 of the Dutch Financial Supervision Act, shareholders and holders of depositary receipts are only required to provide updated information on their holdings once they cross threshold levels of 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 75% and 95%. As a result, other than information that may be ascertained from public filings available under the applicable laws of any other jurisdiction, ING Groep N.V. is not, nor would it likely to be, aware of any changes in the ownership of bearer depositary receipts between the thresholds levels mentioned in the previous sentence.

Information available to ING Groep N.V. showed that as of December 31, 2011, institutional holders in the Netherlands held approximately 489 million bearer depositary receipts, or 26% of the total number of bearer depositary receipts then outstanding and institutional holders in the United States held approximately 898 million bearer depositary receipts (including ADSs), or 48% of the total number of bearer depositary receipts then outstanding.

On December 31, 2011, other than the Trust, no other person is known to ING Groep N.V. to be the owner of more than 10% of the Ordinary Shares or bearer depositary receipts. As of December 31, 2011, members of the Supervisory Board and their related third parties held 244,968 bearer receipts. If members of the Supervisory Board hold ING options that were granted in their former capacity as member of the Executive Board, these options are part of the ING Stock option plan described in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

On December 31, 2011, ING Groep N.V. is not a party to any material agreement that becomes effective, or is required to be amended or terminated in case of a change of control of ING Groep N.V. following a public bid as defined in the Dutch Financial Supervision Act (Wet op het financieel toezicht). ING Groep N.V. subsidiaries may have customary change of control arrangements included in agreements related to various business activities, such as joint venture agreements, letters of credit and other credit facilities, ISDA-agreements, hybrid capital and debt instruments, reinsurance contracts and futures and option trading agreements. Following a change of control of ING Groep N.V. (as the result of a public bid or otherwise), such agreements may be amended or terminated, leading, for example, to an obligatory transfer of the interest in the joint venture, early repayment of amounts due, loss of credit facilities or reinsurance cover and liquidation of outstanding futures and option trading positions.

Related Party Transactions

As of December 31, 2011, the amount outstanding in respect of loans and advances, mostly mortgages, made to members of the Supervisory Board was EUR 0.3 million at an average interest rate of 8.6 %. The amount outstanding in respect of loans and advances, mostly mortgages, to members of the Executive Board was EUR

1.6 million at an average interest rate of 3.4%. The largest aggregate amount of loans and advances outstanding to the members of the Supervisory Board and the Executive Board during 2011 was EUR 2.3 million.

 

121


Table of Contents

The loans and advances mentioned in the preceding paragraph (1) were made in the ordinary course of business, (2) were granted on conditions that are comparable to those of loans and advances granted to people in peer groups and (3) did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features. Loans and advances to members of the Executive Board are compliant with the standards set out in the DNB guidelines for loans to officers and directors of a regulated entity, such as ING.

As described under “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees”, some members of the Supervisory Board are current or former senior executives of leading multi-national corporations based primarily in the Netherlands. ING Group may at any time have lending, investment banking or other financial relationships with one or more of these corporations in the ordinary course of business on terms which we believe are no less favorable to ING than those reached with unaffiliated parties of comparable creditworthiness.

In addition, ING Group has entered into transactions with the Dutch State. For more information, see “Item 4. Information on the Company—Recent Developments” and Note 33 to the consolidated annual accounts.

 

122


Table of Contents
Item 8. Financial information

Legal Proceedings, Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

See Note 31 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

Legal Proceedings

ING Group companies are involved in litigation and arbitration proceedings in the Netherlands and in a number of foreign jurisdictions, including the United States, involving claims by and against them which arise in the ordinary course of their businesses, including in connection with their activities as insurers, lenders, employers, investors and taxpayers. In certain of such proceedings, very large or indeterminate amounts are sought, including punitive and other damages. While it is not feasible to predict or determine the ultimate outcome of all pending or threatened legal and regulatory proceedings, the Company’s management is of the opinion that neither it nor any of its subsidiaries is aware of any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which the Company is aware) which may have or have in the recent past had a significant effect on the financial position or profitability of the Company.

Because of the geographic spread of its business, ING may be subject to tax audits in numerous jurisdictions at any point in time. Although ING believes that it has adequately provided for all its tax positions, the ultimate resolution of these audits may result in liabilities which are different from the amounts recognised.

Proceedings in which ING is involved, include complaints and lawsuits concerning the performance of certain interest sensitive products that were sold by a former subsidiary of ING in Mexico. Proceedings also include lawsuits that have been filed by former employees of an Argentina subsidiary, whose employment was terminated as a result of the Republic of Argentina’s nationalization of the pension fund system. Litigation has been filed by the purchaser of certain ING Mexican subsidiaries who claims that the financial condition of the subsidiaries was not accurately depicted. Further, purported class litigation has been filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging violations of the federal securities laws with respect to disclosures made in connection with the 2007 and 2008 offerings of ING’s Perpetual Hybrid Capital Securities. The Court has determined that the claims relating to the 2007 offerings were without merit and has dismissed them. The challenged disclosures that survived the Court’s ruling relate solely to the June 2008 offering, and primarily to ING Group’s investments in certain residential mortgage-backed securities. Additional purported class litigation challenges the operation of the ING Americas Savings Plan and ESOP and the ING 401(k) Plan for ILIAC Agents. The District Court has dismissed the latter case and plaintiffs have appealed. Also an administrator of an ERISA plan has filed a lawsuit seeking to represent a class of ERISA plan administrators claiming that an ING subsidiary has breached certain of its ERISA duties. These matters are being defended vigorously; however, at this time, ING is unable to assess their final outcome. Therefore at this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect.

Since the end of 2006, unit-linked products (commonly referred to in Dutch as “beleggingsverzekeringen”) have received negative attention in the Dutch media, from Dutch Parliament, the AFM and consumer protection organisations. Costs of unit-linked products sold in the past are perceived as too high and insurers are in general being accused of being less transparent in their offering of unit-linked products. The criticism on unit-linked products led to the introduction of compensation schemes by Dutch insurance companies that have offered unit-linked products. In 2008 ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries reached an outline agreement with all consumer protection organisations to offer compensation to their unit-linked policyholders where individual unit-linked policies have a cost charge in excess of an agreed maximum and to offer similar compensation for certain hybrid insurance products. At December 31, 2008 a provision was recognised for the costs of the settlement. The costs were valued at EUR 365 million. A full agreement on implementation was reached in 2010 with one of the two main consumer protection organisations. In addition, ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries announced additional (so-called “flanking”) measures that comply with the “Best in Class” criteria as formulated on November 24, 2011 by the Dutch Minister of Finance. In December 2011 this resulted in an agreement on these measures with the two main consumer protection organisations. Implementation has started: our plan is to inform all unit-linked policyholders about compensation by the end of 2012. Neither the implementation of the compensation schemes nor these additional measures prevent individual policyholders from initiating legal proceedings against ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries. Policyholders have initiated and may continue to initiate legal proceedings claiming further damages. Because of the continuous public and political attention for the unit-linked issue in general and the uncertain outcome of pending and future legal proceedings, it is not feasible to predict or determine the ultimate financial consequences.

 

123


Table of Contents

In January 2010 ING lodged an appeal with the General Court of the European Union against specific elements of the European Commission’s decision regarding ING’s Restructuring Plan. In its appeal, ING contests the way the Commission has calculated the amount of state aid ING received and the disproportionality of the price leadership restrictions specifically and the disproportionality of restructuring requirements in general. In July 2011 the appeal case was heard orally by the General Court of the European Union. On March 2, 2012, the Court partially annulled the Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009 and as a result a new decision must be issued by the Commission. Interested parties can file an appeal against the General Court’s judgment before the Court of Justice of the European Union within two months and ten days after the date of the General Court’s judgment.

In January 2011 the Association of Stockholders (Vereniging van Effectenbezitters, “VEB”) has issued a writ alleging that investors were misled by the prospectus that was issued with respect to the September 2007 rights issue of Fortis N.V. (now: Ageas N.V.) against Ageas N.V., the underwriters of such rights issue, including ING Bank, and former directors of Fortis N.V. According to the VEB the prospectus shows substantive incorrect and misleading information. The VEB states that the impact and the risks of the subprime crisis for Fortis and Fortis’ liquidity position have been reflected incorrectly in the prospectus. The VEB requests a declaratory decision stating that the summoned parties have acted wrongfully and are therefore responsible for the damages suffered by the investors in Fortis. The amount of damages of EUR 18 billion has not been substantiated yet. ING will defend itself against this claim; at this time ING is not able to assess the future outcome. Therefore at this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect of such action.

In July 2011, the Dutch ING Pensioners’ Collective Action Foundation (Stichting Collectieve Actie Pensioengerechtigden ING Nederland), together with two trade unions (FNV Bondgenoten and CNV Dienstenbond) and a number of individual pensioners, instituted legal proceedings against ING’s decision not to provide funding for indexing pensions insured with Stichting Pensioenfonds ING (the Dutch ING Pension Fund) per January 1, 2011. In July 2011, also the Interest Group ING General Managers’ Pensions (Belangenvereniging ING-Directiepensioenen), together with a number of individual retired Dutch General Managers of ING, instituted legal proceedings against ING’s decision not to provide funding for indexing Dutch General Managers’ pensions per January 1, 2011. It is not feasible to predict the ultimate outcome of these legal proceedings although legal proceedings instituted by Stichting Pensioenfonds ING on the same issue were ruled in ING’s favour. The ultimate outcome of these proceedings may result in liabilities and provisions for such liabilities which are different from the amounts recognised. At this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect of such proceedings

In addition to the foregoing procedures, ING Bank remains in discussions with authorities in the US concerning ING Bank’s compliance with Office of Foreign Asset Control requirements. ING Bank has received requests for information from US Government agencies including the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office. ING Bank is cooperating fully with the ongoing investigations and is engaged in discussions to resolve these matters with the US authorities; however, it is not yet possible to reliably estimate the timing or amount of any potential settlement, which could be significant. At this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect.

In addition, like many other companies in the insurance industry, several of our U.S. companies have received formal requests for information from various governmental and regulatory agencies regarding whether and to what extent they proactively ascertain whether customers have deceased, pay benefits even where no claim has been made, and comply with state laws pertaining to unclaimed or abandoned property. Companies may have to make additional payments to beneficiaries and escheat additional funds deemed abandoned, and regulators may seek fines, penalties and interest. It is currently not practicable to estimate the (potential) financial effect of such information requests.

Dividends

ING Group’s profit retention and distribution policy is determined by its internal financing requirements and its growth opportunities as well as the dividend expectations of capital providers. On the one hand, ING Group’s internal funding needs are determined partly by statutory solvency requirements and capital ratios, compliance with which is essential to its existence. Credit ratings are similarly important to ING Group, because they directly affect the company’s financing costs and as a result profitability. On the other hand, the capital providers expect a dividend, which reflects ING Group’s financial results and is relatively predictable.

ING’s policy is to pay dividends in relation to the long-term underlying development of cash earnings. Dividends will only be paid when the Executive Board considers such a dividend appropriate. Given the uncertain financial environment, increasing regulatory requirements and ING’s priority to repay the remaining outstanding Core

 

124


Table of Contents

Tier 1 Securities, the Executive Board will not propose to pay a dividend over 2011 at the annual General Meeting. ING intends to resume dividend payments on common shares when all remaining Core Tier 1 Securities have been repaid to the Dutch State and Basel III requirements have been met.

The Executive Board decides, subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board of ING Groep N.V., which part of the annual results (after payment of dividends on Cumulative Preference shares) will be added to the reserves of ING Groep N.V. The part of the annual results that remains after this addition to the reserves and after payment of dividends on Cumulative Preference shares is at the disposal of the General Meeting, which may declare dividends there from and/or add additional amounts to the reserves of ING Groep N.V. A proposal of the Executive Board with respect thereto is submitted to the General Meeting.

Cash distributions on ING Groep N.V.’s Ordinary Shares and bearer depositary receipts are generally paid in Euros. However, the Executive Board may decide, with the approval of the Supervisory Board, to declare dividends in the currency of a country other than the Netherlands in which the bearer depositary receipts are trading. Amounts payable to holders of ADSs that are paid to the Depositary in a currency other than dollars will be converted to dollars and subjected to a charge by the Depositary for any expenses incurred by it in such conversion. The right to cash dividends and distributions in respect of the Ordinary Shares will lapse if such dividends or distributions are not claimed within five years following the day after the date on which they were made available.

If a distribution by ING Groep N.V. consists of a dividend in Ordinary Shares, such Ordinary Shares will be held by the Trust, and the Trust will distribute to the holders of the outstanding bearer depositary receipts, in proportion to their holdings, additional bearer receipts issued for the Ordinary Shares received by the Trust as such dividend. In the event the Trust receives any distribution with respect to Ordinary Shares held by the Trust other than in the form of cash or additional shares, the Trust will adopt such method as it may deem legal, equitable and practicable to effect such distribution.

If ING Groep N.V. offers or causes to be offered to the holders of Ordinary Shares the right to subscribe for additional shares, the Trust, subject to applicable law, will offer to each holder of bearer depositary receipts the right to subscribe for additional bearer depositary receipts of such shares on the same basis.

If the Trust has the option to receive such distribution either in cash or in shares, the Trust will give notice of such option by advertisement and give holders of bearer depositary receipts the opportunity to choose between cash and shares until the fourth day before the day on which the Trust must have made such choice. In the absence of such choice by holders of depositary receipts, the Trust will make the choice as it sees fit in the interests of the holders of depositary receipts concerned. Holders of bearer receipts may receive an equal nominal amount in Ordinary Shares.

There are no legislative or other legal provisions currently in force in the Netherlands or arising under ING Groep N.V.’s Articles of Association restricting the remittance of dividends to holders of Ordinary Shares, bearer depositary receipts or ADSs not resident in the Netherlands. Insofar as the laws of the Netherlands are concerned, cash dividends paid in Euro may be transferred from the Netherlands and converted into any other currency, except that for statistical purposes such payments and transactions must be reported by ING Groep N.V. to the Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank N.V., “DNB”) and, further, no payments, including dividend payments, may be made to jurisdictions or persons, that are subject to certain sanctions, adopted by the Government of the Netherlands, implementing resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations, or adopted by the European Union. Dividends are subject to withholding taxes in the Netherlands as described under Item 10, “Additional Information—Taxation—Netherlands Taxation”.

Since December 31, 2011, until the filing of this report, no significant changes have occurred in the financial statements of the Group included in “Item 18, Consolidated Financial Statements” of this document.

 

125


Table of Contents
Item 9. The offer and listing

Bearer receipts representing Ordinary Shares (nominal value EUR 0.24 per share) are traded on Euronext Amsterdam by NYSE Euronext, the principal trading market for the bearer receipts. The bearer receipts are also listed on the stock exchange of Euronext Brussels. In February 2009, ING Group voluntarily delisted from the Paris, Frankfurt and Swiss stock exchanges. ING Bank is one of the principal market makers for the bearer receipts on Euronext Amsterdam by NYSE Euronext.

Since June 13, 1997, ADSs, each representing one bearer receipt in respect of one Ordinary Share, have traded on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “ING”, and are the principal form in which the bearer receipts are traded in the United States. Prior to June 13, 1997, there was no active trading market for the ADSs. The ADSs are issued by JP Morgan Chase Bank, as Depositary, pursuant to an Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement dated March 6, 2004, among the Company, The Trust (Stichting ING Aandelen), as trustee, such Depositary and the holders of ADSs from time to time. The Trust holds all voting rights over the Ordinary Shares, and pursuant to the Trust Agreement, the Trust will grant proxies to holders of the bearer receipts. See “Item 7. Major shareholders and related party transactions”. Under the Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement holders of ADSs may instruct the Depositary as to the exercise of proxy voting rights associated with the ADSs. As of December 31, 2011, there were 145,502,149 ADSs outstanding, representing an equal number of bearer receipts. The ADSs were held by 808 record holders. Because certain of the ADSs were held by brokers or other nominees and the bearer receipts are held in bearer form and due to the impracticability of obtaining accurate residence information for all such shareholders, the number of holders of record or registered holders in the United States is not representative of the number of beneficial holders or of the residence of the beneficial holders. As of December 31, 2011, approximately 26% of the bearer receipts were held by Dutch investors, approximately 18% by investors in the U.K. and approximately 48% by investors in the United States (including as represented by ADSs).

The following are the high and low sales prices of the bearer receipts on the Euronext Amsterdam Stock Exchange, and the ADSs on the New York Stock Exchange (not restated for the rights issue of December 2009), for the period 2007 – February 29, 2012:

 

    

Euronext Amsterdam

Stock Exchange

(EUR)

    

Trading volume

in millions of
bearer receipts

    

New York

Stock Exchange

(USD)

     Trading volume
in millions of
ADS
 
Calendar period    High      Low             High      Low         

2007

     34.69         24.38         3,266.9         47.18         36.41         177.7   

2008

     26.21         5.21         4,904.8         40.67         6.37         436.3   

2009

     12.56         2.50         5,683.3         18.89         3.02         626.5   

2010

                 

First quarter

     7.98         5.98         1,715.6         11.25         8.20         181.3   

Second quarter

     7.94         5.34         2,097.9         10.67         6.80         310.4   

Third quarter

     7.98         5.95         1,565.5         10.63         7.37         158.4   

Fourth quarter

     8.28         6.59         1,428.4         11.45         8.65         163.0   

2011

                 

First quarter

     9.41         7.22         1,749.8         13.30         9.39         142.7   

Second quarter

     9.22         5.34         1,117.2         13.26         11.12         134.5   

Third quarter

     7.98         5.95         2,135.9         12.65         6.09         333.2   

Fourth quarter

     8.28         6.59         3,183.6         10.28         6.26         318.5   

2011 and 2012

                 

September 2011

     6.08         4.57         807.2         8.51         6.09         146.7   

October 2011

     7.12         4.92         787.3         10.28         6.45         111.3   

November 2011

     6.18         4.72         962.1         8.61         6.26         123.1   

December 2011

     6.30         5.06         627.1         8.45         6.58         84.1   

January 2012

     7.18         5.46         702.7         9.23         6.91         84.1   

February 2012

     7.49         6.48         563.2         9.84         8.54         74.3   

 

126


Table of Contents
Item 10. Additional information

Articles of Association

ING Groep N.V. is a holding company organized under the laws of the Netherlands. Its object and purpose, as set forth in article 3 of its Articles of Association, is to participate in, manage, finance, furnish personal or real security for the obligations of and provide services to other enterprises and institutions of any kind, but in particular enterprises and institutions which are active in the field of insurance, lending, investment and/or other financial services, and to engage in any activity which may be related or conducive to the foregoing. ING Groep N.V. is registered under file number 33231073 with the Trade Register of the Chamber of Commerce and the Articles of Association are available there.

Certain Powers of Directors

The Supervisory Board determines the compensation of the members of the Executive Board within the framework of the remuneration policy adopted by the General Meeting and the compensation of members of the Supervisory Board is determined by the General Meeting. Without prejudice to their voting rights they might have if they are a shareholder of ING Groep N.V., neither members of the Executive Board nor members of the Supervisory Board will vote on compensation for themselves or any other member of their body.

During their office, members of the Supervisory Board are not allowed to borrow or to accept guarantees from ING Groep N.V. or any of its subsidiaries. Loans that already exist upon appointment as a member of the Supervisory Board however, may be continued. Subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V. however, may in the normal course of their business and on terms that are customary in the sector, provide other banking and insurance services to members of the Supervisory Board. These services may include services in which the granting of credit is of a subordinate nature, e.g. credit cards and overdrafts in current accounts. Members of the Executive Board are empowered to exercise all the powers of ING Groep N.V. to borrow money, subject to regulatory restrictions (if any) and, in the case of the issuance of debt securities, to the approval of the Supervisory Board.

The Articles of Association do not contain any age limits for retirement of the members of the Executive Board and members of the Supervisory Board. The retirement age for members of the Executive Board under the (Dutch) pension plan is the first day of the month that the individual reaches the age of 65.

Members of the Executive Board are appointed by the General Meeting for a term of four years and may be reappointed. Members of the Supervisory Board are appointed for a term of four years and may be reappointed for two terms subject to the requirement in the charter of the Supervisory Board that a member of the Supervisory Board retires from the Board in the year in which he or she turns 70 (provided that the Supervisory Board does not decide otherwise taking into account special circumstances at its discretion). Both members of the Executive Board and members of the Supervisory Board are appointed from a binding nomination by the Supervisory Board. The General Meeting may declare the nomination non-binding by a resolution passed by an absolute majority of the votes cast, which majority represents more than one-third of the issued share capital.

Members of the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board are not required to hold any shares of ING Groep N.V. to qualify as such.

Material contracts

There have been no material contracts (outside the ordinary course of business, such as intercompany financing) to which ING Groep N.V. is a party in the last two years, except for:

 

   

the Core Tier 1 Securities transaction and the IABF which ING Groep N.V. concluded with the Dutch State, as further described in “Item 4. “Information on the Company – Corporate Governance – Transactions with the Dutch State” and as announced by ING Groep N.V. in its press releases dated October 19, 2008, January 26, 2009 and October 26, 2009 and the restructuring requirements pursuant to these transactions with the Dutch State as announced by ING Groep N.V. in its press release dated November 18, 2009; and

 

   

the Purchase and Sale Agreement, dated as of June 16, 2011, by and among ING Groep N.V., ING Bank N.V., ING Direct N.V. and ING Direct Bancorp, entered into in relation to sale of ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation, as further described in “Item 4. Information on the Company – Changes in the Composition of the Group – Acquisitions and disposals expected and occurring or expected to occur in 2012 – ING Direct USA” and as announced by ING Groep N.V. in its press releases dated June 16, 2011 and February 17, 2012. A copy of the share purchase agreement related to the sale of ING Direct USA was filed by the Company on Form 6-K on July 7, 2011.

 

127


Table of Contents

Documents on Display

ING Groep N.V. is subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. In accordance with these requirements, ING Groep N.V. files reports and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). These materials, including this Annual Report and its exhibits, may be inspected and copied at the SEC’s public reference room located at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549 or on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for more information about the public reference room and the copy charges. You may also inspect ING Groep N.V.’s SEC reports and other information located at the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005, or on the website of ING Groep N.V. (www.ing.com).

Exchange controls

Cash distributions, if any, payable in Euros on Ordinary Shares, bearer depositary receipts and ADSs may be officially transferred from the Netherlands and converted into any other currency without violating Dutch law, except that for statistical purposes such payments and transactions must be reported by ING Groep N.V. to the Dutch Central Bank and, further, no payments, including dividend payments, may be made to jurisdictions or persons subject to certain sanctions, adopted by the government of the Netherlands, implementing resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations or adopted by the European Union.

Restrictions on voting

The ADSs represent interests in bearer depositary receipts for Ordinary Shares in the share capital of ING Groep N.V. issued by the Trust, which holds the Ordinary Shares for which such bearer depositary receipts are issued. See “Item 7. Major shareholders and related party transactions”. The Trust is the holder of all Ordinary Shares underlying the bearer depositary receipts. Only holders of shares (including the Trust) may vote at general meetings.

Holders of bearer depositary receipts are entitled to attend and speak at general meetings of ING Groep N.V. However, holders of bearer depositary receipts (including the Depositary on behalf of the holders of ADSs) as such are not entitled to vote at such meetings. However, as set out in “Item 7. Major shareholders and related party transactions”, the Trust will grant a proxy to the effect that such holder of bearer depositary receipts may, in the name of the Trust, exercise the voting rights attached to a number of its Ordinary Shares that corresponds to the number of bearer depositary receipts held by him. Based on such a proxy the holder of bearer depositary receipts may vote according to its own discretion.

Holders of bearer depositary receipts may surrender the bearer depositary receipts in exchange for Ordinary Shares. The Trust charges a fee for exchanging bearer depositary receipts for Ordinary Shares of one eurocent (EUR 0.01) per bearer depositary receipt, with a minimum of twenty-five Euros (EUR 25.00) per exchange transaction.

Obligations of shareholders to disclose holdings

Section 5.3 of the Dutch Financial Supervision Act (the “Major Holdings Rules”) applies to any person who, directly or indirectly, acquires or disposes of an interest in the voting rights and/or the capital of (in short) a public limited company incorporated under the laws of the Netherlands with an official listing on a stock exchange within the European Economic Area, as a result of which acquisition or disposal the percentage of voting rights or capital interest acquired or disposed of reaches, exceeds or falls below 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 75% or 95%. With respect to ING Groep N.V., the Major Holdings Rules would require any person whose interest in the voting rights and/or capital of ING Groep N.V. reached, exceeded or fell below those percentage interests, whether through ownership of bearer depositary receipts, Ordinary Shares, ADSs, options or warrants, to notify in writing the Dutch Authority for the Financial Markets (Autoriteit Financiële Markten) immediately after the acquisition or disposal of the triggering interest in ING Groep N.V.’s share capital.

The notification will be recorded in the register, which is held by the Authority for the Financial Markets for that purpose, which register is available for public inspection.

Non-compliance with the obligations of the Major Holdings Rules can lead to criminal prosecution or administrative-law sanctions. In addition, a civil court can issue orders against any person who fails to notify or incorrectly notifies the Authority for the Financial Markets, in accordance with the Major Holdings Rules, including suspension of the voting right in respect of such person’s Ordinary Shares.

 

128


Table of Contents

Frequency, notice and agenda of general meetings

General meetings are normally held each year in April or May, to discuss the course of business in the preceding financial year on the basis of the reports prepared by the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board, and to decide on the distribution of dividends or other distributions, the appointment and/or reappointment of members of the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board (if any), other items requiring shareholder approval under Dutch law, and any other matters proposed by the Supervisory Board, the Executive Board or shareholders or holders of depositary receipts in accordance with the Articles of Association. Meetings are convened by public notice via the website of ING Group (www.ing.com) no later than on the forty-second day before the day of the general meeting. As of the date of convening a general meeting, all information relevant for shareholders and holders of depositary receipts is made available to them on this website and at the ING Group head office. This information includes the notice for the general meeting, the agenda, the place and time of the meeting, the address of the website of ING Group, the verbatim text of the proposals with an explanation and instructions on how to participate in the meeting (either in person or by proxy), as well as the reports of the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board. More complex proposals such as amendments to the Articles of Association are normally not included in the notice but are made available separately on the website of ING Group and at the ING Group head office.

Proposals by shareholders and holders of bearer depositary receipts

Proposals to include items on the agenda for a general meeting that have been adequately substantiated under applicable Dutch law can be made by shareholders and holders of depositary receipts representing a joint total of at least 0.1% of the share capital or representing together, on the basis of the stock prices on Euronext Amsterdam by NYSE Euronext, a share value of at least EUR 50 million. Given the periods of notice required for proxy voting, proposals have to be submitted in writing at least 60 days before the date of the meeting. Properly submitted proposals will be included on the agenda for the general meeting.

Dialogue with shareholders and holders of depositary receipts

In 2011, shareholders and holders of depositary receipts were allowed to ask questions about items on the agenda for the annual General Meeting and they will similarly be allowed to do so in 2012. Shareholders and holders of depositary receipts can visit the website of ING Group (www.ing.com) to submit their questions.

Record date

Pursuant to Dutch law, the record date for attending a general meeting and voting on the proposals in that general meeting is the twenty-eighth day before the day of the general meeting. Shareholders and holders of depositary receipts who hold shares and/or depositary receipts for shares at the record date are entitled to attend the general meeting and to exercise other rights related to the general meeting in question on the basis of their holding at the record date, notwithstanding a subsequent sale or purchase of shares or depositary receipts for shares. The record date is published in the notice for the general meeting. In accordance with US requirements, the depositary sets a record date for the American Depositary Shares (‘ADSs’), which date determines which ADSs are entitled to give voting instructions. This record date can differ from the record date set by ING Group for shareholders and holders of depositary receipts.

Attending general meetings

For logistical reasons, attendance at a general meeting by shareholders and holders of depositary receipts, either in person or by proxy, is subject to the requirement that ING Group is notified in advance. Instructions to that effect are included in the notice for the general meeting. General meetings are webcasted via the Company’s website (www.ing.com), so that shareholders and holders of depositary receipts who do not attend the general meeting in person, may nevertheless follow the course of affairs in the meeting by internet webcast.

Voting rights on shares

Each share entitles the holder to cast one vote at the general meeting. The Articles of Association do not restrict the voting rights on any class of shares. ING Group is not aware of any agreement pursuant to which voting rights on any class of its shares are restricted.

 

129


Table of Contents

Capital structure, shares

The authorised capital of ING Groep N.V. consists of Ordinary Shares and cumulative preference shares. Currently, only Ordinary Shares are issued, while a call option to acquire cumulative preference shares has been granted to Stichting Continuiteit ING (ING Continuity Foundation). The acquisition of cumulative preference shares pursuant to the call option is subject to the restriction that, immediately after the issue of cumulative preference shares, the total amount of cumulative preference shares outstanding may not exceed one-third of the total issued share capital of ING Groep N.V. The purpose of the call option is to protect the independence, the continuity and the identity of ING Groep N.V. against influences which are contrary to the interests of ING Groep N.V., its enterprise and the enterprises of its subsidiaries and all stakeholders (including, but not limited to, hostile take-overs). The Ordinary Shares are not used for protective purposes. The Ordinary Shares, which are all registered shares, are not listed on a stock exchange.

The Board of ING Continuity Foundation currently comprises four members who are independent of ING Group. No Executive Board members or former Executive Board members, Supervisory Board members or former Supervisory Board members, ING Group employees or former ING Group employees or permanent advisors or former permanent advisors are on the Board of ING Continuity Foundation. The Board of ING Continuity Foundation appoints its own members, after consultation with the Supervisory Board of ING Group, but without any requirement for approval by ING Group.

Description of shares

A description of the Shares, and other information with respect to shareholders, annual general meetings, changes in capital and limitations on changes in control can be found in our registration statements filed with the Commission on Form F-1 on June 12, 1997 and in this Annual Report under the heading “Item 7—Major shareholders and related party transactions”.

Depositary receipts

More than 99.9% of the issued Ordinary Shares are held by ING Trust Office. In exchange for these shares, ING Trust Office has issued depositary receipts in bearer form for these shares. The depositary receipts are listed on various stock exchanges Depositary receipts can be exchanged upon request of the holders of depositary receipts for non-listed Ordinary Shares, without any restriction, other than payment of an administrative fee of one eurocent (EUR 0.01) per depositary receipt with a minimum of twenty-five euros (EUR 25.00) per exchange transaction.

The holder of a depositary receipt is entitled to receive from ING Trust Office payment of dividends and other distributions corresponding to the dividends and other distributions received by ING Trust Office on an Ordinary Share.

The Board of ING Trust Office currently comprises five members who are independent from ING Group. No Executive Board members or former Executive Board members, Supervisory Board members or former Supervisory Board members, ING Group employees or former ING Group employees or permanent advisors or former permanent advisors are on the Board of ING Trust Office. The Board of ING Trust Office appoints its own members, without any requirement for approval by ING Group.

Issuance of shares

ING Groep N.V.’s authorized capital is the maximum amount of capital allowed to be issued under the terms of its Articles of Association. New shares in excess of this amount can only be issued if the Articles of Association are amended. The General Meeting is authorized to resolve to amend the Articles of Association, provided that the resolution is adopted on a proposal of the Executive Board, which has been approved by the Supervisory Board. Such a resolution of the General Meeting requires a majority of at least two-thirds of the votes cast at a general meeting at which at least two-thirds of the issued share capital is represented. An amendment of the Articles of Association has to be passed by notarial deed if it is to become effective. For reasons of flexibility, ING Group seeks to set the authorised capital in the Articles of Association at the highest level permitted by law.

Share issues are to be decided by the General Meeting, which may also delegate its authority. Each year, the General Meeting is asked to delegate authority to the Executive Board to issue new Ordinary Shares or to grant rights to subscribe for new Ordinary Shares, both with and without pre-emptive rights for existing shareholders. The powers thus delegated to the Executive Board are limited:

Ÿ in time: powers are delegated for a period of 18 months;

 

130


Table of Contents
Ÿ

by number: insofar as sufficient unissued Ordinary Shares are available in the authorised capital, Ordinary Shares may be issued up to a maximum of 10% of the issued share capital, or, in the event of a merger or takeover or to safeguard or conserve the capital position of the Company, up to a maximum of 20% of the issued capital; and;

 

Ÿ

in terms of control: resolutions by the Executive Board to issue shares require the approval of the Supervisory Board.

Approval by the General Meeting would be required for any share issues exceeding these limits.

The purpose of this delegation of authority is to allow the Company to respond promptly to developments in the financial markets. Without such delegation the Company wished to issue new shares, there would be an increased risk that conditions in the financial markets may have changed during the time needed for convening a general meeting, especially as the statutory convocation period was extended to 42 days. In view of the importance of flexibility with respect to the issue of shares, the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board will periodically evaluate the delegation of authority to issue shares and, if necessary, make adjusted proposals to the General Meeting.

Transfer of shares and depositary receipts and transfer restrictions

Shares are transferred by means of a deed of transfer between the transferor and the transferee. To become effective, ING Group has to acknowledge the transfer, unless ING Group itself is a party to the transfer. The Articles of Association do not restrict the transfer of Ordinary Shares, whereas the transfer of cumulative preference shares is subject to prior approval of the Executive Board. The Articles of Association and the trust conditions for registered shares in the share capital of ING Group (‘Trust Conditions’) do not restrict the transfer of depositary receipts for shares. ING Group is not aware of the existence of any agreement pursuant to which the transfer of Ordinary Shares or depositary receipts for such shares is restricted.

Repurchase of shares

ING Group may repurchase outstanding shares and depositary receipts for such shares. Although the power to repurchase shares and depositary receipts for shares is vested in the Executive Board subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board, prior authorisation from the General Meeting is required for these repurchases. Under Dutch law, this authorisation lapses after 18 months. Each year, the General Meeting is asked to approve the Executive Board’s authority to repurchase shares.

When repurchasing shares, the Executive Board is to observe the price ranges prescribed in the authorisation. For the Ordinary Shares and depositary receipts for such shares, the authorisation currently in force stipulates a minimum price of one eurocent and a maximum price equal to the highest stock price on Euronext Amsterdam by NYSE Euronext on the date on which the purchase agreement is concluded or on the preceding day of stock market trading.

Special rights of control

No special rights of control referred to in Article 10 of the EU Directive on takeover bids are attached to any share.

Shareholders’ structure

See “Item 7. Major shareholders and related party transactions” for a description of the bearer depository receipts held by ING Groep N.V. and for details of investors who have reported their interest in ING Groep N.V. pursuant to the Financial Supervision Act (or the predecessor of this legislation).

Pursuant to the terms of the Dutch Financial Supervision Act, a declaration of no objection from the Dutch Minister of Finance is to be obtained by anyone wishing to obtain or hold a participating interest of at least 10% in ING Groep N.V. and to exercise control attached to such a participating interest. Similarly, on the basis of indirect change of control statutes in the various jurisdictions where subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V. are operating, permission from or notification to local regulatory authorities may be required for the acquisition of a substantial interest in ING Groep N.V. ING Groep N.V. is not aware of investors with an interest of 10% or more in ING Groep N.V.

 

131


Table of Contents

TAXATION

The following is a summary of certain Netherlands tax consequences, and the United States federal income tax consequences, of the ownership of our bearer receipts or American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”) by U.S. Shareholders (as defined below) who hold bearer receipts or ADSs as capital assets. For purposes of this summary, a “U.S. Shareholder” is a beneficial owner of bearer receipts or ADSs that is:

 

an individual citizen or resident of the United States,

 

a corporation organized under the laws of the United States or of any state of the United States,

 

an estate, the income of which is subject to United States federal income tax without regard to its source, or

 

a trust if a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust and one or more United States persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

This summary is based on the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations, published rulings and court decisions, the laws of the Netherlands, and the income tax treaty between the Netherlands and the United States (the “Treaty”), all as of the date hereof. These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis. The information provided below is neither intended as tax advice nor purports to describe all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to investors and prospective investors. It should not be read as extending to matters not specifically discussed, and investors should consult their own advisors as to the tax consequences of their ownership and disposal of bearer receipts or ADSs. In particular, the summary does not take into account the specific circumstances of particular investors (such as tax-exempt organizations, banks, insurance companies, dealers in securities, traders in securities that elect to mark-to-market their securities holdings, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, investors whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, investors that actually or constructively own 10% or more of the voting stock of ING Groep N.V., investors that hold bearer receipts or ADSs as part of a straddle or a hedging or conversion transaction, or investors that own bearer receipts or ADSs through a partnership), some of which may be subject to special rules.

Moreover, this summary does not discuss the Dutch tax treatment of a holder of bearer receipts or ADSs:

1. that holds a substantial interest in ING Groep N.V.; or

2. that is an individual who receives income or capital gains derived from the bearer receipts and ADSs and this income received or capital gains derived are attributable to the past, present or future employment activities of such holder.

Generally speaking, for Dutch tax purposes, an interest in the share capital of ING Groep N.V., should not be considered a substantial interest if the holder of such interest, and, in case of an individual, his or her spouse, registered partner, certain other relatives or certain persons sharing the holder’s household, alone or together, does or do not hold, either directly or indirectly, the ownership of, or certain rights over, shares or rights resembling shares representing 5% or more of the total issued and outstanding capital, or the issued and outstanding capital of any class of shares, of ING Groep N.V.

The summary is based in part upon the representations of the Depositary and the assumption that each obligation in the Deposit Agreement and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms. In general, for United States federal income tax and Netherlands tax purposes, holders of bearer receipts or ADSs will be treated as the owners of the Ordinary Shares underlying the bearer receipts or ADSs, and exchanges of Ordinary Shares for bearer receipts and then for ADSs, and exchanges of ADSs for bearer receipts and then for Ordinary Shares, will not be subject to United States federal income tax or Netherlands income tax.

It is assumed, for purposes of this summary, that a U.S. Shareholder is eligible for the benefits of the Treaty and that a U.S. Shareholder’s eligibility is not limited by the limitation on benefits provisions of the Treaty.

NETHERLANDS TAXATION

Withholding tax on dividends

The Netherlands imposes a withholding tax on a distribution of a dividend at the rate of 15%. Stock dividends paid out of ING Groep N.V.’s paid-in share premium recognized for Netherlands tax purposes as such are not subject to the above withholding tax.

 

132


Table of Contents

The Treaty provides for a complete exemption from withholding for dividends received by exempt pension trusts and other exempt organizations, as defined in the Treaty. Qualifying exempt pension trusts may claim the benefits of a reduced withholding tax rate pursuant to article 35 of the Treaty. Qualifying exempt pension trusts normally remain subject to withholding at the rate of 15% and are required to file for a refund of the tax withheld. Only if certain conditions are fulfilled, such pension trusts may be eligible for relief at source upon payment of the dividend. Qualifying exempt organizations (other than qualifying exempt pension trusts) are subject to withholding at the rate of 15% and can only file for a refund of the tax withheld.

On August 29, 2002 dividend-stripping rules were introduced in Netherlands tax law. These rules have retroactive effect as of April 27, 2001. The rules provide that in the case of dividend-stripping, the 15% dividend withholding tax cannot be reduced or refunded. Dividend-stripping is deemed to be present if the recipient of a dividend is, different from what has been assumed above, not the beneficial owner thereof and is entitled to a larger credit, reduction or refund of dividend withholding tax than the beneficial owner of the dividends. Under these rules, a recipient of dividends will not be considered the beneficial owner thereof if as a consequence of a combination of transactions a person other than the recipient wholly or partly benefits from the dividends, whereby such person retains, whether directly or indirectly, an interest in the share on which the dividends were paid.

Currently ING Groep N.V. may, with respect to certain dividends received from qualifying non-Netherlands subsidiaries, credit taxes withheld from those dividends against the Netherlands withholding tax imposed on certain qualifying dividends that are redistributed by ING Groep N.V., up to a maximum of the lesser of

 

3% of the amount of qualifying dividends redistributed by ING Groep N.V. and

 

3% of the gross amount of certain qualifying dividends received by ING Groep N.V.

The reduction is applied to the Dutch dividend withholding tax that ING Groep N.V. must pay to the Dutch tax authorities and not to the Dutch dividend withholding tax that ING Groep N.V. must withhold.

Both the European Free Trade Association Court of Justice as well as the European Court of Justice (ECJ) issued judgments concerning outbound dividend payments to foreign shareholders. According to both courts, it could be in breach with the European freedom of capital and the freedom of establishment to treat outbound dividend payments less favorably than dividend payments to domestic shareholders. As of January 1, 2007, in general, dividend payments to certain qualifying EU resident corporate shareholders are treated the same as dividend payments to certain qualifying Dutch resident corporate shareholders. Dividend payments to corporate shareholders residing outside the EU are treated still less favorably as opposed to dividend payments to certain qualifying Dutch resident corporate shareholders. Furthermore, subject to certain conditions, a legal entity resident in the Netherlands that is not subject to Dutch corporate income tax is entitled to a refund of the Dutch dividend withholding tax withheld. In addition, subject to certain conditions as well, an entity resident in a member state of the European Union or certain member states of the European Economic Area, that is not subject to a result based tax in that member state, and, should that entity be a resident in the Netherlands, would not be subject to Dutch corporate income tax, is also entitled to a refund of the Dutch dividend withholding tax withheld. Such entities that are not a resident of the Netherlands, the European Union or certain European Economic Area countries, are not entitled to a refund of Dutch dividend withholding tax. The above stated court cases may have significant implications for certain non-EU resident shareholders that receive dividends that are subject to Netherlands dividend withholding tax (i.e. the aforementioned different treatment may be a breach of the European freedom of capital).

Although the freedom of capital generally also applies to capital movements to and from third countries, such as the United States, it cannot be ruled out that the freedom of capital movements to and from third countries must be interpreted more stringent as opposed to the freedom of capital movements to EU member states. Furthermore, the freedom of capital movements to and from third countries is generally subject to grandfathering (stand-still) provisions in the EC-Treaty (i.e. the restriction of the freedom of capital movements is allowed if these stand-still provisions apply). However, based on case law of the ECJ it may be held that these stand-still provisions do not apply in the specific case of claiming a refund of the Netherlands dividend withholding tax by a shareholder who did not acquire the shares in ING Groep N.V. with a view to establishing or maintaining lasting and direct economic links between the shareholder and ING Groep N.V. which allow the shareholder to participate effectively in the management of the company or in its control.

Especially the following non-EU resident shareholders may be affected and may as a result be entitled to a (partial) refund of Netherlands dividend withholding tax.

 

133


Table of Contents

Legal entities that could have invoked the participation exemption with respect to the dividends received in case they would have been a resident of the Netherlands for tax purposes. In general, the participation exemption applies in case of shareholdings of 5% or more. In case of legal entities resident in the Netherlands, in effect no Dutch dividend withholding tax is due with respect to dividends on shareholdings that apply for the participation exemption.

 

Individuals if the shares do not belong to the assets of a business enterprise or do not belong to a substantial interest. In case such a natural person would have been a resident of the Netherlands, the dividend as such would not be subject to individual income tax. Instead, the individual would be taxed on a deemed income, calculated at 4% of his net equity, whereas the dividend tax withheld would have been credited in full against the individual income tax due.

 

Legal entities that, if they had been based in the Netherlands, would not have been subject to corporate income tax (such as a pension fund), or would have qualified as an investment institution for the purposes of this tax, and that would, because of this, be eligible for a refund of dividend withholding tax withheld at their expense.

Taxes on income and capital gains

A U.S. Shareholder will not be subject to Netherlands income tax or corporation tax, other than the withholding tax described above, or capital gains tax, provided that:

 

such shareholder is not a resident or deemed resident and, in the case of an individual, has not elected to be treated as a resident of the Netherlands;

 

such shareholder does not have an enterprise or an interest in an enterprise, which in its entirety or in part carries on business in the Netherlands through a permanent establishment or a permanent representative or deemed permanent establishment to which or to whom the bearer receipts or ADSs are attributable; and

 

such shareholder is an individual, and income from a bearer receipt or ADS is not attributable to certain activities in the Netherlands performed by such shareholder other than business activities (for example, by the use of that individual’s special knowledge or activities performed by that individual with respect to the bearer receipts or ADSs as a result of which such individual can make a return on the bearer receipt or ADS that is in excess of the return on normal passive portfolio management).

Gift, estate or inheritance tax

No Netherlands gift, estate or inheritance tax will be imposed on the acquisition of bearer receipts or ADSs by gift or inheritance from a holder of bearer receipts or ADSs who is neither resident nor deemed resident in the Netherlands, provided that the ADSs or bearer receipts are not attributable to an enterprise which in its entirety or in part is carried on through a permanent establishment or a permanent representative in the Netherlands. Furthermore, Dutch gift and inheritance tax is due if the holder of bearer receipts or ADSs dies within 180 days of making the gift, and at the time of death is a resident or deemed resident of the Netherlands. A non-resident Netherlands citizen, however, is still treated as a resident of the Netherlands for gift and inheritance tax purposes for ten years after leaving the Netherlands. An individual with a non-Dutch nationality is deemed to be a resident of the Netherlands for the purposes of Dutch gift tax if he or she has been resident in the Netherlands at any time during the 12 months preceding the date of the gift.

UNITED STATES TAXATION

Taxes on dividends

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, for United States federal income tax purposes, a U.S. Shareholder will be required to include in gross income the full amount of a cash dividend (including any Netherlands withholding tax withheld) as ordinary income when the dividend is actually or constructively received by the Trust. For this purpose, a “dividend” will include any distribution paid by ING Groep N.V. with respect to the bearer receipts or ADSs, but only to the extent such distribution is not in excess of ING Groep N.V.’s current and accumulated earnings and profits as determined for United States federal income tax purposes. Distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for United States federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of a U.S. Shareholder’s basis in the bearer receipts or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain. Because ING Groep N.V. does not keep account of its earnings and profits, as determined for United States federal income tax purposes, any distribution should generally be treated as a dividend for US federal income tax purposes.

 

134


Table of Contents

For foreign tax credit purposes, dividends will generally be income from sources outside the United States and will, depending on the circumstances of the U.S. Shareholder, be either “passive” or “general” income for purposes of computing the foreign tax credit allowable to the shareholder. A dividend will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to U.S. corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations. Dividends paid to a non-corporate U.S. Shareholder in taxable years beginning before January 1, 2013 that are qualified dividend income will be taxable to the shareholder at a maximum tax rate of 15% provided that the shareholder holds the bearer receipts or ADSs for more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and meet other holding period requirements. Dividends paid by ING Groep N.V. with respect to the bearer receipts or ADSs generally will be qualified dividend income.

Subject to certain limitations, a U.S. Shareholder may generally deduct from income, or credit against its United States federal income tax liability, the amount of any Netherlands withholding taxes under the Treaty. The Netherlands withholding tax will likely not be creditable against the U.S. Shareholder’s United States tax liability, however, to the extent that ING Groep N.V. is allowed to reduce the amount of dividend withholding tax paid over to the Netherlands Tax Administration by crediting withholding tax imposed on certain dividends paid to ING Groep N.V. In addition, special rules apply in determining the foreign tax credit limitation with respect to dividends that are subject to the maximum 15% tax rate.

Since payments of dividends with respect to bearer receipts and ADSs will be made in Euros, a U.S. Shareholder will generally be required to determine the amount of dividend income by translating the Euro into United States dollars at the “spot rate” on the date the dividend distribution is includable in the income of the U.S. Shareholder. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency exchange fluctuations during the period from the date the dividend distribution is includable in the income of the U.S. Shareholder to the date such payment is converted into U.S. dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss and will not be eligible for the special tax rate applicable to qualified dividend income. Such gain or loss will generally be income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Taxes on capital gains

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, gain or loss on a sale or exchange of bearer receipts or ADSs by a U.S. Shareholder will generally be a capital gain or loss for United States federal income tax purposes. If such U.S. Shareholder has held the bearer receipts or ADSs for more than one year, such gain or loss will generally be long-term capital gain or loss. Long-term capital gain of a non-corporate U.S. Shareholder is generally taxed at preferential rates. In general, gain or loss from a sale or exchange of bearer receipts or ADSs by a U.S. Shareholder will be treated as income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

Passive foreign investment company

ING Groep N.V. believes it is not a passive foreign investment company (a “PFIC”) for United States federal income tax purposes. This is a factual determination that must be made annually and thus may change.

If ING Groep N.V. were to be treated as a PFIC, unless a U.S. Shareholder made an effective election to be taxed annually on a mark-to-market basis with respect to the bearer receipts or ADSs, any gain from the sale or disposition of bearer receipts or ADSs by a U.S. Shareholder would be allocated ratably to each year in the holder’s holding period and would be treated as ordinary income. Tax would be imposed on the amount allocated to each year prior to the year of disposition at the highest rate in effect for that year, and interest would be charged at the rate applicable to underpayments on the tax payable in respect of the amount so allocated. The same rules would apply to “excess distributions”, defined generally as distributions in a single taxable year exceeding 125% of the average annual distribution made by ING Groep N.V. over the shorter of the holder’s holding period or the three preceding years. Dividends received by a U.S. Shareholder will not be eligible for the special tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income if ING Groep N.V. were to be treated as a PFIC with respect to the shareholder either in the taxable year of the distribution or the preceding taxable year, but instead will be taxable at rates applicable to ordinary income.

A U.S. Shareholder who owns bearer receipts or ADSs during any year that ING Groep N.V. is a PFIC may be required to file Internal Revenue Service Form 8621 and, pursuant to recently enacted legislation, an annual report with the Internal Revenue Service.

 

135


Table of Contents
Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risk

See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects – Factors Affecting Results of Operations” and “Risk Management” of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements for these disclosures, including disclosures relating to operational, compliance and other non market-related risks.

 

Item 12. Description of Securities Other Than Equity Securities

Fees and Charges Payable by a Holder of ADSs

JP Morgan Chase Bank, N.A., as ADR depositary, collects fees for delivery and surrender of ADSs directly from investors, or from intermediaries acting for them, depositing Ordinary Shares or surrendering ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal. The ADR depositary collects fees for making distributions to investors by deducting those fees from the amounts distributed or by selling a portion of the distributable property to pay the fees.

The charges of the ADR depositary payable by investors are as follows:

 

Type of Service

      

ADR Depositary Actions

      

Fee

ADR depositary or substituting the underlying shares

    

Issuance of ADSs against the deposit of Ordinary Shares, including deposits and issuances in respect of:

•    Share distributions, stock splits, rights, merger

•    Exchange of securities or other transactions or event or other distribution affecting the ADSs or deposited securities

    

$ 5.00 or less per 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the new ADSs delivered

Receiving or distributing cash dividends

    

Distribution of cash dividends

    

No fee

Selling or exercising rights

    

Distribution or sale of securities, the fee being in an amount equal to the fee for the execution and delivery of ADSs which would have been charged as a result of the deposit of such securities

    

$ 5.00 or less per each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof)

Withdrawing an underlying Ordinary Share

    

Acceptance of ADSs surrendered for withdrawal of deposited Ordinary Shares

    

$ 5.00 or less for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the ADSs surrendered

General depositary services, particularly those charged on an annual basis

    

Other services performed by the ADS depositary in administering the ADS program

    

No fee

Expenses of the ADR depositary

    

Expenses incurred on behalf of Holders in connection with:

•    Taxes and other governmental charges

•    Cable, telex and facsimile transmission/delivery

•    Transfer or registration fees, if applicable, for the registration of transfers or underlying Ordinary Shares

•    Expenses of the Depositary in connection with the conversion of foreign currency into US dollars (which are paid out of such foreign currency)

•    Any other charge payable by ADR depositary or its agents

    

Expenses payable at the sole discretion of the ADR depositary by billing Holders or by deducting charges from one or more cash dividends or other cash distributions

 

136


Table of Contents

Fees and Payments made by the ADR depositary to ING

The ADR depositary has agreed to reimburse certain ING expenses related to ING’s ADR program and incurred by ING in connection with the program. In the year ended December 31, 2011, the ADR depositary reimbursed to ING, or paid amounts on its behalf to third parties, a total sum of $ 1,900,000

The table below sets forth the types of expenses that the ADR depositary has agreed to reimburse and the amounts reimbursed in the year ended December 31, 2011:

 

Category of expense reimbursed to ING

   Amount Reimbursed for the year ended
December 31, 2011
 

Investor relations, including upfront contribution

   $ 1,900,000   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,900,000   
  

 

 

 

The ADR depositary has paid certain expenses directly to third parties on behalf of ING.The table below sets forth those expenses that the ADR depositary paid directly to third parties in the year ended December 31, 2010.

 

Category of expense paid directly to third parties

   Amount paid in the year ended
December 31, 2011
 

Third-party expenses paid directly

   $ 0   

Fees waived

   $ 350,000   

Total

   $ 350,000   

Under certain circumstances, including removal of the ADR depositary or termination of the ADR program by ING, ING is required to repay the ADR depositary certain amounts reimbursed and/or expenses paid to or on behalf of ING.

 

137


Table of Contents

PART II.

 

Item 13. Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies

None.

 

Item 14. Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds

None.

 

Item 15. Controls and Procedures

On January 31, 2012 an evaluation was performed under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures. Based on that evaluation, the Company’s management, including the CEO and CFO, concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report. There have been no significant changes in the Company’s internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect internal controls over financial reporting subsequent to January 31, 2012.

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. ING’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of our principal executive and principal financial officers to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:

 

 

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of ING;

 

 

provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorisations of our management and directors; and

 

 

provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011. In making this assessment, the Executive Board performed tests based on the criteria of the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control – Integrated Framework. Based on the Management’s assessment and those criteria, Management concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective as of December, 31 2011.

Our independent registered public accounting firm has audited and issued their report on ING’s internal control over financial reporting, which appears on the following page.

 

138


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Shareholders, the Supervisory Board and Executive Board of ING Groep N.V.

We have audited ING Groep N.V.’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). ING Groep N.V.’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorisations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, ING Groep N.V. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of ING Groep N.V. as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated profit and loss accounts, consolidated statements of comprehensive income, consolidated statements of cash flows and consolidated statements of changes in equity for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011 and our report dated March 12, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Amsterdam, the Netherlands

March 12, 2012

Ernst & Young Accountants LLP

 

139


Table of Contents
Item 16A. Audit Committee Financial Expert

The Audit Committee assists the Supervisory Board in monitoring the integrity of the financial statements of ING Group, ING Verzekeringen N.V. and ING Bank N.V., in monitoring the compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and in monitoring the independence and performance of ING’s internal and external auditors. On December 31, 2011, the members of the Audit Committee were: Joost Kuiper (chairman), Tineke Bahlmann, Henk Breukink, Aman Mehta and Luc Vandewalle.

The Supervisory Board has determined that Sjoerd van Keulen, Joost Kuiper and Aman Mehta are financial experts as referred to in the Corporate Governance Code. Joost Kuiper and Aman Mehta were appointed to the Audit Committee per May 9, 2011 and February 14, 2011, respectively. Sjoerd van Keulen was appointed to the Risk Committee per May 9, 2011.

Sjoerd van Keulen and Joost Kuiper are considered to be financial experts due to their broad experience in the banking and insurance business and the Dutch financial sector while Aman Mehta has gathered his experience by serving as chief executive officer of Hong Kong & Shanghai Banking Corporation (HSBC) in Hong Kong.

 

Item 16B. Code of Ethics

ING Group has adopted a code of ethics, called the ING’s Business Principles, which apply to all our employees, including our principal executive officer, principal financial officer and principal accounting officer. These Business Principles have undergone minor changes to adapt them to the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 as a code of ethics for certain officers. The Business Principles are posted on ING Group’s website at www.ing.com, under the heading “Sustainability” followed by “ING Business Principles”. During the most recently completed fiscal year no waivers, explicit or implicit, from these Business Principles have been granted to any of the officers described above.

 

Item 16C. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

At the annual General Meeting held on April 22, 2008, Ernst & Young was appointed to audit the financial statements of ING Group for the financial years 2008 to 2011 inclusive, to report on the outcome of these audits to the Executive Board and the Supervisory Board and to provide an audit opinion on the financial statements of ING Group. Furthermore, Ernst & Young also audited and reported on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting on December 31, 2011. The external auditor attended the meetings of the Audit Committee and the 2011 annual General Meeting.

In the 2012 annual General Meeting it will be proposed to extend the appointment of Ernst & Young by two more years, i.e. for the financial years 2012 and 2013. This proposal is based on an evaluation of the performance of the external auditor by the Audit Committee over the past four years. In addition to its own observations, the Audit Committee took into account feedback given by Senior Management and Internal Auditors on themes including quality of services, costs, business understanding, team composition, integrity, objectivity and independence. A large majority of respondents expressed satisfaction with the performance of the external auditor. The Audit Committee has also taken notice of the press release of the AFM of January 26, 2012 by which the AFM announced that a fine was imposed on Ernst & Young for not exercising its duty of care. The Audit Committee has discussed the findings of the AFM and the measures taken by Ernst & Young to prevent shortcomings in the future.

After a maximum period of five years of performing the financial audit of ING Group or ING Verzekeringen N.V. or ING Bank N.V., the lead audit partners of the external audit firm and the audit partners responsible for reviewing the audits, have to be replaced by other partners of the external audit firm. The Audit Committee provides recommendations to the Supervisory Board regarding these replacements based, among other things on an annual evaluation of the provided services. In line with this requirement, the lead audit partner of Ernst & Young will be succeeded after the year-end audit 2011. The rotation of other partners involved with the audit of the financial statements of ING is subject to applicable independence legislation.

The external auditor may be questioned at the annual general meeting in relation to its audit opinion on the annual accounts. The external auditor will therefore attend and be entitled to address this meeting. The external auditor may only provide audit, audit related, tax and other services to ING Group and its subsidiaries with the permission of the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee generally pre-approves certain types of audit, audit-related, tax and non-audit services to be provided by the external auditor on an annual basis.

 

140


Table of Contents

Services that have not been pre-approved by the Audit Committee should not be provided by the external auditor unless they are specifically pre-approved by the Audit Committee at the recommendation of local management.

The Audit Committee also sets the maximum annual amount that may be spent for pre-approved services. Throughout the year the external auditor and ING monitor the amounts paid versus the pre-approved amounts. ING provides the Audit Committee with a full overview of all services provided to ING, including related fees supported by sufficiently detailed information. This overview is periodically evaluated by the Audit Committee during the year. More information on ING Group’s policy on external auditor independence is available on the website of ING Group (www.ing.com)

Audit fees

Audit fees were paid for professional services rendered by the auditors for the audit of the consolidated financial statements of ING Group and statutory financial statements of ING’s subsidiaries or services provided in connection with the audit of Form 20-F and other filings for regulatory and supervisory purposes as well as the review on interim financial statements.

Audit-related fees

Audit-related fees were paid for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of the consolidated financial statements and are not reported under the audit fee item above. These services consisted primarily of IT audits, work performed relating to comfort letters issued in connection with prospectuses, reviews of SEC product filings and advice on accounting.

Tax fees

Tax fees were paid for tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning professional services. These services consisted of: tax compliance including the review of original and amended tax returns, assistance with questions regarding tax audits, the preparation of employee tax returns under the ING’s expatriate tax services program and tax planning and advisory services relating to common forms of domestic and international taxation (i.e., income tax, capital tax and value added tax).

All other fees

Fees disclosed in Note 47 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements under “all other fees” were paid for products and services other than the audit fees, audit-related fees and tax fees described above, and consisted primarily of non-recurring support and advisory services.

More information on ING’s policy regarding external auditor’s independence are available on the website of ING Group (www. ing.com).

Reference is made to Note 47 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements for audit, audit-related, tax and all other fees paid to the external auditors in 2011, 2010 and 2009.

 

141


Table of Contents
Item 16D. Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees

Not applicable

Item 16E. Purchases of Registered Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers

There were no purchases of Registered Equity Securities in 2011.

 

Purchases           Number
x 1000
     Average
price in
Euros
     Purchased as
part of Publicly
Announced
Plans or
Programs
   Maximum
number of
Shares that may
be purchased

January

     1/1/10 -1/31/10         20         7.57         

February

     2/1/10 -2/28/10         55         6.66         

March

     3/1/10 -31/3/10         9,808         7.35         

April

     4/1/10 -30/4/10         4,442         7.71         

May

     5/1/10 -5/31/10         98         6.61         

June

     6/1/10 -6/30/10         2,110         6.34         

July

     7/1/10 -7/31/10         2         6.88         

August

     8/1/10 -8/31/10         93         7.14         

September

     9/1/10 -9/30/10         123         7.36         

October

     10/1/10 -10/31/10         2         8.06         

November

     11/1/10 -11/30/10         329         7.98         

December

     12/1/10 -12/31/10         23         7.38         
     

 

 

          

Total 1)

        17,105         7.32         
     

 

 

          

 

(1

This table excludes market-making and related hedging purchases by ING Group. The table also (i) excludes ING Group shares purchased by investments funds managed by ING Group for clients in accordance with specified investment strategies that are established by each individual fund manager acting independently of ING Group, and (ii) includes share purchases under ING Group’s delta hedging activities in respect of its employee option plans.

Item 16F. Changes in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant

Not applicable

Item 16G. Corporate Governance

In conformity with regulations from the US Securities and Exchange Commission, ING Group as a foreign private issuer whose securities are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (‘NYSE’) must disclose in its Annual Report on Form 20-F any significant differences between its corporate governance practices and those applicable to US domestic companies under the NYSE listing standards.

ING Group believes the following to be the significant differences between its corporate governance practices and NYSE corporate governance rules applicable to US companies:

 

 

ING Group has a two-tier board structure, in contrast to the one-tier board structure used by most US companies. In the Netherlands, a public limited liability company (naamloze vennootschap) has an Executive Board as its management body and a Supervisory Board which advises and supervises the Executive Board. In general, members of the Executive Board are employees of the company while members of the Supervisory Board are often former state or business leaders and sometimes former members of the Executive Board. Members of the Executive Board and other officers and employees cannot simultaneously be a member of the Supervisory Board. The Supervisory Board must approve specified decisions of the Executive Board. Under the Corporate Governance Code, all members of the Supervisory Board with the exception of not more than one person, should be independent. All members of ING Group’s Supervisory Board, with the exception of Luc Vandewalle (due to his former affiliation with ING Belgium), are independent within the meaning of the Corporate Governance Code. The definitions of independence under the Corporate Governance Code, however, differ in their details from the definitions of independence under the NYSE listing standards. In some

 

142


Table of Contents
 

cases the Dutch requirements are stricter and in other cases the NYSE listing standards are the stricter of the two. The Audit Committee, Risk Committee, Remuneration Committee, Nomination Committee and Corporate Governance Committee of ING Group are comprised of members of the Supervisory Board.

 

 

In contrast to the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the Corporate Governance Code contains an ‘apply-or-explain’ principle, offering the possibility to deviate from the Corporate Governance Code as long as any such deviations are explained. To the extent that such deviations are approved by the General Meeting, the company is deemed to be in full compliance with the Corporate Governance Code.

 

 

Dutch law requires that the company’s external auditors be appointed at the general meeting and not by the Audit Committee.

 

 

The articles of association of ING Group (‘Articles of Association’) provide that there are no quorum requirements to hold a general meeting, although certain shareholder actions and certain resolutions may require a quorum.

 

 

The shareholder approval requirements for equity compensation plans under Dutch law and the Corporate Governance Code differ from those applicable to US companies which are subject to the NYSE’s listing rules. Under Dutch company law and the Corporate Governance Code, shareholder approval is only required for equity compensation plans (or changes thereto) for members of the Executive Board and Supervisory Board, and not for equity compensation plans for other groups of employees.

PART III.

 

Item 18. Consolidated Financial Statements

See pages F-1 to F-243 and the Schedules on F-253 to F-256.

Item 19. Exhibits

The following exhibits are filed as part of this Annual Report:

 

Exhibit 1.1    Amended and Restated Articles of Association of ING Groep N.V., dated June 15, 2011
Exhibit 1.2    Amended and Restated Trust Agreement (English Translation), dated September 2, 2011
Exhibit 2.1    Subordinated Indenture, dated July 18, 2002, between the Company and The Bank of New York, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of ING Groep N.V.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2002, File No. 1-14642 filed on March 27, 2003)
Exhibit 2.2    First Supplemental Indenture, dated July 18, 2002, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 of ING Groep N.V.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2003, File No. 1-14642 filed on March 30, 2004)
Exhibit 2.3    Second Supplemental Indenture, dated December 12, 2002, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.3 of ING Groep N.V.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2003, File No. 1-14642 filed on March 30, 2004)
Exhibit 2.4    Third Supplemental Indenture, dated October 28, 2003, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.4 of ING Groep N.V.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2003, File No. 1-14642 filed on March 30, 2004)
Exhibit 2.5    Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated September 26, 2005, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on September 23, 2005)
Exhibit 2.6    Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated December 8, 2005, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on December 7, 2005)
Exhibit 2.7    Sixth Supplemental Indenture, dated June 13, 2007, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on June 12, 2007)

 

143


Table of Contents
Exhibit 2.8    Seventh Supplemental Indenture, dated October 4, 2007, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on October 3, 2007)
Exhibit 2.9    Eight Supplemental Indenture, dated June 17, 2008, between the Company and The Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on June 17, 2008)
Exhibit 2.10    Terms and Conditions of the Core Tier 1 Securities Ranking Pari Passu with Ordinary Shares (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.10 of ING Groep N.V.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2008, File No. 1-14642 filed on March 19, 2009)
Exhibit 2.11    Term Sheet regarding Core Tier 1 Securities Ranking Pari Passu with Ordinary Shares (incorporated by reference to ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on February 4, 2009)
Exhibit 4.1    Purchase and Sale Agreement, dated as of June 16, 2011, by and among ING Groep N.V., ING Bank N.V., ING Direct N.V., ING Direct Bancorp and Capital One Financial Corporation (incorporated by reference to ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on July 7, 2011)
Exhibit 4.2    ING Restructuring Plan submitted to the Dutch State and subsequently provided to the European Commission on October 22, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2 of ING Groep N.V.’s Report on Form 6-K filed on November 4, 2011)
Exhibit 4.3    2012 Amendment and Contract Transfer Agreement, dated February 16, 2012, among Staat der Nederlanden, ING Support Holding B.V., ING Bank N.V. and ING Groep N.V. attaching the Amended and Restated ING Bank, FSB Illiquid Assets Back-Up Facility Agreement, dated February 16, 2012, among ING Groep N.V., ING Bank N.V. and Staat der Nederlanden
Exhibit 7    Statement regarding Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges
Exhibit 8    List of Subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V.
Exhibit 12.1    Certification of the Registrant’s Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes- Oxley Act of 2002
Exhibit 12.2    Certification of the Registrant’s Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes- Oxley Act of 2002
Exhibit 13.1    Certification of the Registrant’s Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Exhibit 13.2    Certification of the Registrant’s Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Exhibit 15.1    Consent of Ernst & Young Accountants

 

144


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf

 

   

ING Groep N.V.

(Registrant)

Date: March 12, 2012     By:  

/s/ P. Flynn

     

P. Flynn

      Chief Financial Officer

 

145


Table of Contents

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

SELECTED STATISTICAL INFORMATION ON BANKING OPERATIONS

The information in this section sets forth selected statistical information regarding the Group’s banking operations. Information for 2011, 2010 and 2009 is set forth under IFRS-IASB. Unless otherwise indicated, average balances, when used, are calculated from monthly data and the distinction between domestic and foreign is based on the location of the office where the assets and liabilities are booked, as opposed to the domicile of the customer. However, the Company believes that the presentation of these amounts based upon the domicile of the customer would not result in material differences in the amounts presented in this section.

 

     2011     2010     2009  
     Year ended December 31,  

Return on equity of the banking operations*

     11.5     13.4     (3.3 )% 

Return on equity of ING Group*

     11.8     6.9     (6.5 )% 

Return on assets ING Group

     0.4     0.2     (0.1 )% 

Equity to assets of ING group

     3.6     3.5     3.2

Net interest margin of the banking operations**

     1.4     1.4     1.3

 

*

net profit divided by average equity

**

net interest result divided by average total assets

AVERAGE BALANCES AND INTEREST RATES

The following tables show the banking operations, average interest-earning assets and average interest-bearing liabilities, together with average rates, for the periods indicated. The interest income, interest expense and average yield figures do not reflect interest income and expense on derivatives and other interest income and expense not considered to be directly related to interest-bearing assets and liabilities. These items are reflected in the corresponding interest income, interest expense and net interest result figures in the consolidated financial statements. A reconciliation of the interest income, interest expense and net interest result figures to the corresponding line items in the consolidated financial statements is provided hereunder. Amounts in this section for asets and liabilities include assets and liabilities of ING Direct USA; in the IFRS balance sheet these are presented as Assets and Liabilities held for sale.

 

146


Table of Contents

ASSETS

 

     Interest-earning assets                      
     2011      2010      2009  
     Average
balance
     Interest
income
    Average
yield %
     Average
balance
     Interest
income
    Average
yield %
     Average
balance
     Interest
income
    Average
yield %
 
     (EUR millions)            (EUR millions)            (EUR millions)        

Time deposits with banks

                       

domestic

     11,749         230        2.0         13,814         110        0.8         12,306         200        1.6   

foreign

     27,186         603        2.2         27,318         833        3.1         23,429         420        1.8   

Loans and advances

                       

domestic

     246,518         10,160        4.1         237,122         9,608        4.1         264,472         10,120        3.8   

foreign

     196,057         15,410        3.9         385,423         14,375        3.7         362,637         14,364        4.0   

Interest-earning securities(1)

                       

domestic

     28,450         920        3.2         30,926         1,014        3.3         29,790         1,082        3.6   

foreign

     106,296         4,052        3.8         107,564         4,287        4.0         106,673         4,807        4.5   

Other interest-earning assets

                       

domestic

     22,649         363        1.6         12,191         182        1.5         11,014         168        1.5   

foreign

     21,463         229        1.1         20,535         183        0.9         22,572         222        1.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

      

 

 

    

 

 

      

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total

     860,368         31,967        3.7         834,893         30,592        3.6         832,893         31,383        3.8   

Non-interest earning assets

     44,403              54,008              60,073        

Derivatives assets

     53,350              62,585              66,750        
  

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

      

Total assets(1)

     958,121              951,486              959,716        
  

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

      

Percentage of assets applicable to foreign operations

        65.9           64.9           61.8  

Interest income on derivatives

        33,132              38,356              48,828     

other

        1,082              740              935     
     

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

   

Total interest income

        66,181              69,688              81,146     
     

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

(1)

Substantially all interest-earning securities held by the banking operations of the Company are taxable securities.

 

147


Table of Contents

LIABILITIES

 

     Interest-bearing liabilities  
     2011      2010      2009  
     Average
balance
     Interest
expense
    Average
yield %
     Average
balance
     Interest
expense
    Average
yield %
     Average
balance
     Interest
expense
    Average
yield %
 
     (EUR millions)            (EUR millions)            (EUR millions)        

Time deposits from banks

                       

domestic

     33,135         415        1.3         26,922         249        0.9         32,892         596        1.8   

foreign

     16,306         399        2.5         23,363         370        1.7         27,716         634        2.3   

Demand deposits(5)

                       

domestic

     42,599         211        0.5         40,100         125        0.3         64,220         117        0.2   

foreign

     54,417         372        0.7         55,505         383        0.7         50,236         599        1.2   

Time deposits(5)

                       

domestic

     25,658         306        1.2         24,897         221        0.9         32,101         619        1.9   

foreign

     21,899         440        2.0         20,064         364        1.8         26,848         694        2.6   

Savings deposits(5)

                       

domestic

     74,044         1,594        2.2         72,830         1,459        2.0         64,817         1,835        2.8   

foreign

     283,367         5,761        2.0         269,115         5,107        1.9         243,080         6,047        2.5   

Short term debt

                       

domestic

     29,200         285        1.0         16,233         135        0.8         14,791         208        1.4   

foreign

     33,600         629        1.9         50,221         699        1.4         48,246         732        1.5   

Long term debt

                       

domestic

     59,603         2,236        3.8         42,364         1,681        4.0         33,657         1,465        4.4   

foreign

     27,093         1,174        4.3         27,424         1,180        4.3         23,682         999        4.2   

Subordinated liabilities

                       

domestic

     19,628         870        4.4         22,287         1,031        4.6         21,558         999        4.6   

foreign

     971         50        5.2         1,114         61        5.5         1,113         59        5.3   

Other interest-bearing liabilities

                       

domestic

     46,047         454        1.0         47,047         279        0.6         51,811         642        1.2   

foreign

     51,753         653        1.3         57,419         514        0.9         64,863         793        1.2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

      

 

 

    

 

 

      

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total

     819,320         15,849        1.9         795,905         13,858        1.7         801,631         17,038        2.1   

Non-interest bearing liabilities

     49,118              55,417              57,913        

Derivatives liabilities

     58,447              69,751              73,694        

Total Liabilities

     926,885              921,073              933,238        

Group Capital

     31,236              30,413              26,478        
  

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

      

Total liabilities and capital

     958,121              951,486              959,716        
  

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

      

Percentage of liabilities applicable to foreign operations

        61.5           63.3           60.6  

Other interest expense:

                       

interest expenses on derivatives

        35,359              41,333              50,334     

other

        1,516              1,081              1,235     
     

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

   

Total interest expense

        52,724              56,272              68,607     
     

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

   

Total net interest result

        13,457              13,416              12,539     
     

 

 

         

 

 

         

 

 

   

 

(5)

These captions do not include deposits from banks.

 

148


Table of Contents

ANALYSIS OF CHANGES IN NET INTEREST INCOME

The following table allocates changes in the Group’s interest income and expense and net interest result between changes in average balances and rates for the periods indicated. Changes due to a combination of volume and rate have been allocated to changes in average volume. The net changes in interest income, interest expense and net interest result, as calculated in this table, have been reconciled to the changes in interest income, interest expense and net interest result in the consolidated financial statements. See introduction to “Average Balances and Interest Rates” for a discussion of the differences between interest income, interest expense and net interest result as calculated in the following table and as set forth in the consolidated financial statements.

 

    

2011 over 2010

Increase (decrease)

due to changes in

   

2010 over 2009

Increase (decrease)

due to changes in

 
     Average
volume
    Average
rate
    Net
change
    Average
volume
    Average
rate
    Net
change
 
     (EUR millions)     (EUR millions)  

Interest-earning assets

            

Time deposits to banks

            

domestic

     (16     136        120        24        (114     (90

foreign

     (4     (226     (230     70        343        413   

Loans and advances

            

domestic

     179        373        552        (975     463        (512

foreign

     397        638        1,035        902        (891     11   

Interest-earning securities

            

Domestic

     (81     (13     (94     41        (109     (68

foreign

     (51     (184     (235     40        (560     (520

Other interest-earning assets

            

domestic

     156        25        181        18        (4     14   

foreign

     8        38        46        (20     (19     (39

Interest income

            

domestic

     238        521        759        (892     236        (656

foreign

     350        266        616        991        (1,127        (135
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     588        767        1,375        100        (891     (791
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other interest income

         (4,882         (10,666
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total interest income

         (3,507         (11,457
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

The following table shows the interest spread and net interest margin for the past two years.

 

     2011      2010  
     Average rate %      Average rate %  

Interest spread

     

Domestic

     1.8         1.9   

Foreign

     1.7         1.9   

Total

     1.8         1.9   

Net interest margin

     

Domestic

     1.7         1.9   

Foreign

     2.0         2.0   

Total

     1.9         2.0   

 

149


Table of Contents
    

2011 over 2010

Increase (decrease)

due to changes in

   

2010 over 2009

Increase (decrease)

due to changes in

 
     Average
volume
    Average
rate
    Net
change
    Average
volume
    Average
rate
    Net
change
 
     (EUR millions)     (EUR millions)  

Interest-bearing liabilities

            

Time deposits from banks

            

domestic

     58        108        166        (108     (239     (347

foreign

     (100     129        29        (122     (142     (264

Demand deposits

            

domestic

     8        78        86        (44     52        8   

foreign

     (8     (3     (11     63        (279     (216

Time deposits

            

domestic

     7        78        85        (139     (259     (398

foreign

     33        43        76        (175     (155     (330

Savings deposits

            

domestic

     24        111        135        227        (603     (376

foreign

     (270     384        654        647        (1,587     (940

Short term debt

            

domestic

     108        42        150        20        (93     (73

foreign

     (231     161        (70     30        (63     (33

Long term debt

            

domestic

     684        (129     555        379        (163     216   

foreign

     (14     8        (6     158        23        181   

Subordinated liabilities

            

domestic

     (123     (38     (161     34        (2     32   

foreign

     (8     (3     (11     0        2        2   

Other interest-bearing liabilities

            

domestic

     (6     181        175        (59     (304     (363

foreign

     (51     190        139        (91     (188     (279
            

Interest expense domestic

     760        431        1,191        310        (1,611     (1,301

foreign

     (109     909        800        510        (2,389     (1,879
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     651        1,340        1,991        820        (4,000     (3,180
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other interest expense

         (5,539         (9,156
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total interest expense

         (3,548         (12,336
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net interest

            

domestic

     (522     90        (432     (1,202     1,847        645   

Foreign

     459        (643     (184     482        1,262        1,744   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest

     (63     (553     (616     (720     3,109        2,389   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other net interest result

         657            (1,510
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net interest result

         41            879   
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

150


Table of Contents

INVESTMENTS OF THE GROUP’S BANKING OPERATIONS

The following table shows the balance sheet value under IFRS-IASB of the investments of the Group’s banking operations.

 

     Year ended December 31  
     2011      2010      2009  
     (EUR millions)  

Debt securities available for sale

        

Dutch government

     6,552         6,135         3,796   

German government

     10,423         6,929         5,230   

Central banks

     2,088         1,578         332   

Belgian government

     10,438         7,543         7,814   

Other governments

     19,593         27,861         28,402   

Corporate debt securities

        

Banks and financial institutions

     19,641         27,411         27,200   

Other corporate debt securities

     1,075         891         859   

U.S. Treasury and other U.S. Government agencies

     249         1,505         575   

Other debt securities

     2,410         16,606         14,292   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt securities available for sale

     72,469         96,459         88,500   

Debt securities held to maturity

        

Dutch government

        

German government

     531         583         585   

Other governments

     350         367         701   

Banks and financial institutions

     7,630         9,637         11,963   

Other corporate debt securities

        

U.S. Treasury and other U.S. Government agencies

        

Other debt securities

     357         1,106         1,160   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt securities held to maturity

     8,868         11,693         14,409   

Shares and convertible debentures

     2,466         2,741         3,682   

Land and buildings (1)

     1,678         1,891         3,647   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     85,481         112,784         110,238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Including commuted ground rents

Banking investment strategy

ING’s investment strategy for its investment portfolio related to the banking activities is formulated by the Asset and Liability Committee (“ALCO”). The exposures of the investments to market rate movements are managed by modifying the asset and liability mix, either directly or through the use of derivative financial products including interest rate swaps, futures, forwards and purchased option positions such as interest rate caps, floors and collars. See “Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure of Market Risk”.

The investment portfolio related to the banking activities primarily consists of fixed-interest securities. Approximately 74% of the land and buildings owned by ING Bank are wholly or partially in use by Group companies.

 

151


Table of Contents

Portfolio maturity description

 

     1 year or less      Between 1 and 5 years      Between 5 and 10 years  
     Book value      Yield(1)      Book value      Yield(1)      Book
value
     Yield(1)  
     (EUR
millions)
     %      (EUR
millions)
     %      (EUR
millions)
     %  

Debt securities available for sale

                 

Dutch government

     1,650            2,127            2,775      

German government

     207            4,893            4,781      

Belgian government

     1,986            4,703            3,509      

Central banks

     2,088                  

Other governments

     3,194            9,010            5,952      

Banks and financial institutions

     4,293            10,616            4,638      

Corporate debt securities

     549            212            32      

U.S. Treasury and other U.S. Government agencies

                 249      

Other debt securities

     385            560            246      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total debt securities available for sale

     14,352         3.9         32,121         3.5         22,182         3.7   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

     Over 10 years      Total  
     Book
value
     Yield(1)
     Book
value
 
     (EUR
millions)
     %      (EUR
millions)
 

Debt securities available for sale

        

Dutch government

           6,552   

German government

     542            10,423   

Belgian government

     240            10,438   

Central banks

           2,088   

Other governments

     1,437            19,593   

Banks and financial institutions

     94            19,641   

Corporate debt securities

     282            1,075   

U.S. Treasury and other U.S.

Government agencies

           249   

Other debt securities

     1,219            2,410   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total debt securities available for sale

     3,814         4.7         72,469   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

(1)

Since substantially all investment securities held by the banking operations of the Company are taxable securities, the yields are on a tax-equivalent basis. The average yield on available for sale investments is based on amortised cost.

 

152


Table of Contents
     1 year or less      Between 1 and 5 years      Between 5 and 10 years  
     Book value      Yield(1)      Book value      Yield(1)      Book value      Yield(1)  
     (EUR
millions)
     %      (EUR
millions)
     %      (EUR
millions)
     %  

Debt securities held to maturity

                 

Dutch government

                 

German government

     431            100            

Belgian government

                 

Central banks

                 

Other governments

     120            230            

Banks and financial institutions

     1,762            5,768            100      

Corporate debt securities

                 

U.S. Treasury and other U.S. Government agencies

                 

Other debt securities

           216            141      
        

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total debt securities held to maturity

     2,313         1.1         6,314         3.8         241         2.9   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

     Over 10 years    Total  
     Book
value
   Yield(1)
   Book
value
 
     (EUR
millions)
   %    (EUR
millions)
 

Debt securities held to maturity

        

Dutch government

        

German government

           531   

Belgian government

        

Central banks

        

Other governments

           350   

Banks and financial institutions

           7,630   

Corporate debt securities

        

U.S. Treasury and other U.S. Government agencies

        

Other debt securities

           357   
        

 

 

 

Total debt securities held to maturity

           8,868   
        

 

 

 

 

(1)

Since substantially all investment securities held by the banking operations of the Company are taxable securities, the yields are on a tax-equivalent basis.

On December 31, 2011, ING Group also held the following securities for the banking operations that exceeded 10 % of shareholders’ equity:

 

     2011  
     Book value      Market value  
     (EUR millions)  

Belgian government

     10,438         10,438   

German government

     10,954         10,954   

LOAN PORTFOLIO

Loans and advances to banks and customers

Loans and advances to banks include all receivables from credit institutions, except for cash, current accounts and deposits with other banks (including central banks). Lending facilities to corporate and private customers encompass among others, loans, overdrafts and finance lease receivables.

 

153


Table of Contents

Loans and Loan loss provisions

See Note 5 of Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Loans and Loan loss provisions    2011      2010  
     (EUR millions)  

Loans past due 90 days

     8,823         10,464   

Other impaired loans

     2,498         4,188   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total impaired loans (loans with a loan loss provision)

     11,321         14,652   

Potential problem loans

     8,641         7,647   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Impaired loans and potential problem loans

     19,962         22,299   

Loans neither impaired nor potential problem loans

     602,307         616,703   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     622,269         639,002   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

This amount is presented in the balance sheet as:

     

Amounts due from Banks

     43,308         49,056   

Loans and advances to customers

     578,964         589,946   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     622,272         639,002   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loan loss provisions included in:

     

Amounts due from Banks

     7         21   

Loans and advances to customers

     4,943         5,174   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loan loss provisions

     4,950         5,195   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Loans and advances by customer type:    2011      2010  

Loans secured by public authorities

     55,148         55,953   

Loans secured by mortgages

     323,139         330,473   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     8,639         8,664   

Personal lending

     24,401         21,743   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     13,328         18,605   

Corporate loans

     154,309         154,508   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     578,964         589,946   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Loan loss provisions by customer type:    2011      2010  

Loans secured by public authorities

     3         3   

Loans secured by mortgages

     1,215         1,599   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     9         23   

Personal lending

     716         667   

Mortgage backed securities (MBS)

     0         0   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     2         0   

Corporate loans

     3,005         2,903   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,950         5,195   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Decrease in Loan loss provision by customer type:    2011     2010  

Loans secured by public authorities

     0        0   

Loans secured by mortgages

     (384     243   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     (14     (24

Personal lending

     49        (23

Mortgage backed securities (MBS)

     0        (15

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     2        0   

Corporate loans

     102        615   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (245     796   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The net decrease in Loan loss provision includes:

    

Increase in loan loss provision (P&L)

     1,670        1,751   

Write-offs and other

     (1,915     (955
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (245     796   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

154


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the gross loans and advances to banks and customers as of December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 under IFRS-IASB.

 

     Year ended December 31  
     2011      2010      2009      2008      2007  
IFRS-IASB    (EUR millions)  

By domestic offices:

              

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     29,281         28,671         28,149         16,288         14,679   

Loans secured by mortgages

     162,735         157,671         156,319         155,846         141,314   

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     14,130         14,704         9,569         15,528         16,347   

Other private lending

     5,012         5,125         4,972         7,158         6,975   

Mortgage backed securities (MBS)

     0         0         0         0         0   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     0         0         0         0         0   

Other corporate lending

     50,603         53,784         52,888         126,773         105,808   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total domestic offices

     261,761         259,955         251,897         321,593         285,123   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

By foreign offices:

              

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     25,867         27,282         22,933         10,099         8,961   

Loans secured by mortgages

     160,404         172,802         147,484         145,090         132,614   

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     37,817         43,016         36,869         23,099         31,211   

Other private lending

     19,389         16,618         14,988         20,389         17,784   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     13,328         18,605         21,831         11,766         13,082   

Other corporate lending

     103,706         100,724         99,104         109,903         88,237   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total foreign offices

     360,511         379,047         343,209         320,346         291,889   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total gross loans and advances to banks and customers

     622,272         639,002         595,106         641,939         577,012   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maturities and sensitivity of loans to changes in interest rates

The following table analyzes loans and advances to banks and customers by time remaining until maturity as of December 31, 2011.

 

     1 year
or less
     1 year
to 5 years
     After
5 years
     Total  
     (EUR millions)  

By domestic offices:

           

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     668         10,472         18,141         29,281   

Loans secured by mortgages

     9,856         16,970         135,909         162,735   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     11,936         2,180         14         14,130   

Other private lending

     3,129         570         1,313         5,012   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

           

Other corporate lending

     27,526         15,548         7,529         50,603   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total domestic offices

     53,115         45,740         162,906         261,761   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

By foreign offices:

           

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     13,976         4,935         6,956         25,867   

Loans secured by mortgages

     15,823         37,826         106,755         160,404   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     22,662         11,666         3,489         37,817   

Other private lending

     10,329         5,584         3,476         19,389   

Asset backed securities excluding MBS

     2,435         7,803         3,090         13,328   

Other corporate lending

     40,624         41,138         21,944         103,706   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total foreign offices

     105,849         108,952         145,710         360,511   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total gross loans and advances to banks and customers

     158,964         154,692         308,616         622,272   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

155


Table of Contents

The following table analyzes loans and advances to banks and customers by interest rate sensitivity by maturity as of December 31, 2011.

 

     1 year or
less
     Over 1
year
     Total  
     (EUR millions)  

Non-interest earning

     2,782         1,783         4,565   

Fixed interest rate

     70,412         143,065         213,477   

Semi-fixed interest rate(1)

     6,279         169,457         175,736   

Variable interest rate

     79,491         149,003         228,494   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     158,964         463,308         622,272   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Loans that have an interest rate that remains fixed for more than one year and which can then be changed are classified as “semi-fixed”

Loan concentration

The following industry concentrations were in excess of 10% of total loans as of December 31, 2011:

 

     Total outstanding  

Private Individuals

     41.3

Risk elements

Loans Past Due 90 days and Still Accruing Interest

Loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest are loans that are contractually past due 90 days or more as to principal or interest on which we continue to recognize interest income on an accrual basis in accordance with IFRS-IASB. Once a loan has been written down as a result of an impairment loss, interest income is recognized using the rate of interest used to discount the future cash flows for the purpose of measuring the impairment loss. As all loans continue to accrue interest under IFRS-IASB, the non-accrual loan status is no longer used to identify ING Group’s risk elements. No loans are reported as non-accrual and there is an increase in the amount of loans reported as Loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest, compared to the prior years reported, due to the interest accrual on impaired loans. The following table sets forth the outstanding balance of the loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest and non-accrual loans for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 under IFRS-IASB.

 

     Year ended December 31  
     2011      2010      2009      2008      2007  
IFRS-IASB    (EUR millions)  

Loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest

              

Domestic

     5,292         5,758         3,865         2,799         1,159   

Foreign

     3,531         4,705         4,793         2,634         1,892   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest

     8,823         10,463         8,658         5,433         3,051   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, EUR 8,810 million of the loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest have a loan loss provision. Total loans with a loan loss provision, including those loans classified as past due 90 days and still accruing interest with a provision and troubled debt restructurings with a provision, amounts to EUR 11,308 million as of December 31, 2011.

 

156


Table of Contents

Troubled Debt Restructurings

Troubled debt restructurings are loans that we have restructured due to deterioration in the borrower’s financial position and in relation to which, for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower’s deteriorated financial position, we have granted a concession to the borrower that we would not have otherwise granted.

The following table sets forth the outstanding balances of the troubled debt restructurings as of December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 under IFRS-IASB.

 

00.00 00.00 00.00 00.00 00.00
     Year ended December 31  
     2011      2010      2009      2008      2007  
IFRS-IASB    (EUR millions)  

Troubled debt restructurings:

              

Domestic

     966         1,253         782         51         45   

Foreign

     743         2,165         1,271         354         47   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total troubled debt restructurings

     1,709         3,418         2,053         405         92   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest Income on Troubled Debt Restructurings

The following table sets forth the gross interest income that would have been recorded during the year ended December 31, 2011 on troubled debt restructurings had such loans been current in accordance with their original contractual terms and interest income on such loans that was actually included in interest income during the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

     Year ended December 31, 2011  
     (EUR millions)  
    

Domestic

Offices

    

Foreign

Offices

     Total  

Interest income that would have been recognized under the original contractual terms

     18         21         39   

Interest income recognized in the profit and loss account

     17         4         21   

Potential Problem Loans

Potential problem loans are loans that are not classified as loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest or troubled debt restructurings and amounted to EUR 8,641 million as of December 31, 2011. Of this total, EUR 5,982 million relates to domestic loans and EUR 2,659 million relates to foreign loans. These loans are considered potential problem loans as there is known information about possible credit problems causing us to have serious doubts as to the ability of the borrower to comply with the present loan repayment terms and which may result in classifying the loans as loans past due 90 days and still accruing interest or as troubled debt restructurings. Appropriate provisions, following ING Group’s credit risk rating system, have been established for these loans.

 

157


Table of Contents

Cross-border outstandings

Cross-border outstandings are defined as loans (including accrued interest), acceptances, interest-earning deposits with other banks, other interest-earning investments and any other monetary assets that are denominated in euro or other non-local currency. To the extent that material local currency outstandings are not hedged or are not funded by local currency borrowings, such amounts are included in cross-border outstandings.

Commitments such as irrevocable letters of credit are not considered as cross border outstanding. Total outstandings are in line with Dutch Central Bank requirements. On December 31, 2011, there were no outstandings exceeding 1% of total assets in any country where current conditions give rise to liquidity problems which are expected to have a material impact on the timely repayment of interest or principal.

The following tables analyze cross-border outstandings as of the end of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 stating the name of the country and the aggregate amount of cross-border outstandings to borrowers in each foreign country where such outstandings exceed 1% of total assets, by the following categories.

 

     Year ended December 31, 2011  
     Government
& official
institutions
    

Banks &
other
financial

Institutions

    

Commercial

& industrial

     Other      Total      Cross-border
Commitments
 
     (EUR millions)  

United Kingdom

     683         11,800         12,950         900         26,333         3,803   

United States

     271         4,416         6,270         4,067         15,024         11,654   

France

     7,327         9,152         2,697         1,223         20,399         4,457   

Germany

     7,642         3,028         3,668         3,164         17,502         7,017   

 

     Year ended December 31, 2010  
     Government
& official
institutions
    

Banks &
other
financial

Institutions

    

Commercial

& industrial

     Other      Total      Cross-border
Commitments
 
     (EUR millions)  

United Kingdom

     188         12,398         19,347         1,042         32,975         4,046   

United States

     49         4,749         7,952         4,363         17,113         10,309   

France

     9,113         13,051         3,565         1,170         26,899         3,282   

Germany

     7,138         5,560         2,850         3,379         18,927         6,846   

 

     Year ended December 31, 2009  
     Government
& official
institutions
    

Banks &
other
financial

Institutions

    

Commercial

& industrial

     Other      Total      Cross-border
Commitments
 
     (EUR millions)  

United Kingdom

     125         12,285         22,023         1,599         36,032         4,292   

United States

     46         2,245         9,132         7,405         18,828         10,153   

France

     7,758         9,541         4,178         1,955         23,432         2,184   

Germany

     5,736         5,533         4,399         3,459         19,127         7,347   

Italy

     11,211         4,812         3,360         934         20,317         1,890   

Spain

     2,289         8,010         5,583         106         15,988         1,404   

Belgium

     1,916         5,959         7,197         2,383         17,455         15,411   

As of December 2011 Belgium has cross-border outstandings between 0.75% and 1% of total assets and Italy and Spain had cross-border outstandings between 0.40% and 0.50%, and 0.50% and 0.75%, respectively. In 2010 Italy, Spain and Belgium have cross-border outstandings between 0.75% and 1% of total assets.

 

158


Table of Contents

Summary of Loan Loss Experience

For further explanation on loan loss provision see “Loan Loss Provisions” in Note 2.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

The application of the IFRS-IASB methodology has reduced the amount of the unallocated provision for loan losses that ING Group provided in prior years to adequately capture various subjective and judgmental aspects of the credit risk assessment which were not considered on an individual basis.

The following table presents the movements in allocation of the provision for loan losses on loans accounted for as loans and advances to banks and customers for 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 under IFRS-IASB.

 

     Calendar period  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
IFRS-IASB    (EUR millions)  

Balance on January 1

     5,195        4,399        2,611        2,001        2,642   

Change in the composition of the Group

     (3       (3     1        98   

Charge-offs:

          

Domestic:

          

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

          

Loans secured by mortgages

     (129     (86     (79     (34     (22

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     (14     (30     (55     (36     (11

Other private lending

     (56     (65     (140     (126     (115

Other corporate lending

     (343     (277     (229     (133     (189

Foreign:

          

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     (6     (8     (12     (16     (25

Loans secured by mortgages

     (50     (56     (5     (6     (11

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     (3     (5     (1       (2

Other private lending

     (452     (404     (259     (114     (104

Other corporate lending

     (251     (235     (437     (263     (473
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total charge-offs

     (1,304     (1,166     (1,217     (728     (952

Recoveries:

          

Domestic:

          

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

          

Loans secured by mortgages

     36        23        2       

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

             2   

Other private lending

     11        29        101        36        3   

Other corporate lending

     28        9        4       

Foreign:

          

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

          

Loans secured by mortgages

     1        1            1   

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

       3         

Other private lending

     29        29        24        27        30   

Other corporate lending

     7        11        17        27        23   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recoveries

     112        105        148        90        59   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

     (1,192     (1,061     (1,069     (638     (893

Additions and other adjustments (included in value Adjustments to receivables of the Banking operations)

     950        1,857        2,860        1,247        154   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance on December 31

     4,950        5,195        4,399        2,611        2,001   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans and advances to banks and customers

     0.19     0.17     0.17     0.10     0.16

 

159


Table of Contents

Additions to the provision for loan losses presented in the table above were influenced by developments in general economic conditions as well as certain individual exposures.

The following table shows the allocation of the provision for loan losses on loans accounted for as loans and advances to banks and customers for 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 under IFRS-IASB.

 

     Year ended December 31  
     2011      2010      2009      2008      2007  
     EUR      %(1)      EUR      %(1)      EUR      %(1)      EUR      %(1)      EUR      %(1)  
IFRS-IASB    (EUR millions)  

Domestic:

                             

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     1         4.68         0         4.47            4.72            2.54            2.56   

Loans secured by mortgages

     503         26.91         416         25.24         290         27.54         167         24.76         96         24.62   

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     4         2.25         17         2.29            1.61         68         2.42         11         2.85   

Other private lending

     119         0.80         131         0.80         254         0.83         120         1.12         181         1.21   

Other corporate lending

     1,375         7.75         1,385         8.13         917         7.70         474         19.24         377         17.91   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total domestic

     2,002         42.39         1,949         40.93         1,461         42.4         829         50.08         665         49.15   

Foreign:

                             

Loans guaranteed by public authorities

     2         4.13         3         4.25         3         3.85         2         1.57         1         1.56   

Loans secured by mortgages

     712         25.63         1,183         26.93         1,066         23.90         425         22.61         203         23.10   

Loans to or guaranteed by credit institutions

     5         6.05         6         6.7         47         6.78         17         4.02         3         5.56   

Other private lending

     596         3.10         536         2.59         436         2.52         533         3.18         374         3.10   

Mortgage backed securities

     2         2.13         0         2.37         15         2.99               

Other corporate lending

     1,631         16.57         1,518         16.23         1,371         17.56         805         18.54         755         17.53   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total foreign

     2,948         57.61         3,246         59.07         2,938         57.60         1,782         49.92         1,336         50.85   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,950         100.00         5,195         100.00         4,399         100.00         2,611         100.00         2,001         100.00   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

The percentages represent the loans in each category as a percentage of the total loan portfolio for loans and advances to banks and customers.

 

160


Table of Contents

DEPOSITS

The aggregate average balance of all the Group’s interest-bearing deposits (from banks and customer accounts) decreased by 2.7% to EUR 569,312 million for 2011, compared to 2010 (EUR 585,340). Interest rates paid reflect market conditions. The effect on net interest income depends upon competitive pricing and the level of interest income that can be generated through the use of funds. Deposits by banks are primarily time deposits, the majority of which are raised by the Group’s Amsterdam based money market operations in the world’s major financial markets. Certificates of deposit represent 31% of the category ‘Debt securities’ (40% at the end of 2010). These instruments are issued as part of liquidity management with maturities generally of less than three months. The following table includes the average deposit balance by category of deposit and the related average rate.

 

     2011      2010      2009  
     Average
deposit
(EUR millions)
     Average
rate %
     Average
deposit
(EUR millions)
     Average
rate %
     Average
deposit
(EUR millions)
     Average
rate %
 

Deposits by banks

                 

In domestic offices:

                 

Demand —non-interest bearing

     2,502            5,646            6,006      

              —interest bearing

     5,930         1.0         4,646         1.0         5,556         1.0   

Time

     33,158         1.2         26,926         0.9         32,941         1.8   

Other

     10,546         1.9         9,681         1.5         10,869         1.7   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total domestic offices

     52,136            46,899            55,372      

In foreign offices:

                 

Demand —non-interest bearing

     1,561            1,468            1,599      

              —interest bearing

     5,851         1.6         5,932         1.0         5,553         1.4   

Time

     15,662         2.4         21,648         1.7         26,532         2.3   

Other

     9,981         1.6         14,832         3.8         26,455         4.3   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total foreign offices

     33,055            43,880            60,139      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total deposits by banks

     85,191            90,779            115,511      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Customer accounts

                 

In domestic offices:

                 

Demand —non-interest bearing

     782            723            12,005      

              —interest bearing

     47,157         0.5         43,536         0.3         57,162         0.3   

Savings

     73,964         2.2         72,717         2.0         64,731         2.8   

Time

     25,628         1.2         24,738         0.9         31,867         1.9   

Other

     6,545         0.9         8,614         0.5         6,965         1.3   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total domestic offices

     154,076            150,328            172,730      

In foreign offices:

                 

Demand —non-interest bearing

     6,422            6,295            6,160      

              —interest bearing

     50,197         0.9         56,865         0.8         50,956         1.2   

Savings

     257,262         2.2         269,115         1.9         243,080         2.5   

Time

     21,716         2.0         19,794         1.8         26,529         2.6   

Other

     5,715         3.6         6,296         3.9         2,618         5.9   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total foreign offices

     341,312            358,365            329,343      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total customers accounts

     495,388            508,693            502,073      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Debt securities

                 

In domestic offices:

                 

Debentures

     53,963         3.1         36,522         3.1         27,705         3.4   

Certificates of deposit

     23,915         0.9         11,546         0.8         10,406         1.2   

Other

     5,320         1.4         4,719         0.9         4,449         1.8   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total domestic offices

     83,198            52,787            42,560      

In foreign offices:

                 

Debentures

     10,676         5.4         10,886         4.9         8,343         3.5   

Certificates of deposit

     17,195         2.5         35,748         1.3         33,322         1.8   

Other

     21,248         1.2         19,111         1.3         19,263         1.6   
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total foreign offices

     49,119            65,745            60,928      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

Total debt securities

     132,317            118,532            103,488      
  

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

161


Table of Contents

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the aggregate amount of deposits by foreign depositors in domestic offices was EUR 46,778 million, EUR 47,019 million and EUR 47,229 million, respectively.

On December 31, 2011, the maturity of domestic time certificates of deposit and other time deposits, exceeding EUR 20,000, was:

 

     Time certificates of
deposit
     Other time deposits  
     (EUR millions)      %      (EUR millions)      %  

3 months or less

     17,610         86.8         49,446         84.9   

6 months or less but over 3 months

     2,170         10.7         3,904         6.7   

12 months or less but over 6 months

     484         2.4         3,392         5.8   

Over 12 months

     30         0.1         1,476         2.6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     20,294         100         58,218         100   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table shows the amount outstanding for time certificates of deposit and other time deposits exceeding EUR 20,000 issued by foreign offices on December 31, 2011.

 

     (EUR millions)  

Time certificates of deposit

     10,405   

Other time deposits

     56,990   
  

 

 

 

Total

     67,395   
  

 

 

 

Short-term Borrowings

Short-term borrowings are borrowings with an original maturity of one year or less. Commercial paper and securities sold under repurchase agreements are the only significant categories of short-term borrowings within our banking operations.

The following table sets forth certain information relating to the categories of our short-term borrowings.

 

IFRS-IASB    Year ended December 31  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (EUR millions, except % data)  

Commercial paper:

      

Balance at the end of the year

     21,967        20,517        18,225   

Monthly average balance outstanding during the year

     21,908        19,176        19,264   

Maximum balance outstanding at any period end during the year

     22,921        21,370        22,531   

Weighted average interest rate during the year

     1.25     1.70     1.07

Weighted average interest rate on balance at the end of the year

     1.24     1.38     1.13

Securities sold under repurchase agreements:

      

Balance at the end of the year

     54,886        61,468        67,193   

Monthly average balance outstanding during the year

     59,865        79,927        92,523   

Maximum balance outstanding at any period end during the year

     79,547        96,496        138,528   

Weighted average interest rate during the year

     1.30     0.73     1.30

Weighted average interest rate on balance at the end of the year

     1.38     0.94     1.80

 

162


Table of Contents

INDEX TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM      F – 2   
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET      F – 3   
CONSOLIDATED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT      F – 4   
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME      F – 6   
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS      F – 7   
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY      F – 9   
ACCOUNTING POLICIES FOR THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL ACCOUNTS      F – 11   
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL ACCOUNTS      F – 34   
RISK MANAGEMENT      F – 147   
CAPITAL MANAGEMENT      F – 221   
SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION      F – 230   
GLOSSARY      F – 244   

SCHEDULE I:            SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN RELATED PARTIES

     F – 253   

SCHEDULE III:          SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION

     F – 254   

SCHEDULE IV:         REINSURANCE

     F – 255   

SCHEDULE VI:          SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION CONCERNING NON-LIFE INSURANCE OPERATIONS

     F – 256   

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To: the Shareholders, the Supervisory Board and the Executive Board of ING Groep N.V.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of ING Groep N.V. (‘ING Group’), as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated profit and loss accounts, consolidated statements of comprehensive income, consolidated statements of cash flows and consolidated statements of changes in equity for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011. Our audits also included the financial statement schedules listed in the Index at Item 18. These financial statements and schedules are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedules based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of ING Groep N.V. as at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the consolidated results of its operations, and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedules, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), ING Groep N.V.’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated March 12, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Amsterdam, the Netherlands

March 12, 2012

Ernst & Young Accountants LLP

 

F-2


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET OF ING GROUP

AS AT DECEMBER 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    2011      2010  

ASSETS

     

Cash and balances with central banks 1

     31,194         13,072   

Amounts due from banks 2

     45,323         51,828   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss 3

     

– trading assets

     123,688         125,675   

– investments for risk of policyholders

     116,438         120,481   

– non-trading derivatives

     17,159         11,722   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     5,437         6,016   

Investments 4

     

– available-for-sale

     208,539         222,547   

– held-to-maturity

     8,868         11,693   

Loans and advances to customers 5

     596,877         608,938   

Reinsurance contracts 17

     5,870         5,789   

Investments in associates 6

     2,370         3,925   

Real estate investments 7

     1,670         1,900   

Property and equipment 8

     2,886         6,132   

Intangible assets 9

     3,558         5,372   

Deferred acquisition costs 10

     10,204         10,499   

Assets held for sale 11

     62,483         681   

Other assets 12

     31,016         36,469   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,273,580         1,242,739   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

EQUITY

     

Shareholders’ equity (parent) 13

     42,452         37,719   

Non-voting equity securities 13

     3,000         5,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     45,452         42,719   

Minority interests

     777         729   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity

     46,229         43,448   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

     

Subordinated loans 14

     8,858         10,645   

Debt securities in issue 15

     139,861         135,604   

Other borrowed funds 16

     19,684         22,291   

Insurance and investment contracts 17

     278,833         271,128   

Amounts due to banks 18

     72,233         72,852   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit 19

     467,547         511,362   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss 20

     

– trading liabilities

     107,682         108,050   

– non-trading derivatives

     22,165         17,782   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     13,021         12,707   

Liabilities held for sale 11

     64,265         424   

Other liabilities 21

     33,202         36,446   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     1,227,351         1,199,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity and liabilities

     1,273,580         1,242,739   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amounts for 2010 are restated for the change in accounting policy as disclosed in the section ‘Changes in accounting policies’ on page F-13.

References relate to the notes starting on page F-34. These form an integral part of the consolidated annual accounts.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT OF ING GROUP

AS AT DECEMBER 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    2011     2011      2010     2010     2009     2009  

Continuing operations

             

Interest income banking operations

     64,649           68,334          79,850     

Interest expense banking operations

     (51,200        (55,011       (67,475  
  

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

   

Interest result banking operations 35

       13,449           13,323          12,375   

Gross premium income 36

       27,198           27,786          30,248   

Investment income 37

       6,808           7,463          3,158   

Net result on disposals of group companies 38

       855           310          287   

Gross commission income

     6,003           5,868          6,551     

Commission expense

     (1,966        (1,720       (2,311  
  

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

   

Commission income 39

       4,037           4,148          4,240   

Valuation results on non-trading derivatives 40

       292           (1,062       (5,398

Net trading income 41

       209           627          1,125   

Share of result from associates 6

       221           311          (463

Other income 42

       1,343           604          701   
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total income

       54,412           53,510          46,273   

Gross underwriting expenditure 43

     33,716           45,015          50,129     

Investment result for risk of policyholders

     1,246           (10,492       (17,736  

Reinsurance recoveries

     (1,875        (1,721       (1,700  
  

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

   

Underwriting expenditure 43

       33,087           32,802          30,693   

Addition to loan loss provisions 5

       1,670           1,751          2,973   

Intangible amortisation and other impairments 44

       379           1,070          524   

Staff expenses 45

       7,556           7,692          7,271   

Other interest expenses 46

       528           786          711   

Other operating expenses 47

       6,465           6,076          6,593   
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total expenses

       49,685           50,177          48,765   
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Result before tax from continuing operations

       4,727           3,333          (2,492

Taxation 48

       1,009           1,076          (780
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations

       3,718           2,257          (1,712

Discontinued operations

             

Net result from discontinued operations 25

       114           216          100   

Net result from disposal of discontinued operations 25

       995            
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total net result from discontinued operations 25

       1,109           216          100   
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

Net result from continuing and discontinued operations (before minority interests)

       4,827           2,473          (1,612
    

 

 

      

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

F-4


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT OF ING GROUP

AS AT DECEMBER 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    2011    2011      2010    2010      2009    2009  

Net result attributable to:

                 

Equityholders of the parent

        4,740            2,367            (1,494

Minority interests

        87            106            (118
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 
        4,827            2,473            (1,612
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations attributable to:

                 

Equityholders of the parent

        3,636            2,158            (1,587

Minority interests

        82            99            (125
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 
        3,718            2,257            (1,712
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total net result from discontinued operations attributable to:

                 

Equityholders of the parent

        1,104            209            93   

Minority interests

        5            7            7   
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 
        1,109            216            100   
     

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

amounts in euros    2011      2010      2009  

Earnings per share 49

        

Basic earnings per ordinary share

     0.85         0.51         (0.78

Diluted earnings per ordinary share

     0.85         0.51         (0.78

Earnings per share from continuing operations 49

        

Basic earnings per ordinary share from continuing operations

     0.56         0.45         (0.82

Diluted earnings per ordinary share from continuing operations

     0.56         0.45         (0.82

Earnings per share from discontinued operations 49

        

Basic earnings per ordinary share from discontinued operations

     0.29         0.06         0.04   

Diluted earnings per ordinary share from discontinued operations

     0.29         0.06         0.04   

Dividend per ordinary share 50

     0.00         0.00         0.00   

Amounts for 2010 and 2009 are restated for the change in accounting policy as disclosed in the section ‘Changes in accounting policies’ on page F-13.

References relate to the notes starting on page F-34. These form an integral part of the consolidated annual accounts.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME OF ING GROUP

For the years ended December 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    2011     2010     2009  

Net result

     4,827        2,473        (1,612

Unrealised revaluations after taxation (1)

     1,139        2,603        11,867   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss (1)

     723        86        1,554   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

     1,124        475        (805

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

     (2,004     (1,644     (2,079

Exchange rate differences

     (156     2,859        56   

Other revaluations

     (2     (1     (10
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total amount recognised directly in equity (other comprehensive income)

     824        4,378        10,583   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     5,651        6,851        8,971   

Comprehensive income attributable to:

      

Equityholders of the parent

     5,568        6,760        9,102   

Minority interests

     83        91        (131
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     5,651        6,851        8,971   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Reference is made to Note 13 ‘Shareholders’ equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities’ for a breakdown of the individual components.

Amounts for 2010 and 2009 are restated for the change in accounting policy as disclosed in the section ‘Changes in accounting policies’ on page F-13.

The Unrealised revaluations after taxation comprises EUR (16) million (2010: EUR (2) million; 2009: EUR 15 million) related to the share of other comprehensive income of associates.

The Exchange rate differences comprises EUR (35) million (2010: EUR 251 million; 2009: EUR 131 million) related to the share of other comprehensive income of associates.

Reference is made to Note 48 ‘Taxation’ for the disclosure on the income tax effects on each component of the other comprehensive income.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS OF ING GROUP

For the years ended December 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    2011     2010     2009  

Result before tax

     5,876        3,601        (2,290

Adjusted for:         

 

– depreciation

     1,514        1,723        1,701   
 

– deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired

     277        1,159        223   
 

– increase in provisions for insurance and investment contracts

     4,239        4,278        2,585   
 

– addition to loan loss provisions

     1,670        1,751        2,973   
 

– other

     (1,469     3,047        6,014   

Taxation paid

         (1,353     (503     (412

Changes in:           

 

– amounts due from banks, not available on demand

     2,208        (4,333     8,611   
 

– trading assets

     1,754        (14,782     47,963   
 

– non-trading derivatives

     1,988        (1,590     864   
 

– other financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     474        832        2,196   
 

– loans and advances to customers

     (23,713     (16,331     12,208   
 

– other assets

     (59     2,003        6,948   
 

– amounts due to banks, not payable on demand

     (6,731     (9,831     (67,410
 

– customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     27,019        21,202        21,073   
 

– trading liabilities

     (369     9,804        (54,366
 

– other financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

     (207     1        (5,798
 

– other liabilities

     (3,931     (6,806     (10,483
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from operating activities

     9,187        (4,775     (27,400

Investments and advances:

 

– group companies

         (5
   

– associates

     (140     (165     (181
   

– available-for-sale investments

     (223,544     (163,038     (165,771
   

– held-to-maturity investments

       (141  
   

– real estate investments

     (32     (73     (130
   

– property and equipment

     (499     (527     (639
   

– assets subject to operating leases

     (1,188     (1,284     (1,034
   

– investments for risk of policyholders

     (57,130     (52,370     (65,362
   

– other investments

     (340     (372     (338

Disposals and redemptions:

 

– group companies

     4,120        1,757        2,643   
   

– associates

     383        232        294   
   

– available-for-sale investments

     219,442        154,640        167,074   
   

– held-to-maturity investments

     2,370        2,620        1,675   
   

– real estate investments

     118        295        656   
   

– property and equipment

     67        96        82   
   

– assets subject to operating leases

     43        53        93   
   

– investments for risk of policyholders

     61,898        54,817        64,158   
   

– other investments

     936        111        24   
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from investing activities 53

     6,504        (3,349     3,239   

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated loans

      

Repayments of subordinated loans

     (2,356    

Proceeds from borrowed funds and debt securities

     428,381        412,804        437,772   

Repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities

     (429,997     (405,120     (425,182

Issuance of ordinary shares

         7,276   

Repayment of non-voting equity securities

     (2,000       (5,000

Repurchase premium (1)

     (1,000       (346

Payments to acquire treasury shares

       (136     (101

Sales of treasury shares

     41        92        118   

Dividends paid (2)

         (684
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from financing activities

     (6,931     7,640        13,853   
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow 54

     8,760        (484     (10,308

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     20,740        20,959        31,271   

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (200     265        (4
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year 55

     29,300        20,740        20,959   
      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

2011 includes the repurchase premium paid on the repayment of EUR 2 billion non-voting equity securities. 2009 includes the repurchase premium paid on the repayment of EUR 5 billion non-voting equity securities.

(2) 

2009 includes payments on non-voting equity securities (payment of the 2008 coupon of EUR 425 million and the coupon in the repayment of EUR 259 million).

 

F-7


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS OF ING GROUP

For the years ended December 31

As at December 31, 2011 Cash and cash equivalents includes cash and balances with central banks of EUR 31,194 million (2010: EUR 13,072 million; 2009: EUR 15,390 million). Reference is made to Note 55 ‘Cash and Cash equivalents’.

References relate to the notes starting on page F-34. These form an integral part of the consolidated annual accounts.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY OF ING GROUP

For the years ended December 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    Share
capital
    

Share

premium

    Reserves     Total
shareholders’
equity
(parent)
    Non-voting
equity
securities
    Minority
interests
    Total
equity
 

Balance as at January 1, 2009 (before change in accounting policy)

     495         9,182        5,403        15,080        10,000        1,594        26,674   

Effect of change in accounting policy (1)

          (145     (145         (145
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at January 1, 2009 (restated)

     495         9,182        5,258        14,935        10,000        1,594        26,529   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

          11,874        11,874          (7     11,867   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

          1,554        1,554            1,554   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

          (805     (805         (805

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

          (2,079     (2,079         (2,079

Exchange rate differences

          53        53          3        56   

Other revaluations

          (1     (1       (9     (10
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total amount recognised directly in equity

          10,596        10,596          (13     10,583   

Net result

          (1,494     (1,494       (118     (1,612
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

          9,102        9,102          (131     8,971   

Issuance costs incurred

        (222       (222         (222

Employee stock option and share plans

          64        64            64   

Repayment of non-voting equity securities

              (5,000       (5,000

Changes in the composition of the group

                (546     (546

Dividend and repurchase premium (2)

          (605     (605       (2     (607

Proceeds from rights issue

     424         7,074          7,498            7,498   

Purchase/sale of treasury shares

          129        129            129   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2009

     919         16,034        13,948        30,901        5,000        915        36,816   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

          2,607        2,607          (4     2,603   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

          86        86            86   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

          475        475            475   

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

          (1,644     (1,644         (1,644

Exchange rate differences

          2,867        2,867          (8     2,859   

Other revaluations

          2        2          (3     (1
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total amount recognised directly in equity

          4,393        4,393          (15     4,378   

Net result

          2,367        2,367          106        2,473   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

          6,760        6,760          91        6,851   

Employee stock option and share plans

          36        36            36   

Changes in the composition of the group

                (271     (271

Dividend

                (6     (6

Purchase/sale of treasury shares

          22        22            22   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2010

     919         16,034        20,766        37,719          5,000729        43,448   

 

(1) 

The change in accounting policy is disclosed in the section ‘Changes in accounting policies’ on page F-13.

(2) 

The 2009 amount of EUR 605 million includes the coupon (EUR 259 million) and repurchase premium (EUR 346 million) on the repayment of EUR 5 billion non-voting equity securities.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY OF ING GROUP

For the years ended December 31

 

amounts in millions of euros    Share
capital
    

Share

premium

     Reserves    

Total

shareholders’

equity
(parent)

    Non-voting
equity
securities
    Minority
interests
    Total
equity
 

Balance as at January 1, 2011

     919         16,034         20,766        37,719        5,000        729        43,448   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

           1,138        1,138          1        1,139   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

           723        723            723   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

           1,124        1,124            1,124   

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

           (2,004     (2,004         (2,004

Cancellation of shares

                

Exchange rate differences

           (153     (153       (3     (156

Other revaluations

                 (2     (2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total amount recognised directly in equity

           828        828          (4     824   

Net result

           4,740        4,740          87        4,827   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

           5,568        5,568          83        5,651   

Issuance costs incurred

                

Employee stock option and share plans

           115        115            115   

Repayment of non-voting equity securities

               (2,000       (2,000

Repurchase premium

           (1,000     (1,000         (1,000

Changes in the composition of the group

                 (1     (1

Dividend

                 (34     (34

Proceeds from rights issue

                

Purchase/sale of treasury shares

           50        50            50   

Exercise of warrants and options

                
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2011

     919         16,034         25,499        42,452        3,000        777        46,229   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reserves include Revaluation reserve of EUR 5,550 million (2010: EUR 4,752 million; 2009: EUR 2,466 million), Currency translation reserve of EUR 93 million (2010: EUR 79 million; 2009: EUR (2,011) million) and Other reserves of EUR 19,856 million (2010: EUR 15,935 million; 2009: EUR 13,493 million). Changes in individual components are presented in Note 13 ‘Shareholders’ equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities’.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

2.1 NOTEST TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

2.1.1 ACCOUNTING POLICIES FOR THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL ACCOUNTS OF ING GROUP

AUTHORIZATION OF ANNUAL ACCOUNTS

The consolidated annual accounts of ING Groep N.V. (‘ING Group’) for the year ended December 31, 2011 were authorized for issue in accordance with a resolution of the Executive Board on March 12, 2012. The Executive Board may decide to amend the annual accounts as long as these are not adopted by the General Meeting of Shareholders. The General Meeting of Shareholders may decide not to adopt the annual accounts, but may not amend these. ING Groep N.V. is incorporated and domiciled in Amsterdam, the Netherlands. The principal activities of ING Group are described in Item 4 ‘Information on the Company’.

BASIS OF PRESENTATION

ING Group prepares financial information in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (‘IFRS-IASB’) for purposes of reporting with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (‘SEC’), including financial information contained in this Annual Report on Form 20-F. ING Group’s accounting policies and its use of various options under IFRS-IASB are described under ‘Principles of valuation and determination of results’ in the consolidated financial statements. In this document the term ‘IFRS-IASB’ is used to refer to IFRS-IASB as applied by ING Group.

The following new or revised standards, interpretations and amendments to standards and interpretations became effective in 2011:

 

 

Amendment to IAS 32 ‘Classification of Rights Issues’;

 

 

Amendment to IAS 24 ‘Related Party Disclosures’;

 

 

Amendment to IFRIC 14 ‘Prepayments of a Minimum Funding Requirement’;

 

 

IFRIC 19 ‘Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments’; and

 

 

2010 Annual Improvements to IFRS.

The following new or revised standards and interpretations were issued by the IASB, which become effective for ING Group as of 2012 (unless otherwise indicated)

 

 

Amendments to IFRS 7 ‘Disclosures – Transfers of Financial Assets’, effective as of 2012;

 

 

Amendments to IAS 12 ‘Deferred tax: Recovery of Underlying Assets’, effective as of 2012;

 

 

IFRS 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

IFRS 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

IFRS 12 ‘Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

IFRS 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

IAS 28 ‘Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

Amendments to IAS 1 ‘Presentation of Financial Statements – Presentation of Items of Other Income’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

Amendments to IFRS 7 ‘Disclosures – Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’, effective as of 2013;

 

 

Amendments to IAS 32 ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’, effective as of 2014; and

 

 

Amendments to IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 ‘Mandatory Effective Date and Transition Disclosures’, effective as of 2015.

ING Group does not expect the adoption of these new or revised standards and interpretations to have a significant effect on equity and/or result of ING Group.

Furthermore, in 2009 IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ was issued, which was initially effective as of 2013. However in December 2011 the International Accounting Standards Board decided to amend this standard and to postpone the mandatory application of IFRS 9 until 2015. Implementation of IFRS 9 may have a significant impact on equity and/or result of ING Group.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In June 2011 the revized IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’ was issued, which will become effective as of 2013 if endorsed by the EU. At this moment, the revised standard is being analyzed and the full impact is not yet known. One of the changes in the revized standard results in immediate recognition in equity of ‘unrecognized actuarial gains and losses’ as of the effective date. Unrecognized actuarial gains and losses as at December 31, 2011 are disclosed in Note 21 ‘Other liabilities’ and amount to EUR 483 million. The impact of the revized standard will be affected by movements in the unrecognized actuarial gains and losses until the effective date and the impact of other changes in the revized standard.

The presentation of, and certain terms used in, the consolidated balance sheet, the consolidated profit and loss account, consolidated statement of cash flows, consolidated statement of changes in equity and certain notes has been changed to provide additional and more relevant information or (for changes in comparative information) to better align with the current period presentation.

The published 2011 Annual Accounts of ING Group are prepared in accordance with IFRS-IASB. IFRS-EU refers to International Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRS’) as adopted by the European Union (‘EU’), including the decisions ING Group made with regard to the options available under IFRS as adopted by the EU. IFRS-EU differs from IFRS-IASB in respect of certain paragraphs in IAS 39 ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’ regarding hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk.

Under IFRS-EU, ING Group applies fair value hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk (fair value macro hedges) in accordance with the EU ‘carve out’ version of IAS 39. Under the EU ‘IAS 39 carve-out’, hedge accounting may be applied, in respect of fair value macro hedges, to core deposits and hedge ineffectiveness is only recognized when the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets falls below the original designated amount of that bucket and is not recognized when the revised amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets is more than the original designated amount. Under IFRS-IASB, hedge accounting for fair value macro hedges can not be applied to core deposits and ineffectiveness arises whenever the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets is either more or less than the original designated amount of that bucket.

This information is prepared by reversing the hedge accounting impacts that are applied under the EU ‘carve out’ version of IAS 39. Financial information under IFRS-IASB accordingly does not take account of the possibility that had ING Group applied IFRS-IASB as its primary accounting framework it might have applied alternative hedge strategies where those alternative hedge strategies could have qualified for IFRS-IASB compliant hedge accounting. These decisions could have resulted in different shareholders’ equity and net result amounts compared to those indicated in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

Other than for SEC reporting, ING Group intends to continue to prepare its Annual Accounts under IFRS-EU.

A reconciliation between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB is included below.

Both IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB differ in several areas from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (‘US GAAP’).

Reconciliation shareholders’ equity and net result under IFRS-IASB and IFRS-EU:

 

     Shareholders’ equity     Net result  
     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

In accordance with IFRS-IASB

     42,452        37,719        30,901        4,729        2,367        (1,494

Adjustment of the EU ‘IAS 39’ carve-out

     5,648        4,266        3,671        1,383        595        656   

Tax effect of the adjustment

     (1,437     (1,081     (929     (346     (152     (168
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of adjustment after tax

     4,211        3,185        2,742        1,037        443        488   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In accordance with IFRS-EU

     46,663        40,904        33,643        5,766        2,810        (1,006
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-12


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING POLICIES

ING Group changed its accounting policy for the insurance provisions for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for Life (GMWBL) on the Insurance US Closed Block VA book as of January 1, 2011. The revised accounting better reflects the economic value of these guarantees and more closely aligns accounting practice with peers in the United States. Under the revised accounting policy, the insurance provisions reflect current market interest rates and current estimates for other assumptions, except for volatility and correlation (which remain unchanged). ING Group substantially increased hedging of interest rate risk in the Insurance US Closed Block VA book; the results from these hedging derivatives are expected to largely mirror the effect of interest changes on the guarantees in future periods. Implementation of the revised accounting for GMWBL represents a change in accounting policy under IFRS, with a transitional impact being reflected in shareholders’ equity. Comparative years’ results have been restated. Reference is made to Note 56 ‘Impact of change in accounting policy’ for more information on comparative years. The combined impact on shareholders’ equity as at January 1, 2011 is EUR 651 million (lower equity).

The impact on individual balance sheet line items and previous reporting periods can be specified as follows:

 

amounts in millions of euros    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
    January 1,
2009
 

Deferred acquisition costs

     (105     (190     1,146   

Insurance and investment contracts

     546        148        1,369   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impact before tax

     (651     (338     (223

Tax effect

       118        78   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity

     (651     (220     (145
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The impact on the consolidated profit and loss account can be specified as follows:

 

amounts in millions of euros    2010     2009  

Underwriting expenditure

     (281     (109

Taxation

     128        (38
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Result after taxation

     (409     (71
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impact on basic earnings per ordinary share:

 

    

Amount

(in millions of
euros)

   

Weighted average

number of ordinary

shares outstanding

during the period

(in millions)

    

Per ordinary
share

(in euros)

 
     2010     2009     2010      2009      2010      2009  

Basic earnings (before change in accounting policy)

     1,926        (2,099     3,781.5         2,686.0         0.51         (0.78

Impact on the profit and loss account

     (409     (71           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

       

Basic earnings (restated)

     1,517        (2,170     3,781.5         2,686.0         0.40         (0.81
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

       

Impact on diluted earnings per ordinary share

 

    

Amount

(in millions of
euros)

   

Weighted average

number of ordinary

shares outstanding

during the period

(in millions)

    

Per ordinary
share

(in euros)

 
     2010     2009     2010      2009      2010      2009  

Diluted earnings (before change in accounting policy)

     1,926        (2,099     3,788.1         2,691.7         0.51         (0.78

Impact on the profit and loss account

     (409     (71           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

       

Diluted earnings (restated)

     1,517        (2,170     3,788.1         2,691.7         0.40         (0.81
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

F-13


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

ING Group has identified the accounting policies that are most critical to its business operations and to the understanding of its results. These critical accounting policies are those which involve the most complex or subjective decisions or assessments, and relate to insurance provisions, deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired, the loan loss provision, the determination of the fair values of real estate and financial assets and liabilities, impairments and employee benefits. In each case, the determination of these items is fundamental to the financial condition and results of operations, and requires management to make complex judgements based on information and financial data that may change in future periods. As a result, determinations regarding these items necessarily involve the use of assumptions and subjective judgements as to future events and are subject to change, as the use of different assumptions or data could produce materially different results. For a further discussion of the application of these accounting policies, reference is made to the applicable notes to the consolidated financial statements and the information below under ‘Principles of valuation and determination of results’.

INSURANCE PROVISIONS, DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS (DAC) AND VALUE OF BUSINESS ACQUIRED (VOBA)

The establishment of insurance provisions, DAC and VOBA is an inherently uncertain process, involving assumptions about factors such as court decisions, changes in laws, social, economic and demographic trends, inflation, investment returns, policyholder behaviour and other factors, and, in the life insurance business, assumptions concerning mortality and morbidity trends. Specifically, significant assumptions related to these items that could have a material impact on financial results include interest rates, mortality, morbidity, property and casualty claims, investment yields on equity and real estate, foreign currency exchange rates and reserve adequacy assumptions.

The use of different assumptions about these factors could have a material effect on insurance provisions and underwriting expenditure. Changes in assumptions may lead to changes in the insurance provisions over time. Furthermore, some of these assumptions can be volatile.

In addition, the adequacy of insurance provisions, net of DAC and VOBA, is evaluated regularly. The test involves comparing the established insurance provision with current best estimate assumptions about factors such as court decisions, changes in laws, social, economic and demographic trends, inflation, investment returns, policyholder behaviour, mortality and morbidity trends and other factors. The use of different assumptions in this test could lead to a different outcome.

Insurance provisions also include the impact of minimum guarantees which are contained within certain variable annuity products. This impact is dependent upon the difference between the potential minimum benefits payable and the total account balance, expected mortality and surrender rates. The determination of the potential minimum benefits payable also involves the use of assumptions about factors such as inflation, investment returns, policyholder behaviour, and mortality and morbidity trends. The use of different assumptions about these factors could have a material effect on insurance provisions and underwriting expenditure.

The process of defining methodologies and assumptions for insurance provisions, DAC and VOBA is governed by ING Insurance risk management as described in the ‘Risk management’ section.

Reference is made to the ‘Risk management’ section for a sensitivity analysis of net result and shareholders’ equity to insurance, interest rate, equity, foreign currency and real estate risks. These sensitivities are based on changes in assumptions that management considers reasonably likely at the balance sheet date.

LOAN LOSS PROVISIONS

Loan loss provisions are recognised based on an incurred loss model. Considerable judgement is exercised in determining the extent of the loan loss provision (impairment) and is based on the management’s evaluation of the risk in the portfolio, current economic conditions, loss experience in recent years and credit, industry, geographical and concentration trends. Changes in such judgements and analyses may lead to changes in the loan loss provisions over time.

The identification of impairment and the determination of the recoverable amount are an inherently uncertain processes involving various assumptions and factors including the financial condition of the counterparty, expected future cash flows, observable market prices and expected net selling prices.

 

F-14


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Future cash flows in a portfolio of financial assets that are collectively evaluated for impairment are estimated on the basis of the contractual cash flows of the assets in the portfolio and historical loss experience for assets with credit risk characteristics similar to those in the portfolio. Historical loss experience is adjusted on the basis of current observable data to reflect the effects of current conditions that did not affect the period on which the historical loss experience is based and to remove the effects of conditions in the historical period that do not exist currently. Current observable data may include changes in unemployment rates, property prices and commodity prices. The methodology and assumptions used for estimating future cash flows are reviewed regularly to reduce any differences between loss estimates and actual loss experience.

FAIR VALUES OF REAL ESTATE

Real estate investments are reported at fair value. The fair value of real estate investments is based on regular appraisals by independent qualified valuers. The fair values are established using valuation methods such as: comparable market transactions, capitalisation of income methods or discounted cash flow calculations. The underlying assumption used in the valuation is that the properties are let or sold to third parties based on the actual letting status. The discounted cash flow analyses and capitalisation of income method are based on calculations of the future rental income in accordance with the terms in existing leases and estimations of the rental values for new leases when leases expire and incentives like rental free periods. The cash flows are discounted using market based interest rates that reflect appropriately the risk characteristics of real estate.

Market conditions in recent years have led to a reduced level of real estate transactions. Transaction values were significantly impacted by low volumes of actual transactions. As a result comparable market transactions have been used less in valuing ING’s real estate investments by independent qualified valuers. More emphasis has been placed on discounted cash flow analysis and capitalisation of income method.

The valuation of real estate involves various assumptions and techniques. The use of different assumptions and techniques could produce significantly different valuations. To illustrate the uncertainty of our real estate investments valuation, a sensitivity analysis on the changes in fair value of real estate is provided in the ‘Risk management’ section.

FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

Fair values of financial assets and liabilities are determined using quoted market prices where available. Such quoted market prices are primarily obtained from exchange prices for listed instruments. Where an exchange price is not available, market prices may be obtained from independent market vendors, brokers or market makers. In general, positions are valued taking the bid price for a long position and the offer price for a short position. In some cases where positions are marked at mid-market prices, a fair value adjustment is calculated.

In certain markets that have become significantly less liquid or illiquid, the range of prices for the same security from different price sources can be significant. Selecting the most appropriate price within this range requires judgement. The choice of different prices could produce significantly different estimates of fair value.

For certain financial assets and liabilities quoted market prices are not available. For these financial assets and liabilities, fair value is determined using valuation techniques. These valuation techniques range from discounting of cash flows to valuation models, where relevant pricing factors including the market price of underlying reference instruments, market parameters (volatilities, correlations and credit ratings) and customer behaviour are taken into account. All valuation techniques used are subject to internal review and approval. Most data used in these valuation techniques are validated on a daily basis.

Valuation techniques are subjective in nature and significant judgement is involved in establishing fair values for certain financial assets and liabilities. Valuation techniques involve various assumptions regarding pricing factors. The use of different valuation techniques and assumptions could produce significantly different estimates of fair value.

Price testing is performed to assess whether the process of valuation has led to an appropriate fair value of the position and to an appropriate reflection of these valuations in the profit and loss account. Price testing is performed to minimise the potential risks for economic losses due to incorrect or misused models.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Reference is made to Note 34 ‘Fair value of financial assets and liabilities’ for the basis of the determination of the fair value of financial instruments and related sensitivities.

IMPAIRMENTS

Impairment evaluation is a complex process that inherently involves significant judgements and uncertainties that may have a significant impact on ING Group’s consolidated financial statements. Impairments are especially relevant in two areas: Available-for-sale debt and equity securities and Goodwill/Intangible assets.

All debt and equity securities (other than those carried at fair value through profit and loss) are subject to impairment testing every reporting period. The carrying value is reviewed in order to determine whether an impairment loss has been incurred. Evaluation for impairment includes both quantitative and qualitative considerations. For debt securities, such considerations include actual and estimated incurred credit losses indicated by payment default, market data on (estimated) incurred losses and other current evidence that the issuer may be unlikely to pay amounts when due. Equity securities are impaired when management believes that, based on (the combination of) a significant or prolonged decline of the fair value below the acquisition price, there is sufficient reason to believe that the acquisition cost may not be recovered. ‘Significant’ and ‘prolonged’ are interpreted on a case-by-case basis for specific equity securities. Generally 25% and 6 months are used as triggers. Upon impairment, the full difference between (the acquisition) cost and fair value is removed from equity and recognised in net result. Impairments on debt securities may be reversed if there is a decrease in the amount of the impairment which can be objectively related to an observable event. Impairments on equity securities cannot be reversed.

Impairments on other debt instruments (Loans and held-to-maturity investments) are part of the loan loss provision as described above.

Impairment reviews with respect to goodwill and intangible assets are performed at least annually and more frequently if events indicate that impairment may have occurred. Goodwill is tested for impairment by comparing the carrying value (including goodwill) of the reporting unit to the best estimate of the recoverable amount of that reporting unit. The carrying value is determined as the IFRS-IASB net asset value including goodwill. The recoverable amount is estimated as the higher of fair value less cost to sell and value in use. Several methodologies are applied to arrive at the best estimate of the recoverable amount. A reporting unit is the lowest level at which goodwill is monitored. Intangible assets are tested for impairment by comparing the carrying value with the best estimate of the recoverable amount.

The identification of impairment is an inherently uncertain process involving various assumptions and factors, including financial condition of the counterparty, expected future cash flows, statistical loss data, discount rates, observable market prices, etc. Estimates and assumptions are based on management’s judgement and other information available prior to the issuance of the financial statements. Significantly different results can occur as circumstances change and additional information becomes known.

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

Group companies operate various defined benefit retirement plans covering a significant number of ING’s employees.

The liability recognised in the balance sheet in respect of the defined benefit pension plans is the present value of the defined benefit obligation at the balance sheet date less the fair value of the plan assets, together with adjustments for unrecognised actuarial gains and losses, and unrecognised past service costs.

The determination of the defined benefit plan liability is based on internal and external actuarial models and calculations. The defined benefit obligation is calculated using the projected unit credit method. Inherent in these actuarial models are assumptions including discount rates, rates of increase in future salary and benefit levels, mortality rates, trend rates in health care costs, consumer price index, and the expected return on plan assets. The assumptions are based on available market data and the historical performance of plan assets, and are updated annually.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The actuarial assumptions may differ significantly from the actual results due to changes in market conditions, economic and mortality trends, and other assumptions. Any changes in these assumptions could have a significant impact on the defined benefit plan liabilities and future pension costs. The effects of changes in actuarial assumptions and experience adjustments are not recognised in the profit and loss account unless the accumulated changes exceed 10% of the greater of the defined benefit obligation and the fair value of the plan assets. If such is the case the excess is then amortised over the employees’ expected average remaining working lives. Reference is made to Note 21 ‘Other liabilities’ for the weighted averages of basic actuarial assumptions in connection with pension and other post-employment benefits.

PRINCIPLES OF VALUATION AND DETERMINATION OF RESULTS

CONSOLIDATION

ING Group (‘the Group’) comprises ING Groep N.V. (‘the Company’), ING Verzekeringen N.V., ING Bank N.V. and all other subsidiaries. The consolidated financial statements of ING Group comprise the accounts of ING Groep N.V. and all entities in which it either owns, directly or indirectly, more than half of the voting power or over which it has control of their operating and financial policies through situations including, but not limited to:

 

 

Ability to appoint or remove the majority of the board of directors;

 

 

Power to govern such policies under statute or agreement; and

 

 

Power over more than half of the voting rights through an agreement with other investors.

A list of principal subsidiaries is included in Note 29 ‘Principal subsidiaries’.

The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered in assessing whether the Group controls another entity. For interests in investment vehicles, the existence of control is determined taking into account both ING Group’s financial interests for own risk and its role as investment manager.

The results of the operations and the net assets of subsidiaries are included in the profit and loss account and the balance sheet from the date control is obtained until the date control is lost. On disposal, the difference between the sales proceeds, net of directly attributable transaction costs, and the net assets is included in net result.

A subsidiary which ING Group has agreed to sell but is still legally owned by ING Group may still be controlled by ING Group at the balance sheet date and, therefore, still be included in the consolidation. Such a subsidiary may be presented as a held for sale disposal group if certain conditions are met.

All intercompany transactions, balances and unrealised surpluses and deficits on transactions between group companies are eliminated. Where necessary, the accounting policies used by subsidiaries are changed to ensure consistency with group policies. In general, the reporting dates of subsidiaries are the same as the reporting date of ING Groep N.V.

ING Groep N.V. and its Dutch group companies are subject to legal restrictions regarding the amount of dividends they can pay to their shareholders. The Dutch Civil Code contains the restriction that dividends can only be paid up to an amount equal to the excess of the company’s own funds over the sum of the paid-up capital and reserves required by law. Additionally, certain Group companies are subject to restrictions on the amount of funds they may transfer in the form of dividends, or otherwise, to the parent company.

Furthermore, in addition to the restrictions in respect of minimum capital requirements that are imposed by industry regulators in the countries in which the subsidiaries operate, other limitations exist in certain countries.

ING Group’s interests in jointly controlled entities are accounted for using proportionate consolidation. ING Group proportionately consolidates its share of the joint ventures’ individual income and expenses, assets and liabilities, and cash flows on a line-by-line basis with similar items in ING Group’s financial statements. ING Group recognises the portion of gains or losses on the sale of assets to the joint venture that is attributable to the other venturers. ING Group does not recognise its share of profits or losses from the joint venture that results from the purchase of assets by ING Group from the joint venture until it resells the assets to a third party. However, if a loss on the transaction provides evidence of a reduction in the net realisable value of current assets or an impairment loss, the loss is recognised immediately.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Disposal groups held for sale and discontinued operations

Disposal groups held for sale are measured at the lower of their carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. Disposal groups (and groups of non-current assets) are classified as held for sale if their carrying amount will be recovered principally through a sale transaction rather than through continuing use. This is only the case when the sale is highly probable and the disposal group (or group of assets) is available for immediate sale in its present condition; management must be committed to the sale, which is expected to occur within one year from the date of classification as held for sale. When a group of assets that is classified as held for sale represents a major line of business or geographical area the disposal group classifies as discontinued operations. In the consolidated profit and loss account, the income and expenses from discontinued operations are reported separately from income and expenses from continuing operations, down to the level of result after tax for both the current and for comparative years.

USE OF ESTIMATES AND ASSUMPTIONS

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements necessitates the use of estimates and assumptions. These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of the assets and liabilities and the amounts of the contingent liabilities at the balance sheet date, as well as reported income and expenses for the year. The actual outcome may differ from these estimates.

The process of setting assumptions is subject to internal control procedures and approvals, and takes into account internal and external studies, industry statistics, environmental factors and trends, and regulatory requirements.

SEGMENT REPORTING

An operating segment is a distinguishable component of the Group, engaged in providing products or services, subject to risks and returns that are different from those of other operating segments. A geographical area is a distinguishable component of the Group engaged in providing products or services within a particular economic environment that is subject to risks and returns that are different from those of segments operating in other economic environments. The geographical analyses are based on the location of the office from which the transactions are originated.

ANALYSIS OF INSURANCE BUSINESS

Where amounts in respect of insurance business are analysed into ‘life’ and ‘non-life’, health and disability insurance business which is similar in nature to life insurance business is included in ‘life’.

FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION

Functional and presentation currency

Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (‘the functional currency’). The consolidated financial statements are presented in euros, which is ING Group’s functional and presentation currency.

Transactions and balances

Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rate prevailing at the date of the transactions. Exchange rate differences resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at year-end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in the profit and loss account, except when deferred in equity as part of qualifying cash flow hedges or qualifying net investment hedges.

Exchange rate differences on non-monetary items, measured at fair value through profit and loss, are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss. Non-monetary items are retranslated at the date fair value is determined. Exchange rate differences on non-monetary items measured at fair value through the revaluation reserve are included in the revaluation reserve in equity.

Exchange rate differences in the profit and loss account are generally included in Net trading income. Reference is made to Note 41 ‘Net trading income’, which discloses the amounts included in the profit and loss account. Exchange rate differences relating to the disposal of available-for-sale debt and equity securities are considered to be an inherent part of the capital gains and losses recognised in Investment income. As mentioned below in Group companies relating to the disposals of group companies, any exchange rate difference deferred in equity is recognised in the profit and loss account in Net result on disposals of group companies. Reference is also made to Note 13 ‘Shareholders’ equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities’, which discloses the amounts included in the profit and loss account.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Group companies

The results and financial positions of all group companies that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated into the presentation currency as follows:

 

 

Assets and liabilities included in each balance sheet are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheet;

 

 

Income and expenses included in each profit and loss account are translated at average exchange rates (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the transactions); and

 

 

All resulting exchange rate differences are recognised in a separate component of equity.

On consolidation, exchange rate differences arising from the translation of a monetary item that forms part of the net investment in a foreign operation, and of borrowings and other instruments designated as hedges of such investments, are taken to shareholders’ equity. When a foreign operation is sold, the corresponding exchange rate differences are recognised in the profit and loss account as part of the gain or loss on sale.

Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising from the acquisition of a foreign operation are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign operation and translated at the exchange rate prevailing at the balance sheet date.

FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

The fair values of financial instruments are based on quoted market prices at the balance sheet date where available. The quoted market price used for financial assets held by the Group is the current bid price; the quoted market price used for financial liabilities is the current ask price.

The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market are determined using valuation techniques. The Group uses a variety of methods and makes assumptions that are based on market conditions existing at each balance sheet date.

Reference is made to Note 34 ‘Fair value of financial assets and liabilities’ for the basis of the determination of the fair value of financial instruments.

FINANCIAL ASSETS

Recognition of financial assets

All purchases and sales of financial assets classified as fair value through profit and loss, held-to-maturity and available-for-sale that require delivery within the time frame established by regulation or market convention (‘regular way’ purchases and sales) are recognised at trade date, which is the date on which the Group commits to purchase or sell the asset. Loans and receivables are recognised at settlement date, which is the date on which the Group receives or delivers the asset.

Derecognition of financial assets

Financial assets are derecognised when the rights to receive cash flows from the financial assets have expired or where the Group has transferred substantially all risks and rewards of ownership. If the Group neither transfers nor retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a financial asset, it derecognises the financial asset if it no longer has control over the asset. In transfers where control over the asset is retained, the Group continues to recognise the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement. The extent of continuing involvement is determined by the extent to which the Group is exposed to changes in the value of the asset.

Realised gains and losses on investments

Realised gains and losses on investments are determined as the difference between the sale proceeds and (amortised) cost. For equity securities, the cost is determined using a weighted average per portfolio. For debt securities, the cost is determined by specific identification.

CLASSIFICATION OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss include equity securities, debt securities, derivatives, loans and receivables and other, and comprise the following sub-categories: trading assets, non-trading derivatives, financial assets designated at fair value through profit and loss by management and investments for risk of policyholders.

 

F-19


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

A financial asset is classified as at fair value through profit and loss if acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short term or if designated by management as such. Management will make this designation only if this eliminates a measurement inconsistency or if the related assets and liabilities are managed on a fair value basis.

Investments for risk of policyholders are investments against insurance liabilities for which all changes in fair value of invested assets are offset by similar changes in insurance liabilities.

Transaction costs on initial recognition are expensed as incurred. Interest income from debt securities and loans and receivables classified as at fair value through profit and loss is recognised in Interest income banking operations and Investment income in the profit and loss account, using the effective interest method.

Dividend income from equity instruments classified as at fair value through profit and loss is generally recognised in Investment income in the profit and loss account when dividend has been declared. Investment result from investments for risk of policyholders is recognised in investment result for risk of policyholders. For derivatives reference is made to the ‘Derivatives and hedge accounting’ section. For all other financial assets classified as at fair value through profit and loss changes in fair value are recognised in Net trading income.

Investments

Investments (including loans quoted in active markets) are classified either as held-to-maturity or available-for-sale and are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs. Investment debt securities and loans quoted in active markets with fixed maturity where management has both the intent and the ability to hold to maturity are classified as held-to-maturity. Investment securities and actively traded loans intended to be held for an indefinite period of time, which may be sold in response to needs for liquidity or changes in interest rates, exchange rates or equity prices, are classified as available-for-sale.

Available-for-sale financial assets

Available-for-sale financial assets include available-for-sale debt securities and available-for-sale equity securities. Available-for-sale financial assets are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs. For available-for-sale debt securities, the difference between cost and redemption value is amortised. Interest income is recognised using the effective interest method. Available-for-sale financial assets are subsequently measured at fair value. Interest income from debt securities classified as available-for-sale is recognised in Interest income banking operations and Investment income in the profit and loss account using the effective interest method. Dividend income from equity instruments classified as available-for-sale is generally recognised in Investment income in the profit and loss account when the dividend has been declared. Unrealised gains and losses arising from changes in the fair value are recognised in equity. When the securities are disposed of, the related accumulated fair value adjustments are included in the profit and loss account as Investment income. For impairments of available-for-sale financial assets reference is made to the section ‘Impairments of other financial assets’. Investments in prepayment sensitive securities such as Interest-Only and Principal-Only strips are generally classified as available-for-sale.

Held-to-maturity investments

Non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments and fixed maturity for which the Group has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity and which are designated by management as held-to-maturity assets are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs. Subsequently, they are carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method less any impairment losses. Interest income from debt securities classified as held-to-maturity is recognised in Interest income in the profit and loss account using the effective interest method. Held-to-maturity investments include only debt securities.

Loans and receivables

Loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs. Subsequently, they are carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method less any impairment losses. Loans and receivables include: Cash and balances with central banks, Amounts due from banks, Loans and advances to customers and Other assets and are reflected in these balance sheet lines. Interest income from loans and receivables is recognised in Interest income and Investment income in the profit and loss account using the effective interest method.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Credit risk management classification

Credit risk management disclosures are provided in the section ‘Risk management’. The relationship between credit risk classifications in that section and the consolidated balance sheet classifications above is explained below:

 

 

Lending risk arises when ING Group grants a loan to a customer, or issues guarantees on behalf of a customer and mainly relates to the balance sheet classification Loans and advances to customers and off balance sheet items e.g. obligations under financial guarantees and letters of credit;

 

 

Investment risk comprises the credit default and migration risk that is associated with ING Group’s investment portfolio and mainly relates to the balance sheet classification Investments (available-for-sale and held-to-maturity);

 

 

Money market risk arises when ING Group places short term deposits with a counterparty in order to manage excess liquidity and among others relates to the balance sheet classifications Amounts due from banks and Loans and advances to customers;

 

 

Pre-settlement risk arises when a counterparty defaults on a transaction before settlement and ING Group has to replace the contract by a trade with another counterparty at the then prevailing (possibly unfavourable) market price. The pre-settlement risk classification mainly relates to the balance sheet classification Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss (trading assets and non-trading derivatives) and to securities financing;

 

 

Settlement risk arises when there is an exchange of value (funds, instruments or commodities) for the same or different value dates and receipt is not verified or expected until ING Group has paid or delivered its side of the trade. Settlement risk mainly relates to the risk arising on disposal of financial instruments that are classified in the balance sheet as Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss (trading assets and non-trading derivatives) and Investments (available-for-sale and held-to-maturity).

Maximum credit risk exposure

The maximum credit risk exposure for items on the balance sheet is generally the carrying value for the relevant financial assets. For the off-balance sheet items the maximum credit exposure is the maximum amount that could be required to be paid. Collateral received is not taken into account when determining the maximum credit risk exposure.

The manner in which ING Group manages credit risk and determines credit risk exposures for that purpose is explained in the ‘Risk management’ section.

DERIVATIVES AND HEDGE ACCOUNTING

Derivatives are initially recognised at fair value on the date on which a derivative contract is entered into and are subsequently measured at fair value. Fair values are obtained from quoted market prices in active markets, including recent market transactions, and valuation techniques (such as discounted cash flow models and option pricing models), as appropriate. All derivatives are carried as assets when their fair value is positive and as liabilities when their fair values are negative.

Some credit protection contracts that take the legal form of a derivative, such as certain credit default swaps, are accounted for as financial guarantees.

Certain derivatives embedded in other contracts are measured as separate derivatives when their economic characteristics and risks are not closely related to those of the host contract, the host contract is not carried at fair value through profit and loss, and if a separate instrument with the same terms as the embedded derivative would meet the definition of a derivative. These embedded derivatives are measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognised in the profit and loss account. An assessment is carried out when the Group first becomes party to the contract. A reassessment is carried out only when there is a change in the terms of the contract that significantly modifies the expected cash flows.

The method of recognising the resulting fair value gain or loss depends on whether the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument and, if so, the nature of the item being hedged. The Group designates certain derivatives as hedges of the fair value of recognised assets or liabilities or firm commitments (fair value hedge), hedges of highly probable future cash flows attributable to a recognised asset or liability or a forecast transaction (cash flow hedge), or hedges of a net investment in a foreign operation. Hedge accounting is used for derivatives designated in this way provided certain criteria are met.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

At the inception of the transaction ING Group documents the relationship between hedging instruments and hedged items, its risk management objective, together with the methods selected to assess hedge effectiveness. The Group also documents its assessment, both at hedge inception and on an ongoing basis, of whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions are highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged items.

ING Group applies fair value hedge accounting to portfolio hedges of interest rate risk (macro hedging) under the EU ‘carve out’ of IFRS-EU. The EU ‘carve-out’ macro hedging enables a group of derivatives (or proportions) to be viewed in combination and jointly designated as the hedging instrument and removes some of the limitations in fair value hedge accounting relating to hedging core deposits and under-hedging strategies. Under the IFRS-EU ‘carve-out’, hedge accounting may be applied to core deposits and ineffectiveness only arises when the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets falls below the designated amount of that bucket.

ING Group applies fair value hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk (macro hedging) under the EU ‘carve-out’ to its retail operations. The net exposures of retail funding (savings and current accounts) and retail lending (mortgages) are hedged. The hedging activities are designated under a portfolio fair value hedge on the mortgages. Changes in the fair value of the derivatives are recognised in the profit and loss account, together with the fair value adjustment on the mortgages (hedged items) insofar as attributable to interest rate risk (the hedged risk).

Fair value hedges

Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges are recognised in the profit and loss account, together with fair value adjustments to the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk. If the hedge relationship no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, the cumulative adjustment of the hedged item is, in the case of interest bearing instruments, amortised through the profit and loss account over the remaining term of the original hedge or recognised directly when the hedged item is derecognised. For non-interest bearing instruments, the cumulative adjustment of the hedged item is recognised in the profit and loss account only when the hedged item is derecognised.

Cash flow hedges

The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges are recognised in equity. The gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the profit and loss account. Amounts accumulated in equity are recycled to the profit and loss account in the periods in which the hedged item affects net result. When a hedging instrument expires or is sold, or when a hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative gain or loss existing in equity at that time remains in equity and is recognised when the forecast transaction is ultimately recognised in the profit and loss account. When a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative gain or loss that was reported in equity is transferred immediately to the profit and loss account.

Net investment hedges

Hedges of net investments in foreign operations are accounted for in a similar way to cash flow hedges. Any gain or loss on the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge is recognised in equity and the gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the profit and loss account. Gains and losses accumulated in equity are included in the profit and loss account when the foreign operation is disposed.

Non-trading derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting

Derivative instruments that are used by the Group as part of its risk management strategies, but which do not qualify for hedge accounting under ING Group’s accounting policies, are presented as non-trading derivatives. Non-trading derivatives are measured at fair value with changes in the fair value taken to the profit and loss account.

OFFSETTING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS AND FINANCIAL LIABILITIES

Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset, and the net amount reported, in the balance sheet when the Group has a current legally enforceable right to set off the recognised amounts and intends to either settle on a net basis or to realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. Offsetting is applied to certain interest rate swaps for which the services of a central clearing house are used. Furthermore, offsetting is also applied to certain current accounts for which the product features and internal procedures allow net presentation under IFRS-IASB.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

REPURCHASE TRANSACTIONS AND REVERSE REPURCHASE TRANSACTIONS

Securities sold subject to repurchase agreements (‘repos’) are retained in the consolidated financial statements. The counterparty liability is included in Amounts due to banks, Other borrowed funds, Customer deposits and other funds on deposit, or Trading as appropriate.

Securities purchased under agreements to resell (‘reverse repos’) are recognised as Loans and advances to customers or Amounts due from banks, as appropriate. The difference between the sale and repurchase price is treated as interest and amortised over the life of the agreement using the effective interest method.

IMPAIRMENTS OF LOANS AND ADVANCES TO CUSTOMERS (LOAN LOSS PROVISIONS)

ING Group assesses periodically and at each balance sheet date whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or group of financial assets is impaired. A financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired and impairment losses are incurred if, and only if, there is objective evidence of impairment as a result of one or more events that occurred after the initial recognition of the asset, but before the balance sheet date, (a ‘loss event’) and that loss event (or events) has an impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset or group of financial assets that can be reliably estimated. The following circumstances, among others, are considered objective evidence that a financial asset or group of assets is impaired:

 

 

The borrower has sought or has been placed in bankruptcy or similar protection and this leads to the avoidance of or delays in repayment of the financial asset;

 

 

The borrower has failed in the repayment of principal, interest or fees and the payment failure has remained unsolved for a certain period;

 

 

The borrower has demonstrated significant financial difficulty, to the extent that it will have a negative impact on the expected future cash flows of the financial asset;

 

 

The credit obligation has been restructured for non-commercial reasons. ING Group has granted concessions, for economic or legal reasons relating to the borrower’s financial difficulty, the effect of which is a reduction in the expected future cash flows of the financial asset; and

 

 

Historical experience, updated for current events where necessary, provides evidence that a proportion of a group of assets is impaired although the related events that represent impairment triggers are not yet captured by the Group’s credit risk systems.

The Group does not consider events that may be expected to occur in the future as objective evidence, and consequently they are not used as a basis for concluding that a financial asset or group of assets is impaired.

In determining the impairment, expected future cash flows are estimated on the basis of the contractual cash flows of the assets in the portfolio and historical loss experience for assets with credit risk characteristics similar to those in the portfolio. Historical loss experience is adjusted on the basis of current observable data to reflect the effects of current conditions that did not affect the period on which the historical loss experience is based and to remove the effects of conditions in the historical period that do not currently exist. Losses expected as a result of future events, no matter how likely, are not recognised.

The Group first assesses whether objective evidence of impairment exists individually for financial assets that are individually significant, and then individually or collectively for financial assets that are not individually significant. If the Group determines that no objective evidence of impairment exists for an individually assessed financial asset, whether significant or not, it includes the asset in a group of financial assets with similar credit risk characteristics and collectively assesses them for impairment. Assets that are individually assessed for impairment and for which an impairment loss is or continues to be recognised are not included in a collective assessment of impairment.

If there is objective evidence that an impairment loss on an asset carried at amortised cost has been incurred, the amount of the loss is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows (excluding future credit losses that have not been incurred) discounted at the financial asset’s original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is reduced through the use of an allowance account (‘Loan loss provision’) and the amount of the loss is recognised in the profit and loss account under ‘Addition to loan loss provision’. If the asset has a variable interest rate, the discount rate for measuring any impairment loss is the current effective interest rate determined under the contract.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the purposes of a collective evaluation of impairment, financial assets are grouped on the basis of similar credit risk characteristics. Those characteristics are relevant to the estimation of future cash flows for groups of such assets by being indicative of the debtors’ ability to pay all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the assets being evaluated. The collective evaluation of impairment includes the application of a ‘loss confirmation period’ to default probabilities. The loss confirmation period is a concept which recognises that there is a period of time between the emergence of impairment triggers and the point in time at which those events are captured by the Group’s credit risk systems. Accordingly, the application of the loss confirmation period ensures that impairments that are incurred but not yet identified are adequately reflected in the Group’s loan loss provision. Although the loss confirmation periods are inherently uncertain, the Group applies estimates to sub-portfolios (e.g. large corporations, small and medium size enterprises and retail portfolios) that reflect factors such as the frequency with which customers in the sub-portfolio disclose credit risk sensitive information and the frequency with which they are subject to review by the Group’s account managers. Generally, the frequency increases in relation to the size of the borrower. Loss confirmation periods are based on historical experience and are validated, and revised where necessary, through regular back-testing to ensure that they reflect recent experience and current events.

If, in a subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised (such as an improvement in the debtor’s credit rating), the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed by adjusting the provision. The amount of the reversal is recognised in the profit and loss account.

When a loan is uncollectible, it is written off against the related loan loss provision. Such loans are written off after all the necessary procedures have been completed and the amount of the loss has been determined. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are recognised in the profit and loss account.

IMPAIRMENT OF OTHER FINANCIAL ASSETS

At each balance sheet date, the Group assesses whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. In the specific case of equity investments classified as available-for-sale, (the combination of) a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered in determining whether the assets are impaired. ‘Significant’ and ‘prolonged’ are interpreted on a case-by-case basis for specific equity securities; generally 25% and 6 months are used as triggers. If any objective evidence exists for available-for-sale debt and equity investments, the cumulative loss – measured as the difference between the acquisition cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that financial asset previously recognised in net result – is removed from equity and recognised in the profit and loss account. Impairment losses recognised on equity instruments can never be reversed. If, in a subsequent period, the fair value of a debt instrument classified as available-for-sale increases and the increase can be objectively related to an event occurring after the impairment loss was recognised in the profit and loss account, the impairment loss is reversed through the profit and loss account.

INVESTMENTS IN ASSOCIATES

Associates are all entities over which the Group has significant influence but not control. Significant influence generally results from a shareholding of between 20% and 50% of the voting rights, but also is the ability to participate in the financial and operating policies through situations including, but not limited to one or more of the following:

 

 

Representation on the board of directors;

 

 

Participation in the policymaking process; and

 

 

Interchange of managerial personnel.

Investments in associates are initially recognised at cost and subsequently accounted for using the equity method of accounting.

The Group’s investment in associates (net of any accumulated impairment loss) includes goodwill identified on acquisition. The Group’s share of its associates’ post-acquisition profits or losses is recognised in the profit and loss account, and its share of post-acquisition changes in reserves is recognised in equity. The cumulative post-acquisition changes are adjusted against the carrying amount of the investment. When the Group’s share of losses in an associate equals or exceeds its interest in the associate, including any other unsecured receivables, the Group does not recognise further losses, unless it has incurred obligations or made payments on behalf of the associate.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Unrealised gains on transactions between the Group and its associates are eliminated to the extent of the Group’s interest in the associates. Unrealised losses are also eliminated unless they provide evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Accounting policies of associates have been changed where necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the Group. The reporting dates of all material associates are consistent with the reporting date of the Group.

For interests in investment vehicles the existence of significant influence is determined taking into account both the Group’s financial interests for own risk and its role as investment manager.

REAL ESTATE INVESTMENTS

Real estate investments are recognised at fair value at the balance sheet date. Changes in the carrying amount resulting from revaluations are recognised in the profit and loss account. On disposal the difference between the sale proceeds and carrying value is recognised in the profit and loss account.

The fair value of real estate investments is based on regular appraisals by independent qualified valuers. For each reporting period every property is valued either by an independent valuer or internally. Indexation is used when a property is valued internally. The index is based on the results of the independent valuations carried out in that period. Market transactions and disposals made by ING Group are monitored as part of the validation procedures to test the indexation methodology. Valuations performed earlier in the year are updated if necessary to reflect the situation at the year-end. All properties are valued independently at least every five years and more frequently if necessary.

The fair values represent the estimated amount for which the property could be exchanged on the date of valuation between a willing buyer and willing seller in an at-arm’s-length transaction after proper marketing wherein the parties each acted knowledgeably, prudently and without compulsion. Fair values are based on appraisals using valuation methods such as: comparable market transactions, capitalisation of income methods or discounted cash flow calculations. The underlying assumption used in the valuation is that the properties are let or sold to third parties based on the actual letting status. The discounted cash flow analyses and capitalisation of income method are based on calculations of the future rental income in accordance with the terms in existing leases and estimations of the rental values for new leases when leases expire and incentives like rental free periods. The cash flows are discounted using market based interest rates that reflect appropriately the risk characteristics of real estate.

ING Group owns a large real estate portfolio, widely diversified by region, by investment segment (Office, Retail and Residential) and by investment type (Core, Value Add and Opportunistic). The valuation of different investments is performed using different discount rates (‘yields’), dependent on specific characteristics of each property, including occupancy, quality of rent payments and specific local market circumstances. For ING’s main direct properties in its main locations, the yields applied in the 2011 year-end valuation generally are in the range of 5% to 8%.

The valuation of real estate investments takes (expected) vacancies into account. Occupancy rates differ significantly from investment to investment.

For real estate investments held through (minority shares in) real estate investment funds, the valuations are performed under the responsibility of the funds’ asset manager.

Subsequent expenditures are recognised as part of the asset’s carrying amount only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to ING Group and the cost can be measured reliably. All other repairs and maintenance costs are recognised in the profit and loss account.

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

Property in own use

Land and buildings held for own use are stated at fair value at the balance sheet date. Increases in the carrying amount arising on revaluation of land and buildings held for own use are credited to the revaluation reserve in shareholders’ equity. Decreases in the carrying amount that offset previous increases of the same asset are charged against the revaluation reserve directly in equity; all other decreases are charged to the profit and loss account. Increases that reverse a revaluation decrease on the same asset previously recognised in net result are recognised in the profit and loss account. Depreciation is recognised based on the fair value and the estimated useful life (in general 20–50 years). Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis. On disposal the related revaluation reserve is transferred to retained earnings.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The fair values of land and buildings are based on regular appraisals by independent qualified valuers or internally, similar to appraisals of real estate investments. Subsequent expenditure is included in the asset’s carrying amount when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably.

Property obtained from foreclosures

Property obtained from foreclosures is stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less applicable variable selling expenses. Property obtained from foreclosures is included in Other assets – Property development and obtained from foreclosures.

Property development

Property developed and under development for which ING Group has the intention to sell the property after its completion is included in Other assets – Property development and obtained from foreclosures.

Property developed and under development for which ING Group has the intention to sell the property under development after its completion and where there is not yet a specifically negotiated contract is measured at direct construction cost incurred up to the balance sheet date, including borrowing costs incurred during construction and ING Group’s own directly attributable development and supervision expenses less any impairment losses. Profit is recognised using the completed contract method (on sale date of the property). Impairment is recognised if the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less applicable variable selling expenses is lower than carrying value.

Property under development for which ING Group has the intention to sell the property under development after its completion and where there is a specifically negotiated contract is valued using the percentage of completion method (pro rata profit recognition). The stage of completion is measured by reference to costs incurred to date as percentage of total estimated costs for each contract.

Property under development is stated at fair value (with changes in fair value recognised in the profit and loss account) if ING Group has the intention to recognise the property under development after completion as real estate investments.

Equipment

Equipment is stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses. The cost of the assets is depreciated on a straight line basis over their estimated useful lives, which are generally as follows: for data processing equipment two to five years, and four to ten years for fixtures and fittings. Expenditure incurred on maintenance and repairs is recognised in the profit and loss account as incurred. Expenditure incurred on major improvements is capitalised and depreciated.

Assets under operating leases

Assets leased out under operating leases in which ING Group is the lessor are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses. The cost of the assets is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Reference is made to the section ‘Leases’.

Disposals

The difference between the proceeds on disposal and net carrying value is recognised in the profit and loss account under Other income.

Borrowing costs

Borrowing costs incurred for the construction of any qualifying asset are capitalised during the period of time that is required to complete and prepare the asset for its intended use. Borrowing costs are determined at the weighted average cost of capital of the project.

LEASES

The determination of whether an arrangement is or contains a lease is based on the substance of the arrangement at inception date.

ING Group as the lessee

The leases entered into by ING Group are primarily operating leases. The total payments made under operating leases are recognised in the profit and loss account on a straight-line basis over the period of the lease.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

When an operating lease is terminated before the lease period has expired, any penalty payment to be made to the lessor is recognised as an expense in the period in which termination takes place.

ING Group as the lessor

When assets are held subject to a finance lease, the present value of the lease payments is recognised as a receivable under Loans and advances to customers or Amounts due from banks. The difference between the gross receivable and the present value of the receivable is unearned lease finance income. Lease income is recognised over the term of the lease using the net investment method (before tax), which reflects a constant periodic rate of return. When assets are held subject to an operating lease, the assets are included under Assets under operating leases.

ACQUISITIONS, GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Acquisitions and goodwill

ING Group’s acquisitions are accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The consideration for each acquisition is measured at the aggregate of the fair values (at the date of exchange) of assets given, liabilities incurred or assumed, and equity instruments issued in exchange for control of the acquiree. Goodwill, being the difference between the cost of the acquisition (including assumed debt) and the Group’s interest in the fair value of the acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities as at the date of acquisition, is capitalised as an intangible asset. The results of the operations of the acquired companies are included in the profit and loss account from the date control is obtained.

Where applicable, the consideration for the acquisition includes any asset or liability resulting from a contingent consideration arrangement, measured at its acquisition-date fair value. Subsequent changes in the fair value of contingent consideration classified as an asset or liability are accounted for in accordance with relevant IFRSs, taking into account the initial accounting period below. Changes in the fair value of the contingent consideration classified as equity are not recognised.

Where a business combination is achieved in stages, ING Group’s previously held interests in the assets and liabilities of the acquired entity are remeasured to fair value at the acquisition date (i.e. the date ING Group attains control) and the resulting gain or loss, if any, is recognised in the profit or loss account. Amounts arising from interests in the acquiree prior to the acquisition date that have previously been recognised in other comprehensive income are reclassified to the profit or loss account, where such treatment would be appropriate if that interest were disposed of. Acquisition-related costs are recognised in the profit or loss account as incurred and presented in the profit and loss account as Other operating expenses.

Until 2009, before IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’ was revised the accounting of previously held interests in the assets and liabilities of the acquired entity were not remeasured at the acquisition date and the acquisition-related costs were considered to be part of the total consideration.

The initial accounting for the fair value of the net assets of the companies acquired during the year may be determined only provisionally as the determination of the fair value can be complex and the time between the acquisition and the preparation of the Annual Accounts can be limited. The initial accounting shall be completed within a year after acquisition.

Goodwill is only capitalised on acquisitions after the implementation date of IFRS-EU (January 1, 2004). Accounting for acquisitions before that date has not been restated; goodwill and internally generated intangibles on these acquisitions were recognised directly in shareholders’ equity. Goodwill is allocated to reporting units for the purpose of impairment testing. These reporting units represent the lowest level at which goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes. This test is performed annually or more frequently if there are indicators of impairment. Under the impairment tests, the carrying value of the reporting units (including goodwill) is compared to its recoverable amount which is the higher of its fair value less costs to sell and its value in use.

Adjustments to the fair value as at the date of acquisition of acquired assets and liabilities that are identified within one year after acquisition are recognised as an adjustment to goodwill; any subsequent adjustment is recognised as income or expense. On disposal of group companies, the difference between the sale proceeds and carrying value (including goodwill) and the unrealised results (including the currency translation reserve in equity) is included in the profit and loss account.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Computer software

Computer software that has been purchased or generated internally for own use is stated at cost less amortisation and any impairment losses. Amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis over its useful life. This period will generally not exceed three years. Amortisation is included in Other operating expenses.

Value of business acquired (VOBA)

VOBA is an asset that reflects the present value of estimated net cash flows embedded in the insurance contracts of an acquired company, which existed at the time the company was acquired. It represents the difference between the fair value of insurance liabilities and their carrying value. VOBA is amortised in a similar manner to the amortisation of deferred acquisition costs as described in the section ‘Deferred acquisition costs’.

Other intangible assets

Other intangible assets are capitalised and amortised over their expected economic life, which is generally between three and ten years. Intangible assets with an indefinite life are not amortised.

DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS

Deferred acquisition costs (DAC) are an asset and represent costs of acquiring insurance and investment contracts that are deferred and amortised. The deferred costs, all of which vary with (and are primarily related to) the production of new and renewal business, consist principally of commissions, certain underwriting and contract issuance expenses, and certain agency expenses.

For traditional life insurance contracts, certain types of flexible life insurance contracts, and non-life contracts, DAC is amortised over the premium payment period in proportion to the premium revenue recognised.

For other types of flexible life insurance contracts DAC is amortised over the lives of the policies in relation to the emergence of estimated gross profits. Amortisation is adjusted when estimates of current or future gross profits, to be realised from a group of products, are revised. The estimates and the assumptions are reassessed at the end of each reporting period. Higher/lower expected profits (e.g. reflecting stock market performance or a change in the level of assets under management) may cause a lower/higher balance of DAC due to the catch-up of amortisation in previous and future years. This process is known as DAC unlocking. The impact of the DAC unlocking is recognised in the profit and loss account of the period in which the unlocking occurs. Effective as of 2011, the estimate for the short-term equity growth assumption used to calculate the amortisation of DAC in the United States (Insurance US) was changed to a mean reversion assumption.

DAC is evaluated for recoverability at issue. Subsequently it is tested on a regular basis together with the provision for life insurance liabilities and VOBA. The test for recoverability is described in the section ‘Insurance, Investment and Reinsurance Contracts’.

For certain products DAC is adjusted for the impact of unrealised results on allocated investments through equity.

TAXATION

Income tax on the result for the year comprises current and deferred tax. Income tax is recognised in the profit and loss account but it is recognised directly in equity if the tax relates to items that are recognised directly in equity.

Deferred income tax

Deferred income tax is provided in full, using the liability method, on temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the consolidated financial statements. Deferred income tax is determined using tax rates (and laws) that have been enacted or substantially enacted by the balance sheet date and are expected to apply when the related deferred income tax asset is realised or the deferred income tax liability is settled. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not discounted.

 

F-28


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Deferred tax assets are recognised where it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilised. Deferred income tax is provided on temporary differences arising from investments in subsidiaries and associates, except where the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference is controlled by the Group and it is probable that the difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future. The tax effects of income tax losses available for carry forward are recognised as an asset where it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which these losses can be utilised.

Deferred tax related to fair value remeasurement of available-for-sale investments and cash flow hedges, which are recognised directly in equity, is also recognised directly in equity and is subsequently recognised in the profit and loss account together with the deferred gain or loss.

FINANCIAL LIABILITIES

Financial liabilities at amortised cost

Financial liabilities at amortised cost include the following sub-categories: preference shares, other borrowed funds, debt securities in issue, subordinated loans, amounts due to banks and customer deposits and other funds on deposit.

Borrowings are recognised initially at their issue proceeds (fair value of consideration received) net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortised cost; any difference between proceeds, net of transaction costs, and the redemption value is recognised in the profit and loss account over the period of the borrowings using the effective interest method.

If the Group purchases its own debt, it is removed from the balance sheet, and the difference between the carrying amount of the liability and the consideration paid is included in the profit and loss account.

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss comprise the following sub-categories: trading liabilities, non-trading derivatives and other financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit and loss by management. Trading liabilities include equity securities, debt securities, funds on deposit and derivatives. Designation by management will take place only if it eliminates a measurement inconsistency or if the related assets and liabilities are managed on a fair value basis. ING Group has designated an insignificant part of the issued debt, related to market-making activities, at fair value through profit and loss. This issued debt consists mainly of own bonds. The designation as fair value through profit and loss eliminates the inconsistency in the timing of the recognition of gains and losses. All other financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost.

Financial guarantee contracts

Financial guarantee contracts are contracts that require the issuer to make specified payments to reimburse the holder for a loss it incurs because a specified debtor fails to make payments when due, in accordance with the terms of a debt instrument. Such financial guarantees are initially recognised at fair value and subsequently measured at the higher of the discounted best estimate of the obligation under the guarantee and the amount initially recognised less cumulative amortisation to reflect revenue recognition principles.

INSURANCE, INVESTMENT AND REINSURANCE CONTRACTS

Provisions for liabilities under insurance contracts are established in accordance with IFRS 4 ‘Insurance Contracts’. Under IFRS 4, an insurer may continue its existing pre-IFRS accounting policies for insurance contracts, provided that certain minimum requirements are met. Upon adoption of IFRS in 2005, ING Group decided to continue the then existing accounting principles for insurance contracts under IFRS. ING Group operates in many different countries and the accounting principles for insurance contracts follow local practice in these countries. ING’s businesses in the Netherlands apply accounting standards generally accepted in the Netherlands (Dutch GAAP) for its provisions for liabilities under insurance contracts; similarly, ING’s businesses in the United States apply accounting standards generally accepted in the United States (US GAAP).

Changes in those local accounting standards (including Dutch GAAP and US GAAP) subsequent to the adoption of IFRS are considered for adoption on a case-by-case basis. If adopted, the impact thereof is accounted for as a change in accounting policy under IFRS.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In addition, for certain specific products or components thereof, ING applies the option in IFRS 4 to measure (components of) the provisions for liabilities under insurance contracts using market consistent interest rates and other current estimates and assumptions. This relates mainly to Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for Life on the Insurance US Closed Block VA book and certain guarantees embedded in insurance contracts in Japan.

Insurance contracts

Insurance policies which bear significant insurance risk and/or contain discretionary participation features are presented as insurance contracts. Provisions for liabilities under insurance contracts represent estimates of future payouts that will be required for life and non-life insurance claims, including expenses relating to such claims. For some insurance contracts the measurement reflects current market assumptions. Unless indicated otherwise below all changes in the insurance provisions are recognised in the profit and loss account.

Provision for life insurance

The Provision for life insurance is calculated on the basis of a prudent prospective actuarial method, taking into account the conditions for current insurance contracts. Specific methodologies may differ between business units as they may reflect local regulatory requirements and local practices for specific product features in the local markets.

Insurance provisions on traditional life policies are calculated using various assumptions, including assumptions on mortality, morbidity, expenses, investment returns and surrenders. Assumptions for insurance provisions on traditional life insurance contracts, including traditional whole life and term life insurance contracts, are based on best estimate assumptions including margins for adverse deviations. The assumptions are set initially at the policy issue date and remain constant throughout the life of the policy.

Insurance provisions for universal life, variable life and annuity contracts, unit-linked contracts, etc. are generally set equal to the balance that accrues to the benefit of the policyholders. Certain variable annuity products contain minimum guarantees on the amounts payable upon death and/or maturity. The insurance provisions include the impact of these minimum guarantees, taking into account the difference between the potential minimum benefit payable and the total account balance, expected mortality and surrender rates.

The as yet unamortised interest rate rebates on periodic and single premium contracts are deducted from the Provision for life insurance. Interest rate rebates granted during the year are capitalised and amortised in conformity with the anticipated recovery pattern and are recognised in the profit and loss account.

Provision for unearned premiums and unexpired insurance risks

The provision is calculated in proportion to the unexpired periods of risk. For insurance policies covering a risk increasing during the term of the policy at premium rates independent of age, this risk is taken into account when determining the provision. Further provisions are made to cover claims under unexpired insurance contracts, which may exceed the unearned premiums and the premiums due in respect of these contracts.

Claims provision

The claims provision is calculated on a case-by-case basis or by approximation on the basis of experience. Provisions have also been made for claims incurred but not reported (IBNR) and for future claims handling expenses. The adequacy of the Claims provision is evaluated each year using standard actuarial techniques. In addition, IBNR reserves are set to recognise the estimated cost of losses that have occurred but which have not yet been notified to the Group.

Deferred profit sharing

For insurance contracts with discretionary participation features a deferred profit sharing amount is recognised for the full amount of the unrealised revaluation on allocated investments. Upon realisation, the profit sharing on unrealised revaluation is reversed and a deferred profit sharing amount is recognised for the share of realised results on allocated investments that is expected to be shared with policyholders. The deferred profit sharing amount is reduced by the actual allocation of profit sharing to individual policyholders. The change in the deferred profit sharing amount on unrealised revaluation (net of deferred tax) is recognised in equity in the Revaluation reserve.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Provisions for life insurance for risk of policyholders

For insurance contracts for risk of policyholders the provisions are generally shown at the balance sheet value of the related investments.

Reinsurance contracts

Reinsurance premiums, commissions and claim settlements, as well as the reinsurance element of technical provisions are accounted for in the same way as the original contracts for which the reinsurance was concluded. If the reinsurers are unable to meet their obligations, the Group remains liable to its policyholders for the portion reinsured. Consequently, provisions are made for receivables on reinsurance contracts which are deemed uncollectible.

Adequacy test

The adequacy of the provision for life insurance, net of unamortised interest rate rebates, DAC and VOBA (the net insurance liabilities), is evaluated regularly by each business unit for the business originated in that business unit. The test considers current estimates of all contractual and related cash flows, and future developments. It includes investment income on the same basis as it is included in the profit and loss account.

If, for any business unit, it is determined, using a best estimate (50%) confidence level, that a shortfall exists, and there are no offsetting amounts within other business units in the Business Line, the shortfall is recognised immediately in the profit and loss account.

If, for any business unit, the net insurance liabilities are not adequate using a prudent (90%) confidence level, but there are offsetting amounts within other Group business units, then the business unit is allowed to take measures to strengthen the net insurance liabilities over a period no longer than the expected life of the policies. To the extent that there are no offsetting amounts within other Group business units, any shortfall at the 90% confidence level is recognised immediately in the profit and loss account.

If the net insurance liabilities are determined to be adequate at above the 90% confidence level, no reduction in the net insurance liabilities is recognised.

As at December 31, 2009, the Closed Block Variable Annuity business in the United States was inadequate at the 90% confidence level. As there were offsetting amounts within other Group business units, the Group remained adequate at the 90% confidence level. In line with the above policy, specific measures were defined to mitigate the inadequacy in the Closed Block Variable Annuity business in the United States. These specific measures are effective as of 2010 and result in a limitation of additions to DAC that would otherwise result from negative amortisation and unlocking. This limitation of DAC is applied on a quarterly basis and in any year if and when a reserve inadequacy existed at the start of the year. The impact on 2010 was EUR 610 million lower DAC and consequently lower result before tax. Net result in 2011 includes a charge to restore the adequacy of the Insurance US Closed Block VA segment to the 50% confidence level. Reference is made to Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’.

Investment contracts

Insurance policies without discretionary participation features which do not bear significant insurance risk are presented as Investment contracts. Provisions for liabilities under investment contracts are determined either at amortised cost, using the effective interest method (including certain initial acquisition expenses) or at fair value.

OTHER LIABILITIES

Employee benefits – pension obligations

Group companies operate various pension schemes. The schemes are generally funded through payments to insurance companies or trustee-administered funds, determined by periodic actuarial calculations. The Group has both defined benefit and defined contribution plans.

A defined benefit plan is a pension plan that defines an amount of pension benefit that an employee will receive on retirement, usually dependent on one or more factors such as age, years of service and compensation.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The liability recognised in the balance sheet in respect of defined benefit pension plans is the present value of the defined benefit obligation at the balance sheet date less the fair value of plan assets, together with adjustments for unrecognised actuarial gains and losses, and unrecognised past service costs. The defined benefit obligation is calculated annually by internal and external actuaries using the projected unit credit method.

The expected value of the assets is calculated using the expected rate of return on plan assets. Differences between the expected return and the actual return on these plan assets and actuarial changes in the deferred benefit obligation are not recognised in the profit and loss account, unless the accumulated differences and changes exceed 10% of the greater of the defined benefit obligation and the fair value of the plan assets. The excess is recognised in the profit and loss account over employees’ remaining working lives. The corridor was reset to nil at the date of transition to IFRS-IASB.

The value of any plan asset recognised is restricted to the sum of any past service costs not yet recognised and the present value of any economic benefits available in the form of refunds from the plan or reductions in the future contributions to the plan.

For defined contribution plans, the Group pays contributions to publicly or privately administered pension insurance plans on a mandatory, contractual or voluntary basis. The Group has no further payment obligations once the contributions have been paid. The contributions are recognised as staff expenses when they are due. Prepaid contributions are recognised as an asset to the extent that a cash refund or a reduction in the future payments is available.

Other post-employment obligations

Some group companies provide post-employment healthcare and other benefits to certain employees and former employees. The entitlement to these benefits is usually conditional on the employee remaining in service up to retirement age and the completion of a minimum service period. The expected costs of these benefits are accrued over the period of employment using an accounting methodology similar to that for defined benefit pension plans.

Other provisions

A provision involves a present obligation arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow from the company of resources embodying economic benefits, however the timing or the amount is uncertain. Provisions are discounted when the effect of the time value of money is material using a pre-tax discount rate. The determination of provisions is an inherently uncertain process involving estimates regarding amounts and timing of cash flows.

Reorganisation provisions include employee termination benefits when the Group is demonstrably committed to either terminating the employment of current employees according to a detailed formal plan without possibility of withdrawal, or providing termination benefits as a result of an offer made to encourage voluntary redundancy.

INCOME RECOGNITION

Gross premium income

Premiums from life insurance policies are recognised as income when due from the policyholder. For non-life insurance policies, gross premium income is recognised on a pro-rata basis over the term of the related policy coverage. Receipts under investment contracts are not recognised as gross premium income.

Interest

Interest income and expense are recognised in the profit and loss account using the effective interest method. The effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or a financial liability and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the relevant period. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash payments or receipts through the expected life of the financial instrument or, when appropriate, a shorter period to the net carrying amount of the financial asset or financial liability. When calculating the effective interest rate, the Group estimates cash flows considering all contractual terms of the financial instrument (for example, prepayment options) but does not consider future credit losses. The calculation includes all fees and points paid or received between parties to the contract that are an integral part of the effective interest rate, transaction costs and all other premiums or discounts. Once a financial asset or a group of similar financial assets has been written down as a result of an impairment loss, interest income is recognised using the rate of interest used to discount the future cash flows for the purpose of measuring the impairment loss.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

All interest income and expenses from trading positions and non-trading derivatives are classified as interest income and interest expenses in the profit and loss account. Changes in the ‘clean fair value’ are included in Net trading income and Valuation results on non-trading derivatives.

Fees and commissions

Fees and commissions are generally recognised as the service is provided. Loan commitment fees for loans that are likely to be drawn down are deferred (together with related direct costs) and recognised as an adjustment to the effective interest rate on the loan. Loan syndication fees are recognised as income when the syndication has been completed and the Group has retained no part of the loan package for itself or has retained a part at the same effective interest rate as the other participants. Commission and fees arising from negotiating, or participating in the negotiation of, a transaction for a third party – such as the arrangement of the acquisition of shares or other securities or the purchase or sale of businesses – are recognised on completion of the underlying transaction. Portfolio and other management advisory and service fees are recognised based on the applicable service contracts as the service is provided. Asset management fees related to investment funds and investment contract fees are recognised on a pro-rata basis over the period the service is provided. The same principle is applied for wealth management, financial planning and custody services that are continuously provided over an extended period of time. Fees received and paid between banks for payment services are classified as commission income and expenses.

Lease income

The proceeds from leasing out assets under operating leases are recognised on a straight-line basis over the life of the lease agreement. Lease payments received in respect of finance leases when ING Group is the lessor are divided into an interest component (recognised as interest income) and a repayment component.

EXPENSE RECOGNITION

Expenses are recognised in the profit and loss account as incurred or when a decrease in future economic benefits related to a decrease in an asset or an increase in a liability has arisen that can be measured reliably.

Share-based payments

Share-based payment expenses are recognised as a staff expense over the vesting period. A corresponding increase in equity is recognised for equity-settled share-based payment transactions. A liability is recognised for cash-settled share-based payment transactions. The fair value of equity-settled share-based payment transactions is measured at the grant date and the fair value of cash-settled share-based payment transactions is measured at each balance sheet date. Rights granted will remain valid until the expiry date, even if the share based payment scheme is discontinued. The rights are subject to certain conditions, including a pre-determined continuous period of service.

GOVERNMENT GRANTS

Government grants are recognised where there is reasonable assurance that the grant will be received and all attached conditions will be complied with. When the grant relates to an expense item, the grant is recognised over the period necessary to match the grant on a systematic basis to the expense that it is intended to compensate. In such case, the grant is deducted from the related expense in the profit and loss account.

EARNINGS PER ORDINARY SHARE

Earnings per ordinary share is calculated on the basis of the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding. In calculating the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding:

 

 

Own shares held by group companies are deducted from the total number of ordinary shares in issue;

 

 

The computation is based on daily averages;

 

 

In case of exercised warrants, the exercise date is taken into consideration.

The non-voting equity securities are not ordinary shares, because their terms and conditions (especially with regard to coupons and voting rights) are significantly different. Therefore, the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the period is not impacted by the non-voting equity securities.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Diluted earnings per share data are computed as if all convertible instruments outstanding at year-end were exercised at the beginning of the period. It is also assumed that ING Group uses the assumed proceeds thus received to buy its own shares against the average market price in the financial year. The net increase in the number of shares resulting from the exercise is added to the average number of shares used to calculate diluted earnings per share.

Share options with fixed or determinable terms are treated as options in the calculation of diluted earnings per share, even though they may be contingent on vesting. They are treated as outstanding on the grant date. Performance-based employee share options are treated as contingently issuable shares because their issue is contingent upon satisfying specified conditions in addition to the passage of time.

FIDUCIARY ACTIVITIES

The Group commonly acts as trustee and in other fiduciary capacities that result in the holding or placing of assets on behalf of individuals, trusts, retirement benefit plans and other institutions. These assets and income arising thereon are excluded from these financial statements, as they are not assets of the Group.

STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

The statement of cash flows has been drawn up in accordance with the indirect method, classifying cash flows as cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities. In the net cash flow from operating activities, the result before tax is adjusted for those items in the profit and loss account, and changes in balance sheet items, which do not result in actual cash flows during the year.

For the purposes of the statement of cash flows, Cash and cash equivalents comprise balances with less than three months’ maturity from the date of acquisition, including cash and non-restricted balances with central banks, treasury bills and other eligible bills, amounts due from other banks and amounts due to banks. Investments qualify as a cash equivalent if they are readily convertible to a known amount of cash and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.

Cash flows arising from foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates at the date of the cash flows.

The net cash flow shown in respect of Loans and advances to customers relates only to transactions involving actual payments or receipts. The Addition to loan loss provision which is deducted from the item Loans and advances to customers in the balance sheet has been adjusted accordingly from the result before tax and is shown separately in the statement of cash flows.

The difference between the net cash flow in accordance with the statement of cash flows and the change in Cash and cash equivalents in the balance sheet is due to exchange rate differences and is accounted for separately as part of the reconciliation of the net cash flow and the balance sheet change in Cash and cash equivalents.

2.1.2 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED ANNUAL ACCOUNTS OF ING GROUP

ASSETS

1 Cash and balances with central banks

Cash and balances with central banks:

 

     2011      2010  

Amounts held at central banks

     26,481         7,983   

Cash and bank balances

     3,974         4,264   

Short term deposits insurance operations

     739         825   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     31,194         13,072   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-34


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2 Amounts due from banks

Amounts due from banks:

 

     Netherlands      International     Total  
     2011      2010      2011     2010     2011     2010  

Loans and advances to banks

     13,752         14,416         29,556        34,640        43,308        49,056   

Cash advances, overdrafts and other balances

     1,322         1,754         700        1,039        2,022        2,793   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     15,074         16,170         30,256        35,679        45,330        51,849   

Loan loss provisions

           (7     (21     (7     (21
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     15,074         16,170         30,249        35,658        45,323        51,828   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2011, Amounts due from banks included receivables with regard to securities which have been acquired in reverse repurchase transactions amounting to EUR 2,925 million (2010: EUR 4,621 million) and receivables related to finance lease contracts amounting to EUR 76 million (2010: EUR 82 million).

As at December 31, 2011, the balance sheet value included debt securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to nil (2010: nil) and EUR 2,267 million (2010: EUR 1,381 million), respectively.

As at December 31, 2011, the non-subordinated receivables amounted to EUR 45,304 million (2010: EUR 51,788 million) and the subordinated receivables amounted to EUR 19 million (2010: EUR 40 million).

No individual amount due from banks has terms and conditions that materially affect the amount, timing or certainty of consolidated cash flows of the Group. For details on significant concentrations see ‘Risk management’ section.

3 Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

 

     2011      2010  

Trading assets

     123,688         125,675   

Investments for risk of policyholders

     116,438         120,481   

Non-trading derivatives

     17,159         11,722   

Designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     5,437         6,016   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     262,722         263,894   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading assets by type

 

     2011      2010  

Equity securities

     3,732         5,861   

Debt securities

     18,251         27,979   

Derivatives

     59,139         42,390   

Loans and receivables

     42,566         49,445   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     123,688         125,675   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in trading derivatives and other non-trading derivatives for which no hedge accounting is applied is mainly due to changes in fair value resulting from changes in market interest rates. The increase is substantially mitigated by a similar increase in Trading derivates and Other non-trading derivatives (liabilities) as disclosed in Note 20 ‘Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss’.

As at December 31, 2011, the balance sheet value included equity securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to EUR 591 million (2010: EUR 69 million) and nil (2010: nil), respectively. As at December 31, 2011, the balance sheet value included debt securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to EUR 47 million (2010: EUR 65 million) and EUR 1,752 million (2010: EUR 667 million), respectively.

As at December 31, 2011, Trading assets included receivables of EUR 40,904 million (2010: EUR 47,894 million) with regard to reverse repurchase transactions.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Investments for risk of policyholders by type

 

     2011      2010  

Equity securities

     105,580         109,191   

Debt securities

     9,612         8,944   

Loans and receivables

     1,246         2,346   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     116,438         120,481   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The cost of investments for risk of policyholders as at December 31, 2011 was EUR 113,267 million (2010: EUR 113,879 million).

Investments in investment funds (with underlying investments in debt, equity securities, real estate and derivatives) are included under equity securities.

Non-trading derivatives by type

 

     2011      2010  

Derivatives used in

     

– fair value hedges

     3,192         4,127   

– cash flow hedges

     6,641         4,440   

– hedges of net investments in foreign operations

     141         81   

Other non-trading derivatives

     7,185         3,074   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     17,159         11,722   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other non-trading derivatives mainly include interest rate swaps for which no hedge accounting is applied.

Designated as at fair value through profit and loss by type

 

     2011      2010  

Equity securities

     45         392   

Debt securities

     2,967         3,672   

Loans and receivables

     1,000         570   

Other

     1,425         1,382   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     5,437         6,016   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Included in the Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss is a portfolio of loans and receivables which is economically hedged by credit derivatives. The hedges do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting and the loans are recorded at fair value to avoid an accounting mismatch. The maximum credit exposure of the loans and receivables included in Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss approximates its carrying value. The cumulative change in fair value of the loans attributable to changes in credit risk is not significant.

The notional value of the related credit derivatives is EUR 64 million (2010: EUR 205 million). The change in fair value of the credit derivatives attributable to changes in credit risk since the loans were first designated amounts was EUR (1) million (2010: nil) and the change for the current year was nil (2010: nil).

The changes in fair value of the (designated) loans attributable to changes in credit risk have been calculated by determining the changes in credit spread implicit in the fair value of bonds issued by entities with similar credit characteristics.

Other includes investments in private equity funds, hedge funds, other non-traditional investment vehicles and limited partnerships.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

4 Investments

Investments by type

 

     2011      2010  

Available-for-sale

     

– equity securities

     9,305         9,754   

– debt securities

     199,234         212,793   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     208,539         222,547   

Held-to-maturity

     

– debt securities

     8,868         11,693   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     8,868         11,693   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     217,407         234,240   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The fair value of the securities classified as held to maturity amounts to EUR 8,835 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 11,854 million).

Exposure to debt securities

ING Group’s exposure to debt securities is included in the following balance sheet lines:

Debt securities

 

     2011      2010  

Available-for-sale investments

     199,234         212,793   

Held-to-maturity investments

     8,868         11,693   

Loans and advances to customers

     29,117         34,251   

Due from banks

     7,321         8,122   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Available-for-sale investments and Assets at amortised cost

     244,540         266,859   

Trading assets

     18,251         27,979   

Investments for risk of policyholders

     9,612         8,944   

Designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     2,967         3,672   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     30,830         40,595   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     275,370         307,454   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-37


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Group’s total exposure to debt securities included in available-for-sale investments and assets at amortised cost of EUR 244,540 million (2010: EUR 266,859 million) is specified as follows by type of exposure and by banking and insurance operations:

Debt securities by type and balance sheet line (banking operations)

 

     Available-for-sale
investments
     Held-to-maturity
investments
    

Loans and

advances to

customers

    

Due from

banks

    

Total

Banking

operations

 
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010      2011     2010      2011      2010  

Government bonds

     47,256         49,973         881         950         1,081         1,037              49,218         51,960   

Covered bonds

     6,537         4,974         7,209         9,212         7,468         7,818         6,591        6,943         27,805         28,947   

Corporate bonds

     1,088         904               425         162              1,513         1,066   

Financial institution bonds

     15,192         24,015         421         425         134         244         736        1,179         16,483         25,863   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bond portfolio (excluding ABS)

     70,073         79,866         8,511         10,587         9,108         9,261         7,327        8,122         95,019         107,836   

US agency RMBS

     402         10,921            9                    402         10,930   

US prime RMBS

     18         706                          18         706   

US Alt-A RMBS

     156         2,431                          156         2,431   

US subprime RMBS

     22         87                          22         87   

Non-US RMBS

     1,127         1,382            50         9,551         13,245         (6        10,672         14,677   

CDO/CLO

     55         77               416         497              471         574   

Other ABS

     441         592         357         358         2,190         3,540              2,988         4,490   

CMBS

     175         397            689         1,171         1,323              1,346         2,409   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

ABS portfolio

     2,396         16,593         357         1,106         13,328         18,605         (6        16,075         36,304   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     72,469         96,459         8,868         11,693         22,436         27,866         7,321        8,122         111,094         144,140   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2011, Changes in debt securities (banking operations) include the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

Debt securities by type and balance sheet line (insurance operations)

 

     Available-for-sale
investments
    

Held-to-maturity

investments

   Loans and
advances to
customers
     Due from
banks
  

Total

Insurance

operations

 
     2011      2010      2011    2010    2011      2010      2011    2010    2011      2010  

Government bonds

     54,732         48,455                           54,732         48,455   

Covered bonds

     1,118         1,327                           1,118         1,327   

Corporate bonds

     45,260         38,404                           45,260         38,404   

Financial institution bonds

     11,700         13,047                           11,700         13,047   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bond portfolio (excluding ABS)

     112,810         101,233                           112,810         101,233   

US agency RMBS

     5,228         4,799                           5,228         4,799   

US prime RMBS

     1,380         1,625                           1,380         1,625   

US Alt-A RMBS

     295         358                           295         358   

US subprime RMBS

     752         1,560                           752         1,560   

Non-US RMBS

     513         571               4,515         4,603               5,028         5,174   

CDO/CLO

     183         329               505         402               688         731   

Other ABS

     1,459         1,317               1,346         1,112               2,805         2,429   

CMBS

     4,145         4,542               315         268               4,460         4,810   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

ABS portfolio

     13,955         15,101               6,681         6,385               20,636         21,486   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     126,765         116,334               6,681         6,385               133,446         122,719   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-38


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Debt securities by type and balance sheet line (total)

 

     Available-for-sale
investments
     Held-to-maturity
investments
     Loans and advances
to customers
    

Due from

banks

    

Total Banking

and Insurance
operations

 
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010      2011     2010      2011      2010  

Government bonds

     101,988         98,428         881         950         1,081         1,037              103,950         100,415   

Covered bonds

     7,655         6,301         7,209         9,212         7,468         7,818         6,591        6,943         28,923         30,274   

Corporate bonds

     46,348         39,308               425         162              46,773         39,470   

Financial institution bonds

     26,892         37,062         421         425         134         244         736        1,179         28,183         38,910   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bond portfolio (excluding ABS)

     182,883         181,099         8,511         10,587         9,108         9,261         7,327        8,122         207,829         209,069   

US agency RMBS

     5,630         15,720            9                    5,630         15,729   

US prime RMBS

     1,398         2,331                          1,398         2,331   

US Alt-A RMBS

     451         2,789                          451         2,789   

US subprime RMBS

     774         1,647                          774         1,647   

Non-US RMBS

     1,640         1,952            50         14,066         17,848         (6        15,700         19,850   

CDO/CLO

     238         406               921         899              1,159         1,305   

Other ABS

     1,900         1,910         357         358         3,536         4,652              5,793         6,920   

CMBS

     4,320         4,939            689         1,486         1,591              5,806         7,219   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

ABS portfolio

     16,351         31,694         357         1,106         20,009         24,990         (6        36,711         57,790   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     199,234         212,793         8,868         11,693         29,117         34,251         7,321        8,122         244,540         266,859   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Further comments on the ABS portfolio and the Bond portfolio (excluding ABS), including ABS and Greek, Italian, Irish, Portuguese and Spanish Government and unsecured Financial Institution bonds, is provided in the Risk management section under ‘ABS portfolio’ and ‘Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain’.

Asset backed security portfolio

The table below shows certain ABS (US Subprime RMBS, Alt-A RMBS, CMBS and CDO/CLOs) that were considered pressurised asset classes. It includes exposures in all relevant balance sheet lines, including not only loans and advances and investments available-for-sale as disclosed above, but also financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss.

Exposures, revaluations and losses on pressurised ABS bonds

 

     December 31, 2011     Change in 2011     December 31, 2010  
     Balance
sheet
value (1)
     Pre-tax
revaluation
reserve
    Changes
through
equity
(pre-tax)
    Changes
through
profit and
loss
(pre-tax)
    Other
changes
    Balance
sheet
value (1)
     Pre-tax
revaluation
reserve
 

US Subprime RMBS

     774         (190     37        (75     (835     1,647         (227

US Alt-A RMBS

     501         (15     (252     (93     (2,001     2,847         237   

CDO/CLOs

     1,390         (60     (51     (22     (67     1,530         (9

CMBS

     5,901         (464     69        (13     (1,485     7,330         (533
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pressurised ABS

     8,566         (729     (197     (203     (4,388     13,354         (532
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

For assets classified as loans and receivables: amortised cost; otherwise: fair value.

Other changes includes mainly redemptions/prepayments and the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

Reference is made to Note 34 ‘Fair value of financial assets and liabilities’ for disclosure by fair value hierarchy and Note 37 ‘Investment income’ for impairments on available-for-sale debt securities.

 

F-39


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain

In the first half of 2010 concerns arose regarding the creditworthiness of several southern European countries, which later spread to a few other European countries. As a result of these concerns the value of sovereign debt decreased and exposures in those countries are being monitored closely. With regard to troubled European countries, ING Group’s main focus is on Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain as these countries have either applied for support from the European Financial Stability Facility (‘EFSF’) or receive support from the ECB via government bond purchases in the secondary market. Within these countries, ING Group’s main focus is on exposure to Government bonds and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds. The following disclosure focuses in particular on ING Group’s balance sheet exposure with regard to Government bonds and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds in Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain. At December 31, 2011, ING Group’s balance sheet value of ‘Government bonds’ and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds to Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain and the related pre-tax revaluation reserve in equity was as follows:

Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain - Government bonds and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds (1)

 

2011    Balance
sheet
value
     Pre-tax
revaluation
reserve
    Pre-tax
impairments (2)
    Amortised
cost value
    

Fair value of
investments

held-to-maturity

 

Greece

            

Government bonds available-for-sale

     255         0        (940     1,195      

Italy

            

Government bonds available-for-sale

     2,033         (443     0        2,476      

Government bonds at amortised cost (loans)

     97             97      

Financial institutions available-for-sale

     684         (88       772      

Financial institutions at amortised cost (held-to-maturity)

     30             30         28   

Financial institutions at amortised cost (loans)

     131             131      

Ireland

            

Government bonds available-for-sale

     43         (10       53      

Financial institutions available-for-sale

     44         (1       45      

Financial institutions at amortised cost (held-to-maturity)

     34             34         35   

Financial institutions at amortised cost (loans)

     122             122      

Portugal

            

Government bonds available-for-sale

     533         (299       832      

Financial institutions available-for-sale

     125         (32       157      

Spain

            

Government bonds available–for-sale

     1,190         (203       1,393      

Government bonds at amortised cost (held-to-maturity)

     170             170         170   

Financial institutions available-for-sale

     277         (37       314      

Financial institutions at amortised cost (loans)

     85         (1       86      
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     5,853         (1,114     (940     7,907         233   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Exposures are included based on the parent country of the issuer.

(2) 

Pre-tax impairments relate to bonds held at December 31, 2011. In addition, EUR 38 million and EUR 189 million impairments were recognised in 2011 on Greek government bonds and Irish unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds that were no longer held at December 31, 2011. The total amount of impairments recognised on Greek Government bonds and Irish unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds in 2011 is therefore EUR 978 million and EUR 189 million as explained below.

The impact on ING Group’s revaluation reserve in relation to sovereign and unsecured financial institutions debt is limited per December 31, 2011: the negative impact on troubled countries is offset by opposite positive movements in bonds of financially stronger European countries and by the positive impact from lower interest rates in general. Furthermore, in the course of 2011, ING Group reduced its sovereign debt exposure to these troubled countries.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

On July 21,2011 a Private Sector Initiative to support Greece was announced. This initiative involves a voluntary exchange of existing Greek government bonds together with a Buyback Facility. Based on this initiative, ING Group impaired its Greek government bonds maturing up to 2020 in the second quarter of 2011 (Bank: EUR 187 million, Insurance: EUR 123 million). The decrease in market value in the third quarter of 2011 of these impaired bonds was recognised as re-impairment (Bank: EUR 90 million, Insurance: EUR 70 million). Due to the outcome of the EC meeting on October 26, 2011, the Greek government bonds maturing from 2020 were impaired in the third quarter of 2011 (Bank: EUR 177 million, Insurance: EUR 130 million). ING Group impaired all its Greek Government bonds to market value at December 31, 2011. This resulted in a re-impairment in the fourth quarter of 2011 of EUR 200 million (Bank: EUR 133 million, Insurance: EUR 67 million), bringing the total impairments on Greek government bonds to EUR 978 million (Bank: EUR 588 million, Insurance: EUR 390 million). The total Greek government bond portfolio has now been written down by approximately 80%.

In 2011 ING Insurance recognised a total impairment of EUR 189 million on subordinated debt from Irish banks.

Reference is made to Note 34 ‘Fair value of financial assets and liabilities’ for disclosure by fair value hierarchy and Note 37 ‘Investment income’ for impairments on available-for-sale debt securities.

Further information on ING Group’s risk exposure with regard to Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain is provided in the ‘Risk management’ section.

Changes in available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investments

 

    

Available-for-sale

equity securities

   

Available-for-sale

debt securities

    Held-to-maturity     Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     9,754        8,853        212,793        188,850        11,693        14,409        234,240        212,112   

Additions

     1,525        2,381        222,020        160,658          141        223,545        163,180   

Amortisation

         (226     (103     (14     (13     (240     (116

Transfers and reclassifications

     1,288        12          282          (282     1,288        12   

Changes in the composition of the group and other changes

     (188     (5     (23,232     (23     (444       (23,864     (28

Changes in unrealised revaluations

     (845     642        5,645        5,000            4,800        5,642   

Impairments

     (253     (75     (1,485     (735         (1,738     (810

Reversals of impairments

         79        11            79        11   

Disposals and redemptions

     (2,023     (2,228     (219,023     (150,569     (2,370     (2,620     (223,416     (155,417

Exchange rate differences

     47        174        2,663        9,422        3        58        2,713        9,654   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     9,305        9,754        199,234        212,793        8,868        11,693        217,407        234,240   

In 2011, Changes in the composition of the group and other changes relates mainly to the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

Reference is made to Note 37 ‘Investment income’ for details on Impairments.

Transfers and reclassifications of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investments

 

    

Available-for-sale

equity securities

    

Available-for-sale

debt securities

     Held-to-maturity     Total  
     2011      2010      2011    2010      2011    2010     2011      2010  

To/from held-to-maturity

              282                 282   

To/from available-for-sale

                    (282        (282

To/from investment in associates

     1,288         12                    1,288         12   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

 

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,288         12            282            (282     1,288         12   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  

 

 

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2011, To/from investment in associates in relation to available-for-sale equity securities relates mainly to the real estate funds for which significant influence ceased to exist due to the sale of ING Real Estate Investment Management.

 

F-41


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Held-to-maturity debt securities – sale and reclassification to available-for-sale investments (2010)

In the second quarter of 2010 EUR 51 million of Greek government bonds that were classified as held-to-maturity investments were sold. Furthermore, EUR 282 million of Greek government bonds were reclassified from held-to-maturity to available-for-sale investments. As the decisions to sell and reclassify were based on the significant deterioration in the issuer’s creditworthiness compared to the credit rating at initial recognition, this sale and reclassification does not impact the intent for the remainder of the held-to-maturity investment portfolio.

Reclassifications to Loans and advances to customers and Amounts due from banks (2009 and 2008)

Reclassifications out of available-for-sale investments to loans and receivables are allowed under IFRS-IASB as of the third quarter of 2008. In the second and first quarter of 2009 and in the fourth quarter of 2008 ING Group reclassified certain financial assets from Investments available-for-sale to Loans and advances to customers and Amounts due from banks. The Group identified assets, eligible for reclassification, for which at the reclassification date it had the intention to hold for the foreseeable future. The table below provides information on the three reclassifications made in the fourth quarter of 2008 and the first and second quarter of 2009. Information is provided for each of the three reclassifications (see columns) as at the date of reclassification and as at the end of the subsequent reporting periods (see rows). This information is disclosed under IFRS-IASB as long as the reclassified assets continue to be recognised in the balance sheet.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Reclassifications to Loans and advances to customers and Amounts due from banks

 

     Q2 2009     Q1 2009     Q4 2008  

As per reclassification date

      

Fair value

     6,135        22,828        1,594   

Range of effective interest rates (weighted average)

     1.4%–24.8     2.1%–11.7     4.1%–21

Expected recoverable cash flows

     7,118        24,052        1,646   

Unrealised fair value losses in shareholders’ equity (before tax)

     (896     (1,224     (69

Recognised fair value gains (losses) in shareholders’ equity (before tax) between the beginning of the year in which the reclassification took place and the reclassification date

     173        nil        (79

Recognised fair value gains (losses) in shareholders’ equity (before tax) in the year prior to reclassification

     (971     (192     (20

Recognised impairment (before tax) between the beginning of the year in which the reclassification took place and the reclassification date

     nil        nil        nil   

Recognised impairment (before tax) in the year prior to reclassification

     nil        nil        nil   

Impact on the financial years after reclassification:

      

2011

      

Carrying value as at December 31,

     6,734        14,419        633   

Fair value as at December 31,

     6,524        13,250        648   

Unrealised fair value losses recognised in shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31,

     (307     (446     (8

Effect on shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31, if reclassification had not been made

     (210     (1,169     15   

Effect on result (before tax) if reclassification had not been made

     nil        nil        nil   

Effect on result (before tax) for the year (mainly interest income)

     127        390        28   

Recognised impairments (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

Recognised provision for credit losses (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

2010

      

Carrying value as at December 31,

     6,418        16,906        857   

Fair value as at December 31,

     6,546        16,099        889   

Unrealised fair value losses recognised in shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31,

     (491     (633     (65

Effect on shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31, if reclassification had not been made

     128        (807     32   

Effect on result (before tax) if reclassification had not been made

     nil        nil        nil   

Effect on result (before tax) for the year (mainly interest income)

     78        467        34   

Recognised impairments (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

Recognised provision for credit losses (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

2009

      

Carrying value as at December 31,

     6,147        20,551        1,189   

Fair value as at December 31,

     6,472        20,175        1,184   

Unrealised fair value losses in shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31,

     (734     (902     (67

Effect on shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31, if reclassification had not been made

     325        (376     (5

Effect on result (before tax) if reclassification had not been made

     nil        nil        nil   

Effect on result (before tax) after the reclassification until December 31, (mainly interest income)

     54        629        n/a   

Effect on result (before tax) for the year (mainly interest income)

     n/a        n/a        47   

Recognised impairments (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

Recognised provision for credit losses (before tax)

     nil        nil        nil   

2008

      

Carrying value as at December 31,

         1,592   

Fair value as at December 31,

         1,565   

Unrealised fair value losses recognised in shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31,

         (79

Effect on shareholders’ equity (before tax) as at December 31, if reclassification had not been made

         (27

Effect on result (before tax) if reclassification had not been made

         nil   

Effect on result (before tax) after the reclassification until December 31, (mainly interest income)

         9   

Recognised impairments (before tax)

         nil   

Recognised provision for credit losses (before tax)

         nil   

 

F-43


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Available-for-sale equity securities by banking and insurance operations

 

     Listed      Unlisted             Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Banking operations

     1,722         2,159         744         582         2,466         2,741   

Insurance operations

     3,807         4,438         3,032         2,575         6,839         7,013   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     5,529         6,597         3,776         3,157         9,305         9,754   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Debt securities by banking and insurance operations

 

     Available-for-sale      Held-to-maturity             Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Banking operations

     72,469         96,459         8,868         11,693         81,337         108,152   

Insurance operations

     126,765         116,334               126,765         116,334   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     199,234         212,793         8,868         11,693         208,102         224,486   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2011, the balance sheet value included equity securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to nil (2010: nil) and nil (2010: nil), respectively, and debt securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to EUR 909 million (2010: EUR 3,302 million) and EUR 21,183 million (2010: EUR 14,617 million), respectively.

Investments in connection with the insurance operations with a combined carrying value of nil (2010: EUR 6 million) did not produce any income for the year ended December 31, 2011.

5 Loans and advances to customers

Loans and advances to customers by banking and insurance operations

 

     2011     2010  

Banking operations

     572,271        584,773   

Insurance operations

     32,972        31,065   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     605,243        615,838   

Eliminations

     (8,366     (6,900
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     596,877        608,938   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans and advances to customers by type – banking operations

 

     Netherlands     International     Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Loans to, or guaranteed by, public authorities

     29,281        28,671        25,867        27,282        55,148        55,953   

Loans secured by mortgages

     162,734        157,672        160,404        172,801        323,138        330,473   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     379        308        8,260        8,356        8,639        8,664   

Personal lending

     5,012        5,125        19,389        16,618        24,401        21,743   

Asset backed securities

         13,328        18,605        13,328        18,605   

Corporate loans

     48,851        53,785        103,709        100,724        152,560        154,509   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     246,257        245,561        330,957        344,386        577,214        589,947   

Loan loss provisions

     (2,002     (1,932     (2,941     (3,242     (4,943     (5,174
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     244,255        243,629        328,016        341,144        572,271        584,773   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans and advances to customers analysed by subordination – banking operations

 

     2011      2010  

Non-subordinated

     566,672         579,350   

Subordinated

     5,599         5,423   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     572,271         584,773   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2011, the balance sheet value included debt securities which were lent or sold in repurchase transactions amounting to nil (2010: nil) and EUR 1,778 million (2010: EUR 727 million), respectively.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Loans and advances to customers by type – insurance operations

 

     Netherlands     International           Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Policy loans

     44        47        3,308        3,180        3,352        3,227   

Loans secured by mortgages

     6,450        6,594        7,692        7,169        14,142        13,763   

Unsecured loans

     2,187        3,046        5,135        3,137        7,322        6,183   

Asset backed securities

     6,681        6,385            6,681        6,385   

Other

     355        442        1,244        1,182        1,599        1,624   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     15,717        16,514        17,379        14,668        33,096        31,182   

Loan loss provisions

     (80     (71     (44     (46     (124     (117
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     15,637        16,443        17,335        14,622        32,972        31,065   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2011, Loans and advances to customers included receivables with regard to securities which have been acquired in reverse repurchase transactions related to the banking operations amounting to EUR 1,228 million (2010: EUR 1,609 million).

No individual loan or advance has terms and conditions that materially affect the amount, timing or certainty of the consolidated cash flows of the Group. For details on significant concentrations see ‘Risk management’ section.

Loans and advances to customers and Amounts due from banks include finance lease receivables, are detailed as follows:

Finance lease receivables

 

     2011     2010  

Maturities of gross investment in finance lease receivables

    

– within 1 year

     5,386        5,060   

– more than 1 year but less than 5 years

     9,407        9,700   

– more than 5 years

     5,875        6,089   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     20,668        20,849   

Unearned future finance income on finance leases

     (3,228     (3,328
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in finance leases

     17,440        17,521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Maturities of net investment in finance lease receivables

    

– within 1 year

     4,697        4,363   

– more than 1 year but less than 5 years

     8,035        8,294   

– more than 5 years

     4,708        4,864   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     17,440        17,521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Included in Amounts due from banks

     76        82   

Included in Loans and advances to customers

     17,364        17,439   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     17,440        17,521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The allowance for uncollectible finance lease receivables included in the loan loss provisions amounted to EUR 223 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 177 million).

No individual finance lease receivable has terms and conditions that materially affect the amount, timing or certainty of the consolidated cash flows of the Group.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Loan loss provisions analysed by type – banking operations

 

     Netherlands      International      Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Loans to, or guaranteed by, public authorities

     1            2         3         3         3   

Loans secured by mortgages

     503         416         712         1,183         1,215         1,599   

Loans guaranteed by credit institutions

     4         1         5         22         9         23   

Personal lending

     119         131         597         536         716         667   

Asset backed securities

           2            2      

Corporate loans

     1,375         1,384         1,630         1,519         3,005         2,903   

Other

                 
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,002         1,932         2,948         3,263         4,950         5,195   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The closing balance is included in

                 

– Amounts due from banks

           7         21         7         21   

– Loans and advances to customers

     2,002         1,932         2,941         3,242         4,943         5,174   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,002         1,932         2,948         3,263         4,950         5,195   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in loan loss provisions

 

     Banking
operations
    Insurance
operations
    Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     5,195        4,399        117        111        5,312        4,510   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (3       (2       (5  

Write-offs

     (1,304     (1,166     (24     (42     (1,328     (1,208

Recoveries

     112        105        2        1        114        106   

Increase in loan loss provisions

     1,670        1,751        33        41        1,703        1,792   

Exchange rate differences

     (83     155        (2     6        (85     161   

Other changes

     (637     (49         (637     (49
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     4,950        5,195        124        117        5,074        5,312   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The increase in loan loss provisions relating to insurance operations is presented under Investment income. The increase in the loan loss provisions relating to banking operations is presented under Addition to loan loss provisions on the face of the profit and loss account.

In 2011, Other changes relates for EUR 565 million to the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

6 Investments in associates

Investments in associates

 

2011   

Interest

held (%)

    

Fair value

of listed
investment

    

Balance

sheet

value

    

Total

assets

    

Total

liabilities

    

Total

income

    

Total

expenses

 

TMB Public Company Limited

     30         509         580         16,100         14,847         377         301   

Sul America S.A.

     36         641         394         5,353         4,292         3,941         3,662   

CBRE Retail Property Fund Iberica LP

     29            147         1,666         1,146         96         65   

CBRE Lionbrook Property Partnership LP

     27            102         604         225         50         17   

CBRE Property Fund Central Europe LP

     25            90         897         536         87         4   

ING Real Estate Asia Retail Fund

     26            87         868         512         81         37   

CBRE French Residential Fund C.V.

     42            78         249         65         24         8   

The Capital (London) Fund

     20            77         387         3         14         3   

CBRE Retail Property Fund France Belgium C.V.

     15            73         1,374         889         117         57   

CBRE Nordic Property Fund FGR

     14            60         1,079         662         92         67   

CBRE Property Fund Central and Eastern Europe

     21            51         747         509         122         57   

Other investments in associates

           631               
        

 

 

             
           2,370               
        

 

 

             

Other investments in associates represents a large number of associates with an individual balance sheet value of less than EUR 50 million.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Accumulated impairments of EUR 38 million (2010: EUR 71 million) have been recognised.

As a result of the sale of ING Real Estate Investment Management in 2011, as disclosed in Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’, ING is no longer the investment manager of certain funds. For some of the funds significant influence therefore ceased to exist. Significant influence remained for certain funds in which the interest held is below 20% based on the combination of ING Group’s financial interest for own risk and other arrangements, such as participation in the advisory board.

The values presented in the table above could differ from the values presented in the individual annual accounts of the associates, due to the fact that the individual values have been brought in line with ING Group’s accounting principles.

In general, the reporting dates of all material associates are consistent with the reporting date of the Group. However, for practical reasons, the reporting dates of certain associates differ slightly from with the reporting date of the Group, but, in any case, the difference between the reporting date of the associates and that of the Group is no more than three months.

Where the listed fair value is lower than the balance sheet value, an impairment review and an evaluation of the going concern basis has been performed.

Investments in associates

 

2010   

Interest

held (%)

    

Fair value

of listed
investment

    

Balance

sheet

value

    

Total

assets

    

Total

liabilities

    

Total

income

    

Total

expenses

 

TMB Public Company Limited

     30         773         565         14,055         12,826         321         262   

Sul America S.A.

     36         948         388         5,223         4,178         3,749         3,307   

CBRE DRET Master Fund C.V. (1)

     15            201         1,643         267         146         34   

CBRE DOF Master Fund I C.V. (1)

     16            195         1,480         268         67         24   

CBRE Retail Property Fund Iberica LP (1)

     29            144         1,635         1,122         149         86   

CBRE DRES Master Fund C.V. (1)

     13            111         1,004         180         52         20   

ING Real Estate Asia Retail Fund

     28            107         782         450         51         53   

CBRE DOF Master Fund II C.V. (1)

     16            101         755         129         45         29   

CBRE Lionbrook Property Partnership LP (1)

     21            96         620         171         77         19   

CBRE Vastgoed Kantoren C.V. (1)

     10            90         945         46         75         40   

CBRE Vastgoed Winkels C.V. (1)

     10            89         900         5         90         20   

Lion Properties Fund

     4            86         3,412         1,428         1,606         1,150   

Lion Industrial Trust

     8            85         2,691         1,583         247         130   

ING Industrial Fund Australia

     8         81         85         1,830         756         162         86   

CBRE French Residential Fund C.V. (1)

     45            76         233         63         20         8   

CBRE Property Fund Central Europe LP (1)

     25            74         806         510         66         37   

Steadfast Capital Fund II LP

     68            74         145            3         2   

CBRE Retail Property Fund France. Belgium C.V. (1)

     15            70         1,382         916         102         56   

Lion Value Fund

     30            69         341         109         53         10   

CBRE DRES Master Fund II C.V. (1)

     13            63         612         143         22         18   

CBRE Nordic Property Fund FGR (1)

     15            61         940         543         81         59   

ING REI Investment DOF B.V.

     3            59         2,235         414         199         175   

CBRE Retail Property Partnership Southern Europe C.V. (1)

     21            52         1,001         759         48         67   

CBRE European Industrial Fund C.V. (1)

     15            50         647         308         42         28   

Other investments in associates

           934               
        

 

 

             
           3,925               
        

 

 

             

 

(1) 

The name of this associate changed in 2011.

 

F-47


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in Investments in associates

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     3,925        3,699   

Additions

     140        165   

Changes in the composition of the group

     16        (26

Transfers to and from Investments

     (1,288     (12

Revaluations

     (19     (2

Share of results

     241        314   

Dividends received

     (174     (229

Disposals

     (383     (232

Impairments

     (20     (3

Exchange rate differences

     (68     251   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,370        3,925   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2011, Transfers to and from Investments relates mainly to the real estate funds for which significant influence ceased to exist due to the sale of ING Real Estate Investment Management.

In 2011, share of results of EUR 241 million (2010: EUR 314 million) and impairments of EUR 20 million (2010: EUR 3 million) are presented in the profit and loss account in Share of result from associates for EUR 221 million (2010: EUR 311 million).

7 Real estate investments

Changes in real estate investments

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     1,900        3,638   

Additions

     32        73   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (88     (1,632

Transfers to and from Property in own use

     (31  

Transfers to and from Other assets

       (23

Fair value gains/(losses)

     (19     (98

Disposals

     (118     (295

Exchange rate differences

     (6     237   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,670        1,900   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2010, Changes in the composition of the group comprises the sale of ING Summit Industrial Fund LP. Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’.

Real estate investments by banking and insurance operations

 

     2011      2010  

Banking operations

     716         837   

Insurance operations

     954         1,063   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,670         1,900   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The total amount of rental income recognised in the profit and loss account for the year ended December 31, 2011 was EUR 184 million (2010: EUR 304 million). The total amount of contingent rent recognised in the profit and loss account for the year ended December 31, 2011 was nil (2010: EUR 14 million).

The total amount of direct operating expenses (including repairs and maintenance) in relation to Real estate investments that generated rental income for the year ended December 31, 2011 was EUR 101 million (2010: EUR 113 million). The total amount of direct operating expenses (including repairs and maintenance) incurred on Real estate investments that did not generate rental income for the year ended December 31, 2011 was EUR 3 million (2010: EUR 6 million).

 

F-48


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Real estate investments by year of most recent appraisal by independent qualified valuers:

 

in percentages    2011  

Most recent appraisal in 2011

     93   

Most recent appraisal in 2010

     7   
  

 

 

 
     100   
  

 

 

 

ING Group’s real estate is included in the following balance sheet lines:

Real estate exposure

 

     2011      2010  

Real estate investments

     1,670         1,900   

Investments in associates

     1,193         2,568   

Other assets – property development and obtained from foreclosures

     1,584         2,153   

Property and equipment – property in own use

     1,535         1,642   

Investments – available-for-sale

     1,773         633   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     7,755         8,896   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Furthermore, the exposure is impacted by third party interests, leverage in funds and off-balance commitments, resulting in an overall exposure of EUR 10.0 billion (2010: EUR 11.1 billion) of which EUR 4.1 billion (2010: EUR 5.2 billion) relates to banking operations and EUR 5.9 billion (2010: EUR 5.9 billion) relates to insurance operations. Reference is made to the section ‘Risk management’.

8 Property and equipment

Property and equipment by type

 

     2011      2010  

Property in own use

     1,535         1,642   

Equipment

     1,345         1,435   

Assets under operating leases

     6         3,055   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,886         6,132   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Property in own use by banking and insurance operations

 

     2011      2010  

Banking operations

     1,244         1,329   

Insurance operations

     291         313   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,535         1,642   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-49


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in property in own use

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     1,642        1,686   

Additions

     41        51   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (28  

Transfers to and from Real estate investments

     31     

Transfers to and from Other assets

     (31     (4

Depreciation

     (28     (31

Revaluations

     (21     (20

Impairments

     (29     (27

Reversal of impairments

     11        5   

Disposals

     (27     (43

Exchange rate differences

     (26     25   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,535        1,642   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount as at December 31,

     2,366        2,487   

Accumulated depreciation as at December 31,

     (674     (700

Accumulated impairments as at December 31,

     (157     (145
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value as at December 31,

     1,535        1,642   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revaluation surplus

    

Opening balance

     528        531   

Revaluation in year

     (28     (3

Released in year

     (2  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     498        528   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The cost or the purchase price amounted to EUR 1,868 million (2010: EUR 1,959 million). Cost or the purchase price less accumulated depreciation and impairments would have been EUR 1,036 million (2010: EUR 1,114 million) had property in own use been valued at cost instead of at fair value.

Property in own use by year of most recent appraisal by independent qualified valuers:

 

in percentages    2011  

Most recent appraisal in 2011

     54   

Most recent appraisal in 2010

     13   

Most recent appraisal in 2009

     10   

Most recent appraisal in 2008

     15   

Most recent appraisal in 2007

     8   
  

 

 

 
     100   
  

 

 

 

Changes in equipment

 

    

Data

processing
equipment

   

Fixtures and
fittings

and other
equipment

    Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     376        344        1,059        1,098        1,435        1,442   

Additions

     191        192        267        284        458        476   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (11     (4     (29     (7     (40     (11

Disposals

     (16     (12     (24     (41     (40     (53

Depreciation

     (176     (167     (236     (262     (412     (429

Impairments

       (1     (1       (1     (1

Exchange rate differences

     (6     12        (14     20        (20     32   

Other changes

     5        12        (40     (33     (35     (21
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     363        376        982        1,059        1,345        1,435   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount as at December 31,

     1,659        1,707        2,620        2,642        4,279        4,349   

Accumulated depreciation as at December 31,

     (1,295     (1,330     (1,638     (1,583     (2,933     (2,913

Accumulated impairments as at December 31,

     (1     (1         (1     (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value as at December 31,

     363        376        982        1,059        1,345        1,435   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-50


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in assets under operating leases

 

     Cars     Other leased-out
assets
    Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     3,053        2,986        2        5        3,055        2,991   

Additions

     1,188        1,284            1,188        1,284   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (3,250     (3         (3,250     (3

Disposals

     (43     (53         (43     (53

Depreciation

     (594     (784     (2     (3     (596     (787

Exchange rate differences

     (12     13            (12     13   

Transfer and other changes

     (336     (390         (336     (390
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     6        3,053          2        6        3,055   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount as at December 31,

     16        4,617          18        16        4,635   

Accumulated depreciation as at December 31,

     (10     (1,564       (16     (10     (1,580
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value as at December 31,

     6        3,053          2        6        3,055   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2011, Changes in the composition of the group comprises the sale of ING Car Lease. Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’.

Transfer and other changes relates mainly to the transfer of cars under operating lease to Other assets due to the expiration of the lease contract.

Depreciation of assets under operating leases is included in the profit and loss account in Other income as a deduction from operating lease income.

No individual operating lease has terms and conditions that materially affect the amount, timing or certainty of the consolidated cash flows of the Group.

The Group leases assets to third parties under operating leases as lessor. The future minimum lease payments to be received under non–cancellable operating leases are as follows:

Future minimum lease payments by maturity

 

     2011      2010  

Within 1 year

     1         1,155   

More than 1 year but less than 5 years

     4         1,887   

More than 5 years

     1         13   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     6         3,055   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-51


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

9 INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Changes in intangible assets

 

    

Value of

business

acquired

    Goodwill     Software     Other     Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     1,320        1,502        2,765        3,071        754        803        533        645        5,372        6,021   

Additions

             207        223        2        1        209        224   

Capitalised expenses

     81        90            131        148            212        238   

Amortisation and unlocking

     (244     (113         (391     (358     (87     (118     (722     (589

Impairments

         (32     (540     (49     (31     (1       (82     (571

Effect of unrealised revaluations in equity

     (250     (286                 (250     (286

Changes in the composition of the group

     (43       (680     11        (5     (49     (126     (19     (854     (57

Exchange rate differences

     7        127        (212     238        (8     13        (26     48        (239     426   

Disposals

           (7     (9     5          (12     (9     (14

Other

         (47     (8     (19       (13     (12     (79     (20
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     871        1,320        1,794        2,765        611        754        282        533        3,558        5,372   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount as at December 31,

     2,244        2,449        2,436        3,370        2,597        2,557        570        1,013        7,847        9,389   

Accumulated amortisation as at December 31,

     (1,373     (1,129         (1,926     (1,751     (242     (426     (3,541     (3,306

Accumulated impairments as at December 31,

         (642     (605     (60     (52     (46     (54     (748     (711
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value as at December 31,

     871        1,320        1,794        2,765        611        754        282        533        3,558        5,372   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amortisation of software and other intangible assets is included in the profit and loss account in Other operating expenses and Intangible amortisation and other impairments. Amortisation of VOBA is included in Underwriting expenditure.

Goodwill

Changes in Goodwill

A goodwill impairment of EUR 32 million was recognised in 2011. The impairment relates to the reporting unit ING Real Estate. A goodwill impairment of EUR 540 million was recognised in 2010. The impairment relates to the reporting unit Insurance US. In 2011, Changes in composition of the group relates mainly to the disposal of ING Car Lease and the disposal of the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations. Other changes includes EUR 97 million related to the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

Allocation of Goodwill to reporting units

Goodwill is allocated to reporting units as follows:

Goodwill allocation to reporting units

 

     2011      2010  

Retail Central Europe

     738         870   

Retail Belgium

     50         49   

Retail Netherlands

     1         1   

ING Direct

     364         468   

Commercial Banking – Lease

     11         68   

ING Real Estate

        32   

Commercial Banking – Other

     14         14   

Insurance Benelux

     48         48   

Insurance Central & Rest of Europe

     112         123   

Insurance Latin America

        680   

Insurance Asia/Pacific – South Korea

     192         192   

Insurance Asia/Pacific – Rest of Asia

     44         2   

ING Investment Management

     220         218   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,794         2,765   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-52


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Goodwill impairment testing

Goodwill is tested for impairment at the lowest level at which it is monitored for internal management purposes. This level is defined as the so called ‘reporting units’ as set out above. Goodwill is tested for impairment by comparing the carrying value of the reporting unit to the best estimate of the recoverable amount of that reporting unit. The carrying value is determined as the IFRS-IASB net asset value including goodwill. The recoverable amount is estimated as the higher of fair value less cost to sell and value in use. Several methodologies are applied to arrive at the best estimate of the recoverable amount.

As a first step of the impairment test, the best estimate of the recoverable amount of reporting units to which goodwill is allocated is determined separately for each relevant reporting unit based on Price to Earnings, Price to Book, and Price to Assets under management ratios. The main assumptions in this valuation are the multiples for Price to Earnings, Price to Book and Price to Assets under management; these are developed internally but are either derived from or corroborated against market information that is related to observable transaction in the market for comparable businesses. Earnings and carrying values are equal to or derived from the relevant measure under IFRS-IASB. If the outcome of this first step indicates that the difference between recoverable amount and carrying value may not be sufficient to support the amount of goodwill allocated to the reporting unit, an additional analysis is performed in order to determine a recoverable amount in a manner that better addresses the specific characteristics of the relevant reporting unit.

More details on this additional analysis and the outcome thereof are presented below for each of the relevant reporting units. For other reporting units, the goodwill allocated to these reporting units was fully supported in the first step.

ING Real Estate

During 2011 the ING Real Estate business changed significantly. The Real Estate Development business was reduced by selling/closing development projects and ING sold REIM (the ING Real Estate Investment Management business). As a consequence, there were indications in the fourth quarter of 2011 that the recoverable amount of the reporting unit ING Real Estate had fallen below book value. A full goodwill impairment review was performed for the reporting unit ING Real Estate in the fourth quarter of 2011. The reporting unit Real Estate equals the segment ING Real Estate as disclosed in Note 51 ‘Operating segments’. The 2010 impairment test for ING Real Estate showed that the recoverable amount based on fair value using market multiples for Price/Book was at least equal to book value. The outcome of the impairment test performed in the fourth quarter of 2011 indicated that the fair value has become less than book value by an amount that exceeded the goodwill of ING Real Estate, indicating that the full amount of goodwill relating to ING Real Estate is impaired. As a result, the goodwill of EUR 32 million (pre-tax) was written down. The related charge is included in the profit and loss account in the line Intangibles amortisation and other impairments. Goodwill is recognised in the Corporate Line segment and, therefore, this charge is included in the segment reporting in the Corporate Line Bank segment.

Retail Central Europe

For the reporting unit Retail Central Europe the recoverable amount is determined as the sum of the recoverable amounts of the most important components. For certain components, a market price is available based on listed equity securities. In such case, the listed market price is used to determine the recoverable amount. For certain other components, the recoverable amount is determined by a cash flow model taking into account recent market related developments. The most important assumptions in the model are the estimated expected profit based on internal financial budgets/forecasts (4 years medium term plan plus additional 2 years longer term forecast), the terminal growth rate thereafter (approximately 3.5%), the required capital level (ultimately migrating to approximately 10%) and the discount rate (between approximately 10% and 13%). It was concluded that the goodwill allocated to Retail Central Europe is not impaired.

 

F-53


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Insurance US

Due to the unfavourable market circumstances for Insurance, including the low interest rate environment, there were indications in the third quarter of 2010 that the recoverable amount of the reporting unit Insurance US had fallen below carrying value. As a result, a full goodwill impairment review was performed for the reporting unit Insurance US in the third quarter of 2010. The reporting unit Insurance US equals the segment Insurance US as disclosed in Note 51 ‘Operating segments’. The 2009 impairment test for Insurance US showed that the recoverable amount based on fair value (using market multiples for Price/Book and Price/Earnings of listed peer companies) was at least equal to carrying value. The outcome of the impairment test performed in the third quarter of 2010 indicated that the fair value has become less than carrying value by an amount that exceeded the goodwill of Insurance US, indicating that the full amount of goodwill relating to Insurance US is impaired. Further analysis of the recoverable amount confirmed the impairment. As a result, the goodwill of EUR 540 million (pre-tax) was written down. The related charge is included in the profit and loss account in the line ‘Intangibles amortisation and other impairments’. Goodwill is recognised in the Corporate Line segment and, therefore, this charge is included in the segment reporting in the Corporate Line Insurance segment.

10 Deferred acquisition costs

Changes in deferred acquisition costs

 

     Life insurance     Non-life
insurance
    Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     10,457        11,165        42        43        10,499        11,208   

Capitalised

     1,575        1,550        12        12        1,587        1,562   

Amortisation and unlocking

     (1,689     (2,684     (13     (13     (1,702     (2,697

Effect of unrealised revaluations in equity

     (526     (765         (526     (765

Changes in the composition of the group

     44        (5     (2       42        (5

Exchange rate differences

     304        1,194            304        1,194   

Disposal of portfolios

       2              2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     10,165        10,457        39        42        10,204        10,499   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For flexible life insurance contracts the growth rate assumption used to calculate the amortisation of the deferred acquisition costs for 2011 is 8.4% gross and 4.2% net of investment management fees (2010: 8.3% gross and 4.8% net of investment management fees).

In 2011, Amortisation and unlocking include EUR 488 million relating to the assumption review for the Insurance US Closed Block Variable Annuity (VA) business. Reference is made to Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’.

Amortisation and unlocking in 2010 includes a EUR 975 million DAC write-off as explained in Note 51 ‘Operating segments’. The remaining amount includes unlocking of EUR (538) million, which mainly relates to Insurance US and amortisation of EUR (1,184) million.

11 Assets and liabilities held for sale

Assets and liabilities held for sale include disposal groups whose carrying amount will be recovered principally through a sale transaction rather than through continuing operations. This relates to businesses for which a sale is agreed upon or a sale is highly probable at the balance sheet date but for which the transaction has not yet fully closed. For December 31, 2011 this relates to ING Direct USA. For December 31, 2010 this relates mainly to Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd., ING Arrendadora S.A. de C.V., ING Real Estate Investment Management (ING REIM) and Clarion Real Estate Securities. Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’ for more details on occurred and expected significant disposals.

Assets held for sale

 

     2011      2010  

Cash and balances with central banks

     4,980         28   

Amounts due from banks

     314      

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     3         16   

Available-for-sale investments

     22,605         144   

Held-to-maturity investments

     444      

 

F-54


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

Loans and advances to customers

     31,805         244   

Investments in associates

        43   

Property and equipment

     75         12   

Intangible assets

     166         15   

Deferred acquisition costs

        43   

Other assets

     2,091         136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     62,483         681   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities held for sale

 

     2011      2010  

Other borrowed funds

        35   

Insurance and investments contracts

        217   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     64,103      

Other liabilities

     162         172   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     64,265         424   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cumulative other comprehensive income includes EUR 244 million (2010: EUR 7 million) related to Assets and liabilities held for sale.

In addition to the entities presented as Held for sale above, ING is considering potential divestments, including those that are listed under the European Commission Restructuring plan in Note 33 ‘Related parties’. However, none of these businesses qualify as held for sale as at December 31, 2011 as the potential divestments are not yet available for immediate sale in their present condition and/or a sale is not yet highly probable to occur.

12 Other assets

Other assets by type

 

     2011      2010  

Reinsurance and insurance receivables

     1,971         2,201   

Deferred tax assets

     2,801         3,425   

Property development and obtained from foreclosures

     1,584         2,153   

Income tax receivable

     542         527   

Accrued interest and rents

     14,387         16,194   

Other accrued assets

     2,200         2,888   

Pension assets

     3,762         3,458   

Other

     3,769         5,623   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     31,016         36,469   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other includes EUR 1,840 million (2010: EUR 1,875 million) related to transactions still to be settled at balance sheet date.

Disclosures in respect of deferred tax assets and pension assets are provided in Note 21 ‘Other liabilities’.

Accrued interest and rents includes EUR 6,388 million (2010: EUR 7,113 million) accrued interest on assets measured at amortised cost under the IAS 39 classification Loans and receivables.

The total amount of borrowing costs relating to Property development and obtained from foreclosures, capitalised in 2011 is EUR 7 million (2010: EUR 18 million).

Reinsurance and insurance receivables

 

     2011      2010  

Receivables on account of direct insurance from

     

– policyholders

     1,238         1,272   

– intermediaries

     67         108   

Reinsurance receivables

     666         821   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,971         2,201   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The allowance for uncollectible reinsurance and insurance receivables amounted to EUR 66 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 52 million). The allowance is deducted from this receivable.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Property development and obtained from foreclosures

 

     2011     2010  

Property under development

     400        821   

Property developed

     1,055        1,024   

Property obtained from foreclosures

     129        308   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,584        2,153   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount as at December 31,

     2,720        3,240   

Accumulated impairments as at December 31,

     (1,136     (1,087
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     1,584        2,153   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-56


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

EQUITY

13 shareholders’ Equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Share capital

     919         919         919   

Share premium

     16,034         16,034         16,034   

Revaluation reserve

     5,550         4,752         2,466   

Currency translation reserve

     93         79         (2,011

Other reserves

     19,856         15,935         13,493   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     42,452         37,719         30,901   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following equity components cannot be freely distributed: the Revaluation reserve, Share of associates reserve (included in Other reserves), Currency translation reserve and the part of the Other reserves that relates to the former Stichting Regio Bank and the former Stichting Vakbondsspaarbank SPN.

As at December 31, 2011, Other reserves included an amount of EUR 836 million (2010: EUR 741 million; 2009: EUR 645 million) related to the former Stichting Regio Bank and the former Stichting Vakbondsspaarbank SPN.

Share capital

 

     Ordinary shares (par value EUR 0.24)  
     Number x1,000      Amount  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Authorised share capital

     14,500,000         4,500,000         4,500,000         3,480         1,080         1,080   

Unissued share capital

     10,668,439         668,439         668,439         2,561         161         161   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Issued share capital

     3,831,561         3,831,561         3,831,561         919         919         919   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in issued share capital

 

    

Ordinary shares

(par value EUR 0.24)

 
    

Number

x1,000

     Amount  

Issued share capital as at January 1, 2009

     2,063,148         495   

Issue of shares

     1,768,413         424   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Issued share capital as at December 31, 2009

     3,831,561         919   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

No changes have occurred in the issued share capital in 2011 and 2010.

Share premium

Changes in Share premium are disclosed in the Consolidated statement of changes in equity of ING Group.

Rights issue (2009)

On November 27, 2009 existing holders of (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares were offered rights entitling to subscribe for new (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares subject to applicable securities laws. Eligible rights holders could subscribe for 6 new (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares in relation to every 7 subscription rights that they hold. The issue price was set at EUR 4.24 per share. This represented a discount of 37.3% to the Theoretical Ex-Rights Price (TERP), based on the closing price of EUR 8.92 of ING Groep N.V.’s, (depositary receipts for) shares on Euronext Amsterdam and on Euronext Brussels on November 26, 2009.

A total of 1,768,412,544 (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares were offered and sold, of which approximately 97% through the exercise of rights and the remainder through placements to institutional investors. As a result, ING received approximately EUR 7.3 billion in proceeds, net of fees and expenses.

 

F-57


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Ordinary shares

All ordinary shares are in registered form. No share certificates have been issued. Ordinary shares may be transferred by means of a deed of transfer. A transfer of ordinary shares requires written acknowledgement by ING Groep N.V. The par value of ordinary shares is EUR 0.24. The authorised ordinary share capital of ING Groep N.V. currently consists of 14,500 million ordinary shares. It increased in 2011 from 4,500 million ordinary shares to 14,500 million ordinary shares as a result from an amendment made to the Articles of Association on June 15, 2011. As at December 31, 2011, 3,832 million of ordinary shares were issued and fully paid.

Depositary receipts for ordinary shares

More than 99.9% of the ordinary shares issued by ING Groep N.V. is held by Stichting ING Aandelen (ING Trust Office). In exchange for these shares, ING Trust Office has issued depositary receipts in bearer form for these shares. The depositary receipts are listed on various stock exchanges. Depositary receipts can be exchanged upon request of the holders of depositary receipts for (non-listed) ordinary shares without any restriction, other than payment of an administrative fee of EUR 0.01 per depositary receipt with a minimum of EUR 25 per exchange transaction.

The holder of a depositary receipt is entitled to receive from ING Trust Office payment of dividends and distributions corresponding to the dividends and distributions received by ING Trust Office on an ordinary share.

In addition, the holder of a depositary receipt is entitled to attend and to speak at the General Meeting of Shareholders of ING Groep N.V. either in person or by proxy. A holder of a depositary receipt, who thus attends the General Meeting of Shareholders, is entitled to vote as a proxy of the ING Trust Office but entirely at his own discretion for a number of shares equal to the number of his depositary receipts.

A holder of depositary receipts who does not attend the General Meeting of Shareholders in person or by proxy is entitled to give a binding voting instruction to the Trust Office for a number of shares equal to the number of his depositary receipts.

Depositary receipts for ordinary shares held by ING Group (Treasury shares)

As at December 31, 2011, 49.3 million (2010: 51.3 million; 2009: 47.0 million) depositary receipts for ordinary shares ING Groep N.V. with a par value of EUR 0.24 were held by ING Groep N.V. or its subsidiaries. These depositary receipts for ordinary shares were purchased to hedge option rights granted to the Executive Board members and other employees. In December 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it will no longer rebalance its hedge portfolio. This decision is an effort to simplify the management and administration of ING’s various employee share and option programmes. The remaining shares in the hedge portfolio will be used to fund the obligations arising out of exercise and vesting. Once all shares in the hedge portfolio are used ING will fund these obligations by issuing new shares.

Restrictions with respect to dividend and repayment of capital

ING Groep N.V. is subject to legal restrictions regarding the amount of dividends it can pay to the holders of its ordinary shares. Pursuant to the Dutch Civil Code, dividends can only be paid up to an amount equal to the excess of the company’s own funds over the sum of the paid-up capital, and reserves required by law.

Moreover, ING Groep N.V.’s ability to pay dividends is dependent on the dividend payment ability of its subsidiaries and associates. ING Groep N.V. is legally required to create a non-distributable reserve insofar profits of its subsidiaries and associates are subject to dividend payment restrictions which apply to those subsidiaries and associates themselves. Such restrictions may among others be of a similar nature as the restrictions which apply to ING Groep N.V. Furthermore there can be restrictions as a result of minimum capital requirements that are imposed by industry regulators in the countries in which the subsidiaries operate, or other limitations which may exist in certain countries.

Without prejudice to the authority of the Executive Board to allocate profits to reserves and to the fact that the ordinary shares are the most junior securities issued by ING Groep N.V., no specific dividend payment restrictions with respect to ordinary shares exist.

Furthermore, ING Groep N.V. is subject to legal restrictions with respect to repayment of capital to holders of ordinary shares. Capital may be repaid to the holders of ordinary shares pursuant to an amendment of ING Groep N.V.’s Articles of Association whereby the ordinary shares are written down.

 

F-58


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Pursuant to the Dutch Civil Code, capital may only be repaid if none of ING Groep N.V.’s creditors opposes such a repayment within two months following the announcement of a resolution to that effect.

On a distribution of a dividend ING Groep N.V. is in principle required to withhold an income tax on dividends at a rate of 15%.

Changes in revaluation reserve

 

2011    Property
revaluation
reserve
    Available-
for-sale
reserve
    Cash
flow
hedge
reserve
     Total  

Opening balance

     379        3,526        847         4,752   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     (12     967           955   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

       723           723   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

         1,124         1,124   

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

       (2,004        (2,004
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     367        3,212        1,971         5,550   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in revaluation reserve

 

2010    Property
revaluation
reserve
    Available-
for-sale
reserve
    Cash
flow
hedge
reserve
     Total  

Opening balance

     411        1,683        372         2,466   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     (32     3,401           3,369   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

       86           86   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

         475         475   

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

       (1,644        (1,644
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     379        3,526        847         4,752   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in revaluation reserve

 

2009    Property
revaluation
reserve
    Available-
for-sale
reserve
    Cash
flow
hedge
reserve
    Total  

Opening balance

     461        (10,140     1,177        (8,502

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     (50     12,496          12,446   

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

       1,406          1,406   

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

         (805     (805

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

       (2,079       (2,079
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     411        1,683        372        2,466   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC includes the change in the deferred profit sharing liability (net of deferred tax). Reference is made to Note 17 ‘Insurance and investment contracts, reinsurance contracts’.

Changes in currency translation reserve

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Opening balance

     79        (2,011     (1,918

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     167        (777     (294

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss

         148   

Exchange rate differences

     (153     2,867        53   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     93        79        (2,011
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The unrealised revaluations after taxation relate to changes in the value of hedging instruments that are designated as net investment hedges.

 

F-59


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in other reserves

 

2011    Retained
earnings
    Share of
associates
reserve
     Treasury
shares
    Other
reserves
    Total  

Opening balance

     21,104        907         (715     (5,361     15,935   

Result for the year

     4,740               4,740   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     16               16   

Changes in treasury shares

          50          50   

Transfer to share of associates reserve

     (383     383          

Employee stock options and share plans

     115               115   

Repurchase premium

     (1,000            (1,000
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     24,592        1,290         (665     (5,361     19,856   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The repurchase premium of EUR 1 billion is paid in relation to the repayment of the EUR 2 billion non-voting equity securities.

Changes in other reserves

 

2010    Retained
earnings
    Share of
associates
reserve
     Treasury
shares
    Other
reserves
    Total  

Opening balance

     18,946        645         (737     (5,361     13,493   

Result for the year

     2,367               2,367   

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     (156     171             15   

Changes in treasury shares

          22          22   

Transfer to share of associates reserve

     (91     91          

Employee stock options and share plans

     36               36   

Other

     2               2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     21,104        907         (715     (5,361     15,935   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in other reserves

 

2009    Retained
earnings
    Share of
associates
reserve
    Treasury
shares
    Other
reserves
    Total  

Opening balance

     20,833        726        (866     (5,015     15,678   

Result for the year

     (1,494           (1,494

Unrealised revaluations after taxation

     (273     (5         (278

Changes in treasury shares

         129          129   

Transfer to share of associates reserve

     76        (76      

Dividend and repurchase premium

     (259         (346     (605

Employee stock options and share plans

     64              64   

Other

     (1           (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     18,946        645        (737     (5,361     13,493   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividend and repurchase premium includes the coupon (EUR 259 million) and repayment premium (EUR 346 million) on the repayment of EUR 5 billion non-voting equity securities.

Changes in treasury shares

 

     Amount     Number  
     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Opening balance

     715        737        866        51,300,101        47,047,225        36,457,118   

Purchased/sold

     (17     48        47        (625,803     6,393,739        11,648,765   

Rights issue

         (64      

Share-based payments

     (19     (23     (27     (1,368,381     (2,140,863     (1,058,658

Other

     (14     (47     (85      
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     665        715        737        49,305,917        51,300,101        47,047,225   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-60


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Non-voting equity securities (Core Tier 1 securities)

On November 12, 2008, ING Groep N.V. issued one billion non-voting equity securities to the Dutch State at EUR 10 per non-voting equity security, resulting in an increase of ING Group’s core Tier 1 capital of EUR 10 billion. The nominal value of each security is EUR 0.24. The non-voting equity securities do not form part of ING Group’s share capital; accordingly they do not carry voting rights in the General Meeting.

These non-voting equity securities are deeply subordinated and rank pari-passu with ordinary shares in a winding up of ING Group.

On these non-voting equity securities a coupon was and is payable of the higher of:

 

 

EUR 0.85 per security, payable annually in arrears, with a first coupon of EUR 0.425 per security paid on May 12, 2009; and

 

 

110% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2009 (payable in 2010);

 

 

120% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2010 (payable in 2011);

 

 

125% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2011 onwards (payable in 2012 onwards).

Since ING Groep N.V. had already paid an interim dividend of EUR 0.74 per ordinary share in August 2008, ING recognised a coupon payable of EUR 425 million to the Dutch State as of December 31, 2008. This coupon was paid out on May 12, 2009.

Further coupons are to be paid on 12 May of each year (the coupon date) in cash if the dividend on ordinary shares is paid in cash or to be paid in scrip securities in the event of a scrip dividend on ordinary shares. Coupons are only due and payable, on a non-cumulative basis and if a dividend is paid on ordinary shares over the financial year preceding the coupon date, either on an interim or a final dividend basis, provided that ING Group’s capital adequacy position is and remains satisfactory both before and after payment in the opinion of the Dutch central bank.

In December 2009, ING repaid the first half of the non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) of EUR 5 billion plus a total premium of EUR 605 million. On May 13, 2011 ING exercised its option for early repayment of EUR 2 billion of the remaining non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities). The total payment in May 2011 amounted to EUR 3 billion and included a 50% repurchase premium. ING funded this repayment from retained earnings. ING has indicated that it is one of its priorities to repay the remaining EUR 3 billion non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) as soon as possible, but this needs to be done very prudently in light of the current challenging and changing financial and regulatory environment. The terms for the remaining non-voting equity securities, including restrictions on remuneration and corporate governance, remained unchanged. Reference is made to Note 33 ‘Related parties’.

Cumulative preference shares

Pursuant to the Articles of Association of ING Groep N.V. the authorised cumulative preference share capital consists of 4.5 billion cumulative preference shares, of which none have been issued. The par value of these cumulative preference shares is EUR 0.24.

The cumulative preference shares rank before the ordinary shares in entitlement to dividend and to distributions upon liquidation of ING Groep N.V.

The dividend on the cumulative preference shares will be equal to a percentage, calculated on the amount compulsorily paid up or yet to be paid up. This percentage shall be equal to the average of the Euro OverNight Index Average (EONIA) as calculated by the European Central Bank. During the financial year for which the distribution is made, this percentage is weighted on the basis of the number of days for which it applies, increased by 2.5 percentage points.

If and to the extent that the profit available for distribution is not sufficient to pay the dividend referred to above in full, the shortfall will be made up from the reserves insofar as possible. If, and to the extent that, the dividend distribution cannot be made from the reserves, the profits earned in subsequent years shall first be used to make up the shortfall before any distribution may be made on shares of any other category.

ING Groep N.V.’s Articles of Association make provision for the cancellation of cumulative preference shares. Upon cancellation of cumulative preference shares and upon liquidation of ING Groep N.V., the amount paid up on the cumulative preference shares will be repaid together with the dividend shortfall in preceding years, insofar as this shortfall has not yet been made up.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Cumulative preference shares - Restrictions with respect to dividend and repayment of capital

ING Groep N.V. is subject to legal restrictions regarding the amount of dividends it can pay to the holders of its cumulative preference shares, when issued. Pursuant to the Dutch Civil Code, dividends can only be paid up to an amount equal to the excess of the company’s own funds over the sum of the paid-up capital, and reserves required by law.

Moreover, ING Groep N.V.’s ability to pay dividends is dependent on the dividend payment ability of its subsidiaries. ING Groep N.V. is legally required to create a non-distributable reserve insofar profits of its subsidiaries are subject to dividend payment restrictions which apply to those subsidiaries themselves. Such restrictions may among others be of a similar nature as the restrictions which apply to ING Groep N.V. or may be the result of minimum capital requirements that are imposed by industry regulators in the countries in which the subsidiaries operate, or other limitations which may exist in certain countries.

Without prejudice to the fact that the cumulative preference shares, when issued, will be junior securities of ING Groep N.V., no specific dividend payment restrictions with respect to the cumulative preference shares exist.

Furthermore, ING Groep N.V. is subject to legal restrictions with respect to repayment of capital to holders of cumulative preference shares. Capital may be repaid to the holders of cumulative preference shares pursuant to (i) an amendment of ING Groep N.V.’s articles of association whereby the cumulative preference shares are written down or (ii) a resolution to redeem and cancel the cumulative preference shares.

Pursuant to the Dutch Civil Code, capital may only be repaid if none of ING Groep N.V.’s creditors opposes such a repayment within two months following the announcement of a resolution to that effect.

 

F-62


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

LIABILITIES

14 Subordinated loans

Subordinated loans

 

Interest rate              Notional amount
in original
     Balance sheet value  
  Year of issue     Due date    currency      2011      2010  

9.000%

    2008      Perpetual    EUR 10         10         10   

8.500%

    2008      Perpetual    USD  2,000         1,527         1,469   

8.000%

    2008      Perpetual    EUR  1,500         1,500         1,485   

7.375%

    2007      Perpetual    USD  1,500         1,176         1,111   

6.375%

    2007      Perpetual    USD 1,045         804         773   

5.140%

    2006      Perpetual    GBP 66         79         692   

5.775%

    2005      Perpetual    USD 364         292         741   

6.125%

    2005      Perpetual    USD 700         533         504   

4.176%

    2005      Perpetual    EUR 169         168         498   

Variable

    2004      Perpetual    EUR 563         527         994   

6.200%

    2003      Perpetual    USD 500         376         363   

Variable

    2003      Perpetual    EUR 432         424         729   

7.200%

    2002      Perpetual    USD  1,100         839         748   

7.050%

    2002      Perpetual    USD  800         603         528   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 
            8,858         10,645   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subordinated loans consist of perpetual subordinated bonds issued by ING Groep N.V. These bonds have been issued to raise hybrid capital for ING Verzekeringen N.V. and Tier 1 capital for ING Bank N.V. Under IFRS-IASB these bonds are classified as liabilities. They are considered capital for regulatory purposes.

On December 12, 2011 ING announced the launch of three separate exchange offers in Europe and tender offers in the United States of America, on a total of seven series of outstanding subordinated securities of ING entities with a total nominal value of approximately EUR 5.8 billion. Of this amount, EUR 4.8 billion relates to securities issued by ING Groep N.V. and EUR 1.0 billion issued by ING Verzekeringen N.V. All tender and exchange offers announced on December 12, 2011 were successfully completed on December 23, 2011 with an average participation of approximately 60%. As part of this initiative, EUR 0.9 billion intercompany debt from ING Bank N.V. to ING Groep N.V. was repaid. In addition, ING Group issued one new senior bond with a nominal value of EUR 0.7 billion and ING Bank issued two new senior bonds with a nominal value of GBP 0.4 billion and EUR 0.4 billion respectively. The overall transaction resulted in a total gain of EUR 955 million (EUR 716 million after tax), including related hedge results and transaction costs. This gain is recognised in Other income. From this amount, EUR 767 million (EUR 574 million after tax) relates to ING Groep N.V., EUR 93 million (EUR 71 million after tax) to ING Bank N.V. and EUR 95 million (EUR 71 million after tax) to ING Verzekeringen N.V. This affects the subordinated securities as disclosed in this note and in Note 16 ‘Other borrowed funds’.

Except for the 9% 2008 perpetual of EUR 10 million (a private placement) and EUR 750 million of the 8% 2008 perpetual, these loans have been subsequently provided as subordinated loans by ING Groep N.V. to ING Verzekeringen N.V. and ING Bank N.V. under the same conditions as the original bonds as follows:

Subordinated loans provided by ING Groep N.V. to ING Bank N.V. and ING Verzekeringen N.V.:

 

     2011      2010  

ING Bank N.V.

     6,141         7,147   

ING Verzekeringen N.V.

     1,957         2,003   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     8,098         9,150   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

15 Debt securities in issue

Debt securities in issue relate to debentures and other issued debt securities with either fixed interest rates or interest rates based on floating interest rate levels, such as certificates of deposit and accepted bills issued by ING Group, except for subordinated items. Debt securities in issue do not include debt securities presented as Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss. ING Group does not have debt securities that are issued on terms other than those available in the normal course of business. The maturities of the debt securities are as follows:

 

F-63


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Debt securities in issue – maturities

 

     2011      2010  

Fixed rate debt securities

     

Within 1 year

     52,308         63,518   

More than 1 year but less than 2 years

     6,914         7,518   

More than 2 years but less than 3 years

     10,347         6,925   

More than 3 years but less than 4 years

     5,943         9,580   

More than 4 years but less than 5 years

     7,541         5,648   

More than 5 years

     20,655         10,987   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total fixed rate debt securities

     103,708         104,176   

Floating rate debt securities

     

Within 1 year

     15,871         14,007   

More than 1 year but less than 2 years

     8,590         4,321   

More than 2 years but less than 3 years

     3,569         4,552   

More than 3 years but less than 4 years

     1,207         2,113   

More than 4 years but less than 5 years

     162         864   

More than 5 years

     6,754         5,571   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total floating rate debt securities

     36,153         31,428   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt securities

     139,861         135,604   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, ING Group had unused lines of credit available including the payment of commercial paper borrowings relating to debt securities in issue of EUR 8,178 million (2010: EUR 6,518 million).

The following bonds were all issued under the Credit Guarantee Scheme of the State of the Netherlands and are part of ING Group’s regular medium-term funding operations. ING Group pays a fee of 84 basis points over the issued bonds to the Dutch State to participate in the Credit Guarantee Scheme.

 

 

ING Bank issued 3 year government guaranteed senior unsecured bonds amounting to USD 6 billion in January 2009. USD 5 billion of the issue was priced at a fixed rate of 80 basis points over mid-swaps. USD 1 billion was priced at a variable rate of 80 basis points over 3 month LIBOR.

 

 

ING Bank issued a 5 year EUR 4 billion fixed rate government guaranteed senior unsecured bond in February 2009. The issue was priced at a fixed rate of 3.375%, 75 basis points over mid-swaps.

 

 

ING Bank issued a 5 year USD 2 billion fixed rate government guaranteed senior unsecured bond in March 2009. The issue was priced at a fixed coupon of 3.90%, 145 basis points over USD mid-swaps.

16 Other borrowed funds

Other borrowed funds by remaining term

 

2011    2012      2013      2014      2015      2016      Years
after
2016
     Total  

Subordinated loans of group companies

     2,907         1,181         81         918         2,309         4,752         12,148   

Preference shares of group companies

                    404         404   

Loans contracted

     428            76               1,783         2,287   

Loans from credit institutions

     4,052         28         29         28         28         680         4,845   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     7,387         1,209         186         946         2,337         7,619         19,684   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other borrowed funds by remaining term

 

2010    2011      2012      2013      2014      2015      Years
after
2015
     Total  

Subordinated loans of group companies

     2,647         1,673         684         81         1,086         7,609         13,780   

Preference shares of group companies

                    1,121         1,121   

Loans contracted

     2,055               73            1,612         3,740   

Loans from credit institutions

     2,677         29         30         29         159         726         3,650   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     7,379         1,702         714         183         1,245         11,068         22,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-64


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In 2011, Subordinated loans from group companies is affected by the exchange offers in Europe and tender offers in the United States of America as disclosed in Note 14 ‘Subordinated loans’.

Subordinated loans of group companies relate to capital debentures and private loans which are subordinated to all current and future liabilities of ING Bank N.V.

Preference shares of group companies comprise non-cumulative guaranteed Trust Preference Securities which are issued by wholly owned subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V. These securities have a liquidation preference of a certain amount plus any accrued interest and unpaid dividend. Dividends with regard to these preference securities are presented as an interest expense in the profit and loss account. These trust preference securities have no voting rights.

17 Insurance and investment contracts, Reinsurance contracts

The provisions for insurance and investment contracts, net of reinsurance (i.e. the provision for ING Group’s own account) is presented in the balance sheet gross under ‘Insurance and investment contracts’ and ‘Reinsurance contracts’.

Insurance and investment contracts, reinsurance contracts

 

    

Provision

net of reinsurance

     Reinsurance
contracts
    

Insurance

and investment
contracts

 
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Provision for non-participating life policy liabilities

     88,492         80,691         5,534         5,150         94,026         85,841   

Provision for participating life policy liabilities

     52,753         51,191         102         173         52,855         51,364   

Provision for (deferred) profit sharing and rebates

     5,623         3,432         2         3         5,625         3,435   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance provisions excluding provisions for risk of policyholders

     146,868         135,314         5,638         5,326         152,506         140,640   

Provision for life insurance for risk of policyholders

     109,487         114,603         136         359         109,623         114,962   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance provisions

     256,355         249,917         5,774         5,685         262,129         255,602   

Provision for unearned premiums and unexpired risks

     297         345         4         4         301         349   

Reported claims provision

     2,620         2,606         89         97         2,709         2,703   

Claims incurred but not reported (IBNR)

     493         497         3         3         496         500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Claims provisions

     3,113         3,103         92         100         3,205         3,203   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total provisions for insurance contracts

     259,765         253,365         5,870         5,789         265,635         259,154   

Investment contracts for risk of company

     6,259         5,990               6,259         5,990   

Investment contracts for risk of policyholders

     6,939         5,984               6,939         5,984   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total provisions for investment contracts

     13,198         11,974               13,198         11,974   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     272,963         265,339         5,870         5,789         278,833         271,128   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The deferred profit sharing amount on unrealised revaluation is included in Provision for (deferred) profit sharing and rebates and amounts to EUR 3,721 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 1,706 million).

 

F-65


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in life insurance provisions

 

    

Provision

net of reinsurance
(excluding provision
for life insurance for
risk of policyholders)

   

Provision for life
insurance for risk of
policyholders

(net of reinsurance)

    Reinsurance
contracts
   

Life insurance

provisions

 
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     135,314        121,491        114,603        99,299        5,685        5,376        255,602        226,166   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (495     (24     (267     (2     (2       (764     (26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     134,819        121,467        114,336        99,297        5,683        5,376        254,838        226,140   

Current year provisions

     13,774        11,843        7,623        7,500        636        415        22,033        19,758   

Change in deferred profit sharing liability

     1,963        1,422                1,963        1,422   

Prior year provisions

                

– benefit payments to policyholders

     (13,872     (11,938     (12,548     (10,681     (700     (557     (27,120     (23,176

– interest accrual and changes in fair value of liabilities

     6,302        4,884            35        35        6,337        4,919   

– valuation changes for risk of policyholders

         (1,190     10,468            (1,190     10,468   

– effect of changes in discount rate assumptions

       5                  5   

– effect of changes in other assumptions

     635        356        (17     21        (2     6        616        383   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (6,935     (6,693     (13,755     (192     (667     (516     (21,357     (7,401

Exchange rate differences

     3,087        7,203        2,797        8,488        185        374        6,069        16,065   

Other changes

     160        72        (1,514     (490     (63     36        (1,417     (382
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     146,868        135,314        109,487        114,603        5,774        5,685        262,129        255,602   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Where discounting is used in the calculation of life insurance provisions, the rate is within the range 2.8% to 5.5% (2010: 2.8% to 5.8%) based on weighted averages.

Insurance provisions include a provision for the estimated cost of the agreement with regard to unit-linked policies. For more information reference is made to Note 31 ‘Legal proceedings’.

In 2011, Effect of changes in other assumptions includes EUR 611 million relating to the assumption review for the Insurance US Closed Block Variable Annuity (VA) business. Reference is made to Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’.

In 2011, Other changes with regard to Provision for life insurance for risk of policyholders (net of reinsurance) include the transfers of certain insurance contracts outside ING.

ING transferred part of its life insurance business to Scottish Re in 2004 by means of a co-insurance contract. This business continues to be included in Life insurance provisions. The related asset from the co-insurance contract is recognised under Reinsurance contracts. On January 23, 2009, Hannover Re and Scottish Re announced that Hannover Re has agreed to assume the ING individual life reinsurance business originally transferred to Scottish Re in 2004.

ING transferred its U.S. group reinsurance business to Reinsurance Group of America Inc. in 2010 by means of a reinsurance agreement. This business continues to be included in Life insurance provisions. The related asset from the reinsurance contract is recognised under Reinsurance contracts.

 

F-66


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

To the extent that the assuming reinsurers are unable to meet their obligations, the Group is liable to its policyholders for the portion reinsured. Consequently, provisions are made for receivables on reinsurance contracts which are deemed uncollectible. The life reinsurance market is highly concentrated and, therefore, diversification of exposure is inherently difficult. To minimise its exposure to significant losses from reinsurer insolvencies, the Group evaluates the financial condition of its reinsurers, monitors concentrations of credit risk arising from similar geographical regions, activities or economic characteristics of the reinsurer and maintains collateral. Reference is also made to the ‘Risk management’ section.

As at December 31, 2011, the total Reinsurance exposure, including Reinsurance contracts and Receivables from reinsurers (presented in Other assets) amounted to EUR 6,536 million (2010: EUR 6,610 million) after the provision for uncollectible reinsurance of nil (2010: nil).

Changes in provision for unearned premiums and unexpired risks

 

    

Provision

net of reinsurance

    Reinsurance
contracts
   

Provision for

unearned
premiums

and unexpired
risks

 
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     345        361        4        4        349        365   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (8           (8  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     337        361        4        4        341        365   

Premiums written

     1,682        1,676        43        65        1,725        1,741   

Premiums earned during the year

     (1,708     (1,702     (43     (65     (1,751     (1,767

Exchange rate differences

     1        1            1        1   

Other changes

     (15     9            (15     9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     297        345        4        4        301        349   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in claims provisions

 

    

Provision

net of
reinsurance

    Reinsurance
contracts
    Claims
provisions
 
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     3,103        3,073        100        101        3,203        3,174   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (7         1        (7     1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     3,096        3,073        100        102        3,196        3,175   

Additions

            

– for the current year

     1,166        1,121        10        20        1,176        1,141   

– for prior years

     (71     (35     (11     (11     (82     (46

– interest accrual of provision

     40        46            40        46   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,135        1,132        (1     9        1,134        1,141   

Claim settlements and claim settlement costs

            

– for the current year

     472        491        1        3        473        494   

– for prior years

     665        621        6        8        671        629   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,137        1,112        7        11        1,144        1,123   

Exchange rate differences

     2        13            2        13   

Other changes

     17        (3         17        (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     3,113        3,103        92        100        3,205        3,203   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

ING Group had an outstanding balance of EUR 35 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 41 million) relating to environmental and asbestos claims of the insurance operations. In establishing the liability for unpaid claims and claims adjustment expenses related to asbestos related illness and toxic waste clean-up, the management of ING Group considers facts currently known and current legislation and coverage litigation. Liabilities are recognised for IBNR claims and for known claims (including the costs of related litigation) when sufficient information has been obtained to indicate the involvement of a specific insurance policy, and management can reasonably estimate its liability. In addition, liabilities are reviewed and updated regularly.

 

F-67


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Where discounting is used in the calculation of the claims provisions, based on weighted averages, the rate is within the range of 3.0% to 4.0% (2010: 3.0% to 4.0%).

Changes in investment contracts liabilities

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     11,974        11,302   

Current year liabilities

     7,867        4,920   

Prior year provisions

    

– payments to contract holders

     (7,709     (5,185

– interest accrual

     39        81   

– valuation changes investments

     (55     24   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (7,725     (5,080

Exchange rate differences

     380        593   

Other changes

     702        239   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     13,198        11,974   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross claims development table

 

     Underwriting year        
     2004     2005     2006     2007     2008     2009     2010     2011     Total  

Estimate of cumulative claims:

                  

At the end of underwriting year

     1,230        1,122        1,115        1,035        1,091        1,214        1,180        1,210     

1 year later

     1,077        1,053        1,071        936        1,072        1,226        1,208       

2 years later

     925        952        992        873        1,042        1,166         

3 years later

     903        922        978        870        1,041           

4 years later

     904        907        981        850             

5 years later

     895        900        966               

6 years later

     898        881                 

7 years later

     892                   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimate of cumulative claims

     892        881        966        850        1,041        1,166        1,208        1,210        8,214   

Cumulative payments

     (783     (742     (797     (630     (753     (787     (748     (474     (5,714
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     109        139        169        220        288        379        460        736        2,500   

Effect of discounting

     (15     (20     (22     (33     (38     (41     (45     (32     (246
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liability recognised

     94        119        147        187        250        338        415        704        2,254   

Liability relating to underwriting years prior to 2004

                     951   
                  

 

 

 

Total amount recognised in the balance sheet

                     3,205   
                  

 

 

 

The Group applies the exemption in IFRS-IASB not to present Gross claims development for annual periods beginning before January 1, 2004 (the date of transition to IFRS-IASB) as it is impracticable to obtain such information.

18 Amounts due to banks

Amounts due to banks include non-subordinated debt due to banks, other than amounts in the form of debt securities. As at December 31, 2011, liabilities concerning securities sold in repurchase transactions amounted to EUR 11,145 million (2010: EUR 12,200 million).

Amounts due to banks by type

 

     Netherlands      International      Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Non-interest bearing

     1,350         1,893         808         701         2,158         2,594   

Interest bearing

     40,648         37,429         29,427         32,829         70,075         70,258   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     41,998         39,322         30,235         33,530         72,233         72,852   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-68


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

19 Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

 

     2011      2010  

Savings accounts

     291,516         324,581   

Credit balances on customer accounts

     114,867         127,177   

Corporate deposits

     49,668         55,024   

Other

     11,496         4,580   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     467,547         511,362   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit by type

 

     Netherlands      International      Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Non-interest bearing

     13,294         13,522         9,447         6,773         22,741         20,295   

Interest bearing

     134,412         132,311         310,394         358,756         444,806         491,067   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     147,706         145,833         319,841         365,529         467,547         511,362   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2011, the decrease in Customer deposits and other funds on deposits is mainly caused by the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

No funds have been entrusted to the Group by customers on terms other than those prevailing in the normal course of business. As at December 31, 2011, Customer deposits and other funds on deposit included liabilities with regard to securities sold in repurchase transactions amounting to EUR 5,730 million (2010: EUR 5,272 million).

Savings accounts relate to the balances on savings accounts, savings books, savings deposits and time deposits of personal customers. The interest payable on savings accounts, which is contractually added to the accounts, is also included.

20 Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

 

     2011      2010  

Trading liabilities

     107,682         108,050   

Non-trading derivatives

     22,165         17,782   

Designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     13,021         12,707   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     142,868         138,539   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading liabilities by type

 

     2011      2010  

Equity securities

     3,332         4,811   

Debt securities

     9,607         16,707   

Funds on deposit

     38,696         44,767   

Derivatives

     56,047         41,765   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     107,682         108,050   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in trading derivatives and other non-trading derivatives for which no hedge accounting is applied is mainly due to changes in fair value resulting from changes in market interest rates. The increase is substantially mitigated by a similar increase in Trading derivates and Other non-trading derivatives (assets) as disclosed in Note 3 ‘Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss’.

As at December 31, 2011, the Funds on deposit include amounts payable of EUR 38,011 million (2010: EUR 43,995 million) with regard to repurchase transactions.

 

F-69


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Non-trading derivatives by type

 

     2011      2010  

Derivatives used in:

     

– fair value hedges

     3,830         8,601   

– cash flow hedges

     6,462         5,264   

– hedges of net investments in foreign operations

     159         168   

Other non-trading derivatives

     11,714         3,749   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     22,165         17,782   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other non-trading derivatives mainly include interest rate swaps for which no hedge accounting is applied.

Designated as at fair value through profit and loss by type

 

     2011      2010  

Debt securities

     11,271         10,533   

Funds entrusted

     632         934   

Subordinated liabilities

     1,118         1,240   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     13,021         12,707   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2011, the change in the fair value of financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss attributable to changes in the credit risk of that liability was EUR 377 million (2010: EUR 179 million) and EUR 595 million (2010: EUR 218 million) on a cumulative basis. This change has been determined as the amount of change in fair value of the financial liability that is not attributable to changes in market conditions that gave rise to market risk (i.e. mainly interest rate risk based on yield curves).

The amount that ING Group is contractually required to pay at maturity to the holders of financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss is EUR 13,726 million (2010: EUR 12,438 million).

21 Other liabilities

Other liabilities by type

 

     2011      2010  

Deferred tax liabilities

     2,242         1,537   

Income tax payable

     858         1,210   

Pension benefits

     378         543   

Post-employment benefits

     179         172   

Other staff-related liabilities

     1,111         1,248   

Other taxation and social security contributions

     898         885   

Deposits from reinsurers

     1,015         1,007   

Accrued interest

     11,698         13,220   

Costs payable

     2,400         2,873   

Amounts payable to brokers

     72         111   

Amounts payable to policyholders

     2,173         2,130   

Reorganisation provision

     599         434   

Other provisions

     638         533   

Share-based payment plan liabilities

     39         40   

Prepayments received under property under development

     83         173   

Amounts to be settled

     5,442         5,553   

Dividend payable

     

Other

     3,377         4,777   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     33,202         36,446   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other mainly relates to year-end accruals in the normal course of business.

Other staff-related liabilities include vacation leave provisions, bonus provisions, jubilee provisions and disability/illness provisions.

Deferred taxes are calculated on all temporary differences under the liability method using tax rates applicable in the jurisdictions in which the Group is liable to taxation.

 

F-70


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in deferred tax

 

     Net
liability
    Change
through
equity
   

Change
through

net
result

   

Changes

in the
composition
of the group

    Exchange
rate
differences
    Other     Net
liability
 
     2010                                   2011  

Investments

     (296     1,188        452        (58     74        265        1,625   

Real estate investments

     383          (10     7        1          381   

Financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

     (527       (175     (9     6        (20     (725

Deferred acquisition costs and VOBA

     3,111        (272     (194     (57     131        12        2,731   

Fiscal reserve

     1          (1        

Depreciation

     4        1        24        9        2          40   

Insurance provisions

     (1,866     (572     (773     (7     (130     (2     (3,350

Cash flow hedges

     263        373        4              640   

Pension and post-employment benefits

     503        1        68        (12     (10     2        552   

Other provisions

     (655       379        25        16        (21     (256

Receivables

     (51       (8     (12     (1     (2     (74

Loans and advances to customers

     (608     97        (143       6        96        (552

Unused tax losses carried forward

     (1,851     (1     305        34        20        195        (1,298

Other

     (299     (65     27        (4     (17     85        (273
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (1,888     750        (45     (84     98        610        (559
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

– deferred tax liabilities

     1,537                  2,242   

– deferred tax assets

     (3,425               (2,801
  

 

 

             

 

 

 
     (1,888               (559
  

 

 

             

 

 

 

In 2011, Investments-Other, Loans and advances to customers-Other and Unused tax losses carried forward-Other relates mainly to the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

Changes in deferred tax

 

     Net
liability
    Change
through
equity
   

Change
through

net
result

   

Changes

in the
composition
of the group

    Exchange
rate
differences
    Other     Net
liability
 
     2009                                   2010  

Investments

     209        1,205        (1,359     (2     73        (39     87   

Financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

     (312     (18     (185     (2     5        (15     (527

Deferred acquisition costs and VOBA

     2,849        (368     301          326        3        3,111   

Fiscal reserve

         1              1   

Depreciation

     12          9        (10     (1     (6     4   

Insurance provisions

     (1,446     (389     109          (135     (5     (1,866

Cash flow hedges

     69        210            (14     (2     263   

Pension and post-employment benefits

     700          (183       7        (21     503   

Other provisions

     (1,012     (13     476        5        (127     16        (655

Receivables

     (149     (1     82        6        2        9        (51

Loans and advances to customers

     (215       (353     (5     (15     (20     (608

Unused tax losses carried forward

     (2,508     1        801        (3     (152     10        (1,851

Other

     (814     29        419        11        (32     88        (299
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (2,617     656        118        0        (63     18        (1,888
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

– deferred tax liabilities

     1,352                  1,537   

– deferred tax assets

     (3,969               (3,425
  

 

 

             

 

 

 
     (2,617               (1,888
  

 

 

             

 

 

 

 

F-71


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Deferred tax in connection with unused tax losses carried forward

 

     2011     2010  

Total unused tax losses carried forward

     9,093        9,335   

Unused tax losses carried forward not recognised as a deferred tax asset

     (4,529     (2,862
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unused tax losses carried forward recognised as a deferred tax asset

     4,564        6,473   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average tax rate

     28.4     28.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax asset

     1,298        1,851   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following tax loss carry forwards and tax credits will expire as follows as at December 31,:

Total unused tax losses carried forward analysed by expiry terms

 

    

No deferred tax

asset recognised

    

Deferred tax

asset recognised

 
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Within 1 year

     30         14         49         67   

More than 1 year but less than 5 years

     378         406         539         461   

More than 5 years but less than 10 years

     774         243         1,971         3,768   

More than 10 years but less than 20 years

     3,185         2,093         192         1,285   

Unlimited

     162         106         1,813         892   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     4,529         2,862         4,564         6,473   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets are recognised for temporary deductible differences, for tax loss carry forwards and unused tax credits only to the extent that realisation of the related tax benefit is probable.

The deferred tax asset includes balances for which the utilisation is dependent on future taxable profits whilst the related entities have incurred losses in either the current year or the preceding year. The aggregate amount for the most significant entities where this applies is EUR 490 million (2010: EUR 1,102 million).

This can be specified by jurisdiction as follows:

Breakdown by jurisdiction

 

     Banking
operations
     Insurance
operations
     Total  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011      2010  

The Netherlands

        190                  190   

United States

        508         120         232         120         740   

Great Britain

     116         89               116         89   

Belgium

           70         13         70         13   

Australia

     36         40               36         40   

Spain

        11         19            19         11   

Germany

     5         19               5         19   

France

     66                  66      

Mexico

     32                  32      

Italy

     26                  26      
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     281         857         209         245         490         1,102   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2011 the deferred tax assets for banking operations for which the utilisation is dependent on future taxable profits, as disclosed above, decreased significantly compared to 2010, as a result of the announced sale of ING Direct USA. Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’.

In 2011, ING Group has reconsidered its method of determining the breakdown by jurisdiction. The recoverability is now determined at the level of the fiscal unity within that jurisdiction and not at the level of the individual company. Also the offsetting of deferred tax assets with deferred tax liabilities was revised. The comparatives provided in this table have been adjusted accordingly.

 

F-72


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Recognition is based on the fact that it is probable that the entity will have taxable profits and/or can utilise tax planning opportunities before expiration of the deferred tax assets. Changes in circumstances in future periods may adversely impact the assessment of the recoverability. The uncertainty of the recoverability is taken into account in establishing the deferred tax assets.

As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, ING Group had no significant temporary differences associated with the parent company’s investments in subsidiaries, branches and associates and interest in joint ventures as any economic benefit from those investments will not be taxable at parent company level.

Changes in reorganisation provision

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     434        644   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (1     38   

Additions

     531        285   

Interest

     5        5   

Releases

     (14     (77

Charges

     (358     (461

Exchange rate differences

     1        6   

Other changes

     1        (6
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     599        434   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2011, the provision for reorganisation, of which EUR 457 million relates to termination benefits, relates to Dutch Retail Banking activities as well as other restructuring activities.

As at December 31, 2010, the provision for reorganisation, of which EUR 317 million relates to termination benefits, mainly related to the merger of the Dutch Retail Banking activities as well as other restructuring activities.

Changes in other provisions

 

     Litigation     Other     Total  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     304        307        229        440        533        747   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (3     (26     (12     (1     (15     (27

Additions

     19        25        162        52        181        77   

Releases

     (7     (1     (2     (15     (9     (16

Charges

     (21     (13     (56     (59     (77     (72

Exchange rate differences

     (5     3        3        3        (2     6   

Other changes

     10        9        17        (191     27        (182
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     297        304        341        229        638        533   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The provision for the estimated cost of the agreement with regard to unit-linked policies is included in ‘Insurance and investment contracts’ as disclosed in Note 17.

In general, Reorganisation and Other provisions are of a short-term nature.

The amounts included in other provisions are based on best estimates with regard to amounts and timing of cash flows required to settle the obligation.

 

F-73


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Pension and post-employment benefits

Summary of pension benefits

 

     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  

Defined benefit obligation

     16,212        16,183        14,209        14,271        14,499   

Fair value of plan assets

     20,077        17,364        15,310        13,366        14,708   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (3,865     (1,181     (1,101     905        (209

Unrecognised past service costs

     (2     (3     (3     (5     (3

Unrecognised actuarial gains/(losses)

     483        (1,731     (1,450     (2,072     198   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net liability (asset) recognised in the balance sheet

     (3,384     (2,915     (2,554     (1,172     (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Presented as:

          

– Other liabilities

     378        543        589        609        425   

– Other assets

     (3,762     (3,458     (3,143     (1,781     (439
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (3,384     (2,915     (2,554     (1,172     (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Summary of post-employment benefits

 

 
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  

Defined benefit obligation

     176        168        156        210        220   

Fair value of plan assets

          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     176        168        156        210        220   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrecognised past service costs

     3        3        8        2        4   

Unrecognised actuarial gains/(losses)

       1        11        7        8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     179        172        175        219        232   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Group maintains defined benefit retirement plans in some of the countries of operation. These plans provide benefits that are related to the remuneration and service of employees upon retirement. The benefits in some of these plans are subject to various forms of indexation. The indexation is, in some cases, at the discretion of management; in other cases it is dependent upon the sufficiency of plan assets.

Annual contributions are paid to the funds at a rate necessary to adequately finance the accrued liabilities of the plans calculated in accordance with local legal requirements. Plans in all countries comply with applicable local regulations governing investments and funding levels.

The Group provides other post-employment employee benefits to certain employees and former employees. These are primarily post-employment healthcare benefits and discounts on ING products provided to employees and former employees.

Certain group companies sponsor defined contribution pension plans. The assets of all ING Group’s defined contribution plans are held in independently administered funds. Contributions are generally determined as a percentage of pay. These plans do not give rise to balance sheet provisions, other than relating to short-term timing differences included in current liabilities.

Actuarial gains and losses related to pensions and post-employment benefits for the year ended December 31, 2011 include EUR 1,760 million (2010: EUR 1,085 million; 2009: EUR 387 million; 2008: EUR (2,647) million; 2007: EUR (789 million) experience gain adjustments for assets and EUR 10 million (2010: EUR 154 million; 2009: EUR 172 million; 2008: EUR (70) million; 2007: EUR 83 million) experience gain adjustments for liabilities.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in defined benefit obligation

 

     Pension benefits     Post-employment
benefits other
than pensions
 
     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     16,183        14,209        168        156   

Current service cost

     324        298        8        5   

Interest cost

     851        795        8        8   

Employer’s contribution

         4     

Participants contributions

     2        3       

Benefits paid

     (666     (634     (5     (6

Actuarial gains and losses

     (455     1,396        (3     2   

Past service cost

     (8       (4  

Changes in the composition of the group and other changes

     13        (20     (2     (1

Effect of curtailment or settlement

     (110     (7    

Exchange rate differences

     78        143        2        4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     16,212        16,183        176        168   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Relating to:

        

– funded plans

     16,111        16,051       

– unfunded plans

     101        132        176        168   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     16,212        16,183        176        168   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2011, Effect of curtailment or settlement relates mainly to a curtailment in relation to the restructuring in Retail Netherlands and a curtailment in relation to a change in one of the pension plans in the United States.

The estimated unrecognised past services cost and unrecognised actuarial gains and losses for the defined benefit plans to be amortised to pension and other staff related liability costs during 2012 are nil and EUR 40 million, respectively.

Changes in fair value of plan assets

 

     Pension benefits  
     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     17,364        15,310   

Expected return on plan assets

     877        886   

Employer’s contribution

     623        631   

Participants contributions

     15        2   

Benefits paid

     (627     (625

Actuarial gains and losses

     1,746        1,085   

Changes in the composition of the group and other changes

     7        (19

Exchange rate differences

     72        94   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     20,077        17,364   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The actual return on the plan assets amounted to EUR 2,623 million (2010: EUR 1,971 million) and exceeds the expected return on plan assets. This resulted in a large movement with regard to Actuarial gains and losses. The difference is caused by the decreased market interest rate that has an impact on the valuation of the debt securities in the plan assets.

No plan assets are expected to be returned to ING Group during 2012.

 

F-75


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Pension investment strategy

The primary financial objective of ING Employee Benefit Plans (the Plans) is to secure participant retirement benefits. As such, the key objective in the Plans’ financial management is to promote stability and, where appropriate, growth in funded status (i.e. the ratio of market value of assets to liabilities). The investment strategy for the Plans’ portfolios of assets (the Funds) balances the requirement to generate returns with the need to control risk. The asset mix is recognised as the primary mechanism to influence the reward and risk structure of the Funds in an effort to accomplish the Plans’ funding objectives. Desirable target allocations amongst identified asset classes are set and within each asset class, careful consideration is given to balancing the portfolios among industry sectors, geographical areas, interest rate sensitivity, dependence on economic growth, currency and other factors affecting investment returns. The assets are managed by professional investment firms. They are bound by precise mandates and are measured against specific benchmarks. Factors considered by the fund managers include balancing security concentration, investment style, and reliance on particular active investment strategies. The asset mixes of the Funds are reviewed on a regular basis. Generally, the Funds’ asset mixes will be rebalanced to the target mixes as individual portfolios approach their minimum or maximum levels.

Categories of plan assets in percentages

 

     Target
allocation
     Percentage of
plan assets
    

Weighted

average expected

long term rate of
return

 
     2012      2011      2010      2011      2010  

Equity securities

     34         27         34         6.9         7.5   

Debt securities

     51         60         51         3.8         4.3   

Other

     15         13         15         5.2         6.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

       
     100         100         100         4.9         5.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

       

Equity securities include ING Group ordinary shares of nil (0.00% of total plan assets) as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 2 million, 0.02% of total plan assets). Debt securities include investments in ING Group of EUR 42 million (0.30% of total plan assets) as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 57 million, 0.4% of total plan assets). Other includes mainly real estate. Real estate occupied by ING Group as at December 31, 2011 which is included in Other includes nil (0.00% of total plan assets) (2010: EUR 5 million, 0.04% of total plan assets).

Determination of expected return on assets

An important aspect of financial reporting is the assumption used for return on assets (ROA). The ROA is updated at least annually, taking into consideration the Plans’ asset allocations, historical returns on the types of assets held in the Funds, and the current economic environment. Based on these factors, it is expected that the Funds’ assets will earn an average annual percentage in the long-term. This estimate takes into account a reduction for administrative expenses and non-ING investment manager fees paid from the Funds. For estimation purposes, it is assumed that the long term asset mixes will be consistent with the current mixes. Changes in the asset mixes could have an impact on the amount of recognised pension income or expense, the funded status of the Plans, and the need for future cash contributions.

Weighted averages of basic actuarial assumptions in annual % as at December 31,

 

     Pension benefits      Post-employment
benefits other
than pensions
 
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Discount rates

     5.30         5.40         4.70         4.70   

Mortality rates

     1.00         1.00         1.00         1.00   

Expected rates of salary increases (excluding promotion increases)

     2.20         2.70         2.70         2.70   

Medical cost trend rates

           6.10         6.10   

Indexation

     1.80         1.80         2.00         2.00   

The assumptions above are weighted by defined benefit obligations. The rates used for salary developments, interest discount factors and other adjustments reflect country-specific conditions.

The presented discount rate is the weighted average of the discount rates that are applied in different countries. These rates are based on AA corporate bond yields of the specific countries with durations matching the pension liabilities.

 

F-76


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

An increase of 1% in the assumed medical cost trend rate for each future year would have resulted in an additional accumulated defined benefit obligation of EUR 5 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 5 million) and EUR 1 million increase in the charge for the year (2010: EUR 1 million). A decrease of 1% in the medical cost trend rate for each future year would have resulted in lower defined benefit obligation of EUR 5 million as at December 31, 2011 (2010: EUR 5 million) and EUR 2 million decrease in the charge for the year (2010: EUR 2 million).

The actuarial assumption for Indexation for inflation decreased to 1.8% in 2010 mainly as a result of a revised best estimate assumption for future indexation in the pension plan in the Netherlands. As a result of the uncertain circumstances the probability of granting indexation in the short-term future decreased. In 2011, this assumption remained at 1.8% reflecting the uncertainty of granting indexation in the short-term future.

Expected cash flows

For 2012 the expected contributions to pension plans are EUR 575 million.

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service as appropriate, are expected to be made by the plan:

Benefit payments

 

     Pension
benefits
    

Post-
employment
benefits
other

than
pensions

 

2012

     577         15   

2013

     549         15   

2014

     534         15   

2015

     567         14   

2016

     554         14   

Years 2017 – 2021

     3,511         45   

22 Assets by contractual maturity

Amounts presented in these tables by contractual maturity are the amounts as presented in the balance sheet.

 

F-77


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Assets by contractual maturity

 

2011   

Less

than

1 month (1)

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

     Maturity
not
applicable
     Total  

Cash and balances with central banks

     31,194                        31,194   

Amounts due from banks

     26,168         4,420         5,211         8,146         1,378            45,323   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

                    

– trading assets

     40,037         7,797         12,068         25,751         37,572         463         123,688   

– investments for risk of policyholders (2)

                    116,438         116,438   

– non-trading derivatives

     637         521         1,789         5,913         8,299            17,159   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     52         78         790         1,212         1,565         1,740         5,437   

Investments

                    

– available-for-sale

     3,860         3,578         15,025         58,620         105,429         22,027         208,539   

– held-to-maturity

     285         999         1,029         6,314         241            8,868   

Loans and advances to customers

     71,742         13,229         34,457         147,566         325,733         4,150         596,877   

Reinsurance contracts

     17         39         234         1,026         2,656         1,898         5,870   

Intangible assets

     4         8         239         487         166         2,654         3,558   

Deferred acquisition costs

     19         22         98         698         3,630         5,737         10,204   

Assets held for sale (3)

        62,483                     62,483   

Other assets

     10,857         3,190         7,407         4,094         4,969         499         31,016   

Remaining assets (where maturities are not applicable) (4)

                    6,926         6,926   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     184,872         96,364         78,347         259,827         491,638         162,532         1,273,580   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Includes assets on demand.

(2) 

Investments for risk of policyholders are managed on behalf of policyholders on a fair value basis. Although individual instruments may (or may not) have a maturity depending on their nature, this does not impact the liquidity position of ING.

(3) 

Assets held for sale consist of the assets of the disposal groups classified as held for sale as disclosed in Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’. The maturity is based on the classification as disposal group held for sale.

(4) 

Included in remaining assets where maturities are not applicable are property and equipment, real estate investments and investments in associates. Due to their nature remaining assets consist mainly of assets expected to be recovered after more than 12 months.

 

F-78


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Assets by contractual maturity

 

2010   

Less

than

1 month (1)

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

     Maturity
not
applicable
     Total  

Cash and balances with central banks

     13,072                        13,072   

Amounts due from banks

     30,770         4,608         4,706         9,447         2,297            51,828   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

                    

– trading assets

     42,785         8,875         11,569         34,468         27,423         555         125,675   

– investments for risk of policyholders (2)

                    120,481         120,481   

– non-trading derivatives

     474         184         864         4,637         5,563            11,722   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     140         53         917         1,291         1,902         1,713         6,016   

Investments

                    

– available-for-sale

     4,551         3,842         14,273         72,824         103,375         23,682         222,547   

– held-to-maturity

     328         879         1,143         8,786         557            11,693   

Loans and advances to customers

     69,678         15,101         34,354         142,308         343,175         4,322         608,938   

Reinsurance contracts

     17         32         142         727         2,729         2,142         5,789   

Intangible assets

     6         12         295         698         195         4,166         5,372   

Deferred acquisition costs

     20         24         109         820         3,149         6,377         10,499   

Assets held for sale (3)

           681                  681   

Other assets

     13,043         3,137         7,890         6,052         5,518         829         36,469   

Remaining assets (where maturities are not applicable) (4)

                    11,957         11,957   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     174,884         36,747         76,943         282,058         495,883         176,224         1,242,739   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Includes assets on demand.

(2) 

Investments for risk of policyholders are managed on behalf of policyholders on a fair value basis. Although individual instruments may (or may not) have a maturity depending on their nature, this does not impact the liquidity position of ING.

(3) 

Assets held for sale consist of the assets of the disposal groups classified as held for sale as disclosed in Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’. The maturity is based on the classification as disposal group held for sale.

(4) 

Included in remaining assets where maturities are not applicable are property and equipment, real estate investments and investments in associates. Due to their nature remaining assets consist mainly of assets expected to be recovered after more than 12 months.

23 Liabilities by maturity

The tables below include all financial liabilities by maturity based on contractual, undiscounted cash flows. Furthermore, the undiscounted future coupon interest on financial liabilities payable is included in a separate line and in the relevant maturity bucket. Derivative liabilities are included on a net basis if cash flows are settled net. For other derivative liabilities the contractual gross cash flow payable is included.

Non-financial liabilities are included based on a breakdown of the balance sheet amounts by expected maturity. Reference is made to the liquidity risk paragraph in the ‘Risk Management’ section for a description on how liquidity risk is managed.

 

F-79


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Liabilities by maturity

 

2011   

Less

than

1 month (1)

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

    

Maturity
not

applicable

     Adjustment (2)     Total  

Subordinated loans

                    8,939         (81     8,858   

Debt securities in issue

     28,883         24,725         13,570         49,469         21,072            2,142        139,861   

Other borrowed funds

     5,710         93         47         4,156         8,727         416         535        19,684   

Amounts due to banks

     49,608         11,691         3,825         1,808         5,317            (16     72,233   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     385,934         25,895         40,658         12,205         2,079            776        467,547   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

                      

– other trading liabilities

     38,507         3,109         907         2,773         5,706            633        51,635   

– trading derivatives

     3,026         4,373         11,493         26,834         23,103            (12,782     56,047   

– non-trading derivatives

     891         828         4,335         12,536         9,529         1,130         (7,084     22,165   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     301         398         2,062         6,007         4,525            (272     13,021   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

     512,860         71,112         76,897         115,788         80,058         10,485         (16,149     851,051   

Insurance and investment contracts

     2,788         1,788         10,345         39,034         105,512         119,366           278,833   

Liabilities held for sale (3)

        64,265                       64,265   

Other liabilities

     9,064         2,964         10,402         7,130         2,520         1,122           33,202   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial liabilities

     11,852         69,017         20,747         46,164         108,032         120,488           376,300   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     524,712         140,129         97,644         161,952         188,090         130,973         (16,149     1,227,351   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Coupon interest due on financial liabilities

     6,799         1,088         4,185         10,651         41,831              64,554   

 

(1) 

Includes liabilities on demand.

(2) 

This column reconciles the contractual undiscounted cash flows on financial liabilities to the balance sheet values. The adjustments mainly relate to the impact of discounting and, for derivatives, to the fact that the contractual cash flows are presented on a gross basis (unless the cash flows are actually settled net).

(3) 

Liabilities held for sale consist of the liabilities of the disposal groups classified as held for sale as disclosed in Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’. The maturity is based on the classification as disposal group held for sale.

 

F-80


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Liabilities by maturity

 

2010   

Less

than

1 month (1)

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

    

Maturity
not

applicable

     Adjustment (2)     Total  

Subordinated loans

                    10,918         (273     10,645   

Debt securities in issue

     20,578         36,140         21,289         41,016         16,079            502        135,604   

Other borrowed funds

     3,969         2,055         1,289         3,600         9,785         1,121         472        22,291   

Amounts due to banks

     44,480         15,781         6,082         2,154         4,371            (16     72,852   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     451,425         25,142         20,690         12,376         1,729              511,362   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

                      

– other trading liabilities

     46,084         5,329         1,182         9,377         3,779            534        66,285   

– trading derivatives

     3,096         3,255         9,615         27,747         18,930            (20,878     41,765   

– non-trading derivatives

     718         229         4,912         18,745         6,987         1,047         (14,856     17,782   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     260         472         1,014         6,094         4,996            (129     12,707   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

     570,610         88,403         66,073         121,109         66,656         13,086         (34,644     891,293   

Insurance and investment contracts

     1,822         2,108         9,117         37,045         97,918         123,118           271,128   

Liabilities held for sale (3)

           424                    424   

Other liabilities

     11,787         2,513         9,855         7,516         3,377         1,398           36,446   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-financial liabilities

     13,609         4,621         19,396         44,561         101,295         124,516           307,998   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     584,219         93,024         85,469         165,670         167,951         137,602         (34,644     1,199,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Coupon interest due on financial liabilities

     2,813         1,599         3,891         12,277         51,920              72,500   

 

(1) 

Includes liabilities on demand.

(2) 

This column reconciles the contractual undiscounted cash flows on financial liabilities to the balance sheet values. The adjustments mainly relate to the impact of discounting and, for derivatives, to the fact that the contractual cash flows are presented on a gross basis (unless the cash flows are actually settled net).

(3) 

Liabilities held for sale consist of the liabilities of the disposal groups classified as held for sale as disclosed in Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’. The maturity is based on the classification as disposal group held for sale.

24 Derivatives and hedge accounting

Use of derivatives and hedge accounting

As described in the ‘Risk management’ section, ING Group uses derivatives (principally interest rate swaps and cross currency interest rate swaps) for economic hedging purposes in the management of its asset and liability portfolios and structural positions. The objective of economic hedging is to enter into positions with an opposite risk profile to an identified exposure to reduce that exposure. The impact of ING Group’s hedging activities is to optimise the overall cost to the Group of accessing debt capital markets and to mitigate the market risk which would otherwise arise from structural imbalances in the duration and other profiles of its assets and liabilities. In addition, hedging activities are undertaken to hedge against the interest rate risk in the mortgage offer period in relation to retail mortgages and to lock in the interest margin in relation to interest bearing assets and the related funding.

The accounting treatment of hedge transactions varies according to the nature of the instrument hedged and whether the hedge qualifies under the IFRS-IASB hedge accounting rules. Derivatives that qualify for hedge accounting under IFRS-IASB are classified and accounted for in accordance with the nature of the instrument hedged and the type of IFRS-IASB hedge model that is applicable. The three models applicable under IFRS-IASB are: fair value hedge accounting, cash flow hedge accounting and net investment hedge accounting. These are described under the relevant headings below. The company’s detailed accounting policies for these three hedge models are set out in section ‘Principles of valuation and determination of results’.

 

F-81


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

To qualify for hedge accounting under IFRS-IASB, strict criteria must be met. Certain hedges that are economically effective from a risk management perspective do not qualify for hedge accounting under IFRS-IASB. The fair value changes of derivatives relating to such non qualifying hedges are taken to the profit and loss account. However, in certain cases, the Group mitigates the profit and loss account volatility by designating hedged assets and liabilities at fair value through profit and loss. If hedge accounting is applied under IFRS-IASB, it is possible that during the hedge a hedge relationship no longer qualifies for hedge accounting and hedge accounting cannot be continued, even if the hedge remains economically effective. As a result, the volatility arising from undertaking economic hedging in the profit and loss account may be higher than would be expected from an economic point of view.

With respect to exchange rate and interest rate derivative contracts, the notional or contractual amounts of these instruments is indicative of the nominal value of transactions outstanding at the balance sheet date; however they do not represent amounts at risk. ING Group uses credit derivatives to manage its exposure to credit risk, including total return swaps and credit default swaps, to sell or buy protection for credit risk exposures in the loan, investment and trading portfolios. Hedge accounting is not applied in relation to credit derivatives.

Fair value hedge accounting

ING Group’s fair value hedges principally consist of interest rate swaps and cross-currency interest rate swaps that are used to protect against changes in the fair value of fixed-rate instruments due to movements in market interest rates.

Gains and losses on derivatives designated under fair value hedge accounting are recognised in the profit and loss account. The effective portion of the fair value change on the hedged item is also recognised in the profit and loss account. As a result, only the net accounting ineffectiveness has an impact on the net result.

For the year ended December 31, 2011, ING Group recognised EUR 354 million (2010: EUR (153) million) of fair value changes on derivatives designated under fair value hedge accounting in the profit and loss account. This amount was partly offset by EUR (335) million (2010: EUR 157 million) fair value changes recognised on hedged items. This resulted in EUR 19 million (2010: EUR 4 million) net accounting ineffectiveness recognised in the profit and loss account. As at December 31, 2011, the fair values of outstanding derivatives designated under fair value hedge accounting was EUR (638) million (2010: EUR (208) million), presented in the balance sheet as EUR 3,192 million (2010: EUR 4,127 million) positive fair values under assets and EUR 3,830 million (2010: EUR 4,335 million) negative fair values under liabilities.

ING Group applies fair value hedge accounting for portfolio hedges of interest rate risk (macro hedging) under the EU ‘carve out’ of IFRS-EU. The EU ‘carve-out’ macro hedging enables a group of derivatives (or proportions) to be viewed in combination and jointly designated as the hedging instrument and removes some of the limitations in fair value hedge accounting relating to hedging core deposits and under-hedging strategies. Under the IFRS-EU ‘carve-out’, hedge accounting may be applied to core deposits and ineffectiveness only arises when the revised estimate of the amount of cash flows in scheduled time buckets falls below the designated amount of that bucket. ING Group applies the IFRS-EU ‘carve-out’ to its retail operations in which the net exposure of retail funding (savings and current accounts) and retail lending (mortgages) is hedged. The hedging activities are designated under a portfolio fair value hedge on the mortgages, using the IFRS-EU provisions.

Cash flow hedge accounting

ING Group’s cash flow hedges principally consist of (forward) interest rate swaps and cross-currency interest rate swaps that are used to protect against its exposure to variability in future interest cash flows on non-trading assets and liabilities that bear interest at variable rates or are expected to be refunded or reinvested in the future. The amounts and timing of future cash flows, representing both principal and interest flows, are projected for each portfolio of financial assets and liabilities, based on contractual terms and other relevant factors including estimates of prepayments and defaults. The aggregate principal balances and interest cash flows for the respective portfolios form the basis for identifying the notional amount subject to interest rate risk that is designated under cash flow hedge accounting.

 

F-82


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Gains and losses on the effective portions of derivatives designated under cash flow hedge accounting are recognised in Shareholders’ equity. Interest cash flows on these derivatives are recognised in the profit and loss account in interest result consistent with the manner in which the forecast cash flows affect net result. The gains and losses on ineffective portions of such derivatives are recognised immediately in the profit and loss account.

For the year ended December 31, 2011, ING Group recognised EUR 1,124 million (2010: EUR 475 million) after tax in equity as effective fair value changes on derivatives under cash flow hedge accounting. As a consequence, the balance of the cash flow hedge reserve in equity as at December 31, 2011 was EUR 2,611 million (2010: EUR 1,110 million) gross and EUR 1,971 million (2010: EUR 847 million) after deferred tax. This cash flow hedge reserve will fluctuate with the fair value changes of the underlying derivatives and will be reflected in the profit and loss account under Interest income/expense over the remaining term of the underlying hedged items. The cash flow hedge reserve relates to a large number of derivatives and hedged items with varying maturities, up to 45 years for insurance operations and 47 years for banking operations, with the largest concentrations in the range of 2 to 9 years for insurance operations and 1 to 6 years for banking operations. Accounting ineffectiveness on derivatives designated under cash flow hedge accounting resulted in a loss of EUR 17 million (2010: EUR 7 million loss) which was recognised in the profit and loss account.

As at December 31, 2011, the fair value of outstanding derivatives designated under cash flow hedge accounting was EUR 179 million (2010: EUR (824) million), presented in the balance sheet as EUR 6,641 million (2010: EUR 4,440 million) positive fair values under assets and EUR 6,462 million (2010: EUR 5,264 million) negative fair values under liabilities.

As at December 31, 2011, the fair value of outstanding non-derivatives designated as hedging instruments for cash flow hedge accounting purposes was EUR (21 million (2010: nil).

Included in Interest income and interest expense on non-trading derivatives is EUR 2,966 million (2010: EUR 3,613 million) and EUR 2,959 million (2010: EUR 3,138 million), respectively, relating to derivatives used in cash flow hedges.

Hedges of net investments in foreign operations

ING Group’s net investment hedges principally consist of derivatives (including currency forwards and swaps) and non-derivative financial instruments such as foreign currency denominated funding that are used to protect against foreign currency exposures on foreign subsidiaries.

Gains and losses on the effective portions of derivatives designated under net investment hedge accounting are recognised in Shareholders’ equity. The balance in equity is recognised in the profit and loss account when the related foreign subsidiary is disposed. The gains and losses on ineffective portions are recognised immediately in the profit and loss account.

As at December 31, 2011, the fair value of outstanding derivatives designated under net investment hedge accounting was EUR (18 million (2010: EUR (87) million), presented in the balance sheet as EUR 141 million (2010: EUR 81 million) positive fair values under assets and EUR 159 million (2010: EUR 168 million) negative fair values under liabilities.

As at December 31, 2011, the fair value of outstanding non-derivatives designated under net investment hedge accounting was EUR (335) million (2010: EUR 208 million).

Accounting ineffectiveness recognised in the profit and loss account for the year ended December 31, 2011 on derivatives and non-derivatives designated under net investment hedge accounting was nil (2010: EUR 5 million).

 

F-83


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

25 Discontinued operations

The majority of the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations were disposed of in December 2011. This transaction qualifies under IFRS as a discontinued operation. The results of the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations that were divested for the year (and comparative years) and the result recognised on disposal are presented below:

Results from discontinued operations

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Total income

     711         779         837   

Total expenses

     567         512         634   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Result before tax from discontinued operations

     144         267         203   

Tax related to current pre-tax gross result

     30         51         103   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Post-tax result from discontinued operations

     114         216         100   

Post-tax result on disposal of discontinued operations (1)

     995         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total net result from discontinued operations

     1,109         216         100   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The tax effect on the result on disposal of discontinued operations is nil.

Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’ for more details on the disposal of the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations.

The net cash flow incurred by the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations are as follows:

Net cash flow from discontinued operations

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Operating cash flow

     (13     (25     11   

Investing cash flow

     (68     56        49   

Financing cash flow

     (25     (6     (25
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow

     (106     25        35   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The sales proceeds in cash of EUR 2,572 million is presented in the consolidated statement of cash flows under ‘Net cash flow from investment activities - Disposals and redemptions: group companies’ and is not included in the table above.

26 Assets not freely disposable

The assets not freely disposable consist primarily of interest bearing securities pledged to secure deposits from De Nederlandsche Bank (the Dutch central bank) and other banks and serve to secure margin accounts or are used for other purposes required by law. The assets not freely disposable are as follows:

Assets not freely disposable

 

     2011      2010  

Investments

     1,610         8,632   

Loans and advances to customers

     29,800         37,638   

Banks

     18,033         12,025   

Other assets

     4,431         8,731   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     53,874         67,026   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Banks includes Amounts due from banks and balances with central banks. In some jurisdictions ING Bank N.V. has an obligation to maintain a reserve with central banks.

Loans and advances to customers, not freely disposable, includes the loan to the Dutch State in connection with the Illiquid Assets Back-Up Facility agreement as disclosed in Note 33 ‘Related parties’ and loans that for liquidity purposes have been pledged as collateral in the United States of EUR 9 billion (2010: EUR 7 billion), Germany of EUR 5 billion (2010: EUR 5 billion) and Canada of nil (2010: EUR 5 billion).

 

F-84


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The table does not include assets relating to repurchase and stock lending transactions. Reference is made to Note 3 ‘Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss’, Note 4 ‘Investments’ and Note 5 ‘Loans and advances to customers’ for the relevant amounts.

There are no material terms and conditions relating to the collateral represented in the above table which are individually significant.

27 Contingent liabilities and commitments

In the normal course of business the Group is party to activities whose risks are not reflected in whole or in part in the consolidated financial statements. In response to the needs of its customers, the Group offers financial products related to loans. These products include traditional off-balance sheet credit-related financial instruments.

Contingent liabilities and commitments

 

2011   

Less
than

1 month

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

     Maturity
not
applicable
     Total  

Banking operations

                    

Contingent liabilities in respect of

                    

– discounted bills

     1         1                     2   

– guarantees

     18,614         867         820         1,484         3,832            25,617   

– irrevocable letters of credit

     9,271         6,156         1,569         193         17            17,206   

– other

     452         45         65         8               570   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     28,338         7,069         2,454         1,685         3,849            43,395   

Insurance operations

                    

Commitments

     1,148         158         174         227         3         115         1,825   

Guarantees

              9         10         5         24   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,148         158         174         236         13         120         1,849   

Irrevocable facilities

     35,972         14,858         5,211         24,354         5,793            86,188   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     65,458         22,085         7,839         26,275         9,655         120         131,432   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contingent liabilities and commitments

 

2010   

Less
than

1 month

    

1-3

months

    

3-12

months

    

1-5

years

    

Over 5

years

     Maturity
not
applicable
     Total  

Banking operations

                    

Contingent liabilities in respect of

                    

– discounted bills

     1         1         1                  3   

– guarantees

     15,555         472         1,132         1,350         3,202            21,711   

– irrevocable letters of credit

     7,333         6,070         1,914         192         31            15,540   

– other

     333         22         64         9               428   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     23,222         6,565         3,111         1,551         3,233            37,682   

Insurance operations

                    

Commitments

     1,515         117         66         200         13         103         2,014   

Guarantees

              8         10         5         23   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,515         117         66         208         23         108         2,037   

Irrevocable facilities

     38,082         16,552         5,251         24,686         5,456            90,027   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     62,819         23,234         8,428         26,445         8,712         108         129,746   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Guarantees relate both to credit and non-credit substitute guarantees. Credit substitute guarantees are guarantees given by ING Group in respect of credit granted to customers by a third party. Many of them are expected to expire without being drawn on and therefore do not necessarily represent future cash outflows. In addition to the items included in contingent liabilities, ING Group has issued guarantees as a participant in collective arrangements of national industry bodies and as a participant in government required collective guarantee schemes which apply in different countries.

Irrevocable letters of credit mainly secure payments to third parties for a customer’s foreign and domestic trade transactions in order to finance a shipment of goods. ING Group’s credit risk in these transactions is limited since these transactions are collateralised by the commodity shipped and are of a short duration.

 

F-85


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Other contingent liabilities include acceptances of bills and are of a short-term nature. Other contingent liabilities also include contingent liabilities resulting from the normal operations of the Real Estate business including obligations under development and construction contracts. None of the items included in Other contingent liabilities are individually significant.

Irrevocable facilities mainly constitute unused portions of irrevocable credit facilities granted to corporate clients. Many of these facilities are for a fixed duration and bear interest at a floating rate. ING Group’s credit risk and interest rate risk in these transactions is limited. The unused portion of irrevocable credit facilities is partly secured by customers’ assets or counter-guarantees by the central governments and exempted bodies under the regulatory requirements. Irrevocable facilities also include commitments made to purchase securities to be issued by governments and private issuers.

Furthermore, ING Group leases assets from third parties under operating leases as lessee. The future rental commitments to be paid under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows:

Future rental commitments for operating lease contracts

 

2012

     305   

2013

     247   

2014

     189   

2015

     171   

2016

     156   

Years after 2016

     285   

28 Special purpose entities and securitisation

Securitisation

ING Group as originator

ING Group enters into synthetic securitisation programmes in order to reduce credit risk on certain assets. In synthetic securitisations, ING Group enters into a credit default swap with securitisation Special Purpose Entities (SPEs), in relation to which ING Group purchases credit protection in respect of residential mortgage loans and loans to small and medium-sized enterprises. The SPEs have in turn hedged their exposure with investors through the issue of credit linked notes or credit linked commercial paper. As a result of these transactions, ING Group has transferred a substantial part of the credit risk related to these loan portfolios to third-party investors. In general, the third-party investors in securities issued by the SPE have recourse only to the assets of the SPE and not to ING Group.

After securitisation of these assets ING Group continues to recognise them on its balance sheet under Loans and advances to customers. These transactions are therefore not off-balance sheet arrangements.

Assets under synthetic securitisation programmes

 

     2011      2010  

Loans to small and medium-sized enterprises

     5,251         5,273   

Mortgages

     6,245         6,476   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     11,496         11,749   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

ING Group as sponsor of multi-seller conduit

In the normal course of business, ING Group structures financing transactions for its clients by assisting them in obtaining sources of liquidity by selling the clients’ receivables or other financial assets to an SPE. The SPE issues asset-backed commercial paper to the market to fund the purchases. ING Group, in its role as administrative agent, facilitates these transactions by providing structuring, accounting, funding and operations services.

 

F-86


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Group supports the commercial paper programmes by providing the SPE with short-term standby liquidity facilities. These liquidity facilities are intended primarily to cover temporarily disruptions in the commercial paper market. Once drawn these facilities bear normal credit risk. A number of programmes are supported by granting structured liquidity facilities to the SPE, in which ING Group covers at least some of the credit risk incorporated in these programmes itself (in addition to normal liquidity facilities), and might suffer credit losses as a consequence. Furthermore, under a Programme Wide Credit Enhancement ING Group guarantees to a limited amount all remaining losses incorporated in the SPE to the commercial paper investors. All facilities, which vary in risk profile, are granted to the SPE subject to normal ING Group credit and liquidity risk analysis procedures. The fees received for services provided and for facilities are charged subject to market conditions. The SPE is included in the consolidation of ING Group. These transactions are therefore not off-balance sheet arrangements.

The normal non-structured standby liquidity facilities and the structured facilities are reported under irrevocable facilities.

Collateralised debt obligations (CDO)-transactions

Within ING Group, SPEs are used for CDO transactions. In a typical CDO transaction an SPE is used to issue structured, rated securities which are backed (or collateralised) by a pool of transferable debt securities. Besides investing in CDOs ING Group often has different roles in these transactions:

 

 

the arranger of the transaction; ING Group structures the SPE, acquires the assets for the SPE and sells the CDOs to investors;

 

 

collateral manager of the assets in the SPE; ING Group manages the assets based on strict conditions of the SPEs charter.

ING Group receives market-rate fees for structuring, asset managing and distributing CDO-securities to investors. The total amount of these fees is not significant.

ING Group as investor

As part of its investment activities, ING Group invests in securitisations by purchasing notes or by selling credit protection in the market using credit default swaps from securitisation SPEs. For certain own asset securitisation programmes ING Group acts as a market maker and holds limited positions in this capacity.

Other entities

ING Group is also a party to other SPEs used, for example, in structured finance and leasing transactions.

Investment funds

ING Group as fund manager and investor

ING Group sets up investment funds for which it acts as a fund manager and sole investor at the inception of the fund. Subsequently, ING Group will seek third-party investors to invest in the fund, thereby reducing the interest of ING Group. In general, ING Group will maintain a small percentage of interest in these funds. These funds are included in the consolidated financial statements of the Group if and when control exists, taking into account both ING Group’s financial interests for own risk and its role as investment manager.

ING Group as fund manager

ING Group acts as fund manager for several funds. Fees related to these management activities are charged on an at arm’s-length basis. In general, as a fund manager ING Group will hold these funds in a fiduciary capacity. These funds are therefore generally not included in the consolidated financial statements of ING Group.

 

F-87


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

29 Principal subsidiaries

The principal subsidiaries of ING Groep N.V. and their place of incorporation are as follows:

 

Companies treated as part of the banking operations

  

ING Bank N.V.

  

The Netherlands

Bank Mendes Gans N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Lease Holding N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Corporate Investments B.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Vastgoed Management Holding B.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Commercial Finance B.V.

  

The Netherlands

Westland Utrecht Bank N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING België N.V.

  

Belgium

Record Bank N.V.

  

Belgium

ING Luxembourg S.A.

  

Luxembourg

ING Bank Slaski S.A.

  

Poland

ING Financial Holdings Corporation

  

United States of America

ING Vysya Bank Ltd.

  

India

ING Direct N.V.

  

Canada, Germany, Spain, Australia, France, United States of America, Italy, United Kingdom

ING Bank A.S.

  

Turkey

Companies treated as part of the insurance operations

  

ING Verzekeringen N.V.

  

The Netherlands

Nationale-Nederlanden Levensverzekering Maatschappij N.V.

  

The Netherlands

Nationale-Nederlanden Schadeverzekering Maatschappij N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Insurance Eurasia N.V.

  

The Netherlands

Parcom Capital B.V.

  

The Netherlands

Nationale-Nederlanden Service N.V.

  

The Netherlands

Movir N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Re (Netherlands) N.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Fund Management B.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Vastgoed Belegging B.V.

  

The Netherlands

ING Zivotna Poistovna a.s.

  

Slovakia

ING Nationale-Nederlanden Polska S.A.

  

Poland

ING Nationale-Nederlanden Polska Powszechne Towarzystwo Emerytaine S.A.

  

Poland

ING Asigurari de Viata S.A.

  

Romania

ING Greek Life Insurance Company S.A.

  

Greece

ING Nationale-Nederlanden Magyarorszagi Biztosito Rt.

  

Hungary

Nationale-Nederlanden Vida, Compañia de Seguros y Reaseguros S.A.

  

Spain

Nationale-Nederlanden Generales, Compañia de Seguros y Reaseguros S.A.

  

Spain

ING America Insurance Holdings, Inc.

  

United States of America

ING International Insurance Holdings, Inc.

  

United States of America

ING Life Insurance and Annuity Company

  

United States of America

ING North America Insurance Corporation

  

United States of America

Lion Connecticut Holdings Inc.

  

United States of America

ReliaStar Life Insurance Company

  

United States of America

ReliaStar Life Insurance Company of New York

  

United States of America

Security Life of Denver Insurance Company

  

United States of America

ING USA Annuity and Life Insurance Company

  

United States of America

ING Investment Management Co

  

United States of America

Security Life of Denver International Limited

  

Cayman Islands

ING Insurance Berhad

  

Malaysia

ING Life Insurance Company (Japan) Limited

  

Japan

ING Life Insurance Company (Korea) Limited

  

South Korea

ING Life Insurance Company (Bermuda) Limited

  

Hong Kong

30 Companies acquired and companies disposed

Acquisitions effective in 2011

There were no significant acquisitions in 2011.

 

F-88


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Disposals effective in 2011

Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd.

In June 2011 ING had completed the sale of its entire stake in China’s Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd. (PALIC) to China Construction Bank for a consideration of EUR 82 million, and a net profit of EUR 28 million. This is the outcome of a strategic review announced in April 2009 as part of ING’s Back to Basics program. The stake in PALIC was previously included in the segment Insurance Asia/Pacific. The deal had been announced in 2009 and was presented as held for sale since 2009 until the sale was completed.

ING REIM Europe, ING REIM Asia and Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES)

ING announced in February 2011 that it has reached agreement with CB Richard Ellis Group, Inc., to sell ING REIM Europe, ING REIM Asia and Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES), ING REIM’s US-based manager of listed real estate securities, as well as part of ING’s equity interests in funds managed by these businesses.

In July 2011 ING announced the completion of the sale of Clarion Real Estate Securities (CRES) to CB Richard Ellis. The sale resulted in a net gain on divestment of EUR 182 million. CRES was previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

In October 2011 ING announced that it had completed the sale of REIM’s Asian and European operations to US-based CBRE Group Inc., thereby completing the divestment of ING REIM. The divestment of ING REIM has resulted in an after-tax gain on disposal of approximately EUR 245 million. As a result of the agreement at closing ING continues to have certain contingent income and expenses, however no significant impact on the result on divestment is expected. REIM’s Asian and European operations were previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

Clarion Partners

In June 2011 ING announced the completion of the sale of the private market real estate investment manager of its US operations, Clarion Partners, to Clarion Partners management in partnership with Lightyear Capital LLC for USD 100 million. The sale resulted in a net gain on divestment of EUR 39 million. Clarion Partners was previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

ING Investment Management Australia

In October 2011 ING completed the sale of ING Investment Management (ING IM) Australia to UBS AG. ING IM Australia’s business provided a number of investment strategies and products directly to the Australian institutional and wholesale markets. This transaction supports ING’s objective to actively manage its capital and portfolio of businesses to ensure an attractive and coherent combination for the announced divestment of its insurance and investment management activities. ING IM Australia was previously included in the segment ING Investment Management.

Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations

In December 2011 ING completed the sale of its Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations for a total consideration of EUR 2,637 million to Grupo de Inversiones Suramericana (‘GRUPOSURA’). The sale is the first major step in the divestment of ING’s insurance and investment management activities. Under the terms of the agreement, ING received EUR 2,572 million in cash and GRUPOSURA will assume EUR 65 million in debt. The sale resulted in a net profit of EUR 995 million. Included in the transaction are the mandatory pension and voluntary savings businesses in Chile, Colombia, Mexico, Uruguay and ING’s 80% stake in AFP Integra S.A. in Peru; the life insurance businesses in Chile and Peru; As part of this transaction ING sold its 33.7% stake in Peruvian InVita Seguros de Vida S.A. to the Wiese Family, ING’s joint venture partner in InVita. The transaction also includes the local investment management capabilities in these five countries. Not included in the transaction is ING’s 36% stake in the leading Brazilian insurer Sul America SA. ING’s Commercial Banking activities in Mexico, Brazil and Argentina are not affected by the announcement. ING’s Mortgage and ING’s Leasing businesses in Mexico are also not part of the transaction.

 

F-89


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations were previously included in the segments Insurance Latin America and ING Investment Management before they were classified as discontinued operations. The segment Insurance Latin America has ceased to exist following this transaction as the majority of assets and liabilities have been sold. The net result from discontinued operations is presented separately in the consolidated profit and loss account. Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’ for more detailed disclosures.

ING Car Lease

In September 2011 ING completed the sale of ING Car Lease to BMW Group fleet management division Alphabet for total proceeds of EUR 696 million and a net transaction result of EUR 347 million. ING Car Lease was previously partly included in both the Commercial and Retail Banking segment.

Disposals occurred in 2012

ING Direct USA

In June 2011 ING announced that it reached an agreement to sell ING Direct USA to Capital One Financial Corporation, a leading US-based financial holding company. In February 2012 ING announced that the transaction closed. Total proceeds of the transaction are approximately USD 9.0 billion (or approximately EUR 6.9 billion), including USD 6.3 billion in cash and USD 2.7 billion in the form of 54.0 million shares in Capital One, based on the share price of USD 49.29 at closing on February 16, 2012. These shares represented a 9.7% stake in Capital One at closing. The transaction has resulted in a positive result after tax of approximately EUR 0.5 billion.

In 2011 ING Direct USA is still included in the segment ING Direct. After this sale ING Direct USA will no longer be consolidated.

In connection with the divestment of ING Direct USA, ING also completed the adjustment of the agreement with the Dutch State concerning the structure of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (IABF) which was also announced on June 16, 2011. The amendment serves to de-link the IABF from ING Direct USA by putting ING Bank in its place as counterparty for the Dutch State. The IABF is further amended to ensure a continued alignment between ING and the State regarding exposure to the Alt-A portfolio. Only the part of the IABF covering ING Direct USA, currently approximately 85% of the total IABF-portfolio, is adjusted in the amendment. The ING Insurance part of the IABF remains unaltered. Reference is made to Note 33 ‘Related parties’ for details on the original agreement and the amendments made.

 

F-90


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Most significant companies disposed in 2011

 

     Clarion
Partners
    Clarion
Real
Estate
securities
    ING
REIM
Asia
and
Europe
    ING
Car
Lease
    Pacific
Antai Life
Insurance
Company
Ltd
    Latin
American
pensions,
life
insurance
and
investment
management
operations
    Total  

General

              

Primary line of business

     Bank        Bank        Bank        Bank        Insurance        Insurance     

Sales proceeds

              

Cash proceeds (1)

     69        224        365        696        82        2,572        4,008   

Non-cash proceeds

              
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sales proceeds

     69        224        365        696        82        2,572        4,008   

Assets

              

Cash assets

             7        80        87   

Investments

             146        644        790   

Loans and advances to customers

         1        104        54        6        165   

Amounts due from banks

     1        3        94        103            201   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     5              10        679        694   

Property and equipment

           3,275            3,275   

Miscellaneous other assets

     20        44        82        341        48        1,491        2,026   

Liabilities

              

Insurance and investment contracts

             205        715        920   

Amounts due to banks

           101            101   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

           3,028          66        3,094   

Miscellaneous other liabilities

     10        19        116        333        14        563        1,055   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     16        28        61        361        46        1,556        2,068   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% disposed

     100     100     100     100     80     Various  (2)   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets disposed

     16        28        61        361        37        1,478        1,981   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gain/loss on disposal (3)

     39        182        245        347        28        995        1,836   

 

(1) 

Cash outflow/inflow on group companies in the cash flow statement includes cash outflows/inflows on individually immaterial disposals in addition to the cash flows presented.

(2) 

Comprises various entities as explained in the description of the disposal.

(3) 

The gain/loss on disposal comprises the sales proceed, the net assets disposed, the expenses directly related to the disposal and the realisation of unrealised reserves.

Acquisitions effective in 2010

There were no significant acquisitions in 2010.

Disposals effective in 2010

In October 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell its Asian Private Banking business for a consideration of USD 1,463 million (EUR 985 million). The Asia franchise offers private banking services in 11 markets, including Hong Kong, the Philippines and Singapore. The transaction generated a net profit for ING of EUR 332 million. The sale was completed in the first half of 2010. The Asian Private Banking business was previously included in the segment Retail Asia.

In October 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell its Swiss Private Banking business to Julius Baer for a consideration of EUR 345 million (CHF 520 million) in cash. The transaction generated a net profit for ING of EUR 73 million. The sale was completed in January 2010. The Swiss Private Banking business was previously included in the segment Retail CE.

 

F-91


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In August 2010 ING announced that it has agreed to sell its 50% stake in ING Summit Industrial Fund LP (‘Summit’), a Canadian light industrial property portfolio to a joint venture between KingSett Capital and Alberta Investment Management Corporation (AIMCo). The sale was completed in November 2010. The transaction value for 100% of Summit is CAD 2.0 billion (EUR 1.4 billion) and includes assumed debt. In addition to its direct investment in Summit, ING has an indirect participation through its 7.8% unit holding of ING Industrial Fund (IIF), an ING-managed listed property fund in Australia which owns the remaining 50% in Summit. As part of the transaction, IIF has agreed to simultaneously sell its stake in Summit to KingSett/AIMCo. Consequently, ING’s indirect participation in Summit will end as well. Separately, ING sold ING Real Estate Canada, the manager of Summit, to KingSett/AIMCo for an undisclosed amount. The transaction had no material impact on ING Group’s 2010 results and capital ratios. The transaction resulted in a net loss of EUR 26 million in 2010. Summit was previously included in the segment ING Real Estate.

Furthermore there were some disposals that did not have a significant impact on ING’s balance sheet and profit and loss account. In November 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell three of its United States independent retail broker-dealer units to Lightyear Capital LLC for a total consideration of EUR 96 million. The transaction concerns Financial Network Investment Corporation, based in El Segundo, California, Multi-Financial Securities Corporation, based in Denver, Colorado, PrimeVest Financial Services, Inc., based in St. Cloud, Minnesota, and ING Brokers Network LLC, the holding company and back-office supporting those broker dealers, which collectively do business as ING Advisors Network. The sale was completed in February 2010. The three United States independent retail broker-dealer units were previously included in the segment Insurance US.

In December 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell the non-life insurance operations in Greece for a total consideration of EUR 4 million. The sale was completed in July 2010.

 

F-92


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Most significant companies disposed in 2010

 

     Asia
Private
Banking
business (3)
    Swiss
Private
Banking
business (3)
    ING
Summit
Industrial
Fund LP
    Total  

General

        

Primary line of business

     Bank        Bank        Bank     

Sales proceeds

        

Cash proceeds (1)

     985        345        333        1,663   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sales proceeds

     985        345        333        1,663   

Assets

        

Cash assets

     4        179          183   

Investments

     41        236          277   

Loans and advances to customers

     2,390        816        6        3,212   

Amounts due from banks

     1,171        1,177        39        2,387   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     397        8          405   

Real estate investments

         1,620        1,620   

Miscellaneous other assets

     20        46        57        123   

Liabilities

        

Amounts due to banks

     180        755        952        1,887   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     3,098        1,382          4,480   

Miscellaneous other liabilities

     92        53        52        197   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     653        272        718        1,643   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% disposed

     100     100     50 % (4)   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets disposed

     653        272        359        1,284   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gain/loss on disposal (2)

     332        73        (26     379   

 

(1) 

Cash outflow/inflow on group companies in the cash flow statement includes cash outflows/inflows on individually immaterial disposals in addition to the cash flows presented.

(2) 

The gain/loss on disposal comprises the sales proceed, the net assets disposed, the expenses directly related to the disposal and the realisation of unrealised reserves.

(3) 

As per December 31, 2009 recognised as a disposal group held for sale.

(4) 

After disposal of the 50% stake ING has no remaining stake in Summit.

2009

Goodwill recognised in 2009 amounted to EUR 39 million as disclosed in Note 9 ‘Intangible assets’. This includes EUR 26 million in relation to the consolidation of 3W Holding B.V as disclosed below. There were no significant acquisitions in 2009.

In August 2009 ING obtained control of its 50% owned joint venture 3W Holding B.V., a real estate development company. ING obtained a majority representation in the Supervisory Board of 3W Holding B.V. and entered into an option agreement that allows ING to acquire the remaining 50%. As a result of obtaining control, 3W Holding B.V. is fully included in the consolidation as of September 2009. Net assets upon consolidation amounted to EUR (21 million. The estimated consideration payable for obtaining the remaining 50% under the option agreement is approximately EUR 5 million. Therefore, goodwill of EUR 26 million is recognised. This goodwill is mainly attributable to operational synergies arising from obtaining control of the professional network of 3W and the future business potential in the southern Netherlands where 3W is active.

 

F-93


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

     3W Holding B.V.  

General

  

Primary line of business

     Bank   

Date of full consolidation

     September 1, 2009   

Purchase consideration payable

     5   

Assets

  

Miscellaneous other assets

     51   

Liabilities

  

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     21   

Miscellaneous other liabilities

     51   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

     (21
  

 

 

 

Goodwill recognised

     26   

Profit since date of full consolidation

     (16

Income if fully consolidated as of start of year

     (5

Profit if fully consolidated as of start of year

     (19

Disposals effective in 2009

In October 2008 ING reached agreement to sell its entire Taiwanese life insurance business, ING Life Taiwan, to Fubon Financial Holding Co. Ltd. The sale was completed in February 2009 at a final sales price of EUR 466 million (USD 600 million). This differs from the proceeds reported in 2008 of EUR 447 million due to movements in the dollar/euro exchange rate between date of signing the sales agreement and the date of closing. ING was paid in a fixed number of shares with the difference between the fair value of those shares at the closing date and the sale price being paid in subordinated debt securities of the acquirer. This transaction resulted in a loss of EUR 292 million. This loss includes EUR 214 million loss on disposal (recognised in 2008 in ‘Net result on disposal of group companies’ in the profit and loss account) and EUR 78 million operating loss in the period that ING Life Taiwan was held for sale. ING Life Taiwan was previously included in the segment Insurance Asia/Pacific.

In February 2009, ING completed the sale of its 70% stake in ING Canada for net proceeds of EUR 1,316 million. This differs from the proceeds presented in the annual accounts of 2008 of EUR 1,265 million due to movements in the Canadian dollar/euro exchange rate between date of signing the sales agreement and the date of closing. The sale was effected through a private placement and a concurrent ‘bought deal’ public offering in Canada. This transaction resulted in a loss of EUR 38 million. ING Canada was previously included in the segment Insurance US.

In July 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell its non-core Annuity and Mortgage businesses in Chile to Corp Group Vida Chile, S.A for EUR 217 million. This sale does not impact ING’s Pension, Life Insurance, and Investment Management businesses in Chile where ING remains committed to developing leadership positions. This sale was completed in November 2009 and resulted in a loss of EUR 23 million. These non-core Annuity and Mortgages businesses were previously included in the segment Insurance Latin America.

In September 2009 ING reached an agreement to sell its life insurance and wealth management venture in Australia and New Zealand to ANZ, its joint venture partner. Under the terms of the agreement, ING sold its 51% equity stakes in ING Australia and ING New Zealand to ANZ for EUR 1,106 million cash proceeds. The transaction is part of ING’s Back to Basics strategy. The sale was completed in November 2009 and resulted in a profit for ING of EUR 337 million. The joint venture was previously included in the segment Insurance Asia/Pacific.

 

F-94


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Most significant companies disposed in 2009

 

     ING Life
Taiwan (5)
    ING Canada    

Annuity and
Mortgage
business

of Chile

   

Australia/

New
Zealand

    Total  

General

          

Primary line of business

     Insurance        Insurance        Insurance        Insurance     

Sales proceeds

          

Cash proceeds (1)

       1,316        217        1,106        2,639   

Non-cash proceeds

     466              466   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sales proceeds

     466        1,316        217        1,106        3,105   

Assets

          

Cash assets

     80        322        2        233        637   

Investments

     9,801        2,350        1,803        385        14,339   

Loans and advances to customers

     1,341        79        413          1,833   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     1,552        1,075        52        8,370        11,049   

Miscellaneous other assets

     2,538        2,092        74        639        5,343   

Liabilities

          

Insurance and investment contracts

     14,294        3,761        2,009        8,524        28,588   

Miscellaneous other liabilities

     260        223        95        334        912   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets

     758        1,934        240        769        3,701   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% disposed

     100     70 % (4)      100     100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets disposed

     758        1,354        240        769        3,121   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gain/loss on disposal (2)

     (292 (3)      (38     (23     337        (16

 

(1) 

Cash outflow/inflow on group companies in the cash flow statement includes cash outflows/inflows on individually immaterial disposals in addition to the cash flows presented.

(2) 

The gain/loss on disposal comprises the sales proceed, the net assets disposed, the expenses directly related to the disposal and the realisation of unrealised reserves.

(3) 

The loss was recognised in 2008.

(4) 

After disposal of the 70% stake ING has no remaining stake in ING Canada.

(5) 

Assets and liabilities included in this column were presented as assets/liabilities held for sale as at December 31, 2008.

31 Legal proceedings

ING Group companies are involved in litigation and arbitration proceedings in the Netherlands and in a number of foreign jurisdictions, including the United States, involving claims by and against them which arise in the ordinary course of their businesses, including in connection with their activities as insurers, lenders, employers, investors and taxpayers. In certain of such proceedings, very large or indeterminate amounts are sought, including punitive and other damages. While it is not feasible to predict or determine the ultimate outcome of all pending or threatened legal and regulatory proceedings, the Company’s management is of the opinion that neither it nor any of its subsidiaries is aware of any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which the Company is aware) which may have or have in the recent past had a significant effect on the financial position or profitability of the Company.

Because of the geographic spread of its business, ING may be subject to tax audits in numerous jurisdictions at any point in time. Although ING believes that it has adequately provided for all its tax positions, the ultimate resolution of these audits may result in liabilities which are different from the amounts recognised.

 

F-95


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Proceedings in which ING is involved, include complaints and lawsuits concerning the performance of certain interest sensitive products that were sold by a former subsidiary of ING in Mexico. Proceedings also include lawsuits that have been filed by former employees of an Argentina subsidiary, whose employment was terminated as a result the Republic of Argentina’s nationalisation of the pension fund system. Litigation has been filed by the purchaser of certain ING Mexican subsidiaries who claims that the financial condition of the subsidiaries was not accurately depicted. Further, purported class litigation has been filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging violations of the federal securities laws with respect to disclosures made in connection with the 2007 and 2008 offerings of ING’s Perpetual Hybrid Capital Securities. The Court has determined that the claims relating to the 2007 offerings were without merit and has dismissed them. The challenged disclosures that survived the Court’s ruling relate solely to the June 2008 offering, and primarily to ING Group’s investments in certain residential mortgage-backed securities. Additional purported class litigation challenges the operation of the ING Americas Savings Plan and ESOP and the ING 401(k) Plan for ILIAC Agents. The District Court has dismissed the latter case and plaintiffs have appealed. Also an administrator of an ERISA plan has filed a lawsuit seeking to represent a class of ERISA plan administrators claiming that an ING subsidiary has breached certain of its ERISA duties. These matters are being defended vigorously; however, at this time, ING is unable to assess their final outcome. Therefore at this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect.

Since the end of 2006, unit-linked products (commonly referred to in Dutch as ‘beleggingsverzekeringen’) have received negative attention in the Dutch media, from Dutch Parliament, the AFM and consumer protection organisations. Costs of unit-linked products sold in the past are perceived as too high and insurers are in general being accused of being less transparent in their offering of unit-linked products. The criticism on unit-linked products led to the introduction of compensation schemes by Dutch insurance companies that have offered unit-linked products. In 2008 ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries reached an outline agreement with all consumer protection organisations to offer compensation to their unit-linked policyholders where individual unit-linked policies have a cost charge in excess of an agreed maximum and to offer similar compensation for certain hybrid insurance products. At December 31, 2008 a provision was recognised for the costs of the settlement. The costs were valued at EUR 365 million. A full agreement on implementation was reached in 2010 with one of the two main consumer protection organisations. In addition, ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries announced additional (so-called ‘flanking’) measures that comply with the ‘Best in Class’ criteria as formulated on November 24, 2011 by the Dutch Minister of Finance. In December 2011 this resulted in an agreement on these measures with the two main consumer protection organisations. Implementation has started; our plan is to inform all unit-linked policyholders about compensation by the end of 2012. Neither the implementation of the compensation schemes nor these additional measures prevent individual policyholders from initiating legal proceedings against ING’s Dutch insurance subsidiaries. Policyholders have initiated and may continue to initiate legal proceedings claiming further damages. Because of the continuous public and political attention for the unit-linked issue in general and the uncertain outcome of pending and future legal proceedings, it is not feasible to predict or determine the ultimate financial consequences.

In January 2010 ING lodged an appeal with the General Court of the European Union against specific elements of the European Commission’s decision regarding ING’s restructuring plan. In its appeal, ING contests the way the Commission has calculated the amount of state aid ING received and the disproportionality of the price leadership restrictions specifically and the disproportionality of restructuring requirements in general. In July 2011 the appeal case was heard orally by the General Court of the European Union. On March 2, 2012, the Court partially annulled the Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009 and as a result a new decision must be issued by the Commission. Interested parties can file an appeal against the General Court’s judgment before the Court of Justice of the European Union within two months and ten days after the date of the General Court’s judgment.

 

F-96


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In January 2011 the Association of Stockholders (Vereniging van Effectenbezitters, ‘VEB’) has issued a writ alleging that investors were misled by the prospectus that was issued with respect to the September 2007 rights issue of Fortis N.V. (now: Ageas N.V.) against Ageas N.V., the underwriters of such rights issue, including ING Bank, and former directors of Fortis N.V. According to the VEB the prospectus shows substantive incorrect and misleading information. The VEB states that the impact and the risks of the subprime crisis for Fortis and Fortis’ liquidity position have been reflected incorrectly in the prospectus. The VEB requests a declaratory decision stating that the summoned parties have acted wrongfully and are therefore responsible for the damages suffered by the investors in Fortis. The amount of damages of EUR 18 billion has not been substantiated yet. ING will defend itself against this claim; at this time ING is not able to assess the future outcome. Therefore at this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect of such action.

In July 2011, the Dutch ING Pensioners’ Collective Action Foundation (Stichting Collectieve Actie Pensioengerechtigden ING Nederland), together with two trade unions (FNV Bondgenoten and CNV Dienstenbond) and a number of individual pensioners, instituted legal proceedings against ING’s decision not to provide funding for indexing pensions insured with Stichting Pensioenfonds ING (the Dutch ING Pension Fund) per January 1, 2011. In July 2011, also the Interest Group ING General Managers’ Pensions (Belangenvereniging ING-Directiepensioenen), together with a number of individual retired Dutch General Managers of ING, instituted legal proceedings against ING’s decision not to provide funding for indexing Dutch General Managers’ pensions per January 1, 2011. It is not feasible to predict the ultimate outcome of these legal proceedings although legal proceedings instituted by Stichting Pensioenfonds ING on the same issue were ruled in ING’s favour. The ultimate outcome of these proceedings may result in liabilities and provisions for such liabilities which are different from the amounts recognised. At this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect of such proceedings.

In addition to the foregoing procedures, ING Bank remains in discussions with authorities in the US concerning ING Bank’s compliance with Office of Foreign Asset Control requirements. ING Bank has received requests for information from US Government agencies including the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office. ING Bank is cooperating fully with the ongoing investigations and is engaged in discussions to resolve these matters with the US authorities; however, it is not yet possible to reliably estimate the timing or amount of any potential settlement, which could be significant. At this moment it is not practicable to provide an estimate of the (potential) financial effect.

In addition, like many other companies in the insurance industry, several of our U.S. companies have received formal requests for information from various governmental and regulatory agencies regarding whether and to what extent they proactively ascertain whether customers have deceased, pay benefits even where no claim has been made, and comply with state laws pertaining to unclaimed or abandoned property. Companies may have to make additional payments to beneficiaries and escheat additional funds deemed abandoned, and regulators may seek fines, penalties and interest. It is currently not practicable to estimate the (potential) financial effect of such information requests.

32 Joint ventures

Joint ventures are included proportionally in the consolidated financial statements as follows:

Most significant joint ventures

 

2011    Interest
held
(%)
     Assets      Liabilities      Income      Expenses  

Postkantoren B.V.

     50         57         69         16         21   

KB Life Insurance Company Ltd (1)

     49         1,524         1,390         449         434   

ING-BOB Life Insurance Company Ltd

     50         433         379         97         101   

ING Vysya Life Insurance Company Ltd (1)

     26         430         411         117         121   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        2,444         2,249         679         677   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Accounted for as joint venture because of joint control.

 

F-97


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Most significant joint ventures

 

2010    Interest
held
(%)
     Assets      Liabilities      Income      Expenses  

Postkantoren B.V.

     50         91         100         30         28   

KB Life Insurance Company Ltd (1)

     49         1,236         1,118         436         425   

ING-BOB Life Insurance Company Ltd

     50         333         289         87         85   

ING Vysya Life Insurance Company Ltd (1)

     26         495         466         127         136   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        2,155         1,973         680         674   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Accounted for as joint venture because of joint control.

33 Related parties

In the normal course of business, ING Group enters into various transactions with related parties. Parties are considered to be related if one party has the ability to control or exercise significant influence over the other party in making financial or operating decisions. Transactions have taken place on an arm’s length basis and include rendering or receiving of services, leases, transfers under finance arrangements and provisions of guarantees or collateral.

Transactions with joint ventures and associates

 

     Joint ventures      Associates  
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Receivables

     122         114         1,203         1,283   

Liabilities

     5         41         12         38   

Income received

     6         6         144         127   

Expenses paid

           20         11   

Transactions with ING Bank N.V. and ING Verzekeringen N.V.

 

     ING Bank N.V.      ING
Verzekeringen
N.V.
 
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Receivables

     7,515         9,411         2,617         2,095   

Liabilities

     2,869         736         

Income received

     868         825         60         184   

Expenses paid

     306         194         

Receivables on ING Bank N.V. and ING Verzekeringen N.V. mainly include long-term funding. Liabilities to ING Bank N.V. mainly include short-term deposits.

As part of the exchange offers disclosed in Note 14 ‘Subordinated loans’ EUR 0.9 billion intercompany debt from ING Bank N.V. to ING Groep N.V. was repaid.

In 2011 ING made a number of changes in the structure and composition of the Management Boards for Insurance and Banking. As of November 2011 the members of the Management Board Insurance Eurasia and the Management Board Americas Insurance Holdings are considered to be key management personnel and their compensation is therefore included, from that date, in the tables below. Before November 2011 the members of the Management Board Insurance Eurasia were members of the Management Board Insurance.

Transactions with key management personnel (Executive Board, Management Boards and Supervisory Board) and post-employment benefit plans are transactions with related parties. These transactions are disclosed in more detail as required by Part 9 Book 2 of the Dutch Civil Code in the remuneration report in the annual report. The relevant sections of the remuneration report therefore are part of the annual accounts. For the post-employment benefit plans see Note 21 ‘Other liabilities’.

The two members of the Executive Board of ING Groep N.V. are also members of the Management Boards of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings. The Management Board members of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings are also considered to be key management.

 

F-98


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Key management personnel compensation (Executive Board and Management Boards) (1)

 

2011

amounts in thousands of euros

   Executive
Board of
ING
Groep
N.V. (2)
     Management
Boards of ING
Bank N.V.,
ING
Verzekeringen
N.V.,
Insurance
Eurasia and
Americas
Insurance
Holdings (3)
     Total  

Base salary and variable compensation in cash

     2,666         8,240         10,906   

Pension costs

     315         2,083         2,398   

Retirement benefit

        1,828         1,828   

Fair market value of variable compensation in stock

        2,433         2,433   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation

     2,981         14,584         17,565   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

In light of the changed governance structure of both the Banking and Insurance organisation several changes were made to the Board structure of both entities, which resulted in an overall increase in the number of Board members. In January 2011, one additional Board member joined the Management Board Banking, and two additional Board members joined the Management Board Insurance. In October 2011 a Management Board Banking member stepped down and his successor and another member joined that same month. The latter Board member also joined the Management Board Insurance at the same time. In November 2011, a separate Management Board for Americas Insurance Holdings was created, which included four new members.

(2) 

Includes the compensation earned in the capacity as Executive Board member. One Executive Board member stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011, therefore his compensation is included till October 2011

(3) 

Excluding members that are also members of the Executive Board of ING Groep N.V.

Key management personnel compensation (Executive Board and Management Boards)

 

2010

amounts in thousands of euros

   Executive
Board of
ING
Groep
N.V.
     Management
Boards of ING
Bank N.V.
and ING
Verzekeringen
N.V. (1)
     Total  

Base salary and variable compensation in cash

     2,853         5,910         8,763   

Pension costs

     292         1,263         1,555   

Termination benefit

        980         980   

Fair market value of variable compensation in stock

        1,376         1,376   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation

     3,145         9,529         12,674   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Excluding three members that are also members of the Executive Board of ING Groep N.V.

The Executive Board members decided to forego the variable remuneration in relation to performance year 2010. The above table outlines the actual situation.

Key management personnel compensation (Supervisory Board)

 

     Supervisory
Board
 
amounts in thousands of euros    2011      2010  

Base salary

     857         1,010   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation

     857         1,010   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans and advances to key management personnel

 

     Amount
outstanding
December 31,
     Average
interest rate
    Repayments  
amounts in thousands of euros    2011      2010      2011     2010     2011      2010  

Executive Board members (1)

     1,968         1,968         3.6     3.6     

Management Board members of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings

     2,314         13         3.4     4.3     388         4   

Supervisory Board members

     282         282         8.6     8.6     
  

 

 

    

 

 

        

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,564         2,263             388         4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Includes the Executive Board member that stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011.

 

F-99


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The total number of stock options on ING Groep N.V. shares held by the Executive Board members, including the Executive Board member that stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011, of ING Group N.V. amounted to 164,689 as at December 31, 2011 (2010: 164,689) and total number of stock options on ING Groep N.V. shares held by Management Board members of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings amounted to 1,913,631 as at December 31, 2011 (2010: 2,676,675). As at December 31, 2011, members of the Executive Board, including the Executive Board member that stepped down from the Executive Board as per October 1, 2011, held 149,400 ING Groep N.V. shares (2010: 118,723) and members of the Management Boards of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings held 84,173 ING Groep N.V. shares (2010: 284,995). As at December 31, 2011, members of the Supervisory Board held 244,968 ING Groep N.V. shares (2010: 167,407).

There are no significant provisions for doubtful debts or individually significant bad debt expenses recognised on outstanding balances with related parties.

Transactions with the Dutch State

Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility

ING Group and the Dutch State reached an agreement on an Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (‘IABF’) on January 26, 2009. The transaction closed on March 31, 2009. The IABF covers the Alt-A portfolios of both ING Direct USA and ING Insurance US, with a par value of approximately EUR 30 billion. Under the IABF, ING transferred 80% of the economic ownership of its Alt-A portfolio to the Dutch State. As a result, an undivided 80% interest in the risk and rewards on the portfolio was transferred to the Dutch State. ING retained 100% of the legal ownership of its Alt-A portfolio. The transaction price was 90% of the par value with respect to the 80% proportion of the portfolio of which the Dutch State had become the economic owner. The transaction price remains payable by the Dutch State to ING and will be redeemed over the remaining life. Furthermore, under the IABF ING pays a guarantee fee to the State and receives a funding fee and a management fee. As a result of the transaction ING derecognised 80% of the Alt-A portfolio from its balance sheet and recognised a receivable from the Dutch State. The transferred Alt-A portfolio was previously included in Available-for-sale debt securities. The Dutch State also acquired certain consent rights with respect to the sale or transfer of the 20% proportion of the Alt-A portfolio that is retained by ING.

Under the terms of the transaction as agreed on January 26, 2009, the overall sales proceeds amounted to EUR 22.4 billion at the transaction date. The amortised cost (after prior impairments) at the transaction date was also approximately EUR 22.4 billion. The transaction resulted in a loss in the first quarter of 2009 of EUR 109 million after tax (the difference between the sales proceeds and the amortised cost). The fair value under IFRS-IASB at the date of the transaction was EUR 15.2 billion.

In order to obtain approval from the European Commission on ING Group’s Restructuring Plan (see below), ING agreed to make additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payments as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission to the Dutch State corresponding to an adjustment of the fees for the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility. In total, these additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payments as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission amounted to a net present value of EUR 1.3 billion pre-tax, which was recognised as a one-off charge in the fourth quarter of 2009. The remainder of the IABF as agreed in January 2009, including the transfer price of the securities of 90%, remained unaltered.

The difference between the total sales proceeds of EUR 21.1 billion (EUR 22.4 billion -/- adjustment of EUR 1.3 billion) and the fair value under IFRS-IASB of EUR 15.2 billion represents a ‘Government grant’ under IAS 20. This government grant is considered to be an integral part of the transaction and is therefore accounted for as part of the result on the transaction.

The transaction resulted in a reduction of the negative revaluation -and therefore an increase in equity- of EUR 4.6 billion (after tax).

The valuation method of the 20% Alt-A securities in the IFRS-IASB balance sheet is not impacted by the IABF. The methodology used to determine the fair value for these assets in the balance sheet under IFRS-IASB is disclosed in Note 34 ‘Fair value of financial assets and liabilities’.

As at December 31, 2011, the remaining outstanding amount from the transaction price that remained payable by the Dutch State is EUR 10.3 billion (2010: EUR 13.1 billion). The net amount of other unamortised components of the total sales proceeds, as explained above, amounts to EUR 0.6 billion payable (2010: EUR 0.7 billion).

 

F-100


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In connection with the sale of ING Direct USA as disclosed in Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’, ING has reached an agreement with the Dutch State to adjust the structure of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility (IABF). This adjustment served to de-link the IABF from ING Direct USA by putting ING Bank in its place as counterparty for the Dutch State and became effective at the closing of the sale in February 2012. Under the terms of the original transaction ING Direct USA held on its balance the remaining 20% of the Alt-A portfolio, ensuring an alignment of interests between ING and the Dutch state regarding the performance of the portfolio.

Upon closing of the sale ING provided a counter guarantee to the Dutch State covering 25% of the 80% part of the Dutch State. This guarantee covered realised cash losses if they would exceed the 35% that is implied by the market value of the portfolio in June 2011. This adjustment therefore lowered the risk exposure for the Dutch State. The impact on equity and result of the alignment for ING Bank was limited.

Only the part covering ING Direct USA, which currently covers approximately 85% of the total portfolio, is adjusted in the agreement and the guarantee only relates to the portfolio of ING Direct USA. The ING Insurance US and Bancorp part of the IABF remains unaltered.

Non-voting equity securities (Core Tier 1 securities)

On November 12, 2008, ING Groep N.V. issued one billion non-voting equity securities to the Dutch State at EUR 10 per non-voting equity security, resulting in an increase of ING Group’s core Tier 1 capital of EUR 10 billion. The nominal value of each security is EUR 0.24. The non-voting equity securities do not form part of ING Group’s share capital; accordingly they do not carry voting rights in the General Meeting of Shareholders.

These non-voting equity securities are deeply subordinated and rank pari-passu with ordinary shares in a winding up of ING Group.

On these non-voting equity securities a coupon is payable of the higher of:

 

 

EUR 0.85 per security, payable annually in arrears, with a first coupon of EUR 0.425 per security paid on May 12, 2009; and

 

 

110% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2009 (payable in 2010);

 

 

120% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2010 (payable in 2011);

 

 

125% of the dividend paid on each ordinary share over 2011 onwards (payable in 2012 onwards).

Since ING Groep N.V. had already paid an interim dividend of EUR 0.74 in August 2008, ING recognised a coupon payable of EUR 425 million to the Dutch State as of December 31, 2008. This coupon was paid on May 12, 2009.

Further coupons are to be paid on 12 May of each year (the coupon date) in cash if dividend on ordinary shares is paid in cash or to be paid in scrip securities in the event of a scrip dividend on ordinary shares. Coupons are only due and payable, on a non-cumulative basis and if a dividend is paid on ordinary shares over the financial year preceding the coupon date, either on an interim or a final dividend basis, provided that ING Groep N.V.’s capital adequacy position is and remains satisfactory both before and immediately after payment in the opinion of the Dutch Central Bank.

ING Groep N.V. has, as of November 12, 2011, the right to repay all or some of the non-voting equity securities at EUR 15 per security at any time, together with the pro-rata coupon accrued to such date. ING Groep N.V. and the Dutch State have agreed in October 2009 that up to EUR 5 billion of the EUR 10 billion core Tier 1 securities could be repaid at any time until January 31, 2010 at the original issue price of EUR 10 per non-voting equity security, plus a repurchase premium and accrued interest.

ING Groep N.V. also has the right to convert all or some of the non-voting equity securities into ordinary shares on the basis of one non-voting equity security for 1.335 ordinary shares or bearer depositary receipts from three years after the issue date onwards, subject to certain conditions. This equates to an exchange price of EUR 7.49. The Dutch State in that case has the right to demand a redemption payment of EUR 10 per non-voting equity security, together with the pro-rata coupon, if due, accrued to such date.

Both repayment and conversion of the securities must be approved by the Dutch Central Bank.

 

F-101


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Repayment non-voting equity shares

In December 2009, ING repaid the first half of the non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) of EUR 5 billion plus a total premium of EUR 605 million. On May 13, 2011 ING exercised its option for early repayment of EUR 2 billion of the remaining non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities). The total payment in May 2011 amounted to EUR 3 billion and included a 50% repurchase premium. ING funded this repayment from retained earnings. ING has indicated that it is one of its priorities to repay the remaining EUR 3 billion non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) as soon as possible, but this needs to be done very prudently in light of the current challenging and changing financial and regulatory environment.

In order to finance the repayment, in December 2009, of the non-voting equity securities and the associated expenses as well as to mitigate the capital impact of the additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payments as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission, ING launched a capital increase with preferential subscription rights for holders of (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares of up to EUR 7.5 billion. The rights issue, as disclosed in Note 13 ‘Shareholders’ equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities’ was authorised by the Extraordinary General Meeting of Shareholders on November 25, 2009. Proceeds of the issue in excess of the above amounts were used to strengthen ING’s capital position.

European Commission Restructuring Plan

In 2009, ING Groep N.V. submitted a Restructuring Plan to the European Commission as part of the process to receive approval for the government support measures. The European Commission has, by decision of November 18, 2009, formally approved the Restructuring Plan. The main elements of the Restructuring Plan as announced on October 26, 2009 are as follows:

 

 

elimination of double leverage and significant reduction of ING’s balance sheet;

 

 

divestment of all Insurance and Investment Management activities;

 

 

divestment of ING Direct USA;

 

 

creation of a new company in the Dutch retail market composed of Interadvies (including Westland Utrecht and the mortgage activities of Nationale-Nederlanden) and the existing consumer lending portfolio of ING Retail in the Netherlands. This business, once separated, needs to be divested;

 

 

restriction to be a price leader in any EU country for certain retail and SME banking products and restriction to acquire financial institutions or other businesses that would delay the repayment of the non-voting equity securities. These restrictions will apply for the shorter period of three years or until the non-voting equity securities have been repaid in full to the Dutch State;

 

 

an agreement with the Dutch State to alter the repayment terms of 50% of the non-voting equity securities;

 

 

repayment of EUR 5 billion of the non-voting equity securities issued in November 2008 to the Dutch State;

 

 

additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payments as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission will have to be made to the Dutch State in the form of fee adjustments relating to the Illiquid Assets Back-Up Facility which resulted in a one-off pre-tax charge to ING of EUR 1.3 billion in the fourth quarter of 2009;

 

 

launch of a EUR 7.5 billion rights issue, in order to finance the repayment of 50% of the non-voting equity securities and a mitigation of the capital impact of the additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payment as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission to the Dutch State of EUR 1.3 billion;

 

 

execution of the Restructuring Plan before the end of 2013;

 

 

if the overall return on the (remaining) non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) issued to the Dutch State is expected to be lower than 10% p.a., the European Commission may consider the imposition of additional behavioural constraints; and

 

 

The calling of Tier 2 capital and Tier 1 hybrids will in the future be proposed case by case to the Commission for authorisation, for the shorter period of three years starting from the date of the Commission decision or up to the date on which ING has fully repaid the non-voting equity securities (core Tier 1 securities) to the Dutch State (including the relevant accrued interest of core Tier 1 coupons and exit premium fees).

On January 28, 2010, ING lodged an appeal against specific elements of the European Commission’s decision. By judgment of March 2, 2012, the Court partially annulled the Commission’s decision of November 18, 2009, as a result of which a new decision has to be taken by the Commission. Interested parties can file an appeal against the General Court’s judgment before the Court of Justice of the European Union within two months and ten days after the date of the General Court’s judgment.

 

F-102


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Credit Guarantee Scheme

As part of the measures adopted to protect the financial sector, the Dutch State introduced a EUR 200 billion credit guarantee scheme for the issuance of medium term debt instruments by banks (the Credit Guarantee Scheme). ING Bank N.V. issued government guaranteed debt instruments under this Credit Guarantee Scheme (‘Government Guaranteed Bonds’) as part of its regular medium-term funding operations. The relevant Rules of the Credit Guarantee Scheme promulgate the rules applicable to any issues under the Credit Guarantee Scheme and include information such as scope, denomination, tenor and fees payable by the banks. ING Group pays a fee of 84 basis points over the issued bonds to the Dutch State to participate in the Credit Guarantee Scheme. Reference is made to Note 15 ‘Debt securities in issue’.

Other

Following the transactions as disclosed in this note, the Dutch State is a related party of ING Group. All other transactions between ING Group and the Dutch State are of a normal business nature and at arm’s length.

In the framework of the transactions with the Dutch State disclosed in this note, certain arrangements with respect to corporate governance and executive remuneration were agreed with the Dutch State which will remain in place as long as the Dutch State owns at least 250 million non-voting equity securities or as long as the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility is in place (whichever expires last). The arrangements set forth after the second and the fourth bullet hereunder remain valid as long as any of the Government Guaranteed Bonds is outstanding. These arrangements require that:

 

 

the Dutch State may recommend two candidates (the ‘State Nominees’) for appointment to the Supervisory Board. Certain decisions of the Supervisory Board require approval of the State Supervisory Board members;

 

 

ING Group must develop a sustainable remuneration policy for the Executive Board and Senior Management that is aligned to new international standards and submit this to its General Meeting for adoption. This remuneration policy shall include incentive schemes which are linked to long-term value creation, thereby taking account of risk and restricting the potential for ‘rewards for failure’. This new remuneration policy must, amongst others, include objectives relating to corporate and social responsibility;

 

 

members of the Executive Board may not receive any performance-related payment - either in cash, options, shares or bearer depositary receipts - for the years 2008 and 2009 until the adoption of the new remuneration policy in 2010;

 

 

severance payments to Executive Board members are limited to a maximum of one year’s fixed salary, in line with the Tabaksblat Code;

 

 

ING has undertaken to support the growth of lending to corporates and consumers (including mortgages) for an amount of EUR 25 billion, on market conforming terms;

 

 

ING agreed to pro-actively use EUR 10 billion of the Dutch Guarantee Scheme during 2009;

 

 

ING has committed itself to maintaining the Dutch payment system PIN on its payment debit cards as long as other market participants, representing a substantial market share, are still making use of this payment system; and

 

 

appointment of the Chief Executive Officer of the Executive Board requires approval of the State Nominees.

34 Fair value of financial assets and liabilities

The following table presents the estimated fair values of ING Group’s financial assets and liabilities. Certain balance sheet items are not included in the table, as they do not meet the definition of a financial asset or liability. The aggregation of the fair values presented below does not represent, and should not be construed as representing, the underlying value of ING Group.

 

F-103


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Fair value of financial assets and liabilities

 

     Estimated fair value      Balance sheet value  
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Financial assets

           

Cash and balances with central banks

     31,194         13,072         31,194         13,072   

Amounts due from banks

     45,269         51,651         45,323         51,828   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

           

– trading assets

     123,688         125,675         123,688         125,675   

– investments for risk of policyholders

     116,438         120,481         116,438         120,481   

– non-trading derivatives

     17,159         11,722         17,159         11,722   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     5,437         6,016         5,437         6,016   

Investments

           

– available-for-sale

     208,539         222,547         208,539         222,547   

– held-to-maturity

     8,835         11,854         8,868         11,693   

Loans and advances to customers

     610,448         614,548         596,877         608,938   

Other assets (1)

     22,367         26,906         22,367         26,906   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,189,374         1,204,472         1,175,890         1,198,878   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

           

Subordinated loans

     5,909         9,215         8,858         10,645   

Debt securities in issue

     141,774         136,586         139,861         135,604   

Other borrowed funds

     18,053         21,822         19,684         22,291   

Investment contracts for risk of company

     6,717         6,066         6,259         5,991   

Investment contracts for risk of policyholders

     6,939         5,984         6,939         5,984   

Amounts due to banks

     72,687         73,227         72,233         72,852   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     468,447         508,755         467,547         511,362   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

           

– trading liabilities

     107,682         108,050         107,682         108,050   

– non-trading derivatives

     22,165         17,782         22,165         17,782   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     13,021         12,707         13,021         12,707   

Other liabilities (2)

     26,177         29,671         26,177         29,671   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     889,571         929,865         890,426         932,939   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Other assets do not include (deferred) tax assets, property held for sale, pension assets and deferred charges.

(2) 

Other liabilities do not include (deferred) tax liabilities, pension liabilities, insurance provisions, prepayments received under property under development, share-based payment plans, other provisions and other taxation and social security contributions.

The estimated fair values correspond to the amounts at which the financial instruments at our best estimate could have been traded at the balance sheet date between knowledgeable, willing parties in arm’s length transactions. The fair value of financial assets and liabilities is based on quoted market prices, where available. Such quoted market prices are primarily obtained from exchange prices for listed instruments. Where an exchange price is not available, market prices are obtained from independent market vendors, brokers or market makers. Because substantial trading markets do not exist for all financial instruments various techniques have been developed to estimate the approximate fair values of financial assets and liabilities that are not actively traded. These techniques are subjective in nature and involve various assumptions about the relevant pricing factors, especially for inputs that are not readily available in the market (such as credit spreads for own-originated loans and advances to customers). Changes in these assumptions could significantly affect the estimated fair values. Consequently, the fair values presented may not be indicative of the net realisable value. In addition, the calculation of the estimated fair value is based on market conditions at a specific point in time and may not be indicative of future fair values.

Due to a change in market practices for pricing derivatives, ING Group is in the process of adopting a discounting curve, that reflects the Overnight Indexed Swap (‘OIS’) instead of the previously used term EURIBOR rate. In addition, ING refined its calculation methodology for reflecting credit risk in derivatives and issued liabilities. The impact of both these changes is recorded in the profit and loss account; the overall financial effect in 2011 was not material.

 

F-104


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The following methods and assumptions were used by ING Group to estimate the fair value of the financial instruments:

Financial assets

Cash and balances with central banks

The carrying amount of cash approximates its fair value.

Amounts due from banks

The fair values of receivables from banks are generally based on quoted market prices or, if unquoted, on estimates based on discounting future cash flows using available market interest rates offered for receivables with similar characteristics, similar to Loans and advances to customers described below.

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss and Investments

Derivatives

Derivatives contracts can either be exchange traded or over the counter (OTC). The fair value of exchange-traded derivatives is determined using quoted market prices in an active market and those derivatives are classified in Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. For those instruments not actively traded, fair values are estimated based on valuation techniques. OTC derivatives and derivatives trading in an inactive market are valued using valuation techniques because quoted market prices in an active market are not available for such instruments. The valuation techniques and inputs depend on the type of derivative and the nature of the underlying instruments. The principal techniques used to value these instruments are based on discounted cash flows, Black-Scholes option models and Monte Carlo simulation. These valuation models calculate the present value of expected future cash flows, based on ‘no-arbitrage’ principles. These models are commonly used in the banking industry. Inputs to valuation models are determined from observable market data where possible. Certain inputs may not be observable in the market directly, but can be determined from observable prices via valuation model calibration procedures. The inputs used include prices available from exchanges, dealers, brokers or providers of consensus pricing, yield curves, credit spreads, default rates, recovery rates, dividend rates, volatility of underlying interest rates, equity prices and foreign currency exchange rates. These inputs are determined with reference to quoted prices, recently executed trades, independent market quotes and consensus data, where available.

Equity securities

The fair values of publicly traded equity securities are based on quoted market prices when available. Where no quoted market prices are available, fair value is determined based on quoted prices for similar securities or other valuation techniques.

The fair value of private equity is based on quoted market prices, if available. In the absence of quoted prices in an active market, fair value is estimated on the basis of an analysis of the investee’s financial position and results, risk profile, prospects, price, earnings comparisons and revenue multiples and by reference to market valuations for similar entities quoted in an active market.

Debt securities

Fair values for debt securities are based on quoted market prices, where available. Quoted market prices may be obtained from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory service. If quoted prices in an active market are not available, fair value is determined by management based on an analysis of available market inputs, which may include values obtained from one or more pricing services or by a valuation technique that discounts expected future cash flows using a market interest rate curves, referenced credit spreads, maturity of the investment and estimated prepayment rates where applicable.

Certain asset backed securities in the United States are valued using external price sources that are obtained from third party pricing services and brokers.

 

F-105


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In order to determine which independent price in the range of prices obtained best represents fair value under IAS 39, ING applies a discounted cash flow model to calculate an indicative fair value. The key input to this model is a discount rate derived from an internal matrix that is used to construct the discount rate per security by applying credit and liquidity spreads relevant to the characteristics of such asset classes. The main assumptions in this matrix include:

 

 

a base spread;

 

 

a liquidity risk premium;

 

 

an additional credit spread, based on:

 

   

seniority in the capital structure – an adjustment is applied to each security based on its position in the capital structure;

 

   

vintage – an adjustment is applied for underwriting guidelines deteriorating from 2004 to 2007 in combination with differences in home price developments for these vintages.

The spreads are expressed in basis points and reflect the current market characteristics for credit and liquidity.

The indicative fair value obtained through the discounted cash flow model is then used to select the independently obtained price that is closest to the indicative price. In addition, judgement is applied in the event that the resulting indicative fair value is closest to the highest obtained vendor price and that price is a significant outlier compared to other obtained vendor prices. In such cases, the second highest obtained vendor price is deemed the most representative of fair value. The indicative price is not itself used for valuing the security; rather, it is used to select the most appropriate price obtained from independent external sources. As a result, each security in the portfolio is priced based on an external price, without modification by ING Group.

Loans and receivables

Reference is made to Loans and advances to customers below.

Loans and advances to customers

For loans and advances that are repriced frequently and have had no significant changes in credit risk, carrying amounts represent a reasonable estimate of fair values. The fair values of other loans are estimated by discounting expected future cash flows using interest rates offered for similar loans to borrowers with similar credit ratings.

The fair values of mortgage loans are estimated by taking into account prepayment behaviour and discounting future cash flows using interest rates currently being offered for similar loans to borrowers with similar credit ratings. The fair values of fixed rate policy loans are estimated by discounting cash flows at the interest rates charged on policy loans of similar policies currently being issued. Loans with similar characteristics are aggregated for calculations purposes. The carrying values of variable rate policy loans approximate their fair value.

Other assets

The other assets are stated at their carrying value which is not materially different from their fair value.

Financial liabilities

Subordinated loans

The fair value of the subordinated loans is estimated using discounted cash flows based on interest rates and credit spreads that apply to similar instruments.

Investment contracts

For investment contracts for risk of company the fair values have been estimated using a discounted cash flow approach based on interest rates currently being offered for similar contracts with maturities consistent with those remaining for the contracts being valued. For investment contracts for risk of policyholder the fair value generally equals the fair value of the underlying assets.

Amounts due to banks

The fair values of payables to banks are generally based on quoted market prices or, if not available, on estimates based on discounting future cash flows using available market interest rates and credit spreads for payables to banks with similar characteristics.

 

F-106


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

The carrying values of customer deposits and other funds on deposit with no stated maturity approximate their fair values. The fair values of deposits with stated maturities have been estimated based on discounting future cash flows using the interest rates currently applicable to deposits of similar maturities.

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

The fair values of securities in the trading portfolio and other liabilities at fair value through profit and loss are based on quoted market prices, where available. For those securities not actively traded, fair values are estimated based on internal discounted cash flow valuation techniques using interest rates and credit spreads that apply to similar instruments. Reference is made to Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss above.

Debt securities in issue and other borrowed funds

The fair value of debt securities in issue and other borrowed funds is generally based on quoted market prices or, if not available, on estimated prices by discounting expected future cash flows using a current market interest rate and credit spreads applicable to the yield, credit quality and maturity.

Other liabilities

The other liabilities are stated at their carrying value which is not materially different from their fair value.

Fair value hierarchy

ING Group has categorised its financial instruments that are measured in the balance sheet at fair value into a three level hierarchy based on the priority of the inputs to the valuation. The fair value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to valuation techniques based on unobservable inputs. An active market for the asset or liability is a market in which transactions for the asset or liability occur with sufficient frequency and volume to provide reliable pricing information on an ongoing basis. The fair value hierarchy consists of three levels, depending upon whether fair values were determined based on quoted prices in an active market (Level 1), valuation techniques with observable inputs (Level 2) or valuation techniques that incorporate inputs which are unobservable and which have a more than insignificant impact on the fair value of the instrument (Level 3). Financial assets in Level 3 include for example illiquid debt securities, complex OTC and credit derivatives, certain complex loans (for which current market information about similar assets to use as observable, corroborated data for all significant inputs into a valuation model is not available) and asset backed securities for which there is no active market and a wide dispersion in quoted prices.

Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources. Unobservable inputs are inputs which are based on the Group’s own assumptions about the factors that market participants would use in pricing an asset or liability, developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. Unobservable inputs may include volatility, correlation, spreads to discount rates, default rates and recovery rates, prepayment rates and certain credit spreads.

The fair values of the financial instruments carried at fair value were determined as follows:

Methods applied in determining fair values of financial assets and liabilities

 

2011    Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets

           

Trading assets

     32,903         89,403         1,382         123,688   

Investments for risk of policyholders

     111,203         5,094         141         116,438   

Non-trading derivatives

     1,477         14,723         959         17,159   

Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     251         2,300         2,886         5,437   

Available-for-sale investments

     120,889         81,926         5,724         208,539   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     266,723         193,446         11,092         471,261   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

           

Trading liabilities

     20,308         86,434         940         107,682   

Non-trading derivatives

     1,175         18,808         2,182         22,165   

Financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     1,150         7,599         4,272         13,021   

Investment contracts (for contracts carried at fair value)

     3,279         3,648         12         6,939   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     25,912         116,489         7,406         149,807   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-107


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Methods applied in determining fair values of financial assets and liabilities

 

2010    Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets

           

Trading assets

     49,644         73,899         2,132         125,675   

Investments for risk of policyholders

     115,102         5,243         136         120,481   

Non-trading derivatives

     90         10,997         635         11,722   

Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     1,143         3,027         1,846         6,016   

Available-for-sale investments

     113,994         101,816         6,104         221,914   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     279,973         194,982         10,853         485,808   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

           

Trading liabilities

     33,293         73,316         1,441         108,050   

Non-trading derivatives

     878         15,028         1,876         17,782   

Financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     1,834         7,648         3,225         12,707   

Investment contracts (for contracts carried at fair value)

     2,879         3,088         17         5,984   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     38,884         99,080         6,559         144,523   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Level 1 – Quoted prices in active markets

This category includes financial instruments whose fair value is determined directly by reference to published quotes in an active market. A financial instrument is regarded as quoted in an active market if quoted prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency, and those prices represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis.

Level 2 – Valuation technique supported by observable inputs

This category includes financial instruments whose fair value is determined using a valuation technique (e.g. a model), where inputs in the model are taken from an active market or are observable. If certain inputs in the model are unobservable, the instrument is still classified in this category, provided that the impact of those unobservable inputs on the overall valuation is insignificant. Included in this category are items whose value is derived from quoted prices of similar instruments, but for which the prices are modified based on other market observable external data.

Level 3 – Valuation technique supported by unobservable inputs

This category includes financial instruments whose fair value is determined using a valuation technique (e.g. a model) for which more than an insignificant part of the inputs in terms of the overall valuation are not market observable. This category also includes financial assets and liabilities whose fair value is determined by reference to price quotes but for which the market is considered inactive. Level 3 Available-for-sale investments include mainly asset backed securities in the United States as described above under ‘Debt securities’. Level 3 Trading assets, Non-trading derivatives and Assets designated at fair value through profit and loss and Level 3 Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss include financial instruments with different characteristics and nature, which are valued on the basis of valuation techniques that feature one or more significant inputs that are unobservable. An instrument in its entirety is classified as valued using significant unobservable inputs if a significant portion of the instrument’s fair value is driven by unobservable inputs. Unobservable in this context means that there is little or no current market data available from which the price at which an arm’s length transaction would be likely to occur can be derived. More details on the determination of the fair value of these instruments is included above under ‘Derivatives’, ‘Debt securities’ and ‘Loans and advances to customers’.

 

F-108


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in Level 3 Assets

 

2011    Trading
assets
    Investments
for risk of
policyholders
    Non-trading
derivatives
    Financial
assets
designated
as at fair
value
through
profit and
loss
    Available-for-sale
investments
    Total  

Opening balance

     2,132        136        635        1,846        6,104        10,853   

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year

     (361       311        10        (229     (269

Revaluation recognised in equity during the year

             (72     (72

Purchase of assets

     786        123        143        1,112        1,461        3,625   

Sale of assets

     (582     (99     (76     (271     (781     (1,809

Maturity/settlement

     (441       (75     (100     (783     (1,399

Transfers into Level 3

     95        4        13        224        920        1,256   

Transfers out of Level 3

     (245     (6       (2     (2,248     (2,501

Exchange rate differences

     (2     (17     8        59        9        57   

Changes in the composition of the group and other changes

           8        1,343        1,351   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,382        141        959        2,886        5,724        11,092   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Main changes in fair value hierarchy (2011 compared to 2010)

The classification was impacted in 2011 by a transfer of available-for-sale investments of EUR 2.0 billion from Level 3 to Level 2, relating to mortgage backed securities in the United States. Previously these were classified in Level 3 because of the dispersion between prices obtained for the same security from different price sources. In 2011 prices supported by market observable inputs became available and were used in determining the fair value.

Changes in the composition of the group and other changes includes the decrease of the Level 3 assets in relation to the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’. Furthermore Changes in the composition of the group and other changes includes the increase of the Level 3 assets in relation to shares in real estate investment funds; this increase includes mainly the reclassification of associates to investments available-for sale as disclosed in Note 6 ‘Investments in associates’, as well as the reclassification of equity securities in certain real estate companies into Level 3.

Transfers into Level 3 includes certain bonds which were transferred to Level 3 in 2011 as a result of reduced market liquidity and/or pricing sources that could no longer be classified as market observable.

There were no significant transfers between Level 1 and 2.

 

F-109


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in Level 3 Assets

 

2010    Trading
assets
    Investments
for risk of
policyholders
    Non-trading
derivatives
    Financial
assets
designated
as at fair
value
through
profit and
loss
    Available-
for-sale
investments
    Total  

Opening balance

     1,366        54        541        1,830        7,243        11,034   

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year

     193        (5     (275     3        (232     (316

Revaluation recognised in equity during the year

             1,047        1,047   

Purchase of assets

     1,394        134        554        608        1,365        4,055   

Sale of assets

     (899     (143     (340     (637     (720     (2,739

Maturity/settlement

     (275       (2     (96     (775     (1,148

Transfers into Level 3

     474        87        143        21        1,156        1,881   

Transfers out of Level 3

     (150         (4     (3,355     (3,509

Exchange rate differences

     29        9        14        121        375        548   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,132        136        635        1,846        6,104        10,853   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Main changes in fair value hierarchy (2010 compared to 2009)

Amounts in each of the levels of the fair value hierarchy are impacted by changes in the volume of portfolios and fluctuations in pricing levels and foreign currency rates. The amount in Level 3 is impacted by improved market activity in this area leading to increased trading and increases in portfolio volume in financial instruments that qualify for Level 3.

Level 3 assets increased because certain bonds were transferred to Level 3 in 2010 as a result of reduced market liquidity and/or pricing sources that could no longer be classified as market observable. On the other hand, Level 3 assets decreased in 2010 because of a transfer of available-for-sale investments of EUR 2.9 billion out of Level 3 to Level 2, relating to mortgage backed securities in the United States. Previously these were classified in Level 3 because of the dispersion between prices obtained for the same security from different price sources. In 2010 prices supported by market observable inputs became available and were used in determining fair value.

There were no significant transfers between Level 1 and 2.

Changes in Level 3 Liabilities

 

2011    Trading
liabilities
    Non-trading
derivatives
    Financial
liabilities
designated
as at fair
value
through
profit and
loss
    Investment
contracts
(for
contracts
carried at
fair value)
    Total  

Opening balance

     1,441        1,876        3,225        17        6,559   

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year

     46        183        113          342   

Issue of liabilities

     1,138        502        1,613        7        3,260   

Early repayment of liabilities

     (705     (49     (402     (3     (1,159

Maturity/settlement

     (928     (400     (645       (1,973

Transfers into Level 3

     125        25        441          591   

Transfers out of Level 3

     (175     (2     (80     (9     (266

Exchange rate differences

     (2     63        7          68   

Changes in the composition of the group

       (16         (16
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     940        2,182        4,272        12        7,406   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-110


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in Level 3 Liabilities

 

2010    Trading
liabilities
    Non-trading
derivatives
    Financial
liabilities
designated
as at fair
value
through
profit and
loss
    Investment
contracts
(for
contracts
carried at
fair value)
    Total  

Opening balance

     857        1,361        2,589        39        4,846   

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year

     119          85        (5     199   

Revaluation recognised in equity during the year

           9        9   

Issue of liabilities

     1,679        490        2,241        10        4,420   

Early repayment of liabilities

     (876     (247     (863     (55     (2,041

Maturity/settlement

     (326     (1     (561       (888

Transfers into Level 3

     165        282          11        458   

Transfers out of Level 3

     (176     (67     (266       (509

Exchange rate differences

     (1     58          8        65   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,441        1,876        3,225        17        6,559   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year (Level 3)

 

2011    Held at
balance
sheet
date
    Derecognised
during the
year
    Total  

Assets

      

Trading assets

     (364     3        (361

Non-trading derivatives

     308        3        311   

Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     10          10   

Available-for-sale investments

     (160     (69     (229
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (206     (63     (269
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

      

Trading liabilities

     46          46   

Non-trading derivatives

     194        (11     183   

Financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     113          113   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     353        (11     342   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts recognised in the profit and loss account during the year (Level 3)

 

2010    Held at
balance
sheet
date
    Derecognised
during the
year
    Total  

Assets

      

Trading assets

     157        36        193   

Investments for risk of policyholders

       (5     (5

Non-trading derivatives

     (248     (27     (275

Financial assets designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     29        (26     3   

Available-for-sale investments

     (264     32        (232
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (326     10        (316
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

      

Trading liabilities

     119          119   

Non-trading derivatives

     (2     2     

Financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     85          85   

Investment contracts (for contracts carried at fair value)

       (5     (5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     202        (3     199   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-111


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Sensitivities of fair values in Level 3

Reasonably likely changes in the non-observable assumptions used in the valuation of Level 3 assets and liabilities would not have a significant impact on equity and net result, other than explained below for investments in asset backed securities in the United States.

Asset backed securities in the United States

Level 3 assets include EUR 373 million at December 31, 2011 and EUR 3,362 million at December 31, 2010 for investments in asset backed securities in the United States. These assets are valued using external price sources that are obtained from third party pricing services and brokers. In 2011, these asset backed securities in the United States decreased as a result of a transfer from Level 3 to Level 2. Previously these were classified in Level 3 because of the dispersion between prices obtained for the same security from different price sources. In 2011 prices supported by market observable inputs became available and were used in determining the fair value. Furthermore the decrease was caused by the classification of ING Direct USA as a disposal group held for sale. Reference is made to Note 11 ‘Assets and liabilities held for sale’.

During 2008, the trading volumes in the relevant markets reduced significantly and the market became inactive. The dispersion between prices for the same security from different price sources increased significantly. In order to ensure that the most accurate and relevant sources available are used in determining the fair value of these securities, the valuation process was further enhanced during 2008 by using information from additional pricing sources and enhancing the process of selecting the most appropriate price.

Generally, up to four different pricing services are utilised. Management carefully reviews the prices obtained in conjunction with other information available, including, where relevant, trades in the market, quotes from brokers and internal evaluations. If the dispersion between different prices for the same securities is limited, a hierarchy exists that ensures consistent selection of the most appropriate price. If the dispersion between different prices for the same security is significant, additional processes are applied to select the most appropriate price, including an internally developed price validation matrix and a process to challenge the external price source.

Valuation for these securities is inherently complex and subjective. Although each security in the portfolio is priced based on an external price, without modification by ING Group, and management is confident that it has selected the most appropriate price in the current market circumstances, the valuation of these portfolios would have been different had different prices been selected. The sensitivity analysis shows that the highest and the lowest available market prices do not materially impact the valuation of these assets as at December 31, 2011.

Asset backed security portfolio

Fair value hierarchy of pressurised ABS bonds

 

2011    Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

US Subprime RMBS

        763         11         774   

US Alt-A RMBS

        495         7         502   

CDO/CLOs

     6         43         420         469   

CMBS

     2         4,404         6         4,412   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pressurised ABS

     8         5,705         444         6,157   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value hierarchy of pressurised ABS bonds

 

2010    Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

US Subprime RMBS

        17         1,630         1,647   

US Alt-A RMBS

        2,209         638         2,847   

CDO/CLOs

     9         65         557         631   

CMBS

     1         5,040         9         5,050   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pressurised ABS

     10         7,331         2,834         10,175   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-112


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain

Of the Government and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds exposure in Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain as disclosed in Note 4 ‘Investments’, EUR 5.3 billion is classified as available-for-sale and is measured at fair value (with the revaluation recognised in equity, taking into account impairments that are recognised in the profit and loss account). The table below provide the fair value hierarchy per year-end 2011 for the Greek, Italian, Irish, Portuguese and Spanish Government and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bond exposure measured at fair value.

Fair value hierarchy of Greek, Italian, Irish, Portuguese and Spanish bonds at fair value

 

2011    Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Greece

           

Government bonds

        219         36         255   

Italy

           

Government bonds

     1,705         86         242         2,033   

Financial institutions

     311         373            684   

Ireland

           

Government bonds

     43               43   

Financial institutions

     44               44   

Portugal

           

Government bonds

     533               533   

Financial institutions

     60         65            125   

Spain

           

Government bonds

     1,178         12            1,190   

Financial institutions

     277               277   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,151         755         278         5,184   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Classification of bonds in Levels 2 and 3 is mainly a result of decreased trading liquidity in the relevant markets.

35 Interest result banking operations

Interest result banking operations

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Interest income on loans

     26,415         24,942         24,983   

Interest income on impaired loans

     61         40         24   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest income on loans

     26,476         24,982         25,007   

Interest income on available-for-sale securities

     3,463         3,532         3,923   

Interest income on held-to-maturity securities

     400         549         612   

Interest income on trading portfolio

     27,480         32,692         40,844   

Interest income on non-trading derivatives

     1,536         1,709         3,936   

Other interest income

     5,294         4,870         5,528   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest income banking operations

     64,649         68,334         79,850   

Interest expense on deposits by banks

     902         652         1,266   

Interest expense on customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     9,383         8,324         10,976   

Interest expense on debt securities

     3,435         2,761         2,657   

Interest expense on subordinated loans

     1,625         1,856         1,784   

Interest on trading liabilities

     27,209         32,847         40,023   

Interest on non-trading derivatives

     1,658         2,166         4,483   

Other interest expense

     6,988         6,405         6,286   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest expense banking operations

     51,200         55,011         67,475   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest result banking operations

     13,449         13,323         12,375   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest margin

 

in percentages    2011      2010      2009  

Interest margin

     1.42         1.44         1.34   

 

F-113


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In 2011, the decline in average total assets led to an increase of the interest result amounting to EUR 135 million (in 2010 the growth in average total assets led to a decrease of the interest result of EUR 90 million; in 2009 the decline in average assets led to a decrease of the interest result of EUR 929 million). The decrease of the interest margin by 2 basis points led to a decrease of the interest result with EUR 139 million (in 2010 the increase of the interest margin by 10 basis points led to an increase of the interest result with EUR 915 million; in 2009 the increase of the interest margin by 25 basis points led to an increase of the interest result with EUR 2,406 million).

36 Gross premium income

Gross premium income

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Gross premium income from life insurance policies

     25,473         26,045         28,476   

Gross premium income from non-life insurance policies

     1,725         1,741         1,772   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     27,198         27,786         30,248   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross premium income has been presented before deduction of reinsurance and retrocession premiums granted. Gross premium income excludes premium received for investment contracts, for which deposit accounting is applied.

Effect of reinsurance on premiums written

 

     Non-life     Life     Total  
     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Direct gross premiums written

     1,702        1,718        1,746        24,442        24,881        27,177        26,144        26,599        28,923   

Reinsurance assumed gross premiums written

     23        23        26        1,031        1,164        1,299        1,054        1,187        1,325   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total gross premiums written

     1,725        1,741        1,772        25,473        26,045        28,476        27,198        27,786        30,248   

Reinsurance ceded

     (43     (65     (70     (1,888     (2,008     (1,842     (1,931     (2,073     (1,912
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,682        1,676        1,702        23,585        24,037        26,634        25,267        25,713        28,336   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of reinsurance on non-life premiums earned

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Direct gross premiums earned

     1,728        1,744        1,746   

Reinsurance assumed gross premiums earned

     23        23        26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total gross premiums earned

     1,751        1,767        1,772   

Reinsurance ceded

     (43     (65     (68
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,708        1,702        1,704   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’ for disclosure on reinsurance ceded.

 

F-114


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

37 Investment income

Investment income by banking and insurance operations

 

    Banking operations     Insurance operations     Total  
    2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Income from real estate investments

    24        128        157        56        57        55        80        185        212   

Dividend income

    49        59        46        261        211        172        310        270        218   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    73        187        203        317        268        227        390        455        430   

Income from investments in debt securities

          5,749        5,592        5,291        5,749        5,592        5,291   

Income from loans

                 

– unsecured loans

          288        244        202        288        244        202   

– mortgage loans

          810        827        848        810        827        848   

– policy loans

          187        189        177        187        189        177   

– other

          418        354        99        418        354        99   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from investments in debt securities and loans

          7,452        7,206        6,617        7,452        7,206        6,617   

Realised gains/losses on disposal of debt securities

    91        150        (945     68        18        (168     159        168        (1,113

Impairments of available-for-sale debt securities

    (735     (146     (1,491     (750     (589     (586     (1,485     (735     (2,077

Reversal of impairments of available-for-sale debt securities

    74            5        11        2        79        11        2   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Realised gains/losses and impairments of debt securities

    (570     4        (2,436     (677     (560     (752     (1,247     (556     (3,188

Realised gains/losses on disposal of equity securities

    39        338        24        446        193        397        485        531        421   

Impairments of available-for-sale equity securities

    (65     (32     (49     (188     (43     (360     (253     (75     (409
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Realised gains/losses and impairments of equity securities

    (26     306        (25     258        150        37        232        456        12   

Change in fair value of real estate investments

    (21     (50     (588     2        (48     (125     (19     (98     (713
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment income

    (544     447        (2,846     7,352        7,016        6,004        6,808        7,463        3,158   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2011, an impairment of EUR 978 million was recognised on Greek government bonds and an impairment of EUR 189 million was recognised on subordinated debt from Irish banks both are included in Impairments of available-for-sale debt securities. Reference is made to the ‘Risk management’ section for further information on these impairments.

Impairments and reversals of impairments on investments are presented within Investment income, which is part of Total income. This can be specified for each segment as follows:

Impairments/ reversals of impairments on investments per operating segment

 

     Impairments      Reversal of impairments  
     2011      2010      2009      2011     2010     2009  

Retail Belgium

     22                

ING Direct

     464         107         1,394         (30    

Commercial Banking (excluding Real Estate)

     301         70         129         (44    

Insurance Benelux

     410         53         360          

Insurance CRE

     338         18         36          

Insurance US

     166         553         527         (5    

Insurance Asia/Pacific

     15         8         15           (2     (2

ING IM

           3           (9  

Corporate Line Banking

     13         1         16          

Corporate Line Insurance

     9            6          
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,738         810         2,486         (79     (11     (2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-115


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

38 Net result on disposals of group companies

Net result on disposals of group companies

 

     2011  

Pacific Antai Life Insurance Company Ltd.

     28   

Clarion Real Estate Securities

     182   

ING REIM Asia and Europe

     245   

ING Car Lease

     347   

Clarion Partners

     39   

Other

     14   
  

 

 

 
     855   
  

 

 

 

The result on disposal of the Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations is not included above but in the result on disposal of discontinued operations. Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’.

Net result on disposals of group companies

 

     2010  

Asian Private Banking business

     332   

Swiss Private Banking business

     73   

ING Summit Industrial Fund LP

     (26

Other

     (69
  

 

 

 
     310   
  

 

 

 

In 2010 Other includes EUR (24) million related to the sale of certain associates. The remainder includes result on disposal of certain real estate funds and other disposals that are individually not significant.

Net result on disposals of group companies

 

     2009  

ING Australia and New Zealand

     337   

ING Canada

     (38

Annuity and Mortgage business in Chile

     (23

Other

     11   
  

 

 

 
     287   
  

 

 

 

Reference is made to Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’ for more details.

39 Commission income

Gross fee and commission income

 

     Banking operations      Insurance operations      Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Funds transfer

     916         861         859                  916         861         859   

Securities business

     681         695         780                  681         695         780   

Insurance broking

     161         190         188         366         348         124         527         538         312   

Asset management fees

     310         476         566         1,470         1,490         2,080         1,780         1,966         2,646   

Brokerage and advisory fees

     347         329         317         213         225         497         560         554         814   

Other

     1,013         965         825         526         289         315         1,539         1,254         1,140   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     3,428         3,516         3,535         2,575         2,352         3,016         6,003         5,868         6,551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Asset management fees related to the management of investments held for the risk of policyholders of EUR 495 million (2010: EUR 358 million; 2009: EUR 825 million) are included in Commission income.

Other include commission fees of EUR 26 million (2010: EUR 15 million; 2009: EUR 18 million) in respect of underwriting syndication loans.

 

F-116


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Fee and commission expenses

 

     Banking operations      Insurance operations      Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Funds transfer

     313         257         200                  313         257         200   

Securities business

     126         125         159                  126         125         159   

Management fees

     10         19         24         81         201         379         91         220         403   

Brokerage and advisory fees

     68         70         43         284         313         805         352         383         848   

Other

     457         452         449         627         283         252         1,084         735         701   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     974         923         875         992         797         1,436         1,966         1,720         2,311   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

40 Valuation results on non-trading derivatives

Valuation results on non-trading derivatives

 

    Banking operations     Insurance operations     Total  
    2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Change in fair value of derivatives relating to

                 

– fair value hedges

    426        (84     (666     (72     (69     191        354        (153     (475

– cash flow hedges (ineffective portion)

    (1     2        (2     (16     (9     (8     (17     (7     (10

– hedges of net investment in foreign entities (ineffective portion)

              1            1   

– other non-trading derivatives

    (1,697     (1,315     (892     1,380        94        (3,728     (317     (1,221     (4,620
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result on non-trading derivatives

    (1,272     (1,397     (1,560     1,292        16        (3,544     20        (1,381     (5,104

Change in fair value of assets and liabilities (hedged items)

    (393     91        546        58        66        (226     (335     157        320   

Valuation results on assets and liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss (excluding trading)

    504        69        (557     103        93        (57     607        162        (614
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net valuation results

    (1,161     (1,237     (1,571     1,453        175        (3,827     292        (1,062     (5,398
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The positive impact of the Valuation results on non-trading derivatives during 2011 includes the effect of negative developments in the stock markets giving rise to positive valuation results on related derivatives. Furthermore as a result of decreasing long term interest rates, values of interest related derivatives have increased. Valuation results on non-trading derivatives related to insurance provisions are mainly offset by an opposite amount in Underwriting expenditure (reference is made to Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’).

The Valuation results on assets and liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss includes fair value changes on private equity funds and certain issued debt securities. Valuation results on assets and liabilities designated as at fair value through profit and loss were mainly due to changes in the fair value of financial liabilities driven by changes in market conditions and changes in own credit risk as disclosed in Note 20 ‘Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss’. In 2011 market conditions includes in particular credit spread developments.

41 Net trading income

Net trading income

 

     Banking operations     Insurance operations      Total  
     2011     2010      2009     2011     2010     2009      2011     2010     2009  

Securities trading results

     (133     231         331        36        180        155         (97     411        486   

Foreign exchange transactions results

     (374     648         (158     (179     (604     167         (553     44        9   

Derivatives trading results

     882        174         815               882        174        815   

Other

     (49     64         (185     26        (66        (23     (2     (185
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     326        1,117         803        (117     (490     322         209        627        1,125   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-117


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Securities trading results includes the results of making markets in instruments such as government securities, equity securities, corporate debt securities, money-market instruments, and interest rate derivatives such as swaps, options, futures and forward contracts. Foreign exchange transactions results include gains and losses from spot and forward contracts, options, futures, and translated foreign currency assets and liabilities.

The portion of trading gains and losses for the year ended December 31, 2011 relating to trading securities still held as at December 31, amounted to EUR (66) million (2010: EUR 19 million; 2009: EUR 105 million).

The majority of the risks involved in security and currency trading is economically hedged with derivatives. The securities trading results are partly offset by results on these derivatives. The result of these derivatives is included in Derivatives trading results.

42 Other income

Other income

 

     Banking operations      Insurance operations      Total  
     2011     2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011     2010      2009  

Net operating lease income

     176        213         175                  176        213         175   

Income from real estate development projects

     31        36         59                  31        36         59   

Income post office

     (7        99                  (7        99   

Other

     916        98         124         227         257         244         1,143        355         368   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,116        347         457         227         257         244         1,343        604         701   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net operating lease income comprises income of EUR 772 million (2010: EUR 1,000 million; 2009: EUR 967 million) and depreciation of EUR 596 million (2010: EUR 787 million; 2009: EUR 792 million).

In 2011, Other includes a gain of EUR 955 million on the repurchase of subordinated loans as disclosed in Note 14 ‘Subordinated loans’.

43 Underwriting expenditure

Underwriting expenditure

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Gross underwriting expenditure

      

– before effect of investment result for risk of policyholders

     34,962        34,523        32,393   

– effect of investment result risk of policyholders

     (1,246     10,492        17,736   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     33,716        45,015        50,129   

Investment result for risk of policyholders

     1,246        (10,492     (17,736

Reinsurance recoveries

     (1,875     (1,721     (1,700
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underwriting expenditure

     33,087        32,802        30,693   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The investment income and valuation results regarding investments for risk of policyholders is EUR (1,246) million (2010: EUR 10,492 million; 2009: EUR 17,742 million). This amount is not recognised in Investment income and valuation results on assets and liabilities designated at fair value through profit and loss but in Underwriting expenditure. As a result it is shown together with the equal amount of change in insurance provisions for risk of policyholders.

 

F-118


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Underwriting expenditure by class

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Expenditure from life underwriting

      

Reinsurance and retrocession premiums

     1,888        2,008        1,842   

Gross benefits

     27,277        25,493        23,671   

Reinsurance recoveries

     (1,866     (1,712     (1,694

Change in life insurance provisions for risk of company

     1,606        1,875        2,078   

Costs of acquiring insurance business

     1,727        2,557        1,646   

Other underwriting expenditure

     576        560        462   

Profit sharing and rebates

     443        538        438   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     31,651        31,319        28,443   

Expenditure from non-life underwriting

      

Reinsurance and retrocession premiums

     43        65        70   

Gross claims

     1,097        1,034        1,012   

Reinsurance recoveries

     (9     (9     (6

Change in provision for unearned premiums

     (26     (26     (2

Change in claims provision

     5        44        (23

Costs of acquiring insurance business

     269        281        290   

Other underwriting expenditure

     (3     (2     (4
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     1,376        1,387        1,337   

Expenditure from investment contracts

      

Costs of acquiring investment contracts

     3        5        3   

Other changes in investment contract liabilities

     57        91        910   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     60        96        913   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     33,087        32,802        30,693   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Profit sharing and rebates

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Distributions on account of interest or underwriting results

     21         9         91   

Bonuses added to policies

     287         328         289   

Deferred profit sharing expense

     135         201         58   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     443         538         438   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The total Cost of acquiring insurance business (life and non-life) and investment contracts amounted to EUR 1,999 million (2010: EUR 2,843 million; 2009: EUR 1,939 million). This includes amortisation and unlocking of DAC of EUR 1,702 million (2010: EUR 2,697 million; 2009: EUR 1,811 million) and the net amount of commissions paid of EUR 1,884 million (2010: EUR 1,708 million; 2009: EUR 1,758 million) and commissions capitalised in DAC of EUR 1,587 million (2010: EUR 1,562 million; 2009: EUR 1,630 million).

The total amount of commission paid and commission payable with regard to the insurance operations amounted to EUR 2,470 million (2010: EUR 2,424 million; 2009: EUR 2,392 million). This includes the commissions recognised in Costs of acquiring insurance business of EUR 1,884 million (2010: EUR 1,707 million; 2009: EUR 1,758 million) referred to above and commissions recognised in Other underwriting expenditure of EUR 586 million (2010: EUR 717 million; 2009: EUR 634 million). Other underwriting expenditure also includes reinsurance commissions received of EUR 192 million (2010: EUR 192 million; 2009: EUR 255 million).

 

F-119


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In 2011, ING has conducted a comprehensive review of its assumptions for the Insurance US Closed Block Variable Annuity (VA) business. The review showed that current US policyholder behaviour for Closed Block VA policies sold predominantly between 2003 and 2009 diverges from earlier assumptions made by ING, particularly given the ongoing volatility and challenging market circumstances. The assumptions for the US Closed Block VA were updated for lapses, mortality, annuitisation, and utilisation rates, with the most significant revision coming from the adjustments of lapse assumptions. The revisions bring the assumptions more in line with US policyholder experience and reflect to a much greater degree the market volatility of recent years. In conjunction, hedging is adjusted to reflect the revised assumptions. The assumption changes resulted in a charge of EUR 1,099 million, which is reflected in Underwriting expenditure and in the segment Insurance US Closed Block VA. This charge affects the deferred acquisition costs (amortisation and unlocking) for EUR 488 million and the insurance provision (effect of changes in other assumptions) for EUR 611 million. Reference is made to Note 10 ‘Deferred acquisition costs’ and Note 17 ‘Insurance and Investment contracts, reinsurance contracts’. The impact of the assumption adjustments includes a charge to restore the reserve adequacy to the 50% confidence level for the Insurance US Closed Block VA segment. Reference is made to Note 51 ‘Segment reporting’.

ING has completed a separate annual review of the policyholder behaviour assumptions for the VA Japan business, which has not resulted in material adjustments.

In 2010, the Change in life insurance provisions for risk of company includes an amount related to variable annuity assumption changes in the United States and Japan of approximately EUR 356 million (2009: EUR 343 million). These assumptions were updated to reflect lower-than-expected surrenders on policies where the value of the benefit guarantees is significant.

Other underwriting expenditure from life underwriting in 2010 includes a EUR 975 million DAC write-off as explained in Note 51 ‘Operating segments’.

ING Group transferred part of its life insurance business to Scottish Re in 2004 by means of a co-insurance contract. A loss amounting to EUR 160 million was recognised in Underwriting expenditure in 2004 on this transaction. This loss represented the reduction of the related deferred acquisition costs. In addition, an amount of EUR 240 million is being amortised over the life of the underlying business, starting in 2005 and gradually decreasing in subsequent years as the business tails off. The amount amortised in 2011 was EUR 14 million (2010: EUR 17 million; 2009: EUR 13 million). The cumulative amortisation as at December 31, 2011 was EUR 151 million (2010: EUR 132 million; 2009: EUR 107 million). On January 23, 2009, Hannover Re and Scottish Re announced that Hannover Re has agreed to assume the ING individual life reinsurance business originally transferred to Scottish Re in 2004.

ING Group transferred its U.S. group reinsurance business to Reinsurance Group of America Inc. in 2010 by means of a reinsurance agreement. The transaction resulted in EUR 70 million ceding commission which is required to be recorded as a deferred gain and amortised over the life of the underlying business, starting in 2010 and gradually decreasing in subsequent years as the business tails off. The amount amortised in 2011 was EUR 16 million (2010: EUR 52 million). The cumulative amortisation as at December 31, 2011 was EUR 69 million (2010: EUR 52 million).

44 Intangible amortisation and other impairments

Intangible amortisation and (reversals of) impairments

 

     Impairment losses      Reversals of
impairments
    Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011     2010     2009     2011      2010      2009  

Property and equipment

     30         28         8         (11     (5     (12     19         23         (4

Property development

     216         400         450             (7     216         400         443   

Goodwill

     32         540                  32         540      

Software and other intangible assets

     50         31         9               50         31         9   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

(Reversals of) other impairments

     328         999         467         (11     (5     (19     317         994         448   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortisation of other intangible assets

                    62         76         76   
                 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                    379         1,070         524   
                 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-120


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In 2011, impairments are recognised on Property development (in the segment ING Real Estate) due to the sale or termination of large projects in Germany and the Netherlands and on the reassessment of Dutch and Spanish real estate development projects.

In 2011, a goodwill impairment of EUR 32 million (2010: EUR 540 million) is recognised. Reference is made to Note 9 ‘Intangible assets’.

In 2010, impairments on Property development are recognised on a large number of Real Estate development projects in The Netherlands, Spain and the United States. The unfavourable economic circumstances in all regions resulted in lower expected sales prices.

In 2009, impairments on Property development are recognised on a large number of Real Estate development projects in Europe, Australia and the United States. Circumstances that have led to these impairments are unfavourable economic circumstances in all regions that have resulted into lower expected sales prices, changes in strategy of ING Real Estate Development whereby certain projects are not developed further and operational inefficiencies in a limited number of projects.

Impairments on Loans and advances to customers are presented under Addition to loan loss provision. Impairments on investments are presented under Investment income. Reference is made to the ‘Risk management’ section for further information on impairments.

45 Staff expenses

Staff expenses

 

     Banking operations      Insurance operations      Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Salaries

     3,705         3,836         3,555         1,602         1,621         1,492         5,307         5,457         5,047   

Pension and other staff-related benefit costs

     171         199         180         86         114         140         257         313         320   

Social security costs

     525         532         510         152         169         151         677         701         661   

Share-based compensation arrangements (1)

     119         79         57         58         40         39         177         119         96   

External employees

     683         627         660         140         123         96         823         750         756   

Education

     69         61         57         20         11         7         89         72         64   

Other staff costs

     219         220         190         7         60         137         226         280         327   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     5,491         5,554         5,209         2,065         2,138         2,062         7,556         7,692         7,271   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The increase in Share-based compensation arrangements can be explained by ING’s implementation of a global deferral plan as well as regulatory developments which require payment of variable remuneration in stock in lieu of cash.

Number of employees

     Netherlands      International      Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Continuing operations - average number of employees at full time equivalent basis

     26,332         27,750         27,912         71,711         71,621         75,794         98,043         99,371         103,706   

Discontinued operations - average number of employees at full time equivalent basis

              6,376         6,769         6,571         6,376         6,769         6,571   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total average number of employees at full time equivalent basis (1)

     26,332         27,750         27,912         78,087         78,390         82,365         104,419         106,140         110,277   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based compensation arrangements includes EUR 153 million (2010: EUR 90 million; 2009: EUR 65 million) relating to equity-settled share-based payment arrangements and EUR 24 million (2010: EUR 29 million; 2009: EUR 31 million) relating to cash-settled share-based payment arrangements.

 

F-121


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Pension and other staff-related benefit costs

 

     Pension benefits     Post-employment
benefits other than
pensions
    Other     Total  
     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Current service cost

     324        298        320        8        5        (8     9        (2     (38     341        301        274   

Past service cost

     (8     (1     20        (4       (21           (12     (1     (1

Interest cost

     851        795        778        8        8        10        6        5        9        865        808        797   

Expected return on assets

     (877     (886     (842               1        (877     (885     (841

Amortisation of unrecognised past service cost

     1            (1     (5     (1             (5     (1

Amortisation of unrecognised actuarial (gains)/losses

     22        62        106        (4     (9     (5     1        1        5        19        54        106   

Effect of curtailment or settlement

     (110     (7     (96                 (110     (7     (96

Other

     1          (14           (16     (18     15        (15     (18     1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Defined benefit plans

     204        261        272        7        (1     (25     0        (14     (8     211        246        239   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Defined contribution plans

                       46        67        81   
                    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
                       257        313        320   
                    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Remuneration of senior management, Executive Board and Supervisory Board

Reference is made to Note 33 ‘Related parties’.

Stock option and share plans

ING Group has granted option rights on ING Group shares and conditional rights on depositary receipts (share awards) for ING shares to a number of senior executives (members of the Executive Board, general managers and other officers nominated by the Executive Board), and to a considerable number of employees of ING Group. The purpose of the option and share schemes, apart from promoting a lasting growth of ING Group, is to attract, retain and motivate senior executives and staff.

In 2011, ING granted two types of share awards, deferred shares and performance shares. The entitlement to the share awards is granted conditionally. If the participant remains in employment for an uninterrupted period between the grant date and the vesting date, the entitlement becomes unconditional. In addition to the employment condition, the performance shares contain a performance condition. The number of ING depositary receipts that would ultimately be granted at the end of a performance period is dependent on ING’s performance over that period.

In 2011 no share awards (2010: nil; 2009: nil) were granted to the members of the Executive Board of ING Groep N.V., 154,440 share awards were granted to the Management Boards of ING Bank N.V., ING Verzekeringen N.V., Insurance Eurasia and Americas Insurance Holdings. To senior management and other employees 20,135,968 share awards (2010: 26,369,146; 2009: 6,273,467) were granted.

Every year, the ING Group Executive Board decides whether the option and share schemes are to be continued and, if so, to what extent. In 2010 the Group Executive Board decided not to continue the option scheme as from 2011. The existing option schemes up and until 2010 will be run off in the coming years.

The option rights are valid for a period of five or ten years. Option rights that are not exercised within this period lapse. Option rights granted will remain valid until the expiry date, even if the option scheme is discontinued. The option rights are subject to certain conditions, including a pre-determined continuous period of service. The exercise prices of the options are the same as the quoted prices of ING Group shares at the date on which the options are granted.

 

F-122


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Group holds its own shares in order to fulfil its obligations with regard to the existing stock option plan and to hedge the position risk of the options concerned (the so-called delta hedge). As at December 31, 2011, 42,126,329 own shares (2010: 45,213,891; 2009: 35,178,086) were held in connection with the option plan compared to 108,138,551 options outstanding (2010: 124,836,694; 2009: 122,334,486). As a result the granted option rights were (delta) hedged, taking into account the following parameters: strike price, opening price, zero coupon interest rate, dividend yield, expected volatility and employee behaviour. The hedge used to be rebalanced regularly at predetermined points in time. In December 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it will no longer rebalance its hedge portfolio. This decision is an effort to simplify the management and administration of ING’s various employee share and option programmes. The remaining shares in the hedge portfolio will be used to fund the obligations arising from exercise and vesting. Once all shares in the hedge portfolio are used ING will fund these obligations by issuing new shares.

Exposure arising from the share plan is not hedged. The obligations with regard to these plans will in the future be funded either by cash, newly issued shares or remaining shares from the delta hedge portfolio at the discretion of the holder.

In December 2009 ING Groep N.V. completed a rights issue of EUR 7.5 billion. Outstanding stock options and share awards have been amended to reflect the impact of the rights issue through an adjustment factor that reflects the fact that the exercise price of the rights issue was less than the fair value of the shares. As a result, exercise prices and outstanding share options and share awards have been amended through an adjustment factor of approximately 1.3.

On April 6, 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it bought 13,670,000 (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares for its delta hedge portfolio, which was used to hedge employee options and facilitate employee share programmes. The shares were bought in the open market between March 23, and April 6, 2010 at an average price of EUR 7.47 per share.

On June 2, 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it bought 2,080,000 (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares for its delta hedge portfolio, which was used to hedge employee options and facilitate employee share programmes. The shares were bought in the open market on June 1 and 2, 2010 at an average price of EUR 6.33 per share.

On September 8, 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it sold 3,590,000 (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares of its delta hedge portfolio, which was used to hedge employee options and facilitate employee share programmes. The shares were sold in the open market on September 7 and 8, 2010 at an average price of EUR 7.39 per share.

Changes in option rights outstanding

 

     Options outstanding (in numbers)     Weighted average exercise
price (in euros)
 
     2011     2010     2009     2011      2010      2009  

Opening balance

     124,836,694        122,334,486        87,263,381        15.73         17.31         25.93   

Granted

       19,434,097        14,803,109        0.00         7.35         3.93   

Exercised

     (1,111,930     (1,070,630     (22,757     3.97         3.03         5.33   

Forfeited

     (2,698,596     (3,666,001     (5,974,275     12.78         13.23         26.30   

Rights issue

         28,395,811           

Expired

     (12,887,617     (12,195,258     (2,130,783     22.03         20.52         32.11   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Closing balance

     108,138,551        124,836,694        122,334,486        15.20         15.73         17.31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

As per December 31, 2011 total options outstanding consists of 90,620,708 options (2010: 105,036,931; 2009: 103,523,988) relating to equity-settled share-based payment arrangements and 17,517,843 options (2010: 19,799,763; 2009: 18,810,498) relating to cash-settled share-based payment arrangements.

The weighted average share price at the date of exercise for options exercised during 2011 is EUR 8.09 (2010: EUR 7.46; 2009: 8.57).

 

F-123


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Changes in option rights non-vested

 

     Options non-vested (in numbers)    

Weighted average
grant date fair value

(in euros)

 
     2011     2010     2009     2011      2010      2009  

Opening balance

     51,596,578        50,316,665        37,867,732        3.08         3.52         6.03   

Granted

       19,434,097        14,803,109        0.00         3.26         2.52   

Vested

     (17,389,468     (15,415,108     (11,100,675     3.90         4.70         6.48   

Forfeited

     (1,788,356     (2,739,076     (2,931,533     3.05         3.26         5.67   

Rights issue

         11,678,032           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Closing balance

     32,418,754        51,596,578        50,316,665        2.65         3.08         3.52   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Summary of stock options outstanding and exercisable

 

2011

Range of exercise price in euros

  

Options
outstanding

as at
December 31,
2011

     Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
life
    

Weighted
average

exercise
price

     Options
exercisable
as at
December 31,
2011
     Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
life
    

Weighted
average

exercise

price

 

  0.00 –   5.00

     14,723,297         6.68         2.88            0.00         0.00   

  5.00 – 10.00

     23,647,407         6.45         7.90         5,951,950         1.18         9.46   

10.00 – 15.00

     7,334,880         2.32         14.29         7,334,880         2.32         14.29   

15.00 – 20.00

     28,639,179         4.36         17.20         28,639,179         4.36         17.20   

20.00 – 25.00

     21,190,454         2.48         23.56         21,190,454         2.48         23.56   

25.00 – 30.00

     12,603,334         4.30         25.18         12,603,334         4.30         25.18   
  

 

 

          

 

 

       
     108,138,551               75,719,797         
  

 

 

          

 

 

       

Summary of stock options outstanding and exercisable

 

2010

Range of exercise price in euros

  

Options
outstanding

as at
December 31,
2010

    

Weighted
average
remaining
contractual

life

    

Weighted
average

exercise

price

     Options
exercisable
as at
December 31,
2010
    

Weighted
average
remaining
contractual

life

    

Weighted
average

exercise

price

 

  0.00 –   5.00

     16,367,971         7.71         2.88            

  5.00 – 10.00

     25,482,740         7.45         7.88         6,379,628         2.18         9.36   

10.00 – 15.00

     9,585,723         2.61         14.37         9,353,997         2.48         14.37   

15.00 – 20.00

     31,328,453         5.21         17.35         15,434,684         3.54         17.88   

20.00 – 25.00

     22,663,374         3.58         23.60         22,663,374         3.58         23.60   

25.00 – 30.00

     19,408,433         3.58         25.77         19,408,433         3.58         25.77   
  

 

 

          

 

 

       
     124,836,694               73,240,116         
  

 

 

          

 

 

       

Summary of stock options outstanding and exercisable

 

2009

Range of exercise price in euros

  

Options
outstanding

as at
December 31,
2010

    

Weighted
average
remaining
contractual

life

    

Weighted
average

exercise

price

     Options
exercisable
as at
December 31,
2010
    

Weighted
average
remaining
contractual

life

    

Weighted
average

exercise

price

 

  0.00 –   5.00

     18,394,697         3.57         2.88            

  5.00 – 10.00

     7,257,362         8.76         9.17         6,826,298         3.18         9.20   

10.00 – 15.00

     11,132,430         3.51         14.20         10,802,627         3.35         14.20   

15.00 – 20.00

     35,095,363         6.19         17.29         17,396,930         4.50         17.77   

20.00 – 25.00

     28,576,153         4.02         23.38         15,861,602         1.73         22.38   

25.00 – 30.00

     21,878,481         4.50         25.82         21,130,364         4.40         25.83   
  

 

 

          

 

 

       
     122,334,486               72,017,821         
  

 

 

          

 

 

       

As at December 31, 2011, the aggregate intrinsic values of options outstanding and exercisable were EUR 39 million and nil, respectively.

 

F-124


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

As at December 31, 2011 total unrecognised compensation costs related to stock options amounted to EUR 24 million (2010: EUR 65 million; 2009: EUR 62 million). These costs are expected to be recognised over a weighted average period of 1.1 years (2010: 1.9 years; 2009: 1.6 years). Cash received from stock option exercises for the year ended December 31, 2011 was EUR 4 million (2010: EUR 3 million; 2009: nil).

The fair value of options granted is recognised as an expense under staff expenses and is allocated over the vesting period of the options. The fair values of the option awards have been determined using a Monte Carlo simulation. This model takes the risk free interest rate into account (2.0% to 4.6%), as well as the expected life of the options granted (5 to 9 years), the exercise price, the current share price (EUR 2.90 – EUR 26.05), the expected volatility of the certificates of ING Group shares (25% – 84%) and the expected dividends yield (0.94% to 8.99%). The source for implied volatilities used for the valuation of the stock options is ING’s trading system. The implied volatilities in this system are determined by ING’s traders and are based on market data implied volatilities not on historical volatilities.

Due to timing differences in granting option rights and buying shares to hedge them, an equity difference can occur if shares are purchased at a different price than the exercise price of the options. However, ING Group does not intentionally create a position and occurring positions are closed as soon as possible. If option rights expire, the results on the (sale of) shares which were bought to hedge these option rights are recognised in Shareholders’ equity.

Changes in share awards

 

     Share awards (in numbers)     Weighted average grant
date fair value (in euros)
 
     2011     2010     2009     2011      2010      2009  

Opening balance

     35,040,106        14,653,673        7,792,009        7.25         7.53         22.60   

Granted

     20,290,408        26,369,146        6,273,467        9.78         7.55         3.29   

Performance effect

     (1,610,321     (1,507,307     (1,085,987     11.27         13.92         32.52   

Vested

     (3,636,399     (2,961,355     (1,228,764     10.79         11.72         32.63   

Forfeited

     (2,060,908     (1,514,051     (498,553     7.56         7.13         24.01   

Rights issue

         3,401,501           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Closing balance

     48,022,886        35,040,106        14,653,673        7.90         7.25         7.53   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

As per December 31, 2011 the share awards consists of 41,150,790 share awards (2010: 28,592,210; 2009: 10,810,687) relating to equity-settled share-based payment arrangements and 6,872,096 share awards (2010: 6,447,896; 2009: 3,842,986) relating to cash-settled share-based payment arrangements.

The fair value of share awards granted is recognised as an expense under staff expenses and is allocated over the vesting period of the share awards. The fair values of share awards containing a market based performance condition have been determined using a Monte Carlo simulation based valuation model. The model takes into account the risk free interest rate, the current stock prices, expected volatilities and current divided yields of the performance peer group used to determine ING’s Total Shareholder Return (TSR) ranking.

As at December 31, 2011, total unrecognised compensation costs related to share awards amounted to EUR 149 million (2010: EUR 158 million; 2009: EUR 41 million). These costs are expected to be recognised over a weighted average period of 1.5 years (2010: 2.1 years; 2009: 1.8 years).

46 Other interest expenses

Other interest expenses mainly consist of interest in connection with the insurance operations, including interest on the perpetual subordinated loans.

Other interest expenses include nil and nil dividends paid on preference shares and trust preferred securities (2010: nil and nil; 2009: nil and EUR 86 million).

In 2011, total interest income and total interest expense for items not valued at fair value through profit and loss were EUR 43,085 million (2010: EUR 41,139 million; 2009: EUR 41,688 million) and EUR 21,805 million (2010: EUR 19,212 million; 2009: EUR 22,257 million) respectively. Net interest income of EUR 20,373 million is presented in the following lines in the profit and loss account.

 

F-125


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Total net interest income

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Interest result banking operations 35

     13,449        13,323        12,375   

Investment income – insurance operations 37

     7,452        7,206        6,617   

Other interest expenses

     (528     (786     (711
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     20,373        19,743        18,281   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

47 Other operating expenses

Other operating expenses

 

     Banking operations      Insurance operations      Total  
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Depreciation of property and equipment

     371         382         365         69         78         78         440         460         443   

Amortisation of software

     332         312         282         59         46         60         391         358         342   

Computer costs

     707         693         637         309         263         263         1,016         956         900   

Office expenses

     737         659         680         320         308         450         1,057         967         1,130   

Travel and accommodation expenses

     120         102         99         61         64         64         181         166         163   

Advertising and public relations

     594         591         539         91         98         84         685         689         623   

External advisory fees

     332         364         402         413         335         269         745         699         671   

Postal charges

     82         87         111                  82         87         111   

Addition/(releases) of provision for reorganisations and relocations

     387         109         339         130         99         258         517         208         597   

Other

     736         796         999         615         690         614         1,351         1,486         1,613   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     4,398         4,095         4,453         2,067         1,981         2,140         6,465         6,076         6,593   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other operating expenses include lease and sublease payments in respect of operating leases of EUR 155 million (2010: EUR 200 million; 2009: EUR 169 million) in which ING Group is the lessee. In 2009 Other operating expenses also includes the expenses related to the industry-wide deposit guarantee scheme in the Netherlands due to the bankruptcy of DSB Bank and premiums for deposit guarantee schemes in other countries.

For Addition/(releases) of provision for reorganisations and relocations reference is made to the disclosure on the reorganisation provision in Note 21 ‘Other liabilities’.

No individual operating lease has terms and conditions that materially affect the amount, timing and certainty of the consolidated cash flows of the Group.

The External advisory fees include fees for audit services and non-audit services provided by the Group’s auditors.

Fees of Group’s auditors

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Audit fees

     37         35         34   

Audit related fees

     9         9         6   

Tax fees

     4         2         2   

All other fees

     1         1         2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     51         47         44   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fees as disclosed above relate to the network of the Group’s auditors.

 

F-126


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

48 Taxation

Profit and loss account

Taxation on continuing operations by type

 

     Netherlands     International     Total  
     2011      2010     2009     2011     2010      2009     2011     2010      2009  

Current taxation

     48         168        159        1,006        790         416        1,054        958         575   

Deferred taxation

     167         (104     (1,218     (212     222         (137     (45     118         (1,355
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     215         64        (1,059     794        1,012         279        1,009        1,076         (780
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Reconciliation of the weighted average statutory income tax rate to ING Group’s effective income tax rate

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Result before tax from continuing operations

     4,727        3,333        (2,492

Weighted average statutory tax rate

     26.2     24.2     32.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average statutory tax amount

     1,238        806        (819

Associates exemption

     (329     (403     (166

Other income not subject to tax

     (263     (125     (227

Expenses not deductible for tax purposes

     122        102        47   

Impact on deferred tax from change in tax rates

     (56     8     

Deferred tax benefit from previously unrecognised amounts

         (32

Current tax benefit from previously unrecognised amounts

     4       

Write down/reversal of deferred tax assets

     284        740        535   

Adjustment to prior periods

     9        (52     (118
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax amount

     1,009        1,076        (780
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate

     21.3     32.3     31.3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The weighted average statutory tax rate in 2011 compared to 2010 does not differ significantly.

The weighted average statutory tax rate decreased significantly in 2010 compared to 2009. This is caused by the fact that in 2010 profits were realised in a significant part of the tax jurisdictions that incurred losses in 2009.

The effective tax rate in 2011 was lower than the weighted average statutory tax. This is mainly caused by exempt income, which was only partly offset by non deductible expenses and write down of deferred tax assets.

The effective tax rate in 2010 was higher than the weighted average statutory tax. This is caused by an off-setting effect of the write-down of deferred tax assets (mainly in the United States) and the non-deductable expenses which exceeded tax exempt income and prior year adjustments.

The effective tax rate in 2009 was lower than the weighted average statutory tax rate. This is caused by the fact that a write-down of the carrying value of deferred tax assets and non-deductible expenses exceeded tax exempt income.

Adjustment to prior periods in 2011 relates to final tax assessments and other marginal corrections.

Adjustment to prior periods in 2010 relates mainly to a tax settlement.

 

F-127


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Comprehensive income

Income tax related to components of other comprehensive income

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Unrealised revaluations

     (873     (1,216     (4,712

Realised gains/losses transferred to profit and loss (reclassifications from equity to profit and loss)

     (291     8        (494

Changes in cash flow hedge reserve

     (373     (194     203   

Transfer to insurance liabilities/DAC

     847        719        1,017   

Exchange rate differences

     (39     8        13   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax related to components of other comprehensive income

     (729     (675     (3,973
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

49 Earnings per ordinary share

Earnings per ordinary share

    

Amount

(in millions of euros)

   

Weighted average

number of ordinary shares
outstanding during the period

(in millions)

    

Per ordinary share

(in euros)

 
     2011     2010     2009     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Net result

     4,740        2,367        (1,494     3,783.7         3,781.5         2,102.9            

Attribution to non-voting equity securities

     (1,520     (441     (605                 

Impact of rights issue

                 583.1            
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Basic earnings

     3,220        1,926        (2,099     3,783.7         3,781.5         2,686.0         0.85         0.51         (0.78

Effect of dilutive instruments:

                       

Stock option and share plans

           5.4         6.6         5.7            
        

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          
           5.4         6.6         5.7            
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Diluted earnings

     3,220        1,926        (2,099     3,789.1         3,788.1         2,691.7         0.85         0.51         (0.78
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Attribution to non-voting equity securities

The attribution to non-voting equity securities represents the amount that would be payable on the non-voting equity securities if and when the entire net result for the period would be distributed as dividend. This amount is only included for the purpose of determining earnings per share under IFRS-IASB and does not represent a payment (neither actual nor proposed) to the holders of the non-voting equity securities.

The attribution in 2011 includes the premium of EUR 1 billion paid in relation to the repayment of the EUR 2 billion non-voting equity securities. The 2009 amount of EUR 605 million includes the coupon (EUR 259 million) and repayment premium (EUR 346 million) on the repayment of EUR 5 billion non-voting equity securities.

In 2009, the rights issue, which was finalised on December 15, 2009 has an effect on the basic earnings per share and the diluted earnings per share, as defined in IFRS-IASB. All weighted average number of shares outstanding before the rights issue are restated with an adjustment factor of approximately 1.3 that reflects the fact that the exercise price of the rights issue was less than the fair value of the shares. The effect of dilutive securities is adjusted as well.

Dilutive instruments

Diluted earnings per share is calculated as if the stock options and share plans outstanding at the end of the period had been exercised at the beginning of the period and assuming that the cash received from exercised stock options and share plans is used to buy own shares against the average market price during the period. The net increase in the number of shares resulting from exercising stock options and share plans is added to the average number of shares used for the calculation of diluted earnings per share.

 

F-128


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The potential conversion of the non-voting equity securities has an anti-dilutive effect on the earnings per share calculation in 2011, 2010 and 2009 (the diluted earnings per share becoming higher or less negative than the basic earnings per share). Therefore, the potential conversion is not taken into account in the calculation of diluted earnings per share for these years.

Earnings per ordinary share from continuing operations

 

    

Amount

(in millions of euros)

   

Weighted average

number of ordinary shares
outstanding during the period

(in millions)

    

Per ordinary share

(in euros)

 
     2011      2010      2009     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Basic earnings

     3,220         1,926         (2,099     3,783.7         3,781.5         2,686.0            

Less: Total net result from discontinued operations

     1,104         209         93                    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Basic earnings from continuing operations

     2,116         1,717         (2,192     3,783.7         3,781.5         2,686.0         0.56         0.45         (0.82

Effect of dilutive instruments:

                         

Stock option and share plans

             5.4         6.6         5.7            
          

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          
             5.4         6.6         5.7            
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Diluted earnings from continuing operations

     2,116         1,717         (2,192     3,789.1         3,788.1         2,691.7         0.56         0.45         (0.82
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Earnings per ordinary share from discontinued operations

 

    

Amount

(in millions of euros)

    

Weighted average

number of ordinary shares
outstanding during the period

(in millions)

    

Per ordinary share

(in euros)

 
     2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009      2011      2010      2009  

Net result from discontinued operations

     109         209         93                     

Net result from disposal of discontinued operations

     995                           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Total net result from discontinued operations

     1,104         209         93         3,783.7         3,781.5         2,686.0            

Basic earnings from discontinued operations

     1,104         209         93         3,783.7         3,781.5         2,686.0         0.29         0.06         0.04   

Effect of dilutive instruments:

                          

Stock option and share plans

              5.4         6.6         5.7            
           

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          
              5.4         6.6         5.7            
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

Diluted earnings from discontinued operations

     1,104         209         93         3,789.1         3,788.1         2,691.7         0.29         0.06         0.04   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

          

50 Dividend per ordinary share

In 2011, 2010 and 2009 no dividend was declared, therefore the dividend per ordinary share was nil. The Executive Board, with the approval of the Supervisory Board, has proposed, subject to the ratification by the General Meeting of Shareholders, not to pay a cash dividend for the year 2011.

In 2009 a coupon to the Dutch State of EUR 259 million was paid as part of the repayment of EUR 5 billion non-voting equity securities.

 

F-129


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

51 Operating segments

a. General

ING Group’s operating segments relate to the internal segmentation by business lines. As at December 31, 2011, ING Group identifies the following operating segments:

Operating segments of ING Group

 

Banking    Insurance     

Retail Netherlands

  

Insurance Benelux

    

Retail Belgium

  

Insurance Central & Rest of Europe (CRE)

    

ING Direct

  

Insurance United States (US) *

    

Retail Central Europe (CE)

  

Insurance US Closed Block VA

    

Retail Asia

  

Insurance Asia/Pacific

    

Commercial Banking (excluding Real Estate)

  

ING Investment Management (IM)

    

ING Real Estate

  

Corporate Line Insurance

    

Corporate Line Banking

         

 

*

Excluding US Closed Block VA

In 2011 the operating segment Insurance Latin America is not included in the segment reporting anymore as its activities classify mainly as discontinued operations. Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’. Activities reported previously in the segment Insurance Latin America and that are not classified as discontinued operations are now reported in the Corporate Line Insurance. Comparative disclosures are adjusted accordingly.

The Executive Board of ING Group, the Management Board Banking and the Management Board Insurance set the performance targets and approve and monitor the budgets prepared by the business lines. Business lines formulate strategic, commercial and financial policy in conformity with the strategy and performance targets set by the Executive Board, the Management Board Banking and the Management Board Insurance.

The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as those described under Accounting policies for the consolidated annual accounts. Transfer prices for inter-segment transactions are set at arm’s length. Corporate expenses are allocated to business lines based on time spent by head office personnel, the relative number of staff, or on the basis of income, expenses and/or assets of the segment.

ING Group evaluates the results of its operating segments using a financial performance measure called underlying result. The information presented in this note is in line with the information presented to the Executive and Management Board. Underlying result is defined as result under IFRS-IASB excluding the impact of divestments and special items. Disclosures on comparative years also reflect the impact of current year’s divestments.

 

F-130


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The following table specifies the main sources of income of each of the segments:

Specification of the main sources of income of each of the segments

 

Segment    Main source of income

Retail Netherlands

  

Income from retail and private banking activities in the Netherlands. The main products offered are current and savings accounts, mortgages and other consumer lending in the Netherlands.

Retail Belgium

  

Income from retail and private banking activities in Belgium. The main products offered are similar to those in the Netherlands.

Retail CE

  

Income from retail and private banking activities in Central Europe. The main products offered are similar to those in the Netherlands.

Retail Asia

  

Income from retail banking activities in Asia. The main products offered are similar to those in the Netherlands.

ING Direct

  

Income from direct retail banking activities. The main products offered are savings accounts and mortgages.

Commercial Banking (excluding Real Estate)

  

Income from wholesale banking activities. A full range of products is offered from cash management to corporate finance.

ING Real Estate

  

Income from real estate activities.

Insurance Benelux

  

Income from life insurance, non-life insurance and retirement services in the Benelux.

Insurance CRE

  

Income from life insurance, non-life insurance and retirement services in Central and Rest of Europe.

Insurance US *

  

Income from life insurance and retirement services in the United States.

Insurance US Closed Block VA

  

Consists of ING’s Closed Block Variable Annuity business in the United States, which has been closed to new business since early 2010 and which is now being managed in run-off.

Insurance Asia/Pacific

  

Income from life insurance and retirement services in Asia/Pacific.

ING IM

  

Income from investment management activities.

Corporate Line Banking

  

Corporate Line Banking is a reflection of capital management activities and certain expenses that are not allocated to the banking businesses. ING Group applies a system of capital charging for its banking operations in order to create a comparable basis for the results of business units globally, irrespective of the business units’ book equity and the currency they operate in.

Corporate Line Insurance

  

The Corporate Line Insurance includes items related to capital management, run-off portfolios, ING Re and remaining activities in Latin America.

 

*

Excluding US Closed Block VA

This note does not provide information on the revenue specified to each product or service as this is not reported internally and is therefore not readily available.

 

F-131


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

b. ING Group

Operating segments ING Group Total

 

2011    Total
Banking
    Total
Insurance
     Eliminations     Total  

Underlying income

         

– Gross premium income

       27,198           27,198   

– Net interest result - banking operations

     13,562           (60     13,502   

– Commission income

     2,255        1,515           3,770   

– Total investment and other income

     (1,345     9,352         (290     7,717   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     14,472        38,065         (350     52,187   

Underlying expenditure

         

– Underwriting expenditure

       33,087           33,087   

– Operating expenses

     9,128        3,730           12,858   

– Other interest expenses

       910         (350     560   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     1,667             1,667   

– Other impairments

     319        24           343   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     11,114        37,751         (350     48,515   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     3,358        314           3,672   

Taxation

     921        19           940   

Minority interests

     79        4           83   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     2,358        291           2,649   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reconciliation between Underlying and IFRS-IASB income, expenses and net result

 

2011    Income      Expenses      Net
result
 

Underlying

     52,187         48,515         2,649   

Divestments

     1,304         309         933   

Special items

     921         861         54   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing operations)

     54,412         49,685         3,636   

Discontinued operations

     1,707         567         1,104   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing and discontinued operations)

     56,119         50,252         4,740   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Divestments in 2011 reflects the results on the sale of ING Real Estate Investment Management (REIM) and ING Car Lease as well as the operating result of the divested units.

Special items in 2011 includes costs for the Retail Netherlands change programme and strategic repositioning initiatives at Commercial Banking, additional costs for the combining of ING Bank and Postbank in the Netherlands, the transformation programme in Belgium, further restructuring at ING Real Estate following the sale of ING REIM, and costs related to the separation of Banking and Insurance, as well as an adjustment of the Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility based on higher prepayment behaviour in the underlying Alt-A securities and the result on the repurchase of subordinated loans executed in December 2011 as disclosed in Note 42 ‘Other income’ and Note 14 ‘Subordinated loans’.

Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’ for information on discontinued operations.

 

F-132


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments ING Group Total

 

2010    Total
Banking
     Total
Insurance
    Eliminations     Total  

Underlying income

         

– Gross premium income

        27,786          27,786   

– Net interest result - banking operations

     13,555           (93     13,462   

– Commission income

     2,253         1,472          3,725   

– Total investment and other income

     413         7,388        (243     7,558   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     16,221         36,646        (336     52,531   

Underlying expenditure

         

– Underwriting expenditure

        32,802          32,802   

– Operating expenses

     8,848         3,766          12,614   

– Other interest expenses

        1,122        (336     786   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     1,742             1,742   

– Other impairments

     488         28          516   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     11,078         37,718        (336     48,460   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     5,143         (1,072       4,071   

Taxation

     1,275         (40       1,235   

Minority interests

     69         18          87   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     3,799         (1,050       2,749   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reconciliation between Underlying and IFRS-IASB income, expenses and net result

 

2010    Income      Expenses      Net
result
 

Underlying

     52,531         48,460         2,749   

Divestments

     979         438         474   

Special items

        1,279         (1,065
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing operations)

     53,510         50,177         2,158   

Discontinued operations

     781         513         209   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing and discontinued operations)

     54,291         50,690         2,367   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Divestments in 2010 mainly relate to the sale of the three U.S. independent retail broker-dealer units, the sale of the Private Banking businesses in Asia and Switzerland and to the sale of ING’s 50% stake in Summit Industrial Fund LP as well as the operating result of the in 2010 and 2011 divested units.

Special items in 2010 includes mainly restructuring expenses for the combining of the Dutch retail activities, the Belgium retail transformation program, the cost related to the separation of Banking and Insurance and the expenses related to the goodwill impairment in the United States of EUR 513 million (after tax) in 2010. Reference is made to Note 9 ‘Intangible assets’.

Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’ for information on discontinued operations.

 

F-133


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments ING Group Total

 

2009    Total
Banking
    Total
Insurance
    Eliminations     Total  

Underlying income

        

– Gross premium income

       30,009          30,009   

– Net interest result - banking operations

     12,628          (165     12,463   

– Commission income

     2,149        1,359          3,508   

– Total investment and other income

     (2,396     3,061        (171     494   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     12,381        34,429        (336     46,474   

Underlying expenditure

        

– Underwriting expenditure

       30,273          30,273   

– Operating expenses

     8,446        3,593          12,039   

– Other interest expenses

       1,047        (336     711   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     2,854            2,854   

– Other impairments

     467        26          493   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     11,767        34,939        (336     46,370   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     614        (510       104   

Taxation

     (102     (95       (197

Minority interests

     76        17          93   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     640        (432       208   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reconciliation between Underlying and IFRS-IASB income, expenses and net result

 

2009    Income     Expenses      Net
result
 

Underlying

     46,474        46,370         208   

Divestments

     229        708         (37

Special items

     (1,267     1,053         (1,759
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing operations)

     45,436        48,131         (1,588

Discontinued operations

     837        634         94   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB (continuing and discontinued operations)

     46,273        48,765         (1,494
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Divestments in 2009 mainly include the net impact of the sale of ING’s 70% stake in ING Canada, the Nationale Nederlanden Industry Pension fund portfolio, the Annuity and Mortgage businesses in Chile, three US independent retail broker-dealer units (three quarters of ING Advisors Network) and ING Australia Pty Limited as well as the operating result of the in 2009, 2010 and 2011 divested units.

Special items in 2009 reflects mainly the net impact of transaction result on the Illiquid Asset Back-up Facility, including the additional Illiquid Assets Back-up Facility payments as part of the overall agreement with the European Commission of EUR 1.3 billion (EUR 930 million after tax), and restructuring costs.

Reference is made to Note 25 ‘Discontinued operations’ for information on discontinued operations.

 

F-134


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

c. Banking activities

Operating segments Banking

 

2011    Retail
Netherlands
     Retail
Belgium
     ING
Direct
    Retail
CE
     Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Banking
    ING
Real
Estate
    Corporate
Line
Banking
    Total
Banking
 

Underlying income

                      

– Net interest result

     3,613         1,606         3,865        705         143         3,257        482        (109     13,562   

– Commission income

     481         336         166        249         59         933        44        (13     2,255   

– Total investment and other income

     52         89         (608     74         73         (1,078     3        50        (1,345
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     4,146         2,031         3,423        1,028         275         3,112        529        (72     14,472   

Underlying expenditure

                      

– Operating expenses

     2,399         1,425         1,951        772         173         2,176        141        91        9,128   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     457         145         462        97         30         330        146          1,667   

– Other impairments *

     29         7         11        1            2        208        61        319   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     2,885         1,577         2,424        870         203         2,508        495        152        11,114   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     1,261         454         999        158         72         604        34        (224     3,358   

Taxation

     316         108         349        30         14         42        87        (25     921   

Minority interests

           1        29         30         26        (7       79   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     945         346         649        99         28         536        (46     (199     2,358   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

analysed as a part of operating expenses.

Operating segments Banking

 

2010    Retail
Netherlands
    Retail
Belgium
    ING
Direct
    Retail
CE
     Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Banking
     ING
Real
Estate
    Corporate
Line
Banking
    Total
Banking
 

Underlying income

                     

– Net interest result

     3,816        1,608        3,774        670         169         3,233         439        (154     13,555   

– Commission income

     498        345        152        278         55         910         28        (13     2,253   

– Total investment and other income

     (4     95        (144     28         62         82         62        232        413   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     4,310        2,048        3,782        976         286         4,225         529        65        16,221   

Underlying expenditure

                     

– Operating expenses

     2,337        1,345        1,857        760         180         2,105         153        111        8,848   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     560        160        446        61         26         387         102          1,742   

– Other impairments *

     39          29        1            2         383        34        488   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     2,936        1,505        2,332        822         206         2,494         638        145        11,078   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     1,374        543        1,450        154         80         1,731         (109     (80     5,143   

Taxation

     361        91        463        31         15         332         27        (45     1,275   

Minority interests

       (6     1        20         22         28         4          69   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     1,013        458        986        103         43         1,371         (140     (35     3,799   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

analysed as a part of operating expenses.

 

F-135


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments Banking:

 

2009    Retail
Netherlands
    Retail
Belgium
    ING
Direct
    Retail
CE
    Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Banking
    ING
Real
Estate
    Corporate
Line
Banking
    Total
Banking
 

Underlying income

                   

– Net interest result

     3,303        1,619        3,136        675        110         3,513        428        (156     12,628   

– Commission income

     528        339        167        261        43         811        6        (6     2,149   

– Total investment and other income

     39        100        (1,541     (76     43         (101     (654     (206     (2,396
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying income

     3,870        2,058        1,762        860        196         4,223        (220     (368     12,381   

Underlying expenditure

                   

– Operating expenses

     2,477        1,287        1,652        660        132         1,817        162        259        8,446   

– Additions to loan loss provision

     527        200        765        116        39         968        239          2,854   

– Other impairments *

     (2     (7     11               429        36        467   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total underlying expenses

     3,002        1,480        2,428        776        171         2,785        830        295        11,767   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before taxation

     868        578        (666     84        25         1,438        (1,050     (663     614   

Taxation

     229        79        (252     29        5         206        (216     (182     (102

Minority interests

       2          5        10         30        29          76   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     639        497        (414     50        10         1,202        (863     (481     640   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

analysed as a part of operating expenses.

d. Insurance activities

With regard to insurance activities, ING Group analyses, as of 2011, the underlying result through a margin analysis, which includes the following components:

 

 

Operating result

 

 

Non-operating items

Both are comprised of various sub-components. The total of operating result and non-operating items (gains/losses and impairments, revaluations and market & other impacts) equals underlying result before tax.

To determine the operating result the following non-operating items are adjusted in the reported underlying result before tax:

 

 

Realised capital gains/losses and impairments on debt and equity securities;

 

 

Revaluations on assets marked to market through the P&L; and

 

 

Other non-operating impacts, e.g. provision for guarantees on separate account pension contracts, equity related and other DAC unlocking, VA/FIA Guaranteed Benefit Reserve Unlocking and DAC offset on gains/losses on debt securities.

The operating result for the life insurance business is also broken down into expenses and the following sources of income:

 

 

Investment margin which includes the spread between investment income earned and interest credited to insurance liabilities (excluding market impacts but including dividends and coupons)

 

 

Fees and premium-based revenues which includes the portion of life insurance premiums available to cover expenses and profit, fees on deposits and fee income on assets under management (net of guaranteed benefit costs in the United States).

 

 

Technical margin which includes the margin between costs charged for benefits and incurred benefit costs and it includes mortality, morbidity and surrender results.

 

 

Non-modelled which is not significant and includes parts of the business for which no margins are provided.

 

F-136


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

As of the fourth quarter of 2010, the Legacy Variable Annuity segment in the US is reported and analysed separately from the other US business in the internal management reporting. Therefore as of October 1,2010 ING reports the Insurance US Legacy VA business as a separate segment to improve transparency and ongoing business. ING Group’s accounting policy for reserve adequacy as set out in the Accounting policies for the consolidated annual accounts of ING Group requires each segment to be adequate at the 50% confidence level. The separation of the Legacy VA business into a separate segment triggered a charge in the fourth quarter of 2010 to bring reserve adequacy on the new Insurance US Closed Block VA segment to the 50% level. This charge is reflected as a DAC write-down of EUR 975 million before tax. For 2011 the impact of the assumption adjustments includes a charge of EUR 177 million to restore the reserve adequacy of the Insurance US Closed Block VA segment to the 50% level at December 31, 2011. Reference is made to Note 43 ‘Underwriting expenditure’.

The adequacy of the reserves held for the Insurance US Closed Block VA segment is evaluated on a quarterly basis. The test considers current estimates of all contractual and related cash flows (including projected performance of the hedge program). The test is conducted by comparing the present value of the cash flows to the reserves for the business line. If it is determined, using a best estimate (50%) confidence level, that reserves are insufficient to support the projected cash outflows, the shortfall is established as an additional reserve, which is in turn recognised immediately in the profit and loss account. There are no offsets considered by any other business line.

There are several key inputs to the reserve adequacy testing. The liability assumptions are based on management’s best estimate of policyholder behaviour, which is reviewed periodically, but at least annually. Stochastic scenario simulations are incorporated based on management’s long term view of equity markets and interest rates. The hedging program is based on our current approach to managing the risk of the business. Finally, current market conditions impact the results of the test as both reserves and the present value of cash flows are sensitive to market interest rates. Any changes in the items above may have a potentially material impact to the results of the reserve adequacy test.

A net reserve inadequacy exists using a prudent (90%) confidence level for the segment Insurance US Closed Block VA. This inadequacy existed in 2011, 2010 and 2009. This inadequacy was offset by reserve adequacies in other segments, such that at the Group level there is a net adequacy at the prudent (90%) confidence level.

Effective as of 2011, the estimate for the short-term equity growth assumption used to calculate the amortisation of DAC in the United States (Insurance US) was changed to a mean reversion assumption. The impact of this change in estimate in 2011 was approximately EUR 14 million lower result before tax.

 

F-137


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments Insurance

 

2011    Insurance
Benelux
    Insurance
CRE
   

Insurance

US

   

Insurance

US Closed
Block VA

   

Insurance
Asia/

Pacific

    ING
IM
    

Corporate

Line
Insurance

    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     666        76        892        28        73        4           1,739   

Fees and premium based revenues

     585        458        1,064        168        1,442        868           4,585   

Technical margin

     315        169        72        28        178             762   

Income non-modelled life business

     36        9            44             89   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,602        712        2,028        224        1,737        872           7,175   

Administrative expenses

     594        308        742        81        456        676           2,857   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     213        202        625        124        731        3           1,898   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     807        510        1,367        205        1,187        679           4,755   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating result

     795        202        661        19        550        193           2,420   

Non-life operating result

     179        5            4             188   

Corporate Line operating result

                  (402     (402
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     974        207        661        19        554        193         (402     2,206   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (47     (404     (166     2        60        5           (550

Revaluations

     62        (1     159        1        (8     6         (14     205   

Market & other impacts

     (250       (36     (1,295     (18        52        (1,547
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     739        (198     618        (1,273     588        204         (364     314   

Taxation

     69        21        (22     (222     121        72         (20     19   

Minority interests

     4        10                 (10     4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     666        (229     640        (1,051     467        132         (334     291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-138


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments Insurance

 

2010    Insurance
Benelux
     Insurance
CRE
    Insurance
US
    Insurance
US
Closed
Block VA
    Insurance
Asia/
Pacific
    ING
IM
    Corporate
Line
Insurance
    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     457         77        827        (11     53        2          1,405   

Fees and premium based revenues

     578         501        1,060        121        1,329        826          4,415   

Technical margin

     243         149        195        9        157            753   

Income non-modelled life business

     40         16            80            136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,318         743        2,082        119        1,619        828          6,709   

Administrative expenses

     567         261        904        77        441        682          2,932   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     230         197        619        (7     710        3          1,752   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     797         458        1,523        70        1,151        685          4,684   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating result

     521         285        559        49        468        143          2,025   

Non-life operating result

     156         7            5            168   

Corporate Line operating result

                  (633     (633
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     677         292        559        49        473        143        (633     1,560   

Gains/losses and impairments

     14         (29     (564     22        50        10        (15     (512

Revaluations

     60           490        3        (14     (3     (87     449   

Market & other impacts

     24         (10     (177     (2,149     8          (265     (2,569
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     775         253        308        (2,075     517        150        (1,000     (1,072

Taxation

     130         63        (155     (57     137        56        (214     (40

Minority interests

     15         10            1        1        (9     18   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     630         180        463        (2,018     379        93        (777     (1,050
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-139


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Operating segments Insurance

 

2009    Insurance
Benelux
    Insurance
CRE
    Insurance
US
    Insurance
US
Closed
Block VA
    Insurance
Asia/
Pacific
    ING
IM
    Corporate
Line
Insurance
    Total
Insurance
 

Investment margin

     368        77        643        22        9        17          1,136   

Fees and premium based revenues

     569        522        967        167        1,083        704          4,012   

Technical margin

     286        175        238        25        163            887   

Income non-modelled life business

     23        14            86            123   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating income

     1,246        788        1,848        214        1,341        721          6,158   

Administrative expenses

     635        261        791        87        410        535          2,719   

DAC amortisation and trail commissions

     235        197        489        104        570        3          1,598   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM expenses

     870        458        1,280        191        980        538          4,317   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Life & ING IM operating result

     376        330        568        23        361        183          1,841   

Non-life operating result

     248        6            4            258   

Corporate Line operating result

                 (802     (802
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating result

     624        336        568        23        365        183        (802        1,297   

Gains/losses and impairments

     (44     (44     (515     38        26          (7     (546

Revaluations

     (356       272        (4     (9     (33     (213     (343

Market & other impacts

     66        (1     31        (821     1          (194     (918
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying result before tax

     290        291        356        (764     383        150        (1,216     (510

Taxation

     58        57        138        (118     112        56        (398     (95

Minority interests

     15        12            1        1        (12     17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underlying net result

     217        222        218        (646     270        93        (806     (432
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

While the reserves for the segment Insurance US Closed Block VA are adequate at the 50% confidence level, a net reserve inadequacy exists using a prudent (90%) confidence level. This inadequacy existed in 2011, 2010 and 2009. In line with Group Policy, Insurance US Closed Block VA is taking measures to improve adequacy in that region. This inadequacy was offset by reserve adequacies in other segments, such that at the Group level there is a net adequacy at the prudent (90%) confidence level.

Effective as of 2011, the estimate for the short-term equity growth assumption used to calculate the amortisation of DAC in the United States (Insurance US) was changed to a mean reversion assumption. The impact of this change in estimate in 2011 was approximately EUR 14 million lower result before tax.

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Banking

 

2011    Retail
Netherlands
     Retail
Belgium
     ING
Direct
     Retail
CE
     Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Ban-king
     ING
Real
Estate
     Corporate
Line
Ban-king
    Total
Banking
 

Interest income

     8,169         2,959         10,506         1,455         583         38,715         1,282         2,512        66,181   

Interest expense

     1,708         1,202         6,909         735         385         37,295         239         4,251        52,724   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     6,461         1,757         3,597         720         198         1,420         1,043         (1,739     13,457   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Insurance

 

2011    Insurance
Benelux
    

Insurance

CRE

   

Insurance

US

     Insurance
US
Closed
Block VA
    

Insurance
Asia/

Pacific

     ING
IM
     Corporate
Line
Insurance
     Total
Insurance
 

Interest income

     2,216         355        3,224         205         896         12         544         7,452   

Interest expense

     32         (2     7            3         4         484         528   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,184         357        3,217         205         893         8         60         6,924   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-140


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Total interest income and interest expenses

 

2011    Total
Banking
     Total
Insurance
     Eliminations     Total
external
 

Interest income

     66,181         7,452         (1,532     72,101   

Interest expense

     52,724         528         (1,524     51,728   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     13,457         6,924         (8     20,373   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Banking

 

2010    Retail
Netherlands
     Retail
Belgium
     ING
Direct
     Retail
CE
     Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Banking
     ING
Real
Estate
     Corporate
Line
Banking
    Total
Banking
 

Interest income

     7,916         3,093         10,059         1,544         452         43,121         1,145         2,357        69,687   

Interest expense

     1,524         1,015         6,310         817         261         42,509         263         3,572        56,271   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     6,392         2,078         3,749         727         191         612         882         (1,215     13,416   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Insurance

 

2010    Insurance
Benelux
    

Insurance

CRE

    

Insurance

US

     Insurance
US
Closed
Block VA
    

Insurance
Asia/

Pacific

     ING
IM
     Corporate
Line
Insurance
    Total
Insurance
 

Interest income

     2,592         363         3,433         28         808         13         (21     7,216   

Interest expense

     151            76         5         3         5         547        787   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     2,441         363         3,357         23         805         8         (568     6,429   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income and interest expenses

 

2010    Total
Banking
     Total
Insurance
     Eliminations     Total
external
 

Interest income

     69,687         7,216         (1,362     75,541   

Interest expense

     56,271         787         (1,260     55,798   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     13,416         6,429         (102     19,743   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Banking

 

2009    Retail
Netherlands
     Retail
Belgium
     ING
Direct
     Retail
CE
     Retail
Asia
     Commercial
Banking
     ING
Real
Estate
     Corporate
Line
Banking
    Total
Banking
 

Interest income

     8,039         3,020         10,532         1,603         399         54,143         1,259         2,152        81,147   

Interest expense

     2,200         1,541         7,451         950         246         52,531         178         3,510        68,607   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     5,839         1,479         3,081         653         153         1,612         1,081         (1,358     12,540   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income and interest expenses breakdown by operating segments Insurance

2009    Insurance
Benelux
    

Insurance

CRE

    

Insurance

US

     Insurance
US
Closed
Block VA
   

Insurance
Asia/

Pacific

     ING
IM
    Corporate
Line
Insurance
    Total
Insurance
 

Interest income

     2,587         419         3,327         2        643         8        (413     6,573   

Interest expense

     295         37         113         5        10         9        243        712   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     2,292         382         3,214         (3     633         (1     (656     5,861   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-141


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Total interest income and interest expenses

 

2009    Total
Banking
     Total
Insurance
     Eliminations     Total
external
 

Interest income

     81,147         6,573         (1,252     86,468   

Interest expense

     68,607         712         (1,132     68,187   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     12,540         5,861         (120     18,281   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

IFRS-IASB balance sheets by segment are not reported internally to, and not managed by, the chief operating decision maker. IFRS-IASB balance sheet information is prepared, and disclosed below, for the Banking operations as a whole and for the Insurance operations as a whole and by segment.

Total assets and Total liabilities by segment

 

     2011     2010     2009  
    

Total

assets

    Total
liabilities
   

Total

assets

    Total
liabilities
   

Total

assets

    Total
liabilities
 

Insurance Benelux

     96,067        83,756        92,614        83,472        85,131        78,413   

Insurance CRE

     11,729        10,724        12,671        11,288        12,212        10,789   

Insurance US

     118,329        106,696        114,218        102,781        101,103        97,213   

Insurance US Closed Block VA

     41,362        38,771        42,477        40,254        39,636        36,562   

Insurance Latin America

         3,162        1,557        2,759        1,321   

Insurance Asia/Pacific

     62,281        56,712        57,029        52,332        44,267        41,381   

ING IM

     1,385        605        2,033        1,184        926        434   

Corporate Line Insurance

     55,684        29,667        46,595        24,960        37,767        21,116   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Insurance segments

     386,837        326,931        370,799        317,828        323,801        287,229   

Eliminations Insurance segments

     (51,349     (15,122     (45,046     (12,490     (33,696     (12,846
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Insurance operations

     335,488        311,809        325,753        305,338        290,105        274,383   

Total Banking operations

     979,405        933,263        951,006        907,658        897,463        860,547   

Eliminations

     (41,313     (17,710     (34,020     (13,705     (27,786     (11,964
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ING Group

     1,273,580        1,227,362        1,242,739        1,199,291        1,159,782        1,122,966   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Further balance sheet related information for the banking operations is provided by segment in the section ‘Risk Management’.

52 Information on geographical areas

ING Group’s business lines operate in seven main geographical areas: the Netherlands, Belgium, Rest of Europe, North America, Latin America, Asia and Australia. The Netherlands is ING Group’s country of domicile. Geographical distribution of income is based on the origin of revenue. A geographical area is a distinguishable component of the Group engaged in providing products or services within a particular economic environment that is subject to risks and returns that are different from those of segments operating in other economic environments. The geographical analyses are based on the location of the office from which the transactions are originated.

Geographical areas

 

2011    Netherlands      Belgium      Rest of
Europe
     North
America
     Latin
America
     Asia      Australia      Other      Eliminations     Total  

Total income

     17,877         3,795         7,446         17,701         44         10,352         525            (3,328     54,412   

Total assets

     653,459         180,491         323,747         351,630         9,685         115,942         43,652         207         (405,233     1,273,580   

Geographical areas

 

2010    Netherlands      Belgium      Rest of
Europe
     North
America
     Latin
America
     Asia      Australia      Other      Eliminations     Total  

Total income

     16,414         4,352         7,854         17,475         180         9,730         427            (2,922     53,510   

Total assets

     639,318         161,781         326,179         339,516         16,721         105,733         44,160         152         (390,821     1,242,739   

 

F-142


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Geographical areas

 

2009    Netherlands      Belgium      Rest of
Europe
     North
America
     Latin
America
     Asia      Australia      Other      Eliminations     Total  

Total income

     12,870         4,573         7,676         15,224         229         10,089         865            (5,253     46,273   

Total assets

     576,371         156,059         317,994         295,207         14,925         84,874         35,365         134         (321,147     1,159,782   

53 Net cash flow from investing activities

Information on the impact of companies acquired or disposed is presented in Note 30 ‘Companies acquired and companies disposed’.

54 Interest and dividend included in net cash flow

Interest and dividend received and paid

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Interest received

     73,947        77,541        88,161   

Interest paid

     (53,113     (59,329     (68,832
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     20,834        18,212        19,329   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividend received

     485        500        344   

Dividend paid

         (1,030

55 Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents

 

     2011     2010      2009  

Treasury bills and other eligible bills

     2,611        4,441         3,182   

Amounts due from/to banks

     (4,505     3,227         2,387   

Cash and balances with central banks

     31,194        13,072         15,390   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     29,300        20,740         20,959   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Treasury bills and other eligible bills included in cash and cash equivalents

 

     2011      2010      2009  

Treasury bills and other eligible bills included in trading assets

     1,471         1,697         2,284   

Treasury bills and other eligible bills included in available-for-sale investments

     1,140         2,744         898   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,611         4,441         3,182   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amounts due to/from banks

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Included in cash and cash equivalents:

      

– amounts due to banks

     (19,122     (12,898     (12,334

– amounts due from banks

     14,617        16,125        14,721   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (4,505     3,227        2,387   

Not included in cash and cash equivalents:

      

– amounts due to banks

     (53,111     (59,954     (71,901

– amounts due from banks

     30,706        35,703        28,676   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (22,405     (24,251     (43,225

Total as included in balance sheet:

      

– amounts due to banks

     (72,233     (72,852     (84,235

– amounts due from banks

     45,323        51,828        43,397   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (26,910     (21,024     (40,838
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents include amounts due to/from banks with a term of less than three months from the date on which they were acquired.

ING Group’s risk management (including liquidity) is explained in the ‘Risk management’ section.

 

F-143


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

56 Impact of change in accounting policy

This note provides more information on the impact of the change in accounting policy for insurance provisions for Guaranteed Minimum Benefits for Life and how this change affects the financial information of the comparative years as included in previously published annual accounts. Reference is made to ‘Changes in Accounting Policies’ for more details on the impact of the change in accounting policy.

The restated consolidated balance sheets as per December 31, 2009 and January 1, 2009 are as follows:

Restated consolidated balance sheets

 

    

December 31,

2009
(Restated)

    

January 1,

2009

(Restated)

 

ASSETS

     

Cash and balances with central banks

     15,390         22,045   

Amounts due from banks

     43,397         48,447   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

     

– trading assets

     111,444         160,378   

– investments for risk of policyholders

     104,597         95,366   

– non-trading derivatives

     11,632         16,484   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     5,517         8,277   

Investments

     

– available-for-sale

     197,703         242,852   

– held-to-maturity

     14,409         15,440   

Loans and advances to customers

     575,275         616,776   

Reinsurance contracts

     5,480         5,797   

Investments in associates

     3,699         4,355   

Real estate investments

     3,638         4,300   

Property and equipment

     6,119         6,396   

Intangible assets

     6,021         6,915   

Deferred acquisition costs

     11,208         12,989   

Assets held for sale

     5,024         15,312   

Other assets

     39,229         47,665   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,159,782         1,329,794   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

EQUITY

     

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     30,901         14,935   

Non-voting equity securities

     5,000         10,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     35,901         24,935   

Minority interests

     915         1,594   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity

     36,816         26,529   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

     

Subordinated loans

     10,099         10,281   

Debt securities in issue

     119,981         96,488   

Other borrowed funds

     23,151         31,198   

Insurance and investment contracts

     241,006         242,159   

Amounts due to banks

     84,235         152,265   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

     469,508         522,783   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

     

– trading liabilities

     98,245         152,616   

– non-trading derivatives

     20,070         21,773   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

     11,474         14,009   

Liabilities held for sale

     4,890         15,020   

Other liabilities

     40,307         44,673   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     1,122,966         1,303,265   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity and liabilities

     1,159,782         1,329,794   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-144


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The change in accounting policy for insurance provisions for Guaranteed Minimum Benefits for Life affects the following balance sheet line items: Deferred acquisition costs, Other liabilities, Insurance and investment contracts and Shareholders’ equity (reference is made to Note 13 ‘Shareholders’ equity (parent)/non-voting equity securities’). In addition to the comparative information on 2010 as disclosed in the relevant notes the following tables also disclose on the balance sheet items as per December 31, 2009 and January 1, 2009.

Deferred acquisition costs (Restated)

Changes in deferred acquisition costs

 

     Investment
contracts
    Life
insurance
    Non-life
insurance
    Total  

Opening balance January 1, 2009

     89        12,635        265        12,989   

Capitalised

     9        1,609        12        1,630   

Amortisation and unlocking

     (11     (1,722     (12     (1,745

Effect of unrealised revaluations in equity

       (1,140       (1,140

Changes in the composition of the group

     (104     58        (231     (277

Exchange rate differences

     17        (276     9        (250

Disposal of portfolios

       1          1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance December 31, 2009

     0        11,165        43        11,208   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Insurance and investment contracts, Reinsurance contracts (Restated)

Insurance and investment contracts, reinsurance contracts

 

    

Provision

net of reinsurance

     Reinsurance contracts     

Insurance

and investment contracts

 
    

December 31,

2009

    

January 1,

2009

    

December 31,

2009

    

January 1,

2009

    

December 31,

2009

    

January 1,

2009

 

Provision for non-participating life policy liabilities

     69,789         68,489         4,798         4,822         74,587         73,311   

Provision for participating life policy liabilities

     50,102         55,266         200         217         50,302         55,483   

Provision for (deferred) profit sharing and rebates

     1,600         147         3         2         1,603         149   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance provisions excluding provisions for risk of policyholders

     121,491         123,902         5,001         5,041         126,492         128,943   

Provision for life insurance for risk of policyholders

     99,299         84,279         374         541         99,673         84,820   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance provisions

     220,790         208,181         5,375         5,582         226,165         213,763   

Provision for unearned premiums and unexpired risks

     361         1,756         4         13         365         1,769   

Reported claims provision

     2,580         3,995         96         202         2,676         4,197   

Claims incurred but not reported (IBNR)

     493         1,345         5            498         1,345   

Claims provisions

     3,073         5,340         101         202         3,174         5,542   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total provisions for insurance contracts

     224,224         215,277         5,480         5,797         229,704         221,074   

Investment contracts for risk of company

     5,896         9,804               5,896         9,804   

Investment contracts for risk of policyholders

     5,406         11,281               5,406         11,281   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total provisions for investment contracts

     11,302         21,085               11,302         21,085   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     235,526         236,362         5,480         5,797         241,006         242,159   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-145


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Other liabilities (Restated)

Other liabilities by type

 

     December 31,
2009
     January 1,
2009
 

Deferred tax liabilities

     1,352         2,763   

Income tax payable

     1,225         940   

Pension benefits

     589         609   

Post-employment benefits

     175         219   

Other staff-related liabilities

     735         342   

Other taxation and social security contributions

     1,001         1,104   

Deposits from reinsurers

     870         909   

Accrued interest

     16,789         17,552   

Costs payable

     2,654         3,764   

Amounts payable to brokers

     200         89   

Amounts payable to policyholders

     2,182         2,231   

Reorganisation provision

     644         583   

Other provisions

     747         969   

Share-based payment plan liabilities

     24         11   

Prepayments received under property under development

     120         175   

Amounts to be settled

     5,167         3,753   

Dividend payable

        425   

Other

     5,833         8,235   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     40,307         44,673   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in deferred tax

 

     Net
liability
    Change
through
equity
   

Change
through

net
result

   

Changes

in the
composition
of the group

    Exchange
rate
differences
    Other     Net liability  
     January 1,
2009
                                  December 31,
2009
 

Investments

     (5,418     5,330        341        17        (114     53        209   

Financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

     29        (1     (324     (21     10        (6     (313

Deferred acquisition costs and VOBA

     3,402        (567     136        (12     (180     71        2,850   

Fiscal reserve

         (48         48     

Depreciation

     15          (4         1        12   

Insurance provisions

     (494     (483     (468     55        (1     (55     (1,446

Cash flow hedges

     277        (197         (2     (9     69   

Pension and post-employment benefits

     374          326              700   

Other provisions

     (1,422     2        360        4        116        (72     (1,012

Receivables

     (61       (72       (5     (11     (149

Loans and advances to customers

     (201       (32     (28     1        45        (215

Unused tax losses carried forward

     (1,653       (951     7        82        7        (2,508

Other

     (119     (70     (695     (34     19        85        (814
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (5,271     4,014        (1,431     (12     (74     157        (2,617
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprising:

              

– deferred tax liabilities

     2,763                  1,352   

– deferred tax assets

     (8,034               (3,969
  

 

 

             

 

 

 
     (5,271               (2,617
  

 

 

             

 

 

 

 

F-146


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.2.1 RISK MANAGEMENT

ING GROUP RISK MANAGEMENT

Taking measured risks is part of ING Group’s business. As a financial services company active in banking, investments, life and non-life insurance and retirement services, ING Group is naturally exposed to a variety of risks. To ensure measured risk-taking throughout the organisation, ING Group operates through a comprehensive risk management framework, integrated risk management in its daily business activities and strategic planning. This ensures the identification, measurement and control of risks at all levels of the organisation so that ING Group’s financial strength is safeguarded.

Risk Management assists the various management boards with the formulation of risk appetite, strategies, policies and limits and provides a review, oversight and support function throughout ING Group on risk-related issues. The main financial risks ING Group is exposed to are credit risk (including transfer risk), market risk (including interest rate, equity, real estate, implied volatility, and foreign exchange risks), insurance risk, liquidity risk and business risk. In addition, ING Group is exposed to non-financial risks, e.g. operational and compliance risks. The way ING Group manages these risks on a day-to-day basis is described in this risk management section.

As a result of the decision to manage ING Bank and ING Insurance separately, ING has implemented two distinct risk appetite frameworks for both Bank and Insurance. The common concept however is that risk appetite is expressed as the tolerance to allow key capital ratios to deviate from their target levels under adverse scenarios. These frameworks are discussed in more detail in the specific sections of this risk management section.

ING has completed the divestment of its Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations. This transaction is the first major step in the divestment of ING’s insurance and investment management activities.

Both ING Bank and ING Insurance need to prepare for significant changes in the regulatory requirements. For ING Bank the most important one is the implementation of Basel III, while ING Insurance runs an extensive program to allow the implementation of Solvency II (which is the fundamental reform of European insurance solvency and risk governance legislation; announced to be effective as of January 1, 2013 but delays in legislation imply that it will not be effective before January 1, 2014). Additionally, both in Bank and Insurance, ING continued its stress testing efforts, with stress testing becoming more important and more embedded in the risk culture.

MISSION AND OBJECTIVES

The mission of ING Group’s risk management function is to build a sustainable competitive advantage by fully integrating risk management into daily business activities and strategic planning. This mission is fully embedded in ING Group’s business processes. The following principles support this objective:

 

 

Products and portfolios are structured, underwritten, priced, approved and managed appropriately and compliance with internal and external rules and guidelines is monitored;

 

 

ING’s risk profile is transparent, managed to avoid surprises, and is consistent with delegated authorities;

 

 

Delegated authorities are consistent with the overall Group strategy and risk appetite;

 

 

Transparent communication to internal and external stakeholders on risk management.

Risk Management benefits ING and its shareholders directly by providing more efficient capitalisation and lower costs of risk and funding. The cost of capital is reduced by working closely with rating agencies and regulators to align capital requirements to risks. Risk Management helps business units to lower funding costs, make use of the latest risk management tools and skills, and lower strategic risk, allowing them to focus on their core expertise with the goal of making ING’s businesses more competitive in their markets.

GROUP RISK MANAGEMENT FUNCTION

The ING Group CRO is supported by the Risk functions of ING Group and by the Group functions Corporate Legal and the Functional Controller Insurance. As a result of the decision to manage ING Bank and ING Insurance separately, ING Group Chief Risk Office has delegated day-to-day Risk Management within ING Bank, ING Insurance Eurasia and ING Insurance US to the respective (deputy) CROs. The Risk functions of ING Group have been delegated to the CRO of ING Bank.

 

F-147


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Further details on the Risk Governance and Risk Profile in the three entities, is given in the following sections.

LOGO

ING Group uses an integrated risk management approach for both its banking activities and for its Insurance activities. With the operational separation of ING Bank and ING Insurance, the focus of ING’s risk management practices is now located in the bank and insurance companies. The remainder of this risk paragraph discusses these practices for ING Group, ING Bank, ING Insurance Eurasia and ING Insurance US respectively.

Risk measures related to accounting are based on IFRS-EU where relevant, as IFRS-EU is the primary accounting basis, which is also the basis for statutory and regulatory reporting and risk management.

RISK DEVELOPMENTS IN 2011

During 2011, ING continued to actively deleverage and de-risk its balance sheet. The ING Group bond portfolio decreased from EUR 294.5 billion at year-end 2010 to EUR 263.5 billion at year-end of 2011, excluding ING Direct USA. The size of the ING Direct USA bond portfolio is EUR 23.0 billion. The change is mainly caused by changes in the government, financial institutions and ABS and CMBS bond portfolio. The debt securities revaluation reserve after tax, excluding ING Direct USA, improved in 2011 to EUR 5,743 million compared to EUR 1,620 million in 2010, due to interest rates developments and the spread widening that took place during 2011 as a result of the debt crisis in Europe. More details on the Investments can be found in Note 4 ‘Investments’ of the Annual Accounts.

ABS portfolio

The RMBS and ABS portfolio changed from EUR 51.2 billion at year-end 2010 to 31.5 billion, excluding ING Direct USA. The RMBS and ABS exposure of ING Direct USA is EUR 15.0 billion ING Group continued to manage its asset-backed securities (ABS) portfolio downwards in 2011 and reduced the exposure on the ABS portfolio. With the sale of ING Direct USA, the ING Group exposure to ABS is drastically reduced and going forward we will not report them as pressurised assets in our financial reporting. The revaluation reserve on the ABS portfolio deteriorated and is still negative. ING Group still recognised further impairments of EUR 203 million, though for a smaller amount than in the previous year (2010: EUR 541 million). Further details are included in Note 4 ‘Investments’ of the Annual Accounts.

Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain

In the first half of 2010 concerns arose regarding the creditworthiness of several southern European countries, which later spread to a few other European countries. As a result of these concerns the fair value of sovereign debt decreased and those exposures were being monitored more closely. With regard to troubled countries, ING’s main focus is on Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain as these countries have either applied for support from the European Financial Stability Facility (‘EFSF’) or receive support from the ECB via government bond purchases in the secondary market. Within these countries, ING’s main focus is on exposure to Government bonds and Unsecured Financial institutions’ bonds. Further details are included in Note 4 ‘Investments’.

The table below provides information on ING’s risk exposure with regard to Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain. Unless otherwise indicated, the amounts represent risk exposure values and exposures are included based on the country of residence.

 

F-148


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Greece, Italy, Ireland, Portugal and Spain - Total exposures 1) 2) 5)

 

2011    Greece     Italy      Ireland     Portugal      Spain     Total  

Residential mortgages and other consumer lending

     14        7,027         4        3         9,176        16,224   

Corporate Lending

     307        9,156         575        996         7,131        18,165   

Financial Institutions Lending

     6        853         135        139         2,038        3,171   

Government Lending

     0        195         0        0         55        250   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Lending

     326        17,231         714        1,138         18,400        37,810   

RMBS

     96        1,313         1,603        245         4,131        7,388   

CMBS

     0        0         310        0         0        310   

Other ABS

     0        400         467        0         169        1,036   

Corporate Bonds

     0        495         346        68         475        1,384   

Covered Bonds

     0        236         350        0         16,835        17,421   

Financial institutions Bonds (unsecured)

     0        819         291        336         396        1,842   

Government Bonds

     254        2,557         54        809         1,508        5,182   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Debt Securities

     351        5,820         3,421        1,458         23,514        34,563   

Trading (3)

     (5     519         40        11         316        881   

Real Estate (4)

     36        496         0        319         632        1,483   

Undrawn committed facilities (Off balance)

     411        1,229         523        140         2,302        4,605   

Credit protection (CDS)

              

Credit protection bought (notional)

     112        640         131        43         479        1,405   

Credit protection sold (notional)

     107        617         136        43         530        1,433   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net CDS Positions

     5        23         (5     0         (51     (28

 

(1) 

The exposures reported are credit, market and real estate exposures based on source systems and measurement criteria that can differ from those of similar exposures reported in Note 4 ‘Investments’ of the Annual Accounts.

(2) 

More information on the risk management definitions and practices can be found in the remainder of this section.

(3) 

Trading exposure also includes netted CDS exposure, of which details are provided at the bottom of this table.

(4) 

Real Estate includes Real Estate Development, Real Estate Investments and Property in Own Use; it does not include (indirect) exposure through Real Estate Finance, which is reflected in Total Lending and Total Debt Securities.

(5) 

These are Group risk exposures of which the Insurance component is netted for impairments, as well as Bank Greek Government exposure.

Greece

Total Lending exposure is reported in the Balance sheet at amortised cost. Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on lending exposures amount to approximately EUR 1 million. Debt securities - RMBS are reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Debt securities - Government bonds are reported in the balance sheet at fair value (available-for-sale). Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on debt securities amount to EUR 978 million and fully relate to government bonds.

Italy

Total Lending exposure is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on lending exposures amount to approximately EUR 113 million. Debt securities – RMBS and Other ABS are largely reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Other debt securities are reported in the balance sheet at fair value (available-for-sale). No significant provisions/impairments have been recognised.

Ireland

Total Lending exposure is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. No provisions/impairments have been recognised. Approximately 80% of Total Debt securities is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Approximately 20% is reported in the balance sheet at fair value (available-for-sale). Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on debt securities amount to EUR 270 million and relate to subordinated debt from Irish banks (EUR 189 million), RMBS (EUR 2 million) and Other ABS (EUR 88 million). In addition to the above exposures on Ireland, ING Insurance has Irish reinsurance exposure of EUR 1,345 million. This mainly includes reinsurance through an Irish subsidiary of a large European Reinsurance group.

 

F-149


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Portugal

Total Lending exposure is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on lending exposures amount to approximately EUR 7 million. Debt securities – RMBS are largely reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Other debt securities are reported in the balance sheet at fair value (available-for-sale). Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised are less than EUR 1 million.

Spain

Total Lending exposure is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Cumulative provisions/impairments recognised on lending exposures amount to approximately EUR 351 million, of which EUR 319 million relates to Corporate lending and EUR 32 million relates to Residential mortgages and other consumer lending.

Debt securities – RMBS, Other ABS and Covered bonds are largely reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost. Other debt securities are reported in the balance sheet largely at fair value (available-for-sale). No significant provisions/impairments have been recognised.

Debt securities – Covered bonds are backed by mortgage collateral. From the total exposure of EUR 16.8 billion, EUR 14.9 billion is reported in the balance sheet at amortised cost (EUR 11.0 billion Loans and EUR 3.9 billion Held-to-maturity) and EUR 1.9 billion is reported in the balance sheet at fair value (Available-for-sale). No significant provisions/impairments have been recognised. Almost the entire portfolio is investment grade.

Derivatives

In these countries, ING Bank has limited derivative exposure and largely enters derivative transactions to help clients reduce exposure to interest and currency movements. Many of these transactions are covered either via CSA agreements or as part of the collateral of the underlying financing. The key credit risk ING Bank faces in these derivative transactions is movements in markets creating an uncollateralised exposure to a counterparty or that the collateral is not sufficient. ING monitors these marked to market movements on a daily basis. At December 31, 2011 ING Bank had no material, uncollateralized exposure to counterparties in these countries.

ING Insurance does not have material derivatives exposures in these countries.

Monitoring exposures and Current developments

The problems in the Eurozone have been a top priority for risk management throughout 2011, and will continue to be a top priority in 2012. ING closely monitors the exposures in debt securities, lending and credit derivatives in the involved countries, and regularly assesses whether the positions still fit with its risk appetite. This assessment is supported by internal stress tests.

Throughout 2011 ING has reduced its positions in especially government bonds for some of the weaker countries as a result of these risk analyses.

Several European countries have been downgraded but there have also been some positive developments related to the Eurozone crisis. Financial markets rallied due to amongst others the Long Term Refinancing Operations from the ECB and better than expected economic data. Credit spreads for some of the involved countries tightened significantly. Furthermore, a new Greek bail-out plan was approved in February 2012.

Nevertheless, despite these positive signs the Eurozone is not yet out of the doldrums, as many of the fundamental problems still remain. There is no guarantee that the weaker countries will succeed in making their economies more competitive, which is a prerequisite for long term debt sustainability. Risks and concerns about the debt crisis in Europe, as well as the possible exit from the Eurozone of one or more European states and/or the replacement of the Euro by one or more successor currencies, could have a detrimental impact on the global economic recovery, sovereign and non-sovereign debt in these European countries and the financial condition of European financial institutions, including ING.

On February 21, 2012 a new common understanding on key terms of a voluntary exchange of privately held Greek government bonds was reached. The programme is expected to be implemented in March 2012 and did not have an impact on the 2011 results.

 

F-150


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Liquidity risk

Under the volatile market circumstances in 2011, funding and liquidity risk remains an important topic on the agenda of senior management and Asset and Liability Committee Bank (ALCO), that requires continuous monitoring and management. External market and regulatory developments and internal financial developments are closely monitored. Regular stress testing and measurement of early warning indicators are, among others, used to provide additional management information. In 2011 the funding and liquidity risk appetite were updated. The appetite statement is set and allocated throughout ING Bank. In addition, funding and liquidity usage is steered by means of funds transfer pricing thus embedding funding and liquidity risk management in the total organisation. ING Group continued to maintain its liquidity position within conservative internal targets.

In 2011, new frameworks for the funding and liquidity risk management as well as the organisational Assets and Liability Management (ALM) that reflects the evolved importance of funding and liquidity risk was developed. Both of these frameworks will be implemented in 2012.

ING Insurance defines different levels of Liquidity Management; short term liquidity or cash management, long term liquidity management, and stress liquidity management. Liquidity risk is measured through several metrics including ratios and cash flow scenario analysis, in the base case and under several stressed scenarios.

Like to most insurance companies, in normal circumstances liquidity risk is quite remote to ING Insurance. Also under the current challenging market circumstances ING insurance liquidity position is comfortable.

ING BANK

To ensure measured risk-taking throughout the organisation, ING Bank operates through a comprehensive risk management framework. This ensures the identification, measurement and control of risks at all levels of the organisation so that ING Bank’s financial strength is safeguarded.

ING Bank uses risk assessment and measurement to guide decision making. As a result, the quality of risk models is important. The governance process for approval of risk models, methods and parameters ensures compliance with business and regulatory requirements, via a clear assignment of responsibility and accountability.

Nevertheless, users of the information in the risk management section should bear in mind that the analyses provided are forward looking measures that rely on assumptions and estimates of future events, some of which are considered extreme and therefore unlikely to occur. In the normal course of business ING Bank continues to develop, recalibrate and refine the various models that support risk metrics, which may result in changes to the risk metrics as disclosed.

MISSION AND OBJECTIVES

The mission of ING Bank’s risk management function is to build a sustainable competitive advantage by fully integrating risk management into daily business activities and strategic planning. This mission is fully embedded in ING Bank’s business processes. The following principles support this objective:

 

 

Products and portfolios are structured, underwritten, priced, approved and managed appropriately and compliance with internal and external rules and guidelines is monitored;

 

 

ING Bank’s risk profile is transparent, managed to avoid surprises, and is consistent with delegated authorities;

 

 

Delegated authorities are consistent with the overall Bank strategy and risk appetite;

 

 

Transparent communication to internal and external stakeholders on risk management and value creation.

Risk Management benefits ING Bank and its shareholders directly by providing more efficient capitalisation and lower costs of risk and funding. The cost of capital is reduced by working closely with rating agencies and regulators to align capital requirements to risks. Risk Management helps business units to lower funding costs, make use of the latest risk management tools and skills, and lower strategic risk, allowing them to focus on their core expertise with the goal of making ING Bank’s businesses more competitive in their markets.

ING BANK RISK GOVERNANCE

ING Bank’s risk management framework is based on the ‘three lines of defence’ concept which ensures that risk is managed in line with the risk appetite as defined by the Management Board Bank (and ratified by the Supervisory Board) and is cascaded throughout ING Bank.

 

F-151


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Business line management and the regional and local managers have primary responsibility for the day-to-day management of risk and form the first line of defence.

The risk management function, both at bank and regional/local level, belongs to the second line of defence and has the primary responsibility to align risk taking with strategic planning e.g. in limit setting.

The internal audit function provides an ongoing independent (i.e. outside of the risk organisation) and objective assessment of the effectiveness of internal controls, including financial and operational risk management and forms the third line of defence.

LOGO

Board level risk oversight

ING Bank has a two-tier board structure consisting of the Management Board Bank and the Supervisory Board; both tiers play an important role in managing and monitoring the risk management framework.

 

 

The Supervisory Board is responsible for supervising the policy of the Management Board Bank, the general course of affairs of the Company and its business (including its financial policies and corporate structure). For the risk management purposes the Supervisory Board is assisted by two sub-committees:

 

   

The Audit Committee, which assists the Supervisory Board in reviewing and assessing ING Bank’s major risk exposures and the operation of internal risk management and control systems, as well as policies and procedures regarding compliance with applicable laws and regulations; and

 

   

The Risk Committee, which assists the Supervisory Board on matters related to risk governance, risk policies and risk appetite setting.

 

 

The Management Board Bank (MBB) is responsible for managing risks associated with the activities of ING Bank. The MBB’s responsibilities include ensuring that internal risk management and control systems are effective and that ING Bank complies with relevant legislation and regulations. On a regular basis, the MBB reports on these issues and discusses the internal risk management and control systems with the Supervisory Board. On a quarterly basis, the MBB reports on the Bank’s risk profile versus its risk appetite to the Audit Committee, explaining changes in the risk profile.

The Chief Risk Officer (CRO) ensures that the boards are well informed and understand ING Bank’s risk position at all times. Every quarter, the CRO reports to the board committees on ING Bank’s risk appetite levels and on ING Bank’s risk profile. In addition the CRO briefs the board committees on developments in internal and external risk related issues and ensures the board committees understand specific risk concepts.

 

F-152


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

As part of the integration of risk management into the annual strategic planning process, the MBB issues a Planning Letter which provides the organisation with the corporate strategic direction, and addresses key risk issues. Based on the Planning Letter, the business lines and business units develop their business plans which align with the Bank’s strategic direction. The process includes a qualitative and quantitative assessment of the risks involved. As part of the process strategic limits and risk appetite levels are explicitly discussed. Based on the business plans, the Management Board Bank formulates the Strategic Plan which is submitted to the Supervisory Board for approval.

Executive Level

The risk committees described below act within the overall risk policy and delegated authorities granted by the Management Board Bank:

 

 

The Finance and Risk Committee (F&RC) is a platform for the CRO and the Chief Financial Officer (CFO), along with their respective direct reports, to discuss and decide on issues that relate to both the finance and risk domains. The primary responsibility of the F&RC is to co-ordinate, on a high level, the finance and risk decisions that have an impact on internal and/or external reporting;

 

 

ING Bank Credit Committee – Policy (GCC(P)): Discusses and approves policies, methodologies and procedures related to credit, country and reputation risks within ING Bank. The GCC(P) meets on a monthly basis;

 

 

ING Bank Credit Committee – Transaction Approval (GCC(TA)): Discusses and approves transactions which entail taking credit risk (including issuer investment risk). The GCC(TA) meets twice a week;

 

 

Asset and Liability Committee ING Bank (ALCO Bank): Discusses and approves on a monthly basis the overall risk profile of all ING Bank’s market risks that occur in its Commercial Banking and Retail & Direct Banking activities. ALCO Bank defines the policy regarding funding, liquidity, interest rate mismatch and solvency for ING Bank; and

 

 

Non Financial Risk Committee Bank (NFRC Bank): Accountable for the design and maintenance of the Risk Management Framework including the ORM, Compliance and Legal policies, minimum standards, procedures and guidelines; the NFRC structure; development of tools, methods and key parameters (incl. major changes) for risk identification, measurement and monitoring/ reporting.

Risk Management Function

The risk management function is embedded in all levels of ING Bank organisation. The Chief Risk Officer, who is a MBB member, bears primary overall responsibility for the Risk management function. The CRO is responsible for the management and control of risk on a consolidated level to ensure that ING Bank’s risk profile is consistent with its financial resources and the risk appetite. The CRO is also responsible for establishing and maintaining a robust organisational basis for the management of risk throughout the organisation.

The organisation chart below illustrates the functional reporting lines within ING Bank risk organisation.

 

LOGO

The heads of these departments (Risk General Managers) report to the CRO and bear direct responsibility for risk (mitigating) decisions at the Bank level. The Risk General Managers and the CRO are responsible for the harmonisation and standardisation of risk management practices.

 

F-153


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

From December 2011, the reporting lines have been changed. As of then the CCO reports to the new appointed Head of Non Financial Risk ING Bank who in his turn reports to the Chief Risk Officer.

In addition two staff departments report to the CRO:

 

 

Risk Integration and Analytics (RI&A), which is responsible for inter-risk aggregation processes and for providing bank-wide risk information to the CRO and Management Board Bank; and

 

 

Model Validation (MV), which carries out periodic validations of all material risk models used by ING Bank. To ensure independence from the business and other risk departments, the department head reports directly to the CRO.

Risk policies

ING Bank has a framework of risk management policies, procedures and standards in place to create consistency throughout the organisation, and to define minimum requirements that are binding to all business units. The governance framework of the business units aligns with the Bank’s level framework and meets local (regulatory) requirements. Senior Management is responsible to ensure policies, procedures and standards are implemented and adhered to. Policies, procedures and standards are regularly reviewed and updated via the relevant risk committees to reflect changes in markets, products and emerging best practices.

ING BANK RISK PROFILE

ING Bank uses risk assessment and risk measurement to guide decision making. As a result, the quality of risk models is important. The governance process for approval of risk models, methods and parameters ensures business and regulatory requirements, via a clear assignment of responsibility and accountability.

Nevertheless, users of the information in the risk management section should bear in mind that the analyses provided are forward looking measures that rely on assumptions and estimates of future events, some of which are considered extreme and therefore unlikely to occur. In the normal course of business ING Bank continues to develop, recalibrate and refine the various models that support risk metrics, which may result in changes to the risk metrics as disclosed.

Risk types

ING Bank measures the following main types of risks that are associated with its business activities:

 

 

Credit risk: the risk of potential loss due to default by ING Bank’s debtors (including bond issuers) or trading counterparties;

 

 

Market risk: the risk of potential loss due to adverse movements in market variables. Market risks include interest rate, equity, real estate, implied volatility, credit spread, and foreign exchange risks;

 

 

Liquidity risk: the risk that ING Bank or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities when they come due, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner. Liquidity risk can materialise both through trading and non-trading positions;

 

 

Operational risk is the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes reputational risk, as well as legal risk;

 

 

Compliance Risk: is the risk of impairment of ING Bank’s integrity as a result of failure (or perceived failure) to comply with relevant laws, regulations, ING Bank policies and standards as in ING Bank Business Principles; and

 

 

Business risk: the exposure to value loss due to fluctuations in volumes, margins and costs, as well as client behaviour risk. These fluctuations can occur because of internal, industry, or wider market factors. It is the risk inherent to strategy decisions and internal efficiency, and as such strategic risk is included in business risk.

 

F-154


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Bank Risk Appetite Framework

ING Bank uses an integrated risk management approach for its banking activities. The MBB uses the risk appetite frameworks to monitor and manage the actual risk profile in relation to the risk appetite, which is derived from ING Bank rating ambition to be in the range of AA rating. It enables the MBB to identify possible risk concentrations and to support strategic decision making. The risk appetite level is reported to the MBB on a quarterly basis and is subsequently presented to the Risk Committee. The overall risk appetite is translated into specific limits which are cascaded down into the organisation, e.g.

 

 

Credit risk limits;

 

 

ALM/Value at Risk limits; and

 

 

Liquidity risk limits.

ING Bank’s ‘three lines of defence’ governance framework ensures that risk is managed in line with the risk appetite as defined by the MBB and cascaded throughout the Bank, thereby safeguarding controlled risk taking. The role of the business lines is to maximise the value within established risk boundaries. Each quarter, the MBB monitors that the financial and non-financial risks are within the boundaries of the risk appetite as set in the strategic planning process.

ING Bank is engaged in selling a broad range of products, from which financial risks arise managed by the Credit and Market Risk departments. Operational (non-financial) risks are managed by the Operational Risk department.

Financial Risks

For financial risks, ING Bank expresses its risk appetite as the tolerance to allow key capital ratios to deviate from their target levels. Therefore, the risk appetite is closely aligned to Capital Management activities and policies.

ING Bank has expressed tolerances for its risk weighted solvency metrics (core tier 1 ratio), for non-risk weighted solvency metrics (leverage ratio) and for more value based metrics (economic capital).

The metrics that are presented in the following sections relate to each of these metrics and present earnings sensitivity, economic and regulatory capital.

Due to the way the risk departments are organised, these metrics are presented at a higher aggregation level than the identified segments in Note 51 ‘Operating Segments’:

 

 

Retail Banking Benelux contains Retail Netherlands, Retail Belgium (including Retail Luxemburg);

 

 

Retail Banking Direct & International contains Retail Central Europe, Retail Asia and ING Direct;

 

 

Commercial Banking corresponds to Commercial Banking (including ING Real Estate); and

 

 

Bank Corporate Line coincides with the Corporate Line.

Non-Financial Risks

Policy implementation

To ensure robust non-financial risk management, ING Bank monitors the implementation of ING Bank’s Risk Policies and Minimum Standards. Business units have to demonstrate that the appropriate steps have been taken to control their operational, compliance and legal risks. ING Bank applies scorecards to measure the quality of the internal controls within a business unit. Scoring is based on the ability to demonstrate that the required risk management processes are in place and effective within the business units.

Non-financial Risk Dashboard

The Non-Financial Risk Dashboard (NFRD) is a report that is a fixed item on the agenda for the meetings of the MBB and the Risk Committee. NFRD provides management at all organisational levels with information on their key operational, compliance and legal Risks. NFRD is based on their risk tolerance within their business and a clear description of the risks and responses enabling management to prioritise and to manage operational, compliance and legal risks.

ING BANK ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Model Disclosure

This model disclosure section explains the methodologies and models used to determine Economic Capital (EC) the disclosed metrics. The risk models for the EC calculations are reviewed on a periodic basis and validated by the internal Model Validation department. The Economic Capital calculation is also used as part of the Basel II Pillar 2 Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) and the Supervisory Review and Evaluation Process (SREP) that is performed regularly by the Dutch Central Bank.

 

F-155


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Economic Capital is defined as the amount of capital that a transaction or business unit requires in order to support the economic risks it takes. In general EC is measured as the unexpected loss above the expected loss at a given confidence level. This Economic Capital definition is in line with the net market value (or surplus) definition. The process of EC modelling enables ING Bank to allocate Economic Capital to the business units and support risk-adjusted performance measurement (RAROC). The use of RAROC increases focus on risks versus rewards in the decision making process, and consequently stimulates the use of scarce capital in the most efficient way.

The following fundamental principles and definitions have been established for the model:

 

 

ING Bank uses a one-sided confidence level of 99.95% - consistent with ING’s target debt rating (AA) - and a one-year time horizon to calculate EC;

 

 

It is assumed that all currently known measurable sources of risk are included;

 

 

The best estimate risk assumptions are as objective as possible and based on proper analysis of statistical data. There is one set of best-estimate assumptions for each risk type to be used at ING Bank;

 

 

The EC calculation is based on fair value principles. Where complete and efficient markets exist, fair value is equal to market value;

 

 

The EC calculations reflect known embedded options and the influence of client behaviour in banking products;

 

 

The EC calculations are on a pre-tax basis and do not consider the effect of regulatory accounting and solvency requirements on capital levels; and

 

 

The framework does not include any franchise value of the business, discretionary management intervention or future business volumes and margins.

Specific measurement by risk type is described in greater detail in the separate risk type sections.

Aggregation model

The main processes executed in ING Bank Economic Capital aggregation model are depicted in the flowchart below. The white boxes show the processes performed by the model while the shaded box indicates inputs from other risk departments.

LOGO

Correlation factors between risk types used for diversification are based on best estimate assumptions supported by statistical analysis of historical data, ING Bank risk expert judgement, external benchmark studies and common logic. As shown in the flow-chart, the correlation factors are stressed upwards where necessary to account for potential measurement inaccuracy in extreme events due to limited historic data observations. Expert opinion is used for aggregating business and operational risk.

The Economic Capital for ING Bank involves the aggregation of the underlying EC of five risk types, namely credit, transfer, market, operational and business risks. Model disclosures are given in the respective risk sections. These risk types are aggregated to provide a total diversified ING Bank Economic Capital by applying the variance-covariance approach with a 5 x 5 inter-risk correlation matrix.

For allocation of Economic Capital to units and products, diversification factors are calculated for each risk type. These factors are applied consistently throughout ING Bank. The level of diversification benefit is dependent on both the inter-risk correlations as well as the relative size of the undiversified EC exposure for each risk type.

 

F-156


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Reporting Framework

For each business unit and product line, the gross Economic Capital for each risk type is delivered. The net Economic Capital figures are calculated by taking the product of the gross EC and one minus the diversification factor. Total Economic Capital is calculated as the sum of the net EC for each risk type at all reporting levels.

ING Bank Economic Capital and Regulatory Capital

Main risk management tools for ING Bank are Economic Capital (EC) and Regulatory Capital (RC). Both of these Capital metrics are used to determine the amount of capital that a transaction or business unit requires to support the economic risks it faces. RC is driven by methodologies prescribed by regulators whereas EC is driven by internally developed models (all of which are approved by the Dutch Central Bank).

Economic capital is a non accounting measure which is inherently subject to dynamic changes and updates as a result of ING Bank’s portfolio mix and general market developments. ING Bank has been and will continue recalibrating the underlying assumptions to its economic capital models, which may have a material impact on the economic capital values going forward.

The tables below provide ING Bank’s Economic Capital and Regulatory Capital by risk type and business line. The EC figures shown reflect all diversification effects within ING Bank, including risk reduction between the risk categories; while for RC no diversification is taken into account. In 2010, Credit Risk Regulatory Capital still included Transfer Risk for an amount of EUR 202 million. Economic Capital is including Transfer Risk both in 2011 and 2010.

Economic and Regulatory Capital (Bank diversified only) by risk type

 

     Economic Capital      Regulatory Capital  
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Credit risk

     14,365         15,245         22,474         22,452   

Market risk

     8,262         7,233         1,124         364   

Business Risk

     2,448         2,435         

Operational Risk

     1,683         1,619         2,836         2,872   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total banking operations

     26,758         26,532         26,434         25,688   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Economic Capital (Bank diversified only) by business line combination

 

     Economic Capital      Regulatory Capital  
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Commercial Banking

     9,726         10,695         11,615         11,395   

Retail Banking Benelux

     4,445         4,613         5,552         5,498   

Retail Banking Direct & International

     9,475         8,881         8,783         8,587   

Corporate Line Bank (1)

     3,112         2,343         484         208   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total banking operations

     26,758         26,532         26,434         25,688   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Corporate Line includes funding activities at ING Bank level, internal transactions between business units and the Corporate Line, and is managed by Capital Management.

Differences between RC and EC are mainly due to:

 

 

The credit risk EC is lower than RC. Economic Capital (EC) is defined as ING’s own methodology for credit risk. It is the amount of capital that is needed at a minimum to cover for Unexpected Losses within a certain confidence level and a certain time horizon;

 

 

The market risk Economic Capital is higher than the Regulatory Capital primarily due to the inclusion of the interest rate risk banking books in Economic Capital. The market risk RC includes a stressed VaR charge, while EC does not; the EC figures take the diversification across risk types into account;

 

 

The EC figures include Business risk, while RC does not ; and

 

 

A 99.95% confidence level is used for EC, while the confidence level is 99.9% for RC. Correcting for the difference in confidence level will lead to an EC figure that is lower than the RC figure.

Excluding ING Direct USA, the total EC would be EUR 25 billion and the total RC would be EUR 24.2 billion. The above risk metrics and risk appetite framework do not cover liquidity risk: the risk that ING Bank or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner, when they come due. ING Bank has a separate liquidity management framework in place to manage this risk, which is described in the Liquidity Risk section of ING Bank. In 2011 the funding and liquidity risk statements have been updated.

 

F-157


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ONGOING CHANGES IN THE REGULATORY ENVIRONMENT

After the turmoil in the financial markets over the last couple of years and the need for governments to provide aid to financial institutions, financial institutions have been under more scrutiny from the public, supervisors and regulators. The resulting revised regulations are intended to ensure that a crisis in the financial system can be avoided in the future. To accomplish this, regulations focus primarily at the following issues:

 

 

More stringently aligning risk taking with the capital position of financial institutions (Basel III proposal). The Basel III proposal narrows the definition of core Tier 1 and Tier 1 capital, and introduces a new definition for a leverage ratio that should become part of Pillar 1 of the Basel framework. The Basel Committee has also issued a proposal for new liquidity requirements.

Apart from the above mentioned proposals, another aim is to reduce ‘pro-cyclicality’, to avoid that banks would be required to increase their capital in difficult financial times when it is most scarce. Lastly, there is a proposal to introduce additional capital requirements for counterparty credit risk. In addition, the Basel Committee and Financial Stability Board (FSB) are currently considering measures that may have the effect of requiring higher loss absorbency capacity, liquidity surcharges, exposure limits and special resolution regimes for “systemically important financial institutions” (SIFIs) and so-called “Global” SIFIs (G-SIFI). The deadlines for implementation of specific item are set for the timeframe 2013 to 2018.

 

 

Separate from but in line with the Basel III proposal, on a country level local regulators are becoming more stringent on the maximum credit risk bank subsidiaries and branches are allowed to have on their holding companies. In the absence of a supranational harmonisation this leads to so-called trapped pools of liquidity, i.e. excess liquidity in a country that can not merely be transferred (unsecured) to a central treasury in another country.

ING BANK CREDIT RISK

ING Bank Credit Risk Management

Credit risk is the risk of loss from default by debtors (including bond issuers) or trading counterparties. Credit risks are split into five principal risk categories: a) lending (including guarantees and letters of credit); b) investments; c) pre-settlement (derivatives, securities financing and foreign exchange trades); d) money markets and e) settlement. Additionally a sixth category is determined: country risk, which can include or relate to the earlier mentioned other five risk categories.

Governance

Credit Risk Management (CRM) is responsible for the measurement and management of credit risk incurred by all ING Bank entities, including country-related risks. CRM is organised along the business lines of ING Bank. The CRM General Manager is functionally responsible for the global network of credit risk staff, and the heads of the credit risk management functions for the business lines report directly to him.

Credit risk management is supported by dedicated credit risk information systems and internal credit risk measurement methodologies for debtors, issuers and counterparties. CRM creates consistency throughout the credit risk organisation by providing common credit risk policies, methodologies, manuals and tools across the Bank.

ING Bank’s credit policy is to maintain an internationally diversified loan and bond portfolio, while avoiding large risk concentrations. The emphasis is on managing business developments within the business lines by means of top-down concentration limits for countries, individual borrowers and borrower groups. The aim within the banking sector is to expand relationship-banking activities, while maintaining stringent internal risk/return guidelines and controls.

Credit analysis is risk/reward-oriented in that the level of credit analysis is a function of the risk amount, tenor, structure (e.g. covers received) of the facility, and the risks entered into. For credit risk management purposes, financial obligations are classified into lending, investments, pre-settlement, money market and settlement. Sophisticated RAROC-based tools are used internally to ensure a proper balance of risk and reward within the portfolio and concentration parameters. ING Bank’s credit analysts make use of publicly available information in combination with in-house analysis based on information provided by the customer, peer group comparisons, industry comparisons and other quantitative techniques.

 

F-158


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Credit Risk Measurement and Reporting

Figures associated with Money Market and Lending activities are generally the nominal amounts, while amounts associated with Investment activities are based on the original amount invested less repayments. Off-Balance Sheet exposures include the letters of credits and guarantees, which are associated with the Lending Risk Category. Additionally, Off-Balance Sheet exposures include a portion of the unused limits, associated with the statistically expected use of the unused portion of the limit between the moment of measurement and the theoretical moment of statistical default. Collectively, these amounts are called ‘credit risk outstandings’.

Exposures associated with Securitisations (Asset Backed Financing, Commercial/Residential Mortgage Backed Securities and Covered Bonds) are shown separately. These amounts also relate to the amount invested prior to any impairment activity or mark-to-market adjustments. This amount is also considered to be ‘outstandings’.

For the banking operations, ING Bank uses various market pricing and measurement techniques to determine the amount of credit risk on pre-settlement activities. These techniques estimate ING Bank’s potential future exposure on individual and portfolios of trades. Master agreements and collateral agreements are frequently entered into to reduce these credit risks.

Model Disclosure: ING Bank Economic Capital for Credit and Transfer Risk

Economic Capital for credit risk and for transfer risk is the portion of Economic Capital held to withstand unexpected losses inherent in the credit portfolios related to (unexpected) changes in the underlying creditworthiness of debtors or the recovery value of underlying collateral (if any). Credit risk and transfer risk capital are calculated on all portfolios which contain credit or transfer risk, including investment portfolios.

Economic Capital for credit risk and for transfer risk are calculated using internally developed models with a 99.95% confidence level and a time horizon of one year, which represents ING’s desired credit rating. ING Bank uses a series of credit risk models that can be grouped into three principal categories: Probability of Default (PD) models, which measure the standalone creditworthiness of individual debtors; Exposure at Default models (EAD) which estimate the size of the financial obligation at the moment of default in the future; and Loss Given Default Models (LGD), which estimate the recovery value of the underlying collateral or guarantees received (if any) and the unsecured part. Collectively, ING Bank uses over 100 models for credit risk. The various models can be grouped into three categories: statistical, expert and hybrid.

The Economic Capital formula for credit and transfer risks relies on seven different risk drivers. In addition to the PD, EAD, and LGD models mentioned above, the formula also considers the industry and the country of the debtor as well as the remaining term of the respective underlying transactions. Lastly, the formula considers correlation of different asset class types.

The underlying formulas and models that are used for determining Economic Capital for credit and transfer risk are similar to those used for determining the level of regulatory capital that is required under Basel II (Pillar 1). Despite the fact that the same underlying formulas are used, (internal) Economic Capital and regulatory capital are not the same, due to various specific rules imposed by Basel II, such as regulatory caps and floors, and the use of the standardised approach for certain portions of ING Bank’s portfolio. These differences are permitted under the Basel II guidelines.

The table below summarises different capital measures used for different purposes and shows the difference in key elements and purposes.

 

F-159


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

Credit Risk Capital

Measurements

 

Methodology

 

Location

 

Confidence level

 

Inputs

 

Purpose

Regulatory Capital

 

Basel II Formula

 

Vortex Basel Engine (‘VBE’) in the Central Risk Database

 

99.90%

 

Basel II model outputs

 

RWA

Economic Capital

 

Risk Adjusted Capital (RAC) Closed Algebraic Formula

 

Vortex Risk Engine (‘VRE’) in the Central Risk Database

 

99.95%

 

Basel II model outputs excluding Basel II caps and floors, maturity, repayment schedules, correlation factors, migration matrix.

 

Pricing, Economic Capital for credit at transactional level and above

Economic Capital levels for credit and transfer risk are calculated regularly for most of the Commercial Bank, ING Retail Benelux, and the Retail Direct & International banking operations. On a quarterly basis, the Economic Capital for credit risk and transfer risk figures are consolidated with the corresponding Economic Capital components from other disciplines.

Economic and Regulatory Capital (Bank diversified only) by risk type

 

     Economic Capital      Regulatory Capital  
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Credit risk

     14,365         15,245         22,473         22,452   

Governance of Economic Capital for Credit and Transfer Risk

All PD, EAD and LGD models are approved by the Credit Risk Committee (CRC) after thorough review of documentation by the Model Development Committee (MDC) and Model Validation (MV). In addition, each model is validated on an annual basis by MV. Each model has both a credit risk and a front office co-sponsor. Both the MDC and the CRC have participation from both credit risk officers as well as the front office to ensure maximum acceptance by the organisation.

ING Bank Risk categories for credit risk

Lending risk

Lending risk arises when ING Bank grants a loan to a customer, or issues guarantees on behalf of a customer. This is the most common risk category, and includes term loans, mortgages, revolving credits, overdrafts, guarantees, letters of credit, etc. The risk is measured at the notional amount of the financial obligation that the customer has to repay to ING Bank, excluding any accrued and unpaid interest, discount/premium amortisations or impairments.

Investment risk

Investment risk is the credit default and risk rating migration risk that is associated with ING Bank’s investments in bonds, commercial paper, securitisations, and other similar publicly traded securities. Investment risk arises when ING Bank purchases a (synthetic) bond with the intent to hold the bond for a longer period of time (generally through maturity). Bonds that are purchased with the intent to re-sell in a short period of time are considered to be trading risks, which are measured and monitored by the Market Risk Management department. For credit risk purposes, Investment risk is measured at original cost (purchase price) less any prepayments or amortisations and excluding any accrued and unpaid interest or the effects of any impairment.

Money market risk

Money market risk arises when ING Bank places short-term deposits with a counterparty in order to manage excess liquidity, as such, money market deposits tend to be short-term in nature (1-7 days is common). In the event of a counterparty default, ING Bank may lose the deposit placed. Money market risk is therefore measured simply as the notional value of the deposit, excluding any accrued and unpaid interest or the effect of any impairment.

 

F-160


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Pre-settlement risk

Pre-settlement risk arises when a counterparty defaults on a transaction before settlement and ING Bank has to replace the contract by a trade with another counterparty at the then prevailing (possibly unfavourable) market price. The pre-settlement risk (potential or expected risk) is the cost of ING Bank replacing a trade in the market. This credit risk category is associated with dealing room products such as options, swaps, and securities financing transactions. Where there is a mutual exchange of value, the amount of credit risk outstanding is generally based on the replacement value (mark-to-market) plus a potential future volatility concept, using a 3-7 year historical time horizon and a 97.5% (1.96 standard deviations) confidence level.

Settlement risk

Settlement risk arises when there is an exchange of value (funds, instruments or commodities) for the same or different value dates and receipt is not verified or expected until ING Bank has paid or delivered its side of the trade. The risk is that ING Bank delivers, but does not receive delivery from the counterparty. Settlement risk can most commonly be contained and reduced by entering into transactions with delivery-versus-payment (DVP) settlement methods, as is common with most clearing houses, or settlement netting agreements.

For those transactions where DVP settlement is not possible, ING Bank establishes settlement limits through the credit approval process. Settlement risk is then monitored and managed by the credit risk management units. Risk is further mitigated by operational procedures requiring trade confirmations to counterparties with all transaction details, and by entering into internationally accepted documentation, such as International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) Master Agreements for derivative transactions. Additionally, ING Bank regularly participates in projects with other financial institutions to improve and develop new clearing systems and clearing mechanisms to further reduce the level of settlement risk. Due to the very short-term nature of settlement exposure (daily or intra-day), settlement risks do not attract economic or regulatory capital and are excluded from risk reporting disclosures.

Country risk

Country risk is the risk specifically attributable to events in a specific country (or group of countries). It can occur within each of the five above described risk categories. All transactions and trading positions generated by ING Bank include country risk which is further divided into economic and transfer risk. Economic risk is the concentration risk relating to any event in the risk country which may affect transactions and any other exposure in that country, regardless of the currency. Transfer risk is the risk incurred through the inability of ING Bank or its counterparties to meet their respective foreign currency obligations due to a specific country event.

In countries where ING Bank is active, the relevant country’s risk profile is regularly evaluated, resulting in a country rating. Country limits are based on this rating and ING Bank’s risk appetite. Exposures derived from lending, investment pre-settlement and money market activities are then measured and reported against these country limits on a daily basis. Country risk limits are assigned for transfer risk mainly for emerging markets.

Credit Risk Mitigation

As with all financial institutions and banks in particular, ING Bank is in the business of taking credit risks in an informed and measured fashion. As such, the creditworthiness of our customers, trading partners and investments is continually evaluated for their ability to meet their financial obligations to ING Bank. ING Bank uses different credit risk mitigation techniques, of which entering into Master Agreements, Collateral Agreements and CDS contracts are the main techniques used.

Compensation and master agreements

ING Bank uses various market pricing and measurement techniques to determine the amount of credit risk on pre-settlement activities. These techniques estimate ING Bank’s potential future exposure on individual and portfolios of trades. Master agreements and collateral agreements are frequently entered into to reduce these credit risks.

ING Bank matches trades with similar characteristics to determine their eligibility for offsetting. This offsetting effect is called ‘compensation’. Subsequently, ING Bank reduces the amount by any legal netting that may be permitted under various types of Master Agreements, such as ISDAs, GMRAs, GMSLAs, etc. Lastly, the amount is further reduced by any collateral that is held by ING Bank under CSAs or other similar agreements.

 

F-161


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Collateral policies

During the assessment process of creating new loans, trading limits, or making investments, as well as reviewing existing loans trading positions and investments, ING Bank determines the amount and type of collateral, if any, that a customer may be required to pledge to ING Bank. Generally, the lower the perceived creditworthiness of a borrower or financial counterparty, the more collateral the customer or counterparty will have to provide. Within counterparty trading activities, ING Bank actively enters into various legal arrangements whereby ING Bank and/or counterparties may have to post collateral to one another to cover market fluctuations of their relative positions. Laws in various jurisdictions also affect the type and amount of collateral that ING Bank can receive or pledge. The type of collateral which is held as security is determined by the structure of the loan or position. Consequently, since ING Bank’s portfolio is diversified, the profile of collateral it receives is also diversified in nature and does not reflect any particular collateral type more than others.

As part of its securities financing business, ING Bank entities actively enter into agreements to sell and buy back marketable securities. These transactions can take many legal forms. Repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, buy/sellback and sell/buyback agreements, and securities borrowing and lending agreements are the most common. The amount of marketable securities that ING Bank held as collateral under these types of agreements was EUR 74.0 billion at December 31, 2011 and EUR 92.0 billion at December 31, 2010. The decrease is commensurate with the overall decrease in open securities financing trades at year end 2011 compared to year end 2010. These amounts exclude the cash leg of the respective transactions, as well as any pledges of securities under Tri-Party agreements (as the underlying is not directly pledged to or owned by ING Bank). As a general rule, the marketable securities that have been received under these transactions are eligible to be resold or repledged in other (similar) transactions. ING Bank is obliged to return equivalent securities in such cases.

Repossession policy

It is ING Bank’s general policy not to take possession of assets of defaulted debtors. Rather, ING Bank attempts to sell the assets from within the legal entity that has pledged these assets to ING Bank, in accordance with the respective collateral or pledge agreements signed with the obligors. In those cases where ING Bank does take possession of the collateral, ING Bank generally attempts to sell the assets as quickly as possible to prospective buyers. Based on internal assessments to determine the highest and quickest return for ING Bank, the sale of repossessed assets could be the sale of the obligor’s business as a whole (or at least all of its assets), or the assets could be sold piecemeal. With regard to the various mortgage portfolios, ING Bank often has to take possession of the underlying collateral but also tries to reduce the amount of time until resale.

ING Bank Credit Risk Profile

ING Bank’s credit exposure is mainly related to traditional lending to individuals and businesses followed by investments in bonds and other securitised assets. Loans to individuals are mainly mortgage loans secured by residential property. Loans (including guarantees issued) to businesses are often collateralised, but can be unsecured based on internal analysis of the borrowers’ creditworthiness. Bonds in the investment portfolio are generally unsecured. Securitised assets such as Mortgage Backed Securities and Asset Backed Securities are secured by the pro rata portion of the underlying diversified pool of assets (commercial or residential mortgages, car loans and/or other assets) held by the security’s issuer. The last major credit risk source involves pre-settlement exposures which arise from trading activities, including derivatives, repurchase transactions and securities lending/borrowing and foreign exchange transactions.

Credit quality: ING Bank portfolio, outstandings

 

     2011      2010  

Neither past due nor impaired

     849,283         822,445   

Past due but not impaired (1-90 days) (1)

     6,649         5,638   

Impaired (2)

     13,382         13,779   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     869,314         841,862   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Based on lending (consumer loans and residential mortgages only).

(2)

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending and investment activities.

Risk classes

Risk classes are defined based upon the quality of the exposures in terms of creditworthiness, varying from investment grade to problem grade expressed in S&P equivalents.

 

F-162


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk classes ING Bank portfolio, as % of total outstandings (1)

 

         Commercial
Banking
    Retail Banking
Benelux
   

Retail Banking

Direct &

International (2)

    Total ING Bank  
         2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  
1  

(AAA)

     3.0     3.0     0.0     0.0     9.6     14.4     4.5     6.3
2-4  

(AA)

     19.4     14.3     4.2     4.0     16.0     12.1     13.8     10.6
5-7  

(A)

     20.2     24.0     5.1     5.3     17.8     18.8     15.0     16.8
8-10  

(BBB)

     23.7     22.9     42.8     42.0     29.3     28.9     31.3     30.4
11-13  

(BB)

     21.9     22.8     37.3     37.7     15.9     15.5     24.1     24.4
14-16  

(B)

     8.1     8.8     5.4     6.2     8.0     7.2     7.3     7.5
17-22  

(CCC & Problem Grade)

     3.7     4.2     5.2     4.8     3.4     3.1     4.0     4.0
    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
       100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0
    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending, pre-settlement, money market and investment activities.

The ratings reflect probabilities of default and do not take collateral into consideration.

 

(2) 

Covered bonds are presented on the basis of the external credit rating of the issuer in question. Covered bond issues generally possess a better external credit rating than the issuer standalone, given structural features of such covered bonds.

Within the Lending portfolio, there was an upward shift from the highest end investment grade in 2011 as a result of increased outstandings to local German governments. In the Investment portfolio we saw a reversed trend, from AAA to AA, mainly the result of downgraded exposures linked to sovereigns and also driven by the US dollar appreciation. The investment grade counterparty risks (pre-settlement) did not materially change. Related to these counterparties risks are increasing applications of collateral and netting agreements with these counterparties. Where such agreements are in place the credit risks are lowered due to the benefit of collateral and netting agreements. The increase in the AA bucket for Money Market is directly related to deposits given to central banks.

Risk classes ING Bank portfolio per credit risk type, as % of total outstandings (1)

 

         Lending     Investment     Money Market     Pre-settlement     Total ING Bank  
         2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  
1  

(AAA)

     1.6     0.8     18.9     30.8     1.4     1.2     2.9     3.5     4.5     6.3
2-4  

(AA)

     5.2     6.0     38.3     25.0     71.6     22.0     17.0     18.2     13.8     10.6
5-7  

(A)

     9.4     9.5     23.9     27.1     19.3     62.3     50.9     50.8     15.0     16.8
8-10  

(BBB)

     37.8     36.9     13.3     12.5     2.7     6.8     18.5     17.2     31.3     30.4
11-13  

(BB)

     31.5     32.0     2.2     2.0     4.9     7.4     8.2     7.3     24.1     24.4
14-16  

(B)

     9.7     9.9     0.4     0.6     0.1     0.1     1.7     1.8     7.3     7.5
17-22  

(CCC & Problem Grade)

     4.8     4.9     3.0     2.0     0.0     0.2     0.8     1.2     4.0     4.0
    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
       100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0
    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending, pre-settlement, money market and investment activities.

The ratings reflect probabilities of default and do not take collateral into consideration.

Risk concentration

As part of the focus on core clients, ING Bank further reduced its relative exposure to governments and the financial sector while growing the private individual and corporate portfolios. The industry Central Banks was above the threshold of 2.0% in 2011, as a result of the deposits given to various central banks.

 

F-163


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk concentration: ING Bank portfolio, by economic sector (1)(2)

 

     Commercial
Banking
    Retail Banking
Benelux
   

Retail Banking

Direct &

International

    Total ING Bank  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Private Individuals

     0.0     0.1     75.3     74.8     55.1     51.6     41.3     40.0

Commercial Banks

     16.2     17.9     0.2     0.3     11.1     13.2     9.8     11.2

Non-Bank Financial Institutions

     10.7     13.3     1.1     1.2     14.5     16.8     9.4     11.1

Central Governments

     10.7     11.7     0.9     1.0     6.6     8.0     6.5     7.3

Real Estate

     13.0     13.6     4.5     4.5     0.9     0.9     6.2     6.4

Central Banks

     9.6     4.0     0.1     0.1     3.3     1.2     4.6     1.8

Natural Resources

     10.9     10.3     0.4     0.4     0.4     0.4     4.1     3.9

Transportation & Logistics

     5.9     5.7     1.3     1.4     0.2     0.2     2.5     2.5

Services

     3.3     3.3     3.3     3.3     0.3     0.3     2.2     2.2

Lower Public Administration

     0.4     0.5     1.4     1.3     4.4     4.3     2.1     2.1

Other

     19.3     19.6     11.5     11.7     3.2     3.1     11.3     11.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on the total amount of credit risk in the respective column using ING Bank’s internal credit risk measurement methodologies.

(2) 

Economic sectors below 2% are not shown separately but grouped in Other.

ING Bank Lending portfolio

The largest relative geographic area of growth was Belgium, especially in the residential mortgage portfolio. The Americas was the second region in terms of growth which corresponds with the region’s economic recovery in 2011. Exchange rate effects had further impact on the regional division.

In line with ING Bank’s de-risking strategy, the portfolio developments in most countries mirrored the developments in the portfolio as a whole. The depreciated Euro versus the Australian, Canadian and the US dollar had an upward effect of the exposure to the Americas and Asia/Pacific and therewith also to the Retail Banking Direct and International and Commercial Banking portfolios. Excluding ING Direct USA, Retail Banking Direct and International showed a marginal increase, mainly as the result of currency effects.

Largest economic exposures: ING Bank lending portfolio, by geographic area (1)

 

     Commercial
Banking
    Retail Banking
Benelux
   

Retail Banking

Direct &

International

    Total ING Bank  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Netherlands

     21.3     20.7     73.8     74.8     3.5     4.8     30.7     31.2

Belgium

     8.0     7.7     24.3     23.2     0.3     0.2     10.2     9.6

Rest of Europe

     44.1     45.2     1.2     1.3     53.3     53.3     34.4     35.0

Americas

     14.9     14.8     0.2     0.2     27.6     26.4     15.1     14.6

Asia/Pacific

     11.2     11.2     0.1     0.1     15.3     15.3     9.3     9.4

Rest of World

     0.5     0.4     0.4     0.4     0.0     0.0     0.3     0.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0     100.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Geographic areas are based on the country of residence of the obligor.

Credit Covers

At ING Bank, cover is a term which is defined as any security, lien, mortgage, or collateral interest in an asset or guarantee, indemnification or undertaking received (either by contract and/or by law) that is intended to reduce the losses incurred subsequent to an event of default on an obligation (usually financial in nature) a customer may have towards ING Bank. Within ING Bank, covers are subdivided into two distinct groups, called collateral and promises. Reference is made to credit risk management classification as included in the accounting policies for the consolidated annual accounts for a reconciliation between credit risk outstandings categories and financial assets.

Collateral

Collateral is a security interest in assets. If the customer defaults on its promised performance, the asset is given as collateral or security for that obligation is liquidated, such that the proceeds can be applied towards full or partial compensation of the pledgor’s (financial) obligation to ING Bank. Assets have monetary value and are generally owned by the person or organisation, which gives them as collateral to ING Bank. An asset may be tangible, like plant & machinery, buildings, bonds, receivables etc. or intangible like patents, copyrights and trademarks.

 

F-164


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In the table below the residential mortgage portfolio and the mortgage collateral amount are shown. Please note that the figures shown are based on credit collateral amounts, meaning the market values of these properties after haircuts.

Promises

Promises are defined as a legally binding declaration by persons or organisations that give ING Bank the right to expect and claim from those persons or organisations if ING Bank’s customer fails on its obligations to ING Bank. Common examples are guarantees received and letters of credit.

The following tables show the credit risk outstandings and cover values per line of business: Retail Banking (comprising both Benelux, Direct & International) and Commercial Banking. Outstandings for Retail Banking are reported for the most relevant retail product being Residential Mortgages while the remaining outstandings are classified as Other Lending.

Outstandings for Commercial Banking are reported for the most relevant categories being Financial Institutions, Corporates and Governments, while the remaining outstandings are classified as Other. Credit risk outstandings are inclusive of both on balance and off balance sheet outstandings, and of all risk categories.

For each product or category, the cover amounts are then reported for the most relevant collateral categories being Mortgages and Cash, and for the most relevant Promises category being Guarantees. The remaining collaterals and promises are included in the category Other.

Performing Assets – Cover values***** including guarantees received**

 

            December 31, 2011  
     Outstandings*      Mortgages***      Cash      Guarantees**      Other      Total Credit
Covers ****
 

Retail

                 

Residential Mortgages

     336,876         538,692                  538,692   

Other Lending

     13,529         3,104                  3,104   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Retail

     350,405         541,796                  541,796   

Commercial

                 

Financial Institutions

     162,590         3,421         1,331         9,982         3,281         18,015   

Corporates

     225,848         73,916         4,819         21,642         54,161         154,538   

Governments

     75,762         89         12         3,365         1,373         4,839   

Other

     41,327         4,274         61         63         242         4,640   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commercial

     505,527         81,700         6,223         35,052         59,057         182,032   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     855,932         623,496         6,223         35,052         59,057         723,828   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-165


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Performing Assets – Cover values***** including guarantees received**

 

            December 31, 2010  
     Outstandings*      Mortgages***      Cash      Guarantees**      Other      Total Credit
Covers ****
 

Retail

                 

Residential Mortgages

     315,226         523,195                  523,195   

Other Lending

     12,439         2,787                  2,787   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Retail

     327,665         525,982                  525,982   

Commercial

                 

Financial Institutions

     157,834         4,199         1,119         8,174         3,962         17,454   

Corporates

     218,554         67,796         4,106         26,490         45,094         143,486   

Governments

     80,087         62         2         3,401         1,571         5,036   

Other

     43,943         3,310         65         102         497         3,974   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commercial

     500,418         75,367         5,292         38,167         51,124         169,950   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     828,083         601,349         5,292         38,167         51,124         695,932   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

*

Excluding intercompany positions

**

Guarantees received can be additional to pledges and not necessarily replace covers

***

The used valuations methods for the underlying covers may vary per cover

****

Credit covers are the sum of all existing covers. Excess cover amounts on specific loans cannot be put in place for loans without covers. Therefore, the figures shown in the table should not be used for netting calculation purposes

The cover tables show a break down of ING Bank’s retail and commercial portfolios. The Residential Mortgages portfolio relates to private individuals. The growth in this portfolio was mainly driven by United Kingdom, Germany and Belgium. The Financial Institutions portfolio is comprised of commercial banks, central banks and non-bank financial institutions. The increase in this portfolio was mainly driven by The Netherlands. Corporates range from large enterprises to small and medium sized companies. Governments consist of all governmental layers, from local to national.

Loan-to-Value (LTV)

The LTV ratio relates the total loan amount to the market value of the collateral. The market value is the registered value as adopted from the valuation report of a qualified appraiser or valuer. ING Bank has a team of specialists for the valuation of real estate, which is supplemented with external and desk top valuation. In some countries residential mortgages are covered by governmental or commercial insurers. For example the Nationale Hypotheek Garantie (NHG) in The Netherlands, which guarantees the repayment of a loan in case of a forced property sale. The LTV in The Netherlands is relatively high, but is partially compensated by the NHG guaranteed portfolio and other secondary covers, such as life insurance policies, savings and investment products. The average LTV in the Netherlands is 81% (2010: 80%).

When available, indexation is applied to revaluate the collateral to the present value. In the LTV calculation the following property covers are included: residential and industrial/commercial properties, land and applicable other fixed assets. All other covers are excluded. The ING Bank’s total residential mortgage portfolio amounts to EUR 341 billion, making up 39% of the ING Bank’s total credit risk outstandings. The average Loan to Value (LTV) of the total residential mortgage portfolio amounts to 75% (2010: 74%).

Problem loans

Past-due obligations

ING Bank continually measures its portfolio in terms of payment arrears. Particularly the retail portfolios are closely monitored on a monthly basis to determine if there are any significant changes in the level of arrears. Generally, an obligation is considered ‘past-due’ if a payment of interest or principal is more than one day late. In practice, the first 5-7 days after an obligation becomes past due are considered to be operational in nature for retail loans and small businesses portfolios. After this period, letters are sent to the obligor reminding the obligor of its (past due) payment obligations. If the arrear still exists after 90 days, the obligation is transferred to one of the ‘problem loan’ units. In order to reduce the number of arrears, ING banking units encourage their obligors to set up automatic debits from their (current) accounts to ensure timely payments.

 

F-166


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Aging analysis (past due but not impaired): ING Bank portfolio, outstandings (1)(2)

 

     2011      2010  

Past due for 1-30 days

     5,455         4,565   

Past due for 31-60 days

     1,111         973   

Past due for 61-90 days

     83         100   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     6,649         5,638   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on lending (consumer loans and residential mortgages only).

(2) 

The amount of past due but not impaired financial assets in respect of non-lending activities was not material.

Impaired loans and provisions

The credit portfolio is under constant review. Generally, all loans with past due financial obligations of more than 90 days are automatically reclassified as impaired. For the wholesale lending portfolios and securities obligations, there are generally reasons for declaring a loan impaired prior to being 90 days past due. These include, but are not limited to, ING Bank’s assessment of the customer’s perceived inability to meet its financial obligations, or the customer filing for bankruptcy or bankruptcy protection. In some cases, a material breach of financial covenants will also trigger a reclassification of a loan to the impaired category. ING Bank identifies as impaired loans those loans for which it is probable, based on current information and events that the principal and interest amounts contractually due will not be collected in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan agreements.

A formal analysis takes place quarterly to determine the provisions for possible bad debts, using a bottom-up approach. Conclusions are discussed by the ING Provisioning Committee (IPC) Bank, which advises the MBB on specific provisioning levels.

The table below represents the economic sector breakdown of credit risk outstandings (including impaired amounts) for loans and positions that have been classified as problem loans and for which provisions have been made.

Impaired Loans: ING Bank portfolio, outstandings by economic sector(1)

 

     2011      2010  

Private Individuals

     4,790         4,838   

Real Estate

     2,671         2,777   

General Industries

     819         858   

Transportation & Logistics

     797         818   

Food, Beverages & Personal Care

     784         837   

Builders & Contractors

     774         792   

Services

     718         582   

Non-Bank Financial Institutions

     368         527   

Other

     1,661         1,750   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     13,382         13,779   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Economic sectors below EUR 500 million in both years are not shown separately but grouped in Other.

ING Bank holds specific and collective provisions of EUR 3,040 million and EUR 1,133 million, respectively (2010: EUR 2,697 million and EUR 1,404 million respectively), representing the difference between the amortised cost of the portfolio and the estimated recoverable amount discounted at the effective rate of interest. In addition, there is EUR 777 million (2010: EUR 1,094 million) in provisions against the performing portfolio. The 2010 figures are including ING Direct USA.

 

F-167


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Provisions: ING Bank portfolio(1)

 

     Commercial
Banking
    Retail Banking
Benelux
   

Retail Banking

Direct &

International

    Total ING Bank  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     1,855        1,628        1,641        1,290        1,699        1,481        5,195        4,399   

Changes in the composition of the group

     (3               (3  

Write-offs

     (373     (337     (494     (454     (437     (375     (1,304     (1,166

Recoveries

     66        36        37        58        9        11        112        105   

Increase/(decrease) in loan loss provision

     479        497        603        721        588        533        1,670        1,751   

Exchange differences

     15        65          8        (98     82        (83     155   

Other changes

       (34     (36     18        (601     (33     (637     (49
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,039        1,855        1,751        1,641        1,160        1,699        4,950        5,195   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The 2011 figures are excluding ING Direct USA.

The risk costs development in the first half of 2011 was relatively favourable, however, since mid 2011, the economic climate deteriorated. On balance, risk costs for the full year 2011 were in line with 2010 risk costs levels.

Credit Covers Problem Assets

The table hereunder shows the cover values per credit risk category classified based on Retail and Commercial Banking products. In the ING Bank master scale which ranges from 1 being the best rating to 22 being the worst rating, Problem Assets are the Assets with ratings in the range 18-22. All other are called Performing Assets and are shown in the tables above.

Problem Assets – Cover values***** including guarantees received**

 

            December 31, 2011  
     Outstandings*      Mortgages***      Cash      Guarantees**      Other      Total Credit
Covers ****
 

Retail

                 

Residential Mortgages

     4,070         4,987                  4,987   

Other Lending

     569         145                  145   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Retail

     4,639         5,132                  5,132   

Commercial

                 

Financial Institutions

     457         63         1         51         22         137   

Corporates

     8,090         2,913         335         242         1,063         4,553   

Governments

     9                  

Other

     187         105            1         2         108   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commercial

     8,743         3,081         336         294         1,087         4,798   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     13,382         8,213         336         294         1,087         9,930   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-168


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Problem Assets – Cover values***** including guarantees received**

 

            December 31, 2010  
     Outstandings*      Mortgages***      Cash      Guarantees**      Other      Total Credit
Covers ****
 

Retail

                 

Residential Mortgages

     4,026         4,975                  4,975   

Other Lending

     671         154                  154   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Retail

     4,697         5,129                  5,129   

Commercial

                 

Financial Institutions

     366         4            56         23         83   

Corporates

     8,542         2,761         23         343         882         4,009   

Governments

     1                  

Other

     173         59            2         5         66   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commercial

     9,082         2,824         23         401         910         4,158   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     13,779         7,953         23         401         910         9,287   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

*

Excluding intercompany positions

**

Guarantees received can be additional to pledges and not necessarily replace collaterals

***

The used valuations methods for the underlying collaterals may vary per collateral

****

Credit covers are the sum of all existing covers. Excess cover amounts on specific loans cannot be put in place for loans without covers. Therefore, the figures shown in the table should not be used for netting calculation purposes

ING BANK MARKET RISK

ING Bank Market Risk Management

Market risk is the risk that movements in market variables, such as interest rates, equity prices, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads and real estate prices, negatively impact the bank’s earnings, market value or liquidity position. Market risk either arises through positions in trading books or through the banking book positions. The trading positions are held for the purpose of benefiting from short-term price movements, while the banking book positions are intended to be held in the long term (or until maturity) or for the purpose of hedging other banking book positions.

Governance

Within ING Bank, market risk (including liquidity risk) falls under the supervision of the ALCO function with ALCO Bank as the highest approval authority. ALCO Bank determines the overall risk appetite for market risk. The ALCO function is regionally organised with the exception of ING Direct, which has a separate ALCO. The business lines Retail Banking and Commercial Banking are represented within the respective regional and local ALCO’s. The ALCO structure within ING Bank facilitates top-down risk management, limit setting and the monitoring and control of market risk. This ensures a correct implementation of the ING Bank risk appetite.

The Market Risk Management department (MRM) is the designated independent department that is responsible for the design and execution of the bank’s market risk management functions in support of the ALCO function. The MRM structure recognises that risk taking and risk management to a large extent occurs at the regional/local level. Bottom-up reporting allows each management level to fully assess the market risk relevant at the respective levels.

MRM is responsible for determining adequate policies and procedures for managing market risk and for monitoring the compliance with these guidelines. An important element of the market risk management function is the assessment of market risk in new products and businesses. Furthermore MRM maintains an adequate limit framework in line with ING Bank’s risk appetite. The businesses are responsible for adhering to the limits that ultimately are approved by ALCO Bank. Limit breaches are reported to senior management on a timely basis and the business is required to take the appropriate actions to reduce the risk position.

Model Disclosure: ING Bank Economic Capital for Market Risk

Economic Capital for market risk is the Economic Capital necessary to withstand unexpected value movements due to changes in market variables. Economic Capital for market risk is calculated for exposures both in trading portfolios and non-trading portfolios and includes real estate risk, foreign exchange rate risk, equity price risk, interest rate risk and model risks. Economic capital for market risk is calculated using internally developed methodologies with a 99.95% confidence interval and a horizon of one year, which represents extreme events and ING’s target rating.

 

F-169


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the trading and most of the non-trading portfolios (including equity investments), the actual VaR (measured at a 99% confidence interval, a one day holding period and under the assumption of an expected value of zero) is taken as a starting point for the Economic Capital calculations for market risk. To arrive at the Economic Capital for market risk, a simulation based model is used which includes scaling to the required confidence interval and holding period. In determining this scaling factor, several other factors are also taken into account like the occurrence of large market movements (events) and management interventions.

Economic Capital for market risk for the mortgage portfolios within ING Retail Banking (Benelux, Direct and International Banking) and ING Commercial Banking is calculated for embedded option risk (e.g. the prepayment option and offered rate option in mortgages). The embedded options are hedged using a delta-hedging methodology, leaving the mortgage portfolio exposed to convexity and volatility risk.

Real estate price risk includes the market risks in both the investment portfolio and the development portfolio of ING Real Estate. The real estate price risk for the investment portfolio is calculated by stressing the underlying market variables. The stress scenarios at a portfolio level take into account all diversification effects across regions and real estate sectors. Also, the leverage of participations in the real estate investment funds is taken into account. For the Real Estate development process, in addition to market sale price risk, the risk drivers of market rent, investor yield and construction delays are taken into account. Furthermore the risk model differs for each development phase (i.e., research, development, and construction) to appropriately reflect the risk taken in each phase. Using correlations, all risk drivers, and stages are used to calculate a possible market value loss representing the Economic Capital for market risk for the development portfolio.

While aggregating the different Economic Capital market risk figures for the different portfolios, diversification benefits (based on stressed correlations) are taken into account as it is not expected that all extreme market movements will appear at the same moment.

The nature of market risk Economic Capital, evaluating the impact of extreme stress with a 99.95% confidence level, can sometimes be difficult to evidence in a statistical sound manner with the available historical data. The Economic Capital figures disclosed by ING Bank are a best effort estimate based on available data and expert opinions.

Economic and Regulatory Capital (Bank diversified only) by risk type

 

    

Economic

Capital (1)

     Regulatory
Capital
 
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Market risk

     8,262         7,233         1,124         364   

 

(1) 

this includes model risk

The market risk Economic Capital is higher than the Regulatory Capital primarily due to the inclusion of the interest rate risk banking books in Economic Capital. The market risk Regulatory Capital includes a stressed VaR charge, while Economic Capital does not. The main drivers for the increase in market risk Economic Capital are methodology updates. The increase in market risk Regulatory Capital is due to the new market risk framework Basel 2.5 containing an additional capital charge for Stressed VaR and Incremental Risk.

ING Bank Market Risk in Trading Books

Governance

Within the trading portfolios, positions are maintained in the professional financial markets for the purpose of benefiting from short term price movements. Market risk arises in the trading portfolios through the exposure to various market risk factors, including interest rates, equity prices, foreign exchange rates and credit spreads.

The Financial Markets Risk Committee (FMRC) is the market risk committee that, within the risk appetite set by ALCO Bank, sets market risk limits both on an aggregated level and on a desk level, and approves new products. MRM advises both the FMRC and ALCO Bank on the market risk appetite of trading activities.

 

F-170


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

With respect to the trading portfolios, MRM focuses on the management of market risks of Commercial Banking (mainly Financial Markets) as this is the only business line where trading activities take place. Trading activities include facilitation of client business, market making and proprietary position taking in cash and derivatives markets. MRM is responsible for the development and implementation of trading risk policies and risk measurement methodologies, the reporting and monitoring of risk exposures against approved trading limits and the validation of pricing models. MRM also reviews trading mandates and limits, and performs the gatekeeper role in the product review process. The management of trading market risk is performed at various organisational levels, from MRM overall down to specific business areas and trading offices.

Model Disclosure

Value at Risk

MRM uses the historical simulation Value at Risk (VaR) methodology as its primary risk measure. The VaR for market risk quantifies, with a one-sided confidence level of 99%, the maximum overnight loss that could occur due to changes in risk factors (e.g. interest rates, equity prices, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, implied volatilities) if positions remain unchanged for a time period of one day. Next to general market movements in these risk factors, VaR also takes into account market data movements for specific moves in e.g. the underlying issuer of securities. The impact of historical market movements on today’s portfolio is estimated, based on equally weighted observed market movements of the previous year. ING Bank uses VaR with a 1-day horizon for internal risk measurement, control and back testing, and VaR with a 10-day horizon for determining regulatory capital.

Limitations

VaR as a risk measure has some limitations. VaR uses historical data to forecast future price behaviour. Future price behaviour could differ substantially from past behaviour. Moreover, the use of a one-day holding period (or ten days for regulatory capital calculations) assumes that all positions in the portfolio can be liquidated or hedged in one day. In periods of illiquidity or market events, this assumption may not hold true. Also, the use of 99% confidence level means that VaR does not take into account any losses that occur beyond this confidence level. Parts of these limitations are mitigated by the Basel 2.5 regulation (Stressed VaR and Incremental Risk Charges).

Back testing

Back testing is a technique for the ongoing monitoring of the plausibility of the VaR model in use. Although VaR models estimate potential future results, estimates are based on historical market data. In a back test, the actual daily result is compared with the 1-day VaR. In addition to using actual results for back testing, ING Bank also uses hypothetical results, which measure results excluding the effect of intraday trading, fees and commissions. When the actual or hypothetical loss exceeds the VaR an ‘outlier’ occurs. Based on ING Bank’s one-sided confidence level of 99% an outlier is expected once in every 100 business days. In 2011, like in 2010, there was no occurrence where a daily trading loss exceeded the daily consolidated VaR of ING Commercial Banking. ING Bank reports the results of this back testing to DNB on a quarterly basis.

Stress testing

Stress tests are used for the monitoring of market risks under extreme market conditions. Since VaR in general does not produce an estimate of the potential losses that can occur as a result of extreme market movements, ING Bank uses structured stress tests for monitoring the market risk under these extreme conditions. Stress scenarios are based on historical as well as hypothetical extreme events. The result of the stress testing is an event risk number, which is an estimate of the profit and loss account effect caused by a potential event and its world-wide impact for ING Commercial Banking. The event risk number for the ING Commercial Banking trading activity is generated on a weekly basis. Like VaR, event risk is limited by ALCO Bank. ING Bank’s event risk policy basically consists of defined stress parameters per country and per market (fixed income, equity, foreign exchange, credit and related derivative markets). The scenarios and stress parameters are evaluated against extreme actual market movements. If and when necessary, ING Bank evaluates specific stress scenarios, as an addition to its structural stress tests. These specific scenarios relate to current concerns, like political instability in certain regions, terrorist attacks or extreme movements, e.g. in credit spreads. Furthermore, ING participates in bank-wide stress testing as well as in ad hoc stress testing exercises as requested by the DNB or EBA.

 

F-171


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Other trading controls

VaR and event risk limits are the most important limits to control the trading portfolios. Furthermore, ING Bank uses a variety of other limits to supplement VaR and event risk. Position and sensitivity limits are used to prevent large concentrations in specific issuers, sectors or countries. In addition to this, other risk limits are set with respect to the activities in complex derivatives trading. The market risk of these products is controlled by product specific limits and constraints.

Basel 2.5 / CRD 3

The Basel Committee has proposed to supplement the current VaR regulatory capital framework for trading exposures with Incremental Risk Charge and Stressed VaR to cover for the shortcomings of the existing regulatory risk framework. The Basel requirements on the Incremental Risk Charge and stressed VaR have come into force in European legislation (CRD 3) as of December 31, 2011 and are included in the regulatory capital as of Q4 2011.

Stressed VaR

The Stressed VaR (SVaR) is intended to replicate a VaR calculation that would be generated on the bank’s current portfolio with inputs calibrated to the historical data from a continuous 12-month period of significant financial stress relevant to the bank’s portfolio. To calculate SVaR, ING Bank uses the same model that is used for VaR (historical simulation). The historical data period used includes the height of the credit crisis around the fall of Lehman brothers, and is reviewed regularly.

Incremental Risk Charge

With the Incremental Risk Charge (IRC) ING Bank calculates an estimate of default and migration risk for unsecuritised credit products in the trading book over a one-year capital horizon at a 99.9% confidence level. For the calculation of IRC ING Bank performs a Monte Carlo simulation based on a Gaussian copula model. For all issuers the rating is simulated over the different liquidity horizons (time required to liquidate the position or hedge all material risks) within one year. The financial impact is then determined based on the migration to default (based on LGD), or migration to a different rating category (based on credit spread changes).

The liquidity horizon has been set to the regulatory minimum of three months for all positions in scope. Given the types of products in ING Bank’s trading portfolio ING considers this horizon to be conservative. We have demonstrated that ING Bank could still actively trade its positions that are significant for IRC under stressed market circumstances, allowing ING Bank to fully redeem its positions within three months.

Risk Profile

The following chart shows the development of the overnight VaR under a 99% confidence interval and a 1-day horizon. The overnight VaR is presented for the ING Commercial Banking trading portfolio for 2010 and 2011. Several banking books are internally governed by the trading risk process and are therefore excluded from the non-trading risk table and included in the below trading risk graph and table.

LOGO

During 2011 the overnight VaR for the ING Commercial Banking trading portfolio ranged from EUR 12 million to EUR 29 million.

More details on the VaR of the ING Commercial Banking trading portfolio for 2011 and 2010 are provided in the table below.

 

F-172


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Consolidated VaR trading books: ING Commercial Bank

 

     Minimum      Maximum      Average     Year end  
     2011      2010      2011      2010      2011     2010     2011     2010  

Interest rate (1)

     9         18         21         29         15        22        12        20   

Equity

     1         1         18         9         7        4        7        3   

Foreign exchange

     1         1         4         9         2        2        2        4   

Credit spread (1)

     6         n/a         8         n/a         7        n/a        6        n/a   

Diversification (2)

                 (12     (6     (12     (8
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total VaR

     12         17         29         30         19        22        15        19   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Credit spreads are introduced as a separate risk category as of Q4 2011. Minimum, maximum and average values for the risk category Credit spread are calculated on Q4 only. The 2010 credit spreads are consolidated in the interest rate risk category.

(2) 

The total VaR for the columns Minimum and Maximum can not be calculated by taking the sum of the individual components since the observations for both the individual markets as well as total VaR may occur on different dates.

The VaR figures in the table above relate to all books under trading governance. In general, the level of the trading VaR was lower in the first half of 2011, continuing the decreasing trend of 2010. Halfway the year, VaR levels increased due to increased market volatility. The equity VaR increased due to the integration of implied correlation and dividend risk, new risk measures added to the VaR framework. The average consolidated VaR over 2011 was lower than over 2010 (average VaR 2011: EUR 19 million and average VaR 2010: EUR 22 million).

The risk figures in the table below only relate to the CAD2 trading books for which the internal model approach is applied.

Risk measures for Internal Model Approach Portfolios

 

     2011     Year end  
     Minimum      Maximum      Average     2011     2010  

Interest rate VaR (1)

     8         22         14        11        18   

Equity VaR

     1         18         7        7        3   

Foreign exchange VaR

     1         4         2        2        4   

Credit Spread VaR (1)

     6         8         7        6        n/a   

Diversification effect (2)

           (12     (11     (8
          

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total VaR Internal Model Approach (1-day, 99%)

     11         28         18        15        17   

Stressed VaR (10-day, 99%)(3)

     104         182         139        117        n/a   

Incremental Risk Charge (1-year, 99.9%)(3)

     363         545         445        368        n/a   

 

(1)

Credit spreads are introduced as a separate risk category as of Q4 2011. Minimum, maximum and average values for the risk category Credit spread are calculated on Q4 only. The 2010 credit spreads are consolidated in the interest rate risk category.

(2)

The total VaR for the columns Minimum and Maximum can not be calculated by taking the sum of the individual components since the observations for both the individual markets as well as total VaR may occur on different dates.

(3)

Stressed VaR and Incremental Risk Charge figures are based on Q4 2011

Regulatory Capital

According to the Dutch regulation, regulatory capital for trading portfolios can be calculated using the standardised approach or an internal model approach. ING Bank received approval from the DNB to use an internal Value-at-Risk (VAR) model to determine the regulatory capital for the market risk in most trading books of ING Bank. Market risk capital of CAD2 trading books is calculated according to the internal VaR model, where diversification is taken into account. On the other hand, market risk capital of CAD1 books is calculated using standardised fixed risk weights. In 2011, capital on all trading books is performed under the Internal Model Approach. Mismatches in FX risk from the banking books are incorporated under the Standardised Approach. Market risk regulatory capital is calculated under the new market risk framework Basel 2.5 containing a capital charge for Stressed VaR and Incremental Risk, as approved by DNB.

Regulatory Capital

 

     2011      2010(1)  
     SVaR      VaR      Total      Total  

Interest rate / Credit spread

     327         157         484         172   

Equity

     80         62         142         40   

Foreign exchange

     15         12         27         15   

Incremental Risk Charge

           437         n/a   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Internal Model Approach

           1,090         227   

Standardised model

           34         137   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

           1,124         364   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

2010 capital figures do not include Stressed VaR

 

F-173


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Sensitivities

The following tables show the largest trading foreign exchange positions and interest rate and credit spread sensitivities. The credit spread sensitivities are furthermore split in different risk classes and sectors.

Most important foreign exchange positions (year-end 2011)

 

     2011          2010  

Foreign exchange

    

Foreign exchange

  

Chinese yuan

     356     

US dollar

     (457

US dollar

     (283  

Taiwan dollar

     155   

Czech koruna

     (154  

Chinese yuan

     83   

Taiwan dollar

     (44  

South Korean won

     68   

Bulgarian lev

     (43  

Bulgarian lev

     (57

Most important interest rate and credit spread sensitivities (year-end 2011)

 

amounts in thousands of euros    2011          2010  

Interest Rate (BPV (1))

    

Interest Rate (BPV (1))

  

United States

     331     

Eurozone

     (377

UK

     (163  

United States

     167   

Mexico

     (120  

Mexico

     (147

Russia

     (96  

Japan

     141   

Japan

     (86  

Russia

     (73

Credit Spread (BPV (1))

    

Credit Spread (BPV (1))

  

Eurozone

     (287  

Eurozone

     (596

UK

     (50  

Sweden

     (67

United States

     (31  

Hong Kong

     (47

Mexico

     (31  

UK

     (47

Norway

     (25  

United States

     (42

 

(1) 

Basis Point Value (BPV) measures the impact on value of a 1 basis point increase in interest rates or credit spreads.

Credit spread sensitivities per risk class and sector (year-end 2011)

 

     2011     2010  

amounts in thousands of euros

Credit Spread (BPV (1))

   Corporate     Financial
Institutions
    Corporate     Financial
Institutions
 

Risk classes

        

1

  

(AAA)

     (5     (16     (8     (211

2-4

  

(AA)

     (12     (49     (25     (212

5-7

  

(A)

     15        (256     (32     (257

8-10

  

(BBB)

     (49     (42     (77     (102

11-13

  

(BB)

     (14     (24     (11     (47

14-16

  

(B)

     (18     (8     (30     (8

17-22

  

(CCC and Problem Grade)

     2        (21     (24     (33

Not rated

     (1      
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (82     (416     (207     (870
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Basis Point Value (BPV) measures the impact on value of a 1 basis point increase in interest rates or credit spreads.

ING Bank Market risk in Banking Books

ING Bank makes a distinction between trading and banking (non-trading) books. Positions in trading books can change swiftly, whereas positions in banking books are intended to be held until maturity, or at least for the long term. Books that contain positions to hedge exposures resulting from commercial activities are also classified as banking books.

Interest Rate Risk in Banking Book

Interest rate risk in the banking books is defined as the potential negative impact that changing interest rates may have on earnings or market value.

Governance: ALM framework

The management of interest rate risk follows the Asset & Liability Management (ALM) framework as approved by ALCO Bank. Main goal of this framework is to transfer interest rate risks out of commercial books in order to manage it centrally. This allows for a clear demarcation between commercial business results and results on unhedged interest rate positions.

 

F-174


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Bank distinguishes three types of activities: investment of own capital (by Capital Management), commercial business (ING Direct, Retail Banking and Commercial Bank) and the strategic interest rate position (Financial Markets ALM). The scheme below presents the ALM framework:

 

LOGO

Below, the three activities are described in more detail.

Capital Management is responsible for managing the investment of own funds (core capital), more information can be found in the Capital Management section. Capital is invested for longer periods, targeting to maximize return, while keeping it stable at the same time.

Commercial activities lead to interest rate risk, as repricing tenors of assets differ from those of liabilities. Linear interest rate risk is transferred out of the commercial business into the risk center (FM ALM), leaving convexity risk and model risk with the commercial business. The convexity risk is a result of hedging products that contain embedded options, like mortgages, by using linear hedge instruments. Model risk reflects the potential imperfect modelling of client behaviour. The risk transfer process takes place on a monthly basis, but more often if deemed necessary, for instance in volatile markets.

In the risk transfer process, client behavioural characteristics play an important role. The behaviour in relation to mortgages, loans, savings and demand deposits is modelled by MRM, following extensive research. Models and parameters are back-tested regularly and updated when deemed necessary. In the modelling of savings and current accounts different elements play a role: pricing strategies, outstanding and expected volumes and the level and shape of the yield curve. The analyses results in an investment rule for the various portfolios. With respect to mortgages and loans, prepayment behaviour and the interest sensitivity of the embedded offered rate options are modelled.

In line with other commercial businesses, ING Direct transfers interest rate risk out of their commercial books to a large extent. The difference being that the risks are transferred directly to the external market, instead of to the risk center (FM ALM).

Within ING Commercial Banking, FM ALM contains the strategic interest rate position. The main objective is to maximise the economic value of the book and to generate adequate and stable yearly earnings within the risk appetite boundaries set by ALCO Bank.

In the following sections, the interest rate risks in the banking books are presented. ING Bank uses risk measures based on both an earnings and a value perspective. Earnings Sensitivity (ES) is used to provide the earnings perspective and the Net Present Value (NPV)-at-Risk and Basis Point Value (BPV) figures provide the value perspective. Several small banking books are governed by the trading risk process and are therefore excluded from the following banking book risk tables. These are included in the trading risk graph and table in the section ‘Market Risk in Trading Books’.

 

F-175


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk Profile

Earnings Sensitivity (ES)

ES measures the impact of changing interest rates on (pre tax) IFRS-EU earnings. The ES figures in the table below reflect an instantaneous shock up of 1% and a time horizon of one year. Management interventions are not incorporated in these calculations but balance sheet dynamics (e.g. new business) are significant.

The ES is mainly influenced by the sensitivity of savings to interest rate movements. The investment of own funds only impacts the ES marginally, as only a relative small part has to be (re)invested within the 1-year horizon.

Earnings Sensitivity banking books (1% instantaneous upward shock to interest rates)

 

     2011     2010  

By currency

    

Euro

     32        (237

US dollar

     (76     (114

Pound sterling

     (10     (15

Other

     10        50   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (44     (316
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Excluding ING Direct USA earnings sensitivity is approximately 0. In 2011 short-term interest rates remained at low levels in both the Eurozone and the US. Earnings sensitivity for an upward shock decreased to a small negative figure. This indicates that when rates go up the increase in interest paid on liabilities only slightly exceeds the increase in interest received on assets. Earnings are therefore relatively insensitive to rate changes.

Net Present Value (NPV) at Risk

NPV-at-Risk measures the impact of changing interest rates on value. As a full valuation approach is applied, the risk figures include convexity risk that results from embedded optionalities like mortgage prepayment options. Like for ES calculations, an instantaneous shock up of 1% is applied.

The full value impact cannot be directly linked to the balance sheet or profit and loss account, as fair value movements in banking books are generally not reported through the profit and loss account or through equity. The largest part, namely the value mutations of the amortised cost balances, is neither recognised in the balance sheet nor directly in the profit and loss account. The value mutations are expected to materialise over time in the profit and loss account, if interest rates develop according to forward rates throughout the remaining maturity of the portfolio.

The NPV at Risk is dominated by the interest rate sensitive long term investments of own funds. The value of these investments is impacted significantly if interest rates move up by 1%. Convexity risk in retail portfolios as well as the strategic interest position in FM ALM also contributes significantly to the overall NPV at Risk.

NPV-at-Risk banking books (1% instantaneous upward shock to interest rates)

 

     2011     2010  

By currency

    

Euro

     (1,828     (2,446

US dollar

     376        (205

Pound sterling

     (25     (19

Other

     52        48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (1,425     (2,622
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

NPV-at-risk excluding ING Direct USA is EUR (1,914) million. In the course of 2011 NPV-at-Risk decreased substantially. This was mainly due to more expected prepayments of mortgages as a consequence of the low interest rate environment. This decreased the expected duration of mortgages and subsequently the value sensitivity to a rate increase. Furthermore investments were shortened, leading to a lower duration of assets. Finally the outright position in the strategic interest rate portfolio was reduced. This also contributed to the decrease of the NPV sensitivity.

 

F-176


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Basis Point Value (BPV)

BPV measures the impact of a 1 basis point increase in interest rates on value. To a large extent the BPV and NPV at Risk reflect the same risk – the difference being that BPV does not reflect convexity risk, given the small shift in interest rates.

In line with NPV at Risk, the bank’s overall BPV position is dominated by the long term investment of capital, as the present value of this position is significantly impacted if interest rates move up by 1 basis point.

BPV per currency banking books

 

amounts in thousands of euros    2011     2010  

By currency

    

Euro

     (15,545     (21,760

US dollar

     4,551        (548

Pound sterling

     (136     (284

Other

     879        175   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     (10,251     (22,417
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The total BPV excluding ING Direct USA is EUR (16) million. The total BPV decreased substantially mainly on the back of a lower expected duration of mortgages leading as more prepayments are expected due to the low interest rate environment in the US and the Eurozone. Next to that the bank’s strategic interest rate position turned to more neutral.

ING Bank Foreign exchange (FX) risk in banking books

FX exposures in banking books result from core banking business activities (business units doing business in other currencies than their base currency), foreign currency investments in subsidiaries (including realised net profit and loss) and strategic equity stakes in foreign currencies. The policy regarding these exposures is briefly explained below.

Governance – Core banking business

Every business unit hedges the FX risk resulting from core banking business activities into its base currency. Consequently, assets and liabilities are matched in terms of currency.

Governance – FX Translation result

ING Bank’s strategy is to protect the target core Tier 1 ratio against FX rate fluctuations, whilst limiting the volatility in the profit and loss account. Protecting the core Tier 1 ratio is achieved by deliberately taking foreign currency positions equal to certain target positions, such that the target core Tier 1 capital and risk-weighted assets are equally sensitive in relative terms to changing FX rates.

Risk profile – FX Translation result

The following table presents the currency exposures in the banking books for the most important currencies:

Net currency exposures banking books

 

     Foreign Investments     Hedges     Net Exposure  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011      2010  

US dollar

     7,641        7,275        (2,677     (606     4,964         6,669   

Pound sterling

     (997     (993     1,048        1,144        51         151   

Polish zloty

     1,404        1,371        (628     (643     776         728   

Australian dollar

     3,165        2,908        (2,459     (2,056     706         852   

Turkish lira

     1,830        1,891        (425     (444     1,405         1,447   

Other currency

     6,934        7,160        (4,172        (4,028     2,762         3,132   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     19,977        19,612        (9,313     (6,633     10,664         12,979   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The US dollar Net Exposure decreased significantly in 2011. Anticipating on the announced sale of ING Direct USA, the risk-weighted assets will decrease and therefore, a lower Net Exposure is required. This is then achieved by increasing the hedge. The decreased Net exposure in the category ‘Other currency’ is mainly caused by changed share prices of strategic equity stakes. For example, the share price of the bank’s equity stake in Bank of Beijing decreased around 20%, decreasing the Chinese renmimbi currency exposure.

 

F-177


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In order to measure the remaining sensitivity of the target core Tier 1 ratio against FX rate fluctuations, the core Tier 1 ratio at Risk (cTaR) measure is used. It measures the drop in the core Tier 1 ratio from the target when stressing a certain FX rate. The stress scenarios for the FX rates that are used for calculating the cTaR, are presented in the last two columns. Only the scenarios that negatively impact the target core Tier 1 ratio are presented: depending on whether the actual foreign currency position is above or below the target position, the worst case scenario is either a negative or positive movement. A positive stress scenario means that the foreign currency appreciates against the Euro. For the US dollar this means that at the end of 2011 the target core Tier 1 ratio would decrease by 0.12% in absolute terms (e.g. from 9.12% to 9.00%) if the US dollar appreciates by 15%. The US dollar cTaR excluding ING Direct USA (not shown in the table below) is significantly lower at 0.01%, which shows that the core Tier 1 ratio excluding ING Direct USA is well protected. Back testing shows that the strategy was effective in 2011; the core Tier 1 ratio was hardly affected by changing FX rates.

Core Tier 1 ratio sensitivity ING Bank

 

     cTaR     Stress
Scenario
 
     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Currency

        

US dollar

     0.12       15     15

Pound sterling

     0.04     0.02     15     15

Polish zloty

     0.01     0.01     (15 %)      (15 %) 

Australian dollar

     0.00     0.01     20     (20 %) 

Turkish lira

     0.00       25     25

ING Bank Equity price risk in banking books

Equity price risk arises from the possibility that equity security prices will fluctuate, affecting the value of equity securities and other instruments whose value reacts similarly to a particular security, a defined basket of securities, or a securities index. ING Bank maintains a strategic portfolio with substantial equity exposure in its banking books. This equity exposure mainly consists of the investments in associates of EUR 827 million (2010: EUR 1,494 million) and equity securities held in the available-for-sale (AFS) portfolio of EUR 2,466 million (2010: EUR 2,741 million). The value of equity securities held in the available-for-sale portfolio is directly linked to equity security prices with increases/decreases being recognised (except in the case of impairment) in the revaluation reserve. During the year ended December 31, 2011 the revaluation reserve relating to equity securities held in the Available-for-Sale portfolio fluctuated between a month-end low amount of EUR 1,226 million (2010: EUR 1,723 million) and a high amount of EUR 1,706 million (2010: EUR 2,370 million). Investments in associates are measured in accordance with the equity method of accounting and the balance sheet value and therefore not directly linked to equity security prices.

Equities Unrealised Gains and Losses in the AFS portfolio

 

     2011     2010  

Gross unrealised gains

     1,292        1,728   

Gross unrealised losses

     (45     (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,247        1,727   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital requirement for equity price risk under the Simple Risk Weight Approach at December 31, 2011 results in EUR 207 million (2010: EUR 310 million).

ING Bank Real Estate price risk in banking books

Real estate price risk arises from the possibility that real estate prices fluctuate. This affects both the value of real estate assets and earnings related to real estate activities.

ING Bank has three main different categories of real estate exposure on its banking books. First, ING Bank owns buildings it occupies. Second, ING Bank has a Real Estate Development company for which results are dependent on the overall real estate market. The general policy is to mitigate this risk by pre-sale agreements where possible. Third, ING Bank has co-invested seed capital and bridge capital to support the launch of various real estate funds included in the Real Estate Investment Portfolio (REIM). A decrease in real estate prices will cause the value of this seed and bridge capital to decrease and will lower the level of third party assets under management, which in turn will reduce the fee income from this activity. For the third category mentioned above, real estate price shocks will have a direct impact on reported net profit and loss.

 

F-178


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Bank’s real estate exposure (i.e. including leverage and committed purchases) is EUR 4.0 billion of which EUR 0.9 billion is recorded as fair value through P&L. The remaining EUR 3.1 billion is booked at cost or is revalued through equity (with impairments going through P&L).

In total, Real Estate exposure decreased by EUR 1.1 billion mainly as a result of divestments in REIM (EUR (0.7) billion) and Real Estate Development (EUR (0.2) billion). Other important changes are: negative fair value changes and impairments (EUR (0.2) billion)

ING Bank’s real estate exposure revaluing through P&L decreased significantly mainly caused by sales of American and Australian funds (EUR 0.7 billion) and assets being revalued through equity instead (EUR (0.4) billion); the latter is a result of the fact that ING REIM is not the manager of the real estate funds anymore.

Real Estate Exposure banking books recorded as fair value through P&L (by geographic area and sector type)

 

     2011      2010           2011      2010  

Continent

        

Sector

     

Europe

     461         662      

Residential

     70         207   

Americas

     28         812      

Office

     150         385   

Australia

     20         189      

Retail

     510         620   

Asia

     380         349      

Industrial

     113         516   

Other

        14      

Other

     46         298   
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     889         2,026      

Total

     889         2,026   
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

ING Bank’s real estate exposure not revaluing through P&L has not been affected much. This is because divestments and impairments in Real Estate Development (EUR (450) million) were compensated by the inclusion of assets in the REIM portfolio previously revalued through P&L.

Real Estate Exposure banking books not revalued through P&L (by geographic area and sector type) (1)

 

     2011      2010           2011      2010  

Continent

        

Sector

     

Europe

     2,452         2,772      

Residential

     512         614   

Americas

     306         70      

Office

     1,347         1,456   

Australia

     176         204      

Retail

     896         874   

Asia

        

Industrial

     44         43   

Other

     147         99      

Other

     282         158   
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     3,081         3,145      

Total

     3,081         3,145   
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The real estate exposures above do not include the property from foreclosures

ING BANK – LIQUIDITY RISK

Liquidity risk is the risk that ING Bank or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities when they come due, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner. Liquidity risk can materialise both through trading and non-trading positions.

Liquidity Risk Management

MRM is responsible for determining adequate policies and procedures for managing liquidity risk and for monitoring the compliance with these guidelines. In addition it is also responsible for performing liquidity risk stress testing. In accordance with Dutch Central Bank guidelines, ING Bank’s liquidity positions are stress tested on a monthly basis under a scenario that is a mix between a market event and an ING Bank specific event. Additional stress testing exercises are undertaken on consolidated and local level on a periodic and ad-hoc basis.

Governance

As with other bank market risks, liquidity risk falls under the supervision of the ALCO function within ING Bank, with ALCO Bank as the highest approval authority. ALCO Bank determines the liquidity risk (limit) framework and appetite after which this is cascaded down in the organisation under the responsibility of the regional and local ALCOs. The main objective of ING Bank’s liquidity risk framework is to ascertain – by means of proper risk appetite limits – that sufficient liquidity is maintained in order to ensure safe and sound operations under a variety of circumstances.

For this purpose liquidity risk is measured, managed and controlled from three different angles, namely a structural, a tactical and a contingency point of view.

 

F-179


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk profile

Structural liquidity risk

Structural liquidity risk is the risk that the structural, long term balance sheet cannot be financed timely or at a reasonable cost. For the purpose of managing structural liquidity risk, a specific advisory committee to ALCO Bank has been established.

This committee which consists of key representatives from MRM, Capital Management and Financial Markets focuses on all liquidity risk aspects from a going concern perspective. The main objective of the committee is to maintain a sound liquidity profile through:

 

 

Maintaining a well diversified mix of funding sources in terms of instrument types (e.g. unsecured deposits, commercial paper, long term bonds or repurchase agreements), fund providers (e.g. professional money market players, wholesale and retail clients), geographic markets and currencies;

 

 

Actively managing access to the capital markets by regularly issuing public debt in all material markets and the maintenance of investor relations;

 

 

Holding a broad portfolio of eligible assets that can be utilised to obtain secured funding, e.g. from the repo market or (E)CB; in this respect the total marketable/(E)CB eligible collateral position amounts to EUR 194 billion (MtM);

 

 

Management of liquidity gaps, taking into account the asset mix and both the secured and unsecured funding opportunities of ING Bank; and

 

 

Maintaining a funds transfer pricing mechanism in which ING Bank’s cost of liquidity is adequately reflected both under a going concern and a contingency perspective.

With respect to funding sources, ING Bank aims to fund its own originated assets (loans) by an equal amount of own originated liabilities (deposits), translated into an LtD target of below 1.2. Ultimo 2011 the LtD ratio (excluding securities at amortised costs and IABF receivable) equals 1.14. In 2011, uncertainty with regard to economic developments in both Europe and USA, led to US MM Funds being more restrictive in funding European counterparties. As ING Bank manages its balance sheet prudently, whereby short term funding is primarily utilised for short term assets, a decrease of these type of funding sources is manageable. The table below shows the funding mix.

ING Bank Funding Mix

 

     2011     2010  

Funding type

    

Retail deposits

     42     46

Corporate & other deposits

     20     19

Interbank (incl. central bank)

     9     8

Lending / repurchase agreement

     7     7

Public debt

     19     17

Subordinated debt

     3     3
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The funding mix remained well diversified and according to targets set. Deposits accounted for 63% of the total funding mix.

Tactical liquidity risk

Liquidity risk which is resulting from short term cash and collateral positions is managed in the risk framework from a tactical liquidity risk perspective. The day-to-day management of the overall short term liquidity risk of ING Bank is delegated to Financial Markets Amsterdam, while regional and local Financial Markets departments manage liquidity in their respective regions and locations. Within Financial Markets, the focus is on the daily and intraday cash and collateral positions and the policy is to manage and sufficiently spread day-to-day funding requirements.

Contingency liquidity risk

Contingency liquidity risk specifically relates to the organisation and planning for liquidity management in time of stress. Within ING Bank, for contingency purposes, a specific crisis team – consisting of key Board Members, representatives from Staff Departments (e.g. Risk and Capital Management) and Treasuries – is responsible for liquidity management in times of crisis. Throughout the organisation adequate and up-to-date contingency funding plans are in place to enable senior management to act effectively and efficiently in times of crisis.

 

F-180


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Contingency funding plans address both temporary and long-term liquidity disruptions, triggered by either a general market event or an ING Bank specific event.

New developments

All financial institutions have been confronted with a large number of new regulatory requirements. In 2011 ING Bank updated its framework for funding and liquidity risk management so that it provides for an integral approach of liquidity risk management and complies with the changed regulatory rules (CRDII, ILAAP). The framework contains, among others, the annual setting of a funding and liquidity risk appetite related to the ING Bank strategy, a continuous cycle of identification, assessment, control, monitoring and reporting of funding and liquidity risk, a policy covering all legal and regulatory rules, crisis planning and stress testing. The framework will be implemented in 2012.

ING BANK OPERATIONAL RISK

Operational risk is the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes the related risk of reputation loss, as well as legal risk whereas strategic risks are not included. Effective operational risk management leads to more stable business processes (including IT systems) and lower costs. Generic mandatory controls are described in the ORM policy house.

Clear and accessible policies and minimum standards are embedded in ING Bank business processes in all business lines. An infrastructure is in place to enable management to track incidents and operational risk issues. A comprehensive system of internal controls creates an environment of continuous improvement in managing operational risk. ING Bank uses this knowledge (including lessons learned from incidents) to improve the control of key risks.

Governance

At all levels in the organisation Non Financial Risk Committees (NFRC’s) are established that identify, measure and monitor the operational, compliance and legal risks of the region or business unit with appropriate quality of coverage (granularity) and to ensure that appropriate management action is taken by the responsible line managers at the appropriate level of granularity. NFRC’s, chaired by the CEO of the entity, steer the risk management activities of the first and second line of defence in their entities.

The General Manager Operational Risk Management (ORM) is responsible for monitoring operational risks and developing and establishing the Operational Risk Framework within ING Bank. The General Manager ORM also establishes and approves the policies and minimum standards, supports the business line ORM staff, monitors the quality of operational risk management and assists and supports the Management Board Bank in managing ING Bank’s operational risks. The NFRC is the primary approval and oversight committee. The Non-Financial Risk dashboard (NFRD) enables management to focus on the ten operational risk areas through the quarterly report on regional, divisional and Bank level.

The ORM function consists of functional departments for Operational risks (including policies, systems, SOX testing, capital allocation and reporting), for Information (Technology) risks and for Security & Investigations.

ORM uses a layered functional approach within business lines to ensure systematic and consistent implementation of the group-wide ORM framework, policies and minimum standards. To avoid potential conflicts of interests, it is imperative that the ORM officer is impartial and objective when advising business management on operational risk matters in their business unit or business line. To facilitate this, a strong functional reporting line to the next higher level ORM officer is in place. The functional reporting line has clear accountabilities with regard to objective setting, remuneration, performance management and appointment of new ORM staff.

Operational risk framework

ING Bank has developed a comprehensive framework supporting and governing the process of identifying, mitigating, measuring and monitoring operational risks thus reflecting the stages described in the Enterprise Risk Management model of COSO (Committee of Sponsoring Organisations of the Treadway Commission).

The operational risk appetite within ING Bank is defined as the acceptable and authorised maximum level of risk, in each of the operational risk areas that must be adhered to in order for ING Bank to achieve its business plan within approved budgets. This risk appetite is quarterly monitored through the Non-Financial Risk Dashboard which reports the key non financial risk exposures.

 

F-181


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Processes are in place to identify key threats, vulnerabilities and the associated risks which might cause adverse events. Event identification is performed proactively and precedes a risk assessment. Different techniques for event identification exist within ING Bank, e.g. risk & control self assessments, scenario analysis, external events inventories, internal incident analysis (e.g. lessons learned based on information from incident reporting), key risk indicator events and threat scans.

At least once a year business units and departments perform an integrated risk assessment with involvement of the business and their Operational Risk, Compliance, Legal and Finance departments.

Based on the results of the risk assessment, response measures must be determined for the identified risks beyond the risk appetite. Risk response actions balance the expected cost for implementing these measures with the expected benefits regarding the risk reduction. Risk response can be achieved through several combinations of mitigation strategies, for example reducing likelihood of occurrence, reducing impact, risk avoidance, risk acceptance or through the transfer of risk. Tracking takes place through ING Bank’s central risk management system.

The yearly objective setting process for both business management and ORM professionals aims to keep improving the management of operational risk throughout ING Bank to ensure that ING stays in control of its current and future operational risks. ING Bank’s ORM Framework is further maturing towards an integrated controls framework according to pre-agreed requirements and development stages in the individual business units. This development is measured through the scorecard process.

Model disclosure

The Operational Risk Capital model of ING Bank is based on a Loss Distribution Approach (LDA). The Loss Distribution is based on both external and internal loss data exceeding EUR 1 million. The model is adjusted for the specific measured quality of control in a business line and the occurrence of large incidents (‘bonus/malus’). This provides an incentive to local (operational risk) management to better manage operational risk.

Loss Distribution approach

The main objective of the LDA approach is to derive an objective Operational Risk capital amount based on the risk profile of a bank and its business units. This approach estimates the distribution of operational risk losses for each combination of business line and loss event type.

Risk profile

The AMA capital for the fourth quarter of 2011 amounts EUR 2,836 million. This is slightly below the capital estimate of previous year. This is explained by a capital reduction resulting from the divestments of ING Car Lease and REIM Fee Business, which is partially offset by a capital increase resulting from the regular external incident data update.

Economic and Regulatory Capital (Bank diversified only) by risk type

 

    

Economic

Capital

     Regulatory
Capital
 
     2011      2010      2011      2010  

Operational Risk

     1,683         1,619         2,836         2,872   

Main developments in 2011

The AMA (Advance Measurement Approach) 2.0 program will elevate operational risk management to best practice levels by 2012. The AMA 2.0 program will enable the business to influence its capital charge through sound Operational Risk management:

 

 

Business managers as the clear owners of their operational risks and their capital charge

 

 

More accurate and relevant risk data and insights available for operational risk management

 

 

Capital model more reflective of ING Bank risk profile to incentivise business to keep operational risks under control

 

 

More weighting to internal data sources in the capital model, which includes a set of business driven scenarios, risk assessments, audit data and internal loss information

 

 

Major business decisions supported by accurate capital numbers that align to the Non Financial Risk Dashboard (NFRD)

 

F-182


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

AMA 2.0 program delivers an ambitious set of improvements in the management of operational risk:

 

 

Comprehensive, transparent and effective Non Financial Risk Committee (NFRC) hierarchy at top-of-the-house

 

 

Risk appetite statements for regions and divisions as anchor point for operational risk management

 

 

Key risk indicators for top risks at bank and Regional/ Function level to monitor the ING Bank risk profile

 

 

Set of key risk scenarios as capital model input and to prioritise risk management activities

 

 

Key Control Testing to justify capital levels and set a cost incentive to improve controls

 

 

Capture of all material internal losses and share main lessons learned to avoid repetition inside the group

The NFR Awareness Program is designed with the objective that all ING Bank employees are aware of the relevant risks, the potential impact, the appropriate mitigating measures and their personal role in applying those measures. The new approach significantly improves risk awareness by putting ING Bank’s businesses in the lead, working closely with risk professionals. A tailored approach per target group, embedded activities in regular business planning and target setting and focus on desired behaviours and realistic ways of apply rules are the basic elements of the new approach. It also gives an overall structure to the many risk awareness activities carried out by ORM, Compliance and Legal and ensures that ING Bank’s risk awareness activities are better focused on the key risks we face as a business.

ING Bank has further improved its IT risk profile through IT security control implementations and IT process improvements. Specific focus in 2011 was given to further improvements around IT security monitoring, IT platform security and IT user access while specific anti-cybercrime measures were also effectuated.

ING BANK COMPLIANCE RISK

Compliance Risk is defined as the risk of impairment of ING Bank’s integrity as a result of failure (or perceived failure) to comply with relevant laws, regulations, ING Bank policies and standards and the ING Bank Business Principles. In addition to reputational damage, failure to effectively manage Compliance Risk could expose ING Bank to fines, civil and criminal penalties, and payment of damages, court orders and suspension or revocation of licenses, which would adversely impact customers, staff and shareholders of ING.

ING Bank believes that fully embedded Compliance Risk Management Controls preserves and enhances the trust of its customers, staff and shareholders. Being trusted is essential to building sustainable businesses. ING Bank’s Business Principles set the foundation for the high ethical standards ING Bank expects of all our business activities. ING Bank’s Business Principles require all staff at every level to conduct themselves, not only in compliance with laws and regulations, but also by acting with integrity, being open and clear, respectful, and responsible.

Clear and practical policies and procedures are embedded in ING Bank business processes in all Business Lines. Systems are in place to enable management to track current and emerging Compliance Risk issues, to communicate these to internal and external stakeholders, and to drive continuous improvement. ING Bank understands that good Compliance Risk Management involves understanding and delivering on the expectations of customers and other stakeholders, thereby strengthening the quality of key relationships.

Governance

The Compliance Risk Management function

The Chief Compliance Officer (CCO) is the General Manager of Compliance Risk Management and is responsible for developing and establishing the Bank-wide Compliance Risk Management Charter & Framework, establishes the Minimum Standards for managing Compliance Risks and assists and supports the Management Board Bank in managing ING Bank’s Compliance Risks.

ING Bank uses a functional approach Lines to ensure systematic and consistent implementation of the Bank-wide Charter & Framework, policies, Minimum Standards and related procedures. The Local Compliance Officer has the responsibility to assist local management in managing Compliance Risk within that business unit. The Regional or Universal Bank Compliance Officer has a management and supervisory role over all functional activities of the Compliance Officers in the respective region or Universal Bank. The CCO and the Bank Compliance Risk Management team provide overall direction to the Regional or Universal Bank Compliance Officers.

 

F-183


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

To avoid potential conflicts of interest, it is imperative that the Compliance Officers are impartial and objective when advising business management on Compliance Risk in their business unit, region, country or entity. To facilitate this, a strong functional reporting line to the next higher level Compliance Officer is in place. The functional reporting line has clear accountabilities relating to objective setting, remuneration, performance management and the appointment of new Compliance Risk Management staff as well as obligations to veto and escalate.

Scope

The Compliance Risk Management function focuses on managing the risks arising from laws, regulations and standards which are specific to the financial services industry. The Compliance Risk Management function actively educates and supports the business in managing compliance risks including anti-money laundering, preventing terrorist financing, conflicts of interest, proper sales and trading conduct and protection of customer interest.

ING Bank separates Compliance Risk into four conduct-related integrity risk areas: client conduct, personal conduct, organisational conduct as well as financial conduct. ING Bank has a Whistleblower procedure which encourages staff to speak up if they know of or suspect a breach of external regulations or internal policies or Business Principles.

Compliance Risk Management Framework

The Framework consists of three key components:

 

1.

The Compliance Risk Management process

The process has five key activities carried out in accordance with the requirements of the Framework:

 

A.

Identification of Compliance Risk Obligations;

 

B.

Risk Assessment;

 

C.

Compliance Risk Mitigation (includes Training and Education);

 

D.

Compliance Risk Monitoring (includes Action Tracking);

 

E.

Compliance Risk Reporting (includes Internal Events Reporting and Response).

 

2.

Advisory

Compliance Officers proactively advise their CEO, Management, local boards and committees, the next higher level Compliance Officer, and employees on Compliance Risk, responsibilities, obligations and concerns.

 

3.

Scorecard

The Compliance Risk Management function works with the Operational Risk Management Scorecard process to evaluate how well the Compliance Risk Management Framework is embedded in each business. Scoring is based on the ability of the business unit to demonstrate that the required policies and procedures are implemented.

Extra-territorial regulations

Financial institutions continue to be closely scrutinized by regulatory authorities, governmental bodies, shareholders, rating agencies, customers and others to ensure they comply with the relevant laws, regulations, standards and expectations. Bank regulators and other supervisory authorities in Europe, the US and elsewhere continue to oversee the activities of financial institutions to ensure that they operate with integrity and conduct business in an efficient, orderly and transparent manner. ING Bank seeks to meet the standards and expectations of regulatory authorities and other interested parties through a number of initiatives and activities, including scrutinizing account holder information, payment processing and other transactions to support compliance with regulations governing money laundering, economic and trade sanctions, bribery and other corrupt practices. The failure or alleged failure by ING Bank to meet applicable standards in these areas could result in, among other things, suspension or revocation of ING Bank’s licenses, cease and desist orders, fines, civil or criminal penalties and other disciplinary action which could materially damage ING Bank’s reputation and financial condition, and accordingly ING Bank’s primary focus is to support good business practice through its Business Principles and policies.

 

F-184


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING’s continued actions to mature its compliance risk management programme will ensure that ING continues to comply appropriately with international standards and laws. ING has an on-going objective to continuously strengthen the Financial Economic Crime (FEC) controls related to:

 

 

managing Anti-Money Laundering (AML);

 

 

Combat Terrorist Financing (CTF);

 

 

Export Trade and Sanction risks.

As a result of our frequent evaluation of all businesses from economic, strategic and risk perspectives ING Bank continues to believe that for business reasons doing business involving certain specified countries should be discontinued, which includes that ING Bank has a policy not to enter into new relationships with clients from these countries and processes remain in place to discontinue existing relationships involving these countries. At present these countries include Myanmar, North Korea, Sudan, Syria, Iran and Cuba. Each of these countries is subject to a variety of EU, US and other sanctions regimes. Cuba, Iran, Sudan, and Syria are identified by the US as state sponsors of terrorism and are subject to US economic sanctions and export controls.

Regulatory measures and law enforcement agencies investigations

ING Bank N.V. has continued discussions with its Dutch bank regulator De Nederlandsche Bank (DNB) related to transactions involving persons in countries subject to sanctions by the EU, the US and other authorities and its earlier review of transactions involving sanctioned parties. ING Bank completed the global implementation of enhanced compliance and risk management procedures, and continues working to further strengthen the Financial Economic Crime controls as agreed with DNB.

ING Bank remains in discussions with authorities in the US concerning these matters, including ING Bank’s compliance with Office of Foreign Asset Control requirements. ING Bank has received requests for information from US Government agencies including the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office. ING Bank is cooperating fully with the ongoing investigations and is engaged in discussions to resolve these matters with the US authorities; however, it is not yet possible to reliably estimate the timing or amount of any potential settlement, which could be significant.

Main developments in 2011

 

 

Regulator relationships – Bank Compliance Risk Management continued to invest in pro-active relationships with regulators in the jurisdictions where ING Bank operates, striving for an open approach and cooperation in identifying and mitigating compliance risks for ING Bank.

 

 

Promoting Integrity Programme – Bank Compliance Risk Management, together with Human Resources and Corporate Communications & Affairs, continued with the roll-out of the Promoting Integrity Programme (PIP), a global employee education programme focusing on ING Bank’s values (including the ING Bank Business Principles) and the role they play in the business and workplace. Short e-modules were developed on Customer Trust and Anti-Fraud and were followed by manager-led dialogue sessions, where employees discussed what integrity means for them and how the Business Principles and ING Bank Policies and standards can be applied in their daily work.

 

 

Ongoing enhancement of Financial Economic Crime controls – ING Bank continued its strong commitment to preventing any involvement in criminal activity. Existing activities were further strengthened by increased monitoring and internal audits as well as awareness and training programmes and an internal annual sign-off process for senior management concerning implementation of policies and procedures relating to Financial Economic Crime including business with sanctioned parties.

 

 

Gifts, Entertainment and Anti-Bribery Policy – ING Bank issued a revised Gifts, Entertainment and Anti-Bribery Policy to align with the changing regulatory landscape in respect of anti-bribery which provides for severe penalties in case of bribery offences and with new extra-territorial anti-bribery legislation, such as the UK Bribery Act.

 

 

Learning – Continuous global education and awareness training was provided through face-to-face training sessions and learning tools on topics such as Ultra High Risk Countries & Export Trade, Financial Economic Crime, and Gifts, Entertainment and Anti-Bribery. Compliance Risk Management also continued its mandatory global Compliance Officer Training programme for all compliance officers new to ING Bank.

 

F-185


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING BANK BUSINESS RISK

Business Risk for ING Bank has been defined as the exposure to value loss due to fluctuations in volumes, margins and costs, as well as client behaviour risk. It is the risk inherent to strategy decisions and internal efficiency. The calculation of Business Risk Capital is done by calculation of two components,

 

(i)

Expense risk relates to the (in)flexibility to adjust expenses, when that is needed.

 

(ii)

Client behaviour risk relates to clients behaving differently than expected and the effect that this behaviour can have on customer deposits and mortgage pre-payments. The client behaviour risk is calculated by stressing the underlying assumptions in the models for behavioural assets and liabilities.

Each of these components is calculated separately, and combined to one business risk figure via the variance-covariance methodology.

ING INSURANCE

ING INSURANCE RISK MANAGEMENT GOVERNANCE

ING is engaged in selling a broad range of life and non-life insurance products. Risks from these products arise with respect to the adequacy of insurance premium rate levels and provisions for insurance liabilities, earnings and capital position, as well as uncertainty as to the future returns on investments of the insurance premiums. Financial risks include Investment Risk, Asset and Liability Management and surplus and capital issues. Insurance product risks include Insurance risks (actuarial and underwriting) and interest rate sensitivity. Compliance risk, legal risk, reputation risk and operational risk are classified as Non-Financial Risks.

The Management Board Insurance Eurasia consists of 6 members, including the members of the ING Group Executive Board, and is responsible for managing risks associated with the insurance activities in Europe and Asia. The Board ING America Holdings consists of 7 members, including the members of the ING Group Executive Board, and is responsible for managing risks associated with the insurance activities in the United States (ING Insurance US). Risks associated with certain ING Insurance activities that will not be disposed of through the divestments of the Latin American, Asian, European and US business (“Insurance Investments”) are directly managed by the Executive Board.

In anticipation of the intended divestment of the insurance activities, to a large extent risk management has been delegated to ING Insurance Eurasia and ING Insurance US with an oversight role at Group level.

ING has completed the divestment of its Latin American pensions, life insurance and investment management operations. This transaction is the first major step in the divestment of ING’s insurance and investment management activities.

Governance

Risk management within ING is the primary responsibility of the ING Group Chief Risk Officer. The ING Group Chief Risk Officer has a direct functional line with the Deputy Chief Risk Officer of ING Insurance Eurasia and with the Chief Risk officer of ING Insurance US via the ING Insurance US Chief Financial Officer. The General Manager of Insurance Investments is responsible for winding down the activities within Insurance Investments. The ING Group CRO is supported by the Risk functions of ING Group and by the Group functions Corporate Legal and the Functional Controller Insurance.

LOGO

 

F-186


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ONGOING CHANGES IN THE REGULATORY ENVIRONMENT

 

 

The most important regulatory issue for the insurance industry is the continued development by the European Union of the Solvency II capital adequacy framework. Solvency II is intended to be based on economic, risk-based and market-consistent principles whereby capital requirements across Europe are directly dependent on an insurer’s assets and liabilities. However, some of the proposed measures currently under discussion are considered unduly conservative and deviate from economic principles. It is therefore very important that the Solvency II framework, as originally envisaged, will become market-based, avoids pro-cyclicality and should be able to withstand market volatility. The EU politicians and regulators drafting the framework should therefore ensure that the measures to be implemented are robust enough throughout the cycle. ING Insurance Eurasia is working actively with its colleagues in the insurance industry to advise EU politicians and regulators come up with concrete proposals that further these objectives

 

 

The insurance business is sensitive to regulatory action, for instance regulations affecting taxes, pension regulation and customer protection. In the first quarter, the European Court of Justice ruled that price differentiation based on gender for any insurance products sold in the European Union from December 21, 2012 onwards. This will only impact new business and exclude repricing and extensions. Pension fund law changes in Poland were approved and signed at the end of March 2011. These changes are expected to negatively impact future earnings.

 

 

The Dodd-Frank Act, its implementing regulations and other financial regulatory reform initiatives could have adverse consequences for the financial services industry, including ING Insurance US and/or materially affect the results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. The 2010 Dodd-Frank Act directs existing and newly-created government agencies and bodies to conduct certain studies and promulgate a multitude of regulations implementing the law, a process that is underway and is expected to continue over the next few years. While some studies have already been completed and the rule-making process has begun, there continues to be significant uncertainty regarding the results of ongoing studies and the ultimate requirements of those regulations that have not yet been adopted. Until final regulations are promulgated pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the full impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on the businesses, products, results of operation and financial condition will remain unclear.

 

 

State insurance regulators and the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC) regularly re-examine existing laws and regulations applicable to insurance companies and their products. Changes in these laws and regulations, or in interpretations thereof, are often made for the benefit of the consumer at the expense of the insurer and could have a material adverse effect on the financial condition and results of operations. The NAIC continues to work on comprehensive reforms related to life insurance reserves and the accounting for such reserves, although the timing and extent of further changes to statutory reserves and reporting requirements are uncertain.

ING INSURANCE EURASIA

MISSION AND OBJECTIVES

ING Insurance Eurasia is naturally exposed to a variety of risks, being a financial services company that provides wealth management and protection products. The mission of risk management in ING Insurance Eurasia is to ensure that all risks run by the entity are well understood, accurately measured and pro-actively managed, in order to support efficient capital allocation, profitable growth, required returns on capital and predictability in earnings.

The following principles support this objective:

 

 

Transparent communication to internal and external stakeholders on risk management and value creation

 

 

Compliance with internal and external rules and guidelines

 

 

Products and portfolios are structured, underwritten, priced, approved and managed according to the guidelines

 

 

The risk profile of ING Insurance Eurasia is transparent, and is consistent with delegated authorities and the overall Insurance Eurasia strategy and risk appetite

ING INSURANCE EURASIA RISK GOVERNANCE

ING Insurance Eurasia’s risk framework is based on the ‘three lines of defence’ concept which ensures that risk is managed in line with the risk appetite as defined by the Management Board Insurance Eurasia (MBI Eurasia) and ratified by the Supervisory Board and is cascaded throughout ING Insurance Eurasia.

 

F-187


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

LOGO

Board level risk oversight

ING Insurance Eurasia has a two-tier board structure consisting of the Management Board Insurance Eurasia (MBI Eurasia) and the Supervisory Board Insurance Eurasia.

The Supervisory Board is responsible for supervising the policy of the MBI Eurasia and the general course of affairs of the company and its businesses. For Risk Management purposes the Supervisory Board is assisted by two sub-committees:

 

 

The Audit Committee assists the Supervisory Board in supervising and advising the MBI Eurasia with respect to the structure and operation of internal risk management and control systems, as well as compliance with legislation and regulations applicable to ING Insurance Eurasia and its subsidiaries;

 

 

The Risk Committee assists the Supervisory Board in supervising and advising the MBI Eurasia with respect to ING Eurasia’s strategy and its risk policies, including the risks inherent in its business activities.

To the extent that the committees do not determine otherwise, the Chief Risk Officer (CRO) attends the meetings of both committees.

The MBI Eurasia is responsible for managing the risks associated with the activities of ING Insurance Eurasia. The MBI Eurasia’s responsibilities include ensuring the risk management and control systems are effective and ING Insurance Eurasia complies with legislation and regulations. The MBI Eurasia reports and discusses these topics on a regular basis with the Supervisory Board, and reports to the Risk Committee on a quarterly basis on ING Insurance Eurasia’s risk profile versus its risk appetite.

As part of the integration of risk management into the strategic planning process, the MBI Eurasia annually issues a Planning Letter which provides the organization with the corporate strategic planning, and addresses key risk issues. Based on this letter the business lines develop their own business plans, including qualitative and quantitative assessment of the risks involved. Risk appetite, risk tolerance levels and risk limits are explicitly discussed as part of the process. Based on the business plans the MBI Eurasia formulates the Strategic plan which is submitted to the Supervisory Board for approval.

 

F-188


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Executive Level

The MBI Eurasia has delegated tasks to two committees with regards to risk:

Finance and Risk Committee

 

 

The primary responsibility of the committee is to align finance and risk decisions that have an impact on internal and/or external reporting of ING Insurance Eurasia. This includes advising on, (pre-)approving, reviewing and taking actions on issues that impact the financial condition of ING Insurance Eurasia. The Finance and Risk committee has two sub-committees dealing with different risk areas:

 

   

Eurasia Model Committee – The authority that approves methodologies, models and parameters used for measuring Risk, Economic Capital and Market -Consistent Valuations which are applied within ING Insurance Eurasia.

 

   

Impairment Committee – The authority where impairments for financial reporting purposes are approved (including loan loss provisions).

 

 

Risk Committee MBI Eurasia

The Risk Committee MBI Eurasia includes all MBI Eurasia members and heads of finance & risk staff departments. It discusses and decides on risk related items, approving limits and tolerance levels per risk category and approving and mandating action plans for specific financial, product and operational risk issues. The Risk Committee MBI Eurasia has three sub-committees dealing with different risk areas:

 

   

Financial Risk Committee – Oversees all financial risks within the ING Insurance Eurasia entities

 

   

Product Risk Committee – Oversees all insurance product risks within the ING Insurance Eurasia entities

 

   

Non Financial Risk Committee – Oversees all non-financial risks within ING Insurance Eurasia

Risk Management Function

The CRO bears primary and overall responsibility for the risk management function within ING Insurance Eurasia, which identifies, measures, monitors and reports risk within ING Insurance Eurasia. The risk function maintains and updates the policy framework, develops risk methodologies and advises on the risk tolerance and risk profile. The CRO assures that both the Supervisory Board and MBI Eurasia are well informed and understand the material risks within ING Insurance Eurasia at all times.

The CRO delegates day-to-day Risk Management within ING Insurance Eurasia to the Deputy CRO. The Deputy CRO department consists of several risk functions that support the overall Risk Management function.

 

LOGO

Regional level and business unit level have separate risk committees. The Regional CROs report functionally to the Deputy CRO, while the Business Units CROs in turn functionally report to the Regional CROs. Within ING Insurance Eurasia Compliance Risk Management is part of the Legal and Compliance function.

 

F-189


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Product Approval and Review Process

A critical aspect of risk management is that all products are designed, underwritten and priced effectively. Within ING Insurance Eurasia this is safeguarded by the Product Approval and Review Process (PARP). This standard includes requirements to risk profile, value-oriented pricing metrics, targets and documentation. The PARP includes requirements to assess market risks, credit risk, insurance risk, compliance risk, legal risk, operational risk as well as the assessment of the administration and accounting aspects of the product. Requirements with respect to the customer suitability of insurance products are an integral part of the PARP

New Investment class and investment mandate process

Complementing the PARP for insurance products, ING Insurance Eurasia maintains a New Investment Class Approval and Review Process (NICARP) for approving new investment classes. Each asset ING Insurance Eurasia invests in should be on the Global Asset List; the list of all approved investment classes. Each Business Unit maintains a Local Asset List that is a subset of the Global List. For a limited number of investment classes, a Group Investment Transaction Approval (GITA) is required for each new transaction. This requirement only applies when the level of complexity or diversity warrants Group approval for individual (programmes of) transaction(s). Actual investments are made based on Investment Mandates, a formal agreement between the owner of the investments and its asset manager. Business Units can only include investment classes in their Investment Mandates that are on their Local Asset List. Next to setting the allowed investment classes, the mandate also serves to agree the strategic asset allocation and asset, industry, regional, and credit concentration limits.

Reserve adequacy

The ING Insurance Eurasia Group Actuary instructs and supervises all ING Insurance Eurasia entities to ensure that the IFRS insurance liabilities of ING Insurance Eurasia are tested for adequacy taking into account the insurance premium rate levels and the uncertainty of future returns on investments. The reserve adequacy test is executed by evaluating insurance liabilities on current best estimate actuarial assumptions plus a risk margin, ensuring that the reserves remain adequate based on these assumptions. The assumed investment earnings are a combination of the run-off of portfolio yields on existing assets and new money and reinvestment rates. For short-term and reinvestments, new money rates are used. For other reinvestments, long-term best estimate assumptions are taken into account. For many products stochastic testing is required, taking the 90th percentile of results as the required level. In the case where deterministic testing is used, the 90% confidence level is achieved by subtracting risk margins of 20% from the best-estimate interest rates or one percent point, whichever is higher.

Policies

ING Insurance Eurasia has a comprehensive set of risk management policies in place, which are regularly updated to align with the best practices, regulations and change in business profile. Starting in 2011, ING Insurance Eurasia reviews all policies for compliance with emerging Solvency II and other regulations, for example Capital Requirements Directive III (CRD III).

Model governance

Models with regards to the disclosed metrics are approved by the ING Insurance Eurasia Model Committee (EMC). The EMC is responsible for policies, procedures, methodologies, models and parameters which are applied within ING Insurance Eurasia. Regional Model Committees are in place for the approval of regional models and parameters. Significant regional models and parameter changes are also subject to EMC approval. Furthermore, the Model Validation function carries out periodic validations of all internal models. To ensure independence from the business and other risk departments the department head reports directly to the Deputy CRO.

ING INSURANCE EURASIA RISK APPETITE FRAMEWORK

In order to manage risks on a day-to-day basis and balance value, earnings and capital decisions, ING Insurance Eurasia has implemented a risk limit framework, which follows a top down approach

 

     

Description

Risk Appetite

  

A qualitative statement defining the playing field ING Insurance Eurasia wants to act in. Driven by ING Insurance Eurasia’s business strategy.

Risk Tolerance

  

A quantitative boundary on the risks in which the risk taking should be within. Driven by Capital Rating targets and local capital restrictions and risk appetite for financial and non-financial risks.

Risk Limits

  

Limit setting to a granular level for business units throughout the organisation to constrain risk taking at the operational level within the business.

 

F-190


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The risk appetite is managed by Available Financial Resources over Economic Capital Ratio (AFR/EC). This ratio is defined as the Available Financial Resources (AFR) over the amount of capital required for the current net asset value to absorb unexpected losses in a scenario based on a 99.5% confidence level with a one year time horizon. The confidence interval and horizon are aligned to Solvency II.

Financial Risks

For financial risks, the risk tolerance is translated into risk limits on several sensitivities assuming a moderate stress scenario. These limits are set on a regional and business unit level.

 

 

AFR sensitivities – The potential reduction of the current net asset value (based on fair values) to a change in different risk factors;

 

 

IFRS Earnings sensitivities – The sensitivity of realised pre tax earnings of the insurance operations to a change in different risk factors over a full year, using scenario analysis;

Other than the above mentioned sensitivities, several limit structures are put in place on corporate, regional and business unit level. Examples include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

 

Regulatory capital sensitivities

 

 

Issuer concentration limits

 

 

Mortality concentration limits

 

 

Catastrophe and mortality exposure retention limits

 

 

Investment and derivatives guidelines and limits

Financial Risk Management Report

The Financial Risk Management Report (FRMR) is discussed in the Risk Committee of the Supervisory board. The report contains information on the AFR/EC ratio as well as a qualitative summary of relevant risk topics in the regions and specific business units.

Actuarial Opinion

The Actuarial Opinion is a quarterly report to the Supervisory Board which highlights significant developments with respect to the adequacy of insurance liabilities, based on IFRS reserving principles. Developments that (could) have a significant impact on the IFRS P&L are also mentioned in the Actuarial Opinion. The Actuarial Opinion of the last quarter of the year is accompanied by an overview of the IFRS reserve adequacy test.

Financial Risk Dashboard

The Financial Risk Dashboard (FRD) is a report that is discussed quarterly in the Risk Committee of MBI Eurasia and in the Financial Risk Committee. The FRD provides an overview of the main financial risk metrics compared to the limits set by management in alignment with the risk appetite.

Investment Risk Dashboard

On a quarterly basis the Investment Risk Dashboard (IRD) is prepared for the general account of ING Insurance Eurasia. The IRD is reported to the Risk Committee and provides actionable management information on the portfolios. The IRD analyses how the portfolios developed over the quarter. It summarises market developments and provides several breakdowns of the portfolios to highlight (potential) risk concentrations in asset classes, industries, rating classes and individual names. Also given the crisis, the IRD was further adapted to reflect more details and new views on some of the risks in ING Insurance Eurasia’s investment portfolios.

Non-Financial Risks

To ensure robust non-financial risk management, which is also reflected in the risk tolerance levels, ING Insurance Eurasia monitors the full implementation of risk policies, minimum standards and implementation guidelines. Business units have to demonstrate that the appropriate steps have been taken to control their operational and compliance risk. ING Insurance Eurasia applies scorecards to measure the quality of the internal control within a business unit. Scoring is based on the ability to demonstrate that the required risk management processes are in place and effective within the business units.

 

F-191


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Non-Financial Risk Dashboard

The Non-Financial Risk Dashboard (NFRD) is a quarterly report that is discussed at the MBI Eurasia and Risk Committee and sent to the Supervisory Board for information. The NFRD provides management at all organisational levels information on their key operational, compliance and legal risks. The NFRD is based on defined risk tolerance within the business and gives a clear description of the risks and responses enabling management to prioritise and to manage operational, compliance and legal risks.

Stress Testing

ING Insurance Eurasia complements its regular risk reporting process for financial and non-financial risks with (ad hoc) stress tests. Stress testing examines the effect of exceptional but plausible scenarios on the capital position of ING Insurance Eurasia. Stress testing can be initiated internally or by external parties such as the Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank – DNB) and the European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority (EIOPA).

ING INSURANCE EURASIA RISK PROFILE

RISK TYPE DESCRIPTION

ING Insurance Eurasia identifies the following main types of risk that are associated with its business

 

 

Insurance risk – risks such as mortality, morbidity, longevity and property and casualty (P&C) associated with the claims under insurance policies it issues/underwrites; specifically, the risk that premium rate levels and provisions are not sufficient to cover insurance claims

 

 

Business risk – risk driven by the possibility that experience deviates from expectations with respect to policyholder behaviour, expenses and premium re-rating. These fluctuations can occur because of internal, industry, or wider market factors. It is the risk inherent in strategy decisions and internal efficiency, and as such strategic risk is included in business risk

 

 

Market risk – the risk of potential losses due to adverse movements in market variables. Market risks include interest rate, equity, real estate, implied volatility, credit spread including illiquidity premium, and foreign exchange risks.

 

 

Credit risk – the risk of potential losses due to default by ING Insurance Eurasia debtors (including bond issuers) or trading counterparties

 

 

Liquidity risk – the risk that ING or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities when they come due, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner. Liquidity risk can materialise both through trading and non-trading positions.

 

 

Operational risk – the risk of direct or indirect losses resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes reputational risk, as well as legal risk

 

 

Compliance risk – the risk of damage to ING Insurance Eurasia’s integrity as a result of failure (or perceived failure) to comply with relevant laws, regulations, internal policies, procedures and ethical standards

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital (EC) within ING Insurance Eurasia is defined as the amount of additional assets to be held above the market value of liabilities in order to ensure a positive surplus in case of adverse movements. The Economic Capital model is based on a 99.5% level of confidence interval on a one-year time horizon.

 

F-192


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Model disclosure

ING quantifies the impact of the following types of risk in its EC model:

 

 

Market risk – Assets and Liabilities are replicated by the business units using a finite set of standard financial instruments. The set of standard instruments consists of zero coupon bonds, market indices, equity forwards, swaptions, callable bonds, FX options and equity options.

Each unit is provided with 300 risk neutral and 200 risk volatile scenarios which are created for multiple equity indices and exchange rates, consistent with a multi-currency dynamic term structure model. The risk volatile scenarios ensure that the replicating portfolio is calibrated against enough extreme scenarios such that it can be used safely in Economic Capital calculations. Local actuarial software uses these 500 scenarios to derive stochastic cash flows. Based on this a replicating portfolio is derived. The quality of the replication is monitored by several statistical criteria, including R-squared, and benchmarked against market value sensitivities such as duration, convexity and changes in value for larger interest rate and equity shocks. By including equity options, FX options and swaptions in the replicating instruments ING Insurance Eurasia is able to incorporate implied volatility risk in the considered risk types. Credit spread risk is captured through credit-risk-bearing zero coupon bonds in the set of replicating instruments.

 

 

Credit default risk capital – Calculated on all portfolios which contain credit or transfer risk, including investment portfolios. The EC is calculated based on the following seven drivers: Probability of Default (measure of the standalone creditworthiness of individual debtors), Exposure at Default (estimated size of the financial obligation at the moment of default in the future), Loss Given Default (estimated recovery value of the underlying collateral or guarantees received (if any) and the unsecured part), Industry of the debtor, Country of the debtor, Remaining tenor of the underlying transactions and Type of Assets.

 

 

Insurance Risk – Calculated by the business unit for all sub-risks for Life, Morbidity and P&C Risk.

 

 

Business Risk – Calculated by the business unit for Persistency, Expense and Premium-rerating Risk.

 

 

Operational Risk – Calculated by a corporate risk model for all business units, in alignment with Solvency II Standard Formula.

EC Calculation and aggregation

For the EC calculation the risk system (ECAPS) uses 20,000 simulated scenarios of market risks, credit risk, business risk, operational risk, life risk, morbidity risks and P&C risk. Diversification between risks is taken into account by a Gaussian Copula, allowing for different marginal probability distributions at the risk driver level. To be more in line with Solvency II operational risk capital is treated as an add-on, it is not part of the diversification between risk types.

The 20,000 scenarios are calibrated based on the historical time series of the market risk drivers using at least 5 years of historical data. Volatilities and correlations are calibrated to represent the distribution on a quarterly frequency. For each of the 20,000 scenarios the market value of assets and liabilities and the change in value of the Market Value Surplus (MVS) is recalculated. Sorting the results and selecting the 99.5% worst change in MVS result provides the Economic Capital for the given level of aggregation.

For EC calculation ING Insurance Eurasia uses a one-year time horizon. In practice, the EC model calculates instantaneous quarterly shocks, which are annualised to determine the annualised EC. The quarterly shock is used as this stabilises the results and the shocks are within a range that can be more credibly valued for assets and liabilities. A quarterly shock also proves to have more consistency in how correlations between risk factors are defined and therefore align closer to actual risk processes and reporting cycles.

RISK PROFILE

The following table presents the reconciliation from the EC 2010 for Insurance excluding US as reported in the Annual Report 2010, to the comparable basis for ING Insurance Eurasia 2011. This reflects changes in scope and methodology. For the remainder of the risk management paragraph of ING Insurance Eurasia, the EC on a comparable basis to 2011 is used.

 

F-193


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Economic Capital 2010 reconciliation

 

     2010  

As reported for ING Insurance excluding US in 2010

     10,363   

Excluding non-ING Insurance Eurasia entities

     (1,932
  

 

 

 

ING Insurance Eurasia 2010, before changes

     8,431   

Change pension funds fee business to statutory basis

     (98

Change in models and methodology

     2,985   
  

 

 

 

ING Insurance Eurasia 2010, on a basis comparable to 2011

     11,318   
  

 

 

 

The exclusion of non-ING Insurance Eurasia entities mainly relates to the business in Latin America and the financial leverage of ING Insurance excluding US that was considered in last year’s EC.

The fee-based pension funds business in Central and Eastern Europe is regulated by local sectoral rules rather than by Solvency II regulations for insurance entities. AFR and EC of the fee-based pensions administration business were previously calculated using market consistent valuation approach. This has been replaced by using the statutory net equity and required capital of the pension funds administration companies. The impact on EC is EUR 0.1 billion.

ING Insurance Eurasia has carried out a review of the internal model in the context of a Solvency II gap analysis. In that review we benchmarked our models against the Solvency II Standard Formula, the EIOPA consultation papers and comments of expert groups like CRO Forum and Group Consultatif. In the Annual Report 2010 it was estimated that these changes would result in a material increase of EC between EUR 1 billion and EUR 2 billion. During 2011 further refinements and analyses took place which on a comparable basis would lead to an increase in the EC of 2010 of EUR 3.0 billion. The changes are related to equity risk (EUR 0.6 billion), operational risk (EUR 0.1 billion), credit spread and illiquidity premium risk (EUR 1.3 billion), business risk (EUR 0.1 billion) and less diversification (EUR 0.8 billion).

The Solvency II legislative process is still ongoing. In particular, aspects determining the valuation of the policyholder liabilities and thereby the sensitivity to market and other risk factors on the own funds are not yet settled. The Economic Capital model will continue to be updated to reflect most recent market data, developments in best practices, and Solvency II legislation.

The following table provides the Economic Capital breakdown by business line with diversification benefits allocated to the business lines.

Economic Capital break-down ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5%) by business line

 

     2011      2010  

Insurance Benelux

     3,988         5,075   

Insurance Central & Rest of Europe

     859         1,126   

Insurance Asia/Pacific

     2,919         2,759   

Corporate Line Eurasia (1)

     2,520         2,358   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total insurance Eurasia

     10,286         11,318   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Corporate Line includes funding activities at ING Insurance Eurasia level, explicit internal transactions between business unit and Corporate Line, managed by Capital Management, and corporate reinsurance. The responsibility (and risk) of free assets located within the business line for which there is no explicit transfer via a Corporate Line transaction remain at the business unit level.

While the figures above are shown by business line, the diversification across ING Insurance Eurasia businesses is calculated across business units. Total diversification between ING Insurance Eurasia’s business units and the Corporate Line Eurasia is 34% (2010: 28%).

Economic Capital for ING Insurance Eurasia decreased from 2010 to 2011 primarily due to significant de-risking activities in the Benelux and overall lower market valuations, partly offset by increased interest rate risk in Asia Pacific as actual market rates have become closer to guarantees embedded in the insurance products.

The Corporate Line risk includes foreign exchange translation risk related to the potential loss of market value surplus in non-euro denominated business units.

 

F-194


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The table below shows the breakdown of the Economic capital per risk type. Details can be found in the various risk type sections below.

Economic Capital break-down ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5%) by risk category

 

     2011     2010  

Insurance risk

     2,003        1,833   

Business risk

     3,011        2,979   

Market risk

     7,651        9,411   

Credit default risk

     606        627   

Operational risk

     640        633   

Diversification between risk types

     (3,625     (4,165
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total insurance operations Eurasia

     10,286        11,318   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

INSURANCE RISK

Insurance risks comprise of actuarial and underwriting risk such as mortality, longevity, morbidity and property & casualty risks which result from the pricing and acceptance of insurance contracts.

Model disclosure

The table below shows the main risk categories for insurance risks within ING Insurance Eurasia. IFRS Earnings sensitivities are defined on a shock scenario at the 90% confidence level, EC numbers are determined using a 99.5% confidence interval on a one-year horizon.

 

    

Description

  

Key Drivers

Mortality

  

Mortality risk can be subdivided into:

 

•     Positive mortality risk occurs when claims are higher due to higher mortality experience e.g. term insurances

 

•     Negative mortality risk occurs when insured persons live longer than expected, for instance pension products. Longevity risk hits earnings gradually over time.

  

IFRS Earnings: Death claims in life business

 

EC: Pension and annuity business mainly in the Netherlands

Morbidity

  

Morbidity or Health insurance covers insurance indemnifying or reimbursing losses (e.g. loss of income) caused by illness or disability, or for expenses of medical treatment necessitated by illness or disability.

  

IFRS Earnings & EC: Income protection in the Netherlands and Health riders in Korea and Malaysia

Property & Casualty

  

P&C insurance products cover various risks such as fire damage, car accidents, personal and professional liability, hurricanes etc.

  

IFRS Earnings & EC: Storms and third party liabilities in Benelux

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5% undiversified) by Risk Category

 

     2011      2010  

Mortality

     1,203         1,138   

Morbidity

     591         516   

P&C

     209         179   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Insurance Risk

     2,003         1,833   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sensitivities

IFRS Earnings sensitivities for Insurance risks

 

     2011     2010  

Mortality

     (34     (30

Morbidity

     (123     (99

P&C

     (76     (49

Overall exposure to insurance risks did not change significantly during 2011. Annual review of actuarial assumptions for Insurance risk is reflected in the numbers.

Mitigation

In general, insurance risk cannot be (easily) hedged directly via the financial markets and are partially mitigated by diversification across large portfolios. They are therefore managed at the contract level through underwriting policies, product designs requirements, independent product approval processes and risk limitations related to insurance policy terms and conditions agreed with the client.

 

F-195


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk not mitigated by diversification is managed through concentration and exposure limits and through reinsurance and/or securitisations:

 

 

Tolerance limits for non-life insurance risk are set by line of business for catastrophic events and individual risk

 

 

Tolerance limits for life insurance risk are set per insured life and significant mortality events affecting multiple lives such as pandemics

 

 

Reinsurance is used to manage tolerance levels according to the ING Insurance Eurasia reinsurance credit risk policy. This is mainly done for property & casualty insurance business.

 

 

Catastrophic losses resulting from events such as terrorism are considered to be uninsurable. ING participates in industry pools in various countries to mitigate this risk.

BUSINESS RISK

Business risk for insurance is essentially the risk that insurance operations accept as a consequence of participating in the insurance business. In practice this can be defined as the exposure to the possibility that experience differs from expectations with respect to expenses, the run-off of existing business (persistency/renewals), future premium rerating, etc.

Model disclosure

The table below shows the main risk categories for business risk within ING Insurance Eurasia. EC numbers are determined using a 99.5% confidence interval on a one-year horizon.

 

    

Description

  

Key Drivers

Persistency

  

The risk that actual persistency in the future of existing business develops adversely compared to expected persistency of existing business

  

EC: Less surrenders of policies with in-the-money guarantees and higher surrender of policies with higher profitability in Asia

Expense

  

The risk that actual expenses in the future exceed the expected expenses

  

EC: Expense overruns in the Benelux

Premium re-rating

  

The risk that actual premium rate adjustments in the future are less than the expected premium adjustment

  

EC: Related to renewable heath riders in Malaysia

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5% undiversified) by Risk Category

 

     2011      2010  

Business Risk

     3,011         2,979   

MARKET RISK

ING Insurance Eurasia is exposed to market risk to the extent the market value of surpluses can be adversely impacted due to movements in financial markets. Changes in financial market prices impact the market value of ING Insurance Eurasia’s asset portfolio and hedging derivatives directly as well as through the calculated market value of the insurance liabilities.

 

F-196


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The table below shows the main risk categories for market risk within ING Insurance Eurasia. EC numbers are based on a 99.5% confidence interval on a one-year horizon. IFRS and AFR sensitivities measurement is described in the table below.

 

    

Description

  

Key Drivers

Interest Rate

  

Impact of interest rate changes in assets and liabilities

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    Measured by the impact of a 30% upwards and downwards shock relative to the ten year swap rate. Minimum shock is floored at 50 basis points and capped at maximum 150 basis points. Shocks are applied to forward rates up to the last available tenor of the interest rate curve

  

IFRS Earnings : Guaranteed separate account pension business in the Netherlands

 

AFR & EC: Duration gap for Traditional Life products in Korea caused by non-availability of long duration assets and embedded options in the guaranteed separate account pension business in the Netherlands.

Equity

  

Impact of changes in equity prices which impacts direct equity exposure and loss of fee income from unit linked, Variable Annuity (VA), pension and fund business.

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    Measured by the impact of a 25% drop in equity prices

  

IFRS Earnings, AFR & EC: Direct equity exposure and embedded options in guaranteed separate account pension business in the Netherlands and embedded options in VA business in Japan

FX

  

Impact of losses related to changes in exchange rates

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    Measured by the impact of a 10% up and down movement of currencies compared to the euro

  

IFRS Earnings: Translation risk of IFRS earnings from non-Euro businesses

 

AFR & EC: Translation risk of market value surplus from non-euro businesses

Implied Volatility

(Equity & Interest Rate)

  

Impact of losses on assets and liabilities due to movements in the volatility implied from market option prices.

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    For interest rate measured by the impact of a relative increase of 30% in implied volatilities

 

•    For Equity measured by the impact of a relative increase in implied volatilities based on tenor: 80% for tenors less than 1 year, up 30% for tenors between 1 and 3 years, up 20% for tenors between 3-7 years and up 10% for tenors of 7 years and above.

 

NOTE: this impact was not disclosed in 2010 for IFRS earnings as it was considered to be immaterial

  

IFRS Earnings, AFR & EC:

 

Embedded options in:

 

•    traditional Life products in Korea

 

•    guaranteed separate account pension business in the Netherlands

 

•    VA business in Japan

Credit Spread

  

Impact of an increase in credit spreads on investments in fixed income securities offset by movements in the liquidity premium on the liabilities.

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    Measured by the impact of a relative increase based on multiplying duration by a rating based shock (e.g. single A shock is 110 basis points).

 

•    AAA and AA rated government bonds and home government bonds in local currency (for example KRW government bonds in Korea) are excluded, exception only applicable to Greek bonds.

 

•    Shocks for structured credit are 50% higher than for corporate and government bonds.

 

•    Liquidity premium is shocked by 50 basis points up to a certain tenor depending on the currency (e.g. EURO 15 years, USD 30 years)

 

In order to avoid double counting Credit Default Risk is only captured for IFRS earnings, while Credit Spread Risk is only measured for AFR. The only exception is impaired assets for which Credit Spread risk is measured for IFRS earnings.

  

IFRS: Impaired assets in Greece.

 

AFR & EC: Debt securities in all regions. Liquidity premium offset primarily in the Benelux

Real Estate Price Risk

  

Impact of the value of Real Estate assets because of a change in earnings related to Real Estate activities and/or a change in required investor yield

 

AFR & IFRS earnings sensitivities:

 

•    For AFR this is measured by the impact of a 15% drop in real estate prices for all real estate holdings

 

•    For IFRS Earnings this is measured by the impact of a 15% drop in real estate prices only for the minority holdings and direct for all real estate revalued through P&L. Other holdings will be included in case of a possible impairments caused by the drop in prices

  

IFRS Earnings, AFR & EC : Real estate holdings in the Benelux

 

F-197


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5% undiversified) by Risk Category

 

     2011      2010  

Market Risk

     7,651         9,411   

Economic capital mainly reduced due to a decrease in equity risk caused by market conditions and additional hedges which were put in place for the direct equity holdings in the Benelux. In addition credit spread risk reduced as Southern European government bonds were replaced by Dutch, Japanese and German government bonds.

Sensitivities

Sensitivities for market risks

 

    

AFR

2011

    IFRS
Earnings
2011
   

AFR

2010

    IFRS
Earnings
2010
 

Interest Rate Up

     746        (220     601        (170

Interest Rate Down

     (1,601     405        (1,462     251   

Equity

     (823     308        (1,720     (85

FX

     (972     (89     (877     (113

Implied Volatility

     (432     (116     (463     n/a   

Credit Spread

     (180     (195     (1,912     (236

Real Estate

     (790     (782     (798     (791

The Available Financial Resources are currently mainly sensitive to downward interest rates movements and declining equity and real estate prices. Compared to 2010 the downward interest rate sensitivity was reduced by hedges put in place in the Benelux. The sensitivity to equity prices was reduced because of hedges put in place in the Benelux to protect the direct equity exposure. Credit Spread reduced significantly compared to 2010 due to an increased offsetting effect of liquidity premium present in spreads.

The IFRS earnings are mainly sensitive to interest rate movements and a decline in real estate prices. During 2011 the sensitivities for Real Estate risk remained fairly stable. The Interest rates sensitivities compared to 2010 are mainly influenced by the additional hedges put in place in the Benelux. IFRS sensitivities for implied volatility of interest rates and of equity are disclosed since 2011.

REAL ESTATE

Real estate price risk arises from the possibility that the value of real estate assets fluctuates because of a change in earnings related to real estate activities and/or a change in required investor yield. Real estate exposure is mainly present in Europe, more specifically Benelux.

ING Insurance Eurasia has two different categories of real estate exposure on its insurance books. First, ING Insurance Eurasia owns buildings it occupies. Second, ING Insurance Eurasia has invested capital in several real estate funds and direct real estate assets. A decrease in real estate prices will cause the value of this capital to decrease and as such ING Insurance is exposed to real estate price shocks.

The second category can be divided on the one hand in minority stakes in real estate assets that are revalued through equity and on the other hand stakes in funds and direct real estate revalued through P&L. Only for the last category will real estate price shocks have a direct impact on reported net profit.

Real Estate Exposure Profile by Sector Type:

 

Sector   

Revalued
through
P&L

2011

    

Not
revalued
through
P&L

2011

    

Revalued
through
P&L

2010

    

Not
revalued
through
P&L

2010

 

Residential

     325         751         349         785   

Office

     1,320         171         1,321         199   

Retail

     1,975         0         1,933         0   

Industrial

     440         0         422         0   

Other

     212         518         166         502   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,272         1,440         4,191         1,486   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-198


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

As at December 31, 2011, ING Insurance Eurasia has EUR 3.6 billion of real estate related investments (excluding leverage). ING Insurance Eurasia’s real estate exposure (i.e. including leverage) is EUR 5.7 billion of which EUR 4.3 billion is recognised as fair value through P&L and EUR 1.4 billion is not revalued through P&L, but is either booked at cost or is revalued through equity (with impairments going through P&L). In total, real estate exposure increased by EUR 35 million, mainly as a result of positive fair value changes (EUR 22 million), net investments (EUR 126 million) and FX revaluation (EUR 8 million) offset by divestments (EUR 87 million) and impairments (EUR 34 million).

CREDIT RISK

The main credit risk for ING Insurance Eurasia stems from the bond portfolio. This risk is largely measured through the credit spread risk economic capital that is part of the market risk methodology. The spread risk captures differences in risk (and diversification) between rating classes and regions, but does not capture idiosyncratic risk. This name-specific risk is measured in the Credit Default model, using every bond issuer’s probability of default (PD) and stressed loss given default (LGD). For corporate bonds, the idiosyncratic risk is also managed with rating based issuer & lending limits that prevent large exposures in one (group of related) single name(s). An outright loss given default limit serves as the final backstop for corporate exposures. Government exposures are separately monitored. The credit risk profile is monitored and reported in the Investment Risk Dashboard.

Given the size of the portfolio, term loans (including private placements) are a much smaller source of credit risk for ING Insurance Eurasia. These exposures are also included in the issuer & lending limit monitoring. Residential mortgages and policy loans form the retail credit risk exposures of ING Insurance Eurasia. Credit risks are contained through underwriting criteria and the availability of collateral.

The third source of credit risk is the claims on counterparties from OTC derivatives, money market lending and reinsurance.

 

 

Derivatives transactions are only allowed under an ISDA-master agreement with Credit Support Annex, ensuring that ING Insurance Eurasia receives collateral from its counterparty for the total positive marked-to-market value of all bilateral derivative contracts between ING Insurance Eurasia and that counterparty. In case the net marked-to-market is negative, collateral must be posted with the counterparty.

 

 

Money market lending is only done with banks of good credit standing. ING Insurance Eurasia maintains money market limits for each of these banks. The counterparties are continuously monitored for developments that could warrant lowering the limit.

 

 

Reinsurance credit risk is the risk that one of ING Insurance Eurasia’s reinsurers fails to pay timely, or fails to pay at all, valid claims that were reinsured by ING Insurance Eurasia with that reinsurer. ING Insurance Eurasia mitigates this risk by diversifying its reinsurance exposure over various well rated reinsurers, and by requiring collateral for reinsurance contracts that could lead to reinsurance exposures above a minimum threshold.

Within ING Insurance Eurasia, the goal is to maintain a low-risk, well diversified credit portfolio that meets or exceeds market based benchmark returns. ING Insurance Eurasia has a policy of maintaining a high quality investment grade portfolio while avoiding large risk concentrations. The emphasis is on managing business developments within the business lines by means of top-down concentration limits for individual borrowers and certain asset classes.

The table below shows the main risk categories for credit risk within ING Insurance Eurasia. EC numbers are based on a 99.5% confidence interval on a one-year horizon. IFRS and AFR sensitivities measurement is described in the table below.

 

    

Description

  

Key Drivers

Credit Default

  

Impact of a default of counterparties on IFRS earnings

 

IFRS earnings sensitivities(1):

 

•    Measured by the impact of multiplying the Historical Cost, the Probability of Default, and the Loss Given Default (stressed by 15%).

 

•    Impaired assets are shocked as per the Credit Spread methodology

  

IFRS Earnings and EC: General account assets in all regions, mostly bond investments and lending portfolio.

Credit Spread

   See Market Risk section   

 

(1) 

In order to avoid double counting Credit Default Risk is only captured for IFRS earnings, while Credit Spread Risk is only measured for AFR. This assumes Credit Default Risk for mortgages and concentration does not have a material Impact on the AFR.

 

F-199


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5% undiversified) by Risk Category

 

     2011      2010  

Credit Default Risk

     606         627   

Sensitivities

IFRS Earnings sensitivities for Insurance Credit Risks

 

     2011     2010  

Credit Default

     (160     (236

Risk Profile

ING Insurance Eurasia’s goal is to maintain a low-risk, well diversified investment grade portfolio while avoiding large risk concentrations. To limit and diversify spread risk, ING Insurance Eurasia manages the credit portfolio’s distribution over rating classes and industries. Both profiles also include the non-traded fixed income and money market products whose risks are measured with the Credit Default model. The specific risks are contained through the combined issuer and lending concentration limit framework and the separate money market and reinsurance limit frameworks. Please note that for all of the following tables, the figures exclude all ING intercompany exposures.

Risk Classes: ING Insurance Eurasia portfolio, as % of total outstandings (1)

 

          2011     2010  
1   

(AAA)

     29.9     26.5
2-4   

(AA)

     16.3     15.3
5-7   

(A)

     28.0     31.3
8-10   

(BBB)

     8.7     9.2
11-13   

(BB)

     3.9     4.6
14-16   

(B)

     2.3     2.4
17-22   

(CCC, Unrated & Problem Grade)

     10.9     10.7
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        100.0     100.0
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending, pre-settlement, money market and investment activities. The ratings reflect probabilities of default and do not take collateral into consideration and are based on ultimate parent.

ING Insurance Eurasia rating class distribution remained fairly stable during 2011. The increase in the AAA class is mainly due to an increase in AAA government bonds. The CCC, Unrated and Problem Grade class which mainly contains bonds from unrated counterparties, private equity and real estate investments.

Risk Concentration: ING Insurance Eurasia portfolio, by economic sector (1)(2)

 

     2011     2010  

Non-Bank Financial Institutions

     17.2     17.4

Central Governments

     43.6     41.3

Commercial Banks

     10.7     12.9

Private Individuals

     7.5     7.9

Real Estate

     2.6     2.8

Utilities

     2.8     2.5

Natural Resources

     1.6     1.5

Food, Beverages & Personal Care

     1.0     1.0

Other

     13.0     12.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     100.0     100.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending, pre-settlement, money market and investment activities.

(2) 

Economic sectors below 2% are not shown separately but grouped in ‘Other’.

Main shift in 2011 is an increase in central governments due to an increased exposure to European Central Governments, mainly Dutch, Japanese and German.

 

F-200


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Largest economic exposures: ING Insurance Eurasia portfolio, by geographic area (1)

 

     2011     2010  

Netherlands

     21.7     21.3

Belgium

     3.8     3.6

Rest of Europe

     42.7     46.1

Americas

     5.9     6.2

Asia/Pacific

     25.0     21.7

Rest of World

     0.9     1.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100.0     100.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Country is based on the country of residence of the ultimate parent.

The decrease in Rest of Europe is mainly due to decreased exposure to Central Governments of Southern European countries.

Security lending business

ING Insurance Eurasia entities can enter into agreements to sell and buy back marketable securities. These transactions can take many legal forms. Repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, buy/sellback and sell/buyback agreements, and securities borrowing and lending agreements are the most common. The amount of marketable securities that ING Insurance Eurasia held as collateral under these types of agreements at December 31, 2011 was EUR 8.4 billion (2010: EUR 9.5 billion). The decrease was due to the reduced security lending activities. These amounts exclude the cash leg of the respective transactions, as well as any pledges of securities under Tri-Party agreements (as the underlying is not directly pledged to or owned by ING Insurance Eurasia). As a general rule, the marketable securities that have been received under these transactions are eligible to be resold or pledged in other (similar) transactions. ING is obliged to return equivalent securities in such cases.

Mitigation

ING Insurance Eurasia uses different credit risk mitigation techniques, of which the use of ISDA Master Agreements accompanied with Collateral Agreements for all OTC derivative-transactions is an important example. Other forms of cover are mortgages and guarantees, both are important to enhance the credit quality of ING Insurance Eurasia’s mortgage portfolios.

Credit Covers

The table below shows the cover values per credit risk category. At ING Insurance Eurasia, cover is a term which is defined as any security, lien, mortgage, or collateral interest in an asset or guarantee, indemnification or undertaking received (either by contract and/or by law) that is intended to reduce the losses incurred subsequent to an event of default on an obligation (usually financial in nature) a customer may have towards ING Insurance Eurasia. Within ING Insurance Eurasia, covers are subdivided into two distinct groups, called collateral and promises.

Reference is made to Credit risk management classification as included in the accounting policies for the consolidated annual accounts for a reconciliation between credit risk outstandings categories and financial assets.

Collateral

Collateral is a security interest in assets. If the customer defaults on its promised performance, the asset is given as collateral or security for that obligation is liquidated, such that the proceeds can be applied towards full or partial compensation of the pledgor’s (financial) obligation to ING Insurance Eurasia. Assets have monetary value and are generally owned by the person or organisation, who gives them as collateral to ING Insurance Eurasia. Examples of collateral are insurance policies or investment accounts of clients pledged to ING Insurance Eurasia as collateral for mortgage loans, or payables or funds withheld for reinsurance exposures.

Promises

Promises are defined as a legally binding declaration by persons or organisations that give ING Insurance Eurasia the right to expect and claim from those persons or organisations if an ING Insurance Eurasia’s customer fails on its obligations to ING Insurance Eurasia. An example is the guarantee by the Dutch National Mortgage Guarantee scheme (NHG) for residential mortgage loans.

In the tables below the residential mortgage portfolio and the mortgage collateral amount are shown. Please note that the figures shown are based on credit collateral amounts, meaning the market values of these properties after haircuts.

 

F-201


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Outstandings – Cover values including guarantees received

 

          December 31, 2011  
          Outstandings      Mortgages      Cash      Guarantees      Other      Total
Credit
Covers
 

Investment

  

Financial Institutions

     20,670         —           —           —           183         183   
  

Other

     61,334         —           —           —           3         3   

Lending

  

Residential Mortgages

     5,603         7,062         —           482         398         7,942   
  

Financial Institutions

     777         —           —           —           —           —     
  

Commercial Lending

     3,086         341         —           —           —           341   
  

Government Lending

     280         —           —           —           —           —     
  

Other

     88         —           —           —           —           —     

Reinsurance

  

Financial Institutions

     531         —           139         —           62         201   

Other

  

Financial Institutions

     5,889         —           77         —           45         122   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        98,258         7,403         216         482         691         8,792   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Outstandings – Cover values including guarantees received

 

          December 31, 2010  
          Outstandings      Mortgages      Cash      Guarantees      Other      Total
Credit
Covers
 

Investment

  

Financial Institutions

     22,023         —           —           —           194         194   
  

Other

     56,167         —           —           —           1         1   

Lending

  

Residential Mortgages

     5,835         7,197         —           475         491         8,163   
  

Financial Institutions

     260         —           —           —           —           —     
  

Commercial Lending

     2,910         352         —           —           —           352   
  

Government Lending

     326         —           —           —           —           —     
  

Other

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Reinsurance

  

Financial Institutions

     475         —           47         —           63         110   

Other

  

Financial Institutions

     6,059         —           —           —           10         10   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        94,055         7,549         47         475         759         8,830   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The credit covers in the above table represent the sum of all existing covers, however excess cover amounts on specific assets cannot be put in place for other assets without covers, or with a cover amount that is smaller than the underlying exposure. The valuation methods for covers may vary per cover.

In comparison to 2010 figures, the overall cover amount remained largely unchanged. The increase in cash collateral is due to the data quality improvements with regards to reinsurance exposures and bond repo positions in the Hong Kong life business. For residential mortgage lending, the total loan amount decreased nearly 4%, while the total cover amount for residential mortgages decreased approximately by 2%. The decrease was most notable in the category ‘other cover’ (which comprises of insurance policies received and pledged securities), mainly due to a decrease in the number of covers and the average cover value. The guaranteed value of the Dutch National Mortgage Guarantee scheme (NHG) is estimated to be EUR 1.6 billion. The estimated value of the guarantee can differ depending on the number and amount of rejected NHG claims under the scheme (rejection of claims can occur in case the lending institution does not fully comply with the NHG rules).

Loan-to-Value

The LTV ratio relates the total loan amount to the market value of the collateral. The market value is the registered value as adopted from the valuation report of a qualified appraiser or valuer. For example, the LTV of portfolio invested in The Netherlands is based on foreclosure value. When available, indexation is applied to revalue the collateral to the present value. In the LTV calculation the following property covers are included: residential and industrial/commercial properties, land and applicable other fixed assets. All other covers are excluded.

In some countries residential mortgages are covered by governmental or commercial sponsors. For example the NHG (see previous section) in the Netherlands guarantees the repayment of a loan in case of a forced property sale. These covered mortgages are included in the calculation of the weighted average LTV.

The ING Insurance Eurasia residential mortgage portfolio amounts to EUR 5.6 billion, making up 5% of the total ING Insurance Eurasia outstandings. The residential mortgage portfolio is for 97% concentrated in the Netherlands (Nationale-Nederlanden). The average LTV of the Dutch residential mortgage portfolio amounts to 86 %.

 

F-202


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Problem loans

At December 31, 2011 EUR 65 million was classified as a problem loan (2010: EUR 73 million).

Past-due obligations

ING Insurance Eurasia continually measures its portfolio in terms of payment arrears. Particularly the retail residential portfolios are closely monitored on a monthly basis to determine if there are any significant changes in the level of arrears. Generally, an obligation is considered ‘past-due’ if a payment of interest or principal is more than one day late. In practice, the first 15 days after an obligation becomes past due are considered to be operational in nature for the retail loans and small businesses. After this period, letters are sent to the obligor reminding the obligor of its (past due) payment obligations. If the arrear still exists after 60 days, the obligation is transferred to one of the departments that deals with these problem loans.

Aging analysis (past due but not impaired) outstandings (1)(2)

 

     2011      2010  

Past due for 1-30 days

     82         88   

Past due for 31-60 days

     24         28   

Past due for 61-90 days

     17         14   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     123         130   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on residential mortgages only.

(2) 

The amount of past due but not impaired financial assets in respect of non-lending activities was not material.

Impaired loans and provisions

The credit portfolio is under constant review. Generally, all loans with past due financial obligations of more than 90 days are automatically reclassified as impaired. For the wholesale lending portfolios and securities obligations, there are generally reasons for declaring a loan impaired prior to being 90 days past due. These include, but are not limited to, ING Insurance Eurasia’s assessment of the customer’s perceived inability to meet its financial obligations, or the customer filing for bankruptcy or bankruptcy protection. In some cases, a material breach of financial covenants will also trigger a reclassification of a loan to the impaired category. ING Insurance Eurasia identifies those loans as impaired loans when it is likely that the principal and interest amounts contractually due will not be collected in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan agreements, based on current information and events. A formal analysis takes place quarterly to determine the provisions for possible bad debts, using a bottom-up approach. Conclusions are discussed in the Disclosure Committee, which advises the Management Board on specific provisioning levels.

During 2010 and 2011 there were no impairments for loans within ING Insurance Eurasia. Provisions reported here relate to personal loans and mortgages, and are mainly present in Benelux.

Provisions: ING Insurance Eurasia portfolio

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     73.0        55.1   

Write-offs

     (11.7     (4.9

Recoveries

     1.9        1.0   

Increase/(decrease) in loan loss provision

     19.7        21.6   

Exchange differences

     (0.2     0.2   

Other changes

     0.5        0.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     83.2        73.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIQUIDITY RISK

Liquidity risk refers to the risk that a company is unable to settle financial obligations when they fall due. Liquidity in this context is the availability of funds, or certainty that funds will be available without significant losses, to honour all commitments when due. ING Insurance Eurasia identifies two related liquidity risks: funding liquidity risk and market liquidity risk. Funding liquidity risk is the – primary – risk that ING Insurance Eurasia will not have the funds to meet its financial obligations when due. Market liquidity risk is the – secondary – risk that an asset cannot be sold without significant losses. The interrelation with funding liquidity stems from the fact that when payments are due, and not enough cash is available, investment positions need to be converted into cash. When Market liquidity is low, this would lead to a loss.

 

F-203


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Similar to other market risks, liquidity risk falls under the supervision of the Risk Committee. ING Insurance Eurasia maintains a liquidity policy that defines liquidity limits in line with risk tolerances. The Liquidity Management Principles include the following:

 

 

Interbank funding markets should be used to provide liquidity for day-to-day cash management purposes;

 

 

A portion of assets must be invested in unencumbered marketable securities that can be used for collateralised borrowing or asset sales;

 

 

Strategic asset allocation should reflect the expected and contingent liquidity needs of liabilities; and

 

 

Adequate and up-to-date contingency liquidity plans should be in place to enable management to act effectively and efficiently in times of crisis.

ING Insurance Eurasia defines three levels of Liquidity Management. Short term liquidity, or cash management covers the day-to-day cash requirements under normal business conditions and targets funding liquidity risk. Long term liquidity management considers business conditions, in which market liquidity risk materialises. Stress liquidity management looks at the company’s ability to respond to a potential crisis situation. Two types of crisis liquidity events can be distinguished: a market event and an ING Insurance Eurasia specific event. These events can be short-term or long-term and can both occur on a local, regional or global scale. Depending on the type of event, the policy also defines the composition of the crisis teams.

Liquidity risk is measured through several metrics including ratios and cash flow scenario analysis, in the base case and under several stressed scenarios.

OPERATIONAL RISK

Operational risk is defined as the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes the risk of reputational loss, as well as legal risk whereas strategic risks are not included. Operational risk also includes IT risk.

For Operational Risk ING Insurance Eurasia has developed a framework governing the process of identifying, assessing, mitigating, monitoring and reporting operational risks. The framework is based on the elements of the Enterprise Risk Management model of COSO (Committee of Sponsoring Organisations of the Treadway Commission). The Operational Risk capital calculation is described in the Economic capital section.

The Operational risk function works with the Operational Risk Management (ORM) Scorecard process to evaluate yearly the embedding level of the ORM Framework in each business. Policies and minimum standards governing the framework are kept in the policy house. During 2011 Operational Risk started with the implementation of this policy house in which the existing policies are kept in a well structured and easy to access manner.

Risk appetite is defined as the risk level management is prepared to tolerate. The operational risk appetite levels are set by the management team of ING Insurance Eurasia. Via Non Financial Risk Committees (NFRC’s) it is ensured that responsible line managers mitigate the risks that are not within the risk appetite. Incidents and operational risks are tracked and reported on a quarterly basis to management in the Non Financial Risk Dashboard.

Integrated risk assessments are performed at least once a year to determine the completeness of the risks in scope and the level of the risks. Mitigating actions are taken on those risks that are identified as risks beyond the risk appetite level. Status of the mitigating actions is tracked.

To ensure an independent Operational risk function and the possibility for the Operational risk officers to be impartial and objective when advising business management on Operational Risk in their Business Unit and Region, a dual reporting line, directly to Chief Risk Officer of their business and functionally to the next higher level Operational risk Officer, is in place. The head of Operational risk ultimately reports directly to the Deputy Chief Risk Officer.

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

Economic Capital ING Insurance Eurasia (99.5% undiversified) by Risk Category

 

     2011      2010  

Operational Risk

     640         633   

 

F-204


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

COMPLIANCE RISK

Compliance Risk is defined as the risk of damage to ING Insurance Eurasia’s integrity as a result of failure (or perceived failure) to comply with relevant laws, regulations, internal policies, procedures and ethical standards. In addition to reputational damage, failure to effectively manage Compliance Risk could expose ING Insurance Eurasia to fines, civil and criminal penalties, and payment of damages, court orders and suspension or revocation of licenses, which would adversely impact customers, staff and shareholders of ING Insurance Eurasia.

ING Insurance Eurasia separates Compliance Risk into four conduct-related integrity risk areas: client conduct, personal conduct, organisational conduct as well as conduct required because of laws and regulations in the financial services industry. In addition to effective reporting systems, ING Insurance Eurasia has a Whistleblower procedure which encourages staff to speak up if they know of or suspect a breach of external regulations or internal policies or Business Principles.

As a result of frequent evaluation of all businesses from economic, strategic and risk perspectives ING Insurance Eurasia continues to believe that doing businesses in Myanmar, North Korea, Sudan, Syria, Iran and Cuba should be discontinued. ING Insurance Eurasia has a policy not to enter into new relationships with clients from these countries and processes remain in place to discontinue existing relationships involving these countries.

ING Insurance Eurasia performs a due diligence process when developing products and invests considerably in the maintenance of risk management, legal and compliance procedures to monitor current sales practices. Customer protection regulations as well as changes in interpretation and perception by both the public at large and governmental authorities of acceptable market practices might influence client expectations. The risk of potential reputational and financial impact from products and sales practices exists because of the market situation, customer expectations, reported incidents and regulatory activity. As part of ING Insurance Eurasia’s customer centric commitment, Compliance Risk Management and the business work closely together to optimise both products and services to meet the customers’ needs.

ING Insurance Eurasia Compliance Risk Management has developed a framework governing the process of identifying, assessing, mitigating, monitoring and reporting compliance risks. The Compliance function works with the ORM Scorecard process to evaluate yearly the level in which the Compliance Risk Management Framework is embedded in each business.

To ensure an independent compliance function and the possibility for the Compliance Officers to be impartial and objective when advising business management on Compliance Risk in their Business Unit and Region, a dual reporting line, directly to General Management of their business and functionally to the next higher level Compliance Officer, is in place.

Main developments in 2011

 

 

Building Customer Trust – As part of ING Insurance Eurasia’s customer centric commitment, Compliance Risk Management and the business worked closely together to optimise both products and services to meet the customers’ needs.

 

 

Learning – Continuous education and awareness training was provided through face-to-face training sessions and online learning tools.

ING INSURANCE US

MISSION AND OBJECTIVES

As a financial services company active in investments, life insurance and retirement services ING Insurance US is naturally exposed to a variety of risks. The mission of risk management in ING Insurance US is to build a sustainable and competitive advantage by fully integrating risk management into daily business activities and strategic planning.

 

F-205


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The following principles support this objective:

 

 

A transparent communication to internal and external stakeholders on risk management and value creation

 

 

Compliance with internal and external rules and guidelines is monitored

 

 

Product and Portfolios are structured, underwritten, priced, approved and managed appropriately

 

 

The risk profile of ING Insurance US is transparent, managed to avoid surprises and is consistent with delegated authorities

 

 

Delegated authorities are consistent with the overall ING Insurance US strategy and risk appetite

RISK GOVERNANCE

The risk governance is based on the “three lines of defence” framework which ensures that risk is managed in line with the risk appetite as defined by the Management Board AIH (MB AIH) and ratified by the Supervisory Board and is cascaded throughout ING Insurance US.

For most of 2011 ING Insurance US executive management delegated risk governance to a financial risk committee called “Business Line Insurance US & BL US Closed Block Variable Annuity Asset Liability Committee”, the BL ALCO, and a non-financial risk committee called “Operational Risk Committee”.

 

 

BL ALCO

Provided oversight on all financial risk related issues for ING Insurance US.

Advised management on risk limits and appetites, approved investment mandates, oversaw assumption setting.

Implemented and monitored ING Group risk policies ensuring consistency across business units.

 

 

Operational Risk Committee

Addressed bottoms up business unit operational risk matters.

Coordinated across business units on issues including financial controls, business continuity, and information security.

Implemented and monitored ING Groups’ operational risk policies across business units.

In the last quarter of 2011, ING Insurance US transitioned to an expanded risk governance structure as described below.

 

LOGO

 

F-206


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Board level risk oversight

ING Insurance US has a two-tier board structure consisting of the Management Board AIH (MB AIH) and the Supervisory Board.

The Supervisory Board is responsible for supervising the policy of the MB AIH, the general course of affairs of the Company and its businesses. For Risk Management purposes the Supervisory Board is assisted by two sub-committees:

 

 

The Audit Committee assists in reviewing and assessing ING Insurance US’s major risks and the operation of internal risk management and control systems, as well as policies and procedures regarding compliance and its applicable laws and regulations;

 

 

The Risk Committee assists in matters related to risk governance, risk policies and risk appetite setting.

The Chief Risk Officer (CRO) attends the meetings of both committees. The MB AIH is responsible for managing the risks associated with the activities of ING Insurance US. The MB AIH responsibilities include ensuring the risk management and control systems are effective and ING Insurance US complies with relevant legislation and regulations. The MB AIH reports and discusses these issues on a regular basis with the Supervisory Board, and reports to the Audit Committee on a quarterly basis on ING Insurance US’s risk profile versus its risk appetite.

As part of the integration of risk management into the annual strategic planning process, the MB AIH issues a Planning Letter which provides the organization with the corporate strategic planning, and addresses key risk issues. Based on this letter the business lines develop their business plans, including qualitative and quantitative assessment of the risks involved. As part of the process strategic limits and risk appetite levels are explicitly discussed. Based on the business plans the Management Board formulates the Strategic plan which is submitted to the Supervisory Board for approval.

Executive Level

As noted above, during 2011 ING Insurance US transitioned from a financial risk committee called “Business Line Insurance US & BL US Closed Block Variable Annuity Asset Liability Committee” and a non-financial risk committee called “Operational Risk Committee” to the expanded structure described below.

For risk related issues the MB AIH relies on the Executive Committee which has delegated risk related tasks to the following committees:

 

 

Risk Committee

Assists the Executive Committee (EC) by focusing on ING Insurance US risk management and capital issues.

Advises the EC with respect to financial, non-financial, product and model risk issues (“All Risks”).

Recommends, approves and reviews risk policies and determines risk appetite, tolerance and limits.

The Risk Committee has a number of sub-committees focussing on different risk areas:

 

   

Product Committee

Oversees all insurance product risk issues across ING Insurance US. These include insurance risks and interest rate sensitivity (interest guarantees, profit sharing to policyholders, lapse/surrender or increased exposure of products sold, and hedges).

Responsible for preparation/approval on product risk items (e.g., product approval, actuarial assumption setting), monitoring underwriting and management of the product portfolio.

 

   

Operational Risk Committee

Oversees all non-financial risk issues across ING Insurance US. This includes operational, compliance, legal and reputation risk.

Responsible for preparation/pre-approval of non financial risk items, oversight on non-financial risk issues, and deciding on reported risks and proposed accepted risk.

 

   

Model Committee

Oversees all model and model validation risk issues across ING Insurance US.

Responsible for preparation/pre-approval of model risk items and oversight on model validation.

 

   

Asset Liability Committee

Reviews methods and techniques for calculating Asset Liability Management risk, advice about limits and check for breaches in the investment mandates.

Addresses balance sheet management, Statutory Capital requirements, and liquidity needs and recommend to the Executive Committee.

Oversees activities and initiatives related to ING Insurance US debt ratings and relationships with ratings agencies.

Recommends capital and liquidity requirements to the Risk Committee.

 

F-207


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

LOGO

Risk Management Function

The Chief Risk Officer bears primary and overall responsibility for the risk management function within ING Insurance US, which identifies, measures, monitors and reports risk within ING Insurance US. The risk function maintains and updates the policy framework, develops and maintains risk methodologies and advises on the risk tolerance and risk profile. The CRO makes sure both the Supervisory Board and MB AIH are well informed and understand ING Insurance US’s risk position at all times.

The ING Group CRO has delegated the day-to-day Risk Management within ING Insurance US to the ING Insurance US CRO. The ING Insurance US CRO’s department (US Enterprise Risk Management) consists of several risk functions that support the overall business unit and ING Insurance US risk management activities.

Risk committees are established at the ING Insurance US and business unit levels. The Chief Risk Officers of the business units have a reporting line to the ING Insurance US CRO.

 

LOGO

 

F-208


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

New Product Approval and Review Process

A critical aspect of risk management is that all new products are designed, underwritten and priced appropriately. Within ING Insurance US this is safeguarded by the Product Approval and Review Process (PARP). This standard includes requirements to risk profile, traditional and value-oriented pricing metrics, targets and documentation. The PARP includes requirements to assess market risks, insurance risk, compliance risk, legal risk, credit risk, operational risk as well as assessment of the administration and accounting aspects of the product. Customer suitability is integral part of the PARP requirements.

Reserve adequacy

US ERM instructs and supervises all ING Insurance US entities to ensure that the total insurance liabilities of ING Insurance US are tested for adequacy taking into account the insurance premium rate levels and the uncertainty of future returns on investments. This is done by evaluating insurance liabilities on current best estimate actuarial assumptions plus a risk margin, ensuring that the reserves remain adequate based on current assumptions. The assumed investment earnings are a combination of the run-off of portfolio yields on existing assets and new money and reinvestment rates. For new money and reinvestments long-term best estimate assumptions are taken into account, although current new money rates are used for the short-term reinvestments. For most products stochastic testing is required, taking the 90% point as the testing outcome. In the case where deterministic testing is used the 90% confidence level is achieved by subtracting risk margins of the best-estimate scenario.

Policies

ING has a framework of risk policies, procedures and practice notes in place to create consistency throughout the organisation, and to define minimum requirements that are binding on all business units. The governance framework of the business units aligns with the Insurance level framework and meets local (regulatory) requirements. Senior Management is responsible to ensure policies, procedures and standards are implemented and adhered to. Policies, procedures and practice notes are regularly reviewed and updated via the relevant risk committees to reflect changes in markets, products and emerging best practices.

Model governance

During 2011 new models with regard to the disclosed metrics were approved by the Insurance Model Committee at the ING Group level. Under the new governance structure this will be the responsibility of the ING Insurance US Model Committee.

ING INSURANCE US RISK FRAMEWORK

In order to manage the risk on a day-to-day basis and balance value, earnings and capital decisions, ING Insurance US has implemented a risk limit framework. The risk limit framework follows a top down approach.

 

     

Description

Risk Appetite

  

A qualitative measure defining the playing field ING Insurance US wants to act in. Driven by ING Insurance US’s capital rating targets and local capital restrictions, and business strategy

Risk Tolerance

  

A quantitative boundary intended to limit the risks taken driven by the risk appetite.

Risk Limits

  

Limit setting to a granular level for business units throughout the organization

The risk appetite is managed by the following risk tolerance metrics:

 

 

US Regulatory Capital Requirements- Defined as a multiple of the minimum capital required by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC) with consideration of the capital requirements deemed appropriate to maintain the ratings level issued to the operating companies by various rating agencies, excluding entities that are not US domiciled;

 

 

IFRS Earnings;

 

 

Targets are set on the current ratio values, limits are set on these ratios after considering a moderate stress scenario; and

 

 

ING Insurance US is considering the implementation of additional risk tolerance metrics, potentially including US GAAP Earnings, capital sensitivities that include non-US domiciled entities, and a US management version of Economic Capital (which may not fully align with Solvency II).

Financial Risks

For financial risks, the risk tolerance is translated to risk limits on several sensitivities assuming a moderate stress scenario.

 

F-209


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

 

US Regulatory Capital Requirements sensitivities

The potential reduction, under a moderately adverse market and credit stress scenario, of the excess of available statutory capital above the minimum required under the US regulatory Risk Based Capital (RBC) methodology. The RBC methodology is prescribed by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC) and applies to US domiciled regulated insurance entities. The amount of excess capital targeted is also dependent on rating agency models and requirements.

 

 

IFRS Earnings sensitivities

The sensitivity of realised pre tax earnings of the insurance operations over a 12 months period to moderate shocks to underlying risk factors.

Other than this, several other limit structures are put in place on corporate and business unit level. Examples include but are not limited to the following:

 

 

Issuer concentration limits

 

 

Mortality concentration limits

 

 

Catastrophe and mortality exposure retention

 

 

Minimum liquidity requirements

 

 

Investment and derivatives guidelines and limits

Financial Risk Management Board

ING Insurance US contributes to the Financial Risk Management Report (FRMR) that is discussed in the Risk Committee of the Supervisory Board. The report contains a qualitative summary of relevant risk topics in the specific business units.

Actuarial Opinion

ING Insurance US contributes to the Actuarial Opinion, a quarterly report to the Supervisory Board which highlights significant developments with respect to the adequacy of insurance liabilities, based on IFRS reserving principles. Developments that (could) have a significant impact on the IFRS P&L are also mentioned in the Actuarial Opinion. The Actuarial Opinion of the last quarter of the year is accompanied by an overview of the IFRS reserve adequacy test.

Financial Risk Dashboard

ING Insurance US contributes to the Financial Risk Dashboard (FRD), a report that is discusse quarterly in the Risk Committee of MB AIH and in the Financial Risk Committee. The FRD provides an overview of the main financial risk metrics compared to the limits set by management in alignment with the risk appetite.

Investment Risk Dashboard

On a quarterly basis the Investment Risk Dashboard (IRD) is prepared for the general account of ING Insurance US. The IRD is reported to the Risk Committee and provides management information on the porfolios. The IRD analyses how the portfolios developed over the quarter. It summarises market developments and provides several breakdowns of the portfolios to highlight (potential) risk concentrations in asset classes, industries, rating classes and individual names. Also given the crises, the IRD was further adapted to reflect more details and new views on some of the risks in ING Insurance US’s investment portfolios.

Non-Financial Risks

To ensure robust non-financial risk management, which also reflects the risk tolerance levels, ING Insurance US monitors the full implementation of ING Insurance US’s risk policies, minimum standards and implementation guidelines. Business units have to demonstrate that the appropriate steps have been taken to control their operational and compliance risk. ING Insurance US applies scorecards to measure the quality of the internal control within a business unit. Scoring is based on the ability to demonstrate that the required risk management processes are in place and effective within the business units.

Non-Financial Risk Dashboard

The Non-Financial Risk Dashboard (NFRD) is quarterly report that is discussed at the Supervisory Board, AIH Executive Committee, Risk Committee and ING Insurance US management bodies. The NFRD provides management at all organisations levels information on their key operational, compliance and legal risks. The NFRD is based on defined risk tolerance within the business and gives a clear description of the risks and responses enabling management to prioritise and to manage operational, compliance and legal risks.

 

F-210


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Stress Testing

ING Insurance US complements its regular risk reporting process with (ad hoc) stress tests. Stress testing examines the effect of exceptional but plausible scenarios on the capital position for ING Insurance US. Stress testing can be initiated internally or on certain request from external constituents.

RISK TYPE DESCRIPTION

ING Insurance US measures the following main types of risks that are associated with its business risk

 

 

Insurance risk – risks such as mortality and morbidity associated with the claims under insurance policies it issues/underwrites; specifically, the risk that premium rate levels and provisions are not sufficient to cover insurance claims.

 

 

Market risk – the risk of potential loss due to adverse movements in market variables. Market risks include interest rate, equity, real estate, implied volatility, credit spread, and foreign exchange risks.

 

 

Credit risk – the risk of potential loss due to default by ING Insurance US debtors (including bond issuers) or trading counterparties.

 

 

Business risk – the exposure to value loss due to fluctuations in volumes, margins and costs, as well as client behaviour risk. These fluctuations can occur because of internal, industry, or wider market factors. It is the risk inherent to strategy decisions and internal efficiency, and as such strategic risk is included in business risk.

 

 

Liquidity risk – the risk that ING or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities when they come due, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner. Liquidity risk can materialise both through trading and non-trading positions.

 

 

Operational risk – the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes reputation risk, as well as legal risk.

 

 

Compliance risk – the risk of damage to ING Insurance US’s integrity as a result of failure (or perceived failure) to comply with relevant laws, regulations, internal policies, procedures and ethical standards.

INSURANCE RISK

Insurance risks comprise of actuarial and underwriting risk such as mortality, longevity, morbidity etc. which result from the pricing and acceptance of insurance contracts.

The table below shows the main risk categories for insurance risks within ING Insurance US. IFRS Earnings sensitivities are defined on a shock scenario at the 90% confidence level.

 

    

Description

  

Key Drivers

Mortality

  

Within mortality risk there are two main parts:

 

•    Positive mortality risk exists when more insureds die than expected, leading to higher claims than expected.

 

•    Negative mortality risk exists when insureds live longer than expected, leading to higher claims than expected (moderate shocks are not material to the P&L)

  

The largest earnings sensitivity to positive mortality risk arises in the Retail Life insurance business.

Morbidity

  

Morbidity or Health insurance covers insurance indemnifying or reimbursing losses (e.g. loss of income) caused by illness or disability, or for expenses of medical treatment necessitated by illness or disability. Morbidity risk comprises the risk of variability of size, frequency and time to payment of future claims, development of outstanding claims and allocated loss adjustment expenses (ALAE) for morbidity product lines over the remaining contract period.

  

Earnings sensitivity to morbidity risk (e.g. sickness, disability, accidental death, workers’ compensation, medical insurance) is present in the Employee Benefits business.

Sensitivities

Mortality and morbidity sensitivities are calculated on a diversified basis at a 10% level assuming a normal probability distribution of results and a specified mortality/morbidity scenario to calibrate the distribution. The largest contribution to the mortality sensitivity comes from the Retail Life business while the morbidity exposure relates for a large part to the Employee Benefit business.

IFRS Earnings Sensitivities for Insurance Risks

 

     US Excl.
CB-VA
    CB-VA  
     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Mortality

     (19     (16     (7     (3

Morbidity

     (49     (48     0        0   

 

F-211


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Mitigation

In general insurance risks cannot be (easily) hedged directly at the financial markets and tends to be mitigated by diversification across large portfolios. They are therefore managed at the contract level through standard underwriting policies, product design requirements, independent product approval processes and risk limitations related to insurance policy terms and conditions agreed with the client.

Risk not mitigated by diversification is managed through concentration and exposure limits and through reinsurance and/or securitizations:

 

 

Tolerance limits for life insurance risk are set per insured life and significant mortality and morbidity events affecting multiple lives such as pandemics

 

 

Reinsurance is used to manage tolerance levels according to the ING Insurance US reinsurance credit risk policy.

 

 

Catastrophic losses resulting from events such as terrorism are considered to be uninsurable. ING Insurance US participates in industry pools in various countries to mitigate this risk.

BUSINESS RISK

Business risk for insurance is essentially the risk insurance operations accept as consequence of choosing to be in the business. In practice this can be defined as the exposure to the possibility that experience differs from expectations with respect to expenses, the run-off of existing business (persistency/renewals), future premium rerating, etc. Business Risk Capital is done by calculation of four components:

 

 

Persistency risk – the risk that actual persistency in the future of existing business develops adversely compared to expected persistency of existing business

 

 

Expense risk – the risk that actual expenses in the future exceed the expected costs

 

 

Premium re-rating risk (life business) – the risk that actual premium rate adjustments in the future are less than the expected premium adjustment

 

 

Political risk – The more general political risk will be included as part of Operational risk.

Each of these components is calculated separately, and combined to one business risk figure via the variance-covariance methodology.

MARKET RISK

ING Insurance US is exposed to market risk to the extent to which the market value of surpluses can be adversely impacted due to movements in financial markets. Changes in financial market prices impact the market value of ING Insurance US’s current asset portfolio and hedging derivatives directly as well as through the calculated market value of the insurance liabilities.

 

F-212


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The sensitivities shown are calculated at business unit level and cover US domiciled insurance entities. The sensitivities are based on moderate and simple to explain shocks to underlying risk factors. The following risk factors are taken into account:

 

        

Description

 

Key risk drivers

Interest Rate

  

-

 

Impact on assets and liabilities due to movements of interest rates

 

Sensitivities of various guarantees (e.g., minimum interest rate guarantees, and guaranteed living benefits). CB-VA and GMIRs of insurance products

  

-

 

Measured by the impact of a 1% upwards and downwards parallel shift of US Treasury curve

 

 

Equity

  

-

 

Impact of a drop in equity prices which impacts direct equity exposure and loss of fee income from variable and equity linked

 

Separate account and equity indexed business, and direct equity exposure

  

-

 

Measured by the impact of a 25% drop in equity prices

 

Credit (Default and Spread risk)

    

Impact that credit default risk can have on credit impairment levels in a “1 in 10” scenario (using “1 in 10” 1-year default rates by rating category, combined with stressed “Loss Given Default” assumptions); plus impact that a “1-in-10” increase in credit spreads levels can have on previously impaired structured assets (re-impairment risk) and on CDS transactions that are carried at market value

 

General account business

Implied Volatility (Equity & Interest Rates)

  

-

 

Impact of losses on assets and liabilities due to movements in the volatility implied from market option prices.

 

Embedded guarantees in business and derivatives used to hedge equity exposures

  

-

 

For interest rate – measured by the impact of a relative increase of 30% in implied swaption volatilities

 
  

-

 

For equity – measured by the impact of a relative increase in implied volatilities based on tenor – 80% for tenors less than 1 year, up 30% for tenors between 1 and 3 years, up 20% for tenors between 3-7 years and up 10% for tenors of 7 years and above

 

FX

  

-

 

Impact of losses related to changes in real estates

 

Translation risk of market value surplus of non-USD businesses

  

-

 

Measured by the worst case impact of a 10% up and down movement for each currency

 

Real Estate

  

-

 

Impact of losses related to changes in real estate

 
  

-

 

Measured by impact of all real estate down 15%

 

Sensitivities

The stress events are described above. The ING Insurance US earnings sensitivities are dominated by credit, equity and interest rate exposure.

ING Insurance US has no significant earnings sensitivity to Foreign Exchange Rates as ING Insurance US is managed on a local currency basis and therefore there is no translation risk to the Group reporting currency included. There is no significant earnings exposure to non-US currencies. From the ING Group perspective, there may be some translation risk between USD based operations and EUR basis.

ING Insurance US earnings sensitivies are shown in the tables below. Taking into account diversification between risk factors, ING Insurance US (excluding CBVA) is exposed to a EUR 1.0 billion decrease in expected IFRS Earnings within the context of the market and non-market sensitivity analysis. The changes from 2010 to 2011 are the result of many factors including:

 

 

Reduction in interest rates increasing exposure to further declines in rates due to product guarantees;

 

 

Hedging programs, including various actions taken to reduce the risk of declining rates;

 

 

Turnover of the asset portfolio; and

 

 

Incorporation of mean reversion in DAC calculations by Retirement Services;

IFRS Earnings Sensitivities for Market Risks (1)(2)

 

     US Excl. CB-VA  
     2011     2010  

Interest Rate Up

     72        13   

Interest Rate Down

     (146     (34

Equity

     (293     (374

Credit - Default

     (355     (513

Credit - Spread

     (188     (269

 

(1) 

Implied Volatility, FX and Real Estate sensitivities do not have a material impact.

(2) 

Sensitivities are calculated at business unit level.

 

Estimated CBVA Immediate Earnings Sensitivities at December 31, 2011          Immediate Change In Equity Market  
(EUR Millions)                                     
     -25     -15     -5     +5     +15     +25

Earnings sensitivity before RAT Policy Impact

     750        500        100        -250        -600        -900   

RAT Policy Impact (RAT50)

     -950        -600        -200        0        0        0   

Total estimated Post Refinement Earnings Sensitivity

     -200        -100        -100        -250        -600        -900   

Improvement in RAT 50 Sufficiency

     —          —          —          200        600        950   

 

F-213


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Due to the lack of excess reserve adequacy, CBVA results may be volatile under certain economic scenarios. This volatility is shown in the table above which shows the estimated sensitivity of IFRS earnings to immediate changes in equity markets. For, example, as of December 31, 2011 it is estimated that if equity markets were to increase 25%, CBVA would be exposed to an immediate EUR 0.9 billion decrease in IFRS Earnings and an increase in the reserve adequacy at the 50% confidence level of EUR 0.95billion. This immediate sensitivity is not directly comparable to the 12 months sensitivities shown in the preceding table.

The credit default exposure relates to general account debt securities. Exposure to Asset Backed Securities (ABS) and Residential Mortgage Backed Securities (RMBS) contributes significantly to the earnings sensitivity.

Mitigation

ING Insurance US manages its risk exposure through contractual adjustment mechanisms such as changes to credited rates, the contractual terms related to new business, adjusting its capital structure within regulatory constraints, and, where deemed appropriate, hedging various exposures.

Real Estate

ING Insurance US has a small exposure to direct real estate, which is composed primarily of Home Office real estate and real estate from foreclosed loans.

Real Estate Exposure

 

     2011      2010  

Total

     125         121   

CREDIT RISK

ING Insurance US credit exposure arises from the investment of insurance premiums in assets subject to credit risk, largely in the form of unsecured bond investments, investments in private placements and commercial mortgages, as well as in structured finance products. In addition, ING Insurance US is exposed to credit counterparty risk exposure in derivatives transactions, sell/repurchase transactions, securities lending/borrowing and in reinsurance contracts.

Within ING Insurance US, the goal is to maintain a low-risk, well diversified credit risk portfolio that meets or exceeds market based benchmark returns. ING Insurance US has a policy of maintaining a high-quality investment grade fixed income portfolio while avoiding large risk concentrations. The emphasis is on managing total exposure and concentration risk by means of portfolio level risk limits and concentration limits for countries, individual borrowers and borrower groups. Counterparty credit risk is mitigated by only transacting with counterparties that meet minimum credit quality standards as well as by requesting collateral for all larger exposures.

 

F-214


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The table below shows the main risk categories for credit risk within ING Insurance US.

 

   

Description

 

Key Drivers

Issuer or Investment Risk

 

•    Risk related to the impact of a credit default or rating migration, plus the risk that a change in general credit spread levels can have on the market value of these instruments

 

Investments in public bonds, commercial paper, securitisations and other publicly traded securities

 

 

•    Measured at original cost (purchase price) less any prepayments or amortisations and excluding any accrued and unpaid interest or the effects of any impairment.

 

 

Lending Risk

 

 

•    Risk related to certain illiquid investments made by ING Insurance US

 

 

Privately placed bonds and commercial mortgage loans in the United States.

 

 

•    Measured at original cost (purchase price) less any prepayments or amortisations and excluding any accrued and unpaid interest or the effects of any impairment.

 

 

Pre Settlement Risk

 

 

•    Risk of a counterparty defaulting on a transaction before settlement and ING Insurance US having to replace the contract by a trade with another counterparty at the then prevailing (possibly unfavourable) market price.

 

 

Options, swaps, and securities financing transactions used for hedging purposes

 

 

•    Measured as the replacement value (mark-to-market) plus a potential future volatility concept, using a 3-7 year historical time horizon and a 97.5% (1.96 standard deviations) confidence level.

 

Risk Profile

Risk classes

As a result of the downgrade of the United States Government in August 2011 by S&P, the exposure to AAA rated assets decreased to 16.5%. This resulted in a large “inflow” in the AA category, but that was offset by insurance companies where ING Insurance US has (collateralized) reinsurance counterparty risk were downgraded from AA to A. The 17-22 category largely consists of unrated exposures. The exposure to assets actually rated CCC or below is less than 3% of he portfolio.

Risk Classes: ING Insurance US portfolio, as % of total outstandings (1)

 

          ING Insurance US  
          2011     2010  
1   

(AAA)

     16.5     22.3
2-4   

(AA)

     13.7     13.9
5-7   

(A)

     25.3     23.4
8-10   

(BBB)

     24.0     21.3
11-13   

(BB)

     3.8     4.0
14-16   

(B)

     3.9     4.5
17-22   

(CCC, Unrated & Problem Grade)

     12.8     10.6
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        100     100
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Based on credit risk measurement contained in lending, pre-settlement, money market and investment activities. The ratings reflect probabilities of default and do not take collateral into consideration and are based on ultimate parent.

Risk concentration

The risk concentration per sector remains very similar to last year, with the largest decrease shown for Non-Bank Financial institutions which decreased by 2.9% Please note that this category largely consists of special purpose vehicles that issue RMBS, ABS and CMBS securities.

 

F-215


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Risk concentration: ING Insurance US portfolio, by economic sector (1)

 

     ING Insurance US  
     2011     2010  

Non-Bank Financial Institutions

     38.6     41.5

Real Estate

     8.5     7.9

Central Governments

     8.2     8.4

Natural Resources

     6.9     5.5

Utilities

     6.0     5.2

Commercial Banks

     4.4     3.4

Food, Beverages & Personal Care

     3.6     3.2

Chemicals, Health & Pharmaceuticals

     3.1     3.0

Private Individuals

     2.2     2.3

Telecom

     2.2     2.1

General Industries

     2.1     1.6

Other

     14.2     15.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Economic sectors below 2% are not shown separately but grouped in ‘Other’.

ING Insurance US largely invests in financial instruments issued in the United States, as required by regulation. Bonds and private placements issued by Western European corporations account for the majority of the non-US exposure. The decrease in exposures to the Netherlands is partially related to a reduction in the exposure to the Dutch state.

Largest economic exposures: ING Insurance US portfolio, by geographic area (1)

 

     ING Insurance US  
     2011     2010  

United States

     77.4     77.7

Netherlands

     5.7     8.2

Rest of Europe

     9.3     6.8

Rest of Americas

     4.4     4.2

Asia/Pacific

     3.0     3.0

Rest of World

     0.2     0.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Country is based on the country of residence of the obligor.

Securities Lending Business

As part of its securities financing business, ING Insurance US entities actively enter into agreements to sell and buy back marketable securities. These transactions can take many legal forms. Repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, buy/sellback and sell/buyback agreements, and securities borrowing and lending agreements are the most common. The amount of marketable securities that ING Insurance US held as collateral under these types of agreements was EUR 0.8 billion in 2011 and EUR 2 billion in 2010. The change is largely due to a decrease in repurchase agreements and the elimination of the Cash Release securities lending program. These amounts exclude the cash leg of the respective transactions, as well as any pledges of securities under Tri-Party agreements (as the underlying is not directly pledged to or owned by ING Insurance US). As a general rule, the marketable securities that have been received under these transactions are eligible to be resold or pledged in other (similar) transactions. ING is obliged to return equivalent securities in such cases.

Mitigation

Credit Risk in ING Insurance US portfolio is partially mitigated by collateral it has received.

 

F-216


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

 

The entire block of commercial mortgages (EUR 6.7 billion) is collateralized with mortgages on real estate properties. The weighted average loan to (most recent) value of this portfolio was 55% as per December 31, 2011.

 

 

The EUR 10 billion private placement portfolio is partially collateralized with assets pledged to the consortium of lenders.

 

 

The EUR 1.7 billion policy loan portfolio is fully collateralized by the cash value of the underlying insurance policies.

 

 

The gross counterparty risk exposure to reinsurance companies (EUR 5.8 billion per December 31, 2011) is largely collateralized with assets held in trust (EUR 4.0 billion), letters of credit (EUR 1.8 billion), or funds withheld (EUR 1.1 billion). Please note however that some exposures are overcollateralized and that there is a total of EUR 1.7 billion of uncollateralized reinsurance counterparty risk exposure.

 

 

Exposure to financial institutions related to OTC derivative-transactions is largely collateralized, in line with ISDA Master Agreements accompanied by Collateral Support Agreements that have been signed with these counterparties. As per December 31, 2011, ING Insurance US was holding net collateral of EUR 0.35 billion supporting a net market value exposure of EUR 0.5 billion.

Exposures related to Securities Lending, Reverse Repo, and exchange traded instruments are obviously also collateralized.

Problem Loans

ING Insurance US does not have any material past-due or impaired loans. The only type of investments that fall into the loan category are commercial mortgage loans. As soon as such loans become non-performing, the collateral is typically liquidated or the loan is sold.

Impaired loans and provisions

ING Insurance US mainly has bond investments. The amount of impaired loans in its portfolio is very small and limited to commercial mortgage loans.

LIQUIDITY RISK

Liquidity risk refers to the risk that a company is unable to settle financial obligations when they come due, at reasonable cost and in a timely manner. Liquidity risk can materialise both through trading and non-trading positions. As with other market risks, liquidity risk falls under the supervision of the Risk Committee function. Under the volatile market circumstances in 2011, funding and liquidity risk remains an important topic on the agenda of senior management and the Risk Committee, that needs continuous monitoring and management. External market and regulatory developments and internal financial developments are closely monitored. Regular stress testing and measurement of early warning indicators are, among others, used to provide additional management information.

ING Insurance US defines two levels of Liquidity Management. Short term liquidity, or cash management covers the day-to-day cash requirements under normally expected or likely business conditions. Long term liquidity management takes into consideration various expected and adverse business conditions, which might result in the inability of realising the current market values of the assets. The assets may only be sold at a further distressed price simply due to the lack of liquidity. Stress liquidity management looks at the company’s ability to respond to a potential crisis situation. The day-to-day and ongoing cash management allows for a more proactive response to potential liquidity problems in distressed markets. Liquidity risk is measured through several metrics including ratios and cash flow scenario analysis, in a base case and under several stressed scenarios.

OPERATIONAL RISK

Operational risk is defined as the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events. It includes the risk of reputation loss, as well as legal risk whereas strategic risks are not included. Operational risk also includes IT risk.

For Operational Risk, ING Insurance US follows the ING Group framework governing the process of identifying, assessing, mitigating, monitoring and reporting operational risks. The ING framework is based on the elements of the Enterprise Risk Management model of COSO (Committee of Sponsoring Organisations of the Treadway Commission).

 

F-217


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The Operational risk function works with the ING Operational Risk Management (ORM) Scorecard process to evaluate yearly the embedding level of the Operational Risk Management Framework in each business. Policies and minimum standards governing the framework are kept in the policy house. During 2011 Operational Risk started with the implementation of an ING Insurance US policy house in preparing for a stand-alone public organization.

Risk appetite is defined as the risk level management is prepared to tolerate. The operational risk appetite levels are set by ING Group in the form of a risk footprint. Via Operational Risk Committees (ORCs) it is ensured that responsible line managers mitigate the risks that are not within the risk appetite. Incidents and operational risks are tracked and on a quarterly basis reported to management in the Non-Financial Risk Dashboard.

Integrated risk assessments are performed on an ongoing basis across the organization. Mitigating actions are taken for those risks that are identified as risks beyond the risk appetite level. Status of the mitigating actions is formally tracked.

To ensure an independent Operational risk function and the possibility for the Operational risk officers to be impartial and objective when advising business management on Operational Risk, a dual reporting line, directly to ING Insurance US Chief Risk Officer and functionally to the next higher level ING Group Operational Risk Officer, is in place. The head of Operational risk ultimately reports directly to the ING Insurance US Chief Risk Officer.

ING INSURANCE US COMPLIANCE RISK

The ING Insurance US Compliance program and function are aligned with ING Group’s Compliance Risk Management Charter and Framework and the related processes described elsewhere in this Report.

The Scope of the Compliance function

The ING Insurance US Compliance function focuses on managing the risks arising from laws, regulations and standards which are specific to the financial services industry. The Compliance function actively educates and supports the business in managing compliance risks including anti-money laundering, preventing terrorist financing, conflicts of interest, sales practices for insurance and investment products, trading conduct and protection of customer interests.

The Compliance function

In ING Insurance US, the Compliance function is an independent control and risk management department. The ING Insurance US Chief Compliance Officer reports directly to the ING Insurance US Chief Legal Officer, who is a member of the ING Insurance US Executive Committee. The ING Insurance US Chief Compliance Officer also has a functional reporting line to the ING Group Chief Compliance Officer.

Compliance Risk Management Framework

ING Insurance US adheres to the ING Group Compliance Framework, which consists of three key components: the Compliance Risk Management process, an Advisory component and the Scorecard. ING Insurance US Compliance executes a regular process of identifying, assessing, mitigating, monitoring and reporting compliance risks. The Compliance function works with Operational Risk Management’s annual evaluation process, assessing the implementation of compliance program elements within each business line and across the enterprise.

ING Insurance US also maintains a Whistleblower process, which encourages staff to speak up, without fear of reprisal, if they know of or suspect a breach of laws, regulations or internal policies. ING Insurance US also maintains a domestic “hotline” operated by a third-party vendor that is available to all employees to report suspected misconduct, and reporting employees may elect to remain anonymous in doing so.

 

F-218


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Main Compliance developments in 2011

 

 

Policies & Procedures: ING Insurance US Compliance reviewed and prepared drafts of an updated Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, along with new or refreshed Corporate Compliance Policies tailored to the US business and regulatory regime. These will be issued and implemented in 2012.

 

 

Technology Enhancements: ING Insurance US Compliance enhanced technology and tools to improve compliance risk management in the areas of anti-money laundering, position reporting and personal trading.

 

 

Enterprise Functions: ING Insurance US Compliance enhanced its organization by implementing greater focus on consistent enterprise-wide compliance processes and dedicated teams to support critical functions across all business lines, including advertising review, customer complaint resolution, branch office compliance inspections and compliance training. Compliance also integrated its team and processes supporting all of the ING Insurance US wholesale broker-dealers in the Retirement, Insurance and Annuity Manufacturing business lines to provide more effective and consistent controls.

 

 

Extra-territorial Laws: The UK Bribery Act was effective July 1, 2011 and is deemed applicable to ING’s business globally. Accordingly, the ING Group Gifts, Entertainment and Anti-Bribery Policy was amended to comply with the UK Bribery Act, and ING Insurance US adopted and implemented the amended Group policy to enhance ING Insurance US’s existing anti-corruption and anti-bribery policies and procedures.

 

 

Employee Compliance Training: Continuous education and awareness training was provided through the ING Learning Center, with four required Corporate Responsibilities Courses for all ING Insurance US employees, in addition to two targeted courses on Privacy and Anti-Money Laundering for certain designated employees.

REGULATORY CAPITAL

For the capital adequacy assessment of ING Insurance’s US domiciled regulated insurance businesses, available capital is measured under US statutory accounting principles and required capital is measured under the US regulatory Risk Based Capital (RBC) methodology defined by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC). Commonly in the US an insurer’s financial strength and ability to meet policyholder obligations is measured in terms of the amount of statutory capital held in relation to the ‘Company Action Level’ RBC defined by the NAIC framework. Note that the level of capital required by rating agencies to maintain an acceptable claims paying ability rating is well above the regulatory minimum defined by Company Action Level RBC. Consequently ING Insurance US manages its available capital primarily with respect to capital metrics that are aligned with the models of the various rating agencies.

The relevant capital requirements of the ING US business units consist of statutory Risk Based Capital requirements (RBC) for its US domiciled business, along with additional requirements for the Cayman Islands based subsidiary Security Life of Denver International (SLDI). ING US targets a RBC ratio of 425% for its US-domiciled business.

The asset target for variable annuity (VA) business within SLDI is based on Actuarial Guideline 43 (AG 43), a reserve standard written by the US National Association of Insurance Commissioners. AG 43 prescribes reserves based on applying standardized economic scenarios under the Conditional Tail Expectation (CTE) approach, a scenario testing methodology. For rating agency purposes, ING US targets assets satisfying the CTE requirement in excess of the 95% confidence level.

Since Regulatory filings still need to be completed, the actual targets are not available yet, but the total US target is estimated at EUR 7.0 billion.

Regulatory Capital Sensitivities

ING Insurance US calculates regulatory capital sensitivities on the Risk Based Capital model in order to provide insight into how the amount of available capital in excess of regulatory required capital is sensitive to an increase or decrease in different market and credit risk factors under a moderate stress scenario which corresponds approximately with a 1-in-10 event. Regulatory capital sensitivities are calculated in aggregate for the US domiciled regulated insurance entities, and exclude any effects of the sensitivities on the capital of non-US domiciled entities.

The sensitivities shown are calculated at business unit level and cover US domiciled insurance entities. The sensitivities are based on moderate and simple to explain shocks to underlying risk factors. The following risk factors are taken into account:

 

 

Interest rates

 

F-219


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

 

 

Equity

 

 

Credit (credit default and credit spread risk)

 

 

Implied volatility (equity & interest rates)

 

 

Foreign exchange

 

 

Real Estate

The table previously shown in Market Risk section for Earnings at Risk is the same overview of the shock scenarios applied for regulatory capital sensitivities.

The regulatory capital sensitivity in aggregate is calculated by combining the joint impact of the various market stress events calculated by taking into account the correlations between risk types.

Sensitivities

The table below presents market risk sensitivity figures before diversification between risks. The stress events are described above.

Regulatory Capital Sensitivities (1)(2)

 

     US Excl. CB-VA     CB-VA  
     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Interest Rate Up

     2        (132     24        (6

Interest Rate Down

     (50     49        (226     27   

Equity

     (149     (55     (17     (168

Credit – Default

     (272     (366     (8     (12

Credit – Ratings Migration

     (410     (355     (21     (20

 

(1) 

Implied Volatility, FX and Real Estate sensitivities do not have a material impact.

(2) 

Sensitivities are calculated at business unit level and cover US domiciled insurance entities.

(3) 

Sensitivities shown are calculated relative to management targets that are a multiple of ‘Company Action Level’ RBC, and those shown in the 2010 annual report were based on ‘Company Action Level’ RBC.

The changes from 2010 to 2011 are the result of many factors including:

 

 

Reduction in interest rates increasing exposure to further declines in rates due to product guarantees;

 

 

Hedging programs, including various actions taken to reduce the risk of declining rates;

 

 

Hedging activities for Closed Block Variable Annuity related to both interest rates and equity exposure;

 

 

Turnover of the asset portfolio; and

 

 

Refinement of calculation of equity risk arising from hedge funds and limited partnerships was the primary driver of the increase in equity risk for US excluding CB-VA.

INSURANCE INVESTMENTS

The Insurance Investments business consists of certain parts of ING Insurance that will not be part of the divestment of the Latin American, Eurasian and US business. In the course of the divestment process of these businesses the composition of the Insurance Investments portfolio may change. Furthermore, at some stage parts of the Insurance Investments portfolio itself may be divested or closed down. In some cases this can take many years. Currently the most important parts of this portfolio are:

 

 

Financing activities of ING Insurance and some of it’s sub holdings;

 

 

Certain activities related to prior divestments, such as legal claims in Mexico and the ownership of a Mexican mortgage company;

 

 

ING’s stake in the Brazilian SulAmerica joint venture;

 

 

The run-off of former non-life and reinsurance activities.

The largest asset is the Brazilian SulAmerica joint venture with a balance sheet value of EUR 394 million. Insurance Investments is primarily the responsibility of the ING CFO. Winding down financing activities is delegated to ING Capital Management. Other Insurance Investments businesses are managed by the newly appointed General Manager Insurance Investments. Insurance Investments is supported by the Finance and Risk functions of ING Group. From a risk perspective a key element of this structure is support from Group functions such as Credit Risk, Market Risk, Operational Risk and Legal & Compliance and Internal Audit and from the Functional Controller Insurance.

 

F-220


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.2.2 CAPTITAL MANAGEMENT

OBJECTIVES

ING Group Capital Management (Capital Management) is responsible for the sufficient capitalisation of ING Group entities at all times in order to manage the risk associated with ING’s business activities. This involves the management, planning and allocation of capital within ING Group. ING’s Corporate Treasury is part of Capital Management. It executes the necessary capital market transactions, term (capital) funding and risk management transactions. Capital Management monitors and plans capital adequacy on a consolidated basis at three levels: ING Group, ING Insurance and ING Bank. Capital Management takes into account the metrics and requirements of regulators (Insurance Group Directive (IGD) Solvency I, Tier 1 and BIS ratios and limits for hybrid capital), rating agencies (leverage ratios, Adjusted Equity) and internal models such as the economic capital and market value balance sheet approach for parts of ING Insurance including Available Financial Resources (AFR).

ING applies the following main capital definitions:

 

 

Adjusted Equity (ING Group) – This rating agency concept is defined as shareholders’ equity plus core Tier 1 securities, hybrid capital and prudential filters. See ‘Capital Base’ disclosures in this section. This capital definition is applied in comparing available capital to core debt for ING Group;

 

 

Insurance Group Directive capital (ING Insurance) – This regulatory concept is defined as shareholders’ equity plus hybrid capital, prudential filters and certain adjustments. IGD capital is calculated in accordance with method 3 ‘method based on accounting consolidation’ of the Dutch Act on Financial Supervision. In this method the solvency margin is calculated on the basis of the consolidated accounts and is the difference of (i) the assets eligible for the inclusion in the calculation of the solvency margin based on the consolidated data; and (ii) the minimum amount of the solvency margin calculated on the basis of the consolidated data. In applying this method a solvency deficit of an insurance subsidiary, if any, is taken into account, as well as regulatory adjustments of the Dutch insurance subsidiaries based on the Dutch Act on Financial Supervision. See ‘Capital Base’ disclosures in this section. This capital definition is applied in comparing IGD capital to EU required capital base. This measurement of available capital is different from previous years;

 

 

AFR (ING Insurance Eurasia) –This is a pre-tax market value concept, defined for the insurance operations of ING Insurance Eurasia as the market value of assets (MVA) less the market value of liabilities (MVL) on the balance sheet. The liabilities do not include perpetual hybrid capital which is included in AFR. The AFR valuation of ING Eurasia includes an adjustment for portfolio illiquidity. The AFR for pension funds is set equal to the statutory net equity. AFR is used as the measure of available capital in comparison with Economic Capital employed.

 

 

EC, or Economic Capital (ING Insurance Eurasia), is the required capital for the insurance operations of ING Insurance Eurasia, based on a 99.5% confidence interval. This interval is aligned with the Solvency II capital requirement. The EC for pension funds is based on sectoral rules. The excess of AFR over EC is set based on the business strategy and resulting risk appetite defined by the Management Board Eurasia.

 

 

Risk Based Capital (Domestic ING US Insurance only). In the US, regulators have well developed capital adequacy models and stress tests that reflect the unique characteristics of the US insurance industry. US domiciled insurance legal entities are required to hold minimum capital levels by state insurance regulators. The level of capital required by rating agencies to maintain an acceptable claims paying ability rating is well above these levels. The Domestic US Insurance business manages its statutory surplus primarily with respect to capital metrics that are aligned with the models of the various ratings agencies.

 

 

Financial Leverage (ING Insurance). Financial Leverage is the sum of hybrid capital, sub-debt and net financial debt and is used to measure the debt ratio of ING Insurance starting 2010.

DEVELOPMENTS

In 2011 Capital Management’s main focus remained to strengthen the capital position of ING Group, ING Bank and ING Insurance. ING’s capital positions are well placed to deal with the uncertain financial environment, increasing regulatory requirements and the ambition to repay the remaining outstanding Core Tier 1 securities. Capital Management started looking at separate US, Eurasia and Insurance Investments Financial Leverage and Capital Adequacy in 2011.

 

F-221


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

In May ING repaid EUR 2 billion of the Core Tier 1 securities issued in November 2008 at a 50% premium. Nevertheless ING maintained a strong capital position, driven mainly by strong capital generation at ING Bank. ING Bank met the additional capital requirements proposed by the EBA and agreed by the EU Council on October 26, 2011. In December 2011, ING successfully completed a liability management transaction with an average participation of 60%. The net impact of this transaction on ING Group’s consolidated balance sheet was a reduction of EUR 2 billion in hybrid capital and a capital gain of EUR 0.7 billion.

On March 8, 2012, in preparation of the planned insurance and investment management divestments, ING Group has announced three separate exchange offers and consent solicitations on a total of three series of senior securities of ING Verzekeringen N.V. with a total nominal value of EUR 2.6 billion. The objective of the transaction is to remove potential ambiguity that the planned divestments may create with regard to these ING Verzekeringen N.V. securities, predominantly with regard to the Change of Control clauses which may be triggered at the time of a substantial asset disposal. The transaction is scheduled to be completed in April 2012. Any difference between the book value of the currently outstanding securities and the fair value of the newly issued securities will be recognised in the profit and loss account upon completion of the exchange.

In 2011 ING Bank issued a total of EUR 23 billion long-term funding against EUR 10.7 billion of ING Bank’s (including subsidiaries) long-term debt maturing.

POLICIES

The activities of Capital Management are executed on the basis of established policies, guidelines and procedures. The main documents that serve as guidelines for capital planning are the Capital Letter (comprising the approved targets and limits for capital), the Capital Planning Policy, the Dividend Policy and the Capital Request Policy. For the Corporate Treasury there are many policies and limits that guide the management of the balance sheets and the execution of capital market transactions.

The above capital definitions and policies have been approved by the ING Group Executive Board or delegated authorities.

PROCESSES FOR MANAGING CAPITAL

In addition to measuring capital adequacy, Capital Management also ensures that sufficient capital is available through setting targets and limits relevant to the above mentioned metrics for ING Group, ING Bank, and ING Insurance and ensuring adherence to the set limits and targets through planning and executing capital management transactions. The process is supplemented by stress testing and scenario analysis. The ongoing assessment and monitoring of capital adequacy is embedded in Capital Management’s capital planning process and results in a quarterly capital update report which is presented to both the ING Group Finance and Risk Committee and the ING Group Executive and Supervisory Boards. The main objective of the assessment is to ensure that ING Group as a whole has sufficient capital relative to its risk profile both in the short and the medium term.

A key priority of Capital Management is to make sure that strong stand-alone companies are created for banking and insurance in preparation of the separation. All operating entities need to stay adequately capitalised based on local regulatory and rating agency requirements and interdependencies should be reduced to a minimum. The entities should also be able to access capital markets independently.

CAPITAL ADEQUACY ASSESSMENT

During 2011, ING Group, ING Bank and ING Insurance were adequately capitalised.

 

F-222


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING Group’s Capital base

 

     Group     Bank     Insurance  
     2011     2010 (1)     2011     2010     2011     2010 (1)  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     42,452        37,719        30,156        31,266        23,475        20,159   

Core Tier 1 securities

     3,000        5,000           

Group hybrid capital (2)

     9,332        12,039        6,850        8,438        2,604        2,094   

Group leverage (3)

     7,917        8,462           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capitalisation

     62,701        63,220        37,006        39,705        26,079        22,253   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjustments to equity:

            

Revaluation reserve debt securities

     (4,142     (1,158     213        (19    

Revaluation reserve crediting to life policyholders

     3,492        1,488           

Revaluation reserve cash flow hedge

     (1,970     (847     822        639        (2,883     (1,567

Goodwill (4)

     (2,006     (2,908     (1,390     (1,645     (786     (1,425
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revaluation reserves fixed income & other

     (4,626     (3,425     (355     (1,025     (3,669     (2,992

Revaluation reserves excluded from Tier 1 (5)

         (2,043     (2,212    

Insurance hybrid capital (6)

             1,726        2,250   

Excess hybrid capital (7)

       (43           (43

Minority interests

         817        749        62        111   

Differences IFRS-IASB and IFRS-EU (8)

     4,211        3,185        4,211        3,185       

Deductions Tier 1

         (1,014     (1,069    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tier 1 capital for Bank

         38,622        39,333       

Other qualifying capital (9)

         8,502        9,813       

Insurance Group Directive adjustments (10)

             (2,792     (1,244

Group leverage (core debt)

     (7,917     (8,462        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital (Adjusted Equity for Group, BIS capital for Bank and IGD capital for Insurance)

     54,369        54,475        42,913        49,145        21,406        20,335   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

These numbers have been restated to reflect the move towards fair value accounting for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for life in the US closed block VA as of January 1, 2011. Further details on the restatement are available in the Accounting Policies for the consolidated annual accounts of ING Group under ‘Changes in accounting policies’.

(2) 

Tier 1 instruments issued by ING Group (e.g. perpetual debt securities and preference shares) at nominal value. Group hybrid Tier 1 instruments other than preference shares are provided as hybrid capital to ING Bank or ING Insurance.

(3) 

Investments in subsidiaries less equity (including core Tier 1 securities) of the Group holding company. This net debt position is provided as equity to ING Insurance and ING Bank.

(4) 

According to the regulatory definition

(5) 

Includes mainly EUR (1,247) million (2010: EUR (1,727 million) in participations (e.g. Kookmin, Bank of Beijing) and other equity investments, EUR (355) million (2010: EUR (382) million) for Real estate for own use and EUR (441) million (2010: EUR (107 million) for own credit risk. The Dutch banking regulator requires this deduction to be made from Tier 1 capital. This deduction is added back to Tier 2 capital.

(6) 

Qualifying dated subordinated debt issued by ING Insurance at nominal value.

(7) 

Excess Insurance hybrids over the regulatory cap need to be deducted from both Insurance and Group capital.

(8) 

Capital measures exclude the difference between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB as capital measures are based on IFRS-EU as primary accounting basis for statutory and regulatory deductions.

(9) 

Consists of EUR 9,516 million (2010: EUR 10,882 million) Tier 2 capital and no Tier 3 (2010: nil), offset by EUR 1,014 million (2010: EUR 1,069 million) of regulatory deductions.

(10) 

An adjustment for the Dutch Financial supervision act. A ‘test-of-adequacy’ has to be included in the available capital measurement. The revaluation reserve debt securities and revaluation reserve crediting to life policyholders are not reversed out of the IGD capital definition.

REGULATORY REQUIREMENTS

ING BANK

Capital adequacy and the use of regulatory required capital are based on the guidelines developed by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (The Basel Committee) and the European Union Directives, as implemented by the Dutch Central Bank (DNB) for supervisory purposes. The minimum Tier 1 ratio is 4% and the minimum total capital ratio (known as the BIS ratio) is 8% of all risk-weighted assets.

Basel II

As of 2008 ING Bank publishes risk-weighted assets (RWA), Tier 1 and BIS capital and the accompanying capital ratios based on Basel II data only. In addition, ING publishes the minimum required capital level according to Basel II and according to the Basel I floor. As of 2009 the Basel I floor is based on 80% of Basel I RWA. The minimum requirements according to Basel II and Basel I are both compared to total BIS available capital according to Basel II.

 

F-223


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

EBA capital exercise

An additional capital exercise was proposed by the EBA and agreed by the Council on October 26, 2011. This exercise required banks to strengthen their capital positions by building up a temporary capital buffer against sovereign debt exposures to reflect current market prices. In addition, it required them to establish a buffer such that the Core Tier 1 capital ratio reaches a level of 9% by the end of June 2012. ING Bank already meets the 9% Core Tier 1 ratio after the removal of the prudential filters on sovereign assets in the Available-for-Sale portfolio and prudent valuation of sovereign debt in the Held-to-Maturity and Loans and receivables portfolios, reflecting current market prices.

Capital position of ING Bank

 

     2011     2010  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     30,156        31,267   

Differences IFRS-IASB and IFRS-EU (1)

     4,211        3,185   

Minority interests (2)

     817        748   

Subordinated loans qualifying as Tier 1 capital (3)

     6,850        8,438   

Goodwill and intangibles deductible from Tier 1 (1)

     (1,390     (1,645

Deductions Tier 1

     (1,014     (1,069

Revaluation reserve (4)

     (1,008     (1,592
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Available capital – Tier 1

     38,622        39,332   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplementary capital – Tier 2 (5)

     9,516        10,882   

Available Tier 3 funds

    

Deductions

     (1,014     (1,069
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

BIS capital

     47,124        49,145   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets

     330,421        321,103   

Core Tier 1 ratio

     9.62     9.62

Tier 1 ratio

     11.69     12.25

BIS ratio

     14.26     15.30

Required capital based on Basel I floor (6)

     31,107        29,860   

BIS ratio based on Basel I floor (6)

     12.12     13.17

 

(1) 

Capital measures exclude the difference between IFRS-EU and IFRS-IASB as capital measures are based on IFRS-EU as primary accounting basis for statutory and regulatory reporting.

(2 

According to the regulatory definition

(3) 

Subordinated loans qualifying as Tier 1 capital have been placed by ING Groep N.V. with ING Bank N.V.

(4) 

Includes revaluation debt securities, revaluation reserve cash flow hedge and revaluation reserves equity and real estate (see ING’s Capital base table, footnote 5).

(5) 

Includes eligible lower Tier 2 loans and revaluation reserves equity and real estate revaluations removed from Tier 1 capital.

(6) 

Using 80% of Basel I Risk-Weighted Assets.

 

F-224


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

ING INSURANCE

The table below shows the Insurance Group Directive which represents the consolidated regulatory Solvency I position of ING Insurance business. The Insurance companies complied with their respective local regulatory requirements.

Capital position of ING Insurance

 

     2011     2010 (1)  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     23,475        20,159   

Hybrids issued by ING Group (2)

     2,604        2,094   

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance (3)

     1,726        2,207   

Required regulatory adjustments

     (6,399     (4,125
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

IGD capital

     21,406        20,335   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

EU required capital base (4)

     9,515        8,826   

IGD Solvency I ratio (4,5)

     225     230

 

(1) 

These numbers have been restated to reflect the move towards fair value accounting for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for life in the US closed block VA as of January 1, 2011. Further details on the restatement are available in the Accounting Policies for the consolidated annual accounts of ING Group under ‘Changes in accounting policies’.

(2) 

Hybrids issued by ING Group at notional value

(3) 

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance at notional value capped at 25% of EU required capital

(4)

In the fourth quarter 2011, ING has reviewed the calculation of the IGD ratio to ensure consistent application throughout the Group. As a consequence, several changes have been made, mainly related to (i) certain provisions which are internally reinsured and for which required capitals were netted out in the past and (ii) changes in the allocation of policyholder liabilities to the relevant capital requirement categories. The reported IGD Solvency I ratio in 2010 of 250% has been adjusted for this change into 230%.

(5) 

The actual required regulatory adjustments for IGD capital and the EU required capital may be different from the estimate since the statutory results are not final until filed with the regulators.

ING Insurance continues to aim that all operating entities are adequately capitalised based on local regulatory and rating agency requirements and that on a consolidated basis, the financial leverage (hybrids, sub-debt and net financial debt) of ING Insurance is appropriate. The financial leverage decreased in 2011 mainly due to the divestment of the business in Latin America.

Capital base and financial leverage of ING Insurance

 

     2011     2010 (1)  

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     23,475        20,159   

Revaluation reserve debt securities

     (4,379     (1,164

Revaluation reserve crediting to life policyholders

     3,492        1,488   

Revaluation reserve cash flow hedge

     (2,883     (1,567

Goodwill

     (786     (1,425

Minority interests

     62        111   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital base

     18,981        17,602   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Group Hybrid capital (2)

     2,617        2,094   

Insurance hybrid capital (3)

     1,751        2,313   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total hybrids

     4,368        4,407   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

External debt issued by ING Verzekeringen N.V.

     2,855        3,347   

External debt issued by US Holding companies

     930        1,384   

Other net financial debt (4)

     1,686        2,273   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial debt

     5,471        7,004   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

These numbers have been restated to reflect the move towards fair value accounting for Guaranteed Minimum Withdrawal Benefits for life in the US closed block VA as of January 1, 2011. Further details on the restatement are available in the Accounting Policies for the consolidated annual accounts of ING Group under ‘Changes in accounting policies’.

(2) 

Hybrids issued by ING Group at amortised cost value consistent with IFRS carrying value

(3) 

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance at amortised cost value consistent with IFRS carrying value

(4) 

Includes net internal borrowings from the operating subsidiaries, net of cash and current tax liability at the at the holding level and current tax liability of the holding companies, mainly ING Verzekeringen N.V. and ING America Insurance Holdings Inc.

For ING Insurance in total, the capital base for financial leverage purposes is fully based on IFRS accounting, whereas the IGD capital is corrected for some regulatory adjustments. The table below provides a reconciliation.

 

F-225


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

Reconciliation between IGD capital and Capital base:

 

     2011      2010  

IGD Capital

     21,406         20,335   

Hybrids issued by ING Group

     -2,604         -2,094   

Hybrids issued by ING Insurance

     -1,726         -2,207   

Revaluation reserve debt securities

     -4,379         -1,164   

Revaluation reserve crediting to life policyholders

     3,493         1,488   

Required regulatory adjustments

     2,791         1,244   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital base

     18,981         17,602   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

For ING Insurance Eurasia, Available Financial Resources (AFR) continues to be important, especially as an evolving proxy for the Own Funds derivation from our internal model under Solvency II. The following table presents the reconciliation from the AFR 2010 for Insurance excluding US as reported in the Annual Accounts 2010, to the comparable basis for Eurasia 2011. This reflects the changes in scope and methodology.

2010 AFR and EC reconciliation

 

amounts in billions of euros    AFR     EC  

As reported for ING Insurance excluding US in 2010

     19.7        10.4   

Excluding non-ING Insurance Eurasia AFR and EC

     1.4        (2.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

ING Insurance Eurasia 2010, before changes

     21.1        8.4   

Change pension funds fee business to statutory basis

     (1.5     (0.1

Change in models and methodology

     (1.0     3.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

ING Insurance Eurasia 2010, on a basis comparable to 2011

     18.6        11.3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The exclusion of non-ING Insurance Eurasia AFR and EC mainly relates to the business in Latin America and the financial leverage of ING Insurance excluding US that was considered in last year’s AFR position and EC. The capital structure of Eurasia underlying the AFR does not include any senior debt.

The fee-based pension funds business in Central and Eastern Europe is regulated by local sectoral rules rather than by Solvency II regulations for insurance entities. AFR and EC of the fee-based pensions administration business were previously calculated using market consistent valuation approach. This has been replaced by using the statutory net equity and required capital of the pension funds administration companies. The impact on AFR is EUR 1.5 billion and on EC EUR 0.1 billion.

ING Insurance Eurasia has carried out a review of the internal model in the context of a Solvency II gap analysis. This to further align with Solvency II legislation. In that review we benchmarked our models against the Solvency II Standard Formula, the EIOPA consultation papers and comments of expert groups like CRO Forum and Groupe Consultatif. In the Annual Report 2010 it was estimated that these changes would result in a material increase of EC, between EUR 1 billion and EUR 2 billion. During 2011 further refinements and analyses took place which on a comparable basis would lead to an increase in the EC of 2010 of EUR 3.0 billion. The changes are related to equity risk (EUR 0.6 billion), operational risk (EUR 0.1 billion), credit spread and illiquidity premium risk (EUR 1.3 billion), business risk (EUR 0.1 billion) and less diversification (EUR 0.9 billion). The changes mainly due to new illiquidity premium method resulted in an AFR decrease of EUR 1.0 billion. The Solvency II legislative process is still ongoing. In particular, aspects determining the valuation of the policyholder liabilities and thereby the sensitivity to market and other risk factors on the own funds are not yet settled. The Economic Capital model will continue to be updated to reflect most recent market data, developments in best practices, and Solvency II legislation.

At the end of 2010 the AFR for ING Insurance Eurasia was EUR 18.5 billion. As described in the Risk Management section. EC, based on 99.5% confidence interval was EUR 11.4 billion, which leads to excess of AFR over EC for 2010 of EUR 7.1 billion. For 2011 the AFR is EUR 17.3 billion, EC is EUR 10.5 billion and the excess of AFR over EC is EUR 6.8 billion.

 

F-226


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the capital adequacy assessment of ING Insurance’s US domiciled regulated insurance business, available capital is measured under US statutory accounting principles and required capital is measured under the US regulatory Risk Based Capital (RBC) methodology as prescribed by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC). For ING’s US domiciled regulated insurance business, the consolidated RBC ratio (available capital/required capital) is estimated to be approximately 488% for the period ended December 31, 2011. The actual US consolidated RBC ratio may be different from the estimate since the statutory results are not final until filed with the regulators. For ING Insurance’s US domiciled regulated insurance business, the RBC ratio was 426% at the end of 2010.

ING GROUP

The debt/equity ratio of ING Group as at year-end 2011 was 12.71% (2010: 13.44%).

ING Group reports to the Dutch Central Bank as required under the Dutch implementation of the financial conglomerates directive (FICO). The directive mainly covers risk concentrations in the group, intra-group transactions and an assessment of the capital adequacy of the Group.

In the following table, we show the Group’s FICO ratio on the following basis:

 

 

Insurance required capital from applying European Solvency I rules to all ING Insurance entities globally (regardless of local capital requirements);

 

 

Bank required capital based on applying Basel II with the Basel I floor (80% of Basel I Risk Weighted Assets);

 

 

Group FICO capital using an approach similar to that used for Bank BIS capital and Insurance IGD capital whereby Group leverage is deducted.

Regulatory capital adequacy ING Group

 

     2011     2010  

BIS capital

     47,123        49,145   

IGD capital

     21,406        20,336   

Group leverage (core debt)

     (7,917     (8,462
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Regulatory capital

     60,612        61,019   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Required capital banking operations

     31,107        29,860   

Required capital insurance operations

     9,515        8,826   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total required capital

     40,622        38,686   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

FICO ratio

     149     158

Capital adequacy and ratios

Quantitative disclosures on capital measures and ratios

 

     Group     Bank     Insurance  
     2011     2010     2011     2010     2011     2010  

Tier 1 ratio (Bank)

            

Year-end actual Tier 1 ratio

         11.69     12.25    

Regulatory minimum Tier 1 ratio

         4.00     4.00    

Target minimum Tier 1 ratio

         10.00     10.00    

BIS ratio (Bank)

            

Year-end actual BIS ratio

         14.26     15.30    

Regulatory minimum BIS ratio

         8.00     8.00    

Target minimum BIS ratio

         10.00     10.00    

Insurance Groups Directive

            

Year-end actual Capital coverage ratio

             225     230

Required capital

             100     100

Target ratio

             150     150

Debt/Equity ratio (Group)

            

Debt/Equity ratio

     12.71     13.44        

Target maximum Debt/Equity ratio

     15.00     15.00        

 

F-227


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

The Tier 1 ratio and the BIS ratio are regulatory requirements. Internally ING manages on the Core Tier 1 ratio, for which the target was raised from 8.0% to 8.5% in 2011. The actual ratios were 9.62% at the end of 2010 and also 9.62% at the end of 2011. ING expects the BIS ratio to lose its meaning.

Main credit ratings of ING at December 31, 2011

 

     Standard & Poor’s    Moody’s    Fitch
     rating      outlook    rating      outlook    rating      outlook

ING Groep N.V.

                 

– long term

     A       stable      A1       stable      A       stable

ING Bank N.V.

                 

– short term

     A-1            P-1            F1+      

– long term

     A+       stable      Aa3       stable      A+       stable

– financial strength

           C+            

ING Verzekeringen N.V.

                 

– short term

     A-2            P-2            F2      

– long term

     A-       negative      Baa2       developing      A-       negative

ING’s key credit ratings and outlook are shown in the table above. Each of these ratings reflects only the view of the applicable rating agency at the time the rating was issued, and any explanation of the significance of a rating may be obtained only from the rating agency.

A security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and each rating should be evaluated independently of any other rating. There is no assurance that any credit rating will remain in effect for any given period of time or that a rating will not be lowered, suspended or withdrawn entirely by the rating agency if, in the rating agency’s judgment, circumstances so warrant. ING accepts no responsibility for the accuracy or reliability of the ratings.

 

F-228


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

AUTHORISATION OF ANNUAL ACCOUNTS

Amsterdam, March 12, 2012

 

THE SUPERVISORY BOARD

 

THE EXECUTIVE BOARD

Jeroen van der Veer, chairman

 

Jan H.M. Hommen, CEO and chairman

Peter A.F.W. Elverding, vice-chairman

 

Patrick G. Flynn, CFO

J.P. (Tineke) Bahlmann

 

Henk W. Breukink

 

Sjoerd van Keulen

 

Piet C. Klaver

 

Joost Ch.L. Kuiper

 

Aman Mehta

 

Luc A.C.P. Vandewalle

 

Lodewijk J. de Waal

 

 

F-229


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.3 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION

The following financial information presents the balance sheets for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the profit and loss accounts and statements of cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 of (i) ING Groep N.V. (parent company only), (ii) subsidiaries, (iii) the eliminations necessary to arrive at the information for ING on a consolidated basis and (iv) the total for ING Group. The principles of determination of results stated in connection with the profit and loss account are also applicable to the ING Groep N.V. parent only column. Investments in group companies and investments in associates are initially recognized at cost and subsequently accounted for by the equity method of accounting.

 

F-230


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.3.1 CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET

For the year ended December 31, 2011

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries      Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

ASSETS

         

Cash and balances with central banks

     (1,400     31,194         1,400        31,194   

Amounts due from banks

       45,323           45,323   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss:

         

– trading assets

       123,688           123,688   

– investments for risk of policyholders

       116,438           116,438   

– non-trading derivatives

       17,159           17,159   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

       5,437           5,437   

Investments:

         

– available-for-sale

       208,539           208,539   

– held-to-maturity

       8,868           8,868   

Loans and advances to customers

       596,877           596,877   

Reinsurance contracts

       5,870           5,870   

Investments in associates

     65,853        2,370         (65,853     2,370   

Real estate investments

       1,670           1,670   

Property and equipment

       2,886           2,886   

Intangible assets

       3,558           3,558   

Deferred acquisition costs

       10,204           10,204   

Assets held for sale

       62,483           62,483   

Other assets

     488        30,528           31,016   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     64,941        1,273,092         (64,453     1,273,580   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY

         

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     42,452        53,733         (53,733     42,452   

Non-voting equity securities

     3,000             3,000   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     45,452        53,733         (53,733     45,452   

Minority interests

       777           777   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     45,452        54,510         (53,733     46,229   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

         

Subordinated loans

     10,017           (1,159     8,858   

Debt securities in issue

     5,500        134,361           139,861   

Other borrowed funds

     2,716        26,081         (9,113     19,684   

Insurance and investment contracts

       278,833           278,833   

Amounts due to banks

       72,233           72,233   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

       466,647         900        467,547   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss:

         

– trading liabilities

       107,682           107,682   

– non-trading derivatives

     153        22,165         (153     22,165   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

       13,021           13,021   

Liabilities held for sale

       64,265           64,265   

Other liabilities

     1,103        33,294         (1,195     33,202   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     19,489        1,218,582         (10,720     1,227,351   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity and liabilities

     64,941        1,273,092         (64,453     1,273,580   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-231


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the year ended December 31, 2010

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
     Subsidiaries      Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

ASSETS

          

Cash and balances with central banks

     72         13,072         (72     13,072   

Amounts due from banks

        51,828           51,828   

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss:

          

– trading assets

        125,675           125,675   

– investments for risk of policyholders

        120,481           120,481   

– non-trading derivatives

        11,722           11,722   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

        6,016           6,016   

Investments:

          

– available-for-sale

        222,547           222,547   

– held-to-maturity

        11,693           11,693   

Loans and advances to customers

        608,938           608,938   

Reinsurance contracts

        5,789           5,789   

Investments in associates

     62,838         3,925         (62,838     3,925   

Real estate investments

        1,900           1,900   

Property and equipment

        6,132           6,132   

Intangible assets

        5,372           5,372   

Deferred acquisition costs

        10,499           10,499   

Assets held for sale

        681           681   

Other assets

     463         36,006           36,469   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     63,373         1,242,276         (62,910     1,242,739   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY

          

Shareholders’ equity (parent)

     37,719         51,435         (51,435     37,719   

Non-voting equity securities

     5,000              5,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     42,719         51,435         (51,435     42,719   

Minority interests

        729           729   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     42,719         52,164         (51,435     43,448   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES

          

Subordinated loans

     11,766            (1,121     10,645   

Debt securities in issue

     6,571         129,033           135,604   

Other borrowed funds

     500         31,201         (9,410     22,291   

Insurance and investment contracts

        271,128           271,128   

Amounts due to banks

        72,852           72,852   

Customer deposits and other funds on deposit

        511,934         (572     511,362   

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss:

          

– trading liabilities

        108,050           108,050   

– non-trading derivatives

     236         17,782         (236     17,782   

– designated as at fair value through profit and loss

        12,707           12,707   

Liabilities held for sale

        424           424   

Other liabilities

     1,581         35,001         (136     36,446   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     20,654         1,190,112         (11,475     1,199,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity and liabilities

     63,373         1,242,276         (62,910     1,242,739   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-232


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.3.2 Consolidating profit and loss account

For the year ended December 31, 2011

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
     Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

CONTINUING OPERATIONS

         

Income

         

Interest income banking operations

        64,649          64,649   

Interest expense banking operations

        (51,200       (51,200
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest result banking operations

        13,449          13,449   

Gross premium income

        27,198          27,198   

Investment income

        6,808          6,808   

Net result on disposals of group companies

        855          855   

Gross commission income

        6,003          6,003   

Commission expense

        (1,966       (1,966
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commission income

        4,037          4,037   

Valuation results on non-trading derivatives

        292          292   

Net trading income

        209          209   

Share of profit from associates

     4,300         221        (4,300     221   

Other income

     617         726          1,343   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income

     4,917         53,795        (4,300     54,412   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Expenses

         

Gross underwriting expenditure

        33,716          33,716   

Investment result for risk of policyholders

        1,246          1,246   

Reinsurance recoveries

        (1,875       (1,875
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underwriting expenditure

        33,087          33,087   

Addition to loan loss provisions

        1,670          1,670   

Intangible amortization and other impairments

        379          379   

Staff expenses

        7,556          7,556   

Other interest expenses

        528          528   

Other operating expenses

        6,465          6,465   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

        49,685          49,685   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Result before tax from continuing operations

     4,917         4,110        (4,300     4,727   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Taxation

     177         832          1,009   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations

     4,740         3,278        (4,300     3,718   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

         

Net result from discontinued operations

        114          114   

Net result from disposal of discontinued operations

        995          995   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net result from discontinued operations

        1,109          1,109   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result from continuing and discontinued operations (before minority interests)

     4,740         4,387        (4,300     4,827   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

            4,740   

Minority interests

            87   
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

            4,827   
         

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

            3,636   

Minority interests

            82   
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

            3,718   
         

 

 

 

Net result from discontinued operations attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

            1,104   

Minority interests

            5   
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

            1,109   
         

 

 

 

 

F-233


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the year ended December 31, 2010

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

CONTINUING OPERATIONS

        

Income

        

Interest income banking operations

       68,334          68,334   

Interest expense banking operations

       (55,011       (55,011
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest result banking operations

       13,323          13,323   

Gross premium income

       27,786          27,786   

Investment income

       7,463          7,463   

Net result on disposals of group companies

       310          310   

Gross commission income

       5,868          5,868   

Commission expense

       (1,720       (1,720
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commission income

       4,148          4,148   

Valuation results on non-trading derivatives

       (1,062       (1,062

Net trading income

       627          627   

Share of profit from associates

     2,561        311        (2,561     311   

Other income

     (263     867          604   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income

     2,298        53,773        (2,561     53,510   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Expenses

        

Gross underwriting expenditure

       45,015          45,015   

Investment result for risk of policyholders

       (10,492       (10,492

Reinsurance recoveries

       (1,721       (1,721
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Underwriting expenditure

       32,802          32,802   

Addition to loan loss provisions

       1,751          1,751   

Intangible amortization and other impairments

       1,070          1,070   

Staff expenses

       7,692          7,692   

Other interest expenses

       786          786   

Other operating expenses

       6,076          6,076   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

       50,177          50,177   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Result before tax from continuing operations

     2,298        3,596        (2,561     3,333   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Taxation

     (69     1,145          1,076   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations

     2,367        2,451        (2,561     2,257   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

        

Net result from discontinued operations

       216          216   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result from continuing and discontinued operations (before minority interests)

     2,367        2,667        (2,561     2,473   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net result attributable to:

        

Equityholders of the parent

           2,367   

Minority interests

           106   
        

 

 

 

Results for the period

           2,473   
        

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations attributable to:

        

Equityholders of the parent

           2,158   

Minority interests

           99   
        

 

 

 

Results for the period

           2,257   
        

 

 

 

Net result from discontinued operations attributable to:

        

Equityholders of the parent

           209   

Minority interests

           7   
        

 

 

 

Results for the period

           216   
        

 

 

 

 

F-234


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the year ended December 31, 2009

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
     ING Group
consolidated
 

CONTINUING OPERATIONS

         

Income

         

Interest income banking operations

       79,850           79,850   

Interest expense banking operations

       (67,475        (67,475
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest result banking operations

       12,375           12,375   

Gross premium income

       30,248           30,248   

Investment income

       3,158           3,158   

Net result on disposals of group companies

       287           287   

Gross commission income

       6,551           6,551   

Commission expense

       (2,311        (2,311
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commission income

       4,240           4,240   

Valuation results on non-trading derivatives

       (5,399        (5,399

Net trading income

       1,125           1,125   

Share of profit from associates

     (321     (463     321         (463

Other income

     (1,574     2,275           701   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total income

     (1,895     47,846        321         46,272   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses

         

Gross underwriting expenditure

       50,129           50,129   

Investment result for risk of policyholders

       (17,735        (17,735

Reinsurance recoveries

       (1,700        (1,700
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underwriting expenditure

       30,694           30,694   

Addition to loan loss provisions

       2,973           2,973   

Intangible amortization and other impairments

       524           524   

Staff expenses

       7,271           7,271   

Other interest expenses

       711           711   

Other operating expenses

       6,592           6,592   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses

       48,765           48,765   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Result before tax from continuing operations

     (1895     (919     321         (2,493
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Taxation

     (472     (308        (780
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations

     (1423     (611     321         (1,713
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

         

Net result from discontinued operations

       100           100   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net result from continuing and discontinued operations (before minority interests)

     (1423     (511     321         (1,613
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net result attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

            (1,495

Minority interests

            (118
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

            (1,613
         

 

 

 

Net result from continuing operations attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

            (1,588

Minority interests

            (125
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

  

         (1,713
         

 

 

 

Net result from discontinued operations attributable to:

         

Equityholders of the parent

  

         93   

Minority interests

  

         7   
         

 

 

 

Results for the period

  

         100   
         

 

 

 

 

F-235


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.3.3 CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

For the years ended December 31, 2011

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Result before tax

     4,917        4,967        (4,018     5,866   

Adjusted for:

        

– depreciation

       1,514          1,514   

– deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired

       277          277   

– increase in provisions for insurance and investment contracts

       4,239          4,239   

– addition to loan loss provisions

       1,670          1,670   

– other

     (119     (1,350       (1,469

Taxation paid

     (80     (1,273       (1,353

Changes in:

        

– amounts due from banks, not available on demand

       2,208          2,208   

– trading assets

       1,754          1,754   

– non-trading derivatives

     9        1,988        (9     1,988   

– other financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

       474          474   

– loans and advances to customers

     563        (23,703     (563     (23,703

– other assets

     (1,171     46        1,066        (59

– amounts due to banks, not payable on demand

       (6,731       (6,731

– customer deposits and other funds on deposit

       27,019          27,019   

– trading liabilities

       (369       (369

– other financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

       (207       (207

– other liabilities

     (4,385     (3,518     3,972        (3,931
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from operating activities

     (266     9,005        448        9,187   

Investments and advances:

        

– group companies

     3,000          (3,000  

– associates

       (140       (140

– available-for-sale investments

       (223,544       (223,544

– held-to-maturity investments

        

– real estate investments

       (32       (32

– property and equipment

       (499       (499

– assets subject to operating leases

       (1,188       (1,188

– investments for risk of policyholders

       (57,130       (57,130

– other investments

       (340       (340

Disposals and redemptions:

        

– group companies

       4,120          4,120   

– associates

       383          383   

– available-for-sale investments

       219,442          219,442   

– held-to-maturity investments

       2,370          2,370   

– real estate investments

       118          118   

– property and equipment

       67          67   

– assets subject to operating leases

       43          43   

– investments for risk of policyholders

       61,898          61,898   

– other investments

       936          936   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from investing activities

     3,000        6,504        (3,000     6,504   

 

F-236


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the years ended December 31, 2011

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated loans

        

Repayments of subordinated loans

     (2,356         (2,356

Proceeds from borrowed funds and debt securities

     3,859        427,272        (2,750     428,381   

Repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities

     (2,750     (428,247     1,000        (429,997

Issuance of ordinary shares

        

Repurchase of non-voting equity securities

     (2,000         (2,000

Repurchase premium

     (1,000         (1,000

Payments to acquire treasury shares

        

Sales of treasury shares

     41            41   

Dividends paid

  

    (3,000     3,000     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from financing activities

     (4,206     (3,975     1,250        (6,931
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow

     (1,472     11,534        (1,302     8,760   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     72        20,740        (72     20,740   

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

  

    (200       (200
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     (1,400     32,074        (1,374     29,300   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-237


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the years ended December 31, 2010

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Result before tax

     2,427        (2,078     3,252        3,601   

Adjusted for:

        

– depreciation

       1,723          1,723   

– deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired

       1,159          1,159   

– increase in provisions for insurance and investment contracts

       4,278          4,278   

– addition to loan loss provisions

       1,751          1,751   

– other

     (47     3,094          3,047   

Taxation paid

     140        (643       (503

Changes in:

        

– amounts due from banks, not available on demand

       (4,333       (4,333

– trading assets

       (14,782       (14,782

– non-trading derivatives

     110        (1,590     (110     (1,590

– other financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

       832          832   

– loans and advances to customers

     1,504        (16,331     (1,504     (16,331

– other assets

     35        1,968          2,003   

– amounts due to banks, not payable on demand

       (9,831       (9,831

– customer deposits and other funds on deposit

       21,202          21,202   

– trading liabilities

       9,804          9,804   

– other financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

       1          1   

– other liabilities

     (2,964     (811     (3,031     (6,806
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from operating activities

     1,205        (4,587     (1,393     (4,775

Investments and advances:

        

– group companies

     (1,300     1,500        (200  

– associates

       (165       (165

– available-for-sale investments

       (163,038       (163,038

– held-to-maturity investments

       (141       (141

– real estate investments

       (73       (73

– property and equipment

       (527       (527

– assets subject to operating leases

       (1,284       (1,284

– investments for risk of policyholders

       (52,370       (52,370

– other investments

       (372       (372

Disposals and redemptions:

        

– group companies

       1,757          1,757   

– associates

       232          232   

– available-for-sale investments

       154,640          154,640   

– held-to-maturity investments

       2,620          2,620   

– real estate investments

       295          295   

– property and equipment

       96          96   

– assets subject to operating leases

       53          53   

– investments for risk of policyholders

       54,817          54,817   

– other investments

       111          111   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from investing activities

     (1,300     (1,849     (200     (3,349

 

F-238


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the years ended December 31, 2010

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Proceeds from borrowed funds and debt securities

  

    412,804          412,804   

Repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities

  

    (406,624     1,504        (405,120

Payments to acquire treasury shares

  

    (136       (136

Sales of treasury shares

     (16     108          92   

Dividends paid

  

    (200     200     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from financing activities

     (16     5,952        1,704        7,640   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow

     (111     (484     111        (484

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     183        20,959        (183     20,959   

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

  

    265          265   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     72        20,740        (72     20,740   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-239


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the years ended December 31, 2009

 

     ING
Group
NV
parent
company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Result before tax

     (2,004     (716     430        (2,290

Adjusted for:

        

– depreciation

       1,701          1,701   

– deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired

       223          223   

– increase in provisions for insurance and investment contracts

       2,585          2,585   

– addition to loan loss provisions

       2,973          2,973   

– other

     (259     6,107        167        6,014   

Taxation paid

     207        (619       (412

Changes in:

        

– amounts due from banks, not available on demand

       8,611          8,611   

– trading assets

       47,963          47,963   

– non-trading derivatives

       864          864   

– other financial assets at fair value through profit and loss

       2,196          2,196   

– loans and advances to customers

     1,053        12,208        (1,053     12,208   

– other assets

     442        6,864        (358     6,948   

– amounts due to banks, not payable on demand

       (67,410       (67,410

– customer deposits and other funds on deposit

       21,040        33        21,073   

– trading liabilities

       (54,366       (54,366

– other financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss

       (5,798       (5,798

– other liabilities

     1,514        (11,758     (239     (10,483
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from operating activities

     953        (27,333     (1,020     (27,400

Investments and advances:

        

– group companies

     (350     (5     350        (5

– associates

       (181       (181

– available-for-sale investments

       (165,771       (165,771

– real estate investments

       (130       (130

– property and equipment

       (640       (640

– assets subject to operating leases

       (1,034       (1,034

– investments for risk of policyholders

       (65,362       (65,362

– other investments

       (338       (338

Disposals and redemptions:

        

– group companies

       2,643          2,643   

– associates

       294          294   

– available-for-sale investments

       167,075          167,075   

– held-to-maturity investments

       1,675          1,675   

– real estate investments

       656          656   

– property and equipment

       82          82   

– assets subject to operating leases

       93          93   

– investments for risk of policyholders

       64,158          64,158   

– other investments

       24          24   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from investing activities

     (350     3,239        350        3,239   

 

F-240


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

For the years ended December 31, 2009

 

     ING Group NV
parent company
    Subsidiaries     Consolidating
entries
    ING Group
consolidated
 

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated loans

       1,931        (1,931  

Repayments of subordinated loans

       (3,023     3,023     

Proceeds from borrowed funds and debt securities

     3,800        439,561        (5,589     437,772   

Repayments of borrowed funds and debt securities

     (5,550     (425,182     5,550        (425,182

Issuance of ordinary shares

     7,276        700        (700     7,276   

Repayment of non-voting equity securities

     (5,000         (5,000

Payments to acquire treasury shares

       (101       (101

Sales of treasury shares

     51        67          118   

Dividends paid

     (1,030     (350     350        (1,030
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow from financing activities

     (453     13,603        703        13,853   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flow

     150        (10,491     33        (10,308

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     33        31,238          31,271   

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

       (4       (4
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     183        20,743        33        20,959   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-241


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

2.3.4 NOTES TO THE SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION

ASSETS

Investment in wholly owned subsidiaries

Investment in wholly owned subsidiaries:

 

     Ownership
(%)
     Balance
sheet value
     Ownership
(%)
     Balance
sheet value
 
            2011             2010  

Name of investee:

           

ING Bank N.V.

     100         30,134         100         31,266   

ING Verzekeringen N.V.

           100         20,134   

ING Insurance Topholding N.V.

     100         23,465         

Other

        139            9   
     

 

 

       

 

 

 
        53,738            51,409   
     

 

 

       

 

 

 

Movement in investment in wholly owned subsidiaries:

 

     2011     2010  

Opening balance

     51,409        43,044   

Revaluations

     1,022        4,514   

Result of the group companies

     4,311        2,561   

Capital contribution

       1,500   

Dividend

     (3,000     (200
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     53,742        51,419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in ING Groep N.V. shares held by group companies:

     (4     (10
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

     53,738        51,409   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receivables from group companies

     10,716        11,502   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     64,454        62,911   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

SUBORDINATED LOANS

See Note 14 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Interest rate   

Year

of issue

     Due date      Balance sheet value  
                   2011      2010  

9.000%

     2008         Perpetual         10         10   

8.500%

     2008         Perpetual         1,527         1,469   

8.000%

     2008         Perpetual         1,500         1,485   

7.375%

     2007         Perpetual         1,176         1,111   

6.375%

     2007         Perpetual         804         773   

5.140%

     2006         Perpetual         79         692   

5.775%

     2005         Perpetual         292         741   

6.125%

     2005         Perpetual         533         504   

4.176%

     2005         Perpetual         168         498   

Variable

     2004         Perpetual         527         994   

6.200%

     2003         Perpetual         376         363   

Variable

     2003         Perpetual         424         729   

7.200%

     2002         Perpetual         839         748   

7.050%

     2002         Perpetual         603         528   

8.439%

     2000         December 31, 2030         1,159         1,121   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 
           10,017         11,766   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 

EUR 6,141 million (2010: EUR 7,147 million) of these loans has been subsequently provided as subordinated loans by ING Groep N.V. to ING Bank N.V. under the same conditions as the original bonds.

 

F-242


Table of Contents

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – (CONTINUED)

Amounts in million of euros, unless stated otherwise

 

EUR 1,957 million (2010: EUR 2,003 million) of these loans has been subsequently provided as subordinated loans by ING Groep N.V. to ING Verzekeringen N.V. under the same conditions as the original bonds.

Unsecured subordinated loans from group companies to ING Groep N.V., which may be renewable at their due dates at the then prevailing market rates, are included in subordinated loans.

DEBT SECURITIES IN ISSUE

 

Interest rate   

Year

of issue

     Due date      Balance sheet
value
 
                   2011      2010  

4.125%

     2011         March 23, 2015         653      

5.625%

     2008         September 3, 2013         1,053         1,072   

4.699%

     2007         June 1, 2035         117         117   

4.750%

     2007         May 31, 2017         1,932         1,890   

Variable

     2006         June 28, 2011            749   

Variable

     2006         April 11, 2016         998         997   

4.125%

     2006         April 11, 2016         747         746   

6.125%

     2000         January 4, 2011            1,000   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 
           5,500         6,571   
        

 

 

    

 

 

 

The number of debentures held by group companies as at December 31, 2011 was 369,160 with a balance sheet value of EUR 35 million (2010: 131,680 with a balance sheet value of EUR 13 million).

Amounts owed to group companies by remaining term:

 

     2011      2010  

– within one year

     466         1   

– more than one year but less than five years

     2,250         500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2,716         501   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives from group companies by remaining term:

 

     2011      2010  

– within one year

     28         25   

– more than one year but less than five years

     125      

– more than five years

        211   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     153         236   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-243


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

ACTUARIAL AND UNDERWRITING RISK

These risks (mortality, longevity, morbidity, adverse motor or home claims, etc.), result from the pricing and acceptance of insurance contracts. Actuarial risk is the risk that premium levels and provisions in respect of insurance risk may turn out to be (no longer) correct. Underwriting risk is the risk that an issuer will receive a claim under an insurance policy it issues/underwrites. Maximum underwriting exposures are limited through exclusions, cover limits and reinsurance.

ADVANCED MEASUREMENT APPROACH (AMA)

The risk methodology to calculate the regulatory Operational Risk capital.

ALT-A RESIDENTIAL MORTGAGE BACKED SECURITY (ALT-A RMBS)

A type of United States residential mortgage which is considered riskier than ‘prime’ and less risky than ‘sub-prime’ mortgages. Parameters generally taken into account are borrower credit scores, residential property values and loan-to-value ratios. Alt-A mortgages are further characterised by a limited degree of income and/or asset verification.

AMORTISED COST

The amount at which the financial asset or liability is measured at initial recognition less principal repayments, plus or minus the cumulative amortisation using the effective interest method of any difference between that initial amount and the maturity amount, and minus any reduction for impairment or uncollectibility.

ASSET AND LIABILITY COMMITTEE (ALCO)

Manages the balance sheet of ING, especially with regard to strategic non-trading risk. These risks comprise interest rate exposures, equity risk, real estate risk, liquidity, solvency and foreign exchange risk and fluctuations.

ASSET LIABILITY MANAGEMENT (ALM)

The practice of managing a business such that decisions on assets and liabilities are coordinated. It involves the ongoing process of formulating, implementing, monitoring and revising strategies related to assets and liabilities.

ASSET BACKED COMMERCIAL PAPER (ABCP)

Commercial paper that is collateralised by other financial assets.

ASSET BACKED SECURITIES (ABS)

A type of bond or note that is based on pools of assets, or collateralised by the cash flows from a specified pool of underlying assets.

ASSOCIATE

An entity over which the Group has significant influence, generally accompanying a shareholding of between 20% and 50% of the voting rights, and that is not a subsidiary not a joint venture.

AVAILABLE FINANCIAL RESOURCES (AFR)

The available financial resources equal the market value of assets minus market value of liabilities, excluding hybrids issued by ING Group which is counted as capital. ING’s policy is that the available financial resources should exceed economic capital for Bank, Insurance and Group.

AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE FINANCIAL ASSETS

Those non-derivative financial assets that are designated as available-for-sale or are not classified as:

 

 

loans and receivables;

 

 

held-to-maturity investments; or

 

 

financial assets at fair value through profit and loss.

BASEL I

Regulatory requirements issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision for the solvency calculation, which are superseded by Basel II, for ING, from 2008 onwards.

BASEL II

Regulatory requirements issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision for the solvency calculation, which, for ING, apply from 2008 onwards. Basel II is an international standard for calculating the required capital based on internal models that take into account the financial and operational risks.

BASEL III

Regulatory requirements issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision for the solvency calculation and liquidity requirements, which will supersede Basel II. From January 1, 2013 these requirements will start to apply, with the full requirements being effective as of January 1, 2018.

BASIS POINT VALUE (BPV)

The change in the Net Present Value of a cash flow or a pool of cash flows due to a one basis point change of the yield curve.

 

 

F-244


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

BASIS RISK

This risk arises from an imperfect correlation in the adjustment of the rates earned and paid on different financial instruments. Examples of products in which these risks are inherent are demand deposits, saving accounts and mortgages with prepayment options.

BIS

An international organisation which fosters international monetary and financial co-operation and serves as a bank for central banks. BIS has set a minimum for the solvency ratio reflecting the relationship between capital and risk weighted assets. The ratio should be at least 8%.

BUSINESS RISK

The exposure to value loss due to fluctuations in volumes, margins and costs. These fluctuations can occur because of internal, industry, or wider market factors. It is the risk inherent to strategy decisions and internal efficiency.

CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT

Short-term negotiable bearer debt instruments issued by banks.

CLAIM

A demand for payment of a policy benefit because of the occurrence of an insured event, such as the death or disability of the insured or the maturity of an endowment, the incurrence of hospital or medical bills, the destruction or damage of property and related deaths or injuries, defects in, liens on, or challenges to the title to real estate, or the occurrence of a surety loss.

CLAIMS RATIO

Claims, including claims handling expenses, expressed as a percentage of net earned premiums.

COLLATERALISED DEBT OBLIGATION (CDO)

A type of asset-backed security which provides investors exposure to the credit risk of a pool of fixed income assets.

COLLATERALISED LOAN OBLIGATION (CLO)

A type of CDO which is backed primarily by leveraged bank loans.

COMBINED RATIO

The sum of the claims ratio and the cost ratio for a non-life insurance company or a reinsurance company. A combined ratio of more than 100% does not necessarily mean that there is a loss on non-life insurance policies, because the result also includes the allocated investment income.

COMMERCIAL PAPER

Promissory note (issued by financial institutions or large firms) with very-short to short maturity period (usually 2 to 30 days, and not more than 270 days), and unsecured.

COMPLIANCE RISK

Compliance risk is defined as the risk of damage to ING’s reputation as a result of failure or perceived failure to comply with relevant laws, regulations, internal policies and procedures or ethical standards.

CONCENTRATIONS OF CREDIT RISK

Concentrations of credit risk exist when changes in economic, industry or geographical factors similarly affect groups of counterparties whose aggregate exposure is material in relation to ING Group’s total exposure.

CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

Possible obligations that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the entity; or a present obligation that arises from past events but is not recognised because:

 

 

it is not probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation; or

 

 

the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability.

CONTROL

The power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities.

CONVERTIBLE DEBENTURES

Debentures with embedded options issued by corporations. The holder has the right to exchange a convertible debenture for equity in the issuing company at certain times in the future according to a certain exchange ratio. Very often, the conversion is callable. This means that it can be repurchased by the issuer at a certain price at certain times in the future. Once the debentures have been called, the holder can always choose to convert prior to repurchase.

 

 

F-245


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

CONVEXITY

The non-linear relationship between changes in the interest rates and changes in bond prices and their Net Present Value. It is a very important market risk measure for portfolios containing (embedded) options.

CORE DEBT

Investments in ING Group subsidiaries minus the equity of the holding company including hybrids.

COST OF CAPITAL

The costs related to owning capital. These can be split into the cost of equity, hybrids and debt, taking a target leverage into account.

COST RATIO

Underwriting costs expressed as a percentage of premiums written.

COUNTRY RISK

The risk that a government will not fulfil its obligations or obstructs the remittance of funds by debtors, either for financial reasons (transfer risk) or for other reasons (e.g. political risk).

CREDIT INSTITUTIONS

All institutions that are subject to banking supervision by public authorities, including mortgage banks, capital market institutions, multilateral development banks and the International Monetary Fund (IMF).

CREDIT RISK

The risk of loss from default by borrowers (including bond issuers) or counterparties. Credit risks arise in ING’s lending, presettlement and investment activities, as well as in its trading activities. Credit risk management is supported by dedicated credit risk information systems and internal rating methodologies for debtors and counterparties.

DEFERRED TAX LIABILITIES

The amounts of income tax payable in future periods in respect of taxable temporary differences between carrying amounts of assets or liabilities in the balance sheet and tax base, based on tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the assets are realised or the liabilities are settled.

DEFINED BENEFIT PLAN

Post-employment benefit plans other than defined contribution plans.

DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN

Post-employment benefit plans under which an enterprise pays fixed contributions into a separate entity (a fund) and will have no legal or constructive obligation to pay further contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits relating to employee service in the current and prior periods.

DELTA HEDGE

The delta hedge minimises the exposure of the employee option scheme by holding an appropriate number of (depositary receipts for) ordinary shares. The exposure is reassessed every quarter and, if necessary, ordinary shares are bought from the market. In December 2010 ING Groep N.V. announced that it will no longer rebalance its hedge portfolio. This decision is an effort to simplify the management and administration of ING’s various employee share and option programmes. The remaining shares in the hedge portfolio will be used to fund the obligations arising out of exercise and vesting. Once all shares in the hedge portfolio are used ING will fund these obligations by issuing new shares.

DEPOSITARY RECEIPT

Depositary receipt for ordinary and preference shares, issued by the ING Trust Office, in exchange for ordinary and preference shares issued by ING Group.

DERIVATIVES

Financial instruments, which include forwards, futures, options and swaps, whose value is based on an underlying asset, index or reference rate.

DISCOUNTED BILLS

Bills that are sold under deduction of interest giving the owner the right to receive an amount of money on a given date.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

When a group of assets that is classified as held for sale represents a major line of business or geographical area the disposal group classifies as discontinued operations.

 

 

F-246


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

DISCRETIONARY PARTICIPATION FEATURE

A contractual right to receive, as a supplement to guaranteed benefits, additional benefits that: are likely to be a significant portion of the total contractual benefits, whose amount or timing is contractually at the discretion of the insurer, that are contractually based on the performance of a specified pool or type of contract, (un)realised investment returns on a specified pool of assets held by the insurer, or the profit of the company, fund, or other entity that issues the contract.

DISPOSAL GROUP HELD FOR SALE

When groups of assets are to be sold together in a single transaction, and the sale is considered to be highly probable, the disposal group is classified separately in the balance sheet as Assets held for sale. A sale is highly probable when management is demonstrably committed to the sale, which is expected to occur within one year from the date of classification as held for sale. Liabilities directly associated with those assets, and that are included in the transaction are to be included in the balance sheet as ‘liabilities held for sale’.

EARNINGS SENSITIVITY (ES)

Measures the impact on earnings resulting from changes in economic and financial conditions over a one-year horizon.

ECONOMIC CAPITAL

The minimum amount of capital that is required to absorb unexpected losses in times of severe stress. Given ING Group’s A target rating, ING calculates economic capital requirements for ING Bank at a 99.95% level of confidence. This confidence level is derived from the historical default frequency of AA-rated companies (probability of default of 1 in 2000 years or 0.05%). For ING Insurance the economic capital is calculated based on a confidence level of 99.5%, which is aligned with the Solvency II.

EFFECTIVE INTEREST METHOD

A method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or liability and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the relevant period.

ELIMINATION

A process by which intercompany transactions are matched with each other and deducted, so that the assets, liabilities, income and expenses are not inflated.

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

All forms of consideration given by a company in exchange for service rendered by (current and former) employees.

FAIR VALUE

The amount for which an asset could be exchanged, or a liability settled, between knowledgeable, willing parties in an arm’s length transaction.

FINANCE LEASE

A lease that transfers substantially all the risks and rewards associated with ownership of an asset to the lessee. Title may or may not eventually be transferred.

FINANCIAL ASSET

Any asset that is:

 

 

cash;

 

 

an equity instrument of another company;

 

 

a contractual right to;

 

   

receive cash or another financial asset from another company; or

 

   

exchange financial instruments with another company under conditions that are potentially favourable; or

 

   

certain contract that will or may be settled in ING’s own equity instruments.

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

Contracts that give rise to both a financial asset for one company and a financial liability or equity instrument for another company.

FINANCIAL LIABILITY

Any liability that is a contractual obligation:

 

 

to deliver cash or another financial asset to another company; or

 

 

to exchange financial instruments with another company under conditions that are potentially unfavourable; or

 

 

certain contracts that will or may be settled in ING’s own equity instruments.

FOREIGN EXCHANGE RATE RISK

Probability of loss occurring from an adverse movement in foreign exchange rates.

FORWARD CONTRACTS

Commitments to exchange currencies or to buy or sell other financial instruments at specified future dates.

 

 

F-247


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

FUTURE CONTRACTS

Commitments to exchange currencies or to buy or sell other financial instruments at specified future dates. Exchanges act as intermediaries and require daily cash settlement and collateral deposits.

GROSS PREMIUMS WRITTEN

Total premiums (whether or not earned) for insurance contracts written or assumed (including deposits for investment contracts with limited or no life contingencies written) during a specific period, without deduction for premiums ceded.

HELD-TO-MATURITY INVESTMENTS

Non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments and fixed maturity that ING Group has the positive intention and ability to hold to maturity other than:

 

a.

those that ING Group upon initial recognition designates as at fair value through profit and loss;

 

b.

those that ING Group designates as available-for-sale; and

 

c.

those that meet the definition of loans and receivables.

HISTORICAL SIMULATION

A model to calculate Value at Risk, assuming that future changes in risk factors will have the same distribution as they had in the past taking into account the non-linear behaviour of financial products.

IMPAIRMENT LOSS

The amount by which the carrying amount of an asset exceeds its recoverable amount.

INTEREST BEARING INSTRUMENT

A financial asset or a liability for which a time-proportionate compensation is paid or received in relation to a notional amount.

INTERNAL RATE OF RETURN (IRR)

Internal rate of return is the discount rate at which the present value of distributable earnings from new business equals the investment in new business (i.e. the projected return on the investment in new business) is calculated.

INTEREST-RATE REBATES

Profit sharing for group life insurance business. A rebate granted to policyholders based on the discounted value of the difference between the interest rate used to calculate the premiums and the expected yield on investment. The profit sharing is granted by means of a premium discount related to the yield on government bonds.

INTEREST RATE RISK

Probability that the market interest rates will rise significantly higher than the interest rate earned on investments such as bonds, resulting in their lower market value.

IN THE MONEY

A call option is said to be in the money if the exercise price is lower than the price of the underlying value; a put option is said to be in the money if the exercise price is higher than the price of the underlying value.

INVESTMENT RISK

Investment risk is the credit default and risk rating migration risk that is associated with ING Group’s investments in bonds, commercial paper, securitisations, and other similar publicly traded securities. Investment risk arises when ING purchases a (synthetic) bond with the intent to hold the bond for a longer period of time (generally through maturity).

INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO

Comprises those assets which are intended for use on a continuing basis, and have been identified as such. These investments are held in order to cover the insurance provisions and to manage interest rate, capital and liquidity risks.

IRREVOCABLE FACILITIES

Mainly constitute unused portions of irrevocable credit facilities granted to corporate clients and commitments made to purchase securities to be issued by governments and private issuers.

IRREVOCABLE LETTERS OF CREDIT

Concerns an obligation on behalf of a client to pay an amount of money under submission of a specific document or to accept a bill of exchange, subject to certain conditions. An irrevocable letter of credit cannot be cancelled or adjusted by the bank that has granted it during the duration of the agreement unless all those concerned agree.

JOINT VENTURE

A contractual arrangement whereby two or more parties undertake an economic activity which is subject to joint control.

 

 

F-248


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

LEGAL RISK

Legal risk is the risk related to:

 

 

a failure (or perceived failure) to adhere to applicable laws, regulations and standards;

 

 

contractual liabilities or contractual obligations that are defaulted or cannot be enforced as intended, or are enforced in an unexpected or adverse way; and

 

 

liability (tort) towards third parties due to an act or omission contributable to ING; (potentially) resulting in impairment of ING’s integrity, leading to damage to ING’s reputation, legal or regulatory sanctions, or financial loss.

LENDING RISK

Lending risk arises when ING Group grants a loan to a customer, or issues guarantees on behalf of a customer. This is the most common risk category, and includes term loans, mortgages, revolving credits, overdrafts, guarantees, letters of credit, etc. The risk is measured at the notional amount of the financial obligation that the customer has to repay to ING, excluding any accrued and unpaid interest, or discount/premium amortisations or impairments.

LIQUIDITY RISK

The risk that ING Group or one of its subsidiaries cannot meet its financial liabilities when they fall due, at reasonable costs and in a timely manner.

MARKET RISK

Market risk is the risk that movements in market variables, such as interest rates, equity prices, implied volatilities, foreign exchange rates, real estate prices negatively impact the earnings or market value.

MINORITY INTERESTS

The part of the profit and loss and net assets of a subsidiary attributable to an interest which is not owned, directly or indirectly, by the parent company.

MONETARY ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

Assets and liabilities which are fixed in terms of units of currency by contract or otherwise. Examples are cash, short or long-term accounts, notes receivable in cash and notes payable in cash.

MONEY MARKET RISK

Money market risk arises when ING Group places short term deposits with a counterparty in order to manage excess liquidity, as such, money market deposits tend to be short term in nature (1-7 days is common). In the event of a counterparty default, ING Group may lose the deposit placed. Money market risk is therefore measured simply as the notional value of the deposit, excluding any accrued and unpaid interest or the effect of any impairment.

MONOLINER

A financial company that deals specifically with one particular branch of the financial industry.

MONTE CARLO SIMULATION

A model to calculate Value at Risk, assuming that changes in risk factors are (jointly) normally distributed taking into account nonlinear behaviour of financial products.

MORTGAGE BACKED SECURITIES (MBS)

A security whose cash flows are backed by typically the principal and/ or interest payments of a pool of mortgages.

NEW SALES

New sales of life insurance, measured as Annual Premium Equivalent (APE), have been

defined as the total of annual premiums and 10% of single premiums received on production in a given period.

NET ASSET VALUE

Used in the equity method of accounting. The initial net asset value of the investment is determined by the fair value of the assets and liabilities of the investee. After the initial valuation of assets and liabilities of the investee at fair value, the assets and liabilities of the investee are valued in accordance with the accounting policies of the investor. The profit and loss account reflects the investor’s share in the results of operations of the investee.

NET PREMIUMS WRITTEN

Gross premiums written for a given period less premiums ceded to retrocessionaires during the given period.

NET PRESENT VALUE AT RISK (NPV-AT-RISK)

Establishes what the value of future cash flows is in terms of today’s monetary value. NPV-at-Risk establishes the change in value of future cash flows as a result of interest rate changes in terms of today’s monetary value.

 

 

F-249


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

NON-VOTING EQUITY SECURITIES

Core Tier 1 securities issued to the Dutch State in November 2008 for a total consideration of EUR 10 billion. In December 2009 EUR 5 billion and in May 2011 EUR 2 billion was paid back to the Dutch State. This capital injection qualifies as core Tier 1 capital for regulatory purposes.

NOTIONAL AMOUNTS

Represent units of account which, in respect of derivatives, reflect the relationship with the underlying assets. They do not reflect, however, the credit risks assumed by entering into derivative transactions.

OPERATING LEASE

A lease other than a finance lease.

OPERATIONAL RISK

The risk of a direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems or from external events.

OPTION CONTRACTS

Give the purchaser, for a premium, the right, but not the obligation, to buy or sell within a limited period of time a financial instrument or currency at a contracted price that may also be settled in cash. Written options are subject to market risk, but not to credit risk since the counterparties have already performed in accordance with the terms of the contract by paying a cash premium up front.

ORDINARY SHARE

An equity instrument that is subordinate to all other classes of equity instruments. Ordinary shares participate in the net profit for the financial year after other types of shares such as preference shares.

OUT OF THE MONEY

A call option is said to be out of the money if the exercise price is higher than the price of the underlying value; a put option is said to be out of the money if the exercise price is lower than the price of the underlying value.

OVER-THE-COUNTER INSTRUMENT

A non-standardised financial instrument not traded on a stock exchange but directly between market participants.

PLAN ASSETS

Comprise assets held by a long-term employee benefit fund and qualifying insurance policies. Assets held by a long-term employee benefit fund are assets (other than non-transferable financial instruments issued by the reporting enterprise) that:

 

 

are held by an entity (a fund) that is legally separate from the reporting enterprise and exists solely to pay or fund employee benefits; and

 

 

are available to be used only to pay or fund employee benefits, are not available to the reporting enterprise’s own creditors (even in bankruptcy), and cannot be returned to the reporting enterprise, unless either the remaining assets of the fund are sufficient to meet all the related employee benefit obligations of the plan or the reporting enterprise or the assets are returned to the reporting enterprise to reimburse it for employee benefits already paid.

A qualifying insurance policy is an insurance policy issued by an insurer that is not a related party of the reporting enterprise, if the proceeds of the policy:

 

 

can be used only to pay or fund employee benefits under a defined benefit plan; and

 

 

are not available to the reporting enterprise’s own creditors (even in bankruptcy) and cannot be paid to the reporting enterprise, unless either the proceeds represent surplus assets that are not needed for the policy to meet all the related employee benefit obligations or the proceeds are returned to the reporting enterprise to reimburse it for employee benefits already paid.

POST-EMPLOYMENT BENEFIT PLANS

Formal or informal arrangements under which a company provides post-employment benefits for one or more employees. Post-employment benefits are employee benefits other than termination benefits and equity compensation benefits, which are payable after the completion of employment.

PREFERENCE SHARE

Similar to an ordinary share but carries certain preferential rights. These rights usually concern the guarantee of a fixed (cumulative) return to the shareholder or a guaranteed return on the investment.

PREMIUMS EARNED

The portion of net premiums written in current and past periods which applies to the expired portion of the policy period, calculated by subtracting movements in unearned premium reserves from net premiums.

 

 

F-250


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

PRE-SETTLEMENT RISK

Pre-settlement risk arises when a counterparty defaults on a transaction before settlement and ING Group has to replace the contract by a trade with another counterparty at the then prevailing (possibly unfavourable) market price. The pre-settlement risk (potential or expected risk) is the cost of ING Group replacing a trade in the market. This credit risk category is associated with dealing room products such as options, swaps, and securities financing transactions. Where there is a mutual exchange of value, the amount of outstanding is generally based on the replacement value (mark-to-market) plus potential future volatility concept, using an historical 7 year time horizon and a 99% confidence level.

PRIVATE LOAN

Loans to governments, other public bodies, public utilities, corporations, other institutions or individuals with a loan agreement as the only instrument of title.

PRIVATE PLACEMENT

A placement in which newly issued shares or debentures come into possession of a limited group of subscribers who are prepared to buy the new securities.

PROJECTED UNIT CREDIT METHOD

An actuarial valuation method that considers each period of service as giving rise to an additional unit of benefit entitlement and measures each unit separately to build up the final obligation.

QUALIFYING ASSET (WITHIN THE MEANING OF BORROWING COSTS)

An asset that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or sale.

RECOGNITION

The process of incorporating in the balance sheet or profit and loss account an item that meets the definition of an element and satisfies the following criteria for recognition:

 

 

it is probable that any future economic benefit associated with the item will flow to or from the enterprise; and

 

 

the item has a cost or value that can be measured reliably.

RECOVERABLE AMOUNT

The higher of an asset’s net selling price and its value in use.

REDEMPTION VALUE

With respect to investments in fixed-interest securities, the amount payable on the maturity date.

REINSURANCE

The practice whereby one party, called the reinsurer, in consideration for a premium paid to him, agrees to indemnify another party, called the reinsured or ceding company, for part or all of the liability assumed by the reinsured under a contract or contracts of insurance which the reinsured has issued. The reinsured may also be referred to as the original or primary insurer, the direct writing company, or the ceding company.

RETURN ON EQUITY (ROE)

The return on equity is the net result as percentage of the average equity.

RISK ADJUSTED RETURN ON CAPITAL (RAROC)

A performance indicator that measures revenues in the perspective of the risks that had to be taken to obtain that revenue. RAROC is calculated by dividing the risk-adjusted-return by economic capital. In the RAROC calculation, the actual credit-risk provisioning is replaced by statistically expected losses reflecting the average credit losses over the entire economic cycle.

RISK-WEIGHTED ASSETS (‘RWA’ UNDER BASEL I)

Assets which are weighted for credit risk according to a formula used by the Dutch central bank (De Nederlandsche Bank), which conforms to the capital adequacy guidelines of the BIS (Bank of International Settlements). On and off-balance-sheet items are weighted for risk, with off-balance-sheet items converted to balance-sheet equivalents (using credit-conversion factors) before being allocated a risk weight.

RISK-WEIGHTED ASSETS (‘RWA’ UNDER BASEL II)

Assets which are weighted for credit and market risk in accordance with the Basel II methodology. The risk-weighted assets are calculated using internal models approved by The Dutch central bank (De Nederlandsche Bank). Regulatory capital requirements for operational risk are calculated without use of risk-weighted assets.

 

 

F-251


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

 

SETTLEMENT RISK

Settlement risk arises when there is an exchange of value (funds, instruments or commodities) for the same or different value dates and receipt is not verified or expected until ING Group has paid or delivered its side of the trade. The risk is that ING Group delivers, but does not receive delivery from the counterparty.

SIGNIFICANT INFLUENCE

The power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of an entity, but not to have control over these policies. Significant influence may be gained by share ownership, statute or agreement.

SOLVENCY II

The fundamental reform of European insurance solvency and risk governance legislation, which is expected to be effective as of January 1, 2014.

SUB-PRIME MORTGAGES

Mortgage loans made to borrowers who cannot get a regular mortgage because they have a bad credit history or limited income.

SUBSIDIARY

An entity that is controlled by another entity.

SURRENDER

The termination of a life or retirement contract at the request of the policyholder after which the policyholder receives the cash surrender value, if any, on the contract.

SWAP CONTRACTS

Commitments to settle in cash at a specified future date, based on differentials between specified financial indices as applied to a notional principal amount. Generally, no cash is exchanged at the outset of the contract and no principal payments are made by either party.

TIER 1 CAPITAL

Also referred to as the core capital of ING Bank. It comprises paid up share capital, reserves excluding revaluation reserves, retained earnings, minority interests and hybrid Tier 1.

TIER 1 RATIO

Reflecting the Tier 1 capital of ING Bank as a percentage of its total risk weighted assets. The minimum set by the Dutch central bank is 4%.

TOTAL AND UNDERLYING NET RESULT

The variance between Total and Underlying net result is caused by divestments and special items.

TRADING PORTFOLIO

Comprises those financial instruments which are held to obtain short-term transaction results, to facilitate transactions on behalf of clients or to hedge other positions in the trading portfolio.

TRANSFER RISK

Probability of loss due to currency conversion (exchange) restrictions imposed by a foreign government that make it impossible to move money out of the country.

TREASURY BILLS

Generally short-term debt certificates issued by a central government. Dutch Treasury Certificates are regarded as Dutch Treasury bills.

TREASURY SHARES

An entity’s own equity instruments, held by the entity or other members of the consolidated group.

VALUE AT RISK (VAR)

Quantifies, with a one-sided confidence level of at least 99%, the maximum overnight loss in Net Present Value that could occur due to changes in risk factors (e.g. interest rates, foreign exchange rates, equity prices, credit spreads, implied volatilities) if positions remain unchanged for a time interval of one day.

VALUE IN USE

The present value of estimated future cash flows expected to arise from the continuing use of an asset and from its disposal at the end of its useful life.

VARIANCE-COVARIANCE

A model to calculate Value at Risk, assuming that changes in risk factors are (jointly) normally distributed and that the change in portfolio value is linearly dependent on all risk factor changes.

WARRANT

A financial instrument that gives the holder the right to purchase ordinary shares.

WEIGHTED AVERAGE COST OF CAPITAL (WACC)

The weighted average cost of capital is used as the discount rate for calculating the present value of future cash flows.

 

 

F-252


Table of Contents

SCHEDULE I—SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN RELATED PARTIES

Amounts are in millions of euros

 

Column A

Type of investment

  

Column B

Cost

    

Column C

Fair value

     Column D
Amount at
which
shown in
balance
sheet
 

DEBT SECURITIES

        

Debt securities held to maturity

     8,862         8,835         8,868   

Debentures/available-for-sale:

        

– Dutch governments

     11,321         12,201         12,201   

– foreign governments

     86,547         89,787         89,787   

– public utilities

     10,667         11,602         11,602   

– asset-backed securities

     16,212         16,351         16,351   

– redeemable preference shares/sinking funds

        

– all other corporate bonds

     67,655         69,293         69,293   

SHARES AND CONVIRTIBLE DEBENTURES

        

Ordinary shares

        

– public utilities

     30         45         45   

– banks, trusts and insurance companies

     2,056         3,290         3,290   

– industrial and all other

     3,629         4,621         4,621   

Preference shares

     372         445         445   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments

     207,351         216,470         216,503   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-253


Table of Contents

SCHEDULE III—SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION

Amounts are in millions of euros

 

Column A    Column B      Column C      Column D      Column E      Column F      Column G      Column H      Column I      Column J      Column K  
Segment    Deferred
policy
acquisition
costs
     Future
policy
benefits,
losses,
claims
and loss
expenses
     Unearned
premiums
     Other
policy
and
claims
     Premium
revenue
     Net
investment
income
(including
other
income and
other
expenses)
allocated to
underwriting
accounts
     Benefits,
claims,
losses
and
settlement
expenses
     Amortization
of deferred
policy
acquisition
costs
     Other
operating
expenses
     Premiums
written
 

2011

                             

Life

     10,165         263,930            5,623         23,585         9,787         28,092         1,689         3,713         23,585   

Non-life

     39         3,113         297            1,708         316         1,064         13         721         1,682   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     10,204         267,043         297         5,623         25,293         10,103         29,156         1,702         4,434         25,267   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2010

                             

Life

     10,457         258,459            3,432         24,037         6,909         26,847         2,684         3,609         24,037   

Non-life

     42         3,103         345            1,702         368         1,041         13         662         1,676   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     10,499         261,562         345         3,432         25,739         7,277         27,888         2,697         4,271         25,713   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-254


Table of Contents

SCHEDULE IV—REINSURANCE

Amounts are in millions of euros

 

Column A   

Column B

Gross
amount

    

Column C

Ceded to
other
companies

     Column D
Assumed
from other
companies
    

Column E

Net
amount

    

Column F

Percentage
of amount
assumed

to net

 

2011 Premiums

              

– life

     24,442         1,889         1,032         23,585         4.4

– non-life

     1,702         43         23         1,682         1.4
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Premiums

     26,144         1,932         1,055         25,267         4.2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance in Force

     1,188,592         233,778         11,547         966,361         1.2

2010 Premiums

              

– life

     24,881         2,008         1,164         24,037         4.8

– non-life

     1,718         65         23         1,676         1.4
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Premiums

     26,599         2,073         1,187         25,713         4.6
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance in Force

     1,210,461         274,082         14,981         951,360         1.6

2009 Premiums

              

– life

     27,177         1,842         1,299         26,634         4.8

– non-life

     1,746         70         26         1,702         1.5
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Premiums

     28,923         1,912         1,325         28,336         4.7
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Life insurance in Force

     1,096,442         254,454         34,094         876,082         3.9

 

F-255


Table of Contents

SCHEDULE VI—SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION CONCERNING NON-LIFE INSURANCE OPERATIONS

Amounts are in millions of euros

 

Column A   Column B     Column C     Column D     Column E     Column F     Column G     Column H     Column I     Column J     Column K  
Affiliation with the registrant   Deferred
policy
acquisition
costs
    Reserves
for
unpaid
claims &
claims
adjusted
expenses
    Discount
if any
deducted
in
column C
    Unearned
premiums
    Earned
premiums
    Net
investment
income
(including
other
income
and other
expenses)
allocated
to non-life
operations
    Claims and
claims
adjustment
expenses
incurrent
related to
accident
years
    Amortization
of DPAC(1)
    Paid
claims &
claims
adjusted
expenses
    Premiums
written
 
                                        Current     Prior                    

2011

                     

Consolidated Non-life entities

    39        3,113        246        297        1,708        316        1,166        (31     13        1,064        1,682   

2010

                     

Consolidated Non-life entities

    42        3,103        235        345        1,702        368        1,121        11        13        1,041        1,676   

 

(1) 

DPAC: Deferred policy acquisition costs

 

F-256